debug/dwarf: support 64-bit DWARF in byte order check
[official-gcc.git] / gcc / dwarf2out.c
blobec9b40602b1a464c101429735668d7402f5e0e35
1 /* Output Dwarf2 format symbol table information from GCC.
2 Copyright (C) 1992-2017 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3 Contributed by Gary Funck (gary@intrepid.com).
4 Derived from DWARF 1 implementation of Ron Guilmette (rfg@monkeys.com).
5 Extensively modified by Jason Merrill (jason@cygnus.com).
7 This file is part of GCC.
9 GCC is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
10 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free
11 Software Foundation; either version 3, or (at your option) any later
12 version.
14 GCC is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY
15 WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
16 FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public License
17 for more details.
19 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
20 along with GCC; see the file COPYING3. If not see
21 <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
23 /* TODO: Emit .debug_line header even when there are no functions, since
24 the file numbers are used by .debug_info. Alternately, leave
25 out locations for types and decls.
26 Avoid talking about ctors and op= for PODs.
27 Factor out common prologue sequences into multiple CIEs. */
29 /* The first part of this file deals with the DWARF 2 frame unwind
30 information, which is also used by the GCC efficient exception handling
31 mechanism. The second part, controlled only by an #ifdef
32 DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO, deals with the other DWARF 2 debugging
33 information. */
35 /* DWARF2 Abbreviation Glossary:
37 CFA = Canonical Frame Address
38 a fixed address on the stack which identifies a call frame.
39 We define it to be the value of SP just before the call insn.
40 The CFA register and offset, which may change during the course
41 of the function, are used to calculate its value at runtime.
43 CFI = Call Frame Instruction
44 an instruction for the DWARF2 abstract machine
46 CIE = Common Information Entry
47 information describing information common to one or more FDEs
49 DIE = Debugging Information Entry
51 FDE = Frame Description Entry
52 information describing the stack call frame, in particular,
53 how to restore registers
55 DW_CFA_... = DWARF2 CFA call frame instruction
56 DW_TAG_... = DWARF2 DIE tag */
58 #include "config.h"
59 #include "system.h"
60 #include "coretypes.h"
61 #include "target.h"
62 #include "function.h"
63 #include "rtl.h"
64 #include "tree.h"
65 #include "memmodel.h"
66 #include "tm_p.h"
67 #include "stringpool.h"
68 #include "insn-config.h"
69 #include "ira.h"
70 #include "cgraph.h"
71 #include "diagnostic.h"
72 #include "fold-const.h"
73 #include "stor-layout.h"
74 #include "varasm.h"
75 #include "version.h"
76 #include "flags.h"
77 #include "rtlhash.h"
78 #include "reload.h"
79 #include "output.h"
80 #include "expr.h"
81 #include "dwarf2out.h"
82 #include "dwarf2asm.h"
83 #include "toplev.h"
84 #include "md5.h"
85 #include "tree-pretty-print.h"
86 #include "debug.h"
87 #include "common/common-target.h"
88 #include "langhooks.h"
89 #include "lra.h"
90 #include "dumpfile.h"
91 #include "opts.h"
92 #include "tree-dfa.h"
93 #include "gdb/gdb-index.h"
94 #include "rtl-iter.h"
95 #include "stringpool.h"
96 #include "attribs.h"
98 static void dwarf2out_source_line (unsigned int, unsigned int, const char *,
99 int, bool);
100 static rtx_insn *last_var_location_insn;
101 static rtx_insn *cached_next_real_insn;
102 static void dwarf2out_decl (tree);
104 #ifndef XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO
105 #define XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO 0
106 #endif
108 #ifndef HAVE_XCOFF_DWARF_EXTRAS
109 #define HAVE_XCOFF_DWARF_EXTRAS 0
110 #endif
112 #ifdef VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
113 int vms_file_stats_name (const char *, long long *, long *, char *, int *);
115 /* Define this macro to be a nonzero value if the directory specifications
116 which are output in the debug info should end with a separator. */
117 #define DWARF2_DIR_SHOULD_END_WITH_SEPARATOR 1
118 /* Define this macro to evaluate to a nonzero value if GCC should refrain
119 from generating indirect strings in DWARF2 debug information, for instance
120 if your target is stuck with an old version of GDB that is unable to
121 process them properly or uses VMS Debug. */
122 #define DWARF2_INDIRECT_STRING_SUPPORT_MISSING_ON_TARGET 1
123 #else
124 #define DWARF2_DIR_SHOULD_END_WITH_SEPARATOR 0
125 #define DWARF2_INDIRECT_STRING_SUPPORT_MISSING_ON_TARGET 0
126 #endif
128 /* ??? Poison these here until it can be done generically. They've been
129 totally replaced in this file; make sure it stays that way. */
130 #undef DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
131 #undef DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
132 #if (GCC_VERSION >= 3000)
133 #pragma GCC poison DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
134 #endif
136 /* The size of the target's pointer type. */
137 #ifndef PTR_SIZE
138 #define PTR_SIZE (POINTER_SIZE / BITS_PER_UNIT)
139 #endif
141 /* Array of RTXes referenced by the debugging information, which therefore
142 must be kept around forever. */
143 static GTY(()) vec<rtx, va_gc> *used_rtx_array;
145 /* A pointer to the base of a list of incomplete types which might be
146 completed at some later time. incomplete_types_list needs to be a
147 vec<tree, va_gc> *because we want to tell the garbage collector about
148 it. */
149 static GTY(()) vec<tree, va_gc> *incomplete_types;
151 /* A pointer to the base of a table of references to declaration
152 scopes. This table is a display which tracks the nesting
153 of declaration scopes at the current scope and containing
154 scopes. This table is used to find the proper place to
155 define type declaration DIE's. */
156 static GTY(()) vec<tree, va_gc> *decl_scope_table;
158 /* Pointers to various DWARF2 sections. */
159 static GTY(()) section *debug_info_section;
160 static GTY(()) section *debug_skeleton_info_section;
161 static GTY(()) section *debug_abbrev_section;
162 static GTY(()) section *debug_skeleton_abbrev_section;
163 static GTY(()) section *debug_aranges_section;
164 static GTY(()) section *debug_addr_section;
165 static GTY(()) section *debug_macinfo_section;
166 static const char *debug_macinfo_section_name;
167 static unsigned macinfo_label_base = 1;
168 static GTY(()) section *debug_line_section;
169 static GTY(()) section *debug_skeleton_line_section;
170 static GTY(()) section *debug_loc_section;
171 static GTY(()) section *debug_pubnames_section;
172 static GTY(()) section *debug_pubtypes_section;
173 static GTY(()) section *debug_str_section;
174 static GTY(()) section *debug_line_str_section;
175 static GTY(()) section *debug_str_dwo_section;
176 static GTY(()) section *debug_str_offsets_section;
177 static GTY(()) section *debug_ranges_section;
178 static GTY(()) section *debug_frame_section;
180 /* Maximum size (in bytes) of an artificially generated label. */
181 #define MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES 40
183 /* According to the (draft) DWARF 3 specification, the initial length
184 should either be 4 or 12 bytes. When it's 12 bytes, the first 4
185 bytes are 0xffffffff, followed by the length stored in the next 8
186 bytes.
188 However, the SGI/MIPS ABI uses an initial length which is equal to
189 DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE. It is defined (elsewhere) accordingly. */
191 #ifndef DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE
192 #define DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 ? 4 : 12)
193 #endif
195 #ifndef DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE_STR
196 #define DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE_STR (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 ? "-4" : "-12")
197 #endif
199 /* Round SIZE up to the nearest BOUNDARY. */
200 #define DWARF_ROUND(SIZE,BOUNDARY) \
201 ((((SIZE) + (BOUNDARY) - 1) / (BOUNDARY)) * (BOUNDARY))
203 /* CIE identifier. */
204 #if HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= 64
205 #define DWARF_CIE_ID \
206 (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 ? DW_CIE_ID : DW64_CIE_ID)
207 #else
208 #define DWARF_CIE_ID DW_CIE_ID
209 #endif
212 /* A vector for a table that contains frame description
213 information for each routine. */
214 #define NOT_INDEXED (-1U)
215 #define NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED (-2U)
217 static GTY(()) vec<dw_fde_ref, va_gc> *fde_vec;
219 struct GTY((for_user)) indirect_string_node {
220 const char *str;
221 unsigned int refcount;
222 enum dwarf_form form;
223 char *label;
224 unsigned int index;
227 struct indirect_string_hasher : ggc_ptr_hash<indirect_string_node>
229 typedef const char *compare_type;
231 static hashval_t hash (indirect_string_node *);
232 static bool equal (indirect_string_node *, const char *);
235 static GTY (()) hash_table<indirect_string_hasher> *debug_str_hash;
237 static GTY (()) hash_table<indirect_string_hasher> *debug_line_str_hash;
239 /* With split_debug_info, both the comp_dir and dwo_name go in the
240 main object file, rather than the dwo, similar to the force_direct
241 parameter elsewhere but with additional complications:
243 1) The string is needed in both the main object file and the dwo.
244 That is, the comp_dir and dwo_name will appear in both places.
246 2) Strings can use four forms: DW_FORM_string, DW_FORM_strp,
247 DW_FORM_line_strp or DW_FORM_GNU_str_index.
249 3) GCC chooses the form to use late, depending on the size and
250 reference count.
252 Rather than forcing the all debug string handling functions and
253 callers to deal with these complications, simply use a separate,
254 special-cased string table for any attribute that should go in the
255 main object file. This limits the complexity to just the places
256 that need it. */
258 static GTY (()) hash_table<indirect_string_hasher> *skeleton_debug_str_hash;
260 static GTY(()) int dw2_string_counter;
262 /* True if the compilation unit places functions in more than one section. */
263 static GTY(()) bool have_multiple_function_sections = false;
265 /* Whether the default text and cold text sections have been used at all. */
267 static GTY(()) bool text_section_used = false;
268 static GTY(()) bool cold_text_section_used = false;
270 /* The default cold text section. */
271 static GTY(()) section *cold_text_section;
273 /* The DIE for C++14 'auto' in a function return type. */
274 static GTY(()) dw_die_ref auto_die;
276 /* The DIE for C++14 'decltype(auto)' in a function return type. */
277 static GTY(()) dw_die_ref decltype_auto_die;
279 /* Forward declarations for functions defined in this file. */
281 static void output_call_frame_info (int);
282 static void dwarf2out_note_section_used (void);
284 /* Personality decl of current unit. Used only when assembler does not support
285 personality CFI. */
286 static GTY(()) rtx current_unit_personality;
288 /* .debug_rnglists next index. */
289 static unsigned int rnglist_idx;
291 /* Data and reference forms for relocatable data. */
292 #define DW_FORM_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 8 ? DW_FORM_data8 : DW_FORM_data4)
293 #define DW_FORM_ref (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 8 ? DW_FORM_ref8 : DW_FORM_ref4)
295 #ifndef DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION
296 #define DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION ".debug_frame"
297 #endif
299 #ifndef FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL
300 #define FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL "LFB"
301 #endif
303 #ifndef FUNC_END_LABEL
304 #define FUNC_END_LABEL "LFE"
305 #endif
307 #ifndef PROLOGUE_END_LABEL
308 #define PROLOGUE_END_LABEL "LPE"
309 #endif
311 #ifndef EPILOGUE_BEGIN_LABEL
312 #define EPILOGUE_BEGIN_LABEL "LEB"
313 #endif
315 #ifndef FRAME_BEGIN_LABEL
316 #define FRAME_BEGIN_LABEL "Lframe"
317 #endif
318 #define CIE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL "LSCIE"
319 #define CIE_END_LABEL "LECIE"
320 #define FDE_LABEL "LSFDE"
321 #define FDE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL "LASFDE"
322 #define FDE_END_LABEL "LEFDE"
323 #define LINE_NUMBER_BEGIN_LABEL "LSLT"
324 #define LINE_NUMBER_END_LABEL "LELT"
325 #define LN_PROLOG_AS_LABEL "LASLTP"
326 #define LN_PROLOG_END_LABEL "LELTP"
327 #define DIE_LABEL_PREFIX "DW"
329 /* Match the base name of a file to the base name of a compilation unit. */
331 static int
332 matches_main_base (const char *path)
334 /* Cache the last query. */
335 static const char *last_path = NULL;
336 static int last_match = 0;
337 if (path != last_path)
339 const char *base;
340 int length = base_of_path (path, &base);
341 last_path = path;
342 last_match = (length == main_input_baselength
343 && memcmp (base, main_input_basename, length) == 0);
345 return last_match;
348 #ifdef DEBUG_DEBUG_STRUCT
350 static int
351 dump_struct_debug (tree type, enum debug_info_usage usage,
352 enum debug_struct_file criterion, int generic,
353 int matches, int result)
355 /* Find the type name. */
356 tree type_decl = TYPE_STUB_DECL (type);
357 tree t = type_decl;
358 const char *name = 0;
359 if (TREE_CODE (t) == TYPE_DECL)
360 t = DECL_NAME (t);
361 if (t)
362 name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (t);
364 fprintf (stderr, " struct %d %s %s %s %s %d %p %s\n",
365 criterion,
366 DECL_IN_SYSTEM_HEADER (type_decl) ? "sys" : "usr",
367 matches ? "bas" : "hdr",
368 generic ? "gen" : "ord",
369 usage == DINFO_USAGE_DFN ? ";" :
370 usage == DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE ? "." : "*",
371 result,
372 (void*) type_decl, name);
373 return result;
375 #define DUMP_GSTRUCT(type, usage, criterion, generic, matches, result) \
376 dump_struct_debug (type, usage, criterion, generic, matches, result)
378 #else
380 #define DUMP_GSTRUCT(type, usage, criterion, generic, matches, result) \
381 (result)
383 #endif
385 /* Get the number of HOST_WIDE_INTs needed to represent the precision
386 of the number. Some constants have a large uniform precision, so
387 we get the precision needed for the actual value of the number. */
389 static unsigned int
390 get_full_len (const wide_int &op)
392 int prec = wi::min_precision (op, UNSIGNED);
393 return ((prec + HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 1)
394 / HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT);
397 static bool
398 should_emit_struct_debug (tree type, enum debug_info_usage usage)
400 enum debug_struct_file criterion;
401 tree type_decl;
402 bool generic = lang_hooks.types.generic_p (type);
404 if (generic)
405 criterion = debug_struct_generic[usage];
406 else
407 criterion = debug_struct_ordinary[usage];
409 if (criterion == DINFO_STRUCT_FILE_NONE)
410 return DUMP_GSTRUCT (type, usage, criterion, generic, false, false);
411 if (criterion == DINFO_STRUCT_FILE_ANY)
412 return DUMP_GSTRUCT (type, usage, criterion, generic, false, true);
414 type_decl = TYPE_STUB_DECL (TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type));
416 if (type_decl != NULL)
418 if (criterion == DINFO_STRUCT_FILE_SYS && DECL_IN_SYSTEM_HEADER (type_decl))
419 return DUMP_GSTRUCT (type, usage, criterion, generic, false, true);
421 if (matches_main_base (DECL_SOURCE_FILE (type_decl)))
422 return DUMP_GSTRUCT (type, usage, criterion, generic, true, true);
425 return DUMP_GSTRUCT (type, usage, criterion, generic, false, false);
428 /* Switch [BACK] to eh_frame_section. If we don't have an eh_frame_section,
429 switch to the data section instead, and write out a synthetic start label
430 for collect2 the first time around. */
432 static void
433 switch_to_eh_frame_section (bool back ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
435 if (eh_frame_section == 0)
437 int flags;
439 if (EH_TABLES_CAN_BE_READ_ONLY)
441 int fde_encoding;
442 int per_encoding;
443 int lsda_encoding;
445 fde_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/1,
446 /*global=*/0);
447 per_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/2,
448 /*global=*/1);
449 lsda_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/0,
450 /*global=*/0);
451 flags = ((! flag_pic
452 || ((fde_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_absptr
453 && (fde_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_aligned
454 && (per_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_absptr
455 && (per_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_aligned
456 && (lsda_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_absptr
457 && (lsda_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_aligned))
458 ? 0 : SECTION_WRITE);
460 else
461 flags = SECTION_WRITE;
463 #ifdef EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME
464 eh_frame_section = get_section (EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME, flags, NULL);
465 #else
466 eh_frame_section = ((flags == SECTION_WRITE)
467 ? data_section : readonly_data_section);
468 #endif /* EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME */
471 switch_to_section (eh_frame_section);
473 #ifdef EH_FRAME_THROUGH_COLLECT2
474 /* We have no special eh_frame section. Emit special labels to guide
475 collect2. */
476 if (!back)
478 tree label = get_file_function_name ("F");
479 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file, floor_log2 (PTR_SIZE));
480 targetm.asm_out.globalize_label (asm_out_file,
481 IDENTIFIER_POINTER (label));
482 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, IDENTIFIER_POINTER (label));
484 #endif
487 /* Switch [BACK] to the eh or debug frame table section, depending on
488 FOR_EH. */
490 static void
491 switch_to_frame_table_section (int for_eh, bool back)
493 if (for_eh)
494 switch_to_eh_frame_section (back);
495 else
497 if (!debug_frame_section)
498 debug_frame_section = get_section (DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION,
499 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
500 switch_to_section (debug_frame_section);
504 /* Describe for the GTY machinery what parts of dw_cfi_oprnd1 are used. */
506 enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type
507 dw_cfi_oprnd1_desc (enum dwarf_call_frame_info cfi)
509 switch (cfi)
511 case DW_CFA_nop:
512 case DW_CFA_GNU_window_save:
513 case DW_CFA_remember_state:
514 case DW_CFA_restore_state:
515 return dw_cfi_oprnd_unused;
517 case DW_CFA_set_loc:
518 case DW_CFA_advance_loc1:
519 case DW_CFA_advance_loc2:
520 case DW_CFA_advance_loc4:
521 case DW_CFA_MIPS_advance_loc8:
522 return dw_cfi_oprnd_addr;
524 case DW_CFA_offset:
525 case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
526 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
527 case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
528 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
529 case DW_CFA_restore:
530 case DW_CFA_restore_extended:
531 case DW_CFA_undefined:
532 case DW_CFA_same_value:
533 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
534 case DW_CFA_register:
535 case DW_CFA_expression:
536 case DW_CFA_val_expression:
537 return dw_cfi_oprnd_reg_num;
539 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
540 case DW_CFA_GNU_args_size:
541 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
542 return dw_cfi_oprnd_offset;
544 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
545 return dw_cfi_oprnd_loc;
547 default:
548 gcc_unreachable ();
552 /* Describe for the GTY machinery what parts of dw_cfi_oprnd2 are used. */
554 enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type
555 dw_cfi_oprnd2_desc (enum dwarf_call_frame_info cfi)
557 switch (cfi)
559 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
560 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
561 case DW_CFA_offset:
562 case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
563 case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
564 return dw_cfi_oprnd_offset;
566 case DW_CFA_register:
567 return dw_cfi_oprnd_reg_num;
569 case DW_CFA_expression:
570 case DW_CFA_val_expression:
571 return dw_cfi_oprnd_loc;
573 default:
574 return dw_cfi_oprnd_unused;
578 /* Output one FDE. */
580 static void
581 output_fde (dw_fde_ref fde, bool for_eh, bool second,
582 char *section_start_label, int fde_encoding, char *augmentation,
583 bool any_lsda_needed, int lsda_encoding)
585 const char *begin, *end;
586 static unsigned int j;
587 char l1[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES], l2[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
589 targetm.asm_out.emit_unwind_label (asm_out_file, fde->decl, for_eh,
590 /* empty */ 0);
591 targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, FDE_LABEL,
592 for_eh + j);
593 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, FDE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL, for_eh + j);
594 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l2, FDE_END_LABEL, for_eh + j);
595 if (!XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO || for_eh)
597 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 && !for_eh)
598 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff, "Initial length escape value"
599 " indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
600 dw2_asm_output_delta (for_eh ? 4 : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l2, l1,
601 "FDE Length");
603 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l1);
605 if (for_eh)
606 dw2_asm_output_delta (4, l1, section_start_label, "FDE CIE offset");
607 else
608 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, section_start_label,
609 debug_frame_section, "FDE CIE offset");
611 begin = second ? fde->dw_fde_second_begin : fde->dw_fde_begin;
612 end = second ? fde->dw_fde_second_end : fde->dw_fde_end;
614 if (for_eh)
616 rtx sym_ref = gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, begin);
617 SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS (sym_ref) |= SYMBOL_FLAG_LOCAL;
618 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (fde_encoding, sym_ref, false,
619 "FDE initial location");
620 dw2_asm_output_delta (size_of_encoded_value (fde_encoding),
621 end, begin, "FDE address range");
623 else
625 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, begin, "FDE initial location");
626 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, end, begin, "FDE address range");
629 if (augmentation[0])
631 if (any_lsda_needed)
633 int size = size_of_encoded_value (lsda_encoding);
635 if (lsda_encoding == DW_EH_PE_aligned)
637 int offset = ( 4 /* Length */
638 + 4 /* CIE offset */
639 + 2 * size_of_encoded_value (fde_encoding)
640 + 1 /* Augmentation size */ );
641 int pad = -offset & (PTR_SIZE - 1);
643 size += pad;
644 gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (size) == 1);
647 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (size, "Augmentation size");
649 if (fde->uses_eh_lsda)
651 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, second ? "LLSDAC" : "LLSDA",
652 fde->funcdef_number);
653 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (lsda_encoding,
654 gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, l1),
655 false,
656 "Language Specific Data Area");
658 else
660 if (lsda_encoding == DW_EH_PE_aligned)
661 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file, floor_log2 (PTR_SIZE));
662 dw2_asm_output_data (size_of_encoded_value (lsda_encoding), 0,
663 "Language Specific Data Area (none)");
666 else
667 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, "Augmentation size");
670 /* Loop through the Call Frame Instructions associated with this FDE. */
671 fde->dw_fde_current_label = begin;
673 size_t from, until, i;
675 from = 0;
676 until = vec_safe_length (fde->dw_fde_cfi);
678 if (fde->dw_fde_second_begin == NULL)
680 else if (!second)
681 until = fde->dw_fde_switch_cfi_index;
682 else
683 from = fde->dw_fde_switch_cfi_index;
685 for (i = from; i < until; i++)
686 output_cfi ((*fde->dw_fde_cfi)[i], fde, for_eh);
689 /* If we are to emit a ref/link from function bodies to their frame tables,
690 do it now. This is typically performed to make sure that tables
691 associated with functions are dragged with them and not discarded in
692 garbage collecting links. We need to do this on a per function basis to
693 cope with -ffunction-sections. */
695 #ifdef ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_TABLE_REF
696 /* Switch to the function section, emit the ref to the tables, and
697 switch *back* into the table section. */
698 switch_to_section (function_section (fde->decl));
699 ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_TABLE_REF (section_start_label);
700 switch_to_frame_table_section (for_eh, true);
701 #endif
703 /* Pad the FDE out to an address sized boundary. */
704 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file,
705 floor_log2 ((for_eh ? PTR_SIZE : DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)));
706 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
708 j += 2;
711 /* Return true if frame description entry FDE is needed for EH. */
713 static bool
714 fde_needed_for_eh_p (dw_fde_ref fde)
716 if (flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables)
717 return true;
719 if (TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO && DECL_WEAK (fde->decl))
720 return true;
722 if (fde->uses_eh_lsda)
723 return true;
725 /* If exceptions are enabled, we have collected nothrow info. */
726 if (flag_exceptions && (fde->all_throwers_are_sibcalls || fde->nothrow))
727 return false;
729 return true;
732 /* Output the call frame information used to record information
733 that relates to calculating the frame pointer, and records the
734 location of saved registers. */
736 static void
737 output_call_frame_info (int for_eh)
739 unsigned int i;
740 dw_fde_ref fde;
741 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
742 char l1[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES], l2[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
743 char section_start_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
744 bool any_lsda_needed = false;
745 char augmentation[6];
746 int augmentation_size;
747 int fde_encoding = DW_EH_PE_absptr;
748 int per_encoding = DW_EH_PE_absptr;
749 int lsda_encoding = DW_EH_PE_absptr;
750 int return_reg;
751 rtx personality = NULL;
752 int dw_cie_version;
754 /* Don't emit a CIE if there won't be any FDEs. */
755 if (!fde_vec)
756 return;
758 /* Nothing to do if the assembler's doing it all. */
759 if (dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm ())
760 return;
762 /* If we don't have any functions we'll want to unwind out of, don't emit
763 any EH unwind information. If we make FDEs linkonce, we may have to
764 emit an empty label for an FDE that wouldn't otherwise be emitted. We
765 want to avoid having an FDE kept around when the function it refers to
766 is discarded. Example where this matters: a primary function template
767 in C++ requires EH information, an explicit specialization doesn't. */
768 if (for_eh)
770 bool any_eh_needed = false;
772 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*fde_vec, i, fde)
774 if (fde->uses_eh_lsda)
775 any_eh_needed = any_lsda_needed = true;
776 else if (fde_needed_for_eh_p (fde))
777 any_eh_needed = true;
778 else if (TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO)
779 targetm.asm_out.emit_unwind_label (asm_out_file, fde->decl, 1, 1);
782 if (!any_eh_needed)
783 return;
786 /* We're going to be generating comments, so turn on app. */
787 if (flag_debug_asm)
788 app_enable ();
790 /* Switch to the proper frame section, first time. */
791 switch_to_frame_table_section (for_eh, false);
793 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (section_start_label, FRAME_BEGIN_LABEL, for_eh);
794 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, section_start_label);
796 /* Output the CIE. */
797 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, CIE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL, for_eh);
798 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l2, CIE_END_LABEL, for_eh);
799 if (!XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO || for_eh)
801 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 && !for_eh)
802 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
803 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
804 dw2_asm_output_delta (for_eh ? 4 : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l2, l1,
805 "Length of Common Information Entry");
807 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l1);
809 /* Now that the CIE pointer is PC-relative for EH,
810 use 0 to identify the CIE. */
811 dw2_asm_output_data ((for_eh ? 4 : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE),
812 (for_eh ? 0 : DWARF_CIE_ID),
813 "CIE Identifier Tag");
815 /* Use the CIE version 3 for DWARF3; allow DWARF2 to continue to
816 use CIE version 1, unless that would produce incorrect results
817 due to overflowing the return register column. */
818 return_reg = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN, for_eh);
819 dw_cie_version = 1;
820 if (return_reg >= 256 || dwarf_version > 2)
821 dw_cie_version = 3;
822 dw2_asm_output_data (1, dw_cie_version, "CIE Version");
824 augmentation[0] = 0;
825 augmentation_size = 0;
827 personality = current_unit_personality;
828 if (for_eh)
830 char *p;
832 /* Augmentation:
833 z Indicates that a uleb128 is present to size the
834 augmentation section.
835 L Indicates the encoding (and thus presence) of
836 an LSDA pointer in the FDE augmentation.
837 R Indicates a non-default pointer encoding for
838 FDE code pointers.
839 P Indicates the presence of an encoding + language
840 personality routine in the CIE augmentation. */
842 fde_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/1, /*global=*/0);
843 per_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/2, /*global=*/1);
844 lsda_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/0, /*global=*/0);
846 p = augmentation + 1;
847 if (personality)
849 *p++ = 'P';
850 augmentation_size += 1 + size_of_encoded_value (per_encoding);
851 assemble_external_libcall (personality);
853 if (any_lsda_needed)
855 *p++ = 'L';
856 augmentation_size += 1;
858 if (fde_encoding != DW_EH_PE_absptr)
860 *p++ = 'R';
861 augmentation_size += 1;
863 if (p > augmentation + 1)
865 augmentation[0] = 'z';
866 *p = '\0';
869 /* Ug. Some platforms can't do unaligned dynamic relocations at all. */
870 if (personality && per_encoding == DW_EH_PE_aligned)
872 int offset = ( 4 /* Length */
873 + 4 /* CIE Id */
874 + 1 /* CIE version */
875 + strlen (augmentation) + 1 /* Augmentation */
876 + size_of_uleb128 (1) /* Code alignment */
877 + size_of_sleb128 (DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT)
878 + 1 /* RA column */
879 + 1 /* Augmentation size */
880 + 1 /* Personality encoding */ );
881 int pad = -offset & (PTR_SIZE - 1);
883 augmentation_size += pad;
885 /* Augmentations should be small, so there's scarce need to
886 iterate for a solution. Die if we exceed one uleb128 byte. */
887 gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (augmentation_size) == 1);
891 dw2_asm_output_nstring (augmentation, -1, "CIE Augmentation");
892 if (dw_cie_version >= 4)
894 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "CIE Address Size");
895 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "CIE Segment Size");
897 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1, "CIE Code Alignment Factor");
898 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT,
899 "CIE Data Alignment Factor");
901 if (dw_cie_version == 1)
902 dw2_asm_output_data (1, return_reg, "CIE RA Column");
903 else
904 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (return_reg, "CIE RA Column");
906 if (augmentation[0])
908 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (augmentation_size, "Augmentation size");
909 if (personality)
911 dw2_asm_output_data (1, per_encoding, "Personality (%s)",
912 eh_data_format_name (per_encoding));
913 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (per_encoding,
914 personality,
915 true, NULL);
918 if (any_lsda_needed)
919 dw2_asm_output_data (1, lsda_encoding, "LSDA Encoding (%s)",
920 eh_data_format_name (lsda_encoding));
922 if (fde_encoding != DW_EH_PE_absptr)
923 dw2_asm_output_data (1, fde_encoding, "FDE Encoding (%s)",
924 eh_data_format_name (fde_encoding));
927 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*cie_cfi_vec, i, cfi)
928 output_cfi (cfi, NULL, for_eh);
930 /* Pad the CIE out to an address sized boundary. */
931 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file,
932 floor_log2 (for_eh ? PTR_SIZE : DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE));
933 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
935 /* Loop through all of the FDE's. */
936 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*fde_vec, i, fde)
938 unsigned int k;
940 /* Don't emit EH unwind info for leaf functions that don't need it. */
941 if (for_eh && !fde_needed_for_eh_p (fde))
942 continue;
944 for (k = 0; k < (fde->dw_fde_second_begin ? 2 : 1); k++)
945 output_fde (fde, for_eh, k, section_start_label, fde_encoding,
946 augmentation, any_lsda_needed, lsda_encoding);
949 if (for_eh && targetm.terminate_dw2_eh_frame_info)
950 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0, "End of Table");
952 /* Turn off app to make assembly quicker. */
953 if (flag_debug_asm)
954 app_disable ();
957 /* Emit .cfi_startproc and .cfi_personality/.cfi_lsda if needed. */
959 static void
960 dwarf2out_do_cfi_startproc (bool second)
962 int enc;
963 rtx ref;
964 rtx personality = get_personality_function (current_function_decl);
966 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_startproc\n");
968 if (personality)
970 enc = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/2, /*global=*/1);
971 ref = personality;
973 /* ??? The GAS support isn't entirely consistent. We have to
974 handle indirect support ourselves, but PC-relative is done
975 in the assembler. Further, the assembler can't handle any
976 of the weirder relocation types. */
977 if (enc & DW_EH_PE_indirect)
978 ref = dw2_force_const_mem (ref, true);
980 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_personality %#x,", enc);
981 output_addr_const (asm_out_file, ref);
982 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
985 if (crtl->uses_eh_lsda)
987 char lab[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
989 enc = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/0, /*global=*/0);
990 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (lab, second ? "LLSDAC" : "LLSDA",
991 current_function_funcdef_no);
992 ref = gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, lab);
993 SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS (ref) = SYMBOL_FLAG_LOCAL;
995 if (enc & DW_EH_PE_indirect)
996 ref = dw2_force_const_mem (ref, true);
998 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_lsda %#x,", enc);
999 output_addr_const (asm_out_file, ref);
1000 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
1004 /* Allocate CURRENT_FDE. Immediately initialize all we can, noting that
1005 this allocation may be done before pass_final. */
1007 dw_fde_ref
1008 dwarf2out_alloc_current_fde (void)
1010 dw_fde_ref fde;
1012 fde = ggc_cleared_alloc<dw_fde_node> ();
1013 fde->decl = current_function_decl;
1014 fde->funcdef_number = current_function_funcdef_no;
1015 fde->fde_index = vec_safe_length (fde_vec);
1016 fde->all_throwers_are_sibcalls = crtl->all_throwers_are_sibcalls;
1017 fde->uses_eh_lsda = crtl->uses_eh_lsda;
1018 fde->nothrow = crtl->nothrow;
1019 fde->drap_reg = INVALID_REGNUM;
1020 fde->vdrap_reg = INVALID_REGNUM;
1022 /* Record the FDE associated with this function. */
1023 cfun->fde = fde;
1024 vec_safe_push (fde_vec, fde);
1026 return fde;
1029 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the beginning of a function, before
1030 the prologue. */
1032 void
1033 dwarf2out_begin_prologue (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1034 unsigned int column ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1035 const char *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1037 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
1038 char * dup_label;
1039 dw_fde_ref fde;
1040 section *fnsec;
1041 bool do_frame;
1043 current_function_func_begin_label = NULL;
1045 do_frame = dwarf2out_do_frame ();
1047 /* ??? current_function_func_begin_label is also used by except.c for
1048 call-site information. We must emit this label if it might be used. */
1049 if (!do_frame
1050 && (!flag_exceptions
1051 || targetm_common.except_unwind_info (&global_options) == UI_SJLJ))
1052 return;
1054 fnsec = function_section (current_function_decl);
1055 switch_to_section (fnsec);
1056 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL,
1057 current_function_funcdef_no);
1058 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL,
1059 current_function_funcdef_no);
1060 dup_label = xstrdup (label);
1061 current_function_func_begin_label = dup_label;
1063 /* We can elide the fde allocation if we're not emitting debug info. */
1064 if (!do_frame)
1065 return;
1067 /* Cater to the various TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK implementations that
1068 emit insns as rtx but bypass the bulk of rest_of_compilation, which
1069 would include pass_dwarf2_frame. If we've not created the FDE yet,
1070 do so now. */
1071 fde = cfun->fde;
1072 if (fde == NULL)
1073 fde = dwarf2out_alloc_current_fde ();
1075 /* Initialize the bits of CURRENT_FDE that were not available earlier. */
1076 fde->dw_fde_begin = dup_label;
1077 fde->dw_fde_current_label = dup_label;
1078 fde->in_std_section = (fnsec == text_section
1079 || (cold_text_section && fnsec == cold_text_section));
1081 /* We only want to output line number information for the genuine dwarf2
1082 prologue case, not the eh frame case. */
1083 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
1084 if (file)
1085 dwarf2out_source_line (line, column, file, 0, true);
1086 #endif
1088 if (dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm ())
1089 dwarf2out_do_cfi_startproc (false);
1090 else
1092 rtx personality = get_personality_function (current_function_decl);
1093 if (!current_unit_personality)
1094 current_unit_personality = personality;
1096 /* We cannot keep a current personality per function as without CFI
1097 asm, at the point where we emit the CFI data, there is no current
1098 function anymore. */
1099 if (personality && current_unit_personality != personality)
1100 sorry ("multiple EH personalities are supported only with assemblers "
1101 "supporting .cfi_personality directive");
1105 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the end of the generated code
1106 for a function prologue. This gets called *after* the prologue code has
1107 been generated. */
1109 void
1110 dwarf2out_vms_end_prologue (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1111 const char *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1113 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
1115 /* Output a label to mark the endpoint of the code generated for this
1116 function. */
1117 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, PROLOGUE_END_LABEL,
1118 current_function_funcdef_no);
1119 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, PROLOGUE_END_LABEL,
1120 current_function_funcdef_no);
1121 cfun->fde->dw_fde_vms_end_prologue = xstrdup (label);
1124 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the beginning of the generated code
1125 for a function epilogue. This gets called *before* the prologue code has
1126 been generated. */
1128 void
1129 dwarf2out_vms_begin_epilogue (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1130 const char *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1132 dw_fde_ref fde = cfun->fde;
1133 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
1135 if (fde->dw_fde_vms_begin_epilogue)
1136 return;
1138 /* Output a label to mark the endpoint of the code generated for this
1139 function. */
1140 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, EPILOGUE_BEGIN_LABEL,
1141 current_function_funcdef_no);
1142 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, EPILOGUE_BEGIN_LABEL,
1143 current_function_funcdef_no);
1144 fde->dw_fde_vms_begin_epilogue = xstrdup (label);
1147 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the absolute end of the generated code
1148 for a function definition. This gets called *after* the epilogue code has
1149 been generated. */
1151 void
1152 dwarf2out_end_epilogue (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1153 const char *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1155 dw_fde_ref fde;
1156 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
1158 last_var_location_insn = NULL;
1159 cached_next_real_insn = NULL;
1161 if (dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm ())
1162 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_endproc\n");
1164 /* Output a label to mark the endpoint of the code generated for this
1165 function. */
1166 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, FUNC_END_LABEL,
1167 current_function_funcdef_no);
1168 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, label);
1169 fde = cfun->fde;
1170 gcc_assert (fde != NULL);
1171 if (fde->dw_fde_second_begin == NULL)
1172 fde->dw_fde_end = xstrdup (label);
1175 void
1176 dwarf2out_frame_finish (void)
1178 /* Output call frame information. */
1179 if (targetm.debug_unwind_info () == UI_DWARF2)
1180 output_call_frame_info (0);
1182 /* Output another copy for the unwinder. */
1183 if ((flag_unwind_tables || flag_exceptions)
1184 && targetm_common.except_unwind_info (&global_options) == UI_DWARF2)
1185 output_call_frame_info (1);
1188 /* Note that the current function section is being used for code. */
1190 static void
1191 dwarf2out_note_section_used (void)
1193 section *sec = current_function_section ();
1194 if (sec == text_section)
1195 text_section_used = true;
1196 else if (sec == cold_text_section)
1197 cold_text_section_used = true;
1200 static void var_location_switch_text_section (void);
1201 static void set_cur_line_info_table (section *);
1203 void
1204 dwarf2out_switch_text_section (void)
1206 section *sect;
1207 dw_fde_ref fde = cfun->fde;
1209 gcc_assert (cfun && fde && fde->dw_fde_second_begin == NULL);
1211 if (!in_cold_section_p)
1213 fde->dw_fde_end = crtl->subsections.cold_section_end_label;
1214 fde->dw_fde_second_begin = crtl->subsections.hot_section_label;
1215 fde->dw_fde_second_end = crtl->subsections.hot_section_end_label;
1217 else
1219 fde->dw_fde_end = crtl->subsections.hot_section_end_label;
1220 fde->dw_fde_second_begin = crtl->subsections.cold_section_label;
1221 fde->dw_fde_second_end = crtl->subsections.cold_section_end_label;
1223 have_multiple_function_sections = true;
1225 /* There is no need to mark used sections when not debugging. */
1226 if (cold_text_section != NULL)
1227 dwarf2out_note_section_used ();
1229 if (dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm ())
1230 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_endproc\n");
1232 /* Now do the real section switch. */
1233 sect = current_function_section ();
1234 switch_to_section (sect);
1236 fde->second_in_std_section
1237 = (sect == text_section
1238 || (cold_text_section && sect == cold_text_section));
1240 if (dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm ())
1241 dwarf2out_do_cfi_startproc (true);
1243 var_location_switch_text_section ();
1245 if (cold_text_section != NULL)
1246 set_cur_line_info_table (sect);
1249 /* And now, the subset of the debugging information support code necessary
1250 for emitting location expressions. */
1252 /* Data about a single source file. */
1253 struct GTY((for_user)) dwarf_file_data {
1254 const char * filename;
1255 int emitted_number;
1258 /* Describe an entry into the .debug_addr section. */
1260 enum ate_kind {
1261 ate_kind_rtx,
1262 ate_kind_rtx_dtprel,
1263 ate_kind_label
1266 struct GTY((for_user)) addr_table_entry {
1267 enum ate_kind kind;
1268 unsigned int refcount;
1269 unsigned int index;
1270 union addr_table_entry_struct_union
1272 rtx GTY ((tag ("0"))) rtl;
1273 char * GTY ((tag ("1"))) label;
1275 GTY ((desc ("%1.kind"))) addr;
1278 /* Location lists are ranges + location descriptions for that range,
1279 so you can track variables that are in different places over
1280 their entire life. */
1281 typedef struct GTY(()) dw_loc_list_struct {
1282 dw_loc_list_ref dw_loc_next;
1283 const char *begin; /* Label and addr_entry for start of range */
1284 addr_table_entry *begin_entry;
1285 const char *end; /* Label for end of range */
1286 char *ll_symbol; /* Label for beginning of location list.
1287 Only on head of list */
1288 const char *section; /* Section this loclist is relative to */
1289 dw_loc_descr_ref expr;
1290 hashval_t hash;
1291 /* True if all addresses in this and subsequent lists are known to be
1292 resolved. */
1293 bool resolved_addr;
1294 /* True if this list has been replaced by dw_loc_next. */
1295 bool replaced;
1296 /* True if it has been emitted into .debug_loc* / .debug_loclists*
1297 section. */
1298 unsigned char emitted : 1;
1299 /* True if hash field is index rather than hash value. */
1300 unsigned char num_assigned : 1;
1301 /* True if .debug_loclists.dwo offset has been emitted for it already. */
1302 unsigned char offset_emitted : 1;
1303 /* True if note_variable_value_in_expr has been called on it. */
1304 unsigned char noted_variable_value : 1;
1305 /* True if the range should be emitted even if begin and end
1306 are the same. */
1307 bool force;
1308 } dw_loc_list_node;
1310 static dw_loc_descr_ref int_loc_descriptor (HOST_WIDE_INT);
1311 static dw_loc_descr_ref uint_loc_descriptor (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
1313 /* Convert a DWARF stack opcode into its string name. */
1315 static const char *
1316 dwarf_stack_op_name (unsigned int op)
1318 const char *name = get_DW_OP_name (op);
1320 if (name != NULL)
1321 return name;
1323 return "OP_<unknown>";
1326 /* Return a pointer to a newly allocated location description. Location
1327 descriptions are simple expression terms that can be strung
1328 together to form more complicated location (address) descriptions. */
1330 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref
1331 new_loc_descr (enum dwarf_location_atom op, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT oprnd1,
1332 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT oprnd2)
1334 dw_loc_descr_ref descr = ggc_cleared_alloc<dw_loc_descr_node> ();
1336 descr->dw_loc_opc = op;
1337 descr->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_unsigned_const;
1338 descr->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry = NULL;
1339 descr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned = oprnd1;
1340 descr->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_unsigned_const;
1341 descr->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_entry = NULL;
1342 descr->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_unsigned = oprnd2;
1344 return descr;
1347 /* Return a pointer to a newly allocated location description for
1348 REG and OFFSET. */
1350 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref
1351 new_reg_loc_descr (unsigned int reg, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
1353 if (reg <= 31)
1354 return new_loc_descr ((enum dwarf_location_atom) (DW_OP_breg0 + reg),
1355 offset, 0);
1356 else
1357 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bregx, reg, offset);
1360 /* Add a location description term to a location description expression. */
1362 static inline void
1363 add_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref *list_head, dw_loc_descr_ref descr)
1365 dw_loc_descr_ref *d;
1367 /* Find the end of the chain. */
1368 for (d = list_head; (*d) != NULL; d = &(*d)->dw_loc_next)
1371 *d = descr;
1374 /* Compare two location operands for exact equality. */
1376 static bool
1377 dw_val_equal_p (dw_val_node *a, dw_val_node *b)
1379 if (a->val_class != b->val_class)
1380 return false;
1381 switch (a->val_class)
1383 case dw_val_class_none:
1384 return true;
1385 case dw_val_class_addr:
1386 return rtx_equal_p (a->v.val_addr, b->v.val_addr);
1388 case dw_val_class_offset:
1389 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
1390 case dw_val_class_const:
1391 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const_implicit:
1392 case dw_val_class_const_implicit:
1393 case dw_val_class_range_list:
1394 /* These are all HOST_WIDE_INT, signed or unsigned. */
1395 return a->v.val_unsigned == b->v.val_unsigned;
1397 case dw_val_class_loc:
1398 return a->v.val_loc == b->v.val_loc;
1399 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
1400 return a->v.val_loc_list == b->v.val_loc_list;
1401 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
1402 return a->v.val_die_ref.die == b->v.val_die_ref.die;
1403 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
1404 return a->v.val_fde_index == b->v.val_fde_index;
1405 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
1406 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
1407 case dw_val_class_macptr:
1408 case dw_val_class_loclistsptr:
1409 case dw_val_class_high_pc:
1410 return strcmp (a->v.val_lbl_id, b->v.val_lbl_id) == 0;
1411 case dw_val_class_str:
1412 return a->v.val_str == b->v.val_str;
1413 case dw_val_class_flag:
1414 return a->v.val_flag == b->v.val_flag;
1415 case dw_val_class_file:
1416 case dw_val_class_file_implicit:
1417 return a->v.val_file == b->v.val_file;
1418 case dw_val_class_decl_ref:
1419 return a->v.val_decl_ref == b->v.val_decl_ref;
1421 case dw_val_class_const_double:
1422 return (a->v.val_double.high == b->v.val_double.high
1423 && a->v.val_double.low == b->v.val_double.low);
1425 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
1426 return *a->v.val_wide == *b->v.val_wide;
1428 case dw_val_class_vec:
1430 size_t a_len = a->v.val_vec.elt_size * a->v.val_vec.length;
1431 size_t b_len = b->v.val_vec.elt_size * b->v.val_vec.length;
1433 return (a_len == b_len
1434 && !memcmp (a->v.val_vec.array, b->v.val_vec.array, a_len));
1437 case dw_val_class_data8:
1438 return memcmp (a->v.val_data8, b->v.val_data8, 8) == 0;
1440 case dw_val_class_vms_delta:
1441 return (!strcmp (a->v.val_vms_delta.lbl1, b->v.val_vms_delta.lbl1)
1442 && !strcmp (a->v.val_vms_delta.lbl1, b->v.val_vms_delta.lbl1));
1444 case dw_val_class_discr_value:
1445 return (a->v.val_discr_value.pos == b->v.val_discr_value.pos
1446 && a->v.val_discr_value.v.uval == b->v.val_discr_value.v.uval);
1447 case dw_val_class_discr_list:
1448 /* It makes no sense comparing two discriminant value lists. */
1449 return false;
1451 gcc_unreachable ();
1454 /* Compare two location atoms for exact equality. */
1456 static bool
1457 loc_descr_equal_p_1 (dw_loc_descr_ref a, dw_loc_descr_ref b)
1459 if (a->dw_loc_opc != b->dw_loc_opc)
1460 return false;
1462 /* ??? This is only ever set for DW_OP_constNu, for N equal to the
1463 address size, but since we always allocate cleared storage it
1464 should be zero for other types of locations. */
1465 if (a->dtprel != b->dtprel)
1466 return false;
1468 return (dw_val_equal_p (&a->dw_loc_oprnd1, &b->dw_loc_oprnd1)
1469 && dw_val_equal_p (&a->dw_loc_oprnd2, &b->dw_loc_oprnd2));
1472 /* Compare two complete location expressions for exact equality. */
1474 bool
1475 loc_descr_equal_p (dw_loc_descr_ref a, dw_loc_descr_ref b)
1477 while (1)
1479 if (a == b)
1480 return true;
1481 if (a == NULL || b == NULL)
1482 return false;
1483 if (!loc_descr_equal_p_1 (a, b))
1484 return false;
1486 a = a->dw_loc_next;
1487 b = b->dw_loc_next;
1492 /* Add a constant OFFSET to a location expression. */
1494 static void
1495 loc_descr_plus_const (dw_loc_descr_ref *list_head, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
1497 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
1498 HOST_WIDE_INT *p;
1500 gcc_assert (*list_head != NULL);
1502 if (!offset)
1503 return;
1505 /* Find the end of the chain. */
1506 for (loc = *list_head; loc->dw_loc_next != NULL; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
1509 p = NULL;
1510 if (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_fbreg
1511 || (loc->dw_loc_opc >= DW_OP_breg0 && loc->dw_loc_opc <= DW_OP_breg31))
1512 p = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int;
1513 else if (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_bregx)
1514 p = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_int;
1516 /* If the last operation is fbreg, breg{0..31,x}, optimize by adjusting its
1517 offset. Don't optimize if an signed integer overflow would happen. */
1518 if (p != NULL
1519 && ((offset > 0 && *p <= INTTYPE_MAXIMUM (HOST_WIDE_INT) - offset)
1520 || (offset < 0 && *p >= INTTYPE_MINIMUM (HOST_WIDE_INT) - offset)))
1521 *p += offset;
1523 else if (offset > 0)
1524 loc->dw_loc_next = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, offset, 0);
1526 else
1528 loc->dw_loc_next
1529 = uint_loc_descriptor (-(unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) offset);
1530 add_loc_descr (&loc->dw_loc_next, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_minus, 0, 0));
1534 /* Add a constant OFFSET to a location list. */
1536 static void
1537 loc_list_plus_const (dw_loc_list_ref list_head, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
1539 dw_loc_list_ref d;
1540 for (d = list_head; d != NULL; d = d->dw_loc_next)
1541 loc_descr_plus_const (&d->expr, offset);
1544 #define DWARF_REF_SIZE \
1545 (dwarf_version == 2 ? DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE)
1547 /* The number of bits that can be encoded by largest DW_FORM_dataN.
1548 In DWARF4 and earlier it is DW_FORM_data8 with 64 bits, in DWARF5
1549 DW_FORM_data16 with 128 bits. */
1550 #define DWARF_LARGEST_DATA_FORM_BITS \
1551 (dwarf_version >= 5 ? 128 : 64)
1553 /* Utility inline function for construction of ops that were GNU extension
1554 before DWARF 5. */
1555 static inline enum dwarf_location_atom
1556 dwarf_OP (enum dwarf_location_atom op)
1558 switch (op)
1560 case DW_OP_implicit_pointer:
1561 if (dwarf_version < 5)
1562 return DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer;
1563 break;
1565 case DW_OP_entry_value:
1566 if (dwarf_version < 5)
1567 return DW_OP_GNU_entry_value;
1568 break;
1570 case DW_OP_const_type:
1571 if (dwarf_version < 5)
1572 return DW_OP_GNU_const_type;
1573 break;
1575 case DW_OP_regval_type:
1576 if (dwarf_version < 5)
1577 return DW_OP_GNU_regval_type;
1578 break;
1580 case DW_OP_deref_type:
1581 if (dwarf_version < 5)
1582 return DW_OP_GNU_deref_type;
1583 break;
1585 case DW_OP_convert:
1586 if (dwarf_version < 5)
1587 return DW_OP_GNU_convert;
1588 break;
1590 case DW_OP_reinterpret:
1591 if (dwarf_version < 5)
1592 return DW_OP_GNU_reinterpret;
1593 break;
1595 default:
1596 break;
1598 return op;
1601 /* Similarly for attributes. */
1602 static inline enum dwarf_attribute
1603 dwarf_AT (enum dwarf_attribute at)
1605 switch (at)
1607 case DW_AT_call_return_pc:
1608 if (dwarf_version < 5)
1609 return DW_AT_low_pc;
1610 break;
1612 case DW_AT_call_tail_call:
1613 if (dwarf_version < 5)
1614 return DW_AT_GNU_tail_call;
1615 break;
1617 case DW_AT_call_origin:
1618 if (dwarf_version < 5)
1619 return DW_AT_abstract_origin;
1620 break;
1622 case DW_AT_call_target:
1623 if (dwarf_version < 5)
1624 return DW_AT_GNU_call_site_target;
1625 break;
1627 case DW_AT_call_target_clobbered:
1628 if (dwarf_version < 5)
1629 return DW_AT_GNU_call_site_target_clobbered;
1630 break;
1632 case DW_AT_call_parameter:
1633 if (dwarf_version < 5)
1634 return DW_AT_abstract_origin;
1635 break;
1637 case DW_AT_call_value:
1638 if (dwarf_version < 5)
1639 return DW_AT_GNU_call_site_value;
1640 break;
1642 case DW_AT_call_data_value:
1643 if (dwarf_version < 5)
1644 return DW_AT_GNU_call_site_data_value;
1645 break;
1647 case DW_AT_call_all_calls:
1648 if (dwarf_version < 5)
1649 return DW_AT_GNU_all_call_sites;
1650 break;
1652 case DW_AT_call_all_tail_calls:
1653 if (dwarf_version < 5)
1654 return DW_AT_GNU_all_tail_call_sites;
1655 break;
1657 case DW_AT_dwo_name:
1658 if (dwarf_version < 5)
1659 return DW_AT_GNU_dwo_name;
1660 break;
1662 default:
1663 break;
1665 return at;
1668 /* And similarly for tags. */
1669 static inline enum dwarf_tag
1670 dwarf_TAG (enum dwarf_tag tag)
1672 switch (tag)
1674 case DW_TAG_call_site:
1675 if (dwarf_version < 5)
1676 return DW_TAG_GNU_call_site;
1677 break;
1679 case DW_TAG_call_site_parameter:
1680 if (dwarf_version < 5)
1681 return DW_TAG_GNU_call_site_parameter;
1682 break;
1684 default:
1685 break;
1687 return tag;
1690 static unsigned long int get_base_type_offset (dw_die_ref);
1692 /* Return the size of a location descriptor. */
1694 static unsigned long
1695 size_of_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
1697 unsigned long size = 1;
1699 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
1701 case DW_OP_addr:
1702 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
1703 break;
1704 case DW_OP_GNU_addr_index:
1705 case DW_OP_GNU_const_index:
1706 gcc_assert (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry->index != NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED);
1707 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry->index);
1708 break;
1709 case DW_OP_const1u:
1710 case DW_OP_const1s:
1711 size += 1;
1712 break;
1713 case DW_OP_const2u:
1714 case DW_OP_const2s:
1715 size += 2;
1716 break;
1717 case DW_OP_const4u:
1718 case DW_OP_const4s:
1719 size += 4;
1720 break;
1721 case DW_OP_const8u:
1722 case DW_OP_const8s:
1723 size += 8;
1724 break;
1725 case DW_OP_constu:
1726 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
1727 break;
1728 case DW_OP_consts:
1729 size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int);
1730 break;
1731 case DW_OP_pick:
1732 size += 1;
1733 break;
1734 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
1735 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
1736 break;
1737 case DW_OP_skip:
1738 case DW_OP_bra:
1739 size += 2;
1740 break;
1741 case DW_OP_breg0:
1742 case DW_OP_breg1:
1743 case DW_OP_breg2:
1744 case DW_OP_breg3:
1745 case DW_OP_breg4:
1746 case DW_OP_breg5:
1747 case DW_OP_breg6:
1748 case DW_OP_breg7:
1749 case DW_OP_breg8:
1750 case DW_OP_breg9:
1751 case DW_OP_breg10:
1752 case DW_OP_breg11:
1753 case DW_OP_breg12:
1754 case DW_OP_breg13:
1755 case DW_OP_breg14:
1756 case DW_OP_breg15:
1757 case DW_OP_breg16:
1758 case DW_OP_breg17:
1759 case DW_OP_breg18:
1760 case DW_OP_breg19:
1761 case DW_OP_breg20:
1762 case DW_OP_breg21:
1763 case DW_OP_breg22:
1764 case DW_OP_breg23:
1765 case DW_OP_breg24:
1766 case DW_OP_breg25:
1767 case DW_OP_breg26:
1768 case DW_OP_breg27:
1769 case DW_OP_breg28:
1770 case DW_OP_breg29:
1771 case DW_OP_breg30:
1772 case DW_OP_breg31:
1773 size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int);
1774 break;
1775 case DW_OP_regx:
1776 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
1777 break;
1778 case DW_OP_fbreg:
1779 size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int);
1780 break;
1781 case DW_OP_bregx:
1782 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
1783 size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_int);
1784 break;
1785 case DW_OP_piece:
1786 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
1787 break;
1788 case DW_OP_bit_piece:
1789 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
1790 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_unsigned);
1791 break;
1792 case DW_OP_deref_size:
1793 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
1794 size += 1;
1795 break;
1796 case DW_OP_call2:
1797 size += 2;
1798 break;
1799 case DW_OP_call4:
1800 size += 4;
1801 break;
1802 case DW_OP_call_ref:
1803 case DW_OP_GNU_variable_value:
1804 size += DWARF_REF_SIZE;
1805 break;
1806 case DW_OP_implicit_value:
1807 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned)
1808 + loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned;
1809 break;
1810 case DW_OP_implicit_pointer:
1811 case DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer:
1812 size += DWARF_REF_SIZE + size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_int);
1813 break;
1814 case DW_OP_entry_value:
1815 case DW_OP_GNU_entry_value:
1817 unsigned long op_size = size_of_locs (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc);
1818 size += size_of_uleb128 (op_size) + op_size;
1819 break;
1821 case DW_OP_const_type:
1822 case DW_OP_GNU_const_type:
1824 unsigned long o
1825 = get_base_type_offset (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die);
1826 size += size_of_uleb128 (o) + 1;
1827 switch (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class)
1829 case dw_val_class_vec:
1830 size += loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.length
1831 * loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.elt_size;
1832 break;
1833 case dw_val_class_const:
1834 size += HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / BITS_PER_UNIT;
1835 break;
1836 case dw_val_class_const_double:
1837 size += HOST_BITS_PER_DOUBLE_INT / BITS_PER_UNIT;
1838 break;
1839 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
1840 size += (get_full_len (*loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_wide)
1841 * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / BITS_PER_UNIT);
1842 break;
1843 default:
1844 gcc_unreachable ();
1846 break;
1848 case DW_OP_regval_type:
1849 case DW_OP_GNU_regval_type:
1851 unsigned long o
1852 = get_base_type_offset (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_die_ref.die);
1853 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned)
1854 + size_of_uleb128 (o);
1856 break;
1857 case DW_OP_deref_type:
1858 case DW_OP_GNU_deref_type:
1860 unsigned long o
1861 = get_base_type_offset (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_die_ref.die);
1862 size += 1 + size_of_uleb128 (o);
1864 break;
1865 case DW_OP_convert:
1866 case DW_OP_reinterpret:
1867 case DW_OP_GNU_convert:
1868 case DW_OP_GNU_reinterpret:
1869 if (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class == dw_val_class_unsigned_const)
1870 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
1871 else
1873 unsigned long o
1874 = get_base_type_offset (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die);
1875 size += size_of_uleb128 (o);
1877 break;
1878 case DW_OP_GNU_parameter_ref:
1879 size += 4;
1880 break;
1881 default:
1882 break;
1885 return size;
1888 /* Return the size of a series of location descriptors. */
1890 unsigned long
1891 size_of_locs (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
1893 dw_loc_descr_ref l;
1894 unsigned long size;
1896 /* If there are no skip or bra opcodes, don't fill in the dw_loc_addr
1897 field, to avoid writing to a PCH file. */
1898 for (size = 0, l = loc; l != NULL; l = l->dw_loc_next)
1900 if (l->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_skip || l->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_bra)
1901 break;
1902 size += size_of_loc_descr (l);
1904 if (! l)
1905 return size;
1907 for (size = 0, l = loc; l != NULL; l = l->dw_loc_next)
1909 l->dw_loc_addr = size;
1910 size += size_of_loc_descr (l);
1913 return size;
1916 /* Return the size of the value in a DW_AT_discr_value attribute. */
1918 static int
1919 size_of_discr_value (dw_discr_value *discr_value)
1921 if (discr_value->pos)
1922 return size_of_uleb128 (discr_value->v.uval);
1923 else
1924 return size_of_sleb128 (discr_value->v.sval);
1927 /* Return the size of the value in a DW_AT_discr_list attribute. */
1929 static int
1930 size_of_discr_list (dw_discr_list_ref discr_list)
1932 int size = 0;
1934 for (dw_discr_list_ref list = discr_list;
1935 list != NULL;
1936 list = list->dw_discr_next)
1938 /* One byte for the discriminant value descriptor, and then one or two
1939 LEB128 numbers, depending on whether it's a single case label or a
1940 range label. */
1941 size += 1;
1942 size += size_of_discr_value (&list->dw_discr_lower_bound);
1943 if (list->dw_discr_range != 0)
1944 size += size_of_discr_value (&list->dw_discr_upper_bound);
1946 return size;
1949 static HOST_WIDE_INT extract_int (const unsigned char *, unsigned);
1950 static void get_ref_die_offset_label (char *, dw_die_ref);
1951 static unsigned long int get_ref_die_offset (dw_die_ref);
1953 /* Output location description stack opcode's operands (if any).
1954 The for_eh_or_skip parameter controls whether register numbers are
1955 converted using DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT, which is needed in the case that
1956 hard reg numbers have been processed via DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (i.e. for unwind
1957 info). This should be suppressed for the cases that have not been converted
1958 (i.e. symbolic debug info), by setting the parameter < 0. See PR47324. */
1960 static void
1961 output_loc_operands (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, int for_eh_or_skip)
1963 dw_val_ref val1 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd1;
1964 dw_val_ref val2 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd2;
1966 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
1968 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
1969 case DW_OP_const2u:
1970 case DW_OP_const2s:
1971 dw2_asm_output_data (2, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
1972 break;
1973 case DW_OP_const4u:
1974 if (loc->dtprel)
1976 gcc_assert (targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel);
1977 targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel (asm_out_file, 4,
1978 val1->v.val_addr);
1979 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
1980 break;
1982 /* FALLTHRU */
1983 case DW_OP_const4s:
1984 dw2_asm_output_data (4, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
1985 break;
1986 case DW_OP_const8u:
1987 if (loc->dtprel)
1989 gcc_assert (targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel);
1990 targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel (asm_out_file, 8,
1991 val1->v.val_addr);
1992 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
1993 break;
1995 /* FALLTHRU */
1996 case DW_OP_const8s:
1997 gcc_assert (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= 64);
1998 dw2_asm_output_data (8, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
1999 break;
2000 case DW_OP_skip:
2001 case DW_OP_bra:
2003 int offset;
2005 gcc_assert (val1->val_class == dw_val_class_loc);
2006 offset = val1->v.val_loc->dw_loc_addr - (loc->dw_loc_addr + 3);
2008 dw2_asm_output_data (2, offset, NULL);
2010 break;
2011 case DW_OP_implicit_value:
2012 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
2013 switch (val2->val_class)
2015 case dw_val_class_const:
2016 dw2_asm_output_data (val1->v.val_unsigned, val2->v.val_int, NULL);
2017 break;
2018 case dw_val_class_vec:
2020 unsigned int elt_size = val2->v.val_vec.elt_size;
2021 unsigned int len = val2->v.val_vec.length;
2022 unsigned int i;
2023 unsigned char *p;
2025 if (elt_size > sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT))
2027 elt_size /= 2;
2028 len *= 2;
2030 for (i = 0, p = (unsigned char *) val2->v.val_vec.array;
2031 i < len;
2032 i++, p += elt_size)
2033 dw2_asm_output_data (elt_size, extract_int (p, elt_size),
2034 "fp or vector constant word %u", i);
2036 break;
2037 case dw_val_class_const_double:
2039 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT first, second;
2041 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
2043 first = val2->v.val_double.high;
2044 second = val2->v.val_double.low;
2046 else
2048 first = val2->v.val_double.low;
2049 second = val2->v.val_double.high;
2051 dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
2052 first, NULL);
2053 dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
2054 second, NULL);
2056 break;
2057 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
2059 int i;
2060 int len = get_full_len (*val2->v.val_wide);
2061 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
2062 for (i = len - 1; i >= 0; --i)
2063 dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
2064 val2->v.val_wide->elt (i), NULL);
2065 else
2066 for (i = 0; i < len; ++i)
2067 dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
2068 val2->v.val_wide->elt (i), NULL);
2070 break;
2071 case dw_val_class_addr:
2072 gcc_assert (val1->v.val_unsigned == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
2073 dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, val2->v.val_addr, NULL);
2074 break;
2075 default:
2076 gcc_unreachable ();
2078 break;
2079 #else
2080 case DW_OP_const2u:
2081 case DW_OP_const2s:
2082 case DW_OP_const4u:
2083 case DW_OP_const4s:
2084 case DW_OP_const8u:
2085 case DW_OP_const8s:
2086 case DW_OP_skip:
2087 case DW_OP_bra:
2088 case DW_OP_implicit_value:
2089 /* We currently don't make any attempt to make sure these are
2090 aligned properly like we do for the main unwind info, so
2091 don't support emitting things larger than a byte if we're
2092 only doing unwinding. */
2093 gcc_unreachable ();
2094 #endif
2095 case DW_OP_const1u:
2096 case DW_OP_const1s:
2097 dw2_asm_output_data (1, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
2098 break;
2099 case DW_OP_constu:
2100 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
2101 break;
2102 case DW_OP_consts:
2103 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val1->v.val_int, NULL);
2104 break;
2105 case DW_OP_pick:
2106 dw2_asm_output_data (1, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
2107 break;
2108 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
2109 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
2110 break;
2111 case DW_OP_breg0:
2112 case DW_OP_breg1:
2113 case DW_OP_breg2:
2114 case DW_OP_breg3:
2115 case DW_OP_breg4:
2116 case DW_OP_breg5:
2117 case DW_OP_breg6:
2118 case DW_OP_breg7:
2119 case DW_OP_breg8:
2120 case DW_OP_breg9:
2121 case DW_OP_breg10:
2122 case DW_OP_breg11:
2123 case DW_OP_breg12:
2124 case DW_OP_breg13:
2125 case DW_OP_breg14:
2126 case DW_OP_breg15:
2127 case DW_OP_breg16:
2128 case DW_OP_breg17:
2129 case DW_OP_breg18:
2130 case DW_OP_breg19:
2131 case DW_OP_breg20:
2132 case DW_OP_breg21:
2133 case DW_OP_breg22:
2134 case DW_OP_breg23:
2135 case DW_OP_breg24:
2136 case DW_OP_breg25:
2137 case DW_OP_breg26:
2138 case DW_OP_breg27:
2139 case DW_OP_breg28:
2140 case DW_OP_breg29:
2141 case DW_OP_breg30:
2142 case DW_OP_breg31:
2143 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val1->v.val_int, NULL);
2144 break;
2145 case DW_OP_regx:
2147 unsigned r = val1->v.val_unsigned;
2148 if (for_eh_or_skip >= 0)
2149 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (r, for_eh_or_skip);
2150 gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (r)
2151 == size_of_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned));
2152 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
2154 break;
2155 case DW_OP_fbreg:
2156 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val1->v.val_int, NULL);
2157 break;
2158 case DW_OP_bregx:
2160 unsigned r = val1->v.val_unsigned;
2161 if (for_eh_or_skip >= 0)
2162 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (r, for_eh_or_skip);
2163 gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (r)
2164 == size_of_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned));
2165 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
2166 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val2->v.val_int, NULL);
2168 break;
2169 case DW_OP_piece:
2170 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
2171 break;
2172 case DW_OP_bit_piece:
2173 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
2174 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val2->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
2175 break;
2176 case DW_OP_deref_size:
2177 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
2178 dw2_asm_output_data (1, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
2179 break;
2181 case DW_OP_addr:
2182 if (loc->dtprel)
2184 if (targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel)
2186 targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel (asm_out_file,
2187 DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
2188 val1->v.val_addr);
2189 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
2191 else
2192 gcc_unreachable ();
2194 else
2196 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
2197 dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, val1->v.val_addr, NULL);
2198 #else
2199 gcc_unreachable ();
2200 #endif
2202 break;
2204 case DW_OP_GNU_addr_index:
2205 case DW_OP_GNU_const_index:
2206 gcc_assert (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry->index != NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED);
2207 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry->index,
2208 "(index into .debug_addr)");
2209 break;
2211 case DW_OP_call2:
2212 case DW_OP_call4:
2214 unsigned long die_offset
2215 = get_ref_die_offset (val1->v.val_die_ref.die);
2216 /* Make sure the offset has been computed and that we can encode it as
2217 an operand. */
2218 gcc_assert (die_offset > 0
2219 && die_offset <= (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_call2
2220 ? 0xffff
2221 : 0xffffffff));
2222 dw2_asm_output_data ((loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_call2) ? 2 : 4,
2223 die_offset, NULL);
2225 break;
2227 case DW_OP_call_ref:
2228 case DW_OP_GNU_variable_value:
2230 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES
2231 + HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / 2 + 2];
2232 gcc_assert (val1->val_class == dw_val_class_die_ref);
2233 get_ref_die_offset_label (label, val1->v.val_die_ref.die);
2234 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_REF_SIZE, label, debug_info_section, NULL);
2236 break;
2238 case DW_OP_implicit_pointer:
2239 case DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer:
2241 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES
2242 + HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / 2 + 2];
2243 gcc_assert (val1->val_class == dw_val_class_die_ref);
2244 get_ref_die_offset_label (label, val1->v.val_die_ref.die);
2245 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_REF_SIZE, label, debug_info_section, NULL);
2246 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val2->v.val_int, NULL);
2248 break;
2250 case DW_OP_entry_value:
2251 case DW_OP_GNU_entry_value:
2252 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (size_of_locs (val1->v.val_loc), NULL);
2253 output_loc_sequence (val1->v.val_loc, for_eh_or_skip);
2254 break;
2256 case DW_OP_const_type:
2257 case DW_OP_GNU_const_type:
2259 unsigned long o = get_base_type_offset (val1->v.val_die_ref.die), l;
2260 gcc_assert (o);
2261 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (o, NULL);
2262 switch (val2->val_class)
2264 case dw_val_class_const:
2265 l = HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR;
2266 dw2_asm_output_data (1, l, NULL);
2267 dw2_asm_output_data (l, val2->v.val_int, NULL);
2268 break;
2269 case dw_val_class_vec:
2271 unsigned int elt_size = val2->v.val_vec.elt_size;
2272 unsigned int len = val2->v.val_vec.length;
2273 unsigned int i;
2274 unsigned char *p;
2276 l = len * elt_size;
2277 dw2_asm_output_data (1, l, NULL);
2278 if (elt_size > sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT))
2280 elt_size /= 2;
2281 len *= 2;
2283 for (i = 0, p = (unsigned char *) val2->v.val_vec.array;
2284 i < len;
2285 i++, p += elt_size)
2286 dw2_asm_output_data (elt_size, extract_int (p, elt_size),
2287 "fp or vector constant word %u", i);
2289 break;
2290 case dw_val_class_const_double:
2292 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT first, second;
2293 l = HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR;
2295 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 2 * l, NULL);
2296 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
2298 first = val2->v.val_double.high;
2299 second = val2->v.val_double.low;
2301 else
2303 first = val2->v.val_double.low;
2304 second = val2->v.val_double.high;
2306 dw2_asm_output_data (l, first, NULL);
2307 dw2_asm_output_data (l, second, NULL);
2309 break;
2310 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
2312 int i;
2313 int len = get_full_len (*val2->v.val_wide);
2314 l = HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR;
2316 dw2_asm_output_data (1, len * l, NULL);
2317 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
2318 for (i = len - 1; i >= 0; --i)
2319 dw2_asm_output_data (l, val2->v.val_wide->elt (i), NULL);
2320 else
2321 for (i = 0; i < len; ++i)
2322 dw2_asm_output_data (l, val2->v.val_wide->elt (i), NULL);
2324 break;
2325 default:
2326 gcc_unreachable ();
2329 break;
2330 case DW_OP_regval_type:
2331 case DW_OP_GNU_regval_type:
2333 unsigned r = val1->v.val_unsigned;
2334 unsigned long o = get_base_type_offset (val2->v.val_die_ref.die);
2335 gcc_assert (o);
2336 if (for_eh_or_skip >= 0)
2338 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (r, for_eh_or_skip);
2339 gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (r)
2340 == size_of_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned));
2342 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
2343 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (o, NULL);
2345 break;
2346 case DW_OP_deref_type:
2347 case DW_OP_GNU_deref_type:
2349 unsigned long o = get_base_type_offset (val2->v.val_die_ref.die);
2350 gcc_assert (o);
2351 dw2_asm_output_data (1, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
2352 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (o, NULL);
2354 break;
2355 case DW_OP_convert:
2356 case DW_OP_reinterpret:
2357 case DW_OP_GNU_convert:
2358 case DW_OP_GNU_reinterpret:
2359 if (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class == dw_val_class_unsigned_const)
2360 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
2361 else
2363 unsigned long o = get_base_type_offset (val1->v.val_die_ref.die);
2364 gcc_assert (o);
2365 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (o, NULL);
2367 break;
2369 case DW_OP_GNU_parameter_ref:
2371 unsigned long o;
2372 gcc_assert (val1->val_class == dw_val_class_die_ref);
2373 o = get_ref_die_offset (val1->v.val_die_ref.die);
2374 dw2_asm_output_data (4, o, NULL);
2376 break;
2378 default:
2379 /* Other codes have no operands. */
2380 break;
2384 /* Output a sequence of location operations.
2385 The for_eh_or_skip parameter controls whether register numbers are
2386 converted using DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT, which is needed in the case that
2387 hard reg numbers have been processed via DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (i.e. for unwind
2388 info). This should be suppressed for the cases that have not been converted
2389 (i.e. symbolic debug info), by setting the parameter < 0. See PR47324. */
2391 void
2392 output_loc_sequence (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, int for_eh_or_skip)
2394 for (; loc != NULL; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
2396 enum dwarf_location_atom opc = loc->dw_loc_opc;
2397 /* Output the opcode. */
2398 if (for_eh_or_skip >= 0
2399 && opc >= DW_OP_breg0 && opc <= DW_OP_breg31)
2401 unsigned r = (opc - DW_OP_breg0);
2402 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (r, for_eh_or_skip);
2403 gcc_assert (r <= 31);
2404 opc = (enum dwarf_location_atom) (DW_OP_breg0 + r);
2406 else if (for_eh_or_skip >= 0
2407 && opc >= DW_OP_reg0 && opc <= DW_OP_reg31)
2409 unsigned r = (opc - DW_OP_reg0);
2410 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (r, for_eh_or_skip);
2411 gcc_assert (r <= 31);
2412 opc = (enum dwarf_location_atom) (DW_OP_reg0 + r);
2415 dw2_asm_output_data (1, opc,
2416 "%s", dwarf_stack_op_name (opc));
2418 /* Output the operand(s) (if any). */
2419 output_loc_operands (loc, for_eh_or_skip);
2423 /* Output location description stack opcode's operands (if any).
2424 The output is single bytes on a line, suitable for .cfi_escape. */
2426 static void
2427 output_loc_operands_raw (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
2429 dw_val_ref val1 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd1;
2430 dw_val_ref val2 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd2;
2432 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
2434 case DW_OP_addr:
2435 case DW_OP_GNU_addr_index:
2436 case DW_OP_GNU_const_index:
2437 case DW_OP_implicit_value:
2438 /* We cannot output addresses in .cfi_escape, only bytes. */
2439 gcc_unreachable ();
2441 case DW_OP_const1u:
2442 case DW_OP_const1s:
2443 case DW_OP_pick:
2444 case DW_OP_deref_size:
2445 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
2446 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2447 dw2_asm_output_data_raw (1, val1->v.val_int);
2448 break;
2450 case DW_OP_const2u:
2451 case DW_OP_const2s:
2452 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2453 dw2_asm_output_data_raw (2, val1->v.val_int);
2454 break;
2456 case DW_OP_const4u:
2457 case DW_OP_const4s:
2458 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2459 dw2_asm_output_data_raw (4, val1->v.val_int);
2460 break;
2462 case DW_OP_const8u:
2463 case DW_OP_const8s:
2464 gcc_assert (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= 64);
2465 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2466 dw2_asm_output_data_raw (8, val1->v.val_int);
2467 break;
2469 case DW_OP_skip:
2470 case DW_OP_bra:
2472 int offset;
2474 gcc_assert (val1->val_class == dw_val_class_loc);
2475 offset = val1->v.val_loc->dw_loc_addr - (loc->dw_loc_addr + 3);
2477 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2478 dw2_asm_output_data_raw (2, offset);
2480 break;
2482 case DW_OP_regx:
2484 unsigned r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (val1->v.val_unsigned, 1);
2485 gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (r)
2486 == size_of_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned));
2487 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2488 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128_raw (r);
2490 break;
2492 case DW_OP_constu:
2493 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
2494 case DW_OP_piece:
2495 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2496 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128_raw (val1->v.val_unsigned);
2497 break;
2499 case DW_OP_bit_piece:
2500 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2501 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128_raw (val1->v.val_unsigned);
2502 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128_raw (val2->v.val_unsigned);
2503 break;
2505 case DW_OP_consts:
2506 case DW_OP_breg0:
2507 case DW_OP_breg1:
2508 case DW_OP_breg2:
2509 case DW_OP_breg3:
2510 case DW_OP_breg4:
2511 case DW_OP_breg5:
2512 case DW_OP_breg6:
2513 case DW_OP_breg7:
2514 case DW_OP_breg8:
2515 case DW_OP_breg9:
2516 case DW_OP_breg10:
2517 case DW_OP_breg11:
2518 case DW_OP_breg12:
2519 case DW_OP_breg13:
2520 case DW_OP_breg14:
2521 case DW_OP_breg15:
2522 case DW_OP_breg16:
2523 case DW_OP_breg17:
2524 case DW_OP_breg18:
2525 case DW_OP_breg19:
2526 case DW_OP_breg20:
2527 case DW_OP_breg21:
2528 case DW_OP_breg22:
2529 case DW_OP_breg23:
2530 case DW_OP_breg24:
2531 case DW_OP_breg25:
2532 case DW_OP_breg26:
2533 case DW_OP_breg27:
2534 case DW_OP_breg28:
2535 case DW_OP_breg29:
2536 case DW_OP_breg30:
2537 case DW_OP_breg31:
2538 case DW_OP_fbreg:
2539 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2540 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128_raw (val1->v.val_int);
2541 break;
2543 case DW_OP_bregx:
2545 unsigned r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (val1->v.val_unsigned, 1);
2546 gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (r)
2547 == size_of_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned));
2548 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2549 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128_raw (r);
2550 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2551 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128_raw (val2->v.val_int);
2553 break;
2555 case DW_OP_implicit_pointer:
2556 case DW_OP_entry_value:
2557 case DW_OP_const_type:
2558 case DW_OP_regval_type:
2559 case DW_OP_deref_type:
2560 case DW_OP_convert:
2561 case DW_OP_reinterpret:
2562 case DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer:
2563 case DW_OP_GNU_entry_value:
2564 case DW_OP_GNU_const_type:
2565 case DW_OP_GNU_regval_type:
2566 case DW_OP_GNU_deref_type:
2567 case DW_OP_GNU_convert:
2568 case DW_OP_GNU_reinterpret:
2569 case DW_OP_GNU_parameter_ref:
2570 gcc_unreachable ();
2571 break;
2573 default:
2574 /* Other codes have no operands. */
2575 break;
2579 void
2580 output_loc_sequence_raw (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
2582 while (1)
2584 enum dwarf_location_atom opc = loc->dw_loc_opc;
2585 /* Output the opcode. */
2586 if (opc >= DW_OP_breg0 && opc <= DW_OP_breg31)
2588 unsigned r = (opc - DW_OP_breg0);
2589 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (r, 1);
2590 gcc_assert (r <= 31);
2591 opc = (enum dwarf_location_atom) (DW_OP_breg0 + r);
2593 else if (opc >= DW_OP_reg0 && opc <= DW_OP_reg31)
2595 unsigned r = (opc - DW_OP_reg0);
2596 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (r, 1);
2597 gcc_assert (r <= 31);
2598 opc = (enum dwarf_location_atom) (DW_OP_reg0 + r);
2600 /* Output the opcode. */
2601 fprintf (asm_out_file, "%#x", opc);
2602 output_loc_operands_raw (loc);
2604 if (!loc->dw_loc_next)
2605 break;
2606 loc = loc->dw_loc_next;
2608 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2612 /* This function builds a dwarf location descriptor sequence from a
2613 dw_cfa_location, adding the given OFFSET to the result of the
2614 expression. */
2616 struct dw_loc_descr_node *
2617 build_cfa_loc (dw_cfa_location *cfa, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
2619 struct dw_loc_descr_node *head, *tmp;
2621 offset += cfa->offset;
2623 if (cfa->indirect)
2625 head = new_reg_loc_descr (cfa->reg, cfa->base_offset);
2626 head->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_const;
2627 head->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry = NULL;
2628 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0);
2629 add_loc_descr (&head, tmp);
2630 if (offset != 0)
2632 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, offset, 0);
2633 add_loc_descr (&head, tmp);
2636 else
2637 head = new_reg_loc_descr (cfa->reg, offset);
2639 return head;
2642 /* This function builds a dwarf location descriptor sequence for
2643 the address at OFFSET from the CFA when stack is aligned to
2644 ALIGNMENT byte. */
2646 struct dw_loc_descr_node *
2647 build_cfa_aligned_loc (dw_cfa_location *cfa,
2648 HOST_WIDE_INT offset, HOST_WIDE_INT alignment)
2650 struct dw_loc_descr_node *head;
2651 unsigned int dwarf_fp
2652 = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM);
2654 /* When CFA is defined as FP+OFFSET, emulate stack alignment. */
2655 if (cfa->reg == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM && cfa->indirect == 0)
2657 head = new_reg_loc_descr (dwarf_fp, 0);
2658 add_loc_descr (&head, int_loc_descriptor (alignment));
2659 add_loc_descr (&head, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
2660 loc_descr_plus_const (&head, offset);
2662 else
2663 head = new_reg_loc_descr (dwarf_fp, offset);
2664 return head;
2667 /* And now, the support for symbolic debugging information. */
2669 /* .debug_str support. */
2671 static void dwarf2out_init (const char *);
2672 static void dwarf2out_finish (const char *);
2673 static void dwarf2out_early_finish (const char *);
2674 static void dwarf2out_assembly_start (void);
2675 static void dwarf2out_define (unsigned int, const char *);
2676 static void dwarf2out_undef (unsigned int, const char *);
2677 static void dwarf2out_start_source_file (unsigned, const char *);
2678 static void dwarf2out_end_source_file (unsigned);
2679 static void dwarf2out_function_decl (tree);
2680 static void dwarf2out_begin_block (unsigned, unsigned);
2681 static void dwarf2out_end_block (unsigned, unsigned);
2682 static bool dwarf2out_ignore_block (const_tree);
2683 static void dwarf2out_early_global_decl (tree);
2684 static void dwarf2out_late_global_decl (tree);
2685 static void dwarf2out_type_decl (tree, int);
2686 static void dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl (tree, tree, tree, bool, bool);
2687 static void dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl_1 (tree, tree, tree,
2688 dw_die_ref);
2689 static void dwarf2out_abstract_function (tree);
2690 static void dwarf2out_var_location (rtx_insn *);
2691 static void dwarf2out_size_function (tree);
2692 static void dwarf2out_begin_function (tree);
2693 static void dwarf2out_end_function (unsigned int);
2694 static void dwarf2out_register_main_translation_unit (tree unit);
2695 static void dwarf2out_set_name (tree, tree);
2696 static void dwarf2out_register_external_die (tree decl, const char *sym,
2697 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT off);
2698 static bool dwarf2out_die_ref_for_decl (tree decl, const char **sym,
2699 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT *off);
2701 /* The debug hooks structure. */
2703 const struct gcc_debug_hooks dwarf2_debug_hooks =
2705 dwarf2out_init,
2706 dwarf2out_finish,
2707 dwarf2out_early_finish,
2708 dwarf2out_assembly_start,
2709 dwarf2out_define,
2710 dwarf2out_undef,
2711 dwarf2out_start_source_file,
2712 dwarf2out_end_source_file,
2713 dwarf2out_begin_block,
2714 dwarf2out_end_block,
2715 dwarf2out_ignore_block,
2716 dwarf2out_source_line,
2717 dwarf2out_begin_prologue,
2718 #if VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
2719 dwarf2out_vms_end_prologue,
2720 dwarf2out_vms_begin_epilogue,
2721 #else
2722 debug_nothing_int_charstar,
2723 debug_nothing_int_charstar,
2724 #endif
2725 dwarf2out_end_epilogue,
2726 dwarf2out_begin_function,
2727 dwarf2out_end_function, /* end_function */
2728 dwarf2out_register_main_translation_unit,
2729 dwarf2out_function_decl, /* function_decl */
2730 dwarf2out_early_global_decl,
2731 dwarf2out_late_global_decl,
2732 dwarf2out_type_decl, /* type_decl */
2733 dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl,
2734 dwarf2out_die_ref_for_decl,
2735 dwarf2out_register_external_die,
2736 debug_nothing_tree, /* deferred_inline_function */
2737 /* The DWARF 2 backend tries to reduce debugging bloat by not
2738 emitting the abstract description of inline functions until
2739 something tries to reference them. */
2740 dwarf2out_abstract_function, /* outlining_inline_function */
2741 debug_nothing_rtx_code_label, /* label */
2742 debug_nothing_int, /* handle_pch */
2743 dwarf2out_var_location,
2744 dwarf2out_size_function, /* size_function */
2745 dwarf2out_switch_text_section,
2746 dwarf2out_set_name,
2747 1, /* start_end_main_source_file */
2748 TYPE_SYMTAB_IS_DIE /* tree_type_symtab_field */
2751 const struct gcc_debug_hooks dwarf2_lineno_debug_hooks =
2753 dwarf2out_init,
2754 debug_nothing_charstar,
2755 debug_nothing_charstar,
2756 dwarf2out_assembly_start,
2757 debug_nothing_int_charstar,
2758 debug_nothing_int_charstar,
2759 debug_nothing_int_charstar,
2760 debug_nothing_int,
2761 debug_nothing_int_int, /* begin_block */
2762 debug_nothing_int_int, /* end_block */
2763 debug_true_const_tree, /* ignore_block */
2764 dwarf2out_source_line, /* source_line */
2765 debug_nothing_int_int_charstar, /* begin_prologue */
2766 debug_nothing_int_charstar, /* end_prologue */
2767 debug_nothing_int_charstar, /* begin_epilogue */
2768 debug_nothing_int_charstar, /* end_epilogue */
2769 debug_nothing_tree, /* begin_function */
2770 debug_nothing_int, /* end_function */
2771 debug_nothing_tree, /* register_main_translation_unit */
2772 debug_nothing_tree, /* function_decl */
2773 debug_nothing_tree, /* early_global_decl */
2774 debug_nothing_tree, /* late_global_decl */
2775 debug_nothing_tree_int, /* type_decl */
2776 debug_nothing_tree_tree_tree_bool_bool,/* imported_module_or_decl */
2777 debug_false_tree_charstarstar_uhwistar,/* die_ref_for_decl */
2778 debug_nothing_tree_charstar_uhwi, /* register_external_die */
2779 debug_nothing_tree, /* deferred_inline_function */
2780 debug_nothing_tree, /* outlining_inline_function */
2781 debug_nothing_rtx_code_label, /* label */
2782 debug_nothing_int, /* handle_pch */
2783 debug_nothing_rtx_insn, /* var_location */
2784 debug_nothing_tree, /* size_function */
2785 debug_nothing_void, /* switch_text_section */
2786 debug_nothing_tree_tree, /* set_name */
2787 0, /* start_end_main_source_file */
2788 TYPE_SYMTAB_IS_ADDRESS /* tree_type_symtab_field */
2791 /* NOTE: In the comments in this file, many references are made to
2792 "Debugging Information Entries". This term is abbreviated as `DIE'
2793 throughout the remainder of this file. */
2795 /* An internal representation of the DWARF output is built, and then
2796 walked to generate the DWARF debugging info. The walk of the internal
2797 representation is done after the entire program has been compiled.
2798 The types below are used to describe the internal representation. */
2800 /* Whether to put type DIEs into their own section .debug_types instead
2801 of making them part of the .debug_info section. Only supported for
2802 Dwarf V4 or higher and the user didn't disable them through
2803 -fno-debug-types-section. It is more efficient to put them in a
2804 separate comdat sections since the linker will then be able to
2805 remove duplicates. But not all tools support .debug_types sections
2806 yet. For Dwarf V5 or higher .debug_types doesn't exist any more,
2807 it is DW_UT_type unit type in .debug_info section. */
2809 #define use_debug_types (dwarf_version >= 4 && flag_debug_types_section)
2811 /* Various DIE's use offsets relative to the beginning of the
2812 .debug_info section to refer to each other. */
2814 typedef long int dw_offset;
2816 struct comdat_type_node;
2818 /* The entries in the line_info table more-or-less mirror the opcodes
2819 that are used in the real dwarf line table. Arrays of these entries
2820 are collected per section when DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO is not
2821 supported. */
2823 enum dw_line_info_opcode {
2824 /* Emit DW_LNE_set_address; the operand is the label index. */
2825 LI_set_address,
2827 /* Emit a row to the matrix with the given line. This may be done
2828 via any combination of DW_LNS_copy, DW_LNS_advance_line, and
2829 special opcodes. */
2830 LI_set_line,
2832 /* Emit a DW_LNS_set_file. */
2833 LI_set_file,
2835 /* Emit a DW_LNS_set_column. */
2836 LI_set_column,
2838 /* Emit a DW_LNS_negate_stmt; the operand is ignored. */
2839 LI_negate_stmt,
2841 /* Emit a DW_LNS_set_prologue_end/epilogue_begin; the operand is ignored. */
2842 LI_set_prologue_end,
2843 LI_set_epilogue_begin,
2845 /* Emit a DW_LNE_set_discriminator. */
2846 LI_set_discriminator
2849 typedef struct GTY(()) dw_line_info_struct {
2850 enum dw_line_info_opcode opcode;
2851 unsigned int val;
2852 } dw_line_info_entry;
2855 struct GTY(()) dw_line_info_table {
2856 /* The label that marks the end of this section. */
2857 const char *end_label;
2859 /* The values for the last row of the matrix, as collected in the table.
2860 These are used to minimize the changes to the next row. */
2861 unsigned int file_num;
2862 unsigned int line_num;
2863 unsigned int column_num;
2864 int discrim_num;
2865 bool is_stmt;
2866 bool in_use;
2868 vec<dw_line_info_entry, va_gc> *entries;
2872 /* Each DIE attribute has a field specifying the attribute kind,
2873 a link to the next attribute in the chain, and an attribute value.
2874 Attributes are typically linked below the DIE they modify. */
2876 typedef struct GTY(()) dw_attr_struct {
2877 enum dwarf_attribute dw_attr;
2878 dw_val_node dw_attr_val;
2880 dw_attr_node;
2883 /* The Debugging Information Entry (DIE) structure. DIEs form a tree.
2884 The children of each node form a circular list linked by
2885 die_sib. die_child points to the node *before* the "first" child node. */
2887 typedef struct GTY((chain_circular ("%h.die_sib"), for_user)) die_struct {
2888 union die_symbol_or_type_node
2890 const char * GTY ((tag ("0"))) die_symbol;
2891 comdat_type_node *GTY ((tag ("1"))) die_type_node;
2893 GTY ((desc ("%0.comdat_type_p"))) die_id;
2894 vec<dw_attr_node, va_gc> *die_attr;
2895 dw_die_ref die_parent;
2896 dw_die_ref die_child;
2897 dw_die_ref die_sib;
2898 dw_die_ref die_definition; /* ref from a specification to its definition */
2899 dw_offset die_offset;
2900 unsigned long die_abbrev;
2901 int die_mark;
2902 unsigned int decl_id;
2903 enum dwarf_tag die_tag;
2904 /* Die is used and must not be pruned as unused. */
2905 BOOL_BITFIELD die_perennial_p : 1;
2906 BOOL_BITFIELD comdat_type_p : 1; /* DIE has a type signature */
2907 /* For an external ref to die_symbol if die_offset contains an extra
2908 offset to that symbol. */
2909 BOOL_BITFIELD with_offset : 1;
2910 /* Whether this DIE was removed from the DIE tree, for example via
2911 prune_unused_types. We don't consider those present from the
2912 DIE lookup routines. */
2913 BOOL_BITFIELD removed : 1;
2914 /* Lots of spare bits. */
2916 die_node;
2918 /* Set to TRUE while dwarf2out_early_global_decl is running. */
2919 static bool early_dwarf;
2920 static bool early_dwarf_finished;
2921 struct set_early_dwarf {
2922 bool saved;
2923 set_early_dwarf () : saved(early_dwarf)
2925 gcc_assert (! early_dwarf_finished);
2926 early_dwarf = true;
2928 ~set_early_dwarf () { early_dwarf = saved; }
2931 /* Evaluate 'expr' while 'c' is set to each child of DIE in order. */
2932 #define FOR_EACH_CHILD(die, c, expr) do { \
2933 c = die->die_child; \
2934 if (c) do { \
2935 c = c->die_sib; \
2936 expr; \
2937 } while (c != die->die_child); \
2938 } while (0)
2940 /* The pubname structure */
2942 typedef struct GTY(()) pubname_struct {
2943 dw_die_ref die;
2944 const char *name;
2946 pubname_entry;
2949 struct GTY(()) dw_ranges {
2950 const char *label;
2951 /* If this is positive, it's a block number, otherwise it's a
2952 bitwise-negated index into dw_ranges_by_label. */
2953 int num;
2954 /* Index for the range list for DW_FORM_rnglistx. */
2955 unsigned int idx : 31;
2956 /* True if this range might be possibly in a different section
2957 from previous entry. */
2958 unsigned int maybe_new_sec : 1;
2961 /* A structure to hold a macinfo entry. */
2963 typedef struct GTY(()) macinfo_struct {
2964 unsigned char code;
2965 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT lineno;
2966 const char *info;
2968 macinfo_entry;
2971 struct GTY(()) dw_ranges_by_label {
2972 const char *begin;
2973 const char *end;
2976 /* The comdat type node structure. */
2977 struct GTY(()) comdat_type_node
2979 dw_die_ref root_die;
2980 dw_die_ref type_die;
2981 dw_die_ref skeleton_die;
2982 char signature[DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE];
2983 comdat_type_node *next;
2986 /* A list of DIEs for which we can't determine ancestry (parent_die
2987 field) just yet. Later in dwarf2out_finish we will fill in the
2988 missing bits. */
2989 typedef struct GTY(()) limbo_die_struct {
2990 dw_die_ref die;
2991 /* The tree for which this DIE was created. We use this to
2992 determine ancestry later. */
2993 tree created_for;
2994 struct limbo_die_struct *next;
2996 limbo_die_node;
2998 typedef struct skeleton_chain_struct
3000 dw_die_ref old_die;
3001 dw_die_ref new_die;
3002 struct skeleton_chain_struct *parent;
3004 skeleton_chain_node;
3006 /* Define a macro which returns nonzero for a TYPE_DECL which was
3007 implicitly generated for a type.
3009 Note that, unlike the C front-end (which generates a NULL named
3010 TYPE_DECL node for each complete tagged type, each array type,
3011 and each function type node created) the C++ front-end generates
3012 a _named_ TYPE_DECL node for each tagged type node created.
3013 These TYPE_DECLs have DECL_ARTIFICIAL set, so we know not to
3014 generate a DW_TAG_typedef DIE for them. Likewise with the Ada
3015 front-end, but for each type, tagged or not. */
3017 #define TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB(decl) \
3018 (DECL_NAME (decl) == NULL_TREE \
3019 || (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl) \
3020 && ((decl == TYPE_STUB_DECL (TREE_TYPE (decl))) \
3021 /* This is necessary for stub decls that \
3022 appear in nested inline functions. */ \
3023 || (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) != NULL_TREE \
3024 && (decl_ultimate_origin (decl) \
3025 == TYPE_STUB_DECL (TREE_TYPE (decl)))))))
3027 /* Information concerning the compilation unit's programming
3028 language, and compiler version. */
3030 /* Fixed size portion of the DWARF compilation unit header. */
3031 #define DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE \
3032 (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE \
3033 + (dwarf_version >= 5 ? 4 : 3))
3035 /* Fixed size portion of the DWARF comdat type unit header. */
3036 #define DWARF_COMDAT_TYPE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE \
3037 (DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE \
3038 + DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE)
3040 /* Fixed size portion of the DWARF skeleton compilation unit header. */
3041 #define DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_SKELETON_HEADER_SIZE \
3042 (DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE + (dwarf_version >= 5 ? 8 : 0))
3044 /* Fixed size portion of public names info. */
3045 #define DWARF_PUBNAMES_HEADER_SIZE (2 * DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 2)
3047 /* Fixed size portion of the address range info. */
3048 #define DWARF_ARANGES_HEADER_SIZE \
3049 (DWARF_ROUND (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 4, \
3050 DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * 2) \
3051 - DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE)
3053 /* Size of padding portion in the address range info. It must be
3054 aligned to twice the pointer size. */
3055 #define DWARF_ARANGES_PAD_SIZE \
3056 (DWARF_ROUND (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 4, \
3057 DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * 2) \
3058 - (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 4))
3060 /* Use assembler line directives if available. */
3061 #ifndef DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
3062 #ifdef HAVE_AS_DWARF2_DEBUG_LINE
3063 #define DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO 1
3064 #else
3065 #define DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO 0
3066 #endif
3067 #endif
3069 /* Minimum line offset in a special line info. opcode.
3070 This value was chosen to give a reasonable range of values. */
3071 #define DWARF_LINE_BASE -10
3073 /* First special line opcode - leave room for the standard opcodes. */
3074 #define DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE ((int)DW_LNS_set_isa + 1)
3076 /* Range of line offsets in a special line info. opcode. */
3077 #define DWARF_LINE_RANGE (254-DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE+1)
3079 /* Flag that indicates the initial value of the is_stmt_start flag.
3080 In the present implementation, we do not mark any lines as
3081 the beginning of a source statement, because that information
3082 is not made available by the GCC front-end. */
3083 #define DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_IS_STMT_START 1
3085 /* Maximum number of operations per instruction bundle. */
3086 #ifndef DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_MAX_OPS_PER_INSN
3087 #define DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_MAX_OPS_PER_INSN 1
3088 #endif
3090 /* This location is used by calc_die_sizes() to keep track
3091 the offset of each DIE within the .debug_info section. */
3092 static unsigned long next_die_offset;
3094 /* Record the root of the DIE's built for the current compilation unit. */
3095 static GTY(()) dw_die_ref single_comp_unit_die;
3097 /* A list of type DIEs that have been separated into comdat sections. */
3098 static GTY(()) comdat_type_node *comdat_type_list;
3100 /* A list of CU DIEs that have been separated. */
3101 static GTY(()) limbo_die_node *cu_die_list;
3103 /* A list of DIEs with a NULL parent waiting to be relocated. */
3104 static GTY(()) limbo_die_node *limbo_die_list;
3106 /* A list of DIEs for which we may have to generate
3107 DW_AT_{,MIPS_}linkage_name once their DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAMEs are set. */
3108 static GTY(()) limbo_die_node *deferred_asm_name;
3110 struct dwarf_file_hasher : ggc_ptr_hash<dwarf_file_data>
3112 typedef const char *compare_type;
3114 static hashval_t hash (dwarf_file_data *);
3115 static bool equal (dwarf_file_data *, const char *);
3118 /* Filenames referenced by this compilation unit. */
3119 static GTY(()) hash_table<dwarf_file_hasher> *file_table;
3121 struct decl_die_hasher : ggc_ptr_hash<die_node>
3123 typedef tree compare_type;
3125 static hashval_t hash (die_node *);
3126 static bool equal (die_node *, tree);
3128 /* A hash table of references to DIE's that describe declarations.
3129 The key is a DECL_UID() which is a unique number identifying each decl. */
3130 static GTY (()) hash_table<decl_die_hasher> *decl_die_table;
3132 struct GTY ((for_user)) variable_value_struct {
3133 unsigned int decl_id;
3134 vec<dw_die_ref, va_gc> *dies;
3137 struct variable_value_hasher : ggc_ptr_hash<variable_value_struct>
3139 typedef tree compare_type;
3141 static hashval_t hash (variable_value_struct *);
3142 static bool equal (variable_value_struct *, tree);
3144 /* A hash table of DIEs that contain DW_OP_GNU_variable_value with
3145 dw_val_class_decl_ref class, indexed by FUNCTION_DECLs which is
3146 DECL_CONTEXT of the referenced VAR_DECLs. */
3147 static GTY (()) hash_table<variable_value_hasher> *variable_value_hash;
3149 struct block_die_hasher : ggc_ptr_hash<die_struct>
3151 static hashval_t hash (die_struct *);
3152 static bool equal (die_struct *, die_struct *);
3155 /* A hash table of references to DIE's that describe COMMON blocks.
3156 The key is DECL_UID() ^ die_parent. */
3157 static GTY (()) hash_table<block_die_hasher> *common_block_die_table;
3159 typedef struct GTY(()) die_arg_entry_struct {
3160 dw_die_ref die;
3161 tree arg;
3162 } die_arg_entry;
3165 /* Node of the variable location list. */
3166 struct GTY ((chain_next ("%h.next"))) var_loc_node {
3167 /* Either NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION, or, for SRA optimized variables,
3168 EXPR_LIST chain. For small bitsizes, bitsize is encoded
3169 in mode of the EXPR_LIST node and first EXPR_LIST operand
3170 is either NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION for a piece with a known
3171 location or NULL for padding. For larger bitsizes,
3172 mode is 0 and first operand is a CONCAT with bitsize
3173 as first CONCAT operand and NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION resp.
3174 NULL as second operand. */
3175 rtx GTY (()) loc;
3176 const char * GTY (()) label;
3177 struct var_loc_node * GTY (()) next;
3180 /* Variable location list. */
3181 struct GTY ((for_user)) var_loc_list_def {
3182 struct var_loc_node * GTY (()) first;
3184 /* Pointer to the last but one or last element of the
3185 chained list. If the list is empty, both first and
3186 last are NULL, if the list contains just one node
3187 or the last node certainly is not redundant, it points
3188 to the last node, otherwise points to the last but one.
3189 Do not mark it for GC because it is marked through the chain. */
3190 struct var_loc_node * GTY ((skip ("%h"))) last;
3192 /* Pointer to the last element before section switch,
3193 if NULL, either sections weren't switched or first
3194 is after section switch. */
3195 struct var_loc_node * GTY ((skip ("%h"))) last_before_switch;
3197 /* DECL_UID of the variable decl. */
3198 unsigned int decl_id;
3200 typedef struct var_loc_list_def var_loc_list;
3202 /* Call argument location list. */
3203 struct GTY ((chain_next ("%h.next"))) call_arg_loc_node {
3204 rtx GTY (()) call_arg_loc_note;
3205 const char * GTY (()) label;
3206 tree GTY (()) block;
3207 bool tail_call_p;
3208 rtx GTY (()) symbol_ref;
3209 struct call_arg_loc_node * GTY (()) next;
3213 struct decl_loc_hasher : ggc_ptr_hash<var_loc_list>
3215 typedef const_tree compare_type;
3217 static hashval_t hash (var_loc_list *);
3218 static bool equal (var_loc_list *, const_tree);
3221 /* Table of decl location linked lists. */
3222 static GTY (()) hash_table<decl_loc_hasher> *decl_loc_table;
3224 /* Head and tail of call_arg_loc chain. */
3225 static GTY (()) struct call_arg_loc_node *call_arg_locations;
3226 static struct call_arg_loc_node *call_arg_loc_last;
3228 /* Number of call sites in the current function. */
3229 static int call_site_count = -1;
3230 /* Number of tail call sites in the current function. */
3231 static int tail_call_site_count = -1;
3233 /* A cached location list. */
3234 struct GTY ((for_user)) cached_dw_loc_list_def {
3235 /* The DECL_UID of the decl that this entry describes. */
3236 unsigned int decl_id;
3238 /* The cached location list. */
3239 dw_loc_list_ref loc_list;
3241 typedef struct cached_dw_loc_list_def cached_dw_loc_list;
3243 struct dw_loc_list_hasher : ggc_ptr_hash<cached_dw_loc_list>
3246 typedef const_tree compare_type;
3248 static hashval_t hash (cached_dw_loc_list *);
3249 static bool equal (cached_dw_loc_list *, const_tree);
3252 /* Table of cached location lists. */
3253 static GTY (()) hash_table<dw_loc_list_hasher> *cached_dw_loc_list_table;
3255 /* A vector of references to DIE's that are uniquely identified by their tag,
3256 presence/absence of children DIE's, and list of attribute/value pairs. */
3257 static GTY(()) vec<dw_die_ref, va_gc> *abbrev_die_table;
3259 /* A hash map to remember the stack usage for DWARF procedures. The value
3260 stored is the stack size difference between before the DWARF procedure
3261 invokation and after it returned. In other words, for a DWARF procedure
3262 that consumes N stack slots and that pushes M ones, this stores M - N. */
3263 static hash_map<dw_die_ref, int> *dwarf_proc_stack_usage_map;
3265 /* A global counter for generating labels for line number data. */
3266 static unsigned int line_info_label_num;
3268 /* The current table to which we should emit line number information
3269 for the current function. This will be set up at the beginning of
3270 assembly for the function. */
3271 static GTY(()) dw_line_info_table *cur_line_info_table;
3273 /* The two default tables of line number info. */
3274 static GTY(()) dw_line_info_table *text_section_line_info;
3275 static GTY(()) dw_line_info_table *cold_text_section_line_info;
3277 /* The set of all non-default tables of line number info. */
3278 static GTY(()) vec<dw_line_info_table *, va_gc> *separate_line_info;
3280 /* A flag to tell pubnames/types export if there is an info section to
3281 refer to. */
3282 static bool info_section_emitted;
3284 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains a list of publicly
3285 accessible names. */
3286 static GTY (()) vec<pubname_entry, va_gc> *pubname_table;
3288 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains a list of publicly
3289 accessible types. */
3290 static GTY (()) vec<pubname_entry, va_gc> *pubtype_table;
3292 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains a list of macro
3293 defines/undefines (and file start/end markers). */
3294 static GTY (()) vec<macinfo_entry, va_gc> *macinfo_table;
3296 /* True if .debug_macinfo or .debug_macros section is going to be
3297 emitted. */
3298 #define have_macinfo \
3299 ((!XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO || HAVE_XCOFF_DWARF_EXTRAS) \
3300 && debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE \
3301 && !macinfo_table->is_empty ())
3303 /* Vector of dies for which we should generate .debug_ranges info. */
3304 static GTY (()) vec<dw_ranges, va_gc> *ranges_table;
3306 /* Vector of pairs of labels referenced in ranges_table. */
3307 static GTY (()) vec<dw_ranges_by_label, va_gc> *ranges_by_label;
3309 /* Whether we have location lists that need outputting */
3310 static GTY(()) bool have_location_lists;
3312 /* Unique label counter. */
3313 static GTY(()) unsigned int loclabel_num;
3315 /* Unique label counter for point-of-call tables. */
3316 static GTY(()) unsigned int poc_label_num;
3318 /* The last file entry emitted by maybe_emit_file(). */
3319 static GTY(()) struct dwarf_file_data * last_emitted_file;
3321 /* Number of internal labels generated by gen_internal_sym(). */
3322 static GTY(()) int label_num;
3324 static GTY(()) vec<die_arg_entry, va_gc> *tmpl_value_parm_die_table;
3326 /* Instances of generic types for which we need to generate debug
3327 info that describe their generic parameters and arguments. That
3328 generation needs to happen once all types are properly laid out so
3329 we do it at the end of compilation. */
3330 static GTY(()) vec<tree, va_gc> *generic_type_instances;
3332 /* Offset from the "steady-state frame pointer" to the frame base,
3333 within the current function. */
3334 static HOST_WIDE_INT frame_pointer_fb_offset;
3335 static bool frame_pointer_fb_offset_valid;
3337 static vec<dw_die_ref> base_types;
3339 /* Flags to represent a set of attribute classes for attributes that represent
3340 a scalar value (bounds, pointers, ...). */
3341 enum dw_scalar_form
3343 dw_scalar_form_constant = 0x01,
3344 dw_scalar_form_exprloc = 0x02,
3345 dw_scalar_form_reference = 0x04
3348 /* Forward declarations for functions defined in this file. */
3350 static int is_pseudo_reg (const_rtx);
3351 static tree type_main_variant (tree);
3352 static int is_tagged_type (const_tree);
3353 static const char *dwarf_tag_name (unsigned);
3354 static const char *dwarf_attr_name (unsigned);
3355 static const char *dwarf_form_name (unsigned);
3356 static tree decl_ultimate_origin (const_tree);
3357 static tree decl_class_context (tree);
3358 static void add_dwarf_attr (dw_die_ref, dw_attr_node *);
3359 static inline enum dw_val_class AT_class (dw_attr_node *);
3360 static inline unsigned int AT_index (dw_attr_node *);
3361 static void add_AT_flag (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned);
3362 static inline unsigned AT_flag (dw_attr_node *);
3363 static void add_AT_int (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, HOST_WIDE_INT);
3364 static inline HOST_WIDE_INT AT_int (dw_attr_node *);
3365 static void add_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
3366 static inline unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT AT_unsigned (dw_attr_node *);
3367 static void add_AT_double (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
3368 HOST_WIDE_INT, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
3369 static inline void add_AT_vec (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned int,
3370 unsigned int, unsigned char *);
3371 static void add_AT_data8 (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned char *);
3372 static void add_AT_string (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
3373 static inline const char *AT_string (dw_attr_node *);
3374 static enum dwarf_form AT_string_form (dw_attr_node *);
3375 static void add_AT_die_ref (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, dw_die_ref);
3376 static void add_AT_specification (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
3377 static inline dw_die_ref AT_ref (dw_attr_node *);
3378 static inline int AT_ref_external (dw_attr_node *);
3379 static inline void set_AT_ref_external (dw_attr_node *, int);
3380 static void add_AT_fde_ref (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned);
3381 static void add_AT_loc (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, dw_loc_descr_ref);
3382 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref AT_loc (dw_attr_node *);
3383 static void add_AT_loc_list (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
3384 dw_loc_list_ref);
3385 static inline dw_loc_list_ref AT_loc_list (dw_attr_node *);
3386 static addr_table_entry *add_addr_table_entry (void *, enum ate_kind);
3387 static void remove_addr_table_entry (addr_table_entry *);
3388 static void add_AT_addr (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, rtx, bool);
3389 static inline rtx AT_addr (dw_attr_node *);
3390 static void add_AT_lbl_id (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
3391 static void add_AT_lineptr (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
3392 static void add_AT_macptr (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
3393 static void add_AT_loclistsptr (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
3394 const char *);
3395 static void add_AT_offset (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
3396 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
3397 static void add_AT_range_list (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
3398 unsigned long, bool);
3399 static inline const char *AT_lbl (dw_attr_node *);
3400 static dw_attr_node *get_AT (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
3401 static const char *get_AT_low_pc (dw_die_ref);
3402 static const char *get_AT_hi_pc (dw_die_ref);
3403 static const char *get_AT_string (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
3404 static int get_AT_flag (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
3405 static unsigned get_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
3406 static inline dw_die_ref get_AT_ref (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
3407 static bool is_cxx (void);
3408 static bool is_cxx (const_tree);
3409 static bool is_fortran (void);
3410 static bool is_ada (void);
3411 static bool remove_AT (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
3412 static void remove_child_TAG (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_tag);
3413 static void add_child_die (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
3414 static dw_die_ref new_die (enum dwarf_tag, dw_die_ref, tree);
3415 static dw_die_ref lookup_type_die (tree);
3416 static dw_die_ref strip_naming_typedef (tree, dw_die_ref);
3417 static dw_die_ref lookup_type_die_strip_naming_typedef (tree);
3418 static void equate_type_number_to_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3419 static dw_die_ref lookup_decl_die (tree);
3420 static var_loc_list *lookup_decl_loc (const_tree);
3421 static void equate_decl_number_to_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3422 static struct var_loc_node *add_var_loc_to_decl (tree, rtx, const char *);
3423 static void print_spaces (FILE *);
3424 static void print_die (dw_die_ref, FILE *);
3425 static void loc_checksum (dw_loc_descr_ref, struct md5_ctx *);
3426 static void attr_checksum (dw_attr_node *, struct md5_ctx *, int *);
3427 static void die_checksum (dw_die_ref, struct md5_ctx *, int *);
3428 static void checksum_sleb128 (HOST_WIDE_INT, struct md5_ctx *);
3429 static void checksum_uleb128 (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT, struct md5_ctx *);
3430 static void loc_checksum_ordered (dw_loc_descr_ref, struct md5_ctx *);
3431 static void attr_checksum_ordered (enum dwarf_tag, dw_attr_node *,
3432 struct md5_ctx *, int *);
3433 struct checksum_attributes;
3434 static void collect_checksum_attributes (struct checksum_attributes *, dw_die_ref);
3435 static void die_checksum_ordered (dw_die_ref, struct md5_ctx *, int *);
3436 static void checksum_die_context (dw_die_ref, struct md5_ctx *);
3437 static void generate_type_signature (dw_die_ref, comdat_type_node *);
3438 static int same_loc_p (dw_loc_descr_ref, dw_loc_descr_ref, int *);
3439 static int same_dw_val_p (const dw_val_node *, const dw_val_node *, int *);
3440 static int same_attr_p (dw_attr_node *, dw_attr_node *, int *);
3441 static int same_die_p (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref, int *);
3442 static int is_type_die (dw_die_ref);
3443 static int is_comdat_die (dw_die_ref);
3444 static inline bool is_template_instantiation (dw_die_ref);
3445 static int is_declaration_die (dw_die_ref);
3446 static int should_move_die_to_comdat (dw_die_ref);
3447 static dw_die_ref clone_as_declaration (dw_die_ref);
3448 static dw_die_ref clone_die (dw_die_ref);
3449 static dw_die_ref clone_tree (dw_die_ref);
3450 static dw_die_ref copy_declaration_context (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
3451 static void generate_skeleton_ancestor_tree (skeleton_chain_node *);
3452 static void generate_skeleton_bottom_up (skeleton_chain_node *);
3453 static dw_die_ref generate_skeleton (dw_die_ref);
3454 static dw_die_ref remove_child_or_replace_with_skeleton (dw_die_ref,
3455 dw_die_ref,
3456 dw_die_ref);
3457 static void break_out_comdat_types (dw_die_ref);
3458 static void copy_decls_for_unworthy_types (dw_die_ref);
3460 static void add_sibling_attributes (dw_die_ref);
3461 static void output_location_lists (dw_die_ref);
3462 static int constant_size (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
3463 static unsigned long size_of_die (dw_die_ref);
3464 static void calc_die_sizes (dw_die_ref);
3465 static void calc_base_type_die_sizes (void);
3466 static void mark_dies (dw_die_ref);
3467 static void unmark_dies (dw_die_ref);
3468 static void unmark_all_dies (dw_die_ref);
3469 static unsigned long size_of_pubnames (vec<pubname_entry, va_gc> *);
3470 static unsigned long size_of_aranges (void);
3471 static enum dwarf_form value_format (dw_attr_node *);
3472 static void output_value_format (dw_attr_node *);
3473 static void output_abbrev_section (void);
3474 static void output_die_abbrevs (unsigned long, dw_die_ref);
3475 static void output_die (dw_die_ref);
3476 static void output_compilation_unit_header (enum dwarf_unit_type);
3477 static void output_comp_unit (dw_die_ref, int, const unsigned char *);
3478 static void output_comdat_type_unit (comdat_type_node *);
3479 static const char *dwarf2_name (tree, int);
3480 static void add_pubname (tree, dw_die_ref);
3481 static void add_enumerator_pubname (const char *, dw_die_ref);
3482 static void add_pubname_string (const char *, dw_die_ref);
3483 static void add_pubtype (tree, dw_die_ref);
3484 static void output_pubnames (vec<pubname_entry, va_gc> *);
3485 static void output_aranges (void);
3486 static unsigned int add_ranges (const_tree, bool = false);
3487 static void add_ranges_by_labels (dw_die_ref, const char *, const char *,
3488 bool *, bool);
3489 static void output_ranges (void);
3490 static dw_line_info_table *new_line_info_table (void);
3491 static void output_line_info (bool);
3492 static void output_file_names (void);
3493 static dw_die_ref base_type_die (tree, bool);
3494 static int is_base_type (tree);
3495 static dw_die_ref subrange_type_die (tree, tree, tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
3496 static int decl_quals (const_tree);
3497 static dw_die_ref modified_type_die (tree, int, bool, dw_die_ref);
3498 static dw_die_ref generic_parameter_die (tree, tree, bool, dw_die_ref);
3499 static dw_die_ref template_parameter_pack_die (tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
3500 static int type_is_enum (const_tree);
3501 static unsigned int dbx_reg_number (const_rtx);
3502 static void add_loc_descr_op_piece (dw_loc_descr_ref *, int);
3503 static dw_loc_descr_ref reg_loc_descriptor (rtx, enum var_init_status);
3504 static dw_loc_descr_ref one_reg_loc_descriptor (unsigned int,
3505 enum var_init_status);
3506 static dw_loc_descr_ref multiple_reg_loc_descriptor (rtx, rtx,
3507 enum var_init_status);
3508 static dw_loc_descr_ref based_loc_descr (rtx, HOST_WIDE_INT,
3509 enum var_init_status);
3510 static int is_based_loc (const_rtx);
3511 static bool resolve_one_addr (rtx *);
3512 static dw_loc_descr_ref concat_loc_descriptor (rtx, rtx,
3513 enum var_init_status);
3514 static dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descriptor (rtx, machine_mode mode,
3515 enum var_init_status);
3516 struct loc_descr_context;
3517 static void add_loc_descr_to_each (dw_loc_list_ref list, dw_loc_descr_ref ref);
3518 static void add_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref *ret, dw_loc_list_ref list);
3519 static dw_loc_list_ref loc_list_from_tree (tree, int,
3520 struct loc_descr_context *);
3521 static dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descriptor_from_tree (tree, int,
3522 struct loc_descr_context *);
3523 static HOST_WIDE_INT ceiling (HOST_WIDE_INT, unsigned int);
3524 static tree field_type (const_tree);
3525 static unsigned int simple_type_align_in_bits (const_tree);
3526 static unsigned int simple_decl_align_in_bits (const_tree);
3527 static unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT simple_type_size_in_bits (const_tree);
3528 struct vlr_context;
3529 static dw_loc_descr_ref field_byte_offset (const_tree, struct vlr_context *,
3530 HOST_WIDE_INT *);
3531 static void add_AT_location_description (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
3532 dw_loc_list_ref);
3533 static void add_data_member_location_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree,
3534 struct vlr_context *);
3535 static bool add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref, rtx);
3536 static void insert_int (HOST_WIDE_INT, unsigned, unsigned char *);
3537 static void insert_wide_int (const wide_int &, unsigned char *, int);
3538 static void insert_float (const_rtx, unsigned char *);
3539 static rtx rtl_for_decl_location (tree);
3540 static bool add_location_or_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree, bool);
3541 static bool tree_add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
3542 static bool tree_add_const_value_attribute_for_decl (dw_die_ref, tree);
3543 static void add_name_attribute (dw_die_ref, const char *);
3544 static void add_gnat_descriptive_type_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree, dw_die_ref);
3545 static void add_comp_dir_attribute (dw_die_ref);
3546 static void add_scalar_info (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, tree, int,
3547 struct loc_descr_context *);
3548 static void add_bound_info (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, tree,
3549 struct loc_descr_context *);
3550 static void add_subscript_info (dw_die_ref, tree, bool);
3551 static void add_byte_size_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
3552 static void add_alignment_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
3553 static inline void add_bit_offset_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree,
3554 struct vlr_context *);
3555 static void add_bit_size_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
3556 static void add_prototyped_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
3557 static dw_die_ref add_abstract_origin_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
3558 static void add_pure_or_virtual_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
3559 static void add_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref, tree);
3560 static void add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref, tree, bool = false);
3561 static void add_discr_value (dw_die_ref, dw_discr_value *);
3562 static void add_discr_list (dw_die_ref, dw_discr_list_ref);
3563 static inline dw_discr_list_ref AT_discr_list (dw_attr_node *);
3564 static void push_decl_scope (tree);
3565 static void pop_decl_scope (void);
3566 static dw_die_ref scope_die_for (tree, dw_die_ref);
3567 static inline int local_scope_p (dw_die_ref);
3568 static inline int class_scope_p (dw_die_ref);
3569 static inline int class_or_namespace_scope_p (dw_die_ref);
3570 static void add_type_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree, int, bool, dw_die_ref);
3571 static void add_calling_convention_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
3572 static const char *type_tag (const_tree);
3573 static tree member_declared_type (const_tree);
3574 #if 0
3575 static const char *decl_start_label (tree);
3576 #endif
3577 static void gen_array_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3578 static void gen_descr_array_type_die (tree, struct array_descr_info *, dw_die_ref);
3579 #if 0
3580 static void gen_entry_point_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3581 #endif
3582 static dw_die_ref gen_enumeration_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3583 static dw_die_ref gen_formal_parameter_die (tree, tree, bool, dw_die_ref);
3584 static dw_die_ref gen_formal_parameter_pack_die (tree, tree, dw_die_ref, tree*);
3585 static void gen_unspecified_parameters_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3586 static void gen_formal_types_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3587 static void gen_subprogram_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3588 static void gen_variable_die (tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
3589 static void gen_const_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3590 static void gen_label_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3591 static void gen_lexical_block_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3592 static void gen_inlined_subroutine_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3593 static void gen_field_die (tree, struct vlr_context *, dw_die_ref);
3594 static void gen_ptr_to_mbr_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3595 static dw_die_ref gen_compile_unit_die (const char *);
3596 static void gen_inheritance_die (tree, tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
3597 static void gen_member_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3598 static void gen_struct_or_union_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref,
3599 enum debug_info_usage);
3600 static void gen_subroutine_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3601 static void gen_typedef_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3602 static void gen_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3603 static void gen_block_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3604 static void decls_for_scope (tree, dw_die_ref);
3605 static bool is_naming_typedef_decl (const_tree);
3606 static inline dw_die_ref get_context_die (tree);
3607 static void gen_namespace_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3608 static dw_die_ref gen_namelist_decl (tree, dw_die_ref, tree);
3609 static dw_die_ref gen_decl_die (tree, tree, struct vlr_context *, dw_die_ref);
3610 static dw_die_ref force_decl_die (tree);
3611 static dw_die_ref force_type_die (tree);
3612 static dw_die_ref setup_namespace_context (tree, dw_die_ref);
3613 static dw_die_ref declare_in_namespace (tree, dw_die_ref);
3614 static struct dwarf_file_data * lookup_filename (const char *);
3615 static void retry_incomplete_types (void);
3616 static void gen_type_die_for_member (tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
3617 static void gen_generic_params_dies (tree);
3618 static void gen_tagged_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref, enum debug_info_usage);
3619 static void gen_type_die_with_usage (tree, dw_die_ref, enum debug_info_usage);
3620 static void splice_child_die (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
3621 static int file_info_cmp (const void *, const void *);
3622 static dw_loc_list_ref new_loc_list (dw_loc_descr_ref, const char *,
3623 const char *, const char *);
3624 static void output_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref);
3625 static char *gen_internal_sym (const char *);
3626 static bool want_pubnames (void);
3628 static void prune_unmark_dies (dw_die_ref);
3629 static void prune_unused_types_mark_generic_parms_dies (dw_die_ref);
3630 static void prune_unused_types_mark (dw_die_ref, int);
3631 static void prune_unused_types_walk (dw_die_ref);
3632 static void prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (dw_die_ref);
3633 static void prune_unused_types_prune (dw_die_ref);
3634 static void prune_unused_types (void);
3635 static int maybe_emit_file (struct dwarf_file_data *fd);
3636 static inline const char *AT_vms_delta1 (dw_attr_node *);
3637 static inline const char *AT_vms_delta2 (dw_attr_node *);
3638 static inline void add_AT_vms_delta (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
3639 const char *, const char *);
3640 static void append_entry_to_tmpl_value_parm_die_table (dw_die_ref, tree);
3641 static void gen_remaining_tmpl_value_param_die_attribute (void);
3642 static bool generic_type_p (tree);
3643 static void schedule_generic_params_dies_gen (tree t);
3644 static void gen_scheduled_generic_parms_dies (void);
3645 static void resolve_variable_values (void);
3647 static const char *comp_dir_string (void);
3649 static void hash_loc_operands (dw_loc_descr_ref, inchash::hash &);
3651 /* enum for tracking thread-local variables whose address is really an offset
3652 relative to the TLS pointer, which will need link-time relocation, but will
3653 not need relocation by the DWARF consumer. */
3655 enum dtprel_bool
3657 dtprel_false = 0,
3658 dtprel_true = 1
3661 /* Return the operator to use for an address of a variable. For dtprel_true, we
3662 use DW_OP_const*. For regular variables, which need both link-time
3663 relocation and consumer-level relocation (e.g., to account for shared objects
3664 loaded at a random address), we use DW_OP_addr*. */
3666 static inline enum dwarf_location_atom
3667 dw_addr_op (enum dtprel_bool dtprel)
3669 if (dtprel == dtprel_true)
3670 return (dwarf_split_debug_info ? DW_OP_GNU_const_index
3671 : (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE == 4 ? DW_OP_const4u : DW_OP_const8u));
3672 else
3673 return dwarf_split_debug_info ? DW_OP_GNU_addr_index : DW_OP_addr;
3676 /* Return a pointer to a newly allocated address location description. If
3677 dwarf_split_debug_info is true, then record the address with the appropriate
3678 relocation. */
3679 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref
3680 new_addr_loc_descr (rtx addr, enum dtprel_bool dtprel)
3682 dw_loc_descr_ref ref = new_loc_descr (dw_addr_op (dtprel), 0, 0);
3684 ref->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
3685 ref->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr = addr;
3686 ref->dtprel = dtprel;
3687 if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
3688 ref->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry
3689 = add_addr_table_entry (addr,
3690 dtprel ? ate_kind_rtx_dtprel : ate_kind_rtx);
3691 else
3692 ref->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry = NULL;
3694 return ref;
3697 /* Section names used to hold DWARF debugging information. */
3699 #ifndef DEBUG_INFO_SECTION
3700 #define DEBUG_INFO_SECTION ".debug_info"
3701 #endif
3702 #ifndef DEBUG_DWO_INFO_SECTION
3703 #define DEBUG_DWO_INFO_SECTION ".debug_info.dwo"
3704 #endif
3705 #ifndef DEBUG_LTO_INFO_SECTION
3706 #define DEBUG_LTO_INFO_SECTION ".gnu.debuglto_.debug_info"
3707 #endif
3708 #ifndef DEBUG_LTO_DWO_INFO_SECTION
3709 #define DEBUG_LTO_DWO_INFO_SECTION ".gnu.debuglto_.debug_info.dwo"
3710 #endif
3711 #ifndef DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION
3712 #define DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION ".debug_abbrev"
3713 #endif
3714 #ifndef DEBUG_LTO_ABBREV_SECTION
3715 #define DEBUG_LTO_ABBREV_SECTION ".gnu.debuglto_.debug_abbrev"
3716 #endif
3717 #ifndef DEBUG_DWO_ABBREV_SECTION
3718 #define DEBUG_DWO_ABBREV_SECTION ".debug_abbrev.dwo"
3719 #endif
3720 #ifndef DEBUG_LTO_DWO_ABBREV_SECTION
3721 #define DEBUG_LTO_DWO_ABBREV_SECTION ".gnu.debuglto_.debug_abbrev.dwo"
3722 #endif
3723 #ifndef DEBUG_ARANGES_SECTION
3724 #define DEBUG_ARANGES_SECTION ".debug_aranges"
3725 #endif
3726 #ifndef DEBUG_ADDR_SECTION
3727 #define DEBUG_ADDR_SECTION ".debug_addr"
3728 #endif
3729 #ifndef DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION
3730 #define DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION ".debug_macinfo"
3731 #endif
3732 #ifndef DEBUG_LTO_MACINFO_SECTION
3733 #define DEBUG_LTO_MACINFO_SECTION ".gnu.debuglto_.debug_macinfo"
3734 #endif
3735 #ifndef DEBUG_DWO_MACINFO_SECTION
3736 #define DEBUG_DWO_MACINFO_SECTION ".debug_macinfo.dwo"
3737 #endif
3738 #ifndef DEBUG_LTO_DWO_MACINFO_SECTION
3739 #define DEBUG_LTO_DWO_MACINFO_SECTION ".gnu.debuglto_.debug_macinfo.dwo"
3740 #endif
3741 #ifndef DEBUG_MACRO_SECTION
3742 #define DEBUG_MACRO_SECTION ".debug_macro"
3743 #endif
3744 #ifndef DEBUG_LTO_MACRO_SECTION
3745 #define DEBUG_LTO_MACRO_SECTION ".gnu.debuglto_.debug_macro"
3746 #endif
3747 #ifndef DEBUG_DWO_MACRO_SECTION
3748 #define DEBUG_DWO_MACRO_SECTION ".debug_macro.dwo"
3749 #endif
3750 #ifndef DEBUG_LTO_DWO_MACRO_SECTION
3751 #define DEBUG_LTO_DWO_MACRO_SECTION ".gnu.debuglto_.debug_macro.dwo"
3752 #endif
3753 #ifndef DEBUG_LINE_SECTION
3754 #define DEBUG_LINE_SECTION ".debug_line"
3755 #endif
3756 #ifndef DEBUG_LTO_LINE_SECTION
3757 #define DEBUG_LTO_LINE_SECTION ".gnu.debuglto_.debug_line"
3758 #endif
3759 #ifndef DEBUG_DWO_LINE_SECTION
3760 #define DEBUG_DWO_LINE_SECTION ".debug_line.dwo"
3761 #endif
3762 #ifndef DEBUG_LTO_DWO_LINE_SECTION
3763 #define DEBUG_LTO_DWO_LINE_SECTION ".gnu.debuglto_.debug_line.dwo"
3764 #endif
3765 #ifndef DEBUG_LOC_SECTION
3766 #define DEBUG_LOC_SECTION ".debug_loc"
3767 #endif
3768 #ifndef DEBUG_DWO_LOC_SECTION
3769 #define DEBUG_DWO_LOC_SECTION ".debug_loc.dwo"
3770 #endif
3771 #ifndef DEBUG_LOCLISTS_SECTION
3772 #define DEBUG_LOCLISTS_SECTION ".debug_loclists"
3773 #endif
3774 #ifndef DEBUG_DWO_LOCLISTS_SECTION
3775 #define DEBUG_DWO_LOCLISTS_SECTION ".debug_loclists.dwo"
3776 #endif
3777 #ifndef DEBUG_PUBNAMES_SECTION
3778 #define DEBUG_PUBNAMES_SECTION \
3779 ((debug_generate_pub_sections == 2) \
3780 ? ".debug_gnu_pubnames" : ".debug_pubnames")
3781 #endif
3782 #ifndef DEBUG_PUBTYPES_SECTION
3783 #define DEBUG_PUBTYPES_SECTION \
3784 ((debug_generate_pub_sections == 2) \
3785 ? ".debug_gnu_pubtypes" : ".debug_pubtypes")
3786 #endif
3787 #ifndef DEBUG_STR_OFFSETS_SECTION
3788 #define DEBUG_STR_OFFSETS_SECTION ".debug_str_offsets"
3789 #endif
3790 #ifndef DEBUG_DWO_STR_OFFSETS_SECTION
3791 #define DEBUG_DWO_STR_OFFSETS_SECTION ".debug_str_offsets.dwo"
3792 #endif
3793 #ifndef DEBUG_LTO_DWO_STR_OFFSETS_SECTION
3794 #define DEBUG_LTO_DWO_STR_OFFSETS_SECTION ".gnu.debuglto_.debug_str_offsets.dwo"
3795 #endif
3796 #ifndef DEBUG_STR_SECTION
3797 #define DEBUG_STR_SECTION ".debug_str"
3798 #endif
3799 #ifndef DEBUG_LTO_STR_SECTION
3800 #define DEBUG_LTO_STR_SECTION ".gnu.debuglto_.debug_str"
3801 #endif
3802 #ifndef DEBUG_STR_DWO_SECTION
3803 #define DEBUG_STR_DWO_SECTION ".debug_str.dwo"
3804 #endif
3805 #ifndef DEBUG_LTO_STR_DWO_SECTION
3806 #define DEBUG_LTO_STR_DWO_SECTION ".gnu.debuglto_.debug_str.dwo"
3807 #endif
3808 #ifndef DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION
3809 #define DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION ".debug_ranges"
3810 #endif
3811 #ifndef DEBUG_RNGLISTS_SECTION
3812 #define DEBUG_RNGLISTS_SECTION ".debug_rnglists"
3813 #endif
3814 #ifndef DEBUG_LINE_STR_SECTION
3815 #define DEBUG_LINE_STR_SECTION ".debug_line_str"
3816 #endif
3817 #ifndef DEBUG_LTO_LINE_STR_SECTION
3818 #define DEBUG_LTO_LINE_STR_SECTION ".gnu.debuglto_.debug_line_str"
3819 #endif
3821 /* Standard ELF section names for compiled code and data. */
3822 #ifndef TEXT_SECTION_NAME
3823 #define TEXT_SECTION_NAME ".text"
3824 #endif
3826 /* Section flags for .debug_str section. */
3827 #define DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS \
3828 (HAVE_GAS_SHF_MERGE && flag_merge_debug_strings \
3829 ? SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_MERGE | SECTION_STRINGS | 1 \
3830 : SECTION_DEBUG)
3832 /* Section flags for .debug_str.dwo section. */
3833 #define DEBUG_STR_DWO_SECTION_FLAGS (SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE)
3835 /* Attribute used to refer to the macro section. */
3836 #define DEBUG_MACRO_ATTRIBUTE (dwarf_version >= 5 ? DW_AT_macros \
3837 : dwarf_strict ? DW_AT_macro_info : DW_AT_GNU_macros)
3839 /* Labels we insert at beginning sections we can reference instead of
3840 the section names themselves. */
3842 #ifndef TEXT_SECTION_LABEL
3843 #define TEXT_SECTION_LABEL "Ltext"
3844 #endif
3845 #ifndef COLD_TEXT_SECTION_LABEL
3846 #define COLD_TEXT_SECTION_LABEL "Ltext_cold"
3847 #endif
3848 #ifndef DEBUG_LINE_SECTION_LABEL
3849 #define DEBUG_LINE_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_line"
3850 #endif
3851 #ifndef DEBUG_SKELETON_LINE_SECTION_LABEL
3852 #define DEBUG_SKELETON_LINE_SECTION_LABEL "Lskeleton_debug_line"
3853 #endif
3854 #ifndef DEBUG_INFO_SECTION_LABEL
3855 #define DEBUG_INFO_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_info"
3856 #endif
3857 #ifndef DEBUG_SKELETON_INFO_SECTION_LABEL
3858 #define DEBUG_SKELETON_INFO_SECTION_LABEL "Lskeleton_debug_info"
3859 #endif
3860 #ifndef DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL
3861 #define DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_abbrev"
3862 #endif
3863 #ifndef DEBUG_SKELETON_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL
3864 #define DEBUG_SKELETON_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL "Lskeleton_debug_abbrev"
3865 #endif
3866 #ifndef DEBUG_ADDR_SECTION_LABEL
3867 #define DEBUG_ADDR_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_addr"
3868 #endif
3869 #ifndef DEBUG_LOC_SECTION_LABEL
3870 #define DEBUG_LOC_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_loc"
3871 #endif
3872 #ifndef DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL
3873 #define DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_ranges"
3874 #endif
3875 #ifndef DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION_LABEL
3876 #define DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_macinfo"
3877 #endif
3878 #ifndef DEBUG_MACRO_SECTION_LABEL
3879 #define DEBUG_MACRO_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_macro"
3880 #endif
3881 #define SKELETON_COMP_DIE_ABBREV 1
3882 #define SKELETON_TYPE_DIE_ABBREV 2
3884 /* Definitions of defaults for formats and names of various special
3885 (artificial) labels which may be generated within this file (when the -g
3886 options is used and DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO is in effect.
3887 If necessary, these may be overridden from within the tm.h file, but
3888 typically, overriding these defaults is unnecessary. */
3890 static char text_end_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3891 static char text_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3892 static char cold_text_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3893 static char cold_end_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3894 static char abbrev_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3895 static char debug_info_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3896 static char debug_skeleton_info_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3897 static char debug_skeleton_abbrev_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3898 static char debug_line_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3899 static char debug_addr_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3900 static char debug_skeleton_line_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3901 static char macinfo_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3902 static char loc_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3903 static char ranges_section_label[2 * MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3904 static char ranges_base_label[2 * MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3906 #ifndef TEXT_END_LABEL
3907 #define TEXT_END_LABEL "Letext"
3908 #endif
3909 #ifndef COLD_END_LABEL
3910 #define COLD_END_LABEL "Letext_cold"
3911 #endif
3912 #ifndef BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL
3913 #define BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL "LBB"
3914 #endif
3915 #ifndef BLOCK_END_LABEL
3916 #define BLOCK_END_LABEL "LBE"
3917 #endif
3918 #ifndef LINE_CODE_LABEL
3919 #define LINE_CODE_LABEL "LM"
3920 #endif
3923 /* Return the root of the DIE's built for the current compilation unit. */
3924 static dw_die_ref
3925 comp_unit_die (void)
3927 if (!single_comp_unit_die)
3928 single_comp_unit_die = gen_compile_unit_die (NULL);
3929 return single_comp_unit_die;
3932 /* We allow a language front-end to designate a function that is to be
3933 called to "demangle" any name before it is put into a DIE. */
3935 static const char *(*demangle_name_func) (const char *);
3937 void
3938 dwarf2out_set_demangle_name_func (const char *(*func) (const char *))
3940 demangle_name_func = func;
3943 /* Test if rtl node points to a pseudo register. */
3945 static inline int
3946 is_pseudo_reg (const_rtx rtl)
3948 return ((REG_P (rtl) && REGNO (rtl) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
3949 || (GET_CODE (rtl) == SUBREG
3950 && REGNO (SUBREG_REG (rtl)) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER));
3953 /* Return a reference to a type, with its const and volatile qualifiers
3954 removed. */
3956 static inline tree
3957 type_main_variant (tree type)
3959 type = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type);
3961 /* ??? There really should be only one main variant among any group of
3962 variants of a given type (and all of the MAIN_VARIANT values for all
3963 members of the group should point to that one type) but sometimes the C
3964 front-end messes this up for array types, so we work around that bug
3965 here. */
3966 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
3967 while (type != TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type))
3968 type = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type);
3970 return type;
3973 /* Return nonzero if the given type node represents a tagged type. */
3975 static inline int
3976 is_tagged_type (const_tree type)
3978 enum tree_code code = TREE_CODE (type);
3980 return (code == RECORD_TYPE || code == UNION_TYPE
3981 || code == QUAL_UNION_TYPE || code == ENUMERAL_TYPE);
3984 /* Set label to debug_info_section_label + die_offset of a DIE reference. */
3986 static void
3987 get_ref_die_offset_label (char *label, dw_die_ref ref)
3989 sprintf (label, "%s+%ld", debug_info_section_label, ref->die_offset);
3992 /* Return die_offset of a DIE reference to a base type. */
3994 static unsigned long int
3995 get_base_type_offset (dw_die_ref ref)
3997 if (ref->die_offset)
3998 return ref->die_offset;
3999 if (comp_unit_die ()->die_abbrev)
4001 calc_base_type_die_sizes ();
4002 gcc_assert (ref->die_offset);
4004 return ref->die_offset;
4007 /* Return die_offset of a DIE reference other than base type. */
4009 static unsigned long int
4010 get_ref_die_offset (dw_die_ref ref)
4012 gcc_assert (ref->die_offset);
4013 return ref->die_offset;
4016 /* Convert a DIE tag into its string name. */
4018 static const char *
4019 dwarf_tag_name (unsigned int tag)
4021 const char *name = get_DW_TAG_name (tag);
4023 if (name != NULL)
4024 return name;
4026 return "DW_TAG_<unknown>";
4029 /* Convert a DWARF attribute code into its string name. */
4031 static const char *
4032 dwarf_attr_name (unsigned int attr)
4034 const char *name;
4036 switch (attr)
4038 #if VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
4039 case DW_AT_HP_prologue:
4040 return "DW_AT_HP_prologue";
4041 #else
4042 case DW_AT_MIPS_loop_unroll_factor:
4043 return "DW_AT_MIPS_loop_unroll_factor";
4044 #endif
4046 #if VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
4047 case DW_AT_HP_epilogue:
4048 return "DW_AT_HP_epilogue";
4049 #else
4050 case DW_AT_MIPS_stride:
4051 return "DW_AT_MIPS_stride";
4052 #endif
4055 name = get_DW_AT_name (attr);
4057 if (name != NULL)
4058 return name;
4060 return "DW_AT_<unknown>";
4063 /* Convert a DWARF value form code into its string name. */
4065 static const char *
4066 dwarf_form_name (unsigned int form)
4068 const char *name = get_DW_FORM_name (form);
4070 if (name != NULL)
4071 return name;
4073 return "DW_FORM_<unknown>";
4076 /* Determine the "ultimate origin" of a decl. The decl may be an inlined
4077 instance of an inlined instance of a decl which is local to an inline
4078 function, so we have to trace all of the way back through the origin chain
4079 to find out what sort of node actually served as the original seed for the
4080 given block. */
4082 static tree
4083 decl_ultimate_origin (const_tree decl)
4085 if (!CODE_CONTAINS_STRUCT (TREE_CODE (decl), TS_DECL_COMMON))
4086 return NULL_TREE;
4088 /* DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN can point to itself; ignore that if
4089 we're trying to output the abstract instance of this function. */
4090 if (DECL_ABSTRACT_P (decl) && DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) == decl)
4091 return NULL_TREE;
4093 /* Since the DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for a DECL is supposed to be the
4094 most distant ancestor, this should never happen. */
4095 gcc_assert (!DECL_FROM_INLINE (DECL_ORIGIN (decl)));
4097 return DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl);
4100 /* Get the class to which DECL belongs, if any. In g++, the DECL_CONTEXT
4101 of a virtual function may refer to a base class, so we check the 'this'
4102 parameter. */
4104 static tree
4105 decl_class_context (tree decl)
4107 tree context = NULL_TREE;
4109 if (TREE_CODE (decl) != FUNCTION_DECL || ! DECL_VINDEX (decl))
4110 context = DECL_CONTEXT (decl);
4111 else
4112 context = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT
4113 (TREE_TYPE (TREE_VALUE (TYPE_ARG_TYPES (TREE_TYPE (decl)))));
4115 if (context && !TYPE_P (context))
4116 context = NULL_TREE;
4118 return context;
4121 /* Add an attribute/value pair to a DIE. */
4123 static inline void
4124 add_dwarf_attr (dw_die_ref die, dw_attr_node *attr)
4126 /* Maybe this should be an assert? */
4127 if (die == NULL)
4128 return;
4130 if (flag_checking)
4132 /* Check we do not add duplicate attrs. Can't use get_AT here
4133 because that recurses to the specification/abstract origin DIE. */
4134 dw_attr_node *a;
4135 unsigned ix;
4136 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
4137 gcc_assert (a->dw_attr != attr->dw_attr);
4140 vec_safe_reserve (die->die_attr, 1);
4141 vec_safe_push (die->die_attr, *attr);
4144 static inline enum dw_val_class
4145 AT_class (dw_attr_node *a)
4147 return a->dw_attr_val.val_class;
4150 /* Return the index for any attribute that will be referenced with a
4151 DW_FORM_GNU_addr_index or DW_FORM_GNU_str_index. String indices
4152 are stored in dw_attr_val.v.val_str for reference counting
4153 pruning. */
4155 static inline unsigned int
4156 AT_index (dw_attr_node *a)
4158 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str)
4159 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->index;
4160 else if (a->dw_attr_val.val_entry != NULL)
4161 return a->dw_attr_val.val_entry->index;
4162 return NOT_INDEXED;
4165 /* Add a flag value attribute to a DIE. */
4167 static inline void
4168 add_AT_flag (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, unsigned int flag)
4170 dw_attr_node attr;
4172 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4173 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_flag;
4174 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4175 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_flag = flag;
4176 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4179 static inline unsigned
4180 AT_flag (dw_attr_node *a)
4182 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_flag);
4183 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag;
4186 /* Add a signed integer attribute value to a DIE. */
4188 static inline void
4189 add_AT_int (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, HOST_WIDE_INT int_val)
4191 dw_attr_node attr;
4193 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4194 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_const;
4195 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4196 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_int = int_val;
4197 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4200 static inline HOST_WIDE_INT
4201 AT_int (dw_attr_node *a)
4203 gcc_assert (a && (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_const
4204 || AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_const_implicit));
4205 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_int;
4208 /* Add an unsigned integer attribute value to a DIE. */
4210 static inline void
4211 add_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4212 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT unsigned_val)
4214 dw_attr_node attr;
4216 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4217 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_unsigned_const;
4218 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4219 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned = unsigned_val;
4220 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4223 static inline unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
4224 AT_unsigned (dw_attr_node *a)
4226 gcc_assert (a && (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_unsigned_const
4227 || AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_unsigned_const_implicit));
4228 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned;
4231 /* Add an unsigned wide integer attribute value to a DIE. */
4233 static inline void
4234 add_AT_wide (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4235 const wide_int& w)
4237 dw_attr_node attr;
4239 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4240 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_wide_int;
4241 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4242 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_wide = ggc_alloc<wide_int> ();
4243 *attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_wide = w;
4244 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4247 /* Add an unsigned double integer attribute value to a DIE. */
4249 static inline void
4250 add_AT_double (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4251 HOST_WIDE_INT high, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT low)
4253 dw_attr_node attr;
4255 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4256 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_const_double;
4257 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4258 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_double.high = high;
4259 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_double.low = low;
4260 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4263 /* Add a floating point attribute value to a DIE and return it. */
4265 static inline void
4266 add_AT_vec (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4267 unsigned int length, unsigned int elt_size, unsigned char *array)
4269 dw_attr_node attr;
4271 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4272 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_vec;
4273 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4274 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length = length;
4275 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size = elt_size;
4276 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.array = array;
4277 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4280 /* Add an 8-byte data attribute value to a DIE. */
4282 static inline void
4283 add_AT_data8 (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4284 unsigned char data8[8])
4286 dw_attr_node attr;
4288 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4289 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_data8;
4290 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4291 memcpy (attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_data8, data8, 8);
4292 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4295 /* Add DW_AT_low_pc and DW_AT_high_pc to a DIE. When using
4296 dwarf_split_debug_info, address attributes in dies destined for the
4297 final executable have force_direct set to avoid using indexed
4298 references. */
4300 static inline void
4301 add_AT_low_high_pc (dw_die_ref die, const char *lbl_low, const char *lbl_high,
4302 bool force_direct)
4304 dw_attr_node attr;
4305 char * lbl_id;
4307 lbl_id = xstrdup (lbl_low);
4308 attr.dw_attr = DW_AT_low_pc;
4309 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_lbl_id;
4310 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = lbl_id;
4311 if (dwarf_split_debug_info && !force_direct)
4312 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry
4313 = add_addr_table_entry (lbl_id, ate_kind_label);
4314 else
4315 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4316 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4318 attr.dw_attr = DW_AT_high_pc;
4319 if (dwarf_version < 4)
4320 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_lbl_id;
4321 else
4322 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_high_pc;
4323 lbl_id = xstrdup (lbl_high);
4324 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = lbl_id;
4325 if (attr.dw_attr_val.val_class == dw_val_class_lbl_id
4326 && dwarf_split_debug_info && !force_direct)
4327 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry
4328 = add_addr_table_entry (lbl_id, ate_kind_label);
4329 else
4330 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4331 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4334 /* Hash and equality functions for debug_str_hash. */
4336 hashval_t
4337 indirect_string_hasher::hash (indirect_string_node *x)
4339 return htab_hash_string (x->str);
4342 bool
4343 indirect_string_hasher::equal (indirect_string_node *x1, const char *x2)
4345 return strcmp (x1->str, x2) == 0;
4348 /* Add STR to the given string hash table. */
4350 static struct indirect_string_node *
4351 find_AT_string_in_table (const char *str,
4352 hash_table<indirect_string_hasher> *table)
4354 struct indirect_string_node *node;
4356 indirect_string_node **slot
4357 = table->find_slot_with_hash (str, htab_hash_string (str), INSERT);
4358 if (*slot == NULL)
4360 node = ggc_cleared_alloc<indirect_string_node> ();
4361 node->str = ggc_strdup (str);
4362 *slot = node;
4364 else
4365 node = *slot;
4367 node->refcount++;
4368 return node;
4371 /* Add STR to the indirect string hash table. */
4373 static struct indirect_string_node *
4374 find_AT_string (const char *str)
4376 if (! debug_str_hash)
4377 debug_str_hash = hash_table<indirect_string_hasher>::create_ggc (10);
4379 return find_AT_string_in_table (str, debug_str_hash);
4382 /* Add a string attribute value to a DIE. */
4384 static inline void
4385 add_AT_string (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, const char *str)
4387 dw_attr_node attr;
4388 struct indirect_string_node *node;
4390 node = find_AT_string (str);
4392 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4393 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_str;
4394 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4395 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_str = node;
4396 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4399 static inline const char *
4400 AT_string (dw_attr_node *a)
4402 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str);
4403 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->str;
4406 /* Call this function directly to bypass AT_string_form's logic to put
4407 the string inline in the die. */
4409 static void
4410 set_indirect_string (struct indirect_string_node *node)
4412 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4413 /* Already indirect is a no op. */
4414 if (node->form == DW_FORM_strp
4415 || node->form == DW_FORM_line_strp
4416 || node->form == DW_FORM_GNU_str_index)
4418 gcc_assert (node->label);
4419 return;
4421 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "LASF", dw2_string_counter);
4422 ++dw2_string_counter;
4423 node->label = xstrdup (label);
4425 if (!dwarf_split_debug_info)
4427 node->form = DW_FORM_strp;
4428 node->index = NOT_INDEXED;
4430 else
4432 node->form = DW_FORM_GNU_str_index;
4433 node->index = NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED;
4437 /* A helper function for dwarf2out_finish, called to reset indirect
4438 string decisions done for early LTO dwarf output before fat object
4439 dwarf output. */
4442 reset_indirect_string (indirect_string_node **h, void *)
4444 struct indirect_string_node *node = *h;
4445 if (node->form == DW_FORM_strp || node->form == DW_FORM_GNU_str_index)
4447 free (node->label);
4448 node->label = NULL;
4449 node->form = (dwarf_form) 0;
4450 node->index = 0;
4452 return 1;
4455 /* Find out whether a string should be output inline in DIE
4456 or out-of-line in .debug_str section. */
4458 static enum dwarf_form
4459 find_string_form (struct indirect_string_node *node)
4461 unsigned int len;
4463 if (node->form)
4464 return node->form;
4466 len = strlen (node->str) + 1;
4468 /* If the string is shorter or equal to the size of the reference, it is
4469 always better to put it inline. */
4470 if (len <= DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE || node->refcount == 0)
4471 return node->form = DW_FORM_string;
4473 /* If we cannot expect the linker to merge strings in .debug_str
4474 section, only put it into .debug_str if it is worth even in this
4475 single module. */
4476 if (DWARF2_INDIRECT_STRING_SUPPORT_MISSING_ON_TARGET
4477 || ((debug_str_section->common.flags & SECTION_MERGE) == 0
4478 && (len - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE) * node->refcount <= len))
4479 return node->form = DW_FORM_string;
4481 set_indirect_string (node);
4483 return node->form;
4486 /* Find out whether the string referenced from the attribute should be
4487 output inline in DIE or out-of-line in .debug_str section. */
4489 static enum dwarf_form
4490 AT_string_form (dw_attr_node *a)
4492 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str);
4493 return find_string_form (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str);
4496 /* Add a DIE reference attribute value to a DIE. */
4498 static inline void
4499 add_AT_die_ref (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, dw_die_ref targ_die)
4501 dw_attr_node attr;
4502 gcc_checking_assert (targ_die != NULL);
4504 /* With LTO we can end up trying to reference something we didn't create
4505 a DIE for. Avoid crashing later on a NULL referenced DIE. */
4506 if (targ_die == NULL)
4507 return;
4509 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4510 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
4511 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4512 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die = targ_die;
4513 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
4514 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4517 /* Change DIE reference REF to point to NEW_DIE instead. */
4519 static inline void
4520 change_AT_die_ref (dw_attr_node *ref, dw_die_ref new_die)
4522 gcc_assert (ref->dw_attr_val.val_class == dw_val_class_die_ref);
4523 ref->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die = new_die;
4524 ref->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
4527 /* Add an AT_specification attribute to a DIE, and also make the back
4528 pointer from the specification to the definition. */
4530 static inline void
4531 add_AT_specification (dw_die_ref die, dw_die_ref targ_die)
4533 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_specification, targ_die);
4534 gcc_assert (!targ_die->die_definition);
4535 targ_die->die_definition = die;
4538 static inline dw_die_ref
4539 AT_ref (dw_attr_node *a)
4541 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref);
4542 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die;
4545 static inline int
4546 AT_ref_external (dw_attr_node *a)
4548 if (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref)
4549 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external;
4551 return 0;
4554 static inline void
4555 set_AT_ref_external (dw_attr_node *a, int i)
4557 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref);
4558 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external = i;
4561 /* Add an FDE reference attribute value to a DIE. */
4563 static inline void
4564 add_AT_fde_ref (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, unsigned int targ_fde)
4566 dw_attr_node attr;
4568 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4569 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_fde_ref;
4570 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4571 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_fde_index = targ_fde;
4572 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4575 /* Add a location description attribute value to a DIE. */
4577 static inline void
4578 add_AT_loc (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
4580 dw_attr_node attr;
4582 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4583 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
4584 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4585 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_loc = loc;
4586 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4589 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref
4590 AT_loc (dw_attr_node *a)
4592 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc);
4593 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc;
4596 static inline void
4597 add_AT_loc_list (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, dw_loc_list_ref loc_list)
4599 dw_attr_node attr;
4601 if (XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO && !HAVE_XCOFF_DWARF_EXTRAS)
4602 return;
4604 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4605 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_loc_list;
4606 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4607 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_loc_list = loc_list;
4608 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4609 have_location_lists = true;
4612 static inline dw_loc_list_ref
4613 AT_loc_list (dw_attr_node *a)
4615 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc_list);
4616 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc_list;
4619 static inline dw_loc_list_ref *
4620 AT_loc_list_ptr (dw_attr_node *a)
4622 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc_list);
4623 return &a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc_list;
4626 struct addr_hasher : ggc_ptr_hash<addr_table_entry>
4628 static hashval_t hash (addr_table_entry *);
4629 static bool equal (addr_table_entry *, addr_table_entry *);
4632 /* Table of entries into the .debug_addr section. */
4634 static GTY (()) hash_table<addr_hasher> *addr_index_table;
4636 /* Hash an address_table_entry. */
4638 hashval_t
4639 addr_hasher::hash (addr_table_entry *a)
4641 inchash::hash hstate;
4642 switch (a->kind)
4644 case ate_kind_rtx:
4645 hstate.add_int (0);
4646 break;
4647 case ate_kind_rtx_dtprel:
4648 hstate.add_int (1);
4649 break;
4650 case ate_kind_label:
4651 return htab_hash_string (a->addr.label);
4652 default:
4653 gcc_unreachable ();
4655 inchash::add_rtx (a->addr.rtl, hstate);
4656 return hstate.end ();
4659 /* Determine equality for two address_table_entries. */
4661 bool
4662 addr_hasher::equal (addr_table_entry *a1, addr_table_entry *a2)
4664 if (a1->kind != a2->kind)
4665 return 0;
4666 switch (a1->kind)
4668 case ate_kind_rtx:
4669 case ate_kind_rtx_dtprel:
4670 return rtx_equal_p (a1->addr.rtl, a2->addr.rtl);
4671 case ate_kind_label:
4672 return strcmp (a1->addr.label, a2->addr.label) == 0;
4673 default:
4674 gcc_unreachable ();
4678 /* Initialize an addr_table_entry. */
4680 void
4681 init_addr_table_entry (addr_table_entry *e, enum ate_kind kind, void *addr)
4683 e->kind = kind;
4684 switch (kind)
4686 case ate_kind_rtx:
4687 case ate_kind_rtx_dtprel:
4688 e->addr.rtl = (rtx) addr;
4689 break;
4690 case ate_kind_label:
4691 e->addr.label = (char *) addr;
4692 break;
4694 e->refcount = 0;
4695 e->index = NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED;
4698 /* Add attr to the address table entry to the table. Defer setting an
4699 index until output time. */
4701 static addr_table_entry *
4702 add_addr_table_entry (void *addr, enum ate_kind kind)
4704 addr_table_entry *node;
4705 addr_table_entry finder;
4707 gcc_assert (dwarf_split_debug_info);
4708 if (! addr_index_table)
4709 addr_index_table = hash_table<addr_hasher>::create_ggc (10);
4710 init_addr_table_entry (&finder, kind, addr);
4711 addr_table_entry **slot = addr_index_table->find_slot (&finder, INSERT);
4713 if (*slot == HTAB_EMPTY_ENTRY)
4715 node = ggc_cleared_alloc<addr_table_entry> ();
4716 init_addr_table_entry (node, kind, addr);
4717 *slot = node;
4719 else
4720 node = *slot;
4722 node->refcount++;
4723 return node;
4726 /* Remove an entry from the addr table by decrementing its refcount.
4727 Strictly, decrementing the refcount would be enough, but the
4728 assertion that the entry is actually in the table has found
4729 bugs. */
4731 static void
4732 remove_addr_table_entry (addr_table_entry *entry)
4734 gcc_assert (dwarf_split_debug_info && addr_index_table);
4735 /* After an index is assigned, the table is frozen. */
4736 gcc_assert (entry->refcount > 0 && entry->index == NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED);
4737 entry->refcount--;
4740 /* Given a location list, remove all addresses it refers to from the
4741 address_table. */
4743 static void
4744 remove_loc_list_addr_table_entries (dw_loc_descr_ref descr)
4746 for (; descr; descr = descr->dw_loc_next)
4747 if (descr->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry != NULL)
4749 gcc_assert (descr->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry->index == NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED);
4750 remove_addr_table_entry (descr->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry);
4754 /* A helper function for dwarf2out_finish called through
4755 htab_traverse. Assign an addr_table_entry its index. All entries
4756 must be collected into the table when this function is called,
4757 because the indexing code relies on htab_traverse to traverse nodes
4758 in the same order for each run. */
4761 index_addr_table_entry (addr_table_entry **h, unsigned int *index)
4763 addr_table_entry *node = *h;
4765 /* Don't index unreferenced nodes. */
4766 if (node->refcount == 0)
4767 return 1;
4769 gcc_assert (node->index == NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED);
4770 node->index = *index;
4771 *index += 1;
4773 return 1;
4776 /* Add an address constant attribute value to a DIE. When using
4777 dwarf_split_debug_info, address attributes in dies destined for the
4778 final executable should be direct references--setting the parameter
4779 force_direct ensures this behavior. */
4781 static inline void
4782 add_AT_addr (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, rtx addr,
4783 bool force_direct)
4785 dw_attr_node attr;
4787 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4788 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
4789 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_addr = addr;
4790 if (dwarf_split_debug_info && !force_direct)
4791 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = add_addr_table_entry (addr, ate_kind_rtx);
4792 else
4793 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4794 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4797 /* Get the RTX from to an address DIE attribute. */
4799 static inline rtx
4800 AT_addr (dw_attr_node *a)
4802 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_addr);
4803 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_addr;
4806 /* Add a file attribute value to a DIE. */
4808 static inline void
4809 add_AT_file (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4810 struct dwarf_file_data *fd)
4812 dw_attr_node attr;
4814 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4815 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_file;
4816 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4817 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_file = fd;
4818 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4821 /* Get the dwarf_file_data from a file DIE attribute. */
4823 static inline struct dwarf_file_data *
4824 AT_file (dw_attr_node *a)
4826 gcc_assert (a && (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_file
4827 || AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_file_implicit));
4828 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file;
4831 /* Add a vms delta attribute value to a DIE. */
4833 static inline void
4834 add_AT_vms_delta (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4835 const char *lbl1, const char *lbl2)
4837 dw_attr_node attr;
4839 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4840 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_vms_delta;
4841 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4842 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_vms_delta.lbl1 = xstrdup (lbl1);
4843 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_vms_delta.lbl2 = xstrdup (lbl2);
4844 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4847 /* Add a label identifier attribute value to a DIE. */
4849 static inline void
4850 add_AT_lbl_id (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4851 const char *lbl_id)
4853 dw_attr_node attr;
4855 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4856 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_lbl_id;
4857 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4858 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = xstrdup (lbl_id);
4859 if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
4860 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry
4861 = add_addr_table_entry (attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id,
4862 ate_kind_label);
4863 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4866 /* Add a section offset attribute value to a DIE, an offset into the
4867 debug_line section. */
4869 static inline void
4870 add_AT_lineptr (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4871 const char *label)
4873 dw_attr_node attr;
4875 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4876 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_lineptr;
4877 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4878 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = xstrdup (label);
4879 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4882 /* Add a section offset attribute value to a DIE, an offset into the
4883 debug_loclists section. */
4885 static inline void
4886 add_AT_loclistsptr (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4887 const char *label)
4889 dw_attr_node attr;
4891 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4892 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_loclistsptr;
4893 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4894 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = xstrdup (label);
4895 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4898 /* Add a section offset attribute value to a DIE, an offset into the
4899 debug_macinfo section. */
4901 static inline void
4902 add_AT_macptr (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4903 const char *label)
4905 dw_attr_node attr;
4907 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4908 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_macptr;
4909 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4910 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = xstrdup (label);
4911 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4914 /* Add an offset attribute value to a DIE. */
4916 static inline void
4917 add_AT_offset (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4918 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
4920 dw_attr_node attr;
4922 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4923 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_offset;
4924 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4925 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_offset = offset;
4926 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4929 /* Add a range_list attribute value to a DIE. When using
4930 dwarf_split_debug_info, address attributes in dies destined for the
4931 final executable should be direct references--setting the parameter
4932 force_direct ensures this behavior. */
4934 #define UNRELOCATED_OFFSET ((addr_table_entry *) 1)
4935 #define RELOCATED_OFFSET (NULL)
4937 static void
4938 add_AT_range_list (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4939 long unsigned int offset, bool force_direct)
4941 dw_attr_node attr;
4943 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4944 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_range_list;
4945 /* For the range_list attribute, use val_entry to store whether the
4946 offset should follow split-debug-info or normal semantics. This
4947 value is read in output_range_list_offset. */
4948 if (dwarf_split_debug_info && !force_direct)
4949 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = UNRELOCATED_OFFSET;
4950 else
4951 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = RELOCATED_OFFSET;
4952 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_offset = offset;
4953 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4956 /* Return the start label of a delta attribute. */
4958 static inline const char *
4959 AT_vms_delta1 (dw_attr_node *a)
4961 gcc_assert (a && (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_vms_delta));
4962 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vms_delta.lbl1;
4965 /* Return the end label of a delta attribute. */
4967 static inline const char *
4968 AT_vms_delta2 (dw_attr_node *a)
4970 gcc_assert (a && (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_vms_delta));
4971 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vms_delta.lbl2;
4974 static inline const char *
4975 AT_lbl (dw_attr_node *a)
4977 gcc_assert (a && (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_lbl_id
4978 || AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_lineptr
4979 || AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_macptr
4980 || AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loclistsptr
4981 || AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_high_pc));
4982 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id;
4985 /* Get the attribute of type attr_kind. */
4987 static dw_attr_node *
4988 get_AT (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
4990 dw_attr_node *a;
4991 unsigned ix;
4992 dw_die_ref spec = NULL;
4994 if (! die)
4995 return NULL;
4997 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
4998 if (a->dw_attr == attr_kind)
4999 return a;
5000 else if (a->dw_attr == DW_AT_specification
5001 || a->dw_attr == DW_AT_abstract_origin)
5002 spec = AT_ref (a);
5004 if (spec)
5005 return get_AT (spec, attr_kind);
5007 return NULL;
5010 /* Returns the parent of the declaration of DIE. */
5012 static dw_die_ref
5013 get_die_parent (dw_die_ref die)
5015 dw_die_ref t;
5017 if (!die)
5018 return NULL;
5020 if ((t = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin))
5021 || (t = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_specification)))
5022 die = t;
5024 return die->die_parent;
5027 /* Return the "low pc" attribute value, typically associated with a subprogram
5028 DIE. Return null if the "low pc" attribute is either not present, or if it
5029 cannot be represented as an assembler label identifier. */
5031 static inline const char *
5032 get_AT_low_pc (dw_die_ref die)
5034 dw_attr_node *a = get_AT (die, DW_AT_low_pc);
5036 return a ? AT_lbl (a) : NULL;
5039 /* Return the "high pc" attribute value, typically associated with a subprogram
5040 DIE. Return null if the "high pc" attribute is either not present, or if it
5041 cannot be represented as an assembler label identifier. */
5043 static inline const char *
5044 get_AT_hi_pc (dw_die_ref die)
5046 dw_attr_node *a = get_AT (die, DW_AT_high_pc);
5048 return a ? AT_lbl (a) : NULL;
5051 /* Return the value of the string attribute designated by ATTR_KIND, or
5052 NULL if it is not present. */
5054 static inline const char *
5055 get_AT_string (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5057 dw_attr_node *a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
5059 return a ? AT_string (a) : NULL;
5062 /* Return the value of the flag attribute designated by ATTR_KIND, or -1
5063 if it is not present. */
5065 static inline int
5066 get_AT_flag (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5068 dw_attr_node *a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
5070 return a ? AT_flag (a) : 0;
5073 /* Return the value of the unsigned attribute designated by ATTR_KIND, or 0
5074 if it is not present. */
5076 static inline unsigned
5077 get_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5079 dw_attr_node *a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
5081 return a ? AT_unsigned (a) : 0;
5084 static inline dw_die_ref
5085 get_AT_ref (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5087 dw_attr_node *a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
5089 return a ? AT_ref (a) : NULL;
5092 static inline struct dwarf_file_data *
5093 get_AT_file (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5095 dw_attr_node *a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
5097 return a ? AT_file (a) : NULL;
5100 /* Returns the ultimate TRANSLATION_UNIT_DECL context of DECL or NULL. */
5102 static const_tree
5103 get_ultimate_context (const_tree decl)
5105 while (decl && TREE_CODE (decl) != TRANSLATION_UNIT_DECL)
5107 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == BLOCK)
5108 decl = BLOCK_SUPERCONTEXT (decl);
5109 else
5110 decl = get_containing_scope (decl);
5112 return decl;
5115 /* Return TRUE if the language is C++. */
5117 static inline bool
5118 is_cxx (void)
5120 unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_language);
5122 return (lang == DW_LANG_C_plus_plus || lang == DW_LANG_ObjC_plus_plus
5123 || lang == DW_LANG_C_plus_plus_11 || lang == DW_LANG_C_plus_plus_14);
5126 /* Return TRUE if DECL was created by the C++ frontend. */
5128 static bool
5129 is_cxx (const_tree decl)
5131 if (in_lto_p)
5133 const_tree context = get_ultimate_context (decl);
5134 if (context && TRANSLATION_UNIT_LANGUAGE (context))
5135 return strncmp (TRANSLATION_UNIT_LANGUAGE (context), "GNU C++", 7) == 0;
5137 return is_cxx ();
5140 /* Return TRUE if the language is Fortran. */
5142 static inline bool
5143 is_fortran (void)
5145 unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_language);
5147 return (lang == DW_LANG_Fortran77
5148 || lang == DW_LANG_Fortran90
5149 || lang == DW_LANG_Fortran95
5150 || lang == DW_LANG_Fortran03
5151 || lang == DW_LANG_Fortran08);
5154 static inline bool
5155 is_fortran (const_tree decl)
5157 if (in_lto_p)
5159 const_tree context = get_ultimate_context (decl);
5160 if (context && TRANSLATION_UNIT_LANGUAGE (context))
5161 return (strncmp (TRANSLATION_UNIT_LANGUAGE (context),
5162 "GNU Fortran", 11) == 0
5163 || strcmp (TRANSLATION_UNIT_LANGUAGE (context),
5164 "GNU F77") == 0);
5166 return is_fortran ();
5169 /* Return TRUE if the language is Ada. */
5171 static inline bool
5172 is_ada (void)
5174 unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_language);
5176 return lang == DW_LANG_Ada95 || lang == DW_LANG_Ada83;
5179 /* Remove the specified attribute if present. Return TRUE if removal
5180 was successful. */
5182 static bool
5183 remove_AT (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5185 dw_attr_node *a;
5186 unsigned ix;
5188 if (! die)
5189 return false;
5191 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
5192 if (a->dw_attr == attr_kind)
5194 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str)
5195 if (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->refcount)
5196 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->refcount--;
5198 /* vec::ordered_remove should help reduce the number of abbrevs
5199 that are needed. */
5200 die->die_attr->ordered_remove (ix);
5201 return true;
5203 return false;
5206 /* Remove CHILD from its parent. PREV must have the property that
5207 PREV->DIE_SIB == CHILD. Does not alter CHILD. */
5209 static void
5210 remove_child_with_prev (dw_die_ref child, dw_die_ref prev)
5212 gcc_assert (child->die_parent == prev->die_parent);
5213 gcc_assert (prev->die_sib == child);
5214 if (prev == child)
5216 gcc_assert (child->die_parent->die_child == child);
5217 prev = NULL;
5219 else
5220 prev->die_sib = child->die_sib;
5221 if (child->die_parent->die_child == child)
5222 child->die_parent->die_child = prev;
5223 child->die_sib = NULL;
5226 /* Replace OLD_CHILD with NEW_CHILD. PREV must have the property that
5227 PREV->DIE_SIB == OLD_CHILD. Does not alter OLD_CHILD. */
5229 static void
5230 replace_child (dw_die_ref old_child, dw_die_ref new_child, dw_die_ref prev)
5232 dw_die_ref parent = old_child->die_parent;
5234 gcc_assert (parent == prev->die_parent);
5235 gcc_assert (prev->die_sib == old_child);
5237 new_child->die_parent = parent;
5238 if (prev == old_child)
5240 gcc_assert (parent->die_child == old_child);
5241 new_child->die_sib = new_child;
5243 else
5245 prev->die_sib = new_child;
5246 new_child->die_sib = old_child->die_sib;
5248 if (old_child->die_parent->die_child == old_child)
5249 old_child->die_parent->die_child = new_child;
5250 old_child->die_sib = NULL;
5253 /* Move all children from OLD_PARENT to NEW_PARENT. */
5255 static void
5256 move_all_children (dw_die_ref old_parent, dw_die_ref new_parent)
5258 dw_die_ref c;
5259 new_parent->die_child = old_parent->die_child;
5260 old_parent->die_child = NULL;
5261 FOR_EACH_CHILD (new_parent, c, c->die_parent = new_parent);
5264 /* Remove child DIE whose die_tag is TAG. Do nothing if no child
5265 matches TAG. */
5267 static void
5268 remove_child_TAG (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_tag tag)
5270 dw_die_ref c;
5272 c = die->die_child;
5273 if (c) do {
5274 dw_die_ref prev = c;
5275 c = c->die_sib;
5276 while (c->die_tag == tag)
5278 remove_child_with_prev (c, prev);
5279 c->die_parent = NULL;
5280 /* Might have removed every child. */
5281 if (die->die_child == NULL)
5282 return;
5283 c = prev->die_sib;
5285 } while (c != die->die_child);
5288 /* Add a CHILD_DIE as the last child of DIE. */
5290 static void
5291 add_child_die (dw_die_ref die, dw_die_ref child_die)
5293 /* FIXME this should probably be an assert. */
5294 if (! die || ! child_die)
5295 return;
5296 gcc_assert (die != child_die);
5298 child_die->die_parent = die;
5299 if (die->die_child)
5301 child_die->die_sib = die->die_child->die_sib;
5302 die->die_child->die_sib = child_die;
5304 else
5305 child_die->die_sib = child_die;
5306 die->die_child = child_die;
5309 /* Like add_child_die, but put CHILD_DIE after AFTER_DIE. */
5311 static void
5312 add_child_die_after (dw_die_ref die, dw_die_ref child_die,
5313 dw_die_ref after_die)
5315 gcc_assert (die
5316 && child_die
5317 && after_die
5318 && die->die_child
5319 && die != child_die);
5321 child_die->die_parent = die;
5322 child_die->die_sib = after_die->die_sib;
5323 after_die->die_sib = child_die;
5324 if (die->die_child == after_die)
5325 die->die_child = child_die;
5328 /* Unassociate CHILD from its parent, and make its parent be
5329 NEW_PARENT. */
5331 static void
5332 reparent_child (dw_die_ref child, dw_die_ref new_parent)
5334 for (dw_die_ref p = child->die_parent->die_child; ; p = p->die_sib)
5335 if (p->die_sib == child)
5337 remove_child_with_prev (child, p);
5338 break;
5340 add_child_die (new_parent, child);
5343 /* Move CHILD, which must be a child of PARENT or the DIE for which PARENT
5344 is the specification, to the end of PARENT's list of children.
5345 This is done by removing and re-adding it. */
5347 static void
5348 splice_child_die (dw_die_ref parent, dw_die_ref child)
5350 /* We want the declaration DIE from inside the class, not the
5351 specification DIE at toplevel. */
5352 if (child->die_parent != parent)
5354 dw_die_ref tmp = get_AT_ref (child, DW_AT_specification);
5356 if (tmp)
5357 child = tmp;
5360 gcc_assert (child->die_parent == parent
5361 || (child->die_parent
5362 == get_AT_ref (parent, DW_AT_specification)));
5364 reparent_child (child, parent);
5367 /* Create and return a new die with TAG_VALUE as tag. */
5369 static inline dw_die_ref
5370 new_die_raw (enum dwarf_tag tag_value)
5372 dw_die_ref die = ggc_cleared_alloc<die_node> ();
5373 die->die_tag = tag_value;
5374 return die;
5377 /* Create and return a new die with a parent of PARENT_DIE. If
5378 PARENT_DIE is NULL, the new DIE is placed in limbo and an
5379 associated tree T must be supplied to determine parenthood
5380 later. */
5382 static inline dw_die_ref
5383 new_die (enum dwarf_tag tag_value, dw_die_ref parent_die, tree t)
5385 dw_die_ref die = new_die_raw (tag_value);
5387 if (parent_die != NULL)
5388 add_child_die (parent_die, die);
5389 else
5391 limbo_die_node *limbo_node;
5393 /* No DIEs created after early dwarf should end up in limbo,
5394 because the limbo list should not persist past LTO
5395 streaming. */
5396 if (tag_value != DW_TAG_compile_unit
5397 /* These are allowed because they're generated while
5398 breaking out COMDAT units late. */
5399 && tag_value != DW_TAG_type_unit
5400 && tag_value != DW_TAG_skeleton_unit
5401 && !early_dwarf
5402 /* Allow nested functions to live in limbo because they will
5403 only temporarily live there, as decls_for_scope will fix
5404 them up. */
5405 && (TREE_CODE (t) != FUNCTION_DECL
5406 || !decl_function_context (t))
5407 /* Same as nested functions above but for types. Types that
5408 are local to a function will be fixed in
5409 decls_for_scope. */
5410 && (!RECORD_OR_UNION_TYPE_P (t)
5411 || !TYPE_CONTEXT (t)
5412 || TREE_CODE (TYPE_CONTEXT (t)) != FUNCTION_DECL)
5413 /* FIXME debug-early: Allow late limbo DIE creation for LTO,
5414 especially in the ltrans stage, but once we implement LTO
5415 dwarf streaming, we should remove this exception. */
5416 && !in_lto_p)
5418 fprintf (stderr, "symbol ended up in limbo too late:");
5419 debug_generic_stmt (t);
5420 gcc_unreachable ();
5423 limbo_node = ggc_cleared_alloc<limbo_die_node> ();
5424 limbo_node->die = die;
5425 limbo_node->created_for = t;
5426 limbo_node->next = limbo_die_list;
5427 limbo_die_list = limbo_node;
5430 return die;
5433 /* Return the DIE associated with the given type specifier. */
5435 static inline dw_die_ref
5436 lookup_type_die (tree type)
5438 dw_die_ref die = TYPE_SYMTAB_DIE (type);
5439 if (die && die->removed)
5441 TYPE_SYMTAB_DIE (type) = NULL;
5442 return NULL;
5444 return die;
5447 /* Given a TYPE_DIE representing the type TYPE, if TYPE is an
5448 anonymous type named by the typedef TYPE_DIE, return the DIE of the
5449 anonymous type instead the one of the naming typedef. */
5451 static inline dw_die_ref
5452 strip_naming_typedef (tree type, dw_die_ref type_die)
5454 if (type
5455 && TREE_CODE (type) == RECORD_TYPE
5456 && type_die
5457 && type_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_typedef
5458 && is_naming_typedef_decl (TYPE_NAME (type)))
5459 type_die = get_AT_ref (type_die, DW_AT_type);
5460 return type_die;
5463 /* Like lookup_type_die, but if type is an anonymous type named by a
5464 typedef[1], return the DIE of the anonymous type instead the one of
5465 the naming typedef. This is because in gen_typedef_die, we did
5466 equate the anonymous struct named by the typedef with the DIE of
5467 the naming typedef. So by default, lookup_type_die on an anonymous
5468 struct yields the DIE of the naming typedef.
5470 [1]: Read the comment of is_naming_typedef_decl to learn about what
5471 a naming typedef is. */
5473 static inline dw_die_ref
5474 lookup_type_die_strip_naming_typedef (tree type)
5476 dw_die_ref die = lookup_type_die (type);
5477 return strip_naming_typedef (type, die);
5480 /* Equate a DIE to a given type specifier. */
5482 static inline void
5483 equate_type_number_to_die (tree type, dw_die_ref type_die)
5485 TYPE_SYMTAB_DIE (type) = type_die;
5488 /* Returns a hash value for X (which really is a die_struct). */
5490 inline hashval_t
5491 decl_die_hasher::hash (die_node *x)
5493 return (hashval_t) x->decl_id;
5496 /* Return nonzero if decl_id of die_struct X is the same as UID of decl *Y. */
5498 inline bool
5499 decl_die_hasher::equal (die_node *x, tree y)
5501 return (x->decl_id == DECL_UID (y));
5504 /* Return the DIE associated with a given declaration. */
5506 static inline dw_die_ref
5507 lookup_decl_die (tree decl)
5509 dw_die_ref *die = decl_die_table->find_slot_with_hash (decl, DECL_UID (decl),
5510 NO_INSERT);
5511 if (!die)
5512 return NULL;
5513 if ((*die)->removed)
5515 decl_die_table->clear_slot (die);
5516 return NULL;
5518 return *die;
5522 /* For DECL which might have early dwarf output query a SYMBOL + OFFSET
5523 style reference. Return true if we found one refering to a DIE for
5524 DECL, otherwise return false. */
5526 static bool
5527 dwarf2out_die_ref_for_decl (tree decl, const char **sym,
5528 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT *off)
5530 dw_die_ref die;
5532 if (flag_wpa && !decl_die_table)
5533 return false;
5535 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == BLOCK)
5536 die = BLOCK_DIE (decl);
5537 else
5538 die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
5539 if (!die)
5540 return false;
5542 /* During WPA stage we currently use DIEs to store the
5543 decl <-> label + offset map. That's quite inefficient but it
5544 works for now. */
5545 if (flag_wpa)
5547 dw_die_ref ref = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin);
5548 if (!ref)
5550 gcc_assert (die == comp_unit_die ());
5551 return false;
5553 *off = ref->die_offset;
5554 *sym = ref->die_id.die_symbol;
5555 return true;
5558 /* Similar to get_ref_die_offset_label, but using the "correct"
5559 label. */
5560 *off = die->die_offset;
5561 while (die->die_parent)
5562 die = die->die_parent;
5563 /* For the containing CU DIE we compute a die_symbol in
5564 compute_comp_unit_symbol. */
5565 gcc_assert (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_compile_unit
5566 && die->die_id.die_symbol != NULL);
5567 *sym = die->die_id.die_symbol;
5568 return true;
5571 /* Add a reference of kind ATTR_KIND to a DIE at SYMBOL + OFFSET to DIE. */
5573 static void
5574 add_AT_external_die_ref (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
5575 const char *symbol, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
5577 /* Create a fake DIE that contains the reference. Don't use
5578 new_die because we don't want to end up in the limbo list. */
5579 dw_die_ref ref = new_die_raw (die->die_tag);
5580 ref->die_id.die_symbol = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (get_identifier (symbol));
5581 ref->die_offset = offset;
5582 ref->with_offset = 1;
5583 add_AT_die_ref (die, attr_kind, ref);
5586 /* Create a DIE for DECL if required and add a reference to a DIE
5587 at SYMBOL + OFFSET which contains attributes dumped early. */
5589 static void
5590 dwarf2out_register_external_die (tree decl, const char *sym,
5591 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT off)
5593 if (debug_info_level == DINFO_LEVEL_NONE)
5594 return;
5596 if (flag_wpa && !decl_die_table)
5597 decl_die_table = hash_table<decl_die_hasher>::create_ggc (1000);
5599 dw_die_ref die
5600 = TREE_CODE (decl) == BLOCK ? BLOCK_DIE (decl) : lookup_decl_die (decl);
5601 gcc_assert (!die);
5603 tree ctx;
5604 dw_die_ref parent = NULL;
5605 /* Need to lookup a DIE for the decls context - the containing
5606 function or translation unit. */
5607 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == BLOCK)
5609 ctx = BLOCK_SUPERCONTEXT (decl);
5610 /* ??? We do not output DIEs for all scopes thus skip as
5611 many DIEs as needed. */
5612 while (TREE_CODE (ctx) == BLOCK
5613 && !BLOCK_DIE (ctx))
5614 ctx = BLOCK_SUPERCONTEXT (ctx);
5616 else
5617 ctx = DECL_CONTEXT (decl);
5618 while (ctx && TYPE_P (ctx))
5619 ctx = TYPE_CONTEXT (ctx);
5620 if (ctx)
5622 if (TREE_CODE (ctx) == BLOCK)
5623 parent = BLOCK_DIE (ctx);
5624 else if (TREE_CODE (ctx) == TRANSLATION_UNIT_DECL
5625 /* Keep the 1:1 association during WPA. */
5626 && !flag_wpa)
5627 /* Otherwise all late annotations go to the main CU which
5628 imports the original CUs. */
5629 parent = comp_unit_die ();
5630 else if (TREE_CODE (ctx) == FUNCTION_DECL
5631 && TREE_CODE (decl) != PARM_DECL
5632 && TREE_CODE (decl) != BLOCK)
5633 /* Leave function local entities parent determination to when
5634 we process scope vars. */
5636 else
5637 parent = lookup_decl_die (ctx);
5639 else
5640 /* In some cases the FEs fail to set DECL_CONTEXT properly.
5641 Handle this case gracefully by globalizing stuff. */
5642 parent = comp_unit_die ();
5643 /* Create a DIE "stub". */
5644 switch (TREE_CODE (decl))
5646 case TRANSLATION_UNIT_DECL:
5647 if (! flag_wpa)
5649 die = comp_unit_die ();
5650 dw_die_ref import = new_die (DW_TAG_imported_unit, die, NULL_TREE);
5651 add_AT_external_die_ref (import, DW_AT_import, sym, off);
5652 /* We re-target all CU decls to the LTRANS CU DIE, so no need
5653 to create a DIE for the original CUs. */
5654 return;
5656 /* Keep the 1:1 association during WPA. */
5657 die = new_die (DW_TAG_compile_unit, NULL, decl);
5658 break;
5659 case NAMESPACE_DECL:
5660 if (is_fortran (decl))
5661 die = new_die (DW_TAG_module, parent, decl);
5662 else
5663 die = new_die (DW_TAG_namespace, parent, decl);
5664 break;
5665 case FUNCTION_DECL:
5666 die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram, parent, decl);
5667 break;
5668 case VAR_DECL:
5669 die = new_die (DW_TAG_variable, parent, decl);
5670 break;
5671 case RESULT_DECL:
5672 die = new_die (DW_TAG_variable, parent, decl);
5673 break;
5674 case PARM_DECL:
5675 die = new_die (DW_TAG_formal_parameter, parent, decl);
5676 break;
5677 case CONST_DECL:
5678 die = new_die (DW_TAG_constant, parent, decl);
5679 break;
5680 case LABEL_DECL:
5681 die = new_die (DW_TAG_label, parent, decl);
5682 break;
5683 case BLOCK:
5684 die = new_die (DW_TAG_lexical_block, parent, decl);
5685 break;
5686 default:
5687 gcc_unreachable ();
5689 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == BLOCK)
5690 BLOCK_DIE (decl) = die;
5691 else
5692 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, die);
5694 /* Add a reference to the DIE providing early debug at $sym + off. */
5695 add_AT_external_die_ref (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin, sym, off);
5698 /* Returns a hash value for X (which really is a var_loc_list). */
5700 inline hashval_t
5701 decl_loc_hasher::hash (var_loc_list *x)
5703 return (hashval_t) x->decl_id;
5706 /* Return nonzero if decl_id of var_loc_list X is the same as
5707 UID of decl *Y. */
5709 inline bool
5710 decl_loc_hasher::equal (var_loc_list *x, const_tree y)
5712 return (x->decl_id == DECL_UID (y));
5715 /* Return the var_loc list associated with a given declaration. */
5717 static inline var_loc_list *
5718 lookup_decl_loc (const_tree decl)
5720 if (!decl_loc_table)
5721 return NULL;
5722 return decl_loc_table->find_with_hash (decl, DECL_UID (decl));
5725 /* Returns a hash value for X (which really is a cached_dw_loc_list_list). */
5727 inline hashval_t
5728 dw_loc_list_hasher::hash (cached_dw_loc_list *x)
5730 return (hashval_t) x->decl_id;
5733 /* Return nonzero if decl_id of cached_dw_loc_list X is the same as
5734 UID of decl *Y. */
5736 inline bool
5737 dw_loc_list_hasher::equal (cached_dw_loc_list *x, const_tree y)
5739 return (x->decl_id == DECL_UID (y));
5742 /* Equate a DIE to a particular declaration. */
5744 static void
5745 equate_decl_number_to_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref decl_die)
5747 unsigned int decl_id = DECL_UID (decl);
5749 *decl_die_table->find_slot_with_hash (decl, decl_id, INSERT) = decl_die;
5750 decl_die->decl_id = decl_id;
5753 /* Return how many bits covers PIECE EXPR_LIST. */
5755 static HOST_WIDE_INT
5756 decl_piece_bitsize (rtx piece)
5758 int ret = (int) GET_MODE (piece);
5759 if (ret)
5760 return ret;
5761 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (XEXP (piece, 0)) == CONCAT
5762 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (XEXP (piece, 0), 0)));
5763 return INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (piece, 0), 0));
5766 /* Return pointer to the location of location note in PIECE EXPR_LIST. */
5768 static rtx *
5769 decl_piece_varloc_ptr (rtx piece)
5771 if ((int) GET_MODE (piece))
5772 return &XEXP (piece, 0);
5773 else
5774 return &XEXP (XEXP (piece, 0), 1);
5777 /* Create an EXPR_LIST for location note LOC_NOTE covering BITSIZE bits.
5778 Next is the chain of following piece nodes. */
5780 static rtx_expr_list *
5781 decl_piece_node (rtx loc_note, HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, rtx next)
5783 if (bitsize > 0 && bitsize <= (int) MAX_MACHINE_MODE)
5784 return alloc_EXPR_LIST (bitsize, loc_note, next);
5785 else
5786 return alloc_EXPR_LIST (0, gen_rtx_CONCAT (VOIDmode,
5787 GEN_INT (bitsize),
5788 loc_note), next);
5791 /* Return rtx that should be stored into loc field for
5792 LOC_NOTE and BITPOS/BITSIZE. */
5794 static rtx
5795 construct_piece_list (rtx loc_note, HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos,
5796 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize)
5798 if (bitsize != -1)
5800 loc_note = decl_piece_node (loc_note, bitsize, NULL_RTX);
5801 if (bitpos != 0)
5802 loc_note = decl_piece_node (NULL_RTX, bitpos, loc_note);
5804 return loc_note;
5807 /* This function either modifies location piece list *DEST in
5808 place (if SRC and INNER is NULL), or copies location piece list
5809 *SRC to *DEST while modifying it. Location BITPOS is modified
5810 to contain LOC_NOTE, any pieces overlapping it are removed resp.
5811 not copied and if needed some padding around it is added.
5812 When modifying in place, DEST should point to EXPR_LIST where
5813 earlier pieces cover PIECE_BITPOS bits, when copying SRC points
5814 to the start of the whole list and INNER points to the EXPR_LIST
5815 where earlier pieces cover PIECE_BITPOS bits. */
5817 static void
5818 adjust_piece_list (rtx *dest, rtx *src, rtx *inner,
5819 HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos, HOST_WIDE_INT piece_bitpos,
5820 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, rtx loc_note)
5822 HOST_WIDE_INT diff;
5823 bool copy = inner != NULL;
5825 if (copy)
5827 /* First copy all nodes preceding the current bitpos. */
5828 while (src != inner)
5830 *dest = decl_piece_node (*decl_piece_varloc_ptr (*src),
5831 decl_piece_bitsize (*src), NULL_RTX);
5832 dest = &XEXP (*dest, 1);
5833 src = &XEXP (*src, 1);
5836 /* Add padding if needed. */
5837 if (bitpos != piece_bitpos)
5839 *dest = decl_piece_node (NULL_RTX, bitpos - piece_bitpos,
5840 copy ? NULL_RTX : *dest);
5841 dest = &XEXP (*dest, 1);
5843 else if (*dest && decl_piece_bitsize (*dest) == bitsize)
5845 gcc_assert (!copy);
5846 /* A piece with correct bitpos and bitsize already exist,
5847 just update the location for it and return. */
5848 *decl_piece_varloc_ptr (*dest) = loc_note;
5849 return;
5851 /* Add the piece that changed. */
5852 *dest = decl_piece_node (loc_note, bitsize, copy ? NULL_RTX : *dest);
5853 dest = &XEXP (*dest, 1);
5854 /* Skip over pieces that overlap it. */
5855 diff = bitpos - piece_bitpos + bitsize;
5856 if (!copy)
5857 src = dest;
5858 while (diff > 0 && *src)
5860 rtx piece = *src;
5861 diff -= decl_piece_bitsize (piece);
5862 if (copy)
5863 src = &XEXP (piece, 1);
5864 else
5866 *src = XEXP (piece, 1);
5867 free_EXPR_LIST_node (piece);
5870 /* Add padding if needed. */
5871 if (diff < 0 && *src)
5873 if (!copy)
5874 dest = src;
5875 *dest = decl_piece_node (NULL_RTX, -diff, copy ? NULL_RTX : *dest);
5876 dest = &XEXP (*dest, 1);
5878 if (!copy)
5879 return;
5880 /* Finally copy all nodes following it. */
5881 while (*src)
5883 *dest = decl_piece_node (*decl_piece_varloc_ptr (*src),
5884 decl_piece_bitsize (*src), NULL_RTX);
5885 dest = &XEXP (*dest, 1);
5886 src = &XEXP (*src, 1);
5890 /* Add a variable location node to the linked list for DECL. */
5892 static struct var_loc_node *
5893 add_var_loc_to_decl (tree decl, rtx loc_note, const char *label)
5895 unsigned int decl_id;
5896 var_loc_list *temp;
5897 struct var_loc_node *loc = NULL;
5898 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize = -1, bitpos = -1;
5900 if (VAR_P (decl) && DECL_HAS_DEBUG_EXPR_P (decl))
5902 tree realdecl = DECL_DEBUG_EXPR (decl);
5903 if (handled_component_p (realdecl)
5904 || (TREE_CODE (realdecl) == MEM_REF
5905 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (realdecl, 0)) == ADDR_EXPR))
5907 HOST_WIDE_INT maxsize;
5908 bool reverse;
5909 tree innerdecl
5910 = get_ref_base_and_extent (realdecl, &bitpos, &bitsize, &maxsize,
5911 &reverse);
5912 if (!DECL_P (innerdecl)
5913 || DECL_IGNORED_P (innerdecl)
5914 || TREE_STATIC (innerdecl)
5915 || bitsize <= 0
5916 || bitpos + bitsize > 256
5917 || bitsize != maxsize)
5918 return NULL;
5919 decl = innerdecl;
5923 decl_id = DECL_UID (decl);
5924 var_loc_list **slot
5925 = decl_loc_table->find_slot_with_hash (decl, decl_id, INSERT);
5926 if (*slot == NULL)
5928 temp = ggc_cleared_alloc<var_loc_list> ();
5929 temp->decl_id = decl_id;
5930 *slot = temp;
5932 else
5933 temp = *slot;
5935 /* For PARM_DECLs try to keep around the original incoming value,
5936 even if that means we'll emit a zero-range .debug_loc entry. */
5937 if (temp->last
5938 && temp->first == temp->last
5939 && TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL
5940 && NOTE_P (temp->first->loc)
5941 && NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_DECL (temp->first->loc) == decl
5942 && DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl)
5943 && NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (temp->first->loc)
5944 && GET_CODE (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (temp->first->loc))
5945 == GET_CODE (DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl))
5946 && prev_real_insn (as_a<rtx_insn *> (temp->first->loc)) == NULL_RTX
5947 && (bitsize != -1
5948 || !rtx_equal_p (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (temp->first->loc),
5949 NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (loc_note))
5950 || (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (temp->first->loc)
5951 != NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (loc_note))))
5953 loc = ggc_cleared_alloc<var_loc_node> ();
5954 temp->first->next = loc;
5955 temp->last = loc;
5956 loc->loc = construct_piece_list (loc_note, bitpos, bitsize);
5958 else if (temp->last)
5960 struct var_loc_node *last = temp->last, *unused = NULL;
5961 rtx *piece_loc = NULL, last_loc_note;
5962 HOST_WIDE_INT piece_bitpos = 0;
5963 if (last->next)
5965 last = last->next;
5966 gcc_assert (last->next == NULL);
5968 if (bitsize != -1 && GET_CODE (last->loc) == EXPR_LIST)
5970 piece_loc = &last->loc;
5973 HOST_WIDE_INT cur_bitsize = decl_piece_bitsize (*piece_loc);
5974 if (piece_bitpos + cur_bitsize > bitpos)
5975 break;
5976 piece_bitpos += cur_bitsize;
5977 piece_loc = &XEXP (*piece_loc, 1);
5979 while (*piece_loc);
5981 /* TEMP->LAST here is either pointer to the last but one or
5982 last element in the chained list, LAST is pointer to the
5983 last element. */
5984 if (label && strcmp (last->label, label) == 0)
5986 /* For SRA optimized variables if there weren't any real
5987 insns since last note, just modify the last node. */
5988 if (piece_loc != NULL)
5990 adjust_piece_list (piece_loc, NULL, NULL,
5991 bitpos, piece_bitpos, bitsize, loc_note);
5992 return NULL;
5994 /* If the last note doesn't cover any instructions, remove it. */
5995 if (temp->last != last)
5997 temp->last->next = NULL;
5998 unused = last;
5999 last = temp->last;
6000 gcc_assert (strcmp (last->label, label) != 0);
6002 else
6004 gcc_assert (temp->first == temp->last
6005 || (temp->first->next == temp->last
6006 && TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL));
6007 memset (temp->last, '\0', sizeof (*temp->last));
6008 temp->last->loc = construct_piece_list (loc_note, bitpos, bitsize);
6009 return temp->last;
6012 if (bitsize == -1 && NOTE_P (last->loc))
6013 last_loc_note = last->loc;
6014 else if (piece_loc != NULL
6015 && *piece_loc != NULL_RTX
6016 && piece_bitpos == bitpos
6017 && decl_piece_bitsize (*piece_loc) == bitsize)
6018 last_loc_note = *decl_piece_varloc_ptr (*piece_loc);
6019 else
6020 last_loc_note = NULL_RTX;
6021 /* If the current location is the same as the end of the list,
6022 and either both or neither of the locations is uninitialized,
6023 we have nothing to do. */
6024 if (last_loc_note == NULL_RTX
6025 || (!rtx_equal_p (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (last_loc_note),
6026 NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (loc_note)))
6027 || ((NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (last_loc_note)
6028 != NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (loc_note))
6029 && ((NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (last_loc_note)
6030 == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
6031 || (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (loc_note)
6032 == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED))))
6034 /* Add LOC to the end of list and update LAST. If the last
6035 element of the list has been removed above, reuse its
6036 memory for the new node, otherwise allocate a new one. */
6037 if (unused)
6039 loc = unused;
6040 memset (loc, '\0', sizeof (*loc));
6042 else
6043 loc = ggc_cleared_alloc<var_loc_node> ();
6044 if (bitsize == -1 || piece_loc == NULL)
6045 loc->loc = construct_piece_list (loc_note, bitpos, bitsize);
6046 else
6047 adjust_piece_list (&loc->loc, &last->loc, piece_loc,
6048 bitpos, piece_bitpos, bitsize, loc_note);
6049 last->next = loc;
6050 /* Ensure TEMP->LAST will point either to the new last but one
6051 element of the chain, or to the last element in it. */
6052 if (last != temp->last)
6053 temp->last = last;
6055 else if (unused)
6056 ggc_free (unused);
6058 else
6060 loc = ggc_cleared_alloc<var_loc_node> ();
6061 temp->first = loc;
6062 temp->last = loc;
6063 loc->loc = construct_piece_list (loc_note, bitpos, bitsize);
6065 return loc;
6068 /* Keep track of the number of spaces used to indent the
6069 output of the debugging routines that print the structure of
6070 the DIE internal representation. */
6071 static int print_indent;
6073 /* Indent the line the number of spaces given by print_indent. */
6075 static inline void
6076 print_spaces (FILE *outfile)
6078 fprintf (outfile, "%*s", print_indent, "");
6081 /* Print a type signature in hex. */
6083 static inline void
6084 print_signature (FILE *outfile, char *sig)
6086 int i;
6088 for (i = 0; i < DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE; i++)
6089 fprintf (outfile, "%02x", sig[i] & 0xff);
6092 static inline void
6093 print_discr_value (FILE *outfile, dw_discr_value *discr_value)
6095 if (discr_value->pos)
6096 fprintf (outfile, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_UNSIGNED, discr_value->v.sval);
6097 else
6098 fprintf (outfile, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC, discr_value->v.uval);
6101 static void print_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref, FILE *);
6103 /* Print the value associated to the VAL DWARF value node to OUTFILE. If
6104 RECURSE, output location descriptor operations. */
6106 static void
6107 print_dw_val (dw_val_node *val, bool recurse, FILE *outfile)
6109 switch (val->val_class)
6111 case dw_val_class_addr:
6112 fprintf (outfile, "address");
6113 break;
6114 case dw_val_class_offset:
6115 fprintf (outfile, "offset");
6116 break;
6117 case dw_val_class_loc:
6118 fprintf (outfile, "location descriptor");
6119 if (val->v.val_loc == NULL)
6120 fprintf (outfile, " -> <null>\n");
6121 else if (recurse)
6123 fprintf (outfile, ":\n");
6124 print_indent += 4;
6125 print_loc_descr (val->v.val_loc, outfile);
6126 print_indent -= 4;
6128 else
6129 fprintf (outfile, " (%p)\n", (void *) val->v.val_loc);
6130 break;
6131 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
6132 fprintf (outfile, "location list -> label:%s",
6133 val->v.val_loc_list->ll_symbol);
6134 break;
6135 case dw_val_class_range_list:
6136 fprintf (outfile, "range list");
6137 break;
6138 case dw_val_class_const:
6139 case dw_val_class_const_implicit:
6140 fprintf (outfile, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC, val->v.val_int);
6141 break;
6142 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
6143 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const_implicit:
6144 fprintf (outfile, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_UNSIGNED, val->v.val_unsigned);
6145 break;
6146 case dw_val_class_const_double:
6147 fprintf (outfile, "constant (" HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC","\
6148 HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_UNSIGNED")",
6149 val->v.val_double.high,
6150 val->v.val_double.low);
6151 break;
6152 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
6154 int i = val->v.val_wide->get_len ();
6155 fprintf (outfile, "constant (");
6156 gcc_assert (i > 0);
6157 if (val->v.val_wide->elt (i - 1) == 0)
6158 fprintf (outfile, "0x");
6159 fprintf (outfile, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_HEX,
6160 val->v.val_wide->elt (--i));
6161 while (--i >= 0)
6162 fprintf (outfile, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_PADDED_HEX,
6163 val->v.val_wide->elt (i));
6164 fprintf (outfile, ")");
6165 break;
6167 case dw_val_class_vec:
6168 fprintf (outfile, "floating-point or vector constant");
6169 break;
6170 case dw_val_class_flag:
6171 fprintf (outfile, "%u", val->v.val_flag);
6172 break;
6173 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
6174 if (val->v.val_die_ref.die != NULL)
6176 dw_die_ref die = val->v.val_die_ref.die;
6178 if (die->comdat_type_p)
6180 fprintf (outfile, "die -> signature: ");
6181 print_signature (outfile,
6182 die->die_id.die_type_node->signature);
6184 else if (die->die_id.die_symbol)
6186 fprintf (outfile, "die -> label: %s", die->die_id.die_symbol);
6187 if (die->with_offset)
6188 fprintf (outfile, " + %ld", die->die_offset);
6190 else
6191 fprintf (outfile, "die -> %ld", die->die_offset);
6192 fprintf (outfile, " (%p)", (void *) die);
6194 else
6195 fprintf (outfile, "die -> <null>");
6196 break;
6197 case dw_val_class_vms_delta:
6198 fprintf (outfile, "delta: @slotcount(%s-%s)",
6199 val->v.val_vms_delta.lbl2, val->v.val_vms_delta.lbl1);
6200 break;
6201 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
6202 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
6203 case dw_val_class_macptr:
6204 case dw_val_class_loclistsptr:
6205 case dw_val_class_high_pc:
6206 fprintf (outfile, "label: %s", val->v.val_lbl_id);
6207 break;
6208 case dw_val_class_str:
6209 if (val->v.val_str->str != NULL)
6210 fprintf (outfile, "\"%s\"", val->v.val_str->str);
6211 else
6212 fprintf (outfile, "<null>");
6213 break;
6214 case dw_val_class_file:
6215 case dw_val_class_file_implicit:
6216 fprintf (outfile, "\"%s\" (%d)", val->v.val_file->filename,
6217 val->v.val_file->emitted_number);
6218 break;
6219 case dw_val_class_data8:
6221 int i;
6223 for (i = 0; i < 8; i++)
6224 fprintf (outfile, "%02x", val->v.val_data8[i]);
6225 break;
6227 case dw_val_class_discr_value:
6228 print_discr_value (outfile, &val->v.val_discr_value);
6229 break;
6230 case dw_val_class_discr_list:
6231 for (dw_discr_list_ref node = val->v.val_discr_list;
6232 node != NULL;
6233 node = node->dw_discr_next)
6235 if (node->dw_discr_range)
6237 fprintf (outfile, " .. ");
6238 print_discr_value (outfile, &node->dw_discr_lower_bound);
6239 print_discr_value (outfile, &node->dw_discr_upper_bound);
6241 else
6242 print_discr_value (outfile, &node->dw_discr_lower_bound);
6244 if (node->dw_discr_next != NULL)
6245 fprintf (outfile, " | ");
6247 default:
6248 break;
6252 /* Likewise, for a DIE attribute. */
6254 static void
6255 print_attribute (dw_attr_node *a, bool recurse, FILE *outfile)
6257 print_dw_val (&a->dw_attr_val, recurse, outfile);
6261 /* Print the list of operands in the LOC location description to OUTFILE. This
6262 routine is a debugging aid only. */
6264 static void
6265 print_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, FILE *outfile)
6267 dw_loc_descr_ref l = loc;
6269 if (loc == NULL)
6271 print_spaces (outfile);
6272 fprintf (outfile, "<null>\n");
6273 return;
6276 for (l = loc; l != NULL; l = l->dw_loc_next)
6278 print_spaces (outfile);
6279 fprintf (outfile, "(%p) %s",
6280 (void *) l,
6281 dwarf_stack_op_name (l->dw_loc_opc));
6282 if (l->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class != dw_val_class_none)
6284 fprintf (outfile, " ");
6285 print_dw_val (&l->dw_loc_oprnd1, false, outfile);
6287 if (l->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class != dw_val_class_none)
6289 fprintf (outfile, ", ");
6290 print_dw_val (&l->dw_loc_oprnd2, false, outfile);
6292 fprintf (outfile, "\n");
6296 /* Print the information associated with a given DIE, and its children.
6297 This routine is a debugging aid only. */
6299 static void
6300 print_die (dw_die_ref die, FILE *outfile)
6302 dw_attr_node *a;
6303 dw_die_ref c;
6304 unsigned ix;
6306 print_spaces (outfile);
6307 fprintf (outfile, "DIE %4ld: %s (%p)\n",
6308 die->die_offset, dwarf_tag_name (die->die_tag),
6309 (void*) die);
6310 print_spaces (outfile);
6311 fprintf (outfile, " abbrev id: %lu", die->die_abbrev);
6312 fprintf (outfile, " offset: %ld", die->die_offset);
6313 fprintf (outfile, " mark: %d\n", die->die_mark);
6315 if (die->comdat_type_p)
6317 print_spaces (outfile);
6318 fprintf (outfile, " signature: ");
6319 print_signature (outfile, die->die_id.die_type_node->signature);
6320 fprintf (outfile, "\n");
6323 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
6325 print_spaces (outfile);
6326 fprintf (outfile, " %s: ", dwarf_attr_name (a->dw_attr));
6328 print_attribute (a, true, outfile);
6329 fprintf (outfile, "\n");
6332 if (die->die_child != NULL)
6334 print_indent += 4;
6335 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, print_die (c, outfile));
6336 print_indent -= 4;
6338 if (print_indent == 0)
6339 fprintf (outfile, "\n");
6342 /* Print the list of operations in the LOC location description. */
6344 DEBUG_FUNCTION void
6345 debug_dwarf_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
6347 print_loc_descr (loc, stderr);
6350 /* Print the information collected for a given DIE. */
6352 DEBUG_FUNCTION void
6353 debug_dwarf_die (dw_die_ref die)
6355 print_die (die, stderr);
6358 DEBUG_FUNCTION void
6359 debug (die_struct &ref)
6361 print_die (&ref, stderr);
6364 DEBUG_FUNCTION void
6365 debug (die_struct *ptr)
6367 if (ptr)
6368 debug (*ptr);
6369 else
6370 fprintf (stderr, "<nil>\n");
6374 /* Print all DWARF information collected for the compilation unit.
6375 This routine is a debugging aid only. */
6377 DEBUG_FUNCTION void
6378 debug_dwarf (void)
6380 print_indent = 0;
6381 print_die (comp_unit_die (), stderr);
6384 /* Verify the DIE tree structure. */
6386 DEBUG_FUNCTION void
6387 verify_die (dw_die_ref die)
6389 gcc_assert (!die->die_mark);
6390 if (die->die_parent == NULL
6391 && die->die_sib == NULL)
6392 return;
6393 /* Verify the die_sib list is cyclic. */
6394 dw_die_ref x = die;
6397 x->die_mark = 1;
6398 x = x->die_sib;
6400 while (x && !x->die_mark);
6401 gcc_assert (x == die);
6402 x = die;
6405 /* Verify all dies have the same parent. */
6406 gcc_assert (x->die_parent == die->die_parent);
6407 if (x->die_child)
6409 /* Verify the child has the proper parent and recurse. */
6410 gcc_assert (x->die_child->die_parent == x);
6411 verify_die (x->die_child);
6413 x->die_mark = 0;
6414 x = x->die_sib;
6416 while (x && x->die_mark);
6419 /* Sanity checks on DIEs. */
6421 static void
6422 check_die (dw_die_ref die)
6424 unsigned ix;
6425 dw_attr_node *a;
6426 bool inline_found = false;
6427 int n_location = 0, n_low_pc = 0, n_high_pc = 0, n_artificial = 0;
6428 int n_decl_line = 0, n_decl_column = 0, n_decl_file = 0;
6429 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
6431 switch (a->dw_attr)
6433 case DW_AT_inline:
6434 if (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned)
6435 inline_found = true;
6436 break;
6437 case DW_AT_location:
6438 ++n_location;
6439 break;
6440 case DW_AT_low_pc:
6441 ++n_low_pc;
6442 break;
6443 case DW_AT_high_pc:
6444 ++n_high_pc;
6445 break;
6446 case DW_AT_artificial:
6447 ++n_artificial;
6448 break;
6449 case DW_AT_decl_column:
6450 ++n_decl_column;
6451 break;
6452 case DW_AT_decl_line:
6453 ++n_decl_line;
6454 break;
6455 case DW_AT_decl_file:
6456 ++n_decl_file;
6457 break;
6458 default:
6459 break;
6462 if (n_location > 1 || n_low_pc > 1 || n_high_pc > 1 || n_artificial > 1
6463 || n_decl_column > 1 || n_decl_line > 1 || n_decl_file > 1)
6465 fprintf (stderr, "Duplicate attributes in DIE:\n");
6466 debug_dwarf_die (die);
6467 gcc_unreachable ();
6469 if (inline_found)
6471 /* A debugging information entry that is a member of an abstract
6472 instance tree [that has DW_AT_inline] should not contain any
6473 attributes which describe aspects of the subroutine which vary
6474 between distinct inlined expansions or distinct out-of-line
6475 expansions. */
6476 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
6477 gcc_assert (a->dw_attr != DW_AT_low_pc
6478 && a->dw_attr != DW_AT_high_pc
6479 && a->dw_attr != DW_AT_location
6480 && a->dw_attr != DW_AT_frame_base
6481 && a->dw_attr != DW_AT_call_all_calls
6482 && a->dw_attr != DW_AT_GNU_all_call_sites);
6486 #define CHECKSUM(FOO) md5_process_bytes (&(FOO), sizeof (FOO), ctx)
6487 #define CHECKSUM_BLOCK(FOO, SIZE) md5_process_bytes ((FOO), (SIZE), ctx)
6488 #define CHECKSUM_STRING(FOO) md5_process_bytes ((FOO), strlen (FOO), ctx)
6490 /* Calculate the checksum of a location expression. */
6492 static inline void
6493 loc_checksum (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, struct md5_ctx *ctx)
6495 int tem;
6496 inchash::hash hstate;
6497 hashval_t hash;
6499 tem = (loc->dtprel << 8) | ((unsigned int) loc->dw_loc_opc);
6500 CHECKSUM (tem);
6501 hash_loc_operands (loc, hstate);
6502 hash = hstate.end();
6503 CHECKSUM (hash);
6506 /* Calculate the checksum of an attribute. */
6508 static void
6509 attr_checksum (dw_attr_node *at, struct md5_ctx *ctx, int *mark)
6511 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
6512 rtx r;
6514 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr);
6516 /* We don't care that this was compiled with a different compiler
6517 snapshot; if the output is the same, that's what matters. */
6518 if (at->dw_attr == DW_AT_producer)
6519 return;
6521 switch (AT_class (at))
6523 case dw_val_class_const:
6524 case dw_val_class_const_implicit:
6525 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_int);
6526 break;
6527 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
6528 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const_implicit:
6529 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned);
6530 break;
6531 case dw_val_class_const_double:
6532 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_double);
6533 break;
6534 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
6535 CHECKSUM_BLOCK (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_wide->get_val (),
6536 get_full_len (*at->dw_attr_val.v.val_wide)
6537 * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR);
6538 break;
6539 case dw_val_class_vec:
6540 CHECKSUM_BLOCK (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.array,
6541 (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length
6542 * at->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size));
6543 break;
6544 case dw_val_class_flag:
6545 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag);
6546 break;
6547 case dw_val_class_str:
6548 CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_string (at));
6549 break;
6551 case dw_val_class_addr:
6552 r = AT_addr (at);
6553 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (r) == SYMBOL_REF);
6554 CHECKSUM_STRING (XSTR (r, 0));
6555 break;
6557 case dw_val_class_offset:
6558 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset);
6559 break;
6561 case dw_val_class_loc:
6562 for (loc = AT_loc (at); loc; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
6563 loc_checksum (loc, ctx);
6564 break;
6566 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
6567 die_checksum (AT_ref (at), ctx, mark);
6568 break;
6570 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
6571 case dw_val_class_vms_delta:
6572 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
6573 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
6574 case dw_val_class_macptr:
6575 case dw_val_class_loclistsptr:
6576 case dw_val_class_high_pc:
6577 break;
6579 case dw_val_class_file:
6580 case dw_val_class_file_implicit:
6581 CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_file (at)->filename);
6582 break;
6584 case dw_val_class_data8:
6585 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_data8);
6586 break;
6588 default:
6589 break;
6593 /* Calculate the checksum of a DIE. */
6595 static void
6596 die_checksum (dw_die_ref die, struct md5_ctx *ctx, int *mark)
6598 dw_die_ref c;
6599 dw_attr_node *a;
6600 unsigned ix;
6602 /* To avoid infinite recursion. */
6603 if (die->die_mark)
6605 CHECKSUM (die->die_mark);
6606 return;
6608 die->die_mark = ++(*mark);
6610 CHECKSUM (die->die_tag);
6612 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
6613 attr_checksum (a, ctx, mark);
6615 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, die_checksum (c, ctx, mark));
6618 #undef CHECKSUM
6619 #undef CHECKSUM_BLOCK
6620 #undef CHECKSUM_STRING
6622 /* For DWARF-4 types, include the trailing NULL when checksumming strings. */
6623 #define CHECKSUM(FOO) md5_process_bytes (&(FOO), sizeof (FOO), ctx)
6624 #define CHECKSUM_BLOCK(FOO, SIZE) md5_process_bytes ((FOO), (SIZE), ctx)
6625 #define CHECKSUM_STRING(FOO) md5_process_bytes ((FOO), strlen (FOO) + 1, ctx)
6626 #define CHECKSUM_SLEB128(FOO) checksum_sleb128 ((FOO), ctx)
6627 #define CHECKSUM_ULEB128(FOO) checksum_uleb128 ((FOO), ctx)
6628 #define CHECKSUM_ATTR(FOO) \
6629 if (FOO) attr_checksum_ordered (die->die_tag, (FOO), ctx, mark)
6631 /* Calculate the checksum of a number in signed LEB128 format. */
6633 static void
6634 checksum_sleb128 (HOST_WIDE_INT value, struct md5_ctx *ctx)
6636 unsigned char byte;
6637 bool more;
6639 while (1)
6641 byte = (value & 0x7f);
6642 value >>= 7;
6643 more = !((value == 0 && (byte & 0x40) == 0)
6644 || (value == -1 && (byte & 0x40) != 0));
6645 if (more)
6646 byte |= 0x80;
6647 CHECKSUM (byte);
6648 if (!more)
6649 break;
6653 /* Calculate the checksum of a number in unsigned LEB128 format. */
6655 static void
6656 checksum_uleb128 (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT value, struct md5_ctx *ctx)
6658 while (1)
6660 unsigned char byte = (value & 0x7f);
6661 value >>= 7;
6662 if (value != 0)
6663 /* More bytes to follow. */
6664 byte |= 0x80;
6665 CHECKSUM (byte);
6666 if (value == 0)
6667 break;
6671 /* Checksum the context of the DIE. This adds the names of any
6672 surrounding namespaces or structures to the checksum. */
6674 static void
6675 checksum_die_context (dw_die_ref die, struct md5_ctx *ctx)
6677 const char *name;
6678 dw_die_ref spec;
6679 int tag = die->die_tag;
6681 if (tag != DW_TAG_namespace
6682 && tag != DW_TAG_structure_type
6683 && tag != DW_TAG_class_type)
6684 return;
6686 name = get_AT_string (die, DW_AT_name);
6688 spec = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_specification);
6689 if (spec != NULL)
6690 die = spec;
6692 if (die->die_parent != NULL)
6693 checksum_die_context (die->die_parent, ctx);
6695 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('C');
6696 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (tag);
6697 if (name != NULL)
6698 CHECKSUM_STRING (name);
6701 /* Calculate the checksum of a location expression. */
6703 static inline void
6704 loc_checksum_ordered (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, struct md5_ctx *ctx)
6706 /* Special case for lone DW_OP_plus_uconst: checksum as if the location
6707 were emitted as a DW_FORM_sdata instead of a location expression. */
6708 if (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_plus_uconst && loc->dw_loc_next == NULL)
6710 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_sdata);
6711 CHECKSUM_SLEB128 ((HOST_WIDE_INT) loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
6712 return;
6715 /* Otherwise, just checksum the raw location expression. */
6716 while (loc != NULL)
6718 inchash::hash hstate;
6719 hashval_t hash;
6721 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (loc->dtprel);
6722 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (loc->dw_loc_opc);
6723 hash_loc_operands (loc, hstate);
6724 hash = hstate.end ();
6725 CHECKSUM (hash);
6726 loc = loc->dw_loc_next;
6730 /* Calculate the checksum of an attribute. */
6732 static void
6733 attr_checksum_ordered (enum dwarf_tag tag, dw_attr_node *at,
6734 struct md5_ctx *ctx, int *mark)
6736 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
6737 rtx r;
6739 if (AT_class (at) == dw_val_class_die_ref)
6741 dw_die_ref target_die = AT_ref (at);
6743 /* For pointer and reference types, we checksum only the (qualified)
6744 name of the target type (if there is a name). For friend entries,
6745 we checksum only the (qualified) name of the target type or function.
6746 This allows the checksum to remain the same whether the target type
6747 is complete or not. */
6748 if ((at->dw_attr == DW_AT_type
6749 && (tag == DW_TAG_pointer_type
6750 || tag == DW_TAG_reference_type
6751 || tag == DW_TAG_rvalue_reference_type
6752 || tag == DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type))
6753 || (at->dw_attr == DW_AT_friend
6754 && tag == DW_TAG_friend))
6756 dw_attr_node *name_attr = get_AT (target_die, DW_AT_name);
6758 if (name_attr != NULL)
6760 dw_die_ref decl = get_AT_ref (target_die, DW_AT_specification);
6762 if (decl == NULL)
6763 decl = target_die;
6764 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('N');
6765 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (at->dw_attr);
6766 if (decl->die_parent != NULL)
6767 checksum_die_context (decl->die_parent, ctx);
6768 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('E');
6769 CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_string (name_attr));
6770 return;
6774 /* For all other references to another DIE, we check to see if the
6775 target DIE has already been visited. If it has, we emit a
6776 backward reference; if not, we descend recursively. */
6777 if (target_die->die_mark > 0)
6779 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('R');
6780 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (at->dw_attr);
6781 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (target_die->die_mark);
6783 else
6785 dw_die_ref decl = get_AT_ref (target_die, DW_AT_specification);
6787 if (decl == NULL)
6788 decl = target_die;
6789 target_die->die_mark = ++(*mark);
6790 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('T');
6791 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (at->dw_attr);
6792 if (decl->die_parent != NULL)
6793 checksum_die_context (decl->die_parent, ctx);
6794 die_checksum_ordered (target_die, ctx, mark);
6796 return;
6799 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('A');
6800 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (at->dw_attr);
6802 switch (AT_class (at))
6804 case dw_val_class_const:
6805 case dw_val_class_const_implicit:
6806 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_sdata);
6807 CHECKSUM_SLEB128 (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_int);
6808 break;
6810 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
6811 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const_implicit:
6812 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_sdata);
6813 CHECKSUM_SLEB128 ((int) at->dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned);
6814 break;
6816 case dw_val_class_const_double:
6817 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_block);
6818 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (sizeof (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_double));
6819 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_double);
6820 break;
6822 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
6823 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_block);
6824 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (get_full_len (*at->dw_attr_val.v.val_wide)
6825 * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / BITS_PER_UNIT);
6826 CHECKSUM_BLOCK (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_wide->get_val (),
6827 get_full_len (*at->dw_attr_val.v.val_wide)
6828 * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR);
6829 break;
6831 case dw_val_class_vec:
6832 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_block);
6833 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length
6834 * at->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size);
6835 CHECKSUM_BLOCK (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.array,
6836 (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length
6837 * at->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size));
6838 break;
6840 case dw_val_class_flag:
6841 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_flag);
6842 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag ? 1 : 0);
6843 break;
6845 case dw_val_class_str:
6846 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_string);
6847 CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_string (at));
6848 break;
6850 case dw_val_class_addr:
6851 r = AT_addr (at);
6852 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (r) == SYMBOL_REF);
6853 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_string);
6854 CHECKSUM_STRING (XSTR (r, 0));
6855 break;
6857 case dw_val_class_offset:
6858 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_sdata);
6859 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset);
6860 break;
6862 case dw_val_class_loc:
6863 for (loc = AT_loc (at); loc; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
6864 loc_checksum_ordered (loc, ctx);
6865 break;
6867 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
6868 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
6869 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
6870 case dw_val_class_macptr:
6871 case dw_val_class_loclistsptr:
6872 case dw_val_class_high_pc:
6873 break;
6875 case dw_val_class_file:
6876 case dw_val_class_file_implicit:
6877 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_string);
6878 CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_file (at)->filename);
6879 break;
6881 case dw_val_class_data8:
6882 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_data8);
6883 break;
6885 default:
6886 break;
6890 struct checksum_attributes
6892 dw_attr_node *at_name;
6893 dw_attr_node *at_type;
6894 dw_attr_node *at_friend;
6895 dw_attr_node *at_accessibility;
6896 dw_attr_node *at_address_class;
6897 dw_attr_node *at_alignment;
6898 dw_attr_node *at_allocated;
6899 dw_attr_node *at_artificial;
6900 dw_attr_node *at_associated;
6901 dw_attr_node *at_binary_scale;
6902 dw_attr_node *at_bit_offset;
6903 dw_attr_node *at_bit_size;
6904 dw_attr_node *at_bit_stride;
6905 dw_attr_node *at_byte_size;
6906 dw_attr_node *at_byte_stride;
6907 dw_attr_node *at_const_value;
6908 dw_attr_node *at_containing_type;
6909 dw_attr_node *at_count;
6910 dw_attr_node *at_data_location;
6911 dw_attr_node *at_data_member_location;
6912 dw_attr_node *at_decimal_scale;
6913 dw_attr_node *at_decimal_sign;
6914 dw_attr_node *at_default_value;
6915 dw_attr_node *at_digit_count;
6916 dw_attr_node *at_discr;
6917 dw_attr_node *at_discr_list;
6918 dw_attr_node *at_discr_value;
6919 dw_attr_node *at_encoding;
6920 dw_attr_node *at_endianity;
6921 dw_attr_node *at_explicit;
6922 dw_attr_node *at_is_optional;
6923 dw_attr_node *at_location;
6924 dw_attr_node *at_lower_bound;
6925 dw_attr_node *at_mutable;
6926 dw_attr_node *at_ordering;
6927 dw_attr_node *at_picture_string;
6928 dw_attr_node *at_prototyped;
6929 dw_attr_node *at_small;
6930 dw_attr_node *at_segment;
6931 dw_attr_node *at_string_length;
6932 dw_attr_node *at_string_length_bit_size;
6933 dw_attr_node *at_string_length_byte_size;
6934 dw_attr_node *at_threads_scaled;
6935 dw_attr_node *at_upper_bound;
6936 dw_attr_node *at_use_location;
6937 dw_attr_node *at_use_UTF8;
6938 dw_attr_node *at_variable_parameter;
6939 dw_attr_node *at_virtuality;
6940 dw_attr_node *at_visibility;
6941 dw_attr_node *at_vtable_elem_location;
6944 /* Collect the attributes that we will want to use for the checksum. */
6946 static void
6947 collect_checksum_attributes (struct checksum_attributes *attrs, dw_die_ref die)
6949 dw_attr_node *a;
6950 unsigned ix;
6952 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
6954 switch (a->dw_attr)
6956 case DW_AT_name:
6957 attrs->at_name = a;
6958 break;
6959 case DW_AT_type:
6960 attrs->at_type = a;
6961 break;
6962 case DW_AT_friend:
6963 attrs->at_friend = a;
6964 break;
6965 case DW_AT_accessibility:
6966 attrs->at_accessibility = a;
6967 break;
6968 case DW_AT_address_class:
6969 attrs->at_address_class = a;
6970 break;
6971 case DW_AT_alignment:
6972 attrs->at_alignment = a;
6973 break;
6974 case DW_AT_allocated:
6975 attrs->at_allocated = a;
6976 break;
6977 case DW_AT_artificial:
6978 attrs->at_artificial = a;
6979 break;
6980 case DW_AT_associated:
6981 attrs->at_associated = a;
6982 break;
6983 case DW_AT_binary_scale:
6984 attrs->at_binary_scale = a;
6985 break;
6986 case DW_AT_bit_offset:
6987 attrs->at_bit_offset = a;
6988 break;
6989 case DW_AT_bit_size:
6990 attrs->at_bit_size = a;
6991 break;
6992 case DW_AT_bit_stride:
6993 attrs->at_bit_stride = a;
6994 break;
6995 case DW_AT_byte_size:
6996 attrs->at_byte_size = a;
6997 break;
6998 case DW_AT_byte_stride:
6999 attrs->at_byte_stride = a;
7000 break;
7001 case DW_AT_const_value:
7002 attrs->at_const_value = a;
7003 break;
7004 case DW_AT_containing_type:
7005 attrs->at_containing_type = a;
7006 break;
7007 case DW_AT_count:
7008 attrs->at_count = a;
7009 break;
7010 case DW_AT_data_location:
7011 attrs->at_data_location = a;
7012 break;
7013 case DW_AT_data_member_location:
7014 attrs->at_data_member_location = a;
7015 break;
7016 case DW_AT_decimal_scale:
7017 attrs->at_decimal_scale = a;
7018 break;
7019 case DW_AT_decimal_sign:
7020 attrs->at_decimal_sign = a;
7021 break;
7022 case DW_AT_default_value:
7023 attrs->at_default_value = a;
7024 break;
7025 case DW_AT_digit_count:
7026 attrs->at_digit_count = a;
7027 break;
7028 case DW_AT_discr:
7029 attrs->at_discr = a;
7030 break;
7031 case DW_AT_discr_list:
7032 attrs->at_discr_list = a;
7033 break;
7034 case DW_AT_discr_value:
7035 attrs->at_discr_value = a;
7036 break;
7037 case DW_AT_encoding:
7038 attrs->at_encoding = a;
7039 break;
7040 case DW_AT_endianity:
7041 attrs->at_endianity = a;
7042 break;
7043 case DW_AT_explicit:
7044 attrs->at_explicit = a;
7045 break;
7046 case DW_AT_is_optional:
7047 attrs->at_is_optional = a;
7048 break;
7049 case DW_AT_location:
7050 attrs->at_location = a;
7051 break;
7052 case DW_AT_lower_bound:
7053 attrs->at_lower_bound = a;
7054 break;
7055 case DW_AT_mutable:
7056 attrs->at_mutable = a;
7057 break;
7058 case DW_AT_ordering:
7059 attrs->at_ordering = a;
7060 break;
7061 case DW_AT_picture_string:
7062 attrs->at_picture_string = a;
7063 break;
7064 case DW_AT_prototyped:
7065 attrs->at_prototyped = a;
7066 break;
7067 case DW_AT_small:
7068 attrs->at_small = a;
7069 break;
7070 case DW_AT_segment:
7071 attrs->at_segment = a;
7072 break;
7073 case DW_AT_string_length:
7074 attrs->at_string_length = a;
7075 break;
7076 case DW_AT_string_length_bit_size:
7077 attrs->at_string_length_bit_size = a;
7078 break;
7079 case DW_AT_string_length_byte_size:
7080 attrs->at_string_length_byte_size = a;
7081 break;
7082 case DW_AT_threads_scaled:
7083 attrs->at_threads_scaled = a;
7084 break;
7085 case DW_AT_upper_bound:
7086 attrs->at_upper_bound = a;
7087 break;
7088 case DW_AT_use_location:
7089 attrs->at_use_location = a;
7090 break;
7091 case DW_AT_use_UTF8:
7092 attrs->at_use_UTF8 = a;
7093 break;
7094 case DW_AT_variable_parameter:
7095 attrs->at_variable_parameter = a;
7096 break;
7097 case DW_AT_virtuality:
7098 attrs->at_virtuality = a;
7099 break;
7100 case DW_AT_visibility:
7101 attrs->at_visibility = a;
7102 break;
7103 case DW_AT_vtable_elem_location:
7104 attrs->at_vtable_elem_location = a;
7105 break;
7106 default:
7107 break;
7112 /* Calculate the checksum of a DIE, using an ordered subset of attributes. */
7114 static void
7115 die_checksum_ordered (dw_die_ref die, struct md5_ctx *ctx, int *mark)
7117 dw_die_ref c;
7118 dw_die_ref decl;
7119 struct checksum_attributes attrs;
7121 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('D');
7122 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (die->die_tag);
7124 memset (&attrs, 0, sizeof (attrs));
7126 decl = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_specification);
7127 if (decl != NULL)
7128 collect_checksum_attributes (&attrs, decl);
7129 collect_checksum_attributes (&attrs, die);
7131 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_name);
7132 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_accessibility);
7133 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_address_class);
7134 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_allocated);
7135 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_artificial);
7136 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_associated);
7137 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_binary_scale);
7138 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_bit_offset);
7139 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_bit_size);
7140 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_bit_stride);
7141 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_byte_size);
7142 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_byte_stride);
7143 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_const_value);
7144 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_containing_type);
7145 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_count);
7146 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_data_location);
7147 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_data_member_location);
7148 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_decimal_scale);
7149 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_decimal_sign);
7150 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_default_value);
7151 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_digit_count);
7152 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_discr);
7153 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_discr_list);
7154 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_discr_value);
7155 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_encoding);
7156 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_endianity);
7157 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_explicit);
7158 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_is_optional);
7159 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_location);
7160 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_lower_bound);
7161 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_mutable);
7162 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_ordering);
7163 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_picture_string);
7164 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_prototyped);
7165 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_small);
7166 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_segment);
7167 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_string_length);
7168 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_string_length_bit_size);
7169 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_string_length_byte_size);
7170 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_threads_scaled);
7171 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_upper_bound);
7172 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_use_location);
7173 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_use_UTF8);
7174 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_variable_parameter);
7175 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_virtuality);
7176 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_visibility);
7177 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_vtable_elem_location);
7178 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_type);
7179 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_friend);
7180 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_alignment);
7182 /* Checksum the child DIEs. */
7183 c = die->die_child;
7184 if (c) do {
7185 dw_attr_node *name_attr;
7187 c = c->die_sib;
7188 name_attr = get_AT (c, DW_AT_name);
7189 if (is_template_instantiation (c))
7191 /* Ignore instantiations of member type and function templates. */
7193 else if (name_attr != NULL
7194 && (is_type_die (c) || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram))
7196 /* Use a shallow checksum for named nested types and member
7197 functions. */
7198 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('S');
7199 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (c->die_tag);
7200 CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_string (name_attr));
7202 else
7204 /* Use a deep checksum for other children. */
7205 /* Mark this DIE so it gets processed when unmarking. */
7206 if (c->die_mark == 0)
7207 c->die_mark = -1;
7208 die_checksum_ordered (c, ctx, mark);
7210 } while (c != die->die_child);
7212 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (0);
7215 /* Add a type name and tag to a hash. */
7216 static void
7217 die_odr_checksum (int tag, const char *name, md5_ctx *ctx)
7219 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (tag);
7220 CHECKSUM_STRING (name);
7223 #undef CHECKSUM
7224 #undef CHECKSUM_STRING
7225 #undef CHECKSUM_ATTR
7226 #undef CHECKSUM_LEB128
7227 #undef CHECKSUM_ULEB128
7229 /* Generate the type signature for DIE. This is computed by generating an
7230 MD5 checksum over the DIE's tag, its relevant attributes, and its
7231 children. Attributes that are references to other DIEs are processed
7232 by recursion, using the MARK field to prevent infinite recursion.
7233 If the DIE is nested inside a namespace or another type, we also
7234 need to include that context in the signature. The lower 64 bits
7235 of the resulting MD5 checksum comprise the signature. */
7237 static void
7238 generate_type_signature (dw_die_ref die, comdat_type_node *type_node)
7240 int mark;
7241 const char *name;
7242 unsigned char checksum[16];
7243 struct md5_ctx ctx;
7244 dw_die_ref decl;
7245 dw_die_ref parent;
7247 name = get_AT_string (die, DW_AT_name);
7248 decl = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_specification);
7249 parent = get_die_parent (die);
7251 /* First, compute a signature for just the type name (and its surrounding
7252 context, if any. This is stored in the type unit DIE for link-time
7253 ODR (one-definition rule) checking. */
7255 if (is_cxx () && name != NULL)
7257 md5_init_ctx (&ctx);
7259 /* Checksum the names of surrounding namespaces and structures. */
7260 if (parent != NULL)
7261 checksum_die_context (parent, &ctx);
7263 /* Checksum the current DIE. */
7264 die_odr_checksum (die->die_tag, name, &ctx);
7265 md5_finish_ctx (&ctx, checksum);
7267 add_AT_data8 (type_node->root_die, DW_AT_GNU_odr_signature, &checksum[8]);
7270 /* Next, compute the complete type signature. */
7272 md5_init_ctx (&ctx);
7273 mark = 1;
7274 die->die_mark = mark;
7276 /* Checksum the names of surrounding namespaces and structures. */
7277 if (parent != NULL)
7278 checksum_die_context (parent, &ctx);
7280 /* Checksum the DIE and its children. */
7281 die_checksum_ordered (die, &ctx, &mark);
7282 unmark_all_dies (die);
7283 md5_finish_ctx (&ctx, checksum);
7285 /* Store the signature in the type node and link the type DIE and the
7286 type node together. */
7287 memcpy (type_node->signature, &checksum[16 - DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE],
7288 DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE);
7289 die->comdat_type_p = true;
7290 die->die_id.die_type_node = type_node;
7291 type_node->type_die = die;
7293 /* If the DIE is a specification, link its declaration to the type node
7294 as well. */
7295 if (decl != NULL)
7297 decl->comdat_type_p = true;
7298 decl->die_id.die_type_node = type_node;
7302 /* Do the location expressions look same? */
7303 static inline int
7304 same_loc_p (dw_loc_descr_ref loc1, dw_loc_descr_ref loc2, int *mark)
7306 return loc1->dw_loc_opc == loc2->dw_loc_opc
7307 && same_dw_val_p (&loc1->dw_loc_oprnd1, &loc2->dw_loc_oprnd1, mark)
7308 && same_dw_val_p (&loc1->dw_loc_oprnd2, &loc2->dw_loc_oprnd2, mark);
7311 /* Do the values look the same? */
7312 static int
7313 same_dw_val_p (const dw_val_node *v1, const dw_val_node *v2, int *mark)
7315 dw_loc_descr_ref loc1, loc2;
7316 rtx r1, r2;
7318 if (v1->val_class != v2->val_class)
7319 return 0;
7321 switch (v1->val_class)
7323 case dw_val_class_const:
7324 case dw_val_class_const_implicit:
7325 return v1->v.val_int == v2->v.val_int;
7326 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
7327 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const_implicit:
7328 return v1->v.val_unsigned == v2->v.val_unsigned;
7329 case dw_val_class_const_double:
7330 return v1->v.val_double.high == v2->v.val_double.high
7331 && v1->v.val_double.low == v2->v.val_double.low;
7332 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
7333 return *v1->v.val_wide == *v2->v.val_wide;
7334 case dw_val_class_vec:
7335 if (v1->v.val_vec.length != v2->v.val_vec.length
7336 || v1->v.val_vec.elt_size != v2->v.val_vec.elt_size)
7337 return 0;
7338 if (memcmp (v1->v.val_vec.array, v2->v.val_vec.array,
7339 v1->v.val_vec.length * v1->v.val_vec.elt_size))
7340 return 0;
7341 return 1;
7342 case dw_val_class_flag:
7343 return v1->v.val_flag == v2->v.val_flag;
7344 case dw_val_class_str:
7345 return !strcmp (v1->v.val_str->str, v2->v.val_str->str);
7347 case dw_val_class_addr:
7348 r1 = v1->v.val_addr;
7349 r2 = v2->v.val_addr;
7350 if (GET_CODE (r1) != GET_CODE (r2))
7351 return 0;
7352 return !rtx_equal_p (r1, r2);
7354 case dw_val_class_offset:
7355 return v1->v.val_offset == v2->v.val_offset;
7357 case dw_val_class_loc:
7358 for (loc1 = v1->v.val_loc, loc2 = v2->v.val_loc;
7359 loc1 && loc2;
7360 loc1 = loc1->dw_loc_next, loc2 = loc2->dw_loc_next)
7361 if (!same_loc_p (loc1, loc2, mark))
7362 return 0;
7363 return !loc1 && !loc2;
7365 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
7366 return same_die_p (v1->v.val_die_ref.die, v2->v.val_die_ref.die, mark);
7368 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
7369 case dw_val_class_vms_delta:
7370 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
7371 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
7372 case dw_val_class_macptr:
7373 case dw_val_class_loclistsptr:
7374 case dw_val_class_high_pc:
7375 return 1;
7377 case dw_val_class_file:
7378 case dw_val_class_file_implicit:
7379 return v1->v.val_file == v2->v.val_file;
7381 case dw_val_class_data8:
7382 return !memcmp (v1->v.val_data8, v2->v.val_data8, 8);
7384 default:
7385 return 1;
7389 /* Do the attributes look the same? */
7391 static int
7392 same_attr_p (dw_attr_node *at1, dw_attr_node *at2, int *mark)
7394 if (at1->dw_attr != at2->dw_attr)
7395 return 0;
7397 /* We don't care that this was compiled with a different compiler
7398 snapshot; if the output is the same, that's what matters. */
7399 if (at1->dw_attr == DW_AT_producer)
7400 return 1;
7402 return same_dw_val_p (&at1->dw_attr_val, &at2->dw_attr_val, mark);
7405 /* Do the dies look the same? */
7407 static int
7408 same_die_p (dw_die_ref die1, dw_die_ref die2, int *mark)
7410 dw_die_ref c1, c2;
7411 dw_attr_node *a1;
7412 unsigned ix;
7414 /* To avoid infinite recursion. */
7415 if (die1->die_mark)
7416 return die1->die_mark == die2->die_mark;
7417 die1->die_mark = die2->die_mark = ++(*mark);
7419 if (die1->die_tag != die2->die_tag)
7420 return 0;
7422 if (vec_safe_length (die1->die_attr) != vec_safe_length (die2->die_attr))
7423 return 0;
7425 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die1->die_attr, ix, a1)
7426 if (!same_attr_p (a1, &(*die2->die_attr)[ix], mark))
7427 return 0;
7429 c1 = die1->die_child;
7430 c2 = die2->die_child;
7431 if (! c1)
7433 if (c2)
7434 return 0;
7436 else
7437 for (;;)
7439 if (!same_die_p (c1, c2, mark))
7440 return 0;
7441 c1 = c1->die_sib;
7442 c2 = c2->die_sib;
7443 if (c1 == die1->die_child)
7445 if (c2 == die2->die_child)
7446 break;
7447 else
7448 return 0;
7452 return 1;
7455 /* Calculate the MD5 checksum of the compilation unit DIE UNIT_DIE and its
7456 children, and set die_symbol. */
7458 static void
7459 compute_comp_unit_symbol (dw_die_ref unit_die)
7461 const char *die_name = get_AT_string (unit_die, DW_AT_name);
7462 const char *base = die_name ? lbasename (die_name) : "anonymous";
7463 char *name = XALLOCAVEC (char, strlen (base) + 64);
7464 char *p;
7465 int i, mark;
7466 unsigned char checksum[16];
7467 struct md5_ctx ctx;
7469 /* Compute the checksum of the DIE, then append part of it as hex digits to
7470 the name filename of the unit. */
7472 md5_init_ctx (&ctx);
7473 mark = 0;
7474 die_checksum (unit_die, &ctx, &mark);
7475 unmark_all_dies (unit_die);
7476 md5_finish_ctx (&ctx, checksum);
7478 /* When we this for comp_unit_die () we have a DW_AT_name that might
7479 not start with a letter but with anything valid for filenames and
7480 clean_symbol_name doesn't fix that up. Prepend 'g' if the first
7481 character is not a letter. */
7482 sprintf (name, "%s%s.", ISALPHA (*base) ? "" : "g", base);
7483 clean_symbol_name (name);
7485 p = name + strlen (name);
7486 for (i = 0; i < 4; i++)
7488 sprintf (p, "%.2x", checksum[i]);
7489 p += 2;
7492 unit_die->die_id.die_symbol = xstrdup (name);
7495 /* Returns nonzero if DIE represents a type, in the sense of TYPE_P. */
7497 static int
7498 is_type_die (dw_die_ref die)
7500 switch (die->die_tag)
7502 case DW_TAG_array_type:
7503 case DW_TAG_class_type:
7504 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
7505 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
7506 case DW_TAG_pointer_type:
7507 case DW_TAG_reference_type:
7508 case DW_TAG_rvalue_reference_type:
7509 case DW_TAG_string_type:
7510 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
7511 case DW_TAG_subroutine_type:
7512 case DW_TAG_union_type:
7513 case DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type:
7514 case DW_TAG_set_type:
7515 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
7516 case DW_TAG_base_type:
7517 case DW_TAG_const_type:
7518 case DW_TAG_file_type:
7519 case DW_TAG_packed_type:
7520 case DW_TAG_volatile_type:
7521 case DW_TAG_typedef:
7522 return 1;
7523 default:
7524 return 0;
7528 /* Returns 1 iff C is the sort of DIE that should go into a COMDAT CU.
7529 Basically, we want to choose the bits that are likely to be shared between
7530 compilations (types) and leave out the bits that are specific to individual
7531 compilations (functions). */
7533 static int
7534 is_comdat_die (dw_die_ref c)
7536 /* I think we want to leave base types and __vtbl_ptr_type in the main CU, as
7537 we do for stabs. The advantage is a greater likelihood of sharing between
7538 objects that don't include headers in the same order (and therefore would
7539 put the base types in a different comdat). jason 8/28/00 */
7541 if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_base_type)
7542 return 0;
7544 if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_pointer_type
7545 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_reference_type
7546 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_rvalue_reference_type
7547 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_const_type
7548 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_volatile_type)
7550 dw_die_ref t = get_AT_ref (c, DW_AT_type);
7552 return t ? is_comdat_die (t) : 0;
7555 return is_type_die (c);
7558 /* Returns true iff C is a compile-unit DIE. */
7560 static inline bool
7561 is_cu_die (dw_die_ref c)
7563 return c && (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_compile_unit
7564 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_skeleton_unit);
7567 /* Returns true iff C is a unit DIE of some sort. */
7569 static inline bool
7570 is_unit_die (dw_die_ref c)
7572 return c && (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_compile_unit
7573 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_partial_unit
7574 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_type_unit
7575 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_skeleton_unit);
7578 /* Returns true iff C is a namespace DIE. */
7580 static inline bool
7581 is_namespace_die (dw_die_ref c)
7583 return c && c->die_tag == DW_TAG_namespace;
7586 /* Returns true iff C is a class or structure DIE. */
7588 static inline bool
7589 is_class_die (dw_die_ref c)
7591 return c && (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_class_type
7592 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_structure_type);
7595 /* Return non-zero if this DIE is a template parameter. */
7597 static inline bool
7598 is_template_parameter (dw_die_ref die)
7600 switch (die->die_tag)
7602 case DW_TAG_template_type_param:
7603 case DW_TAG_template_value_param:
7604 case DW_TAG_GNU_template_template_param:
7605 case DW_TAG_GNU_template_parameter_pack:
7606 return true;
7607 default:
7608 return false;
7612 /* Return non-zero if this DIE represents a template instantiation. */
7614 static inline bool
7615 is_template_instantiation (dw_die_ref die)
7617 dw_die_ref c;
7619 if (!is_type_die (die) && die->die_tag != DW_TAG_subprogram)
7620 return false;
7621 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, if (is_template_parameter (c)) return true);
7622 return false;
7625 static char *
7626 gen_internal_sym (const char *prefix)
7628 char buf[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
7630 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (buf, prefix, label_num++);
7631 return xstrdup (buf);
7634 /* Return non-zero if this DIE is a declaration. */
7636 static int
7637 is_declaration_die (dw_die_ref die)
7639 dw_attr_node *a;
7640 unsigned ix;
7642 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
7643 if (a->dw_attr == DW_AT_declaration)
7644 return 1;
7646 return 0;
7649 /* Return non-zero if this DIE is nested inside a subprogram. */
7651 static int
7652 is_nested_in_subprogram (dw_die_ref die)
7654 dw_die_ref decl = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_specification);
7656 if (decl == NULL)
7657 decl = die;
7658 return local_scope_p (decl);
7661 /* Return non-zero if this DIE contains a defining declaration of a
7662 subprogram. */
7664 static int
7665 contains_subprogram_definition (dw_die_ref die)
7667 dw_die_ref c;
7669 if (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram && ! is_declaration_die (die))
7670 return 1;
7671 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, if (contains_subprogram_definition (c)) return 1);
7672 return 0;
7675 /* Return non-zero if this is a type DIE that should be moved to a
7676 COMDAT .debug_types section or .debug_info section with DW_UT_*type
7677 unit type. */
7679 static int
7680 should_move_die_to_comdat (dw_die_ref die)
7682 switch (die->die_tag)
7684 case DW_TAG_class_type:
7685 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
7686 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
7687 case DW_TAG_union_type:
7688 /* Don't move declarations, inlined instances, types nested in a
7689 subprogram, or types that contain subprogram definitions. */
7690 if (is_declaration_die (die)
7691 || get_AT (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin)
7692 || is_nested_in_subprogram (die)
7693 || contains_subprogram_definition (die))
7694 return 0;
7695 return 1;
7696 case DW_TAG_array_type:
7697 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
7698 case DW_TAG_pointer_type:
7699 case DW_TAG_reference_type:
7700 case DW_TAG_rvalue_reference_type:
7701 case DW_TAG_string_type:
7702 case DW_TAG_subroutine_type:
7703 case DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type:
7704 case DW_TAG_set_type:
7705 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
7706 case DW_TAG_base_type:
7707 case DW_TAG_const_type:
7708 case DW_TAG_file_type:
7709 case DW_TAG_packed_type:
7710 case DW_TAG_volatile_type:
7711 case DW_TAG_typedef:
7712 default:
7713 return 0;
7717 /* Make a clone of DIE. */
7719 static dw_die_ref
7720 clone_die (dw_die_ref die)
7722 dw_die_ref clone = new_die_raw (die->die_tag);
7723 dw_attr_node *a;
7724 unsigned ix;
7726 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
7727 add_dwarf_attr (clone, a);
7729 return clone;
7732 /* Make a clone of the tree rooted at DIE. */
7734 static dw_die_ref
7735 clone_tree (dw_die_ref die)
7737 dw_die_ref c;
7738 dw_die_ref clone = clone_die (die);
7740 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, add_child_die (clone, clone_tree (c)));
7742 return clone;
7745 /* Make a clone of DIE as a declaration. */
7747 static dw_die_ref
7748 clone_as_declaration (dw_die_ref die)
7750 dw_die_ref clone;
7751 dw_die_ref decl;
7752 dw_attr_node *a;
7753 unsigned ix;
7755 /* If the DIE is already a declaration, just clone it. */
7756 if (is_declaration_die (die))
7757 return clone_die (die);
7759 /* If the DIE is a specification, just clone its declaration DIE. */
7760 decl = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_specification);
7761 if (decl != NULL)
7763 clone = clone_die (decl);
7764 if (die->comdat_type_p)
7765 add_AT_die_ref (clone, DW_AT_signature, die);
7766 return clone;
7769 clone = new_die_raw (die->die_tag);
7771 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
7773 /* We don't want to copy over all attributes.
7774 For example we don't want DW_AT_byte_size because otherwise we will no
7775 longer have a declaration and GDB will treat it as a definition. */
7777 switch (a->dw_attr)
7779 case DW_AT_abstract_origin:
7780 case DW_AT_artificial:
7781 case DW_AT_containing_type:
7782 case DW_AT_external:
7783 case DW_AT_name:
7784 case DW_AT_type:
7785 case DW_AT_virtuality:
7786 case DW_AT_linkage_name:
7787 case DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name:
7788 add_dwarf_attr (clone, a);
7789 break;
7790 case DW_AT_byte_size:
7791 case DW_AT_alignment:
7792 default:
7793 break;
7797 if (die->comdat_type_p)
7798 add_AT_die_ref (clone, DW_AT_signature, die);
7800 add_AT_flag (clone, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
7801 return clone;
7805 /* Structure to map a DIE in one CU to its copy in a comdat type unit. */
7807 struct decl_table_entry
7809 dw_die_ref orig;
7810 dw_die_ref copy;
7813 /* Helpers to manipulate hash table of copied declarations. */
7815 /* Hashtable helpers. */
7817 struct decl_table_entry_hasher : free_ptr_hash <decl_table_entry>
7819 typedef die_struct *compare_type;
7820 static inline hashval_t hash (const decl_table_entry *);
7821 static inline bool equal (const decl_table_entry *, const die_struct *);
7824 inline hashval_t
7825 decl_table_entry_hasher::hash (const decl_table_entry *entry)
7827 return htab_hash_pointer (entry->orig);
7830 inline bool
7831 decl_table_entry_hasher::equal (const decl_table_entry *entry1,
7832 const die_struct *entry2)
7834 return entry1->orig == entry2;
7837 typedef hash_table<decl_table_entry_hasher> decl_hash_type;
7839 /* Copy DIE and its ancestors, up to, but not including, the compile unit
7840 or type unit entry, to a new tree. Adds the new tree to UNIT and returns
7841 a pointer to the copy of DIE. If DECL_TABLE is provided, it is used
7842 to check if the ancestor has already been copied into UNIT. */
7844 static dw_die_ref
7845 copy_ancestor_tree (dw_die_ref unit, dw_die_ref die,
7846 decl_hash_type *decl_table)
7848 dw_die_ref parent = die->die_parent;
7849 dw_die_ref new_parent = unit;
7850 dw_die_ref copy;
7851 decl_table_entry **slot = NULL;
7852 struct decl_table_entry *entry = NULL;
7854 if (decl_table)
7856 /* Check if the entry has already been copied to UNIT. */
7857 slot = decl_table->find_slot_with_hash (die, htab_hash_pointer (die),
7858 INSERT);
7859 if (*slot != HTAB_EMPTY_ENTRY)
7861 entry = *slot;
7862 return entry->copy;
7865 /* Record in DECL_TABLE that DIE has been copied to UNIT. */
7866 entry = XCNEW (struct decl_table_entry);
7867 entry->orig = die;
7868 entry->copy = NULL;
7869 *slot = entry;
7872 if (parent != NULL)
7874 dw_die_ref spec = get_AT_ref (parent, DW_AT_specification);
7875 if (spec != NULL)
7876 parent = spec;
7877 if (!is_unit_die (parent))
7878 new_parent = copy_ancestor_tree (unit, parent, decl_table);
7881 copy = clone_as_declaration (die);
7882 add_child_die (new_parent, copy);
7884 if (decl_table)
7886 /* Record the pointer to the copy. */
7887 entry->copy = copy;
7890 return copy;
7892 /* Copy the declaration context to the new type unit DIE. This includes
7893 any surrounding namespace or type declarations. If the DIE has an
7894 AT_specification attribute, it also includes attributes and children
7895 attached to the specification, and returns a pointer to the original
7896 parent of the declaration DIE. Returns NULL otherwise. */
7898 static dw_die_ref
7899 copy_declaration_context (dw_die_ref unit, dw_die_ref die)
7901 dw_die_ref decl;
7902 dw_die_ref new_decl;
7903 dw_die_ref orig_parent = NULL;
7905 decl = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_specification);
7906 if (decl == NULL)
7907 decl = die;
7908 else
7910 unsigned ix;
7911 dw_die_ref c;
7912 dw_attr_node *a;
7914 /* The original DIE will be changed to a declaration, and must
7915 be moved to be a child of the original declaration DIE. */
7916 orig_parent = decl->die_parent;
7918 /* Copy the type node pointer from the new DIE to the original
7919 declaration DIE so we can forward references later. */
7920 decl->comdat_type_p = true;
7921 decl->die_id.die_type_node = die->die_id.die_type_node;
7923 remove_AT (die, DW_AT_specification);
7925 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (decl->die_attr, ix, a)
7927 if (a->dw_attr != DW_AT_name
7928 && a->dw_attr != DW_AT_declaration
7929 && a->dw_attr != DW_AT_external)
7930 add_dwarf_attr (die, a);
7933 FOR_EACH_CHILD (decl, c, add_child_die (die, clone_tree (c)));
7936 if (decl->die_parent != NULL
7937 && !is_unit_die (decl->die_parent))
7939 new_decl = copy_ancestor_tree (unit, decl, NULL);
7940 if (new_decl != NULL)
7942 remove_AT (new_decl, DW_AT_signature);
7943 add_AT_specification (die, new_decl);
7947 return orig_parent;
7950 /* Generate the skeleton ancestor tree for the given NODE, then clone
7951 the DIE and add the clone into the tree. */
7953 static void
7954 generate_skeleton_ancestor_tree (skeleton_chain_node *node)
7956 if (node->new_die != NULL)
7957 return;
7959 node->new_die = clone_as_declaration (node->old_die);
7961 if (node->parent != NULL)
7963 generate_skeleton_ancestor_tree (node->parent);
7964 add_child_die (node->parent->new_die, node->new_die);
7968 /* Generate a skeleton tree of DIEs containing any declarations that are
7969 found in the original tree. We traverse the tree looking for declaration
7970 DIEs, and construct the skeleton from the bottom up whenever we find one. */
7972 static void
7973 generate_skeleton_bottom_up (skeleton_chain_node *parent)
7975 skeleton_chain_node node;
7976 dw_die_ref c;
7977 dw_die_ref first;
7978 dw_die_ref prev = NULL;
7979 dw_die_ref next = NULL;
7981 node.parent = parent;
7983 first = c = parent->old_die->die_child;
7984 if (c)
7985 next = c->die_sib;
7986 if (c) do {
7987 if (prev == NULL || prev->die_sib == c)
7988 prev = c;
7989 c = next;
7990 next = (c == first ? NULL : c->die_sib);
7991 node.old_die = c;
7992 node.new_die = NULL;
7993 if (is_declaration_die (c))
7995 if (is_template_instantiation (c))
7997 /* Instantiated templates do not need to be cloned into the
7998 type unit. Just move the DIE and its children back to
7999 the skeleton tree (in the main CU). */
8000 remove_child_with_prev (c, prev);
8001 add_child_die (parent->new_die, c);
8002 c = prev;
8004 else if (c->comdat_type_p)
8006 /* This is the skeleton of earlier break_out_comdat_types
8007 type. Clone the existing DIE, but keep the children
8008 under the original (which is in the main CU). */
8009 dw_die_ref clone = clone_die (c);
8011 replace_child (c, clone, prev);
8012 generate_skeleton_ancestor_tree (parent);
8013 add_child_die (parent->new_die, c);
8014 c = clone;
8015 continue;
8017 else
8019 /* Clone the existing DIE, move the original to the skeleton
8020 tree (which is in the main CU), and put the clone, with
8021 all the original's children, where the original came from
8022 (which is about to be moved to the type unit). */
8023 dw_die_ref clone = clone_die (c);
8024 move_all_children (c, clone);
8026 /* If the original has a DW_AT_object_pointer attribute,
8027 it would now point to a child DIE just moved to the
8028 cloned tree, so we need to remove that attribute from
8029 the original. */
8030 remove_AT (c, DW_AT_object_pointer);
8032 replace_child (c, clone, prev);
8033 generate_skeleton_ancestor_tree (parent);
8034 add_child_die (parent->new_die, c);
8035 node.old_die = clone;
8036 node.new_die = c;
8037 c = clone;
8040 generate_skeleton_bottom_up (&node);
8041 } while (next != NULL);
8044 /* Wrapper function for generate_skeleton_bottom_up. */
8046 static dw_die_ref
8047 generate_skeleton (dw_die_ref die)
8049 skeleton_chain_node node;
8051 node.old_die = die;
8052 node.new_die = NULL;
8053 node.parent = NULL;
8055 /* If this type definition is nested inside another type,
8056 and is not an instantiation of a template, always leave
8057 at least a declaration in its place. */
8058 if (die->die_parent != NULL
8059 && is_type_die (die->die_parent)
8060 && !is_template_instantiation (die))
8061 node.new_die = clone_as_declaration (die);
8063 generate_skeleton_bottom_up (&node);
8064 return node.new_die;
8067 /* Remove the CHILD DIE from its parent, possibly replacing it with a cloned
8068 declaration. The original DIE is moved to a new compile unit so that
8069 existing references to it follow it to the new location. If any of the
8070 original DIE's descendants is a declaration, we need to replace the
8071 original DIE with a skeleton tree and move the declarations back into the
8072 skeleton tree. */
8074 static dw_die_ref
8075 remove_child_or_replace_with_skeleton (dw_die_ref unit, dw_die_ref child,
8076 dw_die_ref prev)
8078 dw_die_ref skeleton, orig_parent;
8080 /* Copy the declaration context to the type unit DIE. If the returned
8081 ORIG_PARENT is not NULL, the skeleton needs to be added as a child of
8082 that DIE. */
8083 orig_parent = copy_declaration_context (unit, child);
8085 skeleton = generate_skeleton (child);
8086 if (skeleton == NULL)
8087 remove_child_with_prev (child, prev);
8088 else
8090 skeleton->comdat_type_p = true;
8091 skeleton->die_id.die_type_node = child->die_id.die_type_node;
8093 /* If the original DIE was a specification, we need to put
8094 the skeleton under the parent DIE of the declaration.
8095 This leaves the original declaration in the tree, but
8096 it will be pruned later since there are no longer any
8097 references to it. */
8098 if (orig_parent != NULL)
8100 remove_child_with_prev (child, prev);
8101 add_child_die (orig_parent, skeleton);
8103 else
8104 replace_child (child, skeleton, prev);
8107 return skeleton;
8110 static void
8111 copy_dwarf_procs_ref_in_attrs (dw_die_ref die,
8112 comdat_type_node *type_node,
8113 hash_map<dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref> &copied_dwarf_procs);
8115 /* Helper for copy_dwarf_procs_ref_in_dies. Make a copy of the DIE DWARF
8116 procedure, put it under TYPE_NODE and return the copy. Continue looking for
8117 DWARF procedure references in the DW_AT_location attribute. */
8119 static dw_die_ref
8120 copy_dwarf_procedure (dw_die_ref die,
8121 comdat_type_node *type_node,
8122 hash_map<dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref> &copied_dwarf_procs)
8124 gcc_assert (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_dwarf_procedure);
8126 /* DWARF procedures are not supposed to have children... */
8127 gcc_assert (die->die_child == NULL);
8129 /* ... and they are supposed to have only one attribute: DW_AT_location. */
8130 gcc_assert (vec_safe_length (die->die_attr) == 1
8131 && ((*die->die_attr)[0].dw_attr == DW_AT_location));
8133 /* Do not copy more than once DWARF procedures. */
8134 bool existed;
8135 dw_die_ref &die_copy = copied_dwarf_procs.get_or_insert (die, &existed);
8136 if (existed)
8137 return die_copy;
8139 die_copy = clone_die (die);
8140 add_child_die (type_node->root_die, die_copy);
8141 copy_dwarf_procs_ref_in_attrs (die_copy, type_node, copied_dwarf_procs);
8142 return die_copy;
8145 /* Helper for copy_dwarf_procs_ref_in_dies. Look for references to DWARF
8146 procedures in DIE's attributes. */
8148 static void
8149 copy_dwarf_procs_ref_in_attrs (dw_die_ref die,
8150 comdat_type_node *type_node,
8151 hash_map<dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref> &copied_dwarf_procs)
8153 dw_attr_node *a;
8154 unsigned i;
8156 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, i, a)
8158 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
8160 if (a->dw_attr_val.val_class != dw_val_class_loc)
8161 continue;
8163 for (loc = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
8165 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
8167 case DW_OP_call2:
8168 case DW_OP_call4:
8169 case DW_OP_call_ref:
8170 gcc_assert (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class
8171 == dw_val_class_die_ref);
8172 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die
8173 = copy_dwarf_procedure (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die,
8174 type_node,
8175 copied_dwarf_procs);
8177 default:
8178 break;
8184 /* Copy DWARF procedures that are referenced by the DIE tree to TREE_NODE and
8185 rewrite references to point to the copies.
8187 References are looked for in DIE's attributes and recursively in all its
8188 children attributes that are location descriptions. COPIED_DWARF_PROCS is a
8189 mapping from old DWARF procedures to their copy. It is used not to copy
8190 twice the same DWARF procedure under TYPE_NODE. */
8192 static void
8193 copy_dwarf_procs_ref_in_dies (dw_die_ref die,
8194 comdat_type_node *type_node,
8195 hash_map<dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref> &copied_dwarf_procs)
8197 dw_die_ref c;
8199 copy_dwarf_procs_ref_in_attrs (die, type_node, copied_dwarf_procs);
8200 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, copy_dwarf_procs_ref_in_dies (c,
8201 type_node,
8202 copied_dwarf_procs));
8205 /* Traverse the DIE and set up additional .debug_types or .debug_info
8206 DW_UT_*type sections for each type worthy of being placed in a COMDAT
8207 section. */
8209 static void
8210 break_out_comdat_types (dw_die_ref die)
8212 dw_die_ref c;
8213 dw_die_ref first;
8214 dw_die_ref prev = NULL;
8215 dw_die_ref next = NULL;
8216 dw_die_ref unit = NULL;
8218 first = c = die->die_child;
8219 if (c)
8220 next = c->die_sib;
8221 if (c) do {
8222 if (prev == NULL || prev->die_sib == c)
8223 prev = c;
8224 c = next;
8225 next = (c == first ? NULL : c->die_sib);
8226 if (should_move_die_to_comdat (c))
8228 dw_die_ref replacement;
8229 comdat_type_node *type_node;
8231 /* Break out nested types into their own type units. */
8232 break_out_comdat_types (c);
8234 /* Create a new type unit DIE as the root for the new tree, and
8235 add it to the list of comdat types. */
8236 unit = new_die (DW_TAG_type_unit, NULL, NULL);
8237 add_AT_unsigned (unit, DW_AT_language,
8238 get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_language));
8239 type_node = ggc_cleared_alloc<comdat_type_node> ();
8240 type_node->root_die = unit;
8241 type_node->next = comdat_type_list;
8242 comdat_type_list = type_node;
8244 /* Generate the type signature. */
8245 generate_type_signature (c, type_node);
8247 /* Copy the declaration context, attributes, and children of the
8248 declaration into the new type unit DIE, then remove this DIE
8249 from the main CU (or replace it with a skeleton if necessary). */
8250 replacement = remove_child_or_replace_with_skeleton (unit, c, prev);
8251 type_node->skeleton_die = replacement;
8253 /* Add the DIE to the new compunit. */
8254 add_child_die (unit, c);
8256 /* Types can reference DWARF procedures for type size or data location
8257 expressions. Calls in DWARF expressions cannot target procedures
8258 that are not in the same section. So we must copy DWARF procedures
8259 along with this type and then rewrite references to them. */
8260 hash_map<dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref> copied_dwarf_procs;
8261 copy_dwarf_procs_ref_in_dies (c, type_node, copied_dwarf_procs);
8263 if (replacement != NULL)
8264 c = replacement;
8266 else if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_namespace
8267 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_class_type
8268 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_structure_type
8269 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_union_type)
8271 /* Look for nested types that can be broken out. */
8272 break_out_comdat_types (c);
8274 } while (next != NULL);
8277 /* Like clone_tree, but copy DW_TAG_subprogram DIEs as declarations.
8278 Enter all the cloned children into the hash table decl_table. */
8280 static dw_die_ref
8281 clone_tree_partial (dw_die_ref die, decl_hash_type *decl_table)
8283 dw_die_ref c;
8284 dw_die_ref clone;
8285 struct decl_table_entry *entry;
8286 decl_table_entry **slot;
8288 if (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram)
8289 clone = clone_as_declaration (die);
8290 else
8291 clone = clone_die (die);
8293 slot = decl_table->find_slot_with_hash (die,
8294 htab_hash_pointer (die), INSERT);
8296 /* Assert that DIE isn't in the hash table yet. If it would be there
8297 before, the ancestors would be necessarily there as well, therefore
8298 clone_tree_partial wouldn't be called. */
8299 gcc_assert (*slot == HTAB_EMPTY_ENTRY);
8301 entry = XCNEW (struct decl_table_entry);
8302 entry->orig = die;
8303 entry->copy = clone;
8304 *slot = entry;
8306 if (die->die_tag != DW_TAG_subprogram)
8307 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c,
8308 add_child_die (clone, clone_tree_partial (c, decl_table)));
8310 return clone;
8313 /* Walk the DIE and its children, looking for references to incomplete
8314 or trivial types that are unmarked (i.e., that are not in the current
8315 type_unit). */
8317 static void
8318 copy_decls_walk (dw_die_ref unit, dw_die_ref die, decl_hash_type *decl_table)
8320 dw_die_ref c;
8321 dw_attr_node *a;
8322 unsigned ix;
8324 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
8326 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref)
8328 dw_die_ref targ = AT_ref (a);
8329 decl_table_entry **slot;
8330 struct decl_table_entry *entry;
8332 if (targ->die_mark != 0 || targ->comdat_type_p)
8333 continue;
8335 slot = decl_table->find_slot_with_hash (targ,
8336 htab_hash_pointer (targ),
8337 INSERT);
8339 if (*slot != HTAB_EMPTY_ENTRY)
8341 /* TARG has already been copied, so we just need to
8342 modify the reference to point to the copy. */
8343 entry = *slot;
8344 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die = entry->copy;
8346 else
8348 dw_die_ref parent = unit;
8349 dw_die_ref copy = clone_die (targ);
8351 /* Record in DECL_TABLE that TARG has been copied.
8352 Need to do this now, before the recursive call,
8353 because DECL_TABLE may be expanded and SLOT
8354 would no longer be a valid pointer. */
8355 entry = XCNEW (struct decl_table_entry);
8356 entry->orig = targ;
8357 entry->copy = copy;
8358 *slot = entry;
8360 /* If TARG is not a declaration DIE, we need to copy its
8361 children. */
8362 if (!is_declaration_die (targ))
8364 FOR_EACH_CHILD (
8365 targ, c,
8366 add_child_die (copy,
8367 clone_tree_partial (c, decl_table)));
8370 /* Make sure the cloned tree is marked as part of the
8371 type unit. */
8372 mark_dies (copy);
8374 /* If TARG has surrounding context, copy its ancestor tree
8375 into the new type unit. */
8376 if (targ->die_parent != NULL
8377 && !is_unit_die (targ->die_parent))
8378 parent = copy_ancestor_tree (unit, targ->die_parent,
8379 decl_table);
8381 add_child_die (parent, copy);
8382 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die = copy;
8384 /* Make sure the newly-copied DIE is walked. If it was
8385 installed in a previously-added context, it won't
8386 get visited otherwise. */
8387 if (parent != unit)
8389 /* Find the highest point of the newly-added tree,
8390 mark each node along the way, and walk from there. */
8391 parent->die_mark = 1;
8392 while (parent->die_parent
8393 && parent->die_parent->die_mark == 0)
8395 parent = parent->die_parent;
8396 parent->die_mark = 1;
8398 copy_decls_walk (unit, parent, decl_table);
8404 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, copy_decls_walk (unit, c, decl_table));
8407 /* Copy declarations for "unworthy" types into the new comdat section.
8408 Incomplete types, modified types, and certain other types aren't broken
8409 out into comdat sections of their own, so they don't have a signature,
8410 and we need to copy the declaration into the same section so that we
8411 don't have an external reference. */
8413 static void
8414 copy_decls_for_unworthy_types (dw_die_ref unit)
8416 mark_dies (unit);
8417 decl_hash_type decl_table (10);
8418 copy_decls_walk (unit, unit, &decl_table);
8419 unmark_dies (unit);
8422 /* Traverse the DIE and add a sibling attribute if it may have the
8423 effect of speeding up access to siblings. To save some space,
8424 avoid generating sibling attributes for DIE's without children. */
8426 static void
8427 add_sibling_attributes (dw_die_ref die)
8429 dw_die_ref c;
8431 if (! die->die_child)
8432 return;
8434 if (die->die_parent && die != die->die_parent->die_child)
8435 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_sibling, die->die_sib);
8437 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, add_sibling_attributes (c));
8440 /* Output all location lists for the DIE and its children. */
8442 static void
8443 output_location_lists (dw_die_ref die)
8445 dw_die_ref c;
8446 dw_attr_node *a;
8447 unsigned ix;
8449 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
8450 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc_list)
8451 output_loc_list (AT_loc_list (a));
8453 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, output_location_lists (c));
8456 /* During assign_location_list_indexes and output_loclists_offset the
8457 current index, after it the number of assigned indexes (i.e. how
8458 large the .debug_loclists* offset table should be). */
8459 static unsigned int loc_list_idx;
8461 /* Output all location list offsets for the DIE and its children. */
8463 static void
8464 output_loclists_offsets (dw_die_ref die)
8466 dw_die_ref c;
8467 dw_attr_node *a;
8468 unsigned ix;
8470 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
8471 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc_list)
8473 dw_loc_list_ref l = AT_loc_list (a);
8474 if (l->offset_emitted)
8475 continue;
8476 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l->ll_symbol,
8477 loc_section_label, NULL);
8478 gcc_assert (l->hash == loc_list_idx);
8479 loc_list_idx++;
8480 l->offset_emitted = true;
8483 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, output_loclists_offsets (c));
8486 /* Recursively set indexes of location lists. */
8488 static void
8489 assign_location_list_indexes (dw_die_ref die)
8491 dw_die_ref c;
8492 dw_attr_node *a;
8493 unsigned ix;
8495 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
8496 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc_list)
8498 dw_loc_list_ref list = AT_loc_list (a);
8499 if (!list->num_assigned)
8501 list->num_assigned = true;
8502 list->hash = loc_list_idx++;
8506 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, assign_location_list_indexes (c));
8509 /* We want to limit the number of external references, because they are
8510 larger than local references: a relocation takes multiple words, and
8511 even a sig8 reference is always eight bytes, whereas a local reference
8512 can be as small as one byte (though DW_FORM_ref is usually 4 in GCC).
8513 So if we encounter multiple external references to the same type DIE, we
8514 make a local typedef stub for it and redirect all references there.
8516 This is the element of the hash table for keeping track of these
8517 references. */
8519 struct external_ref
8521 dw_die_ref type;
8522 dw_die_ref stub;
8523 unsigned n_refs;
8526 /* Hashtable helpers. */
8528 struct external_ref_hasher : free_ptr_hash <external_ref>
8530 static inline hashval_t hash (const external_ref *);
8531 static inline bool equal (const external_ref *, const external_ref *);
8534 inline hashval_t
8535 external_ref_hasher::hash (const external_ref *r)
8537 dw_die_ref die = r->type;
8538 hashval_t h = 0;
8540 /* We can't use the address of the DIE for hashing, because
8541 that will make the order of the stub DIEs non-deterministic. */
8542 if (! die->comdat_type_p)
8543 /* We have a symbol; use it to compute a hash. */
8544 h = htab_hash_string (die->die_id.die_symbol);
8545 else
8547 /* We have a type signature; use a subset of the bits as the hash.
8548 The 8-byte signature is at least as large as hashval_t. */
8549 comdat_type_node *type_node = die->die_id.die_type_node;
8550 memcpy (&h, type_node->signature, sizeof (h));
8552 return h;
8555 inline bool
8556 external_ref_hasher::equal (const external_ref *r1, const external_ref *r2)
8558 return r1->type == r2->type;
8561 typedef hash_table<external_ref_hasher> external_ref_hash_type;
8563 /* Return a pointer to the external_ref for references to DIE. */
8565 static struct external_ref *
8566 lookup_external_ref (external_ref_hash_type *map, dw_die_ref die)
8568 struct external_ref ref, *ref_p;
8569 external_ref **slot;
8571 ref.type = die;
8572 slot = map->find_slot (&ref, INSERT);
8573 if (*slot != HTAB_EMPTY_ENTRY)
8574 return *slot;
8576 ref_p = XCNEW (struct external_ref);
8577 ref_p->type = die;
8578 *slot = ref_p;
8579 return ref_p;
8582 /* Subroutine of optimize_external_refs, below.
8584 If we see a type skeleton, record it as our stub. If we see external
8585 references, remember how many we've seen. */
8587 static void
8588 optimize_external_refs_1 (dw_die_ref die, external_ref_hash_type *map)
8590 dw_die_ref c;
8591 dw_attr_node *a;
8592 unsigned ix;
8593 struct external_ref *ref_p;
8595 if (is_type_die (die)
8596 && (c = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_signature)))
8598 /* This is a local skeleton; use it for local references. */
8599 ref_p = lookup_external_ref (map, c);
8600 ref_p->stub = die;
8603 /* Scan the DIE references, and remember any that refer to DIEs from
8604 other CUs (i.e. those which are not marked). */
8605 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
8606 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref
8607 && (c = AT_ref (a))->die_mark == 0
8608 && is_type_die (c))
8610 ref_p = lookup_external_ref (map, c);
8611 ref_p->n_refs++;
8614 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, optimize_external_refs_1 (c, map));
8617 /* htab_traverse callback function for optimize_external_refs, below. SLOT
8618 points to an external_ref, DATA is the CU we're processing. If we don't
8619 already have a local stub, and we have multiple refs, build a stub. */
8622 dwarf2_build_local_stub (external_ref **slot, dw_die_ref data)
8624 struct external_ref *ref_p = *slot;
8626 if (ref_p->stub == NULL && ref_p->n_refs > 1 && !dwarf_strict)
8628 /* We have multiple references to this type, so build a small stub.
8629 Both of these forms are a bit dodgy from the perspective of the
8630 DWARF standard, since technically they should have names. */
8631 dw_die_ref cu = data;
8632 dw_die_ref type = ref_p->type;
8633 dw_die_ref stub = NULL;
8635 if (type->comdat_type_p)
8637 /* If we refer to this type via sig8, use AT_signature. */
8638 stub = new_die (type->die_tag, cu, NULL_TREE);
8639 add_AT_die_ref (stub, DW_AT_signature, type);
8641 else
8643 /* Otherwise, use a typedef with no name. */
8644 stub = new_die (DW_TAG_typedef, cu, NULL_TREE);
8645 add_AT_die_ref (stub, DW_AT_type, type);
8648 stub->die_mark++;
8649 ref_p->stub = stub;
8651 return 1;
8654 /* DIE is a unit; look through all the DIE references to see if there are
8655 any external references to types, and if so, create local stubs for
8656 them which will be applied in build_abbrev_table. This is useful because
8657 references to local DIEs are smaller. */
8659 static external_ref_hash_type *
8660 optimize_external_refs (dw_die_ref die)
8662 external_ref_hash_type *map = new external_ref_hash_type (10);
8663 optimize_external_refs_1 (die, map);
8664 map->traverse <dw_die_ref, dwarf2_build_local_stub> (die);
8665 return map;
8668 /* The following 3 variables are temporaries that are computed only during the
8669 build_abbrev_table call and used and released during the following
8670 optimize_abbrev_table call. */
8672 /* First abbrev_id that can be optimized based on usage. */
8673 static unsigned int abbrev_opt_start;
8675 /* Maximum abbrev_id of a base type plus one (we can't optimize DIEs with
8676 abbrev_id smaller than this, because they must be already sized
8677 during build_abbrev_table). */
8678 static unsigned int abbrev_opt_base_type_end;
8680 /* Vector of usage counts during build_abbrev_table. Indexed by
8681 abbrev_id - abbrev_opt_start. */
8682 static vec<unsigned int> abbrev_usage_count;
8684 /* Vector of all DIEs added with die_abbrev >= abbrev_opt_start. */
8685 static vec<dw_die_ref> sorted_abbrev_dies;
8687 /* The format of each DIE (and its attribute value pairs) is encoded in an
8688 abbreviation table. This routine builds the abbreviation table and assigns
8689 a unique abbreviation id for each abbreviation entry. The children of each
8690 die are visited recursively. */
8692 static void
8693 build_abbrev_table (dw_die_ref die, external_ref_hash_type *extern_map)
8695 unsigned int abbrev_id = 0;
8696 dw_die_ref c;
8697 dw_attr_node *a;
8698 unsigned ix;
8699 dw_die_ref abbrev;
8701 /* Scan the DIE references, and replace any that refer to
8702 DIEs from other CUs (i.e. those which are not marked) with
8703 the local stubs we built in optimize_external_refs. */
8704 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
8705 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref
8706 && (c = AT_ref (a))->die_mark == 0)
8708 struct external_ref *ref_p;
8709 gcc_assert (AT_ref (a)->comdat_type_p || AT_ref (a)->die_id.die_symbol);
8711 ref_p = lookup_external_ref (extern_map, c);
8712 if (ref_p->stub && ref_p->stub != die)
8713 change_AT_die_ref (a, ref_p->stub);
8714 else
8715 /* We aren't changing this reference, so mark it external. */
8716 set_AT_ref_external (a, 1);
8719 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (abbrev_die_table, abbrev_id, abbrev)
8721 dw_attr_node *die_a, *abbrev_a;
8722 unsigned ix;
8723 bool ok = true;
8725 if (abbrev_id == 0)
8726 continue;
8727 if (abbrev->die_tag != die->die_tag)
8728 continue;
8729 if ((abbrev->die_child != NULL) != (die->die_child != NULL))
8730 continue;
8732 if (vec_safe_length (abbrev->die_attr) != vec_safe_length (die->die_attr))
8733 continue;
8735 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, die_a)
8737 abbrev_a = &(*abbrev->die_attr)[ix];
8738 if ((abbrev_a->dw_attr != die_a->dw_attr)
8739 || (value_format (abbrev_a) != value_format (die_a)))
8741 ok = false;
8742 break;
8745 if (ok)
8746 break;
8749 if (abbrev_id >= vec_safe_length (abbrev_die_table))
8751 vec_safe_push (abbrev_die_table, die);
8752 if (abbrev_opt_start)
8753 abbrev_usage_count.safe_push (0);
8755 if (abbrev_opt_start && abbrev_id >= abbrev_opt_start)
8757 abbrev_usage_count[abbrev_id - abbrev_opt_start]++;
8758 sorted_abbrev_dies.safe_push (die);
8761 die->die_abbrev = abbrev_id;
8762 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, build_abbrev_table (c, extern_map));
8765 /* Callback function for sorted_abbrev_dies vector sorting. We sort
8766 by die_abbrev's usage count, from the most commonly used
8767 abbreviation to the least. */
8769 static int
8770 die_abbrev_cmp (const void *p1, const void *p2)
8772 dw_die_ref die1 = *(const dw_die_ref *) p1;
8773 dw_die_ref die2 = *(const dw_die_ref *) p2;
8775 gcc_checking_assert (die1->die_abbrev >= abbrev_opt_start);
8776 gcc_checking_assert (die2->die_abbrev >= abbrev_opt_start);
8778 if (die1->die_abbrev >= abbrev_opt_base_type_end
8779 && die2->die_abbrev >= abbrev_opt_base_type_end)
8781 if (abbrev_usage_count[die1->die_abbrev - abbrev_opt_start]
8782 > abbrev_usage_count[die2->die_abbrev - abbrev_opt_start])
8783 return -1;
8784 if (abbrev_usage_count[die1->die_abbrev - abbrev_opt_start]
8785 < abbrev_usage_count[die2->die_abbrev - abbrev_opt_start])
8786 return 1;
8789 /* Stabilize the sort. */
8790 if (die1->die_abbrev < die2->die_abbrev)
8791 return -1;
8792 if (die1->die_abbrev > die2->die_abbrev)
8793 return 1;
8795 return 0;
8798 /* Convert dw_val_class_const and dw_val_class_unsigned_const class attributes
8799 of DIEs in between sorted_abbrev_dies[first_id] and abbrev_dies[end_id - 1]
8800 into dw_val_class_const_implicit or
8801 dw_val_class_unsigned_const_implicit. */
8803 static void
8804 optimize_implicit_const (unsigned int first_id, unsigned int end,
8805 vec<bool> &implicit_consts)
8807 /* It never makes sense if there is just one DIE using the abbreviation. */
8808 if (end < first_id + 2)
8809 return;
8811 dw_attr_node *a;
8812 unsigned ix, i;
8813 dw_die_ref die = sorted_abbrev_dies[first_id];
8814 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
8815 if (implicit_consts[ix])
8817 enum dw_val_class new_class = dw_val_class_none;
8818 switch (AT_class (a))
8820 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
8821 if ((HOST_WIDE_INT) AT_unsigned (a) < 0)
8822 continue;
8824 /* The .debug_abbrev section will grow by
8825 size_of_sleb128 (AT_unsigned (a)) and we avoid the constants
8826 in all the DIEs using that abbreviation. */
8827 if (constant_size (AT_unsigned (a)) * (end - first_id)
8828 <= (unsigned) size_of_sleb128 (AT_unsigned (a)))
8829 continue;
8831 new_class = dw_val_class_unsigned_const_implicit;
8832 break;
8834 case dw_val_class_const:
8835 new_class = dw_val_class_const_implicit;
8836 break;
8838 case dw_val_class_file:
8839 new_class = dw_val_class_file_implicit;
8840 break;
8842 default:
8843 continue;
8845 for (i = first_id; i < end; i++)
8846 (*sorted_abbrev_dies[i]->die_attr)[ix].dw_attr_val.val_class
8847 = new_class;
8851 /* Attempt to optimize abbreviation table from abbrev_opt_start
8852 abbreviation above. */
8854 static void
8855 optimize_abbrev_table (void)
8857 if (abbrev_opt_start
8858 && vec_safe_length (abbrev_die_table) > abbrev_opt_start
8859 && (dwarf_version >= 5 || vec_safe_length (abbrev_die_table) > 127))
8861 auto_vec<bool, 32> implicit_consts;
8862 sorted_abbrev_dies.qsort (die_abbrev_cmp);
8864 unsigned int abbrev_id = abbrev_opt_start - 1;
8865 unsigned int first_id = ~0U;
8866 unsigned int last_abbrev_id = 0;
8867 unsigned int i;
8868 dw_die_ref die;
8869 if (abbrev_opt_base_type_end > abbrev_opt_start)
8870 abbrev_id = abbrev_opt_base_type_end - 1;
8871 /* Reassign abbreviation ids from abbrev_opt_start above, so that
8872 most commonly used abbreviations come first. */
8873 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (sorted_abbrev_dies, i, die)
8875 dw_attr_node *a;
8876 unsigned ix;
8878 /* If calc_base_type_die_sizes has been called, the CU and
8879 base types after it can't be optimized, because we've already
8880 calculated their DIE offsets. We've sorted them first. */
8881 if (die->die_abbrev < abbrev_opt_base_type_end)
8882 continue;
8883 if (die->die_abbrev != last_abbrev_id)
8885 last_abbrev_id = die->die_abbrev;
8886 if (dwarf_version >= 5 && first_id != ~0U)
8887 optimize_implicit_const (first_id, i, implicit_consts);
8888 abbrev_id++;
8889 (*abbrev_die_table)[abbrev_id] = die;
8890 if (dwarf_version >= 5)
8892 first_id = i;
8893 implicit_consts.truncate (0);
8895 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
8896 switch (AT_class (a))
8898 case dw_val_class_const:
8899 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
8900 case dw_val_class_file:
8901 implicit_consts.safe_push (true);
8902 break;
8903 default:
8904 implicit_consts.safe_push (false);
8905 break;
8909 else if (dwarf_version >= 5)
8911 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
8912 if (!implicit_consts[ix])
8913 continue;
8914 else
8916 dw_attr_node *other_a
8917 = &(*(*abbrev_die_table)[abbrev_id]->die_attr)[ix];
8918 if (!dw_val_equal_p (&a->dw_attr_val,
8919 &other_a->dw_attr_val))
8920 implicit_consts[ix] = false;
8923 die->die_abbrev = abbrev_id;
8925 gcc_assert (abbrev_id == vec_safe_length (abbrev_die_table) - 1);
8926 if (dwarf_version >= 5 && first_id != ~0U)
8927 optimize_implicit_const (first_id, i, implicit_consts);
8930 abbrev_opt_start = 0;
8931 abbrev_opt_base_type_end = 0;
8932 abbrev_usage_count.release ();
8933 sorted_abbrev_dies.release ();
8936 /* Return the power-of-two number of bytes necessary to represent VALUE. */
8938 static int
8939 constant_size (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT value)
8941 int log;
8943 if (value == 0)
8944 log = 0;
8945 else
8946 log = floor_log2 (value);
8948 log = log / 8;
8949 log = 1 << (floor_log2 (log) + 1);
8951 return log;
8954 /* Return the size of a DIE as it is represented in the
8955 .debug_info section. */
8957 static unsigned long
8958 size_of_die (dw_die_ref die)
8960 unsigned long size = 0;
8961 dw_attr_node *a;
8962 unsigned ix;
8963 enum dwarf_form form;
8965 size += size_of_uleb128 (die->die_abbrev);
8966 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
8968 switch (AT_class (a))
8970 case dw_val_class_addr:
8971 if (dwarf_split_debug_info && AT_index (a) != NOT_INDEXED)
8973 gcc_assert (AT_index (a) != NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED);
8974 size += size_of_uleb128 (AT_index (a));
8976 else
8977 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
8978 break;
8979 case dw_val_class_offset:
8980 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
8981 break;
8982 case dw_val_class_loc:
8984 unsigned long lsize = size_of_locs (AT_loc (a));
8986 /* Block length. */
8987 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
8988 size += size_of_uleb128 (lsize);
8989 else
8990 size += constant_size (lsize);
8991 size += lsize;
8993 break;
8994 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
8995 if (dwarf_split_debug_info && dwarf_version >= 5)
8997 gcc_assert (AT_loc_list (a)->num_assigned);
8998 size += size_of_uleb128 (AT_loc_list (a)->hash);
9000 else
9001 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
9002 break;
9003 case dw_val_class_range_list:
9004 if (value_format (a) == DW_FORM_rnglistx)
9006 gcc_assert (rnglist_idx);
9007 dw_ranges *r = &(*ranges_table)[a->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset];
9008 size += size_of_uleb128 (r->idx);
9010 else
9011 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
9012 break;
9013 case dw_val_class_const:
9014 size += size_of_sleb128 (AT_int (a));
9015 break;
9016 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
9018 int csize = constant_size (AT_unsigned (a));
9019 if (dwarf_version == 3
9020 && a->dw_attr == DW_AT_data_member_location
9021 && csize >= 4)
9022 size += size_of_uleb128 (AT_unsigned (a));
9023 else
9024 size += csize;
9026 break;
9027 case dw_val_class_const_implicit:
9028 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const_implicit:
9029 case dw_val_class_file_implicit:
9030 /* These occupy no size in the DIE, just an extra sleb128 in
9031 .debug_abbrev. */
9032 break;
9033 case dw_val_class_const_double:
9034 size += HOST_BITS_PER_DOUBLE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR;
9035 if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= DWARF_LARGEST_DATA_FORM_BITS)
9036 size++; /* block */
9037 break;
9038 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
9039 size += (get_full_len (*a->dw_attr_val.v.val_wide)
9040 * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR);
9041 if (get_full_len (*a->dw_attr_val.v.val_wide)
9042 * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT > DWARF_LARGEST_DATA_FORM_BITS)
9043 size++; /* block */
9044 break;
9045 case dw_val_class_vec:
9046 size += constant_size (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length
9047 * a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size)
9048 + a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length
9049 * a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size; /* block */
9050 break;
9051 case dw_val_class_flag:
9052 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
9053 /* Currently all add_AT_flag calls pass in 1 as last argument,
9054 so DW_FORM_flag_present can be used. If that ever changes,
9055 we'll need to use DW_FORM_flag and have some optimization
9056 in build_abbrev_table that will change those to
9057 DW_FORM_flag_present if it is set to 1 in all DIEs using
9058 the same abbrev entry. */
9059 gcc_assert (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag == 1);
9060 else
9061 size += 1;
9062 break;
9063 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
9064 if (AT_ref_external (a))
9066 /* In DWARF4, we use DW_FORM_ref_sig8; for earlier versions
9067 we use DW_FORM_ref_addr. In DWARF2, DW_FORM_ref_addr
9068 is sized by target address length, whereas in DWARF3
9069 it's always sized as an offset. */
9070 if (use_debug_types)
9071 size += DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE;
9072 else if (dwarf_version == 2)
9073 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
9074 else
9075 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
9077 else
9078 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
9079 break;
9080 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
9081 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
9082 break;
9083 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
9084 if (dwarf_split_debug_info && AT_index (a) != NOT_INDEXED)
9086 gcc_assert (AT_index (a) != NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED);
9087 size += size_of_uleb128 (AT_index (a));
9089 else
9090 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
9091 break;
9092 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
9093 case dw_val_class_macptr:
9094 case dw_val_class_loclistsptr:
9095 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
9096 break;
9097 case dw_val_class_str:
9098 form = AT_string_form (a);
9099 if (form == DW_FORM_strp || form == DW_FORM_line_strp)
9100 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
9101 else if (form == DW_FORM_GNU_str_index)
9102 size += size_of_uleb128 (AT_index (a));
9103 else
9104 size += strlen (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->str) + 1;
9105 break;
9106 case dw_val_class_file:
9107 size += constant_size (maybe_emit_file (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file));
9108 break;
9109 case dw_val_class_data8:
9110 size += 8;
9111 break;
9112 case dw_val_class_vms_delta:
9113 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
9114 break;
9115 case dw_val_class_high_pc:
9116 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
9117 break;
9118 case dw_val_class_discr_value:
9119 size += size_of_discr_value (&a->dw_attr_val.v.val_discr_value);
9120 break;
9121 case dw_val_class_discr_list:
9123 unsigned block_size = size_of_discr_list (AT_discr_list (a));
9125 /* This is a block, so we have the block length and then its
9126 data. */
9127 size += constant_size (block_size) + block_size;
9129 break;
9130 default:
9131 gcc_unreachable ();
9135 return size;
9138 /* Size the debugging information associated with a given DIE. Visits the
9139 DIE's children recursively. Updates the global variable next_die_offset, on
9140 each time through. Uses the current value of next_die_offset to update the
9141 die_offset field in each DIE. */
9143 static void
9144 calc_die_sizes (dw_die_ref die)
9146 dw_die_ref c;
9148 gcc_assert (die->die_offset == 0
9149 || (unsigned long int) die->die_offset == next_die_offset);
9150 die->die_offset = next_die_offset;
9151 next_die_offset += size_of_die (die);
9153 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, calc_die_sizes (c));
9155 if (die->die_child != NULL)
9156 /* Count the null byte used to terminate sibling lists. */
9157 next_die_offset += 1;
9160 /* Size just the base type children at the start of the CU.
9161 This is needed because build_abbrev needs to size locs
9162 and sizing of type based stack ops needs to know die_offset
9163 values for the base types. */
9165 static void
9166 calc_base_type_die_sizes (void)
9168 unsigned long die_offset = (dwarf_split_debug_info
9169 ? DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_SKELETON_HEADER_SIZE
9170 : DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE);
9171 unsigned int i;
9172 dw_die_ref base_type;
9173 #if ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING
9174 dw_die_ref prev = comp_unit_die ()->die_child;
9175 #endif
9177 die_offset += size_of_die (comp_unit_die ());
9178 for (i = 0; base_types.iterate (i, &base_type); i++)
9180 #if ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING
9181 gcc_assert (base_type->die_offset == 0
9182 && prev->die_sib == base_type
9183 && base_type->die_child == NULL
9184 && base_type->die_abbrev);
9185 prev = base_type;
9186 #endif
9187 if (abbrev_opt_start
9188 && base_type->die_abbrev >= abbrev_opt_base_type_end)
9189 abbrev_opt_base_type_end = base_type->die_abbrev + 1;
9190 base_type->die_offset = die_offset;
9191 die_offset += size_of_die (base_type);
9195 /* Set the marks for a die and its children. We do this so
9196 that we know whether or not a reference needs to use FORM_ref_addr; only
9197 DIEs in the same CU will be marked. We used to clear out the offset
9198 and use that as the flag, but ran into ordering problems. */
9200 static void
9201 mark_dies (dw_die_ref die)
9203 dw_die_ref c;
9205 gcc_assert (!die->die_mark);
9207 die->die_mark = 1;
9208 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, mark_dies (c));
9211 /* Clear the marks for a die and its children. */
9213 static void
9214 unmark_dies (dw_die_ref die)
9216 dw_die_ref c;
9218 if (! use_debug_types)
9219 gcc_assert (die->die_mark);
9221 die->die_mark = 0;
9222 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, unmark_dies (c));
9225 /* Clear the marks for a die, its children and referred dies. */
9227 static void
9228 unmark_all_dies (dw_die_ref die)
9230 dw_die_ref c;
9231 dw_attr_node *a;
9232 unsigned ix;
9234 if (!die->die_mark)
9235 return;
9236 die->die_mark = 0;
9238 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, unmark_all_dies (c));
9240 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
9241 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref)
9242 unmark_all_dies (AT_ref (a));
9245 /* Calculate if the entry should appear in the final output file. It may be
9246 from a pruned a type. */
9248 static bool
9249 include_pubname_in_output (vec<pubname_entry, va_gc> *table, pubname_entry *p)
9251 /* By limiting gnu pubnames to definitions only, gold can generate a
9252 gdb index without entries for declarations, which don't include
9253 enough information to be useful. */
9254 if (debug_generate_pub_sections == 2 && is_declaration_die (p->die))
9255 return false;
9257 if (table == pubname_table)
9259 /* Enumerator names are part of the pubname table, but the
9260 parent DW_TAG_enumeration_type die may have been pruned.
9261 Don't output them if that is the case. */
9262 if (p->die->die_tag == DW_TAG_enumerator &&
9263 (p->die->die_parent == NULL
9264 || !p->die->die_parent->die_perennial_p))
9265 return false;
9267 /* Everything else in the pubname table is included. */
9268 return true;
9271 /* The pubtypes table shouldn't include types that have been
9272 pruned. */
9273 return (p->die->die_offset != 0
9274 || !flag_eliminate_unused_debug_types);
9277 /* Return the size of the .debug_pubnames or .debug_pubtypes table
9278 generated for the compilation unit. */
9280 static unsigned long
9281 size_of_pubnames (vec<pubname_entry, va_gc> *names)
9283 unsigned long size;
9284 unsigned i;
9285 pubname_entry *p;
9286 int space_for_flags = (debug_generate_pub_sections == 2) ? 1 : 0;
9288 size = DWARF_PUBNAMES_HEADER_SIZE;
9289 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*names, i, p)
9290 if (include_pubname_in_output (names, p))
9291 size += strlen (p->name) + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 1 + space_for_flags;
9293 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
9294 return size;
9297 /* Return the size of the information in the .debug_aranges section. */
9299 static unsigned long
9300 size_of_aranges (void)
9302 unsigned long size;
9304 size = DWARF_ARANGES_HEADER_SIZE;
9306 /* Count the address/length pair for this compilation unit. */
9307 if (text_section_used)
9308 size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
9309 if (cold_text_section_used)
9310 size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
9311 if (have_multiple_function_sections)
9313 unsigned fde_idx;
9314 dw_fde_ref fde;
9316 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*fde_vec, fde_idx, fde)
9318 if (DECL_IGNORED_P (fde->decl))
9319 continue;
9320 if (!fde->in_std_section)
9321 size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
9322 if (fde->dw_fde_second_begin && !fde->second_in_std_section)
9323 size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
9327 /* Count the two zero words used to terminated the address range table. */
9328 size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
9329 return size;
9332 /* Select the encoding of an attribute value. */
9334 static enum dwarf_form
9335 value_format (dw_attr_node *a)
9337 switch (AT_class (a))
9339 case dw_val_class_addr:
9340 /* Only very few attributes allow DW_FORM_addr. */
9341 switch (a->dw_attr)
9343 case DW_AT_low_pc:
9344 case DW_AT_high_pc:
9345 case DW_AT_entry_pc:
9346 case DW_AT_trampoline:
9347 return (AT_index (a) == NOT_INDEXED
9348 ? DW_FORM_addr : DW_FORM_GNU_addr_index);
9349 default:
9350 break;
9352 switch (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
9354 case 1:
9355 return DW_FORM_data1;
9356 case 2:
9357 return DW_FORM_data2;
9358 case 4:
9359 return DW_FORM_data4;
9360 case 8:
9361 return DW_FORM_data8;
9362 default:
9363 gcc_unreachable ();
9365 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
9366 if (dwarf_split_debug_info
9367 && dwarf_version >= 5
9368 && AT_loc_list (a)->num_assigned)
9369 return DW_FORM_loclistx;
9370 /* FALLTHRU */
9371 case dw_val_class_range_list:
9372 /* For range lists in DWARF 5, use DW_FORM_rnglistx from .debug_info.dwo
9373 but in .debug_info use DW_FORM_sec_offset, which is shorter if we
9374 care about sizes of .debug* sections in shared libraries and
9375 executables and don't take into account relocations that affect just
9376 relocatable objects - for DW_FORM_rnglistx we'd have to emit offset
9377 table in the .debug_rnglists section. */
9378 if (dwarf_split_debug_info
9379 && dwarf_version >= 5
9380 && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_range_list
9381 && rnglist_idx
9382 && a->dw_attr_val.val_entry != RELOCATED_OFFSET)
9383 return DW_FORM_rnglistx;
9384 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
9385 return DW_FORM_sec_offset;
9386 /* FALLTHRU */
9387 case dw_val_class_vms_delta:
9388 case dw_val_class_offset:
9389 switch (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE)
9391 case 4:
9392 return DW_FORM_data4;
9393 case 8:
9394 return DW_FORM_data8;
9395 default:
9396 gcc_unreachable ();
9398 case dw_val_class_loc:
9399 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
9400 return DW_FORM_exprloc;
9401 switch (constant_size (size_of_locs (AT_loc (a))))
9403 case 1:
9404 return DW_FORM_block1;
9405 case 2:
9406 return DW_FORM_block2;
9407 case 4:
9408 return DW_FORM_block4;
9409 default:
9410 gcc_unreachable ();
9412 case dw_val_class_const:
9413 return DW_FORM_sdata;
9414 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
9415 switch (constant_size (AT_unsigned (a)))
9417 case 1:
9418 return DW_FORM_data1;
9419 case 2:
9420 return DW_FORM_data2;
9421 case 4:
9422 /* In DWARF3 DW_AT_data_member_location with
9423 DW_FORM_data4 or DW_FORM_data8 is a loclistptr, not
9424 constant, so we need to use DW_FORM_udata if we need
9425 a large constant. */
9426 if (dwarf_version == 3 && a->dw_attr == DW_AT_data_member_location)
9427 return DW_FORM_udata;
9428 return DW_FORM_data4;
9429 case 8:
9430 if (dwarf_version == 3 && a->dw_attr == DW_AT_data_member_location)
9431 return DW_FORM_udata;
9432 return DW_FORM_data8;
9433 default:
9434 gcc_unreachable ();
9436 case dw_val_class_const_implicit:
9437 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const_implicit:
9438 case dw_val_class_file_implicit:
9439 return DW_FORM_implicit_const;
9440 case dw_val_class_const_double:
9441 switch (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
9443 case 8:
9444 return DW_FORM_data2;
9445 case 16:
9446 return DW_FORM_data4;
9447 case 32:
9448 return DW_FORM_data8;
9449 case 64:
9450 if (dwarf_version >= 5)
9451 return DW_FORM_data16;
9452 /* FALLTHRU */
9453 default:
9454 return DW_FORM_block1;
9456 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
9457 switch (get_full_len (*a->dw_attr_val.v.val_wide) * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
9459 case 8:
9460 return DW_FORM_data1;
9461 case 16:
9462 return DW_FORM_data2;
9463 case 32:
9464 return DW_FORM_data4;
9465 case 64:
9466 return DW_FORM_data8;
9467 case 128:
9468 if (dwarf_version >= 5)
9469 return DW_FORM_data16;
9470 /* FALLTHRU */
9471 default:
9472 return DW_FORM_block1;
9474 case dw_val_class_vec:
9475 switch (constant_size (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length
9476 * a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size))
9478 case 1:
9479 return DW_FORM_block1;
9480 case 2:
9481 return DW_FORM_block2;
9482 case 4:
9483 return DW_FORM_block4;
9484 default:
9485 gcc_unreachable ();
9487 case dw_val_class_flag:
9488 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
9490 /* Currently all add_AT_flag calls pass in 1 as last argument,
9491 so DW_FORM_flag_present can be used. If that ever changes,
9492 we'll need to use DW_FORM_flag and have some optimization
9493 in build_abbrev_table that will change those to
9494 DW_FORM_flag_present if it is set to 1 in all DIEs using
9495 the same abbrev entry. */
9496 gcc_assert (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag == 1);
9497 return DW_FORM_flag_present;
9499 return DW_FORM_flag;
9500 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
9501 if (AT_ref_external (a))
9502 return use_debug_types ? DW_FORM_ref_sig8 : DW_FORM_ref_addr;
9503 else
9504 return DW_FORM_ref;
9505 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
9506 return DW_FORM_data;
9507 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
9508 return (AT_index (a) == NOT_INDEXED
9509 ? DW_FORM_addr : DW_FORM_GNU_addr_index);
9510 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
9511 case dw_val_class_macptr:
9512 case dw_val_class_loclistsptr:
9513 return dwarf_version >= 4 ? DW_FORM_sec_offset : DW_FORM_data;
9514 case dw_val_class_str:
9515 return AT_string_form (a);
9516 case dw_val_class_file:
9517 switch (constant_size (maybe_emit_file (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file)))
9519 case 1:
9520 return DW_FORM_data1;
9521 case 2:
9522 return DW_FORM_data2;
9523 case 4:
9524 return DW_FORM_data4;
9525 default:
9526 gcc_unreachable ();
9529 case dw_val_class_data8:
9530 return DW_FORM_data8;
9532 case dw_val_class_high_pc:
9533 switch (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
9535 case 1:
9536 return DW_FORM_data1;
9537 case 2:
9538 return DW_FORM_data2;
9539 case 4:
9540 return DW_FORM_data4;
9541 case 8:
9542 return DW_FORM_data8;
9543 default:
9544 gcc_unreachable ();
9547 case dw_val_class_discr_value:
9548 return (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_discr_value.pos
9549 ? DW_FORM_udata
9550 : DW_FORM_sdata);
9551 case dw_val_class_discr_list:
9552 switch (constant_size (size_of_discr_list (AT_discr_list (a))))
9554 case 1:
9555 return DW_FORM_block1;
9556 case 2:
9557 return DW_FORM_block2;
9558 case 4:
9559 return DW_FORM_block4;
9560 default:
9561 gcc_unreachable ();
9564 default:
9565 gcc_unreachable ();
9569 /* Output the encoding of an attribute value. */
9571 static void
9572 output_value_format (dw_attr_node *a)
9574 enum dwarf_form form = value_format (a);
9576 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (form, "(%s)", dwarf_form_name (form));
9579 /* Given a die and id, produce the appropriate abbreviations. */
9581 static void
9582 output_die_abbrevs (unsigned long abbrev_id, dw_die_ref abbrev)
9584 unsigned ix;
9585 dw_attr_node *a_attr;
9587 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (abbrev_id, "(abbrev code)");
9588 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (abbrev->die_tag, "(TAG: %s)",
9589 dwarf_tag_name (abbrev->die_tag));
9591 if (abbrev->die_child != NULL)
9592 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_children_yes, "DW_children_yes");
9593 else
9594 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_children_no, "DW_children_no");
9596 for (ix = 0; vec_safe_iterate (abbrev->die_attr, ix, &a_attr); ix++)
9598 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (a_attr->dw_attr, "(%s)",
9599 dwarf_attr_name (a_attr->dw_attr));
9600 output_value_format (a_attr);
9601 if (value_format (a_attr) == DW_FORM_implicit_const)
9603 if (AT_class (a_attr) == dw_val_class_file_implicit)
9605 int f = maybe_emit_file (a_attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_file);
9606 const char *filename = a_attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_file->filename;
9607 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (f, "(%s)", filename);
9609 else
9610 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (a_attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_int, NULL);
9614 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, NULL);
9615 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, NULL);
9619 /* Output the .debug_abbrev section which defines the DIE abbreviation
9620 table. */
9622 static void
9623 output_abbrev_section (void)
9625 unsigned int abbrev_id;
9626 dw_die_ref abbrev;
9628 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (abbrev_die_table, abbrev_id, abbrev)
9629 if (abbrev_id != 0)
9630 output_die_abbrevs (abbrev_id, abbrev);
9632 /* Terminate the table. */
9633 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, NULL);
9636 /* Return a new location list, given the begin and end range, and the
9637 expression. */
9639 static inline dw_loc_list_ref
9640 new_loc_list (dw_loc_descr_ref expr, const char *begin, const char *end,
9641 const char *section)
9643 dw_loc_list_ref retlist = ggc_cleared_alloc<dw_loc_list_node> ();
9645 retlist->begin = begin;
9646 retlist->begin_entry = NULL;
9647 retlist->end = end;
9648 retlist->expr = expr;
9649 retlist->section = section;
9651 return retlist;
9654 /* Generate a new internal symbol for this location list node, if it
9655 hasn't got one yet. */
9657 static inline void
9658 gen_llsym (dw_loc_list_ref list)
9660 gcc_assert (!list->ll_symbol);
9661 list->ll_symbol = gen_internal_sym ("LLST");
9664 /* Output the location list given to us. */
9666 static void
9667 output_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref list_head)
9669 if (list_head->emitted)
9670 return;
9671 list_head->emitted = true;
9673 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, list_head->ll_symbol);
9675 dw_loc_list_ref curr = list_head;
9676 const char *last_section = NULL;
9677 const char *base_label = NULL;
9679 /* Walk the location list, and output each range + expression. */
9680 for (curr = list_head; curr != NULL; curr = curr->dw_loc_next)
9682 unsigned long size;
9683 /* Don't output an entry that starts and ends at the same address. */
9684 if (strcmp (curr->begin, curr->end) == 0 && !curr->force)
9685 continue;
9686 size = size_of_locs (curr->expr);
9687 /* If the expression is too large, drop it on the floor. We could
9688 perhaps put it into DW_TAG_dwarf_procedure and refer to that
9689 in the expression, but >= 64KB expressions for a single value
9690 in a single range are unlikely very useful. */
9691 if (dwarf_version < 5 && size > 0xffff)
9692 continue;
9693 if (dwarf_version >= 5)
9695 if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
9697 /* For -gsplit-dwarf, emit DW_LLE_starx_length, which has
9698 uleb128 index into .debug_addr and uleb128 length. */
9699 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LLE_startx_length,
9700 "DW_LLE_startx_length (%s)",
9701 list_head->ll_symbol);
9702 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (curr->begin_entry->index,
9703 "Location list range start index "
9704 "(%s)", curr->begin);
9705 /* FIXME: This will ICE ifndef HAVE_AS_LEB128.
9706 For that case we probably need to emit DW_LLE_startx_endx,
9707 but we'd need 2 .debug_addr entries rather than just one. */
9708 dw2_asm_output_delta_uleb128 (curr->end, curr->begin,
9709 "Location list length (%s)",
9710 list_head->ll_symbol);
9712 else if (!have_multiple_function_sections && HAVE_AS_LEB128)
9714 /* If all code is in .text section, the base address is
9715 already provided by the CU attributes. Use
9716 DW_LLE_offset_pair where both addresses are uleb128 encoded
9717 offsets against that base. */
9718 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LLE_offset_pair,
9719 "DW_LLE_offset_pair (%s)",
9720 list_head->ll_symbol);
9721 dw2_asm_output_delta_uleb128 (curr->begin, curr->section,
9722 "Location list begin address (%s)",
9723 list_head->ll_symbol);
9724 dw2_asm_output_delta_uleb128 (curr->end, curr->section,
9725 "Location list end address (%s)",
9726 list_head->ll_symbol);
9728 else if (HAVE_AS_LEB128)
9730 /* Otherwise, find out how many consecutive entries could share
9731 the same base entry. If just one, emit DW_LLE_start_length,
9732 otherwise emit DW_LLE_base_address for the base address
9733 followed by a series of DW_LLE_offset_pair. */
9734 if (last_section == NULL || curr->section != last_section)
9736 dw_loc_list_ref curr2;
9737 for (curr2 = curr->dw_loc_next; curr2 != NULL;
9738 curr2 = curr2->dw_loc_next)
9740 if (strcmp (curr2->begin, curr2->end) == 0
9741 && !curr2->force)
9742 continue;
9743 break;
9745 if (curr2 == NULL || curr->section != curr2->section)
9746 last_section = NULL;
9747 else
9749 last_section = curr->section;
9750 base_label = curr->begin;
9751 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LLE_base_address,
9752 "DW_LLE_base_address (%s)",
9753 list_head->ll_symbol);
9754 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, base_label,
9755 "Base address (%s)",
9756 list_head->ll_symbol);
9759 /* Only one entry with the same base address. Use
9760 DW_LLE_start_length with absolute address and uleb128
9761 length. */
9762 if (last_section == NULL)
9764 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LLE_start_length,
9765 "DW_LLE_start_length (%s)",
9766 list_head->ll_symbol);
9767 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->begin,
9768 "Location list begin address (%s)",
9769 list_head->ll_symbol);
9770 dw2_asm_output_delta_uleb128 (curr->end, curr->begin,
9771 "Location list length "
9772 "(%s)", list_head->ll_symbol);
9774 /* Otherwise emit DW_LLE_offset_pair, relative to above emitted
9775 DW_LLE_base_address. */
9776 else
9778 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LLE_offset_pair,
9779 "DW_LLE_offset_pair (%s)",
9780 list_head->ll_symbol);
9781 dw2_asm_output_delta_uleb128 (curr->begin, base_label,
9782 "Location list begin address "
9783 "(%s)", list_head->ll_symbol);
9784 dw2_asm_output_delta_uleb128 (curr->end, base_label,
9785 "Location list end address "
9786 "(%s)", list_head->ll_symbol);
9789 /* The assembler does not support .uleb128 directive. Emit
9790 DW_LLE_start_end with a pair of absolute addresses. */
9791 else
9793 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LLE_start_end,
9794 "DW_LLE_start_end (%s)",
9795 list_head->ll_symbol);
9796 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->begin,
9797 "Location list begin address (%s)",
9798 list_head->ll_symbol);
9799 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->end,
9800 "Location list end address (%s)",
9801 list_head->ll_symbol);
9804 else if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
9806 /* For -gsplit-dwarf -gdwarf-{2,3,4} emit index into .debug_addr
9807 and 4 byte length. */
9808 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LLE_GNU_start_length_entry,
9809 "Location list start/length entry (%s)",
9810 list_head->ll_symbol);
9811 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (curr->begin_entry->index,
9812 "Location list range start index (%s)",
9813 curr->begin);
9814 /* The length field is 4 bytes. If we ever need to support
9815 an 8-byte length, we can add a new DW_LLE code or fall back
9816 to DW_LLE_GNU_start_end_entry. */
9817 dw2_asm_output_delta (4, curr->end, curr->begin,
9818 "Location list range length (%s)",
9819 list_head->ll_symbol);
9821 else if (!have_multiple_function_sections)
9823 /* Pair of relative addresses against start of text section. */
9824 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->begin, curr->section,
9825 "Location list begin address (%s)",
9826 list_head->ll_symbol);
9827 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->end, curr->section,
9828 "Location list end address (%s)",
9829 list_head->ll_symbol);
9831 else
9833 /* Pair of absolute addresses. */
9834 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->begin,
9835 "Location list begin address (%s)",
9836 list_head->ll_symbol);
9837 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->end,
9838 "Location list end address (%s)",
9839 list_head->ll_symbol);
9842 /* Output the block length for this list of location operations. */
9843 if (dwarf_version >= 5)
9844 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (size, "Location expression size");
9845 else
9847 gcc_assert (size <= 0xffff);
9848 dw2_asm_output_data (2, size, "Location expression size");
9851 output_loc_sequence (curr->expr, -1);
9854 /* And finally list termination. */
9855 if (dwarf_version >= 5)
9856 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LLE_end_of_list,
9857 "DW_LLE_end_of_list (%s)", list_head->ll_symbol);
9858 else if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
9859 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LLE_GNU_end_of_list_entry,
9860 "Location list terminator (%s)",
9861 list_head->ll_symbol);
9862 else
9864 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0,
9865 "Location list terminator begin (%s)",
9866 list_head->ll_symbol);
9867 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0,
9868 "Location list terminator end (%s)",
9869 list_head->ll_symbol);
9873 /* Output a range_list offset into the .debug_ranges or .debug_rnglists
9874 section. Emit a relocated reference if val_entry is NULL, otherwise,
9875 emit an indirect reference. */
9877 static void
9878 output_range_list_offset (dw_attr_node *a)
9880 const char *name = dwarf_attr_name (a->dw_attr);
9882 if (a->dw_attr_val.val_entry == RELOCATED_OFFSET)
9884 if (dwarf_version >= 5)
9886 dw_ranges *r = &(*ranges_table)[a->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset];
9887 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, r->label,
9888 debug_ranges_section, "%s", name);
9890 else
9892 char *p = strchr (ranges_section_label, '\0');
9893 sprintf (p, "+" HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_HEX,
9894 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
9895 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, ranges_section_label,
9896 debug_ranges_section, "%s", name);
9897 *p = '\0';
9900 else if (dwarf_version >= 5)
9902 dw_ranges *r = &(*ranges_table)[a->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset];
9903 gcc_assert (rnglist_idx);
9904 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r->idx, "%s", name);
9906 else
9907 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE,
9908 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
9909 "%s (offset from %s)", name, ranges_section_label);
9912 /* Output the offset into the debug_loc section. */
9914 static void
9915 output_loc_list_offset (dw_attr_node *a)
9917 char *sym = AT_loc_list (a)->ll_symbol;
9919 gcc_assert (sym);
9920 if (!dwarf_split_debug_info)
9921 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, sym, debug_loc_section,
9922 "%s", dwarf_attr_name (a->dw_attr));
9923 else if (dwarf_version >= 5)
9925 gcc_assert (AT_loc_list (a)->num_assigned);
9926 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (AT_loc_list (a)->hash, "%s (%s)",
9927 dwarf_attr_name (a->dw_attr),
9928 sym);
9930 else
9931 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, sym, loc_section_label,
9932 "%s", dwarf_attr_name (a->dw_attr));
9935 /* Output an attribute's index or value appropriately. */
9937 static void
9938 output_attr_index_or_value (dw_attr_node *a)
9940 const char *name = dwarf_attr_name (a->dw_attr);
9942 if (dwarf_split_debug_info && AT_index (a) != NOT_INDEXED)
9944 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (AT_index (a), "%s", name);
9945 return;
9947 switch (AT_class (a))
9949 case dw_val_class_addr:
9950 dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, AT_addr (a), "%s", name);
9951 break;
9952 case dw_val_class_high_pc:
9953 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
9954 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, AT_lbl (a), "%s", name);
9955 break;
9956 default:
9957 gcc_unreachable ();
9961 /* Output a type signature. */
9963 static inline void
9964 output_signature (const char *sig, const char *name)
9966 int i;
9968 for (i = 0; i < DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE; i++)
9969 dw2_asm_output_data (1, sig[i], i == 0 ? "%s" : NULL, name);
9972 /* Output a discriminant value. */
9974 static inline void
9975 output_discr_value (dw_discr_value *discr_value, const char *name)
9977 if (discr_value->pos)
9978 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (discr_value->v.uval, "%s", name);
9979 else
9980 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (discr_value->v.sval, "%s", name);
9983 /* Output the DIE and its attributes. Called recursively to generate
9984 the definitions of each child DIE. */
9986 static void
9987 output_die (dw_die_ref die)
9989 dw_attr_node *a;
9990 dw_die_ref c;
9991 unsigned long size;
9992 unsigned ix;
9994 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (die->die_abbrev, "(DIE (%#lx) %s)",
9995 (unsigned long)die->die_offset,
9996 dwarf_tag_name (die->die_tag));
9998 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
10000 const char *name = dwarf_attr_name (a->dw_attr);
10002 switch (AT_class (a))
10004 case dw_val_class_addr:
10005 output_attr_index_or_value (a);
10006 break;
10008 case dw_val_class_offset:
10009 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, a->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset,
10010 "%s", name);
10011 break;
10013 case dw_val_class_range_list:
10014 output_range_list_offset (a);
10015 break;
10017 case dw_val_class_loc:
10018 size = size_of_locs (AT_loc (a));
10020 /* Output the block length for this list of location operations. */
10021 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
10022 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (size, "%s", name);
10023 else
10024 dw2_asm_output_data (constant_size (size), size, "%s", name);
10026 output_loc_sequence (AT_loc (a), -1);
10027 break;
10029 case dw_val_class_const:
10030 /* ??? It would be slightly more efficient to use a scheme like is
10031 used for unsigned constants below, but gdb 4.x does not sign
10032 extend. Gdb 5.x does sign extend. */
10033 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (AT_int (a), "%s", name);
10034 break;
10036 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
10038 int csize = constant_size (AT_unsigned (a));
10039 if (dwarf_version == 3
10040 && a->dw_attr == DW_AT_data_member_location
10041 && csize >= 4)
10042 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (AT_unsigned (a), "%s", name);
10043 else
10044 dw2_asm_output_data (csize, AT_unsigned (a), "%s", name);
10046 break;
10048 case dw_val_class_const_implicit:
10049 if (flag_debug_asm)
10050 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t\t\t%s %s ("
10051 HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC ")\n",
10052 ASM_COMMENT_START, name, AT_int (a));
10053 break;
10055 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const_implicit:
10056 if (flag_debug_asm)
10057 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t\t\t%s %s ("
10058 HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_HEX ")\n",
10059 ASM_COMMENT_START, name, AT_unsigned (a));
10060 break;
10062 case dw_val_class_const_double:
10064 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT first, second;
10066 if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= DWARF_LARGEST_DATA_FORM_BITS)
10067 dw2_asm_output_data (1,
10068 HOST_BITS_PER_DOUBLE_INT
10069 / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
10070 NULL);
10072 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
10074 first = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_double.high;
10075 second = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_double.low;
10077 else
10079 first = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_double.low;
10080 second = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_double.high;
10083 dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
10084 first, "%s", name);
10085 dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
10086 second, NULL);
10088 break;
10090 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
10092 int i;
10093 int len = get_full_len (*a->dw_attr_val.v.val_wide);
10094 int l = HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR;
10095 if (len * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT > DWARF_LARGEST_DATA_FORM_BITS)
10096 dw2_asm_output_data (1, get_full_len (*a->dw_attr_val.v.val_wide)
10097 * l, NULL);
10099 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
10100 for (i = len - 1; i >= 0; --i)
10102 dw2_asm_output_data (l, a->dw_attr_val.v.val_wide->elt (i),
10103 "%s", name);
10104 name = "";
10106 else
10107 for (i = 0; i < len; ++i)
10109 dw2_asm_output_data (l, a->dw_attr_val.v.val_wide->elt (i),
10110 "%s", name);
10111 name = "";
10114 break;
10116 case dw_val_class_vec:
10118 unsigned int elt_size = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size;
10119 unsigned int len = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length;
10120 unsigned int i;
10121 unsigned char *p;
10123 dw2_asm_output_data (constant_size (len * elt_size),
10124 len * elt_size, "%s", name);
10125 if (elt_size > sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT))
10127 elt_size /= 2;
10128 len *= 2;
10130 for (i = 0, p = (unsigned char *) a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.array;
10131 i < len;
10132 i++, p += elt_size)
10133 dw2_asm_output_data (elt_size, extract_int (p, elt_size),
10134 "fp or vector constant word %u", i);
10135 break;
10138 case dw_val_class_flag:
10139 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
10141 /* Currently all add_AT_flag calls pass in 1 as last argument,
10142 so DW_FORM_flag_present can be used. If that ever changes,
10143 we'll need to use DW_FORM_flag and have some optimization
10144 in build_abbrev_table that will change those to
10145 DW_FORM_flag_present if it is set to 1 in all DIEs using
10146 the same abbrev entry. */
10147 gcc_assert (AT_flag (a) == 1);
10148 if (flag_debug_asm)
10149 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t\t\t%s %s\n",
10150 ASM_COMMENT_START, name);
10151 break;
10153 dw2_asm_output_data (1, AT_flag (a), "%s", name);
10154 break;
10156 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
10157 output_loc_list_offset (a);
10158 break;
10160 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
10161 if (AT_ref_external (a))
10163 if (AT_ref (a)->comdat_type_p)
10165 comdat_type_node *type_node
10166 = AT_ref (a)->die_id.die_type_node;
10168 gcc_assert (type_node);
10169 output_signature (type_node->signature, name);
10171 else
10173 const char *sym = AT_ref (a)->die_id.die_symbol;
10174 int size;
10176 gcc_assert (sym);
10177 /* In DWARF2, DW_FORM_ref_addr is sized by target address
10178 length, whereas in DWARF3 it's always sized as an
10179 offset. */
10180 if (dwarf_version == 2)
10181 size = DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
10182 else
10183 size = DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
10184 /* ??? We cannot unconditionally output die_offset if
10185 non-zero - others might create references to those
10186 DIEs via symbols.
10187 And we do not clear its DIE offset after outputting it
10188 (and the label refers to the actual DIEs, not the
10189 DWARF CU unit header which is when using label + offset
10190 would be the correct thing to do).
10191 ??? This is the reason for the with_offset flag. */
10192 if (AT_ref (a)->with_offset)
10193 dw2_asm_output_offset (size, sym, AT_ref (a)->die_offset,
10194 debug_info_section, "%s", name);
10195 else
10196 dw2_asm_output_offset (size, sym, debug_info_section, "%s",
10197 name);
10200 else
10202 gcc_assert (AT_ref (a)->die_offset);
10203 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, AT_ref (a)->die_offset,
10204 "%s", name);
10206 break;
10208 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
10210 char l1[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
10212 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, FDE_LABEL,
10213 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_fde_index * 2);
10214 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l1, debug_frame_section,
10215 "%s", name);
10217 break;
10219 case dw_val_class_vms_delta:
10220 #ifdef ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_VMS_DELTA
10221 dw2_asm_output_vms_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE,
10222 AT_vms_delta2 (a), AT_vms_delta1 (a),
10223 "%s", name);
10224 #else
10225 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE,
10226 AT_vms_delta2 (a), AT_vms_delta1 (a),
10227 "%s", name);
10228 #endif
10229 break;
10231 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
10232 output_attr_index_or_value (a);
10233 break;
10235 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
10236 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, AT_lbl (a),
10237 debug_line_section, "%s", name);
10238 break;
10240 case dw_val_class_macptr:
10241 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, AT_lbl (a),
10242 debug_macinfo_section, "%s", name);
10243 break;
10245 case dw_val_class_loclistsptr:
10246 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, AT_lbl (a),
10247 debug_loc_section, "%s", name);
10248 break;
10250 case dw_val_class_str:
10251 if (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->form == DW_FORM_strp)
10252 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE,
10253 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->label,
10254 debug_str_section,
10255 "%s: \"%s\"", name, AT_string (a));
10256 else if (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->form == DW_FORM_line_strp)
10257 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE,
10258 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->label,
10259 debug_line_str_section,
10260 "%s: \"%s\"", name, AT_string (a));
10261 else if (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->form == DW_FORM_GNU_str_index)
10262 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (AT_index (a),
10263 "%s: \"%s\"", name, AT_string (a));
10264 else
10265 dw2_asm_output_nstring (AT_string (a), -1, "%s", name);
10266 break;
10268 case dw_val_class_file:
10270 int f = maybe_emit_file (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file);
10272 dw2_asm_output_data (constant_size (f), f, "%s (%s)", name,
10273 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file->filename);
10274 break;
10277 case dw_val_class_file_implicit:
10278 if (flag_debug_asm)
10279 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t\t\t%s %s (%d, %s)\n",
10280 ASM_COMMENT_START, name,
10281 maybe_emit_file (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file),
10282 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file->filename);
10283 break;
10285 case dw_val_class_data8:
10287 int i;
10289 for (i = 0; i < 8; i++)
10290 dw2_asm_output_data (1, a->dw_attr_val.v.val_data8[i],
10291 i == 0 ? "%s" : NULL, name);
10292 break;
10295 case dw_val_class_high_pc:
10296 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, AT_lbl (a),
10297 get_AT_low_pc (die), "DW_AT_high_pc");
10298 break;
10300 case dw_val_class_discr_value:
10301 output_discr_value (&a->dw_attr_val.v.val_discr_value, name);
10302 break;
10304 case dw_val_class_discr_list:
10306 dw_discr_list_ref list = AT_discr_list (a);
10307 const int size = size_of_discr_list (list);
10309 /* This is a block, so output its length first. */
10310 dw2_asm_output_data (constant_size (size), size,
10311 "%s: block size", name);
10313 for (; list != NULL; list = list->dw_discr_next)
10315 /* One byte for the discriminant value descriptor, and then as
10316 many LEB128 numbers as required. */
10317 if (list->dw_discr_range)
10318 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_DSC_range,
10319 "%s: DW_DSC_range", name);
10320 else
10321 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_DSC_label,
10322 "%s: DW_DSC_label", name);
10324 output_discr_value (&list->dw_discr_lower_bound, name);
10325 if (list->dw_discr_range)
10326 output_discr_value (&list->dw_discr_upper_bound, name);
10328 break;
10331 default:
10332 gcc_unreachable ();
10336 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, output_die (c));
10338 /* Add null byte to terminate sibling list. */
10339 if (die->die_child != NULL)
10340 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "end of children of DIE %#lx",
10341 (unsigned long) die->die_offset);
10344 /* Output the compilation unit that appears at the beginning of the
10345 .debug_info section, and precedes the DIE descriptions. */
10347 static void
10348 output_compilation_unit_header (enum dwarf_unit_type ut)
10350 if (!XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO)
10352 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
10353 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
10354 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
10355 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE,
10356 next_die_offset - DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE,
10357 "Length of Compilation Unit Info");
10360 dw2_asm_output_data (2, dwarf_version, "DWARF version number");
10361 if (dwarf_version >= 5)
10363 const char *name;
10364 switch (ut)
10366 case DW_UT_compile: name = "DW_UT_compile"; break;
10367 case DW_UT_type: name = "DW_UT_type"; break;
10368 case DW_UT_split_compile: name = "DW_UT_split_compile"; break;
10369 case DW_UT_split_type: name = "DW_UT_split_type"; break;
10370 default: gcc_unreachable ();
10372 dw2_asm_output_data (1, ut, "%s", name);
10373 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Pointer Size (in bytes)");
10375 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, abbrev_section_label,
10376 debug_abbrev_section,
10377 "Offset Into Abbrev. Section");
10378 if (dwarf_version < 5)
10379 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Pointer Size (in bytes)");
10382 /* Output the compilation unit DIE and its children. */
10384 static void
10385 output_comp_unit (dw_die_ref die, int output_if_empty,
10386 const unsigned char *dwo_id)
10388 const char *secname, *oldsym;
10389 char *tmp;
10391 /* Unless we are outputting main CU, we may throw away empty ones. */
10392 if (!output_if_empty && die->die_child == NULL)
10393 return;
10395 /* Even if there are no children of this DIE, we must output the information
10396 about the compilation unit. Otherwise, on an empty translation unit, we
10397 will generate a present, but empty, .debug_info section. IRIX 6.5 `nm'
10398 will then complain when examining the file. First mark all the DIEs in
10399 this CU so we know which get local refs. */
10400 mark_dies (die);
10402 external_ref_hash_type *extern_map = optimize_external_refs (die);
10404 /* For now, optimize only the main CU, in order to optimize the rest
10405 we'd need to see all of them earlier. Leave the rest for post-linking
10406 tools like DWZ. */
10407 if (die == comp_unit_die ())
10408 abbrev_opt_start = vec_safe_length (abbrev_die_table);
10410 build_abbrev_table (die, extern_map);
10412 optimize_abbrev_table ();
10414 delete extern_map;
10416 /* Initialize the beginning DIE offset - and calculate sizes/offsets. */
10417 next_die_offset = (dwo_id
10418 ? DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_SKELETON_HEADER_SIZE
10419 : DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE);
10420 calc_die_sizes (die);
10422 oldsym = die->die_id.die_symbol;
10423 if (oldsym && die->comdat_type_p)
10425 tmp = XALLOCAVEC (char, strlen (oldsym) + 24);
10427 sprintf (tmp, ".gnu.linkonce.wi.%s", oldsym);
10428 secname = tmp;
10429 die->die_id.die_symbol = NULL;
10430 switch_to_section (get_section (secname, SECTION_DEBUG, NULL));
10432 else
10434 switch_to_section (debug_info_section);
10435 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, debug_info_section_label);
10436 info_section_emitted = true;
10439 /* For LTO cross unit DIE refs we want a symbol on the start of the
10440 debuginfo section, not on the CU DIE. */
10441 if ((flag_generate_lto || flag_generate_offload) && oldsym)
10443 /* ??? No way to get visibility assembled without a decl. */
10444 tree decl = build_decl (UNKNOWN_LOCATION, VAR_DECL,
10445 get_identifier (oldsym), char_type_node);
10446 TREE_PUBLIC (decl) = true;
10447 TREE_STATIC (decl) = true;
10448 DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl) = true;
10449 DECL_VISIBILITY (decl) = VISIBILITY_HIDDEN;
10450 DECL_VISIBILITY_SPECIFIED (decl) = true;
10451 targetm.asm_out.assemble_visibility (decl, VISIBILITY_HIDDEN);
10452 #ifdef ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL
10453 /* We prefer a .weak because that handles duplicates from duplicate
10454 archive members in a graceful way. */
10455 ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL (asm_out_file, oldsym);
10456 #else
10457 targetm.asm_out.globalize_label (asm_out_file, oldsym);
10458 #endif
10459 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, oldsym);
10462 /* Output debugging information. */
10463 output_compilation_unit_header (dwo_id
10464 ? DW_UT_split_compile : DW_UT_compile);
10465 if (dwarf_version >= 5)
10467 if (dwo_id != NULL)
10468 for (int i = 0; i < 8; i++)
10469 dw2_asm_output_data (1, dwo_id[i], i == 0 ? "DWO id" : NULL);
10471 output_die (die);
10473 /* Leave the marks on the main CU, so we can check them in
10474 output_pubnames. */
10475 if (oldsym)
10477 unmark_dies (die);
10478 die->die_id.die_symbol = oldsym;
10482 /* Whether to generate the DWARF accelerator tables in .debug_pubnames
10483 and .debug_pubtypes. This is configured per-target, but can be
10484 overridden by the -gpubnames or -gno-pubnames options. */
10486 static inline bool
10487 want_pubnames (void)
10489 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
10490 return false;
10491 if (debug_generate_pub_sections != -1)
10492 return debug_generate_pub_sections;
10493 return targetm.want_debug_pub_sections;
10496 /* Add the DW_AT_GNU_pubnames and DW_AT_GNU_pubtypes attributes. */
10498 static void
10499 add_AT_pubnames (dw_die_ref die)
10501 if (want_pubnames ())
10502 add_AT_flag (die, DW_AT_GNU_pubnames, 1);
10505 /* Add a string attribute value to a skeleton DIE. */
10507 static inline void
10508 add_skeleton_AT_string (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
10509 const char *str)
10511 dw_attr_node attr;
10512 struct indirect_string_node *node;
10514 if (! skeleton_debug_str_hash)
10515 skeleton_debug_str_hash
10516 = hash_table<indirect_string_hasher>::create_ggc (10);
10518 node = find_AT_string_in_table (str, skeleton_debug_str_hash);
10519 find_string_form (node);
10520 if (node->form == DW_FORM_GNU_str_index)
10521 node->form = DW_FORM_strp;
10523 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
10524 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_str;
10525 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
10526 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_str = node;
10527 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
10530 /* Helper function to generate top-level dies for skeleton debug_info and
10531 debug_types. */
10533 static void
10534 add_top_level_skeleton_die_attrs (dw_die_ref die)
10536 const char *dwo_file_name = concat (aux_base_name, ".dwo", NULL);
10537 const char *comp_dir = comp_dir_string ();
10539 add_skeleton_AT_string (die, dwarf_AT (DW_AT_dwo_name), dwo_file_name);
10540 if (comp_dir != NULL)
10541 add_skeleton_AT_string (die, DW_AT_comp_dir, comp_dir);
10542 add_AT_pubnames (die);
10543 add_AT_lineptr (die, DW_AT_GNU_addr_base, debug_addr_section_label);
10546 /* Output skeleton debug sections that point to the dwo file. */
10548 static void
10549 output_skeleton_debug_sections (dw_die_ref comp_unit,
10550 const unsigned char *dwo_id)
10552 /* These attributes will be found in the full debug_info section. */
10553 remove_AT (comp_unit, DW_AT_producer);
10554 remove_AT (comp_unit, DW_AT_language);
10556 switch_to_section (debug_skeleton_info_section);
10557 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, debug_skeleton_info_section_label);
10559 /* Produce the skeleton compilation-unit header. This one differs enough from
10560 a normal CU header that it's better not to call output_compilation_unit
10561 header. */
10562 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
10563 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
10564 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit "
10565 "DWARF extension");
10567 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE,
10568 DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_SKELETON_HEADER_SIZE
10569 - DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE
10570 + size_of_die (comp_unit),
10571 "Length of Compilation Unit Info");
10572 dw2_asm_output_data (2, dwarf_version, "DWARF version number");
10573 if (dwarf_version >= 5)
10575 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_UT_skeleton, "DW_UT_skeleton");
10576 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Pointer Size (in bytes)");
10578 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, debug_skeleton_abbrev_section_label,
10579 debug_skeleton_abbrev_section,
10580 "Offset Into Abbrev. Section");
10581 if (dwarf_version < 5)
10582 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Pointer Size (in bytes)");
10583 else
10584 for (int i = 0; i < 8; i++)
10585 dw2_asm_output_data (1, dwo_id[i], i == 0 ? "DWO id" : NULL);
10587 comp_unit->die_abbrev = SKELETON_COMP_DIE_ABBREV;
10588 output_die (comp_unit);
10590 /* Build the skeleton debug_abbrev section. */
10591 switch_to_section (debug_skeleton_abbrev_section);
10592 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, debug_skeleton_abbrev_section_label);
10594 output_die_abbrevs (SKELETON_COMP_DIE_ABBREV, comp_unit);
10596 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "end of skeleton .debug_abbrev");
10599 /* Output a comdat type unit DIE and its children. */
10601 static void
10602 output_comdat_type_unit (comdat_type_node *node)
10604 const char *secname;
10605 char *tmp;
10606 int i;
10607 #if defined (OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF)
10608 tree comdat_key;
10609 #endif
10611 /* First mark all the DIEs in this CU so we know which get local refs. */
10612 mark_dies (node->root_die);
10614 external_ref_hash_type *extern_map = optimize_external_refs (node->root_die);
10616 build_abbrev_table (node->root_die, extern_map);
10618 delete extern_map;
10619 extern_map = NULL;
10621 /* Initialize the beginning DIE offset - and calculate sizes/offsets. */
10622 next_die_offset = DWARF_COMDAT_TYPE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE;
10623 calc_die_sizes (node->root_die);
10625 #if defined (OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF)
10626 if (dwarf_version >= 5)
10628 if (!dwarf_split_debug_info)
10629 secname = ".debug_info";
10630 else
10631 secname = ".debug_info.dwo";
10633 else if (!dwarf_split_debug_info)
10634 secname = ".debug_types";
10635 else
10636 secname = ".debug_types.dwo";
10638 tmp = XALLOCAVEC (char, 4 + DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE * 2);
10639 sprintf (tmp, dwarf_version >= 5 ? "wi." : "wt.");
10640 for (i = 0; i < DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE; i++)
10641 sprintf (tmp + 3 + i * 2, "%02x", node->signature[i] & 0xff);
10642 comdat_key = get_identifier (tmp);
10643 targetm.asm_out.named_section (secname,
10644 SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_LINKONCE,
10645 comdat_key);
10646 #else
10647 tmp = XALLOCAVEC (char, 18 + DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE * 2);
10648 sprintf (tmp, (dwarf_version >= 5
10649 ? ".gnu.linkonce.wi." : ".gnu.linkonce.wt."));
10650 for (i = 0; i < DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE; i++)
10651 sprintf (tmp + 17 + i * 2, "%02x", node->signature[i] & 0xff);
10652 secname = tmp;
10653 switch_to_section (get_section (secname, SECTION_DEBUG, NULL));
10654 #endif
10656 /* Output debugging information. */
10657 output_compilation_unit_header (dwarf_split_debug_info
10658 ? DW_UT_split_type : DW_UT_type);
10659 output_signature (node->signature, "Type Signature");
10660 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, node->type_die->die_offset,
10661 "Offset to Type DIE");
10662 output_die (node->root_die);
10664 unmark_dies (node->root_die);
10667 /* Return the DWARF2/3 pubname associated with a decl. */
10669 static const char *
10670 dwarf2_name (tree decl, int scope)
10672 if (DECL_NAMELESS (decl))
10673 return NULL;
10674 return lang_hooks.dwarf_name (decl, scope ? 1 : 0);
10677 /* Add a new entry to .debug_pubnames if appropriate. */
10679 static void
10680 add_pubname_string (const char *str, dw_die_ref die)
10682 pubname_entry e;
10684 e.die = die;
10685 e.name = xstrdup (str);
10686 vec_safe_push (pubname_table, e);
10689 static void
10690 add_pubname (tree decl, dw_die_ref die)
10692 if (!want_pubnames ())
10693 return;
10695 /* Don't add items to the table when we expect that the consumer will have
10696 just read the enclosing die. For example, if the consumer is looking at a
10697 class_member, it will either be inside the class already, or will have just
10698 looked up the class to find the member. Either way, searching the class is
10699 faster than searching the index. */
10700 if ((TREE_PUBLIC (decl) && !class_scope_p (die->die_parent))
10701 || is_cu_die (die->die_parent) || is_namespace_die (die->die_parent))
10703 const char *name = dwarf2_name (decl, 1);
10705 if (name)
10706 add_pubname_string (name, die);
10710 /* Add an enumerator to the pubnames section. */
10712 static void
10713 add_enumerator_pubname (const char *scope_name, dw_die_ref die)
10715 pubname_entry e;
10717 gcc_assert (scope_name);
10718 e.name = concat (scope_name, get_AT_string (die, DW_AT_name), NULL);
10719 e.die = die;
10720 vec_safe_push (pubname_table, e);
10723 /* Add a new entry to .debug_pubtypes if appropriate. */
10725 static void
10726 add_pubtype (tree decl, dw_die_ref die)
10728 pubname_entry e;
10730 if (!want_pubnames ())
10731 return;
10733 if ((TREE_PUBLIC (decl)
10734 || is_cu_die (die->die_parent) || is_namespace_die (die->die_parent))
10735 && (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_typedef || COMPLETE_TYPE_P (decl)))
10737 tree scope = NULL;
10738 const char *scope_name = "";
10739 const char *sep = is_cxx () ? "::" : ".";
10740 const char *name;
10742 scope = TYPE_P (decl) ? TYPE_CONTEXT (decl) : NULL;
10743 if (scope && TREE_CODE (scope) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
10745 scope_name = lang_hooks.dwarf_name (scope, 1);
10746 if (scope_name != NULL && scope_name[0] != '\0')
10747 scope_name = concat (scope_name, sep, NULL);
10748 else
10749 scope_name = "";
10752 if (TYPE_P (decl))
10753 name = type_tag (decl);
10754 else
10755 name = lang_hooks.dwarf_name (decl, 1);
10757 /* If we don't have a name for the type, there's no point in adding
10758 it to the table. */
10759 if (name != NULL && name[0] != '\0')
10761 e.die = die;
10762 e.name = concat (scope_name, name, NULL);
10763 vec_safe_push (pubtype_table, e);
10766 /* Although it might be more consistent to add the pubinfo for the
10767 enumerators as their dies are created, they should only be added if the
10768 enum type meets the criteria above. So rather than re-check the parent
10769 enum type whenever an enumerator die is created, just output them all
10770 here. This isn't protected by the name conditional because anonymous
10771 enums don't have names. */
10772 if (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_enumeration_type)
10774 dw_die_ref c;
10776 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, add_enumerator_pubname (scope_name, c));
10781 /* Output a single entry in the pubnames table. */
10783 static void
10784 output_pubname (dw_offset die_offset, pubname_entry *entry)
10786 dw_die_ref die = entry->die;
10787 int is_static = get_AT_flag (die, DW_AT_external) ? 0 : 1;
10789 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, die_offset, "DIE offset");
10791 if (debug_generate_pub_sections == 2)
10793 /* This logic follows gdb's method for determining the value of the flag
10794 byte. */
10795 uint32_t flags = GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_NONE;
10796 switch (die->die_tag)
10798 case DW_TAG_typedef:
10799 case DW_TAG_base_type:
10800 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
10801 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_SET_VALUE(flags, GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_TYPE);
10802 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_STATIC_SET_VALUE(flags, 1);
10803 break;
10804 case DW_TAG_enumerator:
10805 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_SET_VALUE(flags,
10806 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_VARIABLE);
10807 if (!is_cxx ())
10808 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_STATIC_SET_VALUE(flags, 1);
10809 break;
10810 case DW_TAG_subprogram:
10811 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_SET_VALUE(flags,
10812 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_FUNCTION);
10813 if (!is_ada ())
10814 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_STATIC_SET_VALUE(flags, is_static);
10815 break;
10816 case DW_TAG_constant:
10817 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_SET_VALUE(flags,
10818 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_VARIABLE);
10819 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_STATIC_SET_VALUE(flags, is_static);
10820 break;
10821 case DW_TAG_variable:
10822 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_SET_VALUE(flags,
10823 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_VARIABLE);
10824 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_STATIC_SET_VALUE(flags, is_static);
10825 break;
10826 case DW_TAG_namespace:
10827 case DW_TAG_imported_declaration:
10828 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_SET_VALUE(flags, GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_TYPE);
10829 break;
10830 case DW_TAG_class_type:
10831 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
10832 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
10833 case DW_TAG_union_type:
10834 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
10835 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_SET_VALUE(flags, GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_TYPE);
10836 if (!is_cxx ())
10837 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_STATIC_SET_VALUE(flags, 1);
10838 break;
10839 default:
10840 /* An unusual tag. Leave the flag-byte empty. */
10841 break;
10843 dw2_asm_output_data (1, flags >> GDB_INDEX_CU_BITSIZE,
10844 "GDB-index flags");
10847 dw2_asm_output_nstring (entry->name, -1, "external name");
10851 /* Output the public names table used to speed up access to externally
10852 visible names; or the public types table used to find type definitions. */
10854 static void
10855 output_pubnames (vec<pubname_entry, va_gc> *names)
10857 unsigned i;
10858 unsigned long pubnames_length = size_of_pubnames (names);
10859 pubname_entry *pub;
10861 if (!XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO)
10863 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
10864 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
10865 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
10866 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, pubnames_length,
10867 "Pub Info Length");
10870 /* Version number for pubnames/pubtypes is independent of dwarf version. */
10871 dw2_asm_output_data (2, 2, "DWARF Version");
10873 if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
10874 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, debug_skeleton_info_section_label,
10875 debug_skeleton_info_section,
10876 "Offset of Compilation Unit Info");
10877 else
10878 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, debug_info_section_label,
10879 debug_info_section,
10880 "Offset of Compilation Unit Info");
10881 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, next_die_offset,
10882 "Compilation Unit Length");
10884 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*names, i, pub)
10886 if (include_pubname_in_output (names, pub))
10888 dw_offset die_offset = pub->die->die_offset;
10890 /* We shouldn't see pubnames for DIEs outside of the main CU. */
10891 if (names == pubname_table && pub->die->die_tag != DW_TAG_enumerator)
10892 gcc_assert (pub->die->die_mark);
10894 /* If we're putting types in their own .debug_types sections,
10895 the .debug_pubtypes table will still point to the compile
10896 unit (not the type unit), so we want to use the offset of
10897 the skeleton DIE (if there is one). */
10898 if (pub->die->comdat_type_p && names == pubtype_table)
10900 comdat_type_node *type_node = pub->die->die_id.die_type_node;
10902 if (type_node != NULL)
10903 die_offset = (type_node->skeleton_die != NULL
10904 ? type_node->skeleton_die->die_offset
10905 : comp_unit_die ()->die_offset);
10908 output_pubname (die_offset, pub);
10912 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, 0, NULL);
10915 /* Output public names and types tables if necessary. */
10917 static void
10918 output_pubtables (void)
10920 if (!want_pubnames () || !info_section_emitted)
10921 return;
10923 switch_to_section (debug_pubnames_section);
10924 output_pubnames (pubname_table);
10925 /* ??? Only defined by DWARF3, but emitted by Darwin for DWARF2.
10926 It shouldn't hurt to emit it always, since pure DWARF2 consumers
10927 simply won't look for the section. */
10928 switch_to_section (debug_pubtypes_section);
10929 output_pubnames (pubtype_table);
10933 /* Output the information that goes into the .debug_aranges table.
10934 Namely, define the beginning and ending address range of the
10935 text section generated for this compilation unit. */
10937 static void
10938 output_aranges (void)
10940 unsigned i;
10941 unsigned long aranges_length = size_of_aranges ();
10943 if (!XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO)
10945 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
10946 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
10947 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
10948 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, aranges_length,
10949 "Length of Address Ranges Info");
10952 /* Version number for aranges is still 2, even up to DWARF5. */
10953 dw2_asm_output_data (2, 2, "DWARF Version");
10954 if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
10955 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, debug_skeleton_info_section_label,
10956 debug_skeleton_info_section,
10957 "Offset of Compilation Unit Info");
10958 else
10959 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, debug_info_section_label,
10960 debug_info_section,
10961 "Offset of Compilation Unit Info");
10962 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Size of Address");
10963 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "Size of Segment Descriptor");
10965 /* We need to align to twice the pointer size here. */
10966 if (DWARF_ARANGES_PAD_SIZE)
10968 /* Pad using a 2 byte words so that padding is correct for any
10969 pointer size. */
10970 dw2_asm_output_data (2, 0, "Pad to %d byte boundary",
10971 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
10972 for (i = 2; i < (unsigned) DWARF_ARANGES_PAD_SIZE; i += 2)
10973 dw2_asm_output_data (2, 0, NULL);
10976 /* It is necessary not to output these entries if the sections were
10977 not used; if the sections were not used, the length will be 0 and
10978 the address may end up as 0 if the section is discarded by ld
10979 --gc-sections, leaving an invalid (0, 0) entry that can be
10980 confused with the terminator. */
10981 if (text_section_used)
10983 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, text_section_label, "Address");
10984 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, text_end_label,
10985 text_section_label, "Length");
10987 if (cold_text_section_used)
10989 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, cold_text_section_label,
10990 "Address");
10991 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, cold_end_label,
10992 cold_text_section_label, "Length");
10995 if (have_multiple_function_sections)
10997 unsigned fde_idx;
10998 dw_fde_ref fde;
11000 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*fde_vec, fde_idx, fde)
11002 if (DECL_IGNORED_P (fde->decl))
11003 continue;
11004 if (!fde->in_std_section)
11006 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, fde->dw_fde_begin,
11007 "Address");
11008 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, fde->dw_fde_end,
11009 fde->dw_fde_begin, "Length");
11011 if (fde->dw_fde_second_begin && !fde->second_in_std_section)
11013 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, fde->dw_fde_second_begin,
11014 "Address");
11015 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, fde->dw_fde_second_end,
11016 fde->dw_fde_second_begin, "Length");
11021 /* Output the terminator words. */
11022 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
11023 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
11026 /* Add a new entry to .debug_ranges. Return its index into
11027 ranges_table vector. */
11029 static unsigned int
11030 add_ranges_num (int num, bool maybe_new_sec)
11032 dw_ranges r = { NULL, num, 0, maybe_new_sec };
11033 vec_safe_push (ranges_table, r);
11034 return vec_safe_length (ranges_table) - 1;
11037 /* Add a new entry to .debug_ranges corresponding to a block, or a
11038 range terminator if BLOCK is NULL. MAYBE_NEW_SEC is true if
11039 this entry might be in a different section from previous range. */
11041 static unsigned int
11042 add_ranges (const_tree block, bool maybe_new_sec)
11044 return add_ranges_num (block ? BLOCK_NUMBER (block) : 0, maybe_new_sec);
11047 /* Note that (*rnglist_table)[offset] is either a head of a rnglist
11048 chain, or middle entry of a chain that will be directly referred to. */
11050 static void
11051 note_rnglist_head (unsigned int offset)
11053 if (dwarf_version < 5 || (*ranges_table)[offset].label)
11054 return;
11055 (*ranges_table)[offset].label = gen_internal_sym ("LLRL");
11058 /* Add a new entry to .debug_ranges corresponding to a pair of labels.
11059 When using dwarf_split_debug_info, address attributes in dies destined
11060 for the final executable should be direct references--setting the
11061 parameter force_direct ensures this behavior. */
11063 static void
11064 add_ranges_by_labels (dw_die_ref die, const char *begin, const char *end,
11065 bool *added, bool force_direct)
11067 unsigned int in_use = vec_safe_length (ranges_by_label);
11068 unsigned int offset;
11069 dw_ranges_by_label rbl = { begin, end };
11070 vec_safe_push (ranges_by_label, rbl);
11071 offset = add_ranges_num (-(int)in_use - 1, true);
11072 if (!*added)
11074 add_AT_range_list (die, DW_AT_ranges, offset, force_direct);
11075 *added = true;
11076 note_rnglist_head (offset);
11080 /* Emit .debug_ranges section. */
11082 static void
11083 output_ranges (void)
11085 unsigned i;
11086 static const char *const start_fmt = "Offset %#x";
11087 const char *fmt = start_fmt;
11088 dw_ranges *r;
11090 switch_to_section (debug_ranges_section);
11091 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, ranges_section_label);
11092 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (ranges_table, i, r)
11094 int block_num = r->num;
11096 if (block_num > 0)
11098 char blabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
11099 char elabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
11101 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (blabel, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL, block_num);
11102 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (elabel, BLOCK_END_LABEL, block_num);
11104 /* If all code is in the text section, then the compilation
11105 unit base address defaults to DW_AT_low_pc, which is the
11106 base of the text section. */
11107 if (!have_multiple_function_sections)
11109 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, blabel,
11110 text_section_label,
11111 fmt, i * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
11112 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, elabel,
11113 text_section_label, NULL);
11116 /* Otherwise, the compilation unit base address is zero,
11117 which allows us to use absolute addresses, and not worry
11118 about whether the target supports cross-section
11119 arithmetic. */
11120 else
11122 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, blabel,
11123 fmt, i * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
11124 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, elabel, NULL);
11127 fmt = NULL;
11130 /* Negative block_num stands for an index into ranges_by_label. */
11131 else if (block_num < 0)
11133 int lab_idx = - block_num - 1;
11135 if (!have_multiple_function_sections)
11137 gcc_unreachable ();
11138 #if 0
11139 /* If we ever use add_ranges_by_labels () for a single
11140 function section, all we have to do is to take out
11141 the #if 0 above. */
11142 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
11143 (*ranges_by_label)[lab_idx].begin,
11144 text_section_label,
11145 fmt, i * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
11146 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
11147 (*ranges_by_label)[lab_idx].end,
11148 text_section_label, NULL);
11149 #endif
11151 else
11153 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
11154 (*ranges_by_label)[lab_idx].begin,
11155 fmt, i * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
11156 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
11157 (*ranges_by_label)[lab_idx].end,
11158 NULL);
11161 else
11163 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
11164 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
11165 fmt = start_fmt;
11170 /* Non-zero if .debug_line_str should be used for .debug_line section
11171 strings or strings that are likely shareable with those. */
11172 #define DWARF5_USE_DEBUG_LINE_STR \
11173 (!DWARF2_INDIRECT_STRING_SUPPORT_MISSING_ON_TARGET \
11174 && (DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS & SECTION_MERGE) != 0 \
11175 /* FIXME: there is no .debug_line_str.dwo section, \
11176 for -gsplit-dwarf we should use DW_FORM_strx instead. */ \
11177 && !dwarf_split_debug_info)
11179 /* Assign .debug_rnglists indexes. */
11181 static void
11182 index_rnglists (void)
11184 unsigned i;
11185 dw_ranges *r;
11187 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (ranges_table, i, r)
11188 if (r->label)
11189 r->idx = rnglist_idx++;
11192 /* Emit .debug_rnglists section. */
11194 static void
11195 output_rnglists (void)
11197 unsigned i;
11198 dw_ranges *r;
11199 char l1[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
11200 char l2[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
11201 char basebuf[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
11203 switch_to_section (debug_ranges_section);
11204 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, ranges_section_label);
11205 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL, 2);
11206 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l2, DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL, 3);
11207 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
11208 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
11209 "Initial length escape value indicating "
11210 "64-bit DWARF extension");
11211 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l2, l1,
11212 "Length of Range Lists");
11213 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l1);
11214 dw2_asm_output_data (2, dwarf_version, "DWARF Version");
11215 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Address Size");
11216 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "Segment Size");
11217 /* Emit the offset table only for -gsplit-dwarf. If we don't care
11218 about relocation sizes and primarily care about the size of .debug*
11219 sections in linked shared libraries and executables, then
11220 the offset table plus corresponding DW_FORM_rnglistx uleb128 indexes
11221 into it are usually larger than just DW_FORM_sec_offset offsets
11222 into the .debug_rnglists section. */
11223 dw2_asm_output_data (4, dwarf_split_debug_info ? rnglist_idx : 0,
11224 "Offset Entry Count");
11225 if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
11227 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, ranges_base_label);
11228 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (ranges_table, i, r)
11229 if (r->label)
11230 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, r->label,
11231 ranges_base_label, NULL);
11234 const char *lab = "";
11235 unsigned int len = vec_safe_length (ranges_table);
11236 const char *base = NULL;
11237 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (ranges_table, i, r)
11239 int block_num = r->num;
11241 if (r->label)
11243 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, r->label);
11244 lab = r->label;
11246 if (HAVE_AS_LEB128 && (r->label || r->maybe_new_sec))
11247 base = NULL;
11248 if (block_num > 0)
11250 char blabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
11251 char elabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
11253 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (blabel, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL, block_num);
11254 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (elabel, BLOCK_END_LABEL, block_num);
11256 if (HAVE_AS_LEB128)
11258 /* If all code is in the text section, then the compilation
11259 unit base address defaults to DW_AT_low_pc, which is the
11260 base of the text section. */
11261 if (!have_multiple_function_sections)
11263 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_RLE_offset_pair,
11264 "DW_RLE_offset_pair (%s)", lab);
11265 dw2_asm_output_delta_uleb128 (blabel, text_section_label,
11266 "Range begin address (%s)", lab);
11267 dw2_asm_output_delta_uleb128 (elabel, text_section_label,
11268 "Range end address (%s)", lab);
11269 continue;
11271 if (base == NULL)
11273 dw_ranges *r2 = NULL;
11274 if (i < len - 1)
11275 r2 = &(*ranges_table)[i + 1];
11276 if (r2
11277 && r2->num != 0
11278 && r2->label == NULL
11279 && !r2->maybe_new_sec)
11281 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_RLE_base_address,
11282 "DW_RLE_base_address (%s)", lab);
11283 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, blabel,
11284 "Base address (%s)", lab);
11285 strcpy (basebuf, blabel);
11286 base = basebuf;
11289 if (base)
11291 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_RLE_offset_pair,
11292 "DW_RLE_offset_pair (%s)", lab);
11293 dw2_asm_output_delta_uleb128 (blabel, base,
11294 "Range begin address (%s)", lab);
11295 dw2_asm_output_delta_uleb128 (elabel, base,
11296 "Range end address (%s)", lab);
11297 continue;
11299 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_RLE_start_length,
11300 "DW_RLE_start_length (%s)", lab);
11301 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, blabel,
11302 "Range begin address (%s)", lab);
11303 dw2_asm_output_delta_uleb128 (elabel, blabel,
11304 "Range length (%s)", lab);
11306 else
11308 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_RLE_start_end,
11309 "DW_RLE_start_end (%s)", lab);
11310 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, blabel,
11311 "Range begin address (%s)", lab);
11312 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, elabel,
11313 "Range end address (%s)", lab);
11317 /* Negative block_num stands for an index into ranges_by_label. */
11318 else if (block_num < 0)
11320 int lab_idx = - block_num - 1;
11321 const char *blabel = (*ranges_by_label)[lab_idx].begin;
11322 const char *elabel = (*ranges_by_label)[lab_idx].end;
11324 if (!have_multiple_function_sections)
11325 gcc_unreachable ();
11326 if (HAVE_AS_LEB128)
11328 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_RLE_start_length,
11329 "DW_RLE_start_length (%s)", lab);
11330 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, blabel,
11331 "Range begin address (%s)", lab);
11332 dw2_asm_output_delta_uleb128 (elabel, blabel,
11333 "Range length (%s)", lab);
11335 else
11337 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_RLE_start_end,
11338 "DW_RLE_start_end (%s)", lab);
11339 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, blabel,
11340 "Range begin address (%s)", lab);
11341 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, elabel,
11342 "Range end address (%s)", lab);
11345 else
11346 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_RLE_end_of_list,
11347 "DW_RLE_end_of_list (%s)", lab);
11349 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
11352 /* Data structure containing information about input files. */
11353 struct file_info
11355 const char *path; /* Complete file name. */
11356 const char *fname; /* File name part. */
11357 int length; /* Length of entire string. */
11358 struct dwarf_file_data * file_idx; /* Index in input file table. */
11359 int dir_idx; /* Index in directory table. */
11362 /* Data structure containing information about directories with source
11363 files. */
11364 struct dir_info
11366 const char *path; /* Path including directory name. */
11367 int length; /* Path length. */
11368 int prefix; /* Index of directory entry which is a prefix. */
11369 int count; /* Number of files in this directory. */
11370 int dir_idx; /* Index of directory used as base. */
11373 /* Callback function for file_info comparison. We sort by looking at
11374 the directories in the path. */
11376 static int
11377 file_info_cmp (const void *p1, const void *p2)
11379 const struct file_info *const s1 = (const struct file_info *) p1;
11380 const struct file_info *const s2 = (const struct file_info *) p2;
11381 const unsigned char *cp1;
11382 const unsigned char *cp2;
11384 /* Take care of file names without directories. We need to make sure that
11385 we return consistent values to qsort since some will get confused if
11386 we return the same value when identical operands are passed in opposite
11387 orders. So if neither has a directory, return 0 and otherwise return
11388 1 or -1 depending on which one has the directory. */
11389 if ((s1->path == s1->fname || s2->path == s2->fname))
11390 return (s2->path == s2->fname) - (s1->path == s1->fname);
11392 cp1 = (const unsigned char *) s1->path;
11393 cp2 = (const unsigned char *) s2->path;
11395 while (1)
11397 ++cp1;
11398 ++cp2;
11399 /* Reached the end of the first path? If so, handle like above. */
11400 if ((cp1 == (const unsigned char *) s1->fname)
11401 || (cp2 == (const unsigned char *) s2->fname))
11402 return ((cp2 == (const unsigned char *) s2->fname)
11403 - (cp1 == (const unsigned char *) s1->fname));
11405 /* Character of current path component the same? */
11406 else if (*cp1 != *cp2)
11407 return *cp1 - *cp2;
11411 struct file_name_acquire_data
11413 struct file_info *files;
11414 int used_files;
11415 int max_files;
11418 /* Traversal function for the hash table. */
11421 file_name_acquire (dwarf_file_data **slot, file_name_acquire_data *fnad)
11423 struct dwarf_file_data *d = *slot;
11424 struct file_info *fi;
11425 const char *f;
11427 gcc_assert (fnad->max_files >= d->emitted_number);
11429 if (! d->emitted_number)
11430 return 1;
11432 gcc_assert (fnad->max_files != fnad->used_files);
11434 fi = fnad->files + fnad->used_files++;
11436 /* Skip all leading "./". */
11437 f = d->filename;
11438 while (f[0] == '.' && IS_DIR_SEPARATOR (f[1]))
11439 f += 2;
11441 /* Create a new array entry. */
11442 fi->path = f;
11443 fi->length = strlen (f);
11444 fi->file_idx = d;
11446 /* Search for the file name part. */
11447 f = strrchr (f, DIR_SEPARATOR);
11448 #if defined (DIR_SEPARATOR_2)
11450 char *g = strrchr (fi->path, DIR_SEPARATOR_2);
11452 if (g != NULL)
11454 if (f == NULL || f < g)
11455 f = g;
11458 #endif
11460 fi->fname = f == NULL ? fi->path : f + 1;
11461 return 1;
11464 /* Helper function for output_file_names. Emit a FORM encoded
11465 string STR, with assembly comment start ENTRY_KIND and
11466 index IDX */
11468 static void
11469 output_line_string (enum dwarf_form form, const char *str,
11470 const char *entry_kind, unsigned int idx)
11472 switch (form)
11474 case DW_FORM_string:
11475 dw2_asm_output_nstring (str, -1, "%s: %#x", entry_kind, idx);
11476 break;
11477 case DW_FORM_line_strp:
11478 if (!debug_line_str_hash)
11479 debug_line_str_hash
11480 = hash_table<indirect_string_hasher>::create_ggc (10);
11482 struct indirect_string_node *node;
11483 node = find_AT_string_in_table (str, debug_line_str_hash);
11484 set_indirect_string (node);
11485 node->form = form;
11486 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, node->label,
11487 debug_line_str_section, "%s: %#x: \"%s\"",
11488 entry_kind, 0, node->str);
11489 break;
11490 default:
11491 gcc_unreachable ();
11495 /* Output the directory table and the file name table. We try to minimize
11496 the total amount of memory needed. A heuristic is used to avoid large
11497 slowdowns with many input files. */
11499 static void
11500 output_file_names (void)
11502 struct file_name_acquire_data fnad;
11503 int numfiles;
11504 struct file_info *files;
11505 struct dir_info *dirs;
11506 int *saved;
11507 int *savehere;
11508 int *backmap;
11509 int ndirs;
11510 int idx_offset;
11511 int i;
11513 if (!last_emitted_file)
11515 if (dwarf_version >= 5)
11517 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "Directory entry format count");
11518 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, "Directories count");
11519 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "File name entry format count");
11520 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, "File names count");
11522 else
11524 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End directory table");
11525 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End file name table");
11527 return;
11530 numfiles = last_emitted_file->emitted_number;
11532 /* Allocate the various arrays we need. */
11533 files = XALLOCAVEC (struct file_info, numfiles);
11534 dirs = XALLOCAVEC (struct dir_info, numfiles);
11536 fnad.files = files;
11537 fnad.used_files = 0;
11538 fnad.max_files = numfiles;
11539 file_table->traverse<file_name_acquire_data *, file_name_acquire> (&fnad);
11540 gcc_assert (fnad.used_files == fnad.max_files);
11542 qsort (files, numfiles, sizeof (files[0]), file_info_cmp);
11544 /* Find all the different directories used. */
11545 dirs[0].path = files[0].path;
11546 dirs[0].length = files[0].fname - files[0].path;
11547 dirs[0].prefix = -1;
11548 dirs[0].count = 1;
11549 dirs[0].dir_idx = 0;
11550 files[0].dir_idx = 0;
11551 ndirs = 1;
11553 for (i = 1; i < numfiles; i++)
11554 if (files[i].fname - files[i].path == dirs[ndirs - 1].length
11555 && memcmp (dirs[ndirs - 1].path, files[i].path,
11556 dirs[ndirs - 1].length) == 0)
11558 /* Same directory as last entry. */
11559 files[i].dir_idx = ndirs - 1;
11560 ++dirs[ndirs - 1].count;
11562 else
11564 int j;
11566 /* This is a new directory. */
11567 dirs[ndirs].path = files[i].path;
11568 dirs[ndirs].length = files[i].fname - files[i].path;
11569 dirs[ndirs].count = 1;
11570 dirs[ndirs].dir_idx = ndirs;
11571 files[i].dir_idx = ndirs;
11573 /* Search for a prefix. */
11574 dirs[ndirs].prefix = -1;
11575 for (j = 0; j < ndirs; j++)
11576 if (dirs[j].length < dirs[ndirs].length
11577 && dirs[j].length > 1
11578 && (dirs[ndirs].prefix == -1
11579 || dirs[j].length > dirs[dirs[ndirs].prefix].length)
11580 && memcmp (dirs[j].path, dirs[ndirs].path, dirs[j].length) == 0)
11581 dirs[ndirs].prefix = j;
11583 ++ndirs;
11586 /* Now to the actual work. We have to find a subset of the directories which
11587 allow expressing the file name using references to the directory table
11588 with the least amount of characters. We do not do an exhaustive search
11589 where we would have to check out every combination of every single
11590 possible prefix. Instead we use a heuristic which provides nearly optimal
11591 results in most cases and never is much off. */
11592 saved = XALLOCAVEC (int, ndirs);
11593 savehere = XALLOCAVEC (int, ndirs);
11595 memset (saved, '\0', ndirs * sizeof (saved[0]));
11596 for (i = 0; i < ndirs; i++)
11598 int j;
11599 int total;
11601 /* We can always save some space for the current directory. But this
11602 does not mean it will be enough to justify adding the directory. */
11603 savehere[i] = dirs[i].length;
11604 total = (savehere[i] - saved[i]) * dirs[i].count;
11606 for (j = i + 1; j < ndirs; j++)
11608 savehere[j] = 0;
11609 if (saved[j] < dirs[i].length)
11611 /* Determine whether the dirs[i] path is a prefix of the
11612 dirs[j] path. */
11613 int k;
11615 k = dirs[j].prefix;
11616 while (k != -1 && k != (int) i)
11617 k = dirs[k].prefix;
11619 if (k == (int) i)
11621 /* Yes it is. We can possibly save some memory by
11622 writing the filenames in dirs[j] relative to
11623 dirs[i]. */
11624 savehere[j] = dirs[i].length;
11625 total += (savehere[j] - saved[j]) * dirs[j].count;
11630 /* Check whether we can save enough to justify adding the dirs[i]
11631 directory. */
11632 if (total > dirs[i].length + 1)
11634 /* It's worthwhile adding. */
11635 for (j = i; j < ndirs; j++)
11636 if (savehere[j] > 0)
11638 /* Remember how much we saved for this directory so far. */
11639 saved[j] = savehere[j];
11641 /* Remember the prefix directory. */
11642 dirs[j].dir_idx = i;
11647 /* Emit the directory name table. */
11648 idx_offset = dirs[0].length > 0 ? 1 : 0;
11649 enum dwarf_form str_form = DW_FORM_string;
11650 enum dwarf_form idx_form = DW_FORM_udata;
11651 if (dwarf_version >= 5)
11653 const char *comp_dir = comp_dir_string ();
11654 if (comp_dir == NULL)
11655 comp_dir = "";
11656 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 1, "Directory entry format count");
11657 if (DWARF5_USE_DEBUG_LINE_STR)
11658 str_form = DW_FORM_line_strp;
11659 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (DW_LNCT_path, "DW_LNCT_path");
11660 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (str_form, "%s",
11661 get_DW_FORM_name (str_form));
11662 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (ndirs + idx_offset, "Directories count");
11663 if (str_form == DW_FORM_string)
11665 dw2_asm_output_nstring (comp_dir, -1, "Directory Entry: %#x", 0);
11666 for (i = 1 - idx_offset; i < ndirs; i++)
11667 dw2_asm_output_nstring (dirs[i].path,
11668 dirs[i].length
11669 - !DWARF2_DIR_SHOULD_END_WITH_SEPARATOR,
11670 "Directory Entry: %#x", i + idx_offset);
11672 else
11674 output_line_string (str_form, comp_dir, "Directory Entry", 0);
11675 for (i = 1 - idx_offset; i < ndirs; i++)
11677 const char *str
11678 = ggc_alloc_string (dirs[i].path,
11679 dirs[i].length
11680 - !DWARF2_DIR_SHOULD_END_WITH_SEPARATOR);
11681 output_line_string (str_form, str, "Directory Entry",
11682 (unsigned) i + idx_offset);
11686 else
11688 for (i = 1 - idx_offset; i < ndirs; i++)
11689 dw2_asm_output_nstring (dirs[i].path,
11690 dirs[i].length
11691 - !DWARF2_DIR_SHOULD_END_WITH_SEPARATOR,
11692 "Directory Entry: %#x", i + idx_offset);
11694 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End directory table");
11697 /* We have to emit them in the order of emitted_number since that's
11698 used in the debug info generation. To do this efficiently we
11699 generate a back-mapping of the indices first. */
11700 backmap = XALLOCAVEC (int, numfiles);
11701 for (i = 0; i < numfiles; i++)
11702 backmap[files[i].file_idx->emitted_number - 1] = i;
11704 if (dwarf_version >= 5)
11706 const char *filename0 = get_AT_string (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_name);
11707 if (filename0 == NULL)
11708 filename0 = "";
11709 /* DW_LNCT_directory_index can use DW_FORM_udata, DW_FORM_data1 and
11710 DW_FORM_data2. Choose one based on the number of directories
11711 and how much space would they occupy in each encoding.
11712 If we have at most 256 directories, all indexes fit into
11713 a single byte, so DW_FORM_data1 is most compact (if there
11714 are at most 128 directories, DW_FORM_udata would be as
11715 compact as that, but not shorter and slower to decode). */
11716 if (ndirs + idx_offset <= 256)
11717 idx_form = DW_FORM_data1;
11718 /* If there are more than 65536 directories, we have to use
11719 DW_FORM_udata, DW_FORM_data2 can't refer to them.
11720 Otherwise, compute what space would occupy if all the indexes
11721 used DW_FORM_udata - sum - and compare that to how large would
11722 be DW_FORM_data2 encoding, and pick the more efficient one. */
11723 else if (ndirs + idx_offset <= 65536)
11725 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT sum = 1;
11726 for (i = 0; i < numfiles; i++)
11728 int file_idx = backmap[i];
11729 int dir_idx = dirs[files[file_idx].dir_idx].dir_idx;
11730 sum += size_of_uleb128 (dir_idx);
11732 if (sum >= HOST_WIDE_INT_UC (2) * (numfiles + 1))
11733 idx_form = DW_FORM_data2;
11735 #ifdef VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
11736 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 4, "File name entry format count");
11737 #else
11738 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 2, "File name entry format count");
11739 #endif
11740 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (DW_LNCT_path, "DW_LNCT_path");
11741 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (str_form, "%s",
11742 get_DW_FORM_name (str_form));
11743 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (DW_LNCT_directory_index,
11744 "DW_LNCT_directory_index");
11745 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (idx_form, "%s",
11746 get_DW_FORM_name (idx_form));
11747 #ifdef VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
11748 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (DW_LNCT_timestamp, "DW_LNCT_timestamp");
11749 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (DW_FORM_udata, "DW_FORM_udata");
11750 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (DW_LNCT_size, "DW_LNCT_size");
11751 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (DW_FORM_udata, "DW_FORM_udata");
11752 #endif
11753 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (numfiles + 1, "File names count");
11755 output_line_string (str_form, filename0, "File Entry", 0);
11757 /* Include directory index. */
11758 if (idx_form != DW_FORM_udata)
11759 dw2_asm_output_data (idx_form == DW_FORM_data1 ? 1 : 2,
11760 0, NULL);
11761 else
11762 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, NULL);
11764 #ifdef VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
11765 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, NULL);
11766 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, NULL);
11767 #endif
11770 /* Now write all the file names. */
11771 for (i = 0; i < numfiles; i++)
11773 int file_idx = backmap[i];
11774 int dir_idx = dirs[files[file_idx].dir_idx].dir_idx;
11776 #ifdef VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
11777 #define MAX_VMS_VERSION_LEN 6 /* ";32768" */
11779 /* Setting these fields can lead to debugger miscomparisons,
11780 but VMS Debug requires them to be set correctly. */
11782 int ver;
11783 long long cdt;
11784 long siz;
11785 int maxfilelen = (strlen (files[file_idx].path)
11786 + dirs[dir_idx].length
11787 + MAX_VMS_VERSION_LEN + 1);
11788 char *filebuf = XALLOCAVEC (char, maxfilelen);
11790 vms_file_stats_name (files[file_idx].path, 0, 0, 0, &ver);
11791 snprintf (filebuf, maxfilelen, "%s;%d",
11792 files[file_idx].path + dirs[dir_idx].length, ver);
11794 output_line_string (str_form, filebuf, "File Entry", (unsigned) i + 1);
11796 /* Include directory index. */
11797 if (dwarf_version >= 5 && idx_form != DW_FORM_udata)
11798 dw2_asm_output_data (idx_form == DW_FORM_data1 ? 1 : 2,
11799 dir_idx + idx_offset, NULL);
11800 else
11801 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (dir_idx + idx_offset, NULL);
11803 /* Modification time. */
11804 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 ((vms_file_stats_name (files[file_idx].path,
11805 &cdt, 0, 0, 0) == 0)
11806 ? cdt : 0, NULL);
11808 /* File length in bytes. */
11809 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 ((vms_file_stats_name (files[file_idx].path,
11810 0, &siz, 0, 0) == 0)
11811 ? siz : 0, NULL);
11812 #else
11813 output_line_string (str_form,
11814 files[file_idx].path + dirs[dir_idx].length,
11815 "File Entry", (unsigned) i + 1);
11817 /* Include directory index. */
11818 if (dwarf_version >= 5 && idx_form != DW_FORM_udata)
11819 dw2_asm_output_data (idx_form == DW_FORM_data1 ? 1 : 2,
11820 dir_idx + idx_offset, NULL);
11821 else
11822 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (dir_idx + idx_offset, NULL);
11824 if (dwarf_version >= 5)
11825 continue;
11827 /* Modification time. */
11828 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, NULL);
11830 /* File length in bytes. */
11831 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, NULL);
11832 #endif /* VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO */
11835 if (dwarf_version < 5)
11836 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End file name table");
11840 /* Output one line number table into the .debug_line section. */
11842 static void
11843 output_one_line_info_table (dw_line_info_table *table)
11845 char line_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
11846 unsigned int current_line = 1;
11847 bool current_is_stmt = DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_IS_STMT_START;
11848 dw_line_info_entry *ent;
11849 size_t i;
11851 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (table->entries, i, ent)
11853 switch (ent->opcode)
11855 case LI_set_address:
11856 /* ??? Unfortunately, we have little choice here currently, and
11857 must always use the most general form. GCC does not know the
11858 address delta itself, so we can't use DW_LNS_advance_pc. Many
11859 ports do have length attributes which will give an upper bound
11860 on the address range. We could perhaps use length attributes
11861 to determine when it is safe to use DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc. */
11862 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (line_label, LINE_CODE_LABEL, ent->val);
11864 /* This can handle any delta. This takes
11865 4+DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE bytes. */
11866 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "set address %s", line_label);
11867 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
11868 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
11869 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, line_label, NULL);
11870 break;
11872 case LI_set_line:
11873 if (ent->val == current_line)
11875 /* We still need to start a new row, so output a copy insn. */
11876 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_copy,
11877 "copy line %u", current_line);
11879 else
11881 int line_offset = ent->val - current_line;
11882 int line_delta = line_offset - DWARF_LINE_BASE;
11884 current_line = ent->val;
11885 if (line_delta >= 0 && line_delta < (DWARF_LINE_RANGE - 1))
11887 /* This can handle deltas from -10 to 234, using the current
11888 definitions of DWARF_LINE_BASE and DWARF_LINE_RANGE.
11889 This takes 1 byte. */
11890 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE + line_delta,
11891 "line %u", current_line);
11893 else
11895 /* This can handle any delta. This takes at least 4 bytes,
11896 depending on the value being encoded. */
11897 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_advance_line,
11898 "advance to line %u", current_line);
11899 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (line_offset, NULL);
11900 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_copy, NULL);
11903 break;
11905 case LI_set_file:
11906 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_set_file, "set file %u", ent->val);
11907 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (ent->val, "%u", ent->val);
11908 break;
11910 case LI_set_column:
11911 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_set_column, "column %u", ent->val);
11912 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (ent->val, "%u", ent->val);
11913 break;
11915 case LI_negate_stmt:
11916 current_is_stmt = !current_is_stmt;
11917 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_negate_stmt,
11918 "is_stmt %d", current_is_stmt);
11919 break;
11921 case LI_set_prologue_end:
11922 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_set_prologue_end,
11923 "set prologue end");
11924 break;
11926 case LI_set_epilogue_begin:
11927 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_set_epilogue_begin,
11928 "set epilogue begin");
11929 break;
11931 case LI_set_discriminator:
11932 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "discriminator %u", ent->val);
11933 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + size_of_uleb128 (ent->val), NULL);
11934 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_discriminator, NULL);
11935 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (ent->val, NULL);
11936 break;
11940 /* Emit debug info for the address of the end of the table. */
11941 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "set address %s", table->end_label);
11942 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
11943 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
11944 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, table->end_label, NULL);
11946 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "end sequence");
11947 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1, NULL);
11948 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_end_sequence, NULL);
11951 /* Output the source line number correspondence information. This
11952 information goes into the .debug_line section. */
11954 static void
11955 output_line_info (bool prologue_only)
11957 static unsigned int generation;
11958 char l1[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES], l2[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
11959 char p1[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES], p2[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
11960 bool saw_one = false;
11961 int opc;
11963 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, LINE_NUMBER_BEGIN_LABEL, generation);
11964 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l2, LINE_NUMBER_END_LABEL, generation);
11965 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (p1, LN_PROLOG_AS_LABEL, generation);
11966 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (p2, LN_PROLOG_END_LABEL, generation++);
11968 if (!XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO)
11970 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
11971 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
11972 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
11973 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l2, l1,
11974 "Length of Source Line Info");
11977 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l1);
11979 dw2_asm_output_data (2, dwarf_version, "DWARF Version");
11980 if (dwarf_version >= 5)
11982 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Address Size");
11983 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "Segment Size");
11985 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, p2, p1, "Prolog Length");
11986 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, p1);
11988 /* Define the architecture-dependent minimum instruction length (in bytes).
11989 In this implementation of DWARF, this field is used for information
11990 purposes only. Since GCC generates assembly language, we have no
11991 a priori knowledge of how many instruction bytes are generated for each
11992 source line, and therefore can use only the DW_LNE_set_address and
11993 DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc line information commands. Accordingly, we fix
11994 this as '1', which is "correct enough" for all architectures,
11995 and don't let the target override. */
11996 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 1, "Minimum Instruction Length");
11998 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
11999 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_MAX_OPS_PER_INSN,
12000 "Maximum Operations Per Instruction");
12001 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_IS_STMT_START,
12002 "Default is_stmt_start flag");
12003 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_BASE,
12004 "Line Base Value (Special Opcodes)");
12005 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_RANGE,
12006 "Line Range Value (Special Opcodes)");
12007 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE,
12008 "Special Opcode Base");
12010 for (opc = 1; opc < DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE; opc++)
12012 int n_op_args;
12013 switch (opc)
12015 case DW_LNS_advance_pc:
12016 case DW_LNS_advance_line:
12017 case DW_LNS_set_file:
12018 case DW_LNS_set_column:
12019 case DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc:
12020 case DW_LNS_set_isa:
12021 n_op_args = 1;
12022 break;
12023 default:
12024 n_op_args = 0;
12025 break;
12028 dw2_asm_output_data (1, n_op_args, "opcode: %#x has %d args",
12029 opc, n_op_args);
12032 /* Write out the information about the files we use. */
12033 output_file_names ();
12034 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, p2);
12035 if (prologue_only)
12037 /* Output the marker for the end of the line number info. */
12038 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
12039 return;
12042 if (separate_line_info)
12044 dw_line_info_table *table;
12045 size_t i;
12047 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*separate_line_info, i, table)
12048 if (table->in_use)
12050 output_one_line_info_table (table);
12051 saw_one = true;
12054 if (cold_text_section_line_info && cold_text_section_line_info->in_use)
12056 output_one_line_info_table (cold_text_section_line_info);
12057 saw_one = true;
12060 /* ??? Some Darwin linkers crash on a .debug_line section with no
12061 sequences. Further, merely a DW_LNE_end_sequence entry is not
12062 sufficient -- the address column must also be initialized.
12063 Make sure to output at least one set_address/end_sequence pair,
12064 choosing .text since that section is always present. */
12065 if (text_section_line_info->in_use || !saw_one)
12066 output_one_line_info_table (text_section_line_info);
12068 /* Output the marker for the end of the line number info. */
12069 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
12072 /* Return true if DW_AT_endianity should be emitted according to REVERSE. */
12074 static inline bool
12075 need_endianity_attribute_p (bool reverse)
12077 return reverse && (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict);
12080 /* Given a pointer to a tree node for some base type, return a pointer to
12081 a DIE that describes the given type. REVERSE is true if the type is
12082 to be interpreted in the reverse storage order wrt the target order.
12084 This routine must only be called for GCC type nodes that correspond to
12085 Dwarf base (fundamental) types. */
12087 static dw_die_ref
12088 base_type_die (tree type, bool reverse)
12090 dw_die_ref base_type_result;
12091 enum dwarf_type encoding;
12092 bool fpt_used = false;
12093 struct fixed_point_type_info fpt_info;
12094 tree type_bias = NULL_TREE;
12096 /* If this is a subtype that should not be emitted as a subrange type,
12097 use the base type. See subrange_type_for_debug_p. */
12098 if (TREE_CODE (type) == INTEGER_TYPE && TREE_TYPE (type) != NULL_TREE)
12099 type = TREE_TYPE (type);
12101 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
12103 case INTEGER_TYPE:
12104 if ((dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict)
12105 && TYPE_NAME (type)
12106 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (type)) == TYPE_DECL
12107 && DECL_IS_BUILTIN (TYPE_NAME (type))
12108 && DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (type)))
12110 const char *name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (type)));
12111 if (strcmp (name, "char16_t") == 0
12112 || strcmp (name, "char32_t") == 0)
12114 encoding = DW_ATE_UTF;
12115 break;
12118 if ((dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
12119 && lang_hooks.types.get_fixed_point_type_info)
12121 memset (&fpt_info, 0, sizeof (fpt_info));
12122 if (lang_hooks.types.get_fixed_point_type_info (type, &fpt_info))
12124 fpt_used = true;
12125 encoding = ((TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
12126 ? DW_ATE_unsigned_fixed
12127 : DW_ATE_signed_fixed);
12128 break;
12131 if (TYPE_STRING_FLAG (type))
12133 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
12134 encoding = DW_ATE_unsigned_char;
12135 else
12136 encoding = DW_ATE_signed_char;
12138 else if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
12139 encoding = DW_ATE_unsigned;
12140 else
12141 encoding = DW_ATE_signed;
12143 if (!dwarf_strict
12144 && lang_hooks.types.get_type_bias)
12145 type_bias = lang_hooks.types.get_type_bias (type);
12146 break;
12148 case REAL_TYPE:
12149 if (DECIMAL_FLOAT_MODE_P (TYPE_MODE (type)))
12151 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
12152 encoding = DW_ATE_decimal_float;
12153 else
12154 encoding = DW_ATE_lo_user;
12156 else
12157 encoding = DW_ATE_float;
12158 break;
12160 case FIXED_POINT_TYPE:
12161 if (!(dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict))
12162 encoding = DW_ATE_lo_user;
12163 else if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
12164 encoding = DW_ATE_unsigned_fixed;
12165 else
12166 encoding = DW_ATE_signed_fixed;
12167 break;
12169 /* Dwarf2 doesn't know anything about complex ints, so use
12170 a user defined type for it. */
12171 case COMPLEX_TYPE:
12172 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (type)) == REAL_TYPE)
12173 encoding = DW_ATE_complex_float;
12174 else
12175 encoding = DW_ATE_lo_user;
12176 break;
12178 case BOOLEAN_TYPE:
12179 /* GNU FORTRAN/Ada/C++ BOOLEAN type. */
12180 encoding = DW_ATE_boolean;
12181 break;
12183 default:
12184 /* No other TREE_CODEs are Dwarf fundamental types. */
12185 gcc_unreachable ();
12188 base_type_result = new_die_raw (DW_TAG_base_type);
12190 add_AT_unsigned (base_type_result, DW_AT_byte_size,
12191 int_size_in_bytes (type));
12192 add_AT_unsigned (base_type_result, DW_AT_encoding, encoding);
12194 if (need_endianity_attribute_p (reverse))
12195 add_AT_unsigned (base_type_result, DW_AT_endianity,
12196 BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN ? DW_END_little : DW_END_big);
12198 add_alignment_attribute (base_type_result, type);
12200 if (fpt_used)
12202 switch (fpt_info.scale_factor_kind)
12204 case fixed_point_scale_factor_binary:
12205 add_AT_int (base_type_result, DW_AT_binary_scale,
12206 fpt_info.scale_factor.binary);
12207 break;
12209 case fixed_point_scale_factor_decimal:
12210 add_AT_int (base_type_result, DW_AT_decimal_scale,
12211 fpt_info.scale_factor.decimal);
12212 break;
12214 case fixed_point_scale_factor_arbitrary:
12215 /* Arbitrary scale factors cannot be described in standard DWARF,
12216 yet. */
12217 if (!dwarf_strict)
12219 /* Describe the scale factor as a rational constant. */
12220 const dw_die_ref scale_factor
12221 = new_die (DW_TAG_constant, comp_unit_die (), type);
12223 add_AT_unsigned (scale_factor, DW_AT_GNU_numerator,
12224 fpt_info.scale_factor.arbitrary.numerator);
12225 add_AT_int (scale_factor, DW_AT_GNU_denominator,
12226 fpt_info.scale_factor.arbitrary.denominator);
12228 add_AT_die_ref (base_type_result, DW_AT_small, scale_factor);
12230 break;
12232 default:
12233 gcc_unreachable ();
12237 if (type_bias)
12238 add_scalar_info (base_type_result, DW_AT_GNU_bias, type_bias,
12239 dw_scalar_form_constant
12240 | dw_scalar_form_exprloc
12241 | dw_scalar_form_reference,
12242 NULL);
12244 return base_type_result;
12247 /* A C++ function with deduced return type can have a TEMPLATE_TYPE_PARM
12248 named 'auto' in its type: return true for it, false otherwise. */
12250 static inline bool
12251 is_cxx_auto (tree type)
12253 if (is_cxx ())
12255 tree name = TYPE_IDENTIFIER (type);
12256 if (name == get_identifier ("auto")
12257 || name == get_identifier ("decltype(auto)"))
12258 return true;
12260 return false;
12263 /* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return nonzero if the
12264 given input type is a Dwarf "fundamental" type. Otherwise return null. */
12266 static inline int
12267 is_base_type (tree type)
12269 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
12271 case INTEGER_TYPE:
12272 case REAL_TYPE:
12273 case FIXED_POINT_TYPE:
12274 case COMPLEX_TYPE:
12275 case BOOLEAN_TYPE:
12276 case POINTER_BOUNDS_TYPE:
12277 return 1;
12279 case VOID_TYPE:
12280 case ARRAY_TYPE:
12281 case RECORD_TYPE:
12282 case UNION_TYPE:
12283 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
12284 case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
12285 case FUNCTION_TYPE:
12286 case METHOD_TYPE:
12287 case POINTER_TYPE:
12288 case REFERENCE_TYPE:
12289 case NULLPTR_TYPE:
12290 case OFFSET_TYPE:
12291 case LANG_TYPE:
12292 case VECTOR_TYPE:
12293 return 0;
12295 default:
12296 if (is_cxx_auto (type))
12297 return 0;
12298 gcc_unreachable ();
12301 return 0;
12304 /* Given a pointer to a tree node, assumed to be some kind of a ..._TYPE
12305 node, return the size in bits for the type if it is a constant, or else
12306 return the alignment for the type if the type's size is not constant, or
12307 else return BITS_PER_WORD if the type actually turns out to be an
12308 ERROR_MARK node. */
12310 static inline unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
12311 simple_type_size_in_bits (const_tree type)
12313 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ERROR_MARK)
12314 return BITS_PER_WORD;
12315 else if (TYPE_SIZE (type) == NULL_TREE)
12316 return 0;
12317 else if (tree_fits_uhwi_p (TYPE_SIZE (type)))
12318 return tree_to_uhwi (TYPE_SIZE (type));
12319 else
12320 return TYPE_ALIGN (type);
12323 /* Similarly, but return an offset_int instead of UHWI. */
12325 static inline offset_int
12326 offset_int_type_size_in_bits (const_tree type)
12328 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ERROR_MARK)
12329 return BITS_PER_WORD;
12330 else if (TYPE_SIZE (type) == NULL_TREE)
12331 return 0;
12332 else if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE (type)) == INTEGER_CST)
12333 return wi::to_offset (TYPE_SIZE (type));
12334 else
12335 return TYPE_ALIGN (type);
12338 /* Given a pointer to a tree node for a subrange type, return a pointer
12339 to a DIE that describes the given type. */
12341 static dw_die_ref
12342 subrange_type_die (tree type, tree low, tree high, tree bias,
12343 dw_die_ref context_die)
12345 dw_die_ref subrange_die;
12346 const HOST_WIDE_INT size_in_bytes = int_size_in_bytes (type);
12348 if (context_die == NULL)
12349 context_die = comp_unit_die ();
12351 subrange_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subrange_type, context_die, type);
12353 if (int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (type)) != size_in_bytes)
12355 /* The size of the subrange type and its base type do not match,
12356 so we need to generate a size attribute for the subrange type. */
12357 add_AT_unsigned (subrange_die, DW_AT_byte_size, size_in_bytes);
12360 add_alignment_attribute (subrange_die, type);
12362 if (low)
12363 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_lower_bound, low, NULL);
12364 if (high)
12365 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_upper_bound, high, NULL);
12366 if (bias && !dwarf_strict)
12367 add_scalar_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_GNU_bias, bias,
12368 dw_scalar_form_constant
12369 | dw_scalar_form_exprloc
12370 | dw_scalar_form_reference,
12371 NULL);
12373 return subrange_die;
12376 /* Returns the (const and/or volatile) cv_qualifiers associated with
12377 the decl node. This will normally be augmented with the
12378 cv_qualifiers of the underlying type in add_type_attribute. */
12380 static int
12381 decl_quals (const_tree decl)
12383 return ((TREE_READONLY (decl)
12384 /* The C++ front-end correctly marks reference-typed
12385 variables as readonly, but from a language (and debug
12386 info) standpoint they are not const-qualified. */
12387 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) != REFERENCE_TYPE
12388 ? TYPE_QUAL_CONST : TYPE_UNQUALIFIED)
12389 | (TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl)
12390 ? TYPE_QUAL_VOLATILE : TYPE_UNQUALIFIED));
12393 /* Determine the TYPE whose qualifiers match the largest strict subset
12394 of the given TYPE_QUALS, and return its qualifiers. Ignore all
12395 qualifiers outside QUAL_MASK. */
12397 static int
12398 get_nearest_type_subqualifiers (tree type, int type_quals, int qual_mask)
12400 tree t;
12401 int best_rank = 0, best_qual = 0, max_rank;
12403 type_quals &= qual_mask;
12404 max_rank = popcount_hwi (type_quals) - 1;
12406 for (t = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type); t && best_rank < max_rank;
12407 t = TYPE_NEXT_VARIANT (t))
12409 int q = TYPE_QUALS (t) & qual_mask;
12411 if ((q & type_quals) == q && q != type_quals
12412 && check_base_type (t, type))
12414 int rank = popcount_hwi (q);
12416 if (rank > best_rank)
12418 best_rank = rank;
12419 best_qual = q;
12424 return best_qual;
12427 struct dwarf_qual_info_t { int q; enum dwarf_tag t; };
12428 static const dwarf_qual_info_t dwarf_qual_info[] =
12430 { TYPE_QUAL_CONST, DW_TAG_const_type },
12431 { TYPE_QUAL_VOLATILE, DW_TAG_volatile_type },
12432 { TYPE_QUAL_RESTRICT, DW_TAG_restrict_type },
12433 { TYPE_QUAL_ATOMIC, DW_TAG_atomic_type }
12435 static const unsigned int dwarf_qual_info_size
12436 = sizeof (dwarf_qual_info) / sizeof (dwarf_qual_info[0]);
12438 /* If DIE is a qualified DIE of some base DIE with the same parent,
12439 return the base DIE, otherwise return NULL. Set MASK to the
12440 qualifiers added compared to the returned DIE. */
12442 static dw_die_ref
12443 qualified_die_p (dw_die_ref die, int *mask, unsigned int depth)
12445 unsigned int i;
12446 for (i = 0; i < dwarf_qual_info_size; i++)
12447 if (die->die_tag == dwarf_qual_info[i].t)
12448 break;
12449 if (i == dwarf_qual_info_size)
12450 return NULL;
12451 if (vec_safe_length (die->die_attr) != 1)
12452 return NULL;
12453 dw_die_ref type = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_type);
12454 if (type == NULL || type->die_parent != die->die_parent)
12455 return NULL;
12456 *mask |= dwarf_qual_info[i].q;
12457 if (depth)
12459 dw_die_ref ret = qualified_die_p (type, mask, depth - 1);
12460 if (ret)
12461 return ret;
12463 return type;
12466 /* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return a debugging
12467 entry that chains the modifiers specified by CV_QUALS in front of the
12468 given type. REVERSE is true if the type is to be interpreted in the
12469 reverse storage order wrt the target order. */
12471 static dw_die_ref
12472 modified_type_die (tree type, int cv_quals, bool reverse,
12473 dw_die_ref context_die)
12475 enum tree_code code = TREE_CODE (type);
12476 dw_die_ref mod_type_die;
12477 dw_die_ref sub_die = NULL;
12478 tree item_type = NULL;
12479 tree qualified_type;
12480 tree name, low, high;
12481 dw_die_ref mod_scope;
12482 /* Only these cv-qualifiers are currently handled. */
12483 const int cv_qual_mask = (TYPE_QUAL_CONST | TYPE_QUAL_VOLATILE
12484 | TYPE_QUAL_RESTRICT | TYPE_QUAL_ATOMIC);
12485 const bool reverse_base_type
12486 = need_endianity_attribute_p (reverse) && is_base_type (type);
12488 if (code == ERROR_MARK)
12489 return NULL;
12491 if (lang_hooks.types.get_debug_type)
12493 tree debug_type = lang_hooks.types.get_debug_type (type);
12495 if (debug_type != NULL_TREE && debug_type != type)
12496 return modified_type_die (debug_type, cv_quals, reverse, context_die);
12499 cv_quals &= cv_qual_mask;
12501 /* Don't emit DW_TAG_restrict_type for DWARFv2, since it is a type
12502 tag modifier (and not an attribute) old consumers won't be able
12503 to handle it. */
12504 if (dwarf_version < 3)
12505 cv_quals &= ~TYPE_QUAL_RESTRICT;
12507 /* Likewise for DW_TAG_atomic_type for DWARFv5. */
12508 if (dwarf_version < 5)
12509 cv_quals &= ~TYPE_QUAL_ATOMIC;
12511 /* See if we already have the appropriately qualified variant of
12512 this type. */
12513 qualified_type = get_qualified_type (type, cv_quals);
12515 if (qualified_type == sizetype)
12517 /* Try not to expose the internal sizetype type's name. */
12518 if (TYPE_NAME (qualified_type)
12519 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (qualified_type)) == TYPE_DECL)
12521 tree t = TREE_TYPE (TYPE_NAME (qualified_type));
12523 gcc_checking_assert (TREE_CODE (t) == INTEGER_TYPE
12524 && (TYPE_PRECISION (t)
12525 == TYPE_PRECISION (qualified_type))
12526 && (TYPE_UNSIGNED (t)
12527 == TYPE_UNSIGNED (qualified_type)));
12528 qualified_type = t;
12530 else if (qualified_type == sizetype
12531 && TREE_CODE (sizetype) == TREE_CODE (size_type_node)
12532 && TYPE_PRECISION (sizetype) == TYPE_PRECISION (size_type_node)
12533 && TYPE_UNSIGNED (sizetype) == TYPE_UNSIGNED (size_type_node))
12534 qualified_type = size_type_node;
12537 /* If we do, then we can just use its DIE, if it exists. */
12538 if (qualified_type)
12540 mod_type_die = lookup_type_die (qualified_type);
12542 /* DW_AT_endianity doesn't come from a qualifier on the type, so it is
12543 dealt with specially: the DIE with the attribute, if it exists, is
12544 placed immediately after the regular DIE for the same base type. */
12545 if (mod_type_die
12546 && (!reverse_base_type
12547 || ((mod_type_die = mod_type_die->die_sib) != NULL
12548 && get_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_endianity))))
12549 return mod_type_die;
12552 name = qualified_type ? TYPE_NAME (qualified_type) : NULL;
12554 /* Handle C typedef types. */
12555 if (name
12556 && TREE_CODE (name) == TYPE_DECL
12557 && DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (name)
12558 && !DECL_ARTIFICIAL (name))
12560 tree dtype = TREE_TYPE (name);
12562 /* Skip the typedef for base types with DW_AT_endianity, no big deal. */
12563 if (qualified_type == dtype && !reverse_base_type)
12565 tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (name);
12567 /* Typedef variants that have an abstract origin don't get their own
12568 type DIE (see gen_typedef_die), so fall back on the ultimate
12569 abstract origin instead. */
12570 if (origin != NULL && origin != name)
12571 return modified_type_die (TREE_TYPE (origin), cv_quals, reverse,
12572 context_die);
12574 /* For a named type, use the typedef. */
12575 gen_type_die (qualified_type, context_die);
12576 return lookup_type_die (qualified_type);
12578 else
12580 int dquals = TYPE_QUALS_NO_ADDR_SPACE (dtype);
12581 dquals &= cv_qual_mask;
12582 if ((dquals & ~cv_quals) != TYPE_UNQUALIFIED
12583 || (cv_quals == dquals && DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (name) != type))
12584 /* cv-unqualified version of named type. Just use
12585 the unnamed type to which it refers. */
12586 return modified_type_die (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (name), cv_quals,
12587 reverse, context_die);
12588 /* Else cv-qualified version of named type; fall through. */
12592 mod_scope = scope_die_for (type, context_die);
12594 if (cv_quals)
12596 int sub_quals = 0, first_quals = 0;
12597 unsigned i;
12598 dw_die_ref first = NULL, last = NULL;
12600 /* Determine a lesser qualified type that most closely matches
12601 this one. Then generate DW_TAG_* entries for the remaining
12602 qualifiers. */
12603 sub_quals = get_nearest_type_subqualifiers (type, cv_quals,
12604 cv_qual_mask);
12605 if (sub_quals && use_debug_types)
12607 bool needed = false;
12608 /* If emitting type units, make sure the order of qualifiers
12609 is canonical. Thus, start from unqualified type if
12610 an earlier qualifier is missing in sub_quals, but some later
12611 one is present there. */
12612 for (i = 0; i < dwarf_qual_info_size; i++)
12613 if (dwarf_qual_info[i].q & cv_quals & ~sub_quals)
12614 needed = true;
12615 else if (needed && (dwarf_qual_info[i].q & cv_quals))
12617 sub_quals = 0;
12618 break;
12621 mod_type_die = modified_type_die (type, sub_quals, reverse, context_die);
12622 if (mod_scope && mod_type_die && mod_type_die->die_parent == mod_scope)
12624 /* As not all intermediate qualified DIEs have corresponding
12625 tree types, ensure that qualified DIEs in the same scope
12626 as their DW_AT_type are emitted after their DW_AT_type,
12627 only with other qualified DIEs for the same type possibly
12628 in between them. Determine the range of such qualified
12629 DIEs now (first being the base type, last being corresponding
12630 last qualified DIE for it). */
12631 unsigned int count = 0;
12632 first = qualified_die_p (mod_type_die, &first_quals,
12633 dwarf_qual_info_size);
12634 if (first == NULL)
12635 first = mod_type_die;
12636 gcc_assert ((first_quals & ~sub_quals) == 0);
12637 for (count = 0, last = first;
12638 count < (1U << dwarf_qual_info_size);
12639 count++, last = last->die_sib)
12641 int quals = 0;
12642 if (last == mod_scope->die_child)
12643 break;
12644 if (qualified_die_p (last->die_sib, &quals, dwarf_qual_info_size)
12645 != first)
12646 break;
12650 for (i = 0; i < dwarf_qual_info_size; i++)
12651 if (dwarf_qual_info[i].q & cv_quals & ~sub_quals)
12653 dw_die_ref d;
12654 if (first && first != last)
12656 for (d = first->die_sib; ; d = d->die_sib)
12658 int quals = 0;
12659 qualified_die_p (d, &quals, dwarf_qual_info_size);
12660 if (quals == (first_quals | dwarf_qual_info[i].q))
12661 break;
12662 if (d == last)
12664 d = NULL;
12665 break;
12668 if (d)
12670 mod_type_die = d;
12671 continue;
12674 if (first)
12676 d = new_die_raw (dwarf_qual_info[i].t);
12677 add_child_die_after (mod_scope, d, last);
12678 last = d;
12680 else
12681 d = new_die (dwarf_qual_info[i].t, mod_scope, type);
12682 if (mod_type_die)
12683 add_AT_die_ref (d, DW_AT_type, mod_type_die);
12684 mod_type_die = d;
12685 first_quals |= dwarf_qual_info[i].q;
12688 else if (code == POINTER_TYPE || code == REFERENCE_TYPE)
12690 dwarf_tag tag = DW_TAG_pointer_type;
12691 if (code == REFERENCE_TYPE)
12693 if (TYPE_REF_IS_RVALUE (type) && dwarf_version >= 4)
12694 tag = DW_TAG_rvalue_reference_type;
12695 else
12696 tag = DW_TAG_reference_type;
12698 mod_type_die = new_die (tag, mod_scope, type);
12700 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_byte_size,
12701 simple_type_size_in_bits (type) / BITS_PER_UNIT);
12702 add_alignment_attribute (mod_type_die, type);
12703 item_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
12705 addr_space_t as = TYPE_ADDR_SPACE (item_type);
12706 if (!ADDR_SPACE_GENERIC_P (as))
12708 int action = targetm.addr_space.debug (as);
12709 if (action >= 0)
12711 /* Positive values indicate an address_class. */
12712 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_address_class, action);
12714 else
12716 /* Negative values indicate an (inverted) segment base reg. */
12717 dw_loc_descr_ref d
12718 = one_reg_loc_descriptor (~action, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
12719 add_AT_loc (mod_type_die, DW_AT_segment, d);
12723 else if (code == INTEGER_TYPE
12724 && TREE_TYPE (type) != NULL_TREE
12725 && subrange_type_for_debug_p (type, &low, &high))
12727 tree bias = NULL_TREE;
12728 if (lang_hooks.types.get_type_bias)
12729 bias = lang_hooks.types.get_type_bias (type);
12730 mod_type_die = subrange_type_die (type, low, high, bias, context_die);
12731 item_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
12733 else if (is_base_type (type))
12735 mod_type_die = base_type_die (type, reverse);
12737 /* The DIE with DW_AT_endianity is placed right after the naked DIE. */
12738 if (reverse_base_type)
12740 dw_die_ref after_die
12741 = modified_type_die (type, cv_quals, false, context_die);
12742 add_child_die_after (comp_unit_die (), mod_type_die, after_die);
12744 else
12745 add_child_die (comp_unit_die (), mod_type_die);
12747 add_pubtype (type, mod_type_die);
12749 else
12751 gen_type_die (type, context_die);
12753 /* We have to get the type_main_variant here (and pass that to the
12754 `lookup_type_die' routine) because the ..._TYPE node we have
12755 might simply be a *copy* of some original type node (where the
12756 copy was created to help us keep track of typedef names) and
12757 that copy might have a different TYPE_UID from the original
12758 ..._TYPE node. */
12759 if (TREE_CODE (type) == FUNCTION_TYPE
12760 || TREE_CODE (type) == METHOD_TYPE)
12762 /* For function/method types, can't just use type_main_variant here,
12763 because that can have different ref-qualifiers for C++,
12764 but try to canonicalize. */
12765 tree main = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type);
12766 for (tree t = main; t; t = TYPE_NEXT_VARIANT (t))
12767 if (TYPE_QUALS_NO_ADDR_SPACE (t) == 0
12768 && check_base_type (t, main)
12769 && check_lang_type (t, type))
12770 return lookup_type_die (t);
12771 return lookup_type_die (type);
12773 else if (TREE_CODE (type) != VECTOR_TYPE
12774 && TREE_CODE (type) != ARRAY_TYPE)
12775 return lookup_type_die (type_main_variant (type));
12776 else
12777 /* Vectors have the debugging information in the type,
12778 not the main variant. */
12779 return lookup_type_die (type);
12782 /* Builtin types don't have a DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE. For those,
12783 don't output a DW_TAG_typedef, since there isn't one in the
12784 user's program; just attach a DW_AT_name to the type.
12785 Don't attach a DW_AT_name to DW_TAG_const_type or DW_TAG_volatile_type
12786 if the base type already has the same name. */
12787 if (name
12788 && ((TREE_CODE (name) != TYPE_DECL
12789 && (qualified_type == TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type)
12790 || (cv_quals == TYPE_UNQUALIFIED)))
12791 || (TREE_CODE (name) == TYPE_DECL
12792 && TREE_TYPE (name) == qualified_type
12793 && DECL_NAME (name))))
12795 if (TREE_CODE (name) == TYPE_DECL)
12796 /* Could just call add_name_and_src_coords_attributes here,
12797 but since this is a builtin type it doesn't have any
12798 useful source coordinates anyway. */
12799 name = DECL_NAME (name);
12800 add_name_attribute (mod_type_die, IDENTIFIER_POINTER (name));
12802 /* This probably indicates a bug. */
12803 else if (mod_type_die && mod_type_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_base_type)
12805 name = TYPE_IDENTIFIER (type);
12806 add_name_attribute (mod_type_die,
12807 name ? IDENTIFIER_POINTER (name) : "__unknown__");
12810 if (qualified_type && !reverse_base_type)
12811 equate_type_number_to_die (qualified_type, mod_type_die);
12813 if (item_type)
12814 /* We must do this after the equate_type_number_to_die call, in case
12815 this is a recursive type. This ensures that the modified_type_die
12816 recursion will terminate even if the type is recursive. Recursive
12817 types are possible in Ada. */
12818 sub_die = modified_type_die (item_type,
12819 TYPE_QUALS_NO_ADDR_SPACE (item_type),
12820 reverse,
12821 context_die);
12823 if (sub_die != NULL)
12824 add_AT_die_ref (mod_type_die, DW_AT_type, sub_die);
12826 add_gnat_descriptive_type_attribute (mod_type_die, type, context_die);
12827 if (TYPE_ARTIFICIAL (type))
12828 add_AT_flag (mod_type_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
12830 return mod_type_die;
12833 /* Generate DIEs for the generic parameters of T.
12834 T must be either a generic type or a generic function.
12835 See http://gcc.gnu.org/wiki/TemplateParmsDwarf for more. */
12837 static void
12838 gen_generic_params_dies (tree t)
12840 tree parms, args;
12841 int parms_num, i;
12842 dw_die_ref die = NULL;
12843 int non_default;
12845 if (!t || (TYPE_P (t) && !COMPLETE_TYPE_P (t)))
12846 return;
12848 if (TYPE_P (t))
12849 die = lookup_type_die (t);
12850 else if (DECL_P (t))
12851 die = lookup_decl_die (t);
12853 gcc_assert (die);
12855 parms = lang_hooks.get_innermost_generic_parms (t);
12856 if (!parms)
12857 /* T has no generic parameter. It means T is neither a generic type
12858 or function. End of story. */
12859 return;
12861 parms_num = TREE_VEC_LENGTH (parms);
12862 args = lang_hooks.get_innermost_generic_args (t);
12863 if (TREE_CHAIN (args) && TREE_CODE (TREE_CHAIN (args)) == INTEGER_CST)
12864 non_default = int_cst_value (TREE_CHAIN (args));
12865 else
12866 non_default = TREE_VEC_LENGTH (args);
12867 for (i = 0; i < parms_num; i++)
12869 tree parm, arg, arg_pack_elems;
12870 dw_die_ref parm_die;
12872 parm = TREE_VEC_ELT (parms, i);
12873 arg = TREE_VEC_ELT (args, i);
12874 arg_pack_elems = lang_hooks.types.get_argument_pack_elems (arg);
12875 gcc_assert (parm && TREE_VALUE (parm) && arg);
12877 if (parm && TREE_VALUE (parm) && arg)
12879 /* If PARM represents a template parameter pack,
12880 emit a DW_TAG_GNU_template_parameter_pack DIE, followed
12881 by DW_TAG_template_*_parameter DIEs for the argument
12882 pack elements of ARG. Note that ARG would then be
12883 an argument pack. */
12884 if (arg_pack_elems)
12885 parm_die = template_parameter_pack_die (TREE_VALUE (parm),
12886 arg_pack_elems,
12887 die);
12888 else
12889 parm_die = generic_parameter_die (TREE_VALUE (parm), arg,
12890 true /* emit name */, die);
12891 if (i >= non_default)
12892 add_AT_flag (parm_die, DW_AT_default_value, 1);
12897 /* Create and return a DIE for PARM which should be
12898 the representation of a generic type parameter.
12899 For instance, in the C++ front end, PARM would be a template parameter.
12900 ARG is the argument to PARM.
12901 EMIT_NAME_P if tree, the DIE will have DW_AT_name attribute set to the
12902 name of the PARM.
12903 PARENT_DIE is the parent DIE which the new created DIE should be added to,
12904 as a child node. */
12906 static dw_die_ref
12907 generic_parameter_die (tree parm, tree arg,
12908 bool emit_name_p,
12909 dw_die_ref parent_die)
12911 dw_die_ref tmpl_die = NULL;
12912 const char *name = NULL;
12914 if (!parm || !DECL_NAME (parm) || !arg)
12915 return NULL;
12917 /* We support non-type generic parameters and arguments,
12918 type generic parameters and arguments, as well as
12919 generic generic parameters (a.k.a. template template parameters in C++)
12920 and arguments. */
12921 if (TREE_CODE (parm) == PARM_DECL)
12922 /* PARM is a nontype generic parameter */
12923 tmpl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_template_value_param, parent_die, parm);
12924 else if (TREE_CODE (parm) == TYPE_DECL)
12925 /* PARM is a type generic parameter. */
12926 tmpl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_template_type_param, parent_die, parm);
12927 else if (lang_hooks.decls.generic_generic_parameter_decl_p (parm))
12928 /* PARM is a generic generic parameter.
12929 Its DIE is a GNU extension. It shall have a
12930 DW_AT_name attribute to represent the name of the template template
12931 parameter, and a DW_AT_GNU_template_name attribute to represent the
12932 name of the template template argument. */
12933 tmpl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_template_template_param,
12934 parent_die, parm);
12935 else
12936 gcc_unreachable ();
12938 if (tmpl_die)
12940 tree tmpl_type;
12942 /* If PARM is a generic parameter pack, it means we are
12943 emitting debug info for a template argument pack element.
12944 In other terms, ARG is a template argument pack element.
12945 In that case, we don't emit any DW_AT_name attribute for
12946 the die. */
12947 if (emit_name_p)
12949 name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_NAME (parm));
12950 gcc_assert (name);
12951 add_AT_string (tmpl_die, DW_AT_name, name);
12954 if (!lang_hooks.decls.generic_generic_parameter_decl_p (parm))
12956 /* DWARF3, 5.6.8 says if PARM is a non-type generic parameter
12957 TMPL_DIE should have a child DW_AT_type attribute that is set
12958 to the type of the argument to PARM, which is ARG.
12959 If PARM is a type generic parameter, TMPL_DIE should have a
12960 child DW_AT_type that is set to ARG. */
12961 tmpl_type = TYPE_P (arg) ? arg : TREE_TYPE (arg);
12962 add_type_attribute (tmpl_die, tmpl_type,
12963 (TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (tmpl_type)
12964 ? TYPE_QUAL_VOLATILE : TYPE_UNQUALIFIED),
12965 false, parent_die);
12967 else
12969 /* So TMPL_DIE is a DIE representing a
12970 a generic generic template parameter, a.k.a template template
12971 parameter in C++ and arg is a template. */
12973 /* The DW_AT_GNU_template_name attribute of the DIE must be set
12974 to the name of the argument. */
12975 name = dwarf2_name (TYPE_P (arg) ? TYPE_NAME (arg) : arg, 1);
12976 if (name)
12977 add_AT_string (tmpl_die, DW_AT_GNU_template_name, name);
12980 if (TREE_CODE (parm) == PARM_DECL)
12981 /* So PARM is a non-type generic parameter.
12982 DWARF3 5.6.8 says we must set a DW_AT_const_value child
12983 attribute of TMPL_DIE which value represents the value
12984 of ARG.
12985 We must be careful here:
12986 The value of ARG might reference some function decls.
12987 We might currently be emitting debug info for a generic
12988 type and types are emitted before function decls, we don't
12989 know if the function decls referenced by ARG will actually be
12990 emitted after cgraph computations.
12991 So must defer the generation of the DW_AT_const_value to
12992 after cgraph is ready. */
12993 append_entry_to_tmpl_value_parm_die_table (tmpl_die, arg);
12996 return tmpl_die;
12999 /* Generate and return a DW_TAG_GNU_template_parameter_pack DIE representing.
13000 PARM_PACK must be a template parameter pack. The returned DIE
13001 will be child DIE of PARENT_DIE. */
13003 static dw_die_ref
13004 template_parameter_pack_die (tree parm_pack,
13005 tree parm_pack_args,
13006 dw_die_ref parent_die)
13008 dw_die_ref die;
13009 int j;
13011 gcc_assert (parent_die && parm_pack);
13013 die = new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_template_parameter_pack, parent_die, parm_pack);
13014 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (die, parm_pack);
13015 for (j = 0; j < TREE_VEC_LENGTH (parm_pack_args); j++)
13016 generic_parameter_die (parm_pack,
13017 TREE_VEC_ELT (parm_pack_args, j),
13018 false /* Don't emit DW_AT_name */,
13019 die);
13020 return die;
13023 /* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return true if it is
13024 an enumerated type. */
13026 static inline int
13027 type_is_enum (const_tree type)
13029 return TREE_CODE (type) == ENUMERAL_TYPE;
13032 /* Return the DBX register number described by a given RTL node. */
13034 static unsigned int
13035 dbx_reg_number (const_rtx rtl)
13037 unsigned regno = REGNO (rtl);
13039 gcc_assert (regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER);
13041 #ifdef LEAF_REG_REMAP
13042 if (crtl->uses_only_leaf_regs)
13044 int leaf_reg = LEAF_REG_REMAP (regno);
13045 if (leaf_reg != -1)
13046 regno = (unsigned) leaf_reg;
13048 #endif
13050 regno = DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (regno);
13051 gcc_assert (regno != INVALID_REGNUM);
13052 return regno;
13055 /* Optionally add a DW_OP_piece term to a location description expression.
13056 DW_OP_piece is only added if the location description expression already
13057 doesn't end with DW_OP_piece. */
13059 static void
13060 add_loc_descr_op_piece (dw_loc_descr_ref *list_head, int size)
13062 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
13064 if (*list_head != NULL)
13066 /* Find the end of the chain. */
13067 for (loc = *list_head; loc->dw_loc_next != NULL; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
13070 if (loc->dw_loc_opc != DW_OP_piece)
13071 loc->dw_loc_next = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_piece, size, 0);
13075 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a machine register or
13076 zero if there is none. */
13078 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13079 reg_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, enum var_init_status initialized)
13081 rtx regs;
13083 if (REGNO (rtl) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
13084 return 0;
13086 /* We only use "frame base" when we're sure we're talking about the
13087 post-prologue local stack frame. We do this by *not* running
13088 register elimination until this point, and recognizing the special
13089 argument pointer and soft frame pointer rtx's.
13090 Use DW_OP_fbreg offset DW_OP_stack_value in this case. */
13091 if ((rtl == arg_pointer_rtx || rtl == frame_pointer_rtx)
13092 && eliminate_regs (rtl, VOIDmode, NULL_RTX) != rtl)
13094 dw_loc_descr_ref result = NULL;
13096 if (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict)
13098 result = mem_loc_descriptor (rtl, GET_MODE (rtl), VOIDmode,
13099 initialized);
13100 if (result)
13101 add_loc_descr (&result,
13102 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
13104 return result;
13107 regs = targetm.dwarf_register_span (rtl);
13109 if (REG_NREGS (rtl) > 1 || regs)
13110 return multiple_reg_loc_descriptor (rtl, regs, initialized);
13111 else
13113 unsigned int dbx_regnum = dbx_reg_number (rtl);
13114 if (dbx_regnum == IGNORED_DWARF_REGNUM)
13115 return 0;
13116 return one_reg_loc_descriptor (dbx_regnum, initialized);
13120 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a machine register for
13121 a given hard register number. */
13123 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13124 one_reg_loc_descriptor (unsigned int regno, enum var_init_status initialized)
13126 dw_loc_descr_ref reg_loc_descr;
13128 if (regno <= 31)
13129 reg_loc_descr
13130 = new_loc_descr ((enum dwarf_location_atom) (DW_OP_reg0 + regno), 0, 0);
13131 else
13132 reg_loc_descr = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_regx, regno, 0);
13134 if (initialized == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
13135 add_loc_descr (&reg_loc_descr, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit, 0, 0));
13137 return reg_loc_descr;
13140 /* Given an RTL of a register, return a location descriptor that
13141 designates a value that spans more than one register. */
13143 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13144 multiple_reg_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, rtx regs,
13145 enum var_init_status initialized)
13147 int size, i;
13148 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result = NULL;
13150 /* Simple, contiguous registers. */
13151 if (regs == NULL_RTX)
13153 unsigned reg = REGNO (rtl);
13154 int nregs;
13156 #ifdef LEAF_REG_REMAP
13157 if (crtl->uses_only_leaf_regs)
13159 int leaf_reg = LEAF_REG_REMAP (reg);
13160 if (leaf_reg != -1)
13161 reg = (unsigned) leaf_reg;
13163 #endif
13165 gcc_assert ((unsigned) DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (reg) == dbx_reg_number (rtl));
13166 nregs = REG_NREGS (rtl);
13168 size = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl)) / nregs;
13170 loc_result = NULL;
13171 while (nregs--)
13173 dw_loc_descr_ref t;
13175 t = one_reg_loc_descriptor (DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (reg),
13176 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13177 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, t);
13178 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&loc_result, size);
13179 ++reg;
13181 return loc_result;
13184 /* Now onto stupid register sets in non contiguous locations. */
13186 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (regs) == PARALLEL);
13188 size = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XVECEXP (regs, 0, 0)));
13189 loc_result = NULL;
13191 for (i = 0; i < XVECLEN (regs, 0); ++i)
13193 dw_loc_descr_ref t;
13195 t = one_reg_loc_descriptor (dbx_reg_number (XVECEXP (regs, 0, i)),
13196 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13197 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, t);
13198 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&loc_result, size);
13201 if (loc_result && initialized == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
13202 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit, 0, 0));
13203 return loc_result;
13206 static unsigned long size_of_int_loc_descriptor (HOST_WIDE_INT);
13208 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a constant i,
13209 as a compound operation from constant (i >> shift), constant shift
13210 and DW_OP_shl. */
13212 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13213 int_shift_loc_descriptor (HOST_WIDE_INT i, int shift)
13215 dw_loc_descr_ref ret = int_loc_descriptor (i >> shift);
13216 add_loc_descr (&ret, int_loc_descriptor (shift));
13217 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
13218 return ret;
13221 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a constant. */
13223 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13224 int_loc_descriptor (HOST_WIDE_INT i)
13226 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
13228 /* Pick the smallest representation of a constant, rather than just
13229 defaulting to the LEB encoding. */
13230 if (i >= 0)
13232 int clz = clz_hwi (i);
13233 int ctz = ctz_hwi (i);
13234 if (i <= 31)
13235 op = (enum dwarf_location_atom) (DW_OP_lit0 + i);
13236 else if (i <= 0xff)
13237 op = DW_OP_const1u;
13238 else if (i <= 0xffff)
13239 op = DW_OP_const2u;
13240 else if (clz + ctz >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 5
13241 && clz + 5 + 255 >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
13242 /* DW_OP_litX DW_OP_litY DW_OP_shl takes just 3 bytes and
13243 DW_OP_litX DW_OP_const1u Y DW_OP_shl takes just 4 bytes,
13244 while DW_OP_const4u is 5 bytes. */
13245 return int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - clz - 5);
13246 else if (clz + ctz >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 8
13247 && clz + 8 + 31 >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
13248 /* DW_OP_const1u X DW_OP_litY DW_OP_shl takes just 4 bytes,
13249 while DW_OP_const4u is 5 bytes. */
13250 return int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - clz - 8);
13252 else if (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE == 4 && i > 0x7fffffff
13253 && size_of_int_loc_descriptor ((HOST_WIDE_INT) (int32_t) i)
13254 <= 4)
13256 /* As i >= 2**31, the double cast above will yield a negative number.
13257 Since wrapping is defined in DWARF expressions we can output big
13258 positive integers as small negative ones, regardless of the size
13259 of host wide ints.
13261 Here, since the evaluator will handle 32-bit values and since i >=
13262 2**31, we know it's going to be interpreted as a negative literal:
13263 store it this way if we can do better than 5 bytes this way. */
13264 return int_loc_descriptor ((HOST_WIDE_INT) (int32_t) i);
13266 else if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32 || i <= 0xffffffff)
13267 op = DW_OP_const4u;
13269 /* Past this point, i >= 0x100000000 and thus DW_OP_constu will take at
13270 least 6 bytes: see if we can do better before falling back to it. */
13271 else if (clz + ctz >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 8
13272 && clz + 8 + 255 >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
13273 /* DW_OP_const1u X DW_OP_const1u Y DW_OP_shl takes just 5 bytes. */
13274 return int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - clz - 8);
13275 else if (clz + ctz >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 16
13276 && clz + 16 + (size_of_uleb128 (i) > 5 ? 255 : 31)
13277 >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
13278 /* DW_OP_const2u X DW_OP_litY DW_OP_shl takes just 5 bytes,
13279 DW_OP_const2u X DW_OP_const1u Y DW_OP_shl takes 6 bytes. */
13280 return int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - clz - 16);
13281 else if (clz + ctz >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 32
13282 && clz + 32 + 31 >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
13283 && size_of_uleb128 (i) > 6)
13284 /* DW_OP_const4u X DW_OP_litY DW_OP_shl takes just 7 bytes. */
13285 return int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - clz - 32);
13286 else
13287 op = DW_OP_constu;
13289 else
13291 if (i >= -0x80)
13292 op = DW_OP_const1s;
13293 else if (i >= -0x8000)
13294 op = DW_OP_const2s;
13295 else if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32 || i >= -0x80000000)
13297 if (size_of_int_loc_descriptor (i) < 5)
13299 dw_loc_descr_ref ret = int_loc_descriptor (-i);
13300 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_neg, 0, 0));
13301 return ret;
13303 op = DW_OP_const4s;
13305 else
13307 if (size_of_int_loc_descriptor (i)
13308 < (unsigned long) 1 + size_of_sleb128 (i))
13310 dw_loc_descr_ref ret = int_loc_descriptor (-i);
13311 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_neg, 0, 0));
13312 return ret;
13314 op = DW_OP_consts;
13318 return new_loc_descr (op, i, 0);
13321 /* Likewise, for unsigned constants. */
13323 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13324 uint_loc_descriptor (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT i)
13326 const unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT max_int = INTTYPE_MAXIMUM (HOST_WIDE_INT);
13327 const unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT max_uint
13328 = INTTYPE_MAXIMUM (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
13330 /* If possible, use the clever signed constants handling. */
13331 if (i <= max_int)
13332 return int_loc_descriptor ((HOST_WIDE_INT) i);
13334 /* Here, we are left with positive numbers that cannot be represented as
13335 HOST_WIDE_INT, i.e.:
13336 max (HOST_WIDE_INT) < i <= max (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT)
13338 Using DW_OP_const4/8/./u operation to encode them consumes a lot of bytes
13339 whereas may be better to output a negative integer: thanks to integer
13340 wrapping, we know that:
13341 x = x - 2 ** DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
13342 = x - 2 * (max (HOST_WIDE_INT) + 1)
13343 So numbers close to max (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) could be represented as
13344 small negative integers. Let's try that in cases it will clearly improve
13345 the encoding: there is no gain turning DW_OP_const4u into
13346 DW_OP_const4s. */
13347 if (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * 8 == HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
13348 && ((DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE == 4 && i > max_uint - 0x8000)
13349 || (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE == 8 && i > max_uint - 0x80000000)))
13351 const unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT first_shift = i - max_int - 1;
13353 /* Now, -1 < first_shift <= max (HOST_WIDE_INT)
13354 i.e. 0 <= first_shift <= max (HOST_WIDE_INT). */
13355 const HOST_WIDE_INT second_shift
13356 = (HOST_WIDE_INT) first_shift - (HOST_WIDE_INT) max_int - 1;
13358 /* So we finally have:
13359 -max (HOST_WIDE_INT) - 1 <= second_shift <= -1.
13360 i.e. min (HOST_WIDE_INT) <= second_shift < 0. */
13361 return int_loc_descriptor (second_shift);
13364 /* Last chance: fallback to a simple constant operation. */
13365 return new_loc_descr
13366 ((HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32 || i <= 0xffffffff)
13367 ? DW_OP_const4u
13368 : DW_OP_const8u,
13369 i, 0);
13372 /* Generate and return a location description that computes the unsigned
13373 comparison of the two stack top entries (a OP b where b is the top-most
13374 entry and a is the second one). The KIND of comparison can be LT_EXPR,
13375 LE_EXPR, GT_EXPR or GE_EXPR. */
13377 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13378 uint_comparison_loc_list (enum tree_code kind)
13380 enum dwarf_location_atom op, flip_op;
13381 dw_loc_descr_ref ret, bra_node, jmp_node, tmp;
13383 switch (kind)
13385 case LT_EXPR:
13386 op = DW_OP_lt;
13387 break;
13388 case LE_EXPR:
13389 op = DW_OP_le;
13390 break;
13391 case GT_EXPR:
13392 op = DW_OP_gt;
13393 break;
13394 case GE_EXPR:
13395 op = DW_OP_ge;
13396 break;
13397 default:
13398 gcc_unreachable ();
13401 bra_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
13402 jmp_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_skip, 0, 0);
13404 /* Until DWARFv4, operations all work on signed integers. It is nevertheless
13405 possible to perform unsigned comparisons: we just have to distinguish
13406 three cases:
13408 1. when a and b have the same sign (as signed integers); then we should
13409 return: a OP(signed) b;
13411 2. when a is a negative signed integer while b is a positive one, then a
13412 is a greater unsigned integer than b; likewise when a and b's roles
13413 are flipped.
13415 So first, compare the sign of the two operands. */
13416 ret = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_over, 0, 0);
13417 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_over, 0, 0));
13418 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_xor, 0, 0));
13419 /* If they have different signs (i.e. they have different sign bits), then
13420 the stack top value has now the sign bit set and thus it's smaller than
13421 zero. */
13422 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_lit0, 0, 0));
13423 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_lt, 0, 0));
13424 add_loc_descr (&ret, bra_node);
13426 /* We are in case 1. At this point, we know both operands have the same
13427 sign, to it's safe to use the built-in signed comparison. */
13428 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
13429 add_loc_descr (&ret, jmp_node);
13431 /* We are in case 2. Here, we know both operands do not have the same sign,
13432 so we have to flip the signed comparison. */
13433 flip_op = (kind == LT_EXPR || kind == LE_EXPR) ? DW_OP_gt : DW_OP_lt;
13434 tmp = new_loc_descr (flip_op, 0, 0);
13435 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
13436 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = tmp;
13437 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
13439 /* This dummy operation is necessary to make the two branches join. */
13440 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_nop, 0, 0);
13441 jmp_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
13442 jmp_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = tmp;
13443 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
13445 return ret;
13448 /* Likewise, but takes the location description lists (might be destructive on
13449 them). Return NULL if either is NULL or if concatenation fails. */
13451 static dw_loc_list_ref
13452 loc_list_from_uint_comparison (dw_loc_list_ref left, dw_loc_list_ref right,
13453 enum tree_code kind)
13455 if (left == NULL || right == NULL)
13456 return NULL;
13458 add_loc_list (&left, right);
13459 if (left == NULL)
13460 return NULL;
13462 add_loc_descr_to_each (left, uint_comparison_loc_list (kind));
13463 return left;
13466 /* Return size_of_locs (int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, shift))
13467 without actually allocating it. */
13469 static unsigned long
13470 size_of_int_shift_loc_descriptor (HOST_WIDE_INT i, int shift)
13472 return size_of_int_loc_descriptor (i >> shift)
13473 + size_of_int_loc_descriptor (shift)
13474 + 1;
13477 /* Return size_of_locs (int_loc_descriptor (i)) without
13478 actually allocating it. */
13480 static unsigned long
13481 size_of_int_loc_descriptor (HOST_WIDE_INT i)
13483 unsigned long s;
13485 if (i >= 0)
13487 int clz, ctz;
13488 if (i <= 31)
13489 return 1;
13490 else if (i <= 0xff)
13491 return 2;
13492 else if (i <= 0xffff)
13493 return 3;
13494 clz = clz_hwi (i);
13495 ctz = ctz_hwi (i);
13496 if (clz + ctz >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 5
13497 && clz + 5 + 255 >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
13498 return size_of_int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
13499 - clz - 5);
13500 else if (clz + ctz >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 8
13501 && clz + 8 + 31 >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
13502 return size_of_int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
13503 - clz - 8);
13504 else if (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE == 4 && i > 0x7fffffff
13505 && size_of_int_loc_descriptor ((HOST_WIDE_INT) (int32_t) i)
13506 <= 4)
13507 return size_of_int_loc_descriptor ((HOST_WIDE_INT) (int32_t) i);
13508 else if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32 || i <= 0xffffffff)
13509 return 5;
13510 s = size_of_uleb128 ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) i);
13511 if (clz + ctz >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 8
13512 && clz + 8 + 255 >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
13513 return size_of_int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
13514 - clz - 8);
13515 else if (clz + ctz >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 16
13516 && clz + 16 + (s > 5 ? 255 : 31) >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
13517 return size_of_int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
13518 - clz - 16);
13519 else if (clz + ctz >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 32
13520 && clz + 32 + 31 >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
13521 && s > 6)
13522 return size_of_int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
13523 - clz - 32);
13524 else
13525 return 1 + s;
13527 else
13529 if (i >= -0x80)
13530 return 2;
13531 else if (i >= -0x8000)
13532 return 3;
13533 else if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32 || i >= -0x80000000)
13535 if (-(unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) i != (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) i)
13537 s = size_of_int_loc_descriptor (-i) + 1;
13538 if (s < 5)
13539 return s;
13541 return 5;
13543 else
13545 unsigned long r = 1 + size_of_sleb128 (i);
13546 if (-(unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) i != (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) i)
13548 s = size_of_int_loc_descriptor (-i) + 1;
13549 if (s < r)
13550 return s;
13552 return r;
13557 /* Return loc description representing "address" of integer value.
13558 This can appear only as toplevel expression. */
13560 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13561 address_of_int_loc_descriptor (int size, HOST_WIDE_INT i)
13563 int litsize;
13564 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result = NULL;
13566 if (!(dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
13567 return NULL;
13569 litsize = size_of_int_loc_descriptor (i);
13570 /* Determine if DW_OP_stack_value or DW_OP_implicit_value
13571 is more compact. For DW_OP_stack_value we need:
13572 litsize + 1 (DW_OP_stack_value)
13573 and for DW_OP_implicit_value:
13574 1 (DW_OP_implicit_value) + 1 (length) + size. */
13575 if ((int) DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE >= size && litsize + 1 <= 1 + 1 + size)
13577 loc_result = int_loc_descriptor (i);
13578 add_loc_descr (&loc_result,
13579 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
13580 return loc_result;
13583 loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_implicit_value,
13584 size, 0);
13585 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_const;
13586 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_int = i;
13587 return loc_result;
13590 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a base+offset location. */
13592 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13593 based_loc_descr (rtx reg, HOST_WIDE_INT offset,
13594 enum var_init_status initialized)
13596 unsigned int regno;
13597 dw_loc_descr_ref result;
13598 dw_fde_ref fde = cfun->fde;
13600 /* We only use "frame base" when we're sure we're talking about the
13601 post-prologue local stack frame. We do this by *not* running
13602 register elimination until this point, and recognizing the special
13603 argument pointer and soft frame pointer rtx's. */
13604 if (reg == arg_pointer_rtx || reg == frame_pointer_rtx)
13606 rtx elim = (ira_use_lra_p
13607 ? lra_eliminate_regs (reg, VOIDmode, NULL_RTX)
13608 : eliminate_regs (reg, VOIDmode, NULL_RTX));
13610 if (elim != reg)
13612 if (GET_CODE (elim) == PLUS)
13614 offset += INTVAL (XEXP (elim, 1));
13615 elim = XEXP (elim, 0);
13617 gcc_assert ((SUPPORTS_STACK_ALIGNMENT
13618 && (elim == hard_frame_pointer_rtx
13619 || elim == stack_pointer_rtx))
13620 || elim == (frame_pointer_needed
13621 ? hard_frame_pointer_rtx
13622 : stack_pointer_rtx));
13624 /* If drap register is used to align stack, use frame
13625 pointer + offset to access stack variables. If stack
13626 is aligned without drap, use stack pointer + offset to
13627 access stack variables. */
13628 if (crtl->stack_realign_tried
13629 && reg == frame_pointer_rtx)
13631 int base_reg
13632 = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM ((fde && fde->drap_reg != INVALID_REGNUM)
13633 ? HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
13634 : REGNO (elim));
13635 return new_reg_loc_descr (base_reg, offset);
13638 gcc_assert (frame_pointer_fb_offset_valid);
13639 offset += frame_pointer_fb_offset;
13640 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_fbreg, offset, 0);
13644 regno = REGNO (reg);
13645 #ifdef LEAF_REG_REMAP
13646 if (crtl->uses_only_leaf_regs)
13648 int leaf_reg = LEAF_REG_REMAP (regno);
13649 if (leaf_reg != -1)
13650 regno = (unsigned) leaf_reg;
13652 #endif
13653 regno = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (regno);
13655 if (!optimize && fde
13656 && (fde->drap_reg == regno || fde->vdrap_reg == regno))
13658 /* Use cfa+offset to represent the location of arguments passed
13659 on the stack when drap is used to align stack.
13660 Only do this when not optimizing, for optimized code var-tracking
13661 is supposed to track where the arguments live and the register
13662 used as vdrap or drap in some spot might be used for something
13663 else in other part of the routine. */
13664 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_fbreg, offset, 0);
13667 if (regno <= 31)
13668 result = new_loc_descr ((enum dwarf_location_atom) (DW_OP_breg0 + regno),
13669 offset, 0);
13670 else
13671 result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bregx, regno, offset);
13673 if (initialized == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
13674 add_loc_descr (&result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit, 0, 0));
13676 return result;
13679 /* Return true if this RTL expression describes a base+offset calculation. */
13681 static inline int
13682 is_based_loc (const_rtx rtl)
13684 return (GET_CODE (rtl) == PLUS
13685 && ((REG_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
13686 && REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
13687 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1)))));
13690 /* Try to handle TLS MEMs, for which mem_loc_descriptor on XEXP (mem, 0)
13691 failed. */
13693 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13694 tls_mem_loc_descriptor (rtx mem)
13696 tree base;
13697 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result;
13699 if (MEM_EXPR (mem) == NULL_TREE || !MEM_OFFSET_KNOWN_P (mem))
13700 return NULL;
13702 base = get_base_address (MEM_EXPR (mem));
13703 if (base == NULL
13704 || !VAR_P (base)
13705 || !DECL_THREAD_LOCAL_P (base))
13706 return NULL;
13708 loc_result = loc_descriptor_from_tree (MEM_EXPR (mem), 1, NULL);
13709 if (loc_result == NULL)
13710 return NULL;
13712 if (MEM_OFFSET (mem))
13713 loc_descr_plus_const (&loc_result, MEM_OFFSET (mem));
13715 return loc_result;
13718 /* Output debug info about reason why we failed to expand expression as dwarf
13719 expression. */
13721 static void
13722 expansion_failed (tree expr, rtx rtl, char const *reason)
13724 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
13726 fprintf (dump_file, "Failed to expand as dwarf: ");
13727 if (expr)
13728 print_generic_expr (dump_file, expr, dump_flags);
13729 if (rtl)
13731 fprintf (dump_file, "\n");
13732 print_rtl (dump_file, rtl);
13734 fprintf (dump_file, "\nReason: %s\n", reason);
13738 /* Helper function for const_ok_for_output. */
13740 static bool
13741 const_ok_for_output_1 (rtx rtl)
13743 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == UNSPEC)
13745 /* If delegitimize_address couldn't do anything with the UNSPEC, assume
13746 we can't express it in the debug info. */
13747 /* Don't complain about TLS UNSPECs, those are just too hard to
13748 delegitimize. Note this could be a non-decl SYMBOL_REF such as
13749 one in a constant pool entry, so testing SYMBOL_REF_TLS_MODEL
13750 rather than DECL_THREAD_LOCAL_P is not just an optimization. */
13751 if (flag_checking
13752 && (XVECLEN (rtl, 0) == 0
13753 || GET_CODE (XVECEXP (rtl, 0, 0)) != SYMBOL_REF
13754 || SYMBOL_REF_TLS_MODEL (XVECEXP (rtl, 0, 0)) == TLS_MODEL_NONE))
13755 inform (current_function_decl
13756 ? DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (current_function_decl)
13757 : UNKNOWN_LOCATION,
13758 #if NUM_UNSPEC_VALUES > 0
13759 "non-delegitimized UNSPEC %s (%d) found in variable location",
13760 ((XINT (rtl, 1) >= 0 && XINT (rtl, 1) < NUM_UNSPEC_VALUES)
13761 ? unspec_strings[XINT (rtl, 1)] : "unknown"),
13762 XINT (rtl, 1));
13763 #else
13764 "non-delegitimized UNSPEC %d found in variable location",
13765 XINT (rtl, 1));
13766 #endif
13767 expansion_failed (NULL_TREE, rtl,
13768 "UNSPEC hasn't been delegitimized.\n");
13769 return false;
13772 if (targetm.const_not_ok_for_debug_p (rtl))
13774 expansion_failed (NULL_TREE, rtl,
13775 "Expression rejected for debug by the backend.\n");
13776 return false;
13779 /* FIXME: Refer to PR60655. It is possible for simplification
13780 of rtl expressions in var tracking to produce such expressions.
13781 We should really identify / validate expressions
13782 enclosed in CONST that can be handled by assemblers on various
13783 targets and only handle legitimate cases here. */
13784 if (GET_CODE (rtl) != SYMBOL_REF)
13786 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == NOT)
13787 return false;
13788 return true;
13791 if (CONSTANT_POOL_ADDRESS_P (rtl))
13793 bool marked;
13794 get_pool_constant_mark (rtl, &marked);
13795 /* If all references to this pool constant were optimized away,
13796 it was not output and thus we can't represent it. */
13797 if (!marked)
13799 expansion_failed (NULL_TREE, rtl,
13800 "Constant was removed from constant pool.\n");
13801 return false;
13805 if (SYMBOL_REF_TLS_MODEL (rtl) != TLS_MODEL_NONE)
13806 return false;
13808 /* Avoid references to external symbols in debug info, on several targets
13809 the linker might even refuse to link when linking a shared library,
13810 and in many other cases the relocations for .debug_info/.debug_loc are
13811 dropped, so the address becomes zero anyway. Hidden symbols, guaranteed
13812 to be defined within the same shared library or executable are fine. */
13813 if (SYMBOL_REF_EXTERNAL_P (rtl))
13815 tree decl = SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl);
13817 if (decl == NULL || !targetm.binds_local_p (decl))
13819 expansion_failed (NULL_TREE, rtl,
13820 "Symbol not defined in current TU.\n");
13821 return false;
13825 return true;
13828 /* Return true if constant RTL can be emitted in DW_OP_addr or
13829 DW_AT_const_value. TLS SYMBOL_REFs, external SYMBOL_REFs or
13830 non-marked constant pool SYMBOL_REFs can't be referenced in it. */
13832 static bool
13833 const_ok_for_output (rtx rtl)
13835 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SYMBOL_REF)
13836 return const_ok_for_output_1 (rtl);
13838 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST)
13840 subrtx_var_iterator::array_type array;
13841 FOR_EACH_SUBRTX_VAR (iter, array, XEXP (rtl, 0), ALL)
13842 if (!const_ok_for_output_1 (*iter))
13843 return false;
13844 return true;
13847 return true;
13850 /* Return a reference to DW_TAG_base_type corresponding to MODE and UNSIGNEDP
13851 if possible, NULL otherwise. */
13853 static dw_die_ref
13854 base_type_for_mode (machine_mode mode, bool unsignedp)
13856 dw_die_ref type_die;
13857 tree type = lang_hooks.types.type_for_mode (mode, unsignedp);
13859 if (type == NULL)
13860 return NULL;
13861 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
13863 case INTEGER_TYPE:
13864 case REAL_TYPE:
13865 break;
13866 default:
13867 return NULL;
13869 type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
13870 if (!type_die)
13871 type_die = modified_type_die (type, TYPE_UNQUALIFIED, false,
13872 comp_unit_die ());
13873 if (type_die == NULL || type_die->die_tag != DW_TAG_base_type)
13874 return NULL;
13875 return type_die;
13878 /* For OP descriptor assumed to be in unsigned MODE, convert it to a unsigned
13879 type matching MODE, or, if MODE is narrower than or as wide as
13880 DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, untyped. Return NULL if the conversion is not
13881 possible. */
13883 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13884 convert_descriptor_to_mode (scalar_int_mode mode, dw_loc_descr_ref op)
13886 machine_mode outer_mode = mode;
13887 dw_die_ref type_die;
13888 dw_loc_descr_ref cvt;
13890 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
13892 add_loc_descr (&op, new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_convert), 0, 0));
13893 return op;
13895 type_die = base_type_for_mode (outer_mode, 1);
13896 if (type_die == NULL)
13897 return NULL;
13898 cvt = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_convert), 0, 0);
13899 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
13900 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
13901 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
13902 add_loc_descr (&op, cvt);
13903 return op;
13906 /* Return location descriptor for comparison OP with operands OP0 and OP1. */
13908 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13909 compare_loc_descriptor (enum dwarf_location_atom op, dw_loc_descr_ref op0,
13910 dw_loc_descr_ref op1)
13912 dw_loc_descr_ref ret = op0;
13913 add_loc_descr (&ret, op1);
13914 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
13915 if (STORE_FLAG_VALUE != 1)
13917 add_loc_descr (&ret, int_loc_descriptor (STORE_FLAG_VALUE));
13918 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_mul, 0, 0));
13920 return ret;
13923 /* Subroutine of scompare_loc_descriptor for the case in which we're
13924 comparing two scalar integer operands OP0 and OP1 that have mode OP_MODE,
13925 and in which OP_MODE is bigger than DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE. */
13927 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13928 scompare_loc_descriptor_wide (enum dwarf_location_atom op,
13929 scalar_int_mode op_mode,
13930 dw_loc_descr_ref op0, dw_loc_descr_ref op1)
13932 dw_die_ref type_die = base_type_for_mode (op_mode, 0);
13933 dw_loc_descr_ref cvt;
13935 if (type_die == NULL)
13936 return NULL;
13937 cvt = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_convert), 0, 0);
13938 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
13939 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
13940 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
13941 add_loc_descr (&op0, cvt);
13942 cvt = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_convert), 0, 0);
13943 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
13944 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
13945 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
13946 add_loc_descr (&op1, cvt);
13947 return compare_loc_descriptor (op, op0, op1);
13950 /* Subroutine of scompare_loc_descriptor for the case in which we're
13951 comparing two scalar integer operands OP0 and OP1 that have mode OP_MODE,
13952 and in which OP_MODE is smaller than DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE. */
13954 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13955 scompare_loc_descriptor_narrow (enum dwarf_location_atom op, rtx rtl,
13956 scalar_int_mode op_mode,
13957 dw_loc_descr_ref op0, dw_loc_descr_ref op1)
13959 int shift = (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE - GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode)) * BITS_PER_UNIT;
13960 /* For eq/ne, if the operands are known to be zero-extended,
13961 there is no need to do the fancy shifting up. */
13962 if (op == DW_OP_eq || op == DW_OP_ne)
13964 dw_loc_descr_ref last0, last1;
13965 for (last0 = op0; last0->dw_loc_next != NULL; last0 = last0->dw_loc_next)
13967 for (last1 = op1; last1->dw_loc_next != NULL; last1 = last1->dw_loc_next)
13969 /* deref_size zero extends, and for constants we can check
13970 whether they are zero extended or not. */
13971 if (((last0->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_deref_size
13972 && last0->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int <= GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode))
13973 || (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
13974 && (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 0))
13975 == (INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 0)) & GET_MODE_MASK (op_mode))))
13976 && ((last1->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_deref_size
13977 && last1->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int <= GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode))
13978 || (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1))
13979 && (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1))
13980 == (INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)) & GET_MODE_MASK (op_mode)))))
13981 return compare_loc_descriptor (op, op0, op1);
13983 /* EQ/NE comparison against constant in narrower type than
13984 DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE can be performed either as
13985 DW_OP_const1u <shift> DW_OP_shl DW_OP_const* <cst << shift>
13986 DW_OP_{eq,ne}
13988 DW_OP_const*u <mode_mask> DW_OP_and DW_OP_const* <cst & mode_mask>
13989 DW_OP_{eq,ne}. Pick whatever is shorter. */
13990 if (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1))
13991 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (op_mode) < HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
13992 && (size_of_int_loc_descriptor (shift) + 1
13993 + size_of_int_loc_descriptor (UINTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)) << shift)
13994 >= size_of_int_loc_descriptor (GET_MODE_MASK (op_mode)) + 1
13995 + size_of_int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1))
13996 & GET_MODE_MASK (op_mode))))
13998 add_loc_descr (&op0, int_loc_descriptor (GET_MODE_MASK (op_mode)));
13999 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
14000 op1 = int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1))
14001 & GET_MODE_MASK (op_mode));
14002 return compare_loc_descriptor (op, op0, op1);
14005 add_loc_descr (&op0, int_loc_descriptor (shift));
14006 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
14007 if (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1)))
14008 op1 = int_loc_descriptor (UINTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)) << shift);
14009 else
14011 add_loc_descr (&op1, int_loc_descriptor (shift));
14012 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
14014 return compare_loc_descriptor (op, op0, op1);
14017 /* Return location descriptor for unsigned comparison OP RTL. */
14019 static dw_loc_descr_ref
14020 scompare_loc_descriptor (enum dwarf_location_atom op, rtx rtl,
14021 machine_mode mem_mode)
14023 machine_mode op_mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0));
14024 dw_loc_descr_ref op0, op1;
14026 if (op_mode == VOIDmode)
14027 op_mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 1));
14028 if (op_mode == VOIDmode)
14029 return NULL;
14031 scalar_int_mode int_op_mode;
14032 if (dwarf_strict
14033 && dwarf_version < 5
14034 && (!is_a <scalar_int_mode> (op_mode, &int_op_mode)
14035 || GET_MODE_SIZE (int_op_mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE))
14036 return NULL;
14038 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), op_mode, mem_mode,
14039 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14040 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), op_mode, mem_mode,
14041 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14043 if (op0 == NULL || op1 == NULL)
14044 return NULL;
14046 if (is_a <scalar_int_mode> (op_mode, &int_op_mode))
14048 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (int_op_mode) < DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14049 return scompare_loc_descriptor_narrow (op, rtl, int_op_mode, op0, op1);
14051 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (int_op_mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14052 return scompare_loc_descriptor_wide (op, int_op_mode, op0, op1);
14054 return compare_loc_descriptor (op, op0, op1);
14057 /* Return location descriptor for unsigned comparison OP RTL. */
14059 static dw_loc_descr_ref
14060 ucompare_loc_descriptor (enum dwarf_location_atom op, rtx rtl,
14061 machine_mode mem_mode)
14063 dw_loc_descr_ref op0, op1;
14065 machine_mode test_op_mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0));
14066 if (test_op_mode == VOIDmode)
14067 test_op_mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 1));
14069 scalar_int_mode op_mode;
14070 if (!is_a <scalar_int_mode> (test_op_mode, &op_mode))
14071 return NULL;
14073 if (dwarf_strict
14074 && dwarf_version < 5
14075 && GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14076 return NULL;
14078 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), op_mode, mem_mode,
14079 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14080 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), op_mode, mem_mode,
14081 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14083 if (op0 == NULL || op1 == NULL)
14084 return NULL;
14086 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode) < DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14088 HOST_WIDE_INT mask = GET_MODE_MASK (op_mode);
14089 dw_loc_descr_ref last0, last1;
14090 for (last0 = op0; last0->dw_loc_next != NULL; last0 = last0->dw_loc_next)
14092 for (last1 = op1; last1->dw_loc_next != NULL; last1 = last1->dw_loc_next)
14094 if (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0)))
14095 op0 = int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 0)) & mask);
14096 /* deref_size zero extends, so no need to mask it again. */
14097 else if (last0->dw_loc_opc != DW_OP_deref_size
14098 || last0->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int > GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode))
14100 add_loc_descr (&op0, int_loc_descriptor (mask));
14101 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
14103 if (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1)))
14104 op1 = int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)) & mask);
14105 /* deref_size zero extends, so no need to mask it again. */
14106 else if (last1->dw_loc_opc != DW_OP_deref_size
14107 || last1->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int > GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode))
14109 add_loc_descr (&op1, int_loc_descriptor (mask));
14110 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
14113 else if (GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode) == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14115 HOST_WIDE_INT bias = 1;
14116 bias <<= (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * BITS_PER_UNIT - 1);
14117 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, bias, 0));
14118 if (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1)))
14119 op1 = int_loc_descriptor ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) bias
14120 + INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)));
14121 else
14122 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst,
14123 bias, 0));
14125 return compare_loc_descriptor (op, op0, op1);
14128 /* Return location descriptor for {U,S}{MIN,MAX}. */
14130 static dw_loc_descr_ref
14131 minmax_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, machine_mode mode,
14132 machine_mode mem_mode)
14134 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
14135 dw_loc_descr_ref op0, op1, ret;
14136 dw_loc_descr_ref bra_node, drop_node;
14138 scalar_int_mode int_mode;
14139 if (dwarf_strict
14140 && dwarf_version < 5
14141 && (!is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
14142 || GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE))
14143 return NULL;
14145 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
14146 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14147 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode, mem_mode,
14148 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14150 if (op0 == NULL || op1 == NULL)
14151 return NULL;
14153 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_dup, 0, 0));
14154 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
14155 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_over, 0, 0));
14156 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == UMIN || GET_CODE (rtl) == UMAX)
14158 /* Checked by the caller. */
14159 int_mode = as_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode);
14160 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) < DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14162 HOST_WIDE_INT mask = GET_MODE_MASK (int_mode);
14163 add_loc_descr (&op0, int_loc_descriptor (mask));
14164 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
14165 add_loc_descr (&op1, int_loc_descriptor (mask));
14166 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
14168 else if (GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14170 HOST_WIDE_INT bias = 1;
14171 bias <<= (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * BITS_PER_UNIT - 1);
14172 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, bias, 0));
14173 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, bias, 0));
14176 else if (is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
14177 && GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) < DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14179 int shift = (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE - GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode)) * BITS_PER_UNIT;
14180 add_loc_descr (&op0, int_loc_descriptor (shift));
14181 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
14182 add_loc_descr (&op1, int_loc_descriptor (shift));
14183 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
14185 else if (is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
14186 && GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14188 dw_die_ref type_die = base_type_for_mode (int_mode, 0);
14189 dw_loc_descr_ref cvt;
14190 if (type_die == NULL)
14191 return NULL;
14192 cvt = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_convert), 0, 0);
14193 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
14194 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
14195 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
14196 add_loc_descr (&op0, cvt);
14197 cvt = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_convert), 0, 0);
14198 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
14199 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
14200 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
14201 add_loc_descr (&op1, cvt);
14204 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SMIN || GET_CODE (rtl) == UMIN)
14205 op = DW_OP_lt;
14206 else
14207 op = DW_OP_gt;
14208 ret = op0;
14209 add_loc_descr (&ret, op1);
14210 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
14211 bra_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
14212 add_loc_descr (&ret, bra_node);
14213 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
14214 drop_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_drop, 0, 0);
14215 add_loc_descr (&ret, drop_node);
14216 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
14217 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = drop_node;
14218 if ((GET_CODE (rtl) == SMIN || GET_CODE (rtl) == SMAX)
14219 && is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
14220 && GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14221 ret = convert_descriptor_to_mode (int_mode, ret);
14222 return ret;
14225 /* Helper function for mem_loc_descriptor. Perform OP binary op,
14226 but after converting arguments to type_die, afterwards
14227 convert back to unsigned. */
14229 static dw_loc_descr_ref
14230 typed_binop (enum dwarf_location_atom op, rtx rtl, dw_die_ref type_die,
14231 scalar_int_mode mode, machine_mode mem_mode)
14233 dw_loc_descr_ref cvt, op0, op1;
14235 if (type_die == NULL)
14236 return NULL;
14237 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
14238 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14239 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode, mem_mode,
14240 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14241 if (op0 == NULL || op1 == NULL)
14242 return NULL;
14243 cvt = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_convert), 0, 0);
14244 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
14245 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
14246 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
14247 add_loc_descr (&op0, cvt);
14248 cvt = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_convert), 0, 0);
14249 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
14250 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
14251 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
14252 add_loc_descr (&op1, cvt);
14253 add_loc_descr (&op0, op1);
14254 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
14255 return convert_descriptor_to_mode (mode, op0);
14258 /* CLZ (where constV is CLZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO computed value,
14259 const0 is DW_OP_lit0 or corresponding typed constant,
14260 const1 is DW_OP_lit1 or corresponding typed constant
14261 and constMSB is constant with just the MSB bit set
14262 for the mode):
14263 DW_OP_dup DW_OP_bra <L1> DW_OP_drop constV DW_OP_skip <L4>
14264 L1: const0 DW_OP_swap
14265 L2: DW_OP_dup constMSB DW_OP_and DW_OP_bra <L3> const1 DW_OP_shl
14266 DW_OP_swap DW_OP_plus_uconst <1> DW_OP_swap DW_OP_skip <L2>
14267 L3: DW_OP_drop
14268 L4: DW_OP_nop
14270 CTZ is similar:
14271 DW_OP_dup DW_OP_bra <L1> DW_OP_drop constV DW_OP_skip <L4>
14272 L1: const0 DW_OP_swap
14273 L2: DW_OP_dup const1 DW_OP_and DW_OP_bra <L3> const1 DW_OP_shr
14274 DW_OP_swap DW_OP_plus_uconst <1> DW_OP_swap DW_OP_skip <L2>
14275 L3: DW_OP_drop
14276 L4: DW_OP_nop
14278 FFS is similar:
14279 DW_OP_dup DW_OP_bra <L1> DW_OP_drop const0 DW_OP_skip <L4>
14280 L1: const1 DW_OP_swap
14281 L2: DW_OP_dup const1 DW_OP_and DW_OP_bra <L3> const1 DW_OP_shr
14282 DW_OP_swap DW_OP_plus_uconst <1> DW_OP_swap DW_OP_skip <L2>
14283 L3: DW_OP_drop
14284 L4: DW_OP_nop */
14286 static dw_loc_descr_ref
14287 clz_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, scalar_int_mode mode,
14288 machine_mode mem_mode)
14290 dw_loc_descr_ref op0, ret, tmp;
14291 HOST_WIDE_INT valv;
14292 dw_loc_descr_ref l1jump, l1label;
14293 dw_loc_descr_ref l2jump, l2label;
14294 dw_loc_descr_ref l3jump, l3label;
14295 dw_loc_descr_ref l4jump, l4label;
14296 rtx msb;
14298 if (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) != mode)
14299 return NULL;
14301 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
14302 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14303 if (op0 == NULL)
14304 return NULL;
14305 ret = op0;
14306 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CLZ)
14308 if (!CLZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (mode, valv))
14309 valv = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode);
14311 else if (GET_CODE (rtl) == FFS)
14312 valv = 0;
14313 else if (!CTZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (mode, valv))
14314 valv = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode);
14315 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_dup, 0, 0));
14316 l1jump = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
14317 add_loc_descr (&ret, l1jump);
14318 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_drop, 0, 0));
14319 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (GEN_INT (valv), mode, mem_mode,
14320 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14321 if (tmp == NULL)
14322 return NULL;
14323 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
14324 l4jump = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_skip, 0, 0);
14325 add_loc_descr (&ret, l4jump);
14326 l1label = mem_loc_descriptor (GET_CODE (rtl) == FFS
14327 ? const1_rtx : const0_rtx,
14328 mode, mem_mode,
14329 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14330 if (l1label == NULL)
14331 return NULL;
14332 add_loc_descr (&ret, l1label);
14333 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
14334 l2label = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_dup, 0, 0);
14335 add_loc_descr (&ret, l2label);
14336 if (GET_CODE (rtl) != CLZ)
14337 msb = const1_rtx;
14338 else if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
14339 msb = GEN_INT (HOST_WIDE_INT_1U
14340 << (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) - 1));
14341 else
14342 msb = immed_wide_int_const
14343 (wi::set_bit_in_zero (GET_MODE_PRECISION (mode) - 1,
14344 GET_MODE_PRECISION (mode)), mode);
14345 if (GET_CODE (msb) == CONST_INT && INTVAL (msb) < 0)
14346 tmp = new_loc_descr (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32
14347 ? DW_OP_const4u : HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 64
14348 ? DW_OP_const8u : DW_OP_constu, INTVAL (msb), 0);
14349 else
14350 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (msb, mode, mem_mode,
14351 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14352 if (tmp == NULL)
14353 return NULL;
14354 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
14355 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
14356 l3jump = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
14357 add_loc_descr (&ret, l3jump);
14358 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (const1_rtx, mode, mem_mode,
14359 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14360 if (tmp == NULL)
14361 return NULL;
14362 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
14363 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (GET_CODE (rtl) == CLZ
14364 ? DW_OP_shl : DW_OP_shr, 0, 0));
14365 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
14366 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, 1, 0));
14367 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
14368 l2jump = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_skip, 0, 0);
14369 add_loc_descr (&ret, l2jump);
14370 l3label = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_drop, 0, 0);
14371 add_loc_descr (&ret, l3label);
14372 l4label = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_nop, 0, 0);
14373 add_loc_descr (&ret, l4label);
14374 l1jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
14375 l1jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = l1label;
14376 l2jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
14377 l2jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = l2label;
14378 l3jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
14379 l3jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = l3label;
14380 l4jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
14381 l4jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = l4label;
14382 return ret;
14385 /* POPCOUNT (const0 is DW_OP_lit0 or corresponding typed constant,
14386 const1 is DW_OP_lit1 or corresponding typed constant):
14387 const0 DW_OP_swap
14388 L1: DW_OP_dup DW_OP_bra <L2> DW_OP_dup DW_OP_rot const1 DW_OP_and
14389 DW_OP_plus DW_OP_swap const1 DW_OP_shr DW_OP_skip <L1>
14390 L2: DW_OP_drop
14392 PARITY is similar:
14393 L1: DW_OP_dup DW_OP_bra <L2> DW_OP_dup DW_OP_rot const1 DW_OP_and
14394 DW_OP_xor DW_OP_swap const1 DW_OP_shr DW_OP_skip <L1>
14395 L2: DW_OP_drop */
14397 static dw_loc_descr_ref
14398 popcount_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, scalar_int_mode mode,
14399 machine_mode mem_mode)
14401 dw_loc_descr_ref op0, ret, tmp;
14402 dw_loc_descr_ref l1jump, l1label;
14403 dw_loc_descr_ref l2jump, l2label;
14405 if (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) != mode)
14406 return NULL;
14408 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
14409 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14410 if (op0 == NULL)
14411 return NULL;
14412 ret = op0;
14413 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (const0_rtx, mode, mem_mode,
14414 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14415 if (tmp == NULL)
14416 return NULL;
14417 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
14418 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
14419 l1label = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_dup, 0, 0);
14420 add_loc_descr (&ret, l1label);
14421 l2jump = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
14422 add_loc_descr (&ret, l2jump);
14423 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_dup, 0, 0));
14424 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_rot, 0, 0));
14425 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (const1_rtx, mode, mem_mode,
14426 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14427 if (tmp == NULL)
14428 return NULL;
14429 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
14430 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
14431 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (GET_CODE (rtl) == POPCOUNT
14432 ? DW_OP_plus : DW_OP_xor, 0, 0));
14433 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
14434 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (const1_rtx, mode, mem_mode,
14435 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14436 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
14437 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shr, 0, 0));
14438 l1jump = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_skip, 0, 0);
14439 add_loc_descr (&ret, l1jump);
14440 l2label = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_drop, 0, 0);
14441 add_loc_descr (&ret, l2label);
14442 l1jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
14443 l1jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = l1label;
14444 l2jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
14445 l2jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = l2label;
14446 return ret;
14449 /* BSWAP (constS is initial shift count, either 56 or 24):
14450 constS const0
14451 L1: DW_OP_pick <2> constS DW_OP_pick <3> DW_OP_minus DW_OP_shr
14452 const255 DW_OP_and DW_OP_pick <2> DW_OP_shl DW_OP_or
14453 DW_OP_swap DW_OP_dup const0 DW_OP_eq DW_OP_bra <L2> const8
14454 DW_OP_minus DW_OP_swap DW_OP_skip <L1>
14455 L2: DW_OP_drop DW_OP_swap DW_OP_drop */
14457 static dw_loc_descr_ref
14458 bswap_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, scalar_int_mode mode,
14459 machine_mode mem_mode)
14461 dw_loc_descr_ref op0, ret, tmp;
14462 dw_loc_descr_ref l1jump, l1label;
14463 dw_loc_descr_ref l2jump, l2label;
14465 if (BITS_PER_UNIT != 8
14466 || (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) != 32
14467 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) != 64))
14468 return NULL;
14470 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
14471 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14472 if (op0 == NULL)
14473 return NULL;
14475 ret = op0;
14476 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (GEN_INT (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) - 8),
14477 mode, mem_mode,
14478 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14479 if (tmp == NULL)
14480 return NULL;
14481 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
14482 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (const0_rtx, mode, mem_mode,
14483 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14484 if (tmp == NULL)
14485 return NULL;
14486 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
14487 l1label = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_pick, 2, 0);
14488 add_loc_descr (&ret, l1label);
14489 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (GEN_INT (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) - 8),
14490 mode, mem_mode,
14491 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14492 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
14493 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_pick, 3, 0));
14494 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_minus, 0, 0));
14495 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shr, 0, 0));
14496 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (GEN_INT (255), mode, mem_mode,
14497 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14498 if (tmp == NULL)
14499 return NULL;
14500 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
14501 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
14502 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_pick, 2, 0));
14503 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
14504 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_or, 0, 0));
14505 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
14506 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_dup, 0, 0));
14507 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (const0_rtx, mode, mem_mode,
14508 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14509 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
14510 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_eq, 0, 0));
14511 l2jump = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
14512 add_loc_descr (&ret, l2jump);
14513 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (GEN_INT (8), mode, mem_mode,
14514 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14515 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
14516 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_minus, 0, 0));
14517 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
14518 l1jump = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_skip, 0, 0);
14519 add_loc_descr (&ret, l1jump);
14520 l2label = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_drop, 0, 0);
14521 add_loc_descr (&ret, l2label);
14522 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
14523 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_drop, 0, 0));
14524 l1jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
14525 l1jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = l1label;
14526 l2jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
14527 l2jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = l2label;
14528 return ret;
14531 /* ROTATE (constMASK is mode mask, BITSIZE is bitsize of mode):
14532 DW_OP_over DW_OP_over DW_OP_shl [ constMASK DW_OP_and ] DW_OP_rot
14533 [ DW_OP_swap constMASK DW_OP_and DW_OP_swap ] DW_OP_neg
14534 DW_OP_plus_uconst <BITSIZE> DW_OP_shr DW_OP_or
14536 ROTATERT is similar:
14537 DW_OP_over DW_OP_over DW_OP_neg DW_OP_plus_uconst <BITSIZE>
14538 DW_OP_shl [ constMASK DW_OP_and ] DW_OP_rot
14539 [ DW_OP_swap constMASK DW_OP_and DW_OP_swap ] DW_OP_shr DW_OP_or */
14541 static dw_loc_descr_ref
14542 rotate_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, scalar_int_mode mode,
14543 machine_mode mem_mode)
14545 rtx rtlop1 = XEXP (rtl, 1);
14546 dw_loc_descr_ref op0, op1, ret, mask[2] = { NULL, NULL };
14547 int i;
14549 if (GET_MODE (rtlop1) != VOIDmode
14550 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (rtlop1)) < GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode))
14551 rtlop1 = gen_rtx_ZERO_EXTEND (mode, rtlop1);
14552 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
14553 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14554 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (rtlop1, mode, mem_mode,
14555 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14556 if (op0 == NULL || op1 == NULL)
14557 return NULL;
14558 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) < DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14559 for (i = 0; i < 2; i++)
14561 if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) < HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
14562 mask[i] = mem_loc_descriptor (GEN_INT (GET_MODE_MASK (mode)),
14563 mode, mem_mode,
14564 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14565 else if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) == HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
14566 mask[i] = new_loc_descr (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32
14567 ? DW_OP_const4u
14568 : HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 64
14569 ? DW_OP_const8u : DW_OP_constu,
14570 GET_MODE_MASK (mode), 0);
14571 else
14572 mask[i] = NULL;
14573 if (mask[i] == NULL)
14574 return NULL;
14575 add_loc_descr (&mask[i], new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
14577 ret = op0;
14578 add_loc_descr (&ret, op1);
14579 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_over, 0, 0));
14580 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_over, 0, 0));
14581 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == ROTATERT)
14583 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_neg, 0, 0));
14584 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst,
14585 GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode), 0));
14587 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
14588 if (mask[0] != NULL)
14589 add_loc_descr (&ret, mask[0]);
14590 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_rot, 0, 0));
14591 if (mask[1] != NULL)
14593 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
14594 add_loc_descr (&ret, mask[1]);
14595 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
14597 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == ROTATE)
14599 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_neg, 0, 0));
14600 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst,
14601 GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode), 0));
14603 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shr, 0, 0));
14604 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_or, 0, 0));
14605 return ret;
14608 /* Helper function for mem_loc_descriptor. Return DW_OP_GNU_parameter_ref
14609 for DEBUG_PARAMETER_REF RTL. */
14611 static dw_loc_descr_ref
14612 parameter_ref_descriptor (rtx rtl)
14614 dw_loc_descr_ref ret;
14615 dw_die_ref ref;
14617 if (dwarf_strict)
14618 return NULL;
14619 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (DEBUG_PARAMETER_REF_DECL (rtl)) == PARM_DECL);
14620 /* With LTO during LTRANS we get the late DIE that refers to the early
14621 DIE, thus we add another indirection here. This seems to confuse
14622 gdb enough to make gcc.dg/guality/pr68860-1.c FAIL with LTO. */
14623 ref = lookup_decl_die (DEBUG_PARAMETER_REF_DECL (rtl));
14624 ret = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_parameter_ref, 0, 0);
14625 if (ref)
14627 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
14628 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = ref;
14629 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
14631 else
14633 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_decl_ref;
14634 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_decl_ref = DEBUG_PARAMETER_REF_DECL (rtl);
14636 return ret;
14639 /* The following routine converts the RTL for a variable or parameter
14640 (resident in memory) into an equivalent Dwarf representation of a
14641 mechanism for getting the address of that same variable onto the top of a
14642 hypothetical "address evaluation" stack.
14644 When creating memory location descriptors, we are effectively transforming
14645 the RTL for a memory-resident object into its Dwarf postfix expression
14646 equivalent. This routine recursively descends an RTL tree, turning
14647 it into Dwarf postfix code as it goes.
14649 MODE is the mode that should be assumed for the rtl if it is VOIDmode.
14651 MEM_MODE is the mode of the memory reference, needed to handle some
14652 autoincrement addressing modes.
14654 Return 0 if we can't represent the location. */
14656 dw_loc_descr_ref
14657 mem_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, machine_mode mode,
14658 machine_mode mem_mode,
14659 enum var_init_status initialized)
14661 dw_loc_descr_ref mem_loc_result = NULL;
14662 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
14663 dw_loc_descr_ref op0, op1;
14664 rtx inner = NULL_RTX;
14666 if (mode == VOIDmode)
14667 mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
14669 /* Note that for a dynamically sized array, the location we will generate a
14670 description of here will be the lowest numbered location which is
14671 actually within the array. That's *not* necessarily the same as the
14672 zeroth element of the array. */
14674 rtl = targetm.delegitimize_address (rtl);
14676 if (mode != GET_MODE (rtl) && GET_MODE (rtl) != VOIDmode)
14677 return NULL;
14679 scalar_int_mode int_mode, inner_mode, op1_mode;
14680 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
14682 case POST_INC:
14683 case POST_DEC:
14684 case POST_MODIFY:
14685 return mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode, initialized);
14687 case SUBREG:
14688 /* The case of a subreg may arise when we have a local (register)
14689 variable or a formal (register) parameter which doesn't quite fill
14690 up an entire register. For now, just assume that it is
14691 legitimate to make the Dwarf info refer to the whole register which
14692 contains the given subreg. */
14693 if (!subreg_lowpart_p (rtl))
14694 break;
14695 inner = SUBREG_REG (rtl);
14696 /* FALLTHRU */
14697 case TRUNCATE:
14698 if (inner == NULL_RTX)
14699 inner = XEXP (rtl, 0);
14700 if (is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
14701 && is_a <scalar_int_mode> (GET_MODE (inner), &inner_mode)
14702 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
14703 #ifdef POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
14704 || (int_mode == Pmode && mem_mode != VOIDmode)
14705 #endif
14707 && GET_MODE_SIZE (inner_mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14709 mem_loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (inner,
14710 inner_mode,
14711 mem_mode, initialized);
14712 break;
14714 if (dwarf_strict && dwarf_version < 5)
14715 break;
14716 if (is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
14717 && is_a <scalar_int_mode> (GET_MODE (inner), &inner_mode)
14718 ? GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) <= GET_MODE_SIZE (inner_mode)
14719 : GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) == GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (inner)))
14721 dw_die_ref type_die;
14722 dw_loc_descr_ref cvt;
14724 mem_loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (inner,
14725 GET_MODE (inner),
14726 mem_mode, initialized);
14727 if (mem_loc_result == NULL)
14728 break;
14729 type_die = base_type_for_mode (mode, SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (mode));
14730 if (type_die == NULL)
14732 mem_loc_result = NULL;
14733 break;
14735 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode)
14736 != GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (inner)))
14737 cvt = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_convert), 0, 0);
14738 else
14739 cvt = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_reinterpret), 0, 0);
14740 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
14741 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
14742 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
14743 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, cvt);
14744 if (is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
14745 && GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14747 /* Convert it to untyped afterwards. */
14748 cvt = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_convert), 0, 0);
14749 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, cvt);
14752 break;
14754 case REG:
14755 if (!is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
14756 || (GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
14757 && rtl != arg_pointer_rtx
14758 && rtl != frame_pointer_rtx
14759 #ifdef POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
14760 && (int_mode != Pmode || mem_mode == VOIDmode)
14761 #endif
14764 dw_die_ref type_die;
14765 unsigned int dbx_regnum;
14767 if (dwarf_strict && dwarf_version < 5)
14768 break;
14769 if (REGNO (rtl) > FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
14770 break;
14771 type_die = base_type_for_mode (mode, SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (mode));
14772 if (type_die == NULL)
14773 break;
14775 dbx_regnum = dbx_reg_number (rtl);
14776 if (dbx_regnum == IGNORED_DWARF_REGNUM)
14777 break;
14778 mem_loc_result = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_regval_type),
14779 dbx_regnum, 0);
14780 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
14781 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
14782 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
14783 break;
14785 /* Whenever a register number forms a part of the description of the
14786 method for calculating the (dynamic) address of a memory resident
14787 object, DWARF rules require the register number be referred to as
14788 a "base register". This distinction is not based in any way upon
14789 what category of register the hardware believes the given register
14790 belongs to. This is strictly DWARF terminology we're dealing with
14791 here. Note that in cases where the location of a memory-resident
14792 data object could be expressed as: OP_ADD (OP_BASEREG (basereg),
14793 OP_CONST (0)) the actual DWARF location descriptor that we generate
14794 may just be OP_BASEREG (basereg). This may look deceptively like
14795 the object in question was allocated to a register (rather than in
14796 memory) so DWARF consumers need to be aware of the subtle
14797 distinction between OP_REG and OP_BASEREG. */
14798 if (REGNO (rtl) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
14799 mem_loc_result = based_loc_descr (rtl, 0, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14800 else if (stack_realign_drap
14801 && crtl->drap_reg
14802 && crtl->args.internal_arg_pointer == rtl
14803 && REGNO (crtl->drap_reg) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
14805 /* If RTL is internal_arg_pointer, which has been optimized
14806 out, use DRAP instead. */
14807 mem_loc_result = based_loc_descr (crtl->drap_reg, 0,
14808 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14810 break;
14812 case SIGN_EXTEND:
14813 case ZERO_EXTEND:
14814 if (!is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
14815 || !is_a <scalar_int_mode> (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)), &inner_mode))
14816 break;
14817 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), inner_mode,
14818 mem_mode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14819 if (op0 == 0)
14820 break;
14821 else if (GET_CODE (rtl) == ZERO_EXTEND
14822 && GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
14823 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (inner_mode) < HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
14824 /* If DW_OP_const{1,2,4}u won't be used, it is shorter
14825 to expand zero extend as two shifts instead of
14826 masking. */
14827 && GET_MODE_SIZE (inner_mode) <= 4)
14829 mem_loc_result = op0;
14830 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
14831 int_loc_descriptor (GET_MODE_MASK (inner_mode)));
14832 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
14834 else if (GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14836 int shift = DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE - GET_MODE_SIZE (inner_mode);
14837 shift *= BITS_PER_UNIT;
14838 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SIGN_EXTEND)
14839 op = DW_OP_shra;
14840 else
14841 op = DW_OP_shr;
14842 mem_loc_result = op0;
14843 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, int_loc_descriptor (shift));
14844 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
14845 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, int_loc_descriptor (shift));
14846 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
14848 else if (!dwarf_strict || dwarf_version >= 5)
14850 dw_die_ref type_die1, type_die2;
14851 dw_loc_descr_ref cvt;
14853 type_die1 = base_type_for_mode (inner_mode,
14854 GET_CODE (rtl) == ZERO_EXTEND);
14855 if (type_die1 == NULL)
14856 break;
14857 type_die2 = base_type_for_mode (int_mode, 1);
14858 if (type_die2 == NULL)
14859 break;
14860 mem_loc_result = op0;
14861 cvt = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_convert), 0, 0);
14862 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
14863 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die1;
14864 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
14865 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, cvt);
14866 cvt = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_convert), 0, 0);
14867 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
14868 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die2;
14869 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
14870 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, cvt);
14872 break;
14874 case MEM:
14876 rtx new_rtl = avoid_constant_pool_reference (rtl);
14877 if (new_rtl != rtl)
14879 mem_loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (new_rtl, mode, mem_mode,
14880 initialized);
14881 if (mem_loc_result != NULL)
14882 return mem_loc_result;
14885 mem_loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0),
14886 get_address_mode (rtl), mode,
14887 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14888 if (mem_loc_result == NULL)
14889 mem_loc_result = tls_mem_loc_descriptor (rtl);
14890 if (mem_loc_result != NULL)
14892 if (!is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
14893 || GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14895 dw_die_ref type_die;
14896 dw_loc_descr_ref deref;
14898 if (dwarf_strict && dwarf_version < 5)
14899 return NULL;
14900 type_die
14901 = base_type_for_mode (mode, SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (mode));
14902 if (type_die == NULL)
14903 return NULL;
14904 deref = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_deref_type),
14905 GET_MODE_SIZE (mode), 0);
14906 deref->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
14907 deref->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
14908 deref->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
14909 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, deref);
14911 else if (GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14912 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0));
14913 else
14914 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
14915 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref_size,
14916 GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode), 0));
14918 break;
14920 case LO_SUM:
14921 return mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode, mem_mode, initialized);
14923 case LABEL_REF:
14924 /* Some ports can transform a symbol ref into a label ref, because
14925 the symbol ref is too far away and has to be dumped into a constant
14926 pool. */
14927 case CONST:
14928 case SYMBOL_REF:
14929 if (!is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
14930 || (GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
14931 #ifdef POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
14932 && (int_mode != Pmode || mem_mode == VOIDmode)
14933 #endif
14935 break;
14936 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SYMBOL_REF
14937 && SYMBOL_REF_TLS_MODEL (rtl) != TLS_MODEL_NONE)
14939 dw_loc_descr_ref temp;
14941 /* If this is not defined, we have no way to emit the data. */
14942 if (!targetm.have_tls || !targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel)
14943 break;
14945 temp = new_addr_loc_descr (rtl, dtprel_true);
14947 /* We check for DWARF 5 here because gdb did not implement
14948 DW_OP_form_tls_address until after 7.12. */
14949 mem_loc_result = new_loc_descr ((dwarf_version >= 5
14950 ? DW_OP_form_tls_address
14951 : DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address),
14952 0, 0);
14953 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, temp);
14955 break;
14958 if (!const_ok_for_output (rtl))
14960 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST)
14961 mem_loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), int_mode,
14962 mem_mode, initialized);
14963 break;
14966 symref:
14967 mem_loc_result = new_addr_loc_descr (rtl, dtprel_false);
14968 vec_safe_push (used_rtx_array, rtl);
14969 break;
14971 case CONCAT:
14972 case CONCATN:
14973 case VAR_LOCATION:
14974 case DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR:
14975 expansion_failed (NULL_TREE, rtl,
14976 "CONCAT/CONCATN/VAR_LOCATION is handled only by loc_descriptor");
14977 return 0;
14979 case ENTRY_VALUE:
14980 if (dwarf_strict && dwarf_version < 5)
14981 return NULL;
14982 if (REG_P (ENTRY_VALUE_EXP (rtl)))
14984 if (!is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
14985 || GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14986 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (ENTRY_VALUE_EXP (rtl), mode,
14987 VOIDmode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14988 else
14990 unsigned int dbx_regnum = dbx_reg_number (ENTRY_VALUE_EXP (rtl));
14991 if (dbx_regnum == IGNORED_DWARF_REGNUM)
14992 return NULL;
14993 op0 = one_reg_loc_descriptor (dbx_regnum,
14994 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14997 else if (MEM_P (ENTRY_VALUE_EXP (rtl))
14998 && REG_P (XEXP (ENTRY_VALUE_EXP (rtl), 0)))
15000 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (ENTRY_VALUE_EXP (rtl), mode,
15001 VOIDmode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15002 if (op0 && op0->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_fbreg)
15003 return NULL;
15005 else
15006 gcc_unreachable ();
15007 if (op0 == NULL)
15008 return NULL;
15009 mem_loc_result = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_entry_value), 0, 0);
15010 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
15011 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = op0;
15012 break;
15014 case DEBUG_PARAMETER_REF:
15015 mem_loc_result = parameter_ref_descriptor (rtl);
15016 break;
15018 case PRE_MODIFY:
15019 /* Extract the PLUS expression nested inside and fall into
15020 PLUS code below. */
15021 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 1);
15022 goto plus;
15024 case PRE_INC:
15025 case PRE_DEC:
15026 /* Turn these into a PLUS expression and fall into the PLUS code
15027 below. */
15028 rtl = gen_rtx_PLUS (mode, XEXP (rtl, 0),
15029 gen_int_mode (GET_CODE (rtl) == PRE_INC
15030 ? GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (mem_mode)
15031 : -GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (mem_mode),
15032 mode));
15034 /* fall through */
15036 case PLUS:
15037 plus:
15038 if (is_based_loc (rtl)
15039 && is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
15040 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
15041 || XEXP (rtl, 0) == arg_pointer_rtx
15042 || XEXP (rtl, 0) == frame_pointer_rtx))
15043 mem_loc_result = based_loc_descr (XEXP (rtl, 0),
15044 INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)),
15045 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15046 else
15048 mem_loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
15049 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15050 if (mem_loc_result == 0)
15051 break;
15053 if (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1))
15054 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (as_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode))
15055 <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE))
15056 loc_descr_plus_const (&mem_loc_result, INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)));
15057 else
15059 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode, mem_mode,
15060 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15061 if (op1 == 0)
15062 return NULL;
15063 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op1);
15064 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
15065 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
15068 break;
15070 /* If a pseudo-reg is optimized away, it is possible for it to
15071 be replaced with a MEM containing a multiply or shift. */
15072 case MINUS:
15073 op = DW_OP_minus;
15074 goto do_binop;
15076 case MULT:
15077 op = DW_OP_mul;
15078 goto do_binop;
15080 case DIV:
15081 if ((!dwarf_strict || dwarf_version >= 5)
15082 && is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
15083 && GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
15085 mem_loc_result = typed_binop (DW_OP_div, rtl,
15086 base_type_for_mode (mode, 0),
15087 int_mode, mem_mode);
15088 break;
15090 op = DW_OP_div;
15091 goto do_binop;
15093 case UMOD:
15094 op = DW_OP_mod;
15095 goto do_binop;
15097 case ASHIFT:
15098 op = DW_OP_shl;
15099 goto do_shift;
15101 case ASHIFTRT:
15102 op = DW_OP_shra;
15103 goto do_shift;
15105 case LSHIFTRT:
15106 op = DW_OP_shr;
15107 goto do_shift;
15109 do_shift:
15110 if (!is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode))
15111 break;
15112 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), int_mode, mem_mode,
15113 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15115 rtx rtlop1 = XEXP (rtl, 1);
15116 if (is_a <scalar_int_mode> (GET_MODE (rtlop1), &op1_mode)
15117 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (op1_mode) < GET_MODE_BITSIZE (int_mode))
15118 rtlop1 = gen_rtx_ZERO_EXTEND (int_mode, rtlop1);
15119 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (rtlop1, int_mode, mem_mode,
15120 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15123 if (op0 == 0 || op1 == 0)
15124 break;
15126 mem_loc_result = op0;
15127 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op1);
15128 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
15129 break;
15131 case AND:
15132 op = DW_OP_and;
15133 goto do_binop;
15135 case IOR:
15136 op = DW_OP_or;
15137 goto do_binop;
15139 case XOR:
15140 op = DW_OP_xor;
15141 goto do_binop;
15143 do_binop:
15144 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
15145 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15146 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode, mem_mode,
15147 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15149 if (op0 == 0 || op1 == 0)
15150 break;
15152 mem_loc_result = op0;
15153 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op1);
15154 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
15155 break;
15157 case MOD:
15158 if ((!dwarf_strict || dwarf_version >= 5)
15159 && is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
15160 && GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
15162 mem_loc_result = typed_binop (DW_OP_mod, rtl,
15163 base_type_for_mode (mode, 0),
15164 int_mode, mem_mode);
15165 break;
15168 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
15169 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15170 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode, mem_mode,
15171 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15173 if (op0 == 0 || op1 == 0)
15174 break;
15176 mem_loc_result = op0;
15177 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op1);
15178 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_over, 0, 0));
15179 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_over, 0, 0));
15180 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_div, 0, 0));
15181 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_mul, 0, 0));
15182 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_minus, 0, 0));
15183 break;
15185 case UDIV:
15186 if ((!dwarf_strict || dwarf_version >= 5)
15187 && is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode))
15189 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
15191 op = DW_OP_div;
15192 goto do_binop;
15194 mem_loc_result = typed_binop (DW_OP_div, rtl,
15195 base_type_for_mode (int_mode, 1),
15196 int_mode, mem_mode);
15198 break;
15200 case NOT:
15201 op = DW_OP_not;
15202 goto do_unop;
15204 case ABS:
15205 op = DW_OP_abs;
15206 goto do_unop;
15208 case NEG:
15209 op = DW_OP_neg;
15210 goto do_unop;
15212 do_unop:
15213 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
15214 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15216 if (op0 == 0)
15217 break;
15219 mem_loc_result = op0;
15220 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
15221 break;
15223 case CONST_INT:
15224 if (!is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
15225 || GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
15226 #ifdef POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
15227 || (int_mode == Pmode
15228 && mem_mode != VOIDmode
15229 && trunc_int_for_mode (INTVAL (rtl), ptr_mode) == INTVAL (rtl))
15230 #endif
15233 mem_loc_result = int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (rtl));
15234 break;
15236 if ((!dwarf_strict || dwarf_version >= 5)
15237 && (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (int_mode) == HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
15238 || GET_MODE_BITSIZE (int_mode) == HOST_BITS_PER_DOUBLE_INT))
15240 dw_die_ref type_die = base_type_for_mode (int_mode, 1);
15241 scalar_int_mode amode;
15242 if (type_die == NULL)
15243 return NULL;
15244 if (INTVAL (rtl) >= 0
15245 && (int_mode_for_size (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * BITS_PER_UNIT, 0)
15246 .exists (&amode))
15247 && trunc_int_for_mode (INTVAL (rtl), amode) == INTVAL (rtl)
15248 /* const DW_OP_convert <XXX> vs.
15249 DW_OP_const_type <XXX, 1, const>. */
15250 && size_of_int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (rtl)) + 1 + 1
15251 < (unsigned long) 1 + 1 + 1 + GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode))
15253 mem_loc_result = int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (rtl));
15254 op0 = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_convert), 0, 0);
15255 op0->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
15256 op0->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
15257 op0->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
15258 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op0);
15259 return mem_loc_result;
15261 mem_loc_result = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_const_type), 0,
15262 INTVAL (rtl));
15263 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
15264 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
15265 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
15266 if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (int_mode) == HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
15267 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_const;
15268 else
15270 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class
15271 = dw_val_class_const_double;
15272 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_double
15273 = double_int::from_shwi (INTVAL (rtl));
15276 break;
15278 case CONST_DOUBLE:
15279 if (!dwarf_strict || dwarf_version >= 5)
15281 dw_die_ref type_die;
15283 /* Note that if TARGET_SUPPORTS_WIDE_INT == 0, a
15284 CONST_DOUBLE rtx could represent either a large integer
15285 or a floating-point constant. If TARGET_SUPPORTS_WIDE_INT != 0,
15286 the value is always a floating point constant.
15288 When it is an integer, a CONST_DOUBLE is used whenever
15289 the constant requires 2 HWIs to be adequately represented.
15290 We output CONST_DOUBLEs as blocks. */
15291 if (mode == VOIDmode
15292 || (GET_MODE (rtl) == VOIDmode
15293 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) != HOST_BITS_PER_DOUBLE_INT))
15294 break;
15295 type_die = base_type_for_mode (mode, SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (mode));
15296 if (type_die == NULL)
15297 return NULL;
15298 mem_loc_result = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_const_type), 0, 0);
15299 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
15300 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
15301 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
15302 #if TARGET_SUPPORTS_WIDE_INT == 0
15303 if (!SCALAR_FLOAT_MODE_P (mode))
15305 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class
15306 = dw_val_class_const_double;
15307 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_double
15308 = rtx_to_double_int (rtl);
15310 else
15311 #endif
15313 scalar_float_mode float_mode = as_a <scalar_float_mode> (mode);
15314 unsigned int length = GET_MODE_SIZE (float_mode);
15315 unsigned char *array = ggc_vec_alloc<unsigned char> (length);
15317 insert_float (rtl, array);
15318 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_vec;
15319 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.length = length / 4;
15320 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.elt_size = 4;
15321 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.array = array;
15324 break;
15326 case CONST_WIDE_INT:
15327 if (!dwarf_strict || dwarf_version >= 5)
15329 dw_die_ref type_die;
15331 type_die = base_type_for_mode (mode, SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (mode));
15332 if (type_die == NULL)
15333 return NULL;
15334 mem_loc_result = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_const_type), 0, 0);
15335 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
15336 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
15337 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
15338 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class
15339 = dw_val_class_wide_int;
15340 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_wide = ggc_alloc<wide_int> ();
15341 *mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_wide = rtx_mode_t (rtl, mode);
15343 break;
15345 case EQ:
15346 mem_loc_result = scompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_eq, rtl, mem_mode);
15347 break;
15349 case GE:
15350 mem_loc_result = scompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_ge, rtl, mem_mode);
15351 break;
15353 case GT:
15354 mem_loc_result = scompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_gt, rtl, mem_mode);
15355 break;
15357 case LE:
15358 mem_loc_result = scompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_le, rtl, mem_mode);
15359 break;
15361 case LT:
15362 mem_loc_result = scompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_lt, rtl, mem_mode);
15363 break;
15365 case NE:
15366 mem_loc_result = scompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_ne, rtl, mem_mode);
15367 break;
15369 case GEU:
15370 mem_loc_result = ucompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_ge, rtl, mem_mode);
15371 break;
15373 case GTU:
15374 mem_loc_result = ucompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_gt, rtl, mem_mode);
15375 break;
15377 case LEU:
15378 mem_loc_result = ucompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_le, rtl, mem_mode);
15379 break;
15381 case LTU:
15382 mem_loc_result = ucompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_lt, rtl, mem_mode);
15383 break;
15385 case UMIN:
15386 case UMAX:
15387 if (!SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (mode))
15388 break;
15389 /* FALLTHRU */
15390 case SMIN:
15391 case SMAX:
15392 mem_loc_result = minmax_loc_descriptor (rtl, mode, mem_mode);
15393 break;
15395 case ZERO_EXTRACT:
15396 case SIGN_EXTRACT:
15397 if (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1))
15398 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 2))
15399 && is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
15400 && is_a <scalar_int_mode> (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)), &inner_mode)
15401 && GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
15402 && GET_MODE_SIZE (inner_mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
15403 && ((unsigned) INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1))
15404 + (unsigned) INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 2))
15405 <= GET_MODE_BITSIZE (int_mode)))
15407 int shift, size;
15408 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), inner_mode,
15409 mem_mode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15410 if (op0 == 0)
15411 break;
15412 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SIGN_EXTRACT)
15413 op = DW_OP_shra;
15414 else
15415 op = DW_OP_shr;
15416 mem_loc_result = op0;
15417 size = INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1));
15418 shift = INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 2));
15419 if (BITS_BIG_ENDIAN)
15420 shift = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (inner_mode) - shift - size;
15421 if (shift + size != (int) DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
15423 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
15424 int_loc_descriptor (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
15425 - shift - size));
15426 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
15428 if (size != (int) DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
15430 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
15431 int_loc_descriptor (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE - size));
15432 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
15435 break;
15437 case IF_THEN_ELSE:
15439 dw_loc_descr_ref op2, bra_node, drop_node;
15440 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0),
15441 GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == VOIDmode
15442 ? word_mode : GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)),
15443 mem_mode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15444 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode, mem_mode,
15445 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15446 op2 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 2), mode, mem_mode,
15447 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15448 if (op0 == NULL || op1 == NULL || op2 == NULL)
15449 break;
15451 mem_loc_result = op1;
15452 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op2);
15453 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op0);
15454 bra_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
15455 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, bra_node);
15456 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
15457 drop_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_drop, 0, 0);
15458 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, drop_node);
15459 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
15460 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = drop_node;
15462 break;
15464 case FLOAT_EXTEND:
15465 case FLOAT_TRUNCATE:
15466 case FLOAT:
15467 case UNSIGNED_FLOAT:
15468 case FIX:
15469 case UNSIGNED_FIX:
15470 if (!dwarf_strict || dwarf_version >= 5)
15472 dw_die_ref type_die;
15473 dw_loc_descr_ref cvt;
15475 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)),
15476 mem_mode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15477 if (op0 == NULL)
15478 break;
15479 if (is_a <scalar_int_mode> (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)), &int_mode)
15480 && (GET_CODE (rtl) == FLOAT
15481 || GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE))
15483 type_die = base_type_for_mode (int_mode,
15484 GET_CODE (rtl) == UNSIGNED_FLOAT);
15485 if (type_die == NULL)
15486 break;
15487 cvt = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_convert), 0, 0);
15488 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
15489 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
15490 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
15491 add_loc_descr (&op0, cvt);
15493 type_die = base_type_for_mode (mode, GET_CODE (rtl) == UNSIGNED_FIX);
15494 if (type_die == NULL)
15495 break;
15496 cvt = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_convert), 0, 0);
15497 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
15498 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
15499 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
15500 add_loc_descr (&op0, cvt);
15501 if (is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
15502 && (GET_CODE (rtl) == FIX
15503 || GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) < DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE))
15505 op0 = convert_descriptor_to_mode (int_mode, op0);
15506 if (op0 == NULL)
15507 break;
15509 mem_loc_result = op0;
15511 break;
15513 case CLZ:
15514 case CTZ:
15515 case FFS:
15516 if (is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode))
15517 mem_loc_result = clz_loc_descriptor (rtl, int_mode, mem_mode);
15518 break;
15520 case POPCOUNT:
15521 case PARITY:
15522 if (is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode))
15523 mem_loc_result = popcount_loc_descriptor (rtl, int_mode, mem_mode);
15524 break;
15526 case BSWAP:
15527 if (is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode))
15528 mem_loc_result = bswap_loc_descriptor (rtl, int_mode, mem_mode);
15529 break;
15531 case ROTATE:
15532 case ROTATERT:
15533 if (is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode))
15534 mem_loc_result = rotate_loc_descriptor (rtl, int_mode, mem_mode);
15535 break;
15537 case COMPARE:
15538 /* In theory, we could implement the above. */
15539 /* DWARF cannot represent the unsigned compare operations
15540 natively. */
15541 case SS_MULT:
15542 case US_MULT:
15543 case SS_DIV:
15544 case US_DIV:
15545 case SS_PLUS:
15546 case US_PLUS:
15547 case SS_MINUS:
15548 case US_MINUS:
15549 case SS_NEG:
15550 case US_NEG:
15551 case SS_ABS:
15552 case SS_ASHIFT:
15553 case US_ASHIFT:
15554 case SS_TRUNCATE:
15555 case US_TRUNCATE:
15556 case UNORDERED:
15557 case ORDERED:
15558 case UNEQ:
15559 case UNGE:
15560 case UNGT:
15561 case UNLE:
15562 case UNLT:
15563 case LTGT:
15564 case FRACT_CONVERT:
15565 case UNSIGNED_FRACT_CONVERT:
15566 case SAT_FRACT:
15567 case UNSIGNED_SAT_FRACT:
15568 case SQRT:
15569 case ASM_OPERANDS:
15570 case VEC_MERGE:
15571 case VEC_SELECT:
15572 case VEC_CONCAT:
15573 case VEC_DUPLICATE:
15574 case UNSPEC:
15575 case HIGH:
15576 case FMA:
15577 case STRICT_LOW_PART:
15578 case CONST_VECTOR:
15579 case CONST_FIXED:
15580 case CLRSB:
15581 case CLOBBER:
15582 /* If delegitimize_address couldn't do anything with the UNSPEC, we
15583 can't express it in the debug info. This can happen e.g. with some
15584 TLS UNSPECs. */
15585 break;
15587 case CONST_STRING:
15588 resolve_one_addr (&rtl);
15589 goto symref;
15591 /* RTL sequences inside PARALLEL record a series of DWARF operations for
15592 the expression. An UNSPEC rtx represents a raw DWARF operation,
15593 new_loc_descr is called for it to build the operation directly.
15594 Otherwise mem_loc_descriptor is called recursively. */
15595 case PARALLEL:
15597 int index = 0;
15598 dw_loc_descr_ref exp_result = NULL;
15600 for (; index < XVECLEN (rtl, 0); index++)
15602 rtx elem = XVECEXP (rtl, 0, index);
15603 if (GET_CODE (elem) == UNSPEC)
15605 /* Each DWARF operation UNSPEC contain two operands, if
15606 one operand is not used for the operation, const0_rtx is
15607 passed. */
15608 gcc_assert (XVECLEN (elem, 0) == 2);
15610 HOST_WIDE_INT dw_op = XINT (elem, 1);
15611 HOST_WIDE_INT oprnd1 = INTVAL (XVECEXP (elem, 0, 0));
15612 HOST_WIDE_INT oprnd2 = INTVAL (XVECEXP (elem, 0, 1));
15613 exp_result
15614 = new_loc_descr ((enum dwarf_location_atom) dw_op, oprnd1,
15615 oprnd2);
15617 else
15618 exp_result
15619 = mem_loc_descriptor (elem, mode, mem_mode,
15620 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15622 if (!mem_loc_result)
15623 mem_loc_result = exp_result;
15624 else
15625 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, exp_result);
15628 break;
15631 default:
15632 if (flag_checking)
15634 print_rtl (stderr, rtl);
15635 gcc_unreachable ();
15637 break;
15640 if (mem_loc_result && initialized == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
15641 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit, 0, 0));
15643 return mem_loc_result;
15646 /* Return a descriptor that describes the concatenation of two locations.
15647 This is typically a complex variable. */
15649 static dw_loc_descr_ref
15650 concat_loc_descriptor (rtx x0, rtx x1, enum var_init_status initialized)
15652 dw_loc_descr_ref cc_loc_result = NULL;
15653 dw_loc_descr_ref x0_ref
15654 = loc_descriptor (x0, VOIDmode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15655 dw_loc_descr_ref x1_ref
15656 = loc_descriptor (x1, VOIDmode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15658 if (x0_ref == 0 || x1_ref == 0)
15659 return 0;
15661 cc_loc_result = x0_ref;
15662 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&cc_loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x0)));
15664 add_loc_descr (&cc_loc_result, x1_ref);
15665 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&cc_loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x1)));
15667 if (initialized == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
15668 add_loc_descr (&cc_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit, 0, 0));
15670 return cc_loc_result;
15673 /* Return a descriptor that describes the concatenation of N
15674 locations. */
15676 static dw_loc_descr_ref
15677 concatn_loc_descriptor (rtx concatn, enum var_init_status initialized)
15679 unsigned int i;
15680 dw_loc_descr_ref cc_loc_result = NULL;
15681 unsigned int n = XVECLEN (concatn, 0);
15683 for (i = 0; i < n; ++i)
15685 dw_loc_descr_ref ref;
15686 rtx x = XVECEXP (concatn, 0, i);
15688 ref = loc_descriptor (x, VOIDmode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15689 if (ref == NULL)
15690 return NULL;
15692 add_loc_descr (&cc_loc_result, ref);
15693 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&cc_loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x)));
15696 if (cc_loc_result && initialized == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
15697 add_loc_descr (&cc_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit, 0, 0));
15699 return cc_loc_result;
15702 /* Helper function for loc_descriptor. Return DW_OP_implicit_pointer
15703 for DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR RTL. */
15705 static dw_loc_descr_ref
15706 implicit_ptr_descriptor (rtx rtl, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
15708 dw_loc_descr_ref ret;
15709 dw_die_ref ref;
15711 if (dwarf_strict && dwarf_version < 5)
15712 return NULL;
15713 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR_DECL (rtl)) == VAR_DECL
15714 || TREE_CODE (DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR_DECL (rtl)) == PARM_DECL
15715 || TREE_CODE (DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR_DECL (rtl)) == RESULT_DECL);
15716 ref = lookup_decl_die (DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR_DECL (rtl));
15717 ret = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_implicit_pointer), 0, offset);
15718 ret->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_const;
15719 if (ref)
15721 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
15722 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = ref;
15723 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
15725 else
15727 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_decl_ref;
15728 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_decl_ref = DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR_DECL (rtl);
15730 return ret;
15733 /* Output a proper Dwarf location descriptor for a variable or parameter
15734 which is either allocated in a register or in a memory location. For a
15735 register, we just generate an OP_REG and the register number. For a
15736 memory location we provide a Dwarf postfix expression describing how to
15737 generate the (dynamic) address of the object onto the address stack.
15739 MODE is mode of the decl if this loc_descriptor is going to be used in
15740 .debug_loc section where DW_OP_stack_value and DW_OP_implicit_value are
15741 allowed, VOIDmode otherwise.
15743 If we don't know how to describe it, return 0. */
15745 static dw_loc_descr_ref
15746 loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, machine_mode mode,
15747 enum var_init_status initialized)
15749 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result = NULL;
15750 scalar_int_mode int_mode;
15752 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
15754 case SUBREG:
15755 /* The case of a subreg may arise when we have a local (register)
15756 variable or a formal (register) parameter which doesn't quite fill
15757 up an entire register. For now, just assume that it is
15758 legitimate to make the Dwarf info refer to the whole register which
15759 contains the given subreg. */
15760 if (REG_P (SUBREG_REG (rtl)) && subreg_lowpart_p (rtl))
15761 loc_result = loc_descriptor (SUBREG_REG (rtl),
15762 GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (rtl)), initialized);
15763 else
15764 goto do_default;
15765 break;
15767 case REG:
15768 loc_result = reg_loc_descriptor (rtl, initialized);
15769 break;
15771 case MEM:
15772 loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), get_address_mode (rtl),
15773 GET_MODE (rtl), initialized);
15774 if (loc_result == NULL)
15775 loc_result = tls_mem_loc_descriptor (rtl);
15776 if (loc_result == NULL)
15778 rtx new_rtl = avoid_constant_pool_reference (rtl);
15779 if (new_rtl != rtl)
15780 loc_result = loc_descriptor (new_rtl, mode, initialized);
15782 break;
15784 case CONCAT:
15785 loc_result = concat_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), XEXP (rtl, 1),
15786 initialized);
15787 break;
15789 case CONCATN:
15790 loc_result = concatn_loc_descriptor (rtl, initialized);
15791 break;
15793 case VAR_LOCATION:
15794 /* Single part. */
15795 if (GET_CODE (PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (rtl)) != PARALLEL)
15797 rtx loc = PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (rtl);
15798 if (GET_CODE (loc) == EXPR_LIST)
15799 loc = XEXP (loc, 0);
15800 loc_result = loc_descriptor (loc, mode, initialized);
15801 break;
15804 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 1);
15805 /* FALLTHRU */
15807 case PARALLEL:
15809 rtvec par_elems = XVEC (rtl, 0);
15810 int num_elem = GET_NUM_ELEM (par_elems);
15811 machine_mode mode;
15812 int i;
15814 /* Create the first one, so we have something to add to. */
15815 loc_result = loc_descriptor (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems, 0), 0),
15816 VOIDmode, initialized);
15817 if (loc_result == NULL)
15818 return NULL;
15819 mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems, 0), 0));
15820 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (mode));
15821 for (i = 1; i < num_elem; i++)
15823 dw_loc_descr_ref temp;
15825 temp = loc_descriptor (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems, i), 0),
15826 VOIDmode, initialized);
15827 if (temp == NULL)
15828 return NULL;
15829 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, temp);
15830 mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems, i), 0));
15831 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (mode));
15834 break;
15836 case CONST_INT:
15837 if (mode != VOIDmode && mode != BLKmode)
15839 int_mode = as_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode);
15840 loc_result = address_of_int_loc_descriptor (GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode),
15841 INTVAL (rtl));
15843 break;
15845 case CONST_DOUBLE:
15846 if (mode == VOIDmode)
15847 mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
15849 if (mode != VOIDmode && (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
15851 gcc_assert (mode == GET_MODE (rtl) || VOIDmode == GET_MODE (rtl));
15853 /* Note that a CONST_DOUBLE rtx could represent either an integer
15854 or a floating-point constant. A CONST_DOUBLE is used whenever
15855 the constant requires more than one word in order to be
15856 adequately represented. We output CONST_DOUBLEs as blocks. */
15857 scalar_mode smode = as_a <scalar_mode> (mode);
15858 loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_implicit_value,
15859 GET_MODE_SIZE (smode), 0);
15860 #if TARGET_SUPPORTS_WIDE_INT == 0
15861 if (!SCALAR_FLOAT_MODE_P (smode))
15863 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_const_double;
15864 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_double
15865 = rtx_to_double_int (rtl);
15867 else
15868 #endif
15870 unsigned int length = GET_MODE_SIZE (smode);
15871 unsigned char *array = ggc_vec_alloc<unsigned char> (length);
15873 insert_float (rtl, array);
15874 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_vec;
15875 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.length = length / 4;
15876 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.elt_size = 4;
15877 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.array = array;
15880 break;
15882 case CONST_WIDE_INT:
15883 if (mode == VOIDmode)
15884 mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
15886 if (mode != VOIDmode && (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
15888 int_mode = as_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode);
15889 loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_implicit_value,
15890 GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode), 0);
15891 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_wide_int;
15892 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_wide = ggc_alloc<wide_int> ();
15893 *loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_wide = rtx_mode_t (rtl, int_mode);
15895 break;
15897 case CONST_VECTOR:
15898 if (mode == VOIDmode)
15899 mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
15901 if (mode != VOIDmode && (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
15903 unsigned int elt_size = GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl));
15904 unsigned int length = CONST_VECTOR_NUNITS (rtl);
15905 unsigned char *array
15906 = ggc_vec_alloc<unsigned char> (length * elt_size);
15907 unsigned int i;
15908 unsigned char *p;
15909 machine_mode imode = GET_MODE_INNER (mode);
15911 gcc_assert (mode == GET_MODE (rtl) || VOIDmode == GET_MODE (rtl));
15912 switch (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode))
15914 case MODE_VECTOR_INT:
15915 for (i = 0, p = array; i < length; i++, p += elt_size)
15917 rtx elt = CONST_VECTOR_ELT (rtl, i);
15918 insert_wide_int (rtx_mode_t (elt, imode), p, elt_size);
15920 break;
15922 case MODE_VECTOR_FLOAT:
15923 for (i = 0, p = array; i < length; i++, p += elt_size)
15925 rtx elt = CONST_VECTOR_ELT (rtl, i);
15926 insert_float (elt, p);
15928 break;
15930 default:
15931 gcc_unreachable ();
15934 loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_implicit_value,
15935 length * elt_size, 0);
15936 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_vec;
15937 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.length = length;
15938 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.elt_size = elt_size;
15939 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.array = array;
15941 break;
15943 case CONST:
15944 if (mode == VOIDmode
15945 || CONST_SCALAR_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
15946 || CONST_DOUBLE_AS_FLOAT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
15947 || GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == CONST_VECTOR)
15949 loc_result = loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, initialized);
15950 break;
15952 /* FALLTHROUGH */
15953 case SYMBOL_REF:
15954 if (!const_ok_for_output (rtl))
15955 break;
15956 /* FALLTHROUGH */
15957 case LABEL_REF:
15958 if (is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
15959 && GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
15960 && (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
15962 loc_result = new_addr_loc_descr (rtl, dtprel_false);
15963 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
15964 vec_safe_push (used_rtx_array, rtl);
15966 break;
15968 case DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR:
15969 loc_result = implicit_ptr_descriptor (rtl, 0);
15970 break;
15972 case PLUS:
15973 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR
15974 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1)))
15976 loc_result
15977 = implicit_ptr_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)));
15978 break;
15980 /* FALLTHRU */
15981 do_default:
15982 default:
15983 if ((is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
15984 && GET_MODE (rtl) == int_mode
15985 && GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
15986 && dwarf_version >= 4)
15987 || (!dwarf_strict && mode != VOIDmode && mode != BLKmode))
15989 /* Value expression. */
15990 loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (rtl, mode, VOIDmode, initialized);
15991 if (loc_result)
15992 add_loc_descr (&loc_result,
15993 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
15995 break;
15998 return loc_result;
16001 /* We need to figure out what section we should use as the base for the
16002 address ranges where a given location is valid.
16003 1. If this particular DECL has a section associated with it, use that.
16004 2. If this function has a section associated with it, use that.
16005 3. Otherwise, use the text section.
16006 XXX: If you split a variable across multiple sections, we won't notice. */
16008 static const char *
16009 secname_for_decl (const_tree decl)
16011 const char *secname;
16013 if (VAR_OR_FUNCTION_DECL_P (decl)
16014 && (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl) || TREE_PUBLIC (decl) || TREE_STATIC (decl))
16015 && DECL_SECTION_NAME (decl))
16016 secname = DECL_SECTION_NAME (decl);
16017 else if (current_function_decl && DECL_SECTION_NAME (current_function_decl))
16018 secname = DECL_SECTION_NAME (current_function_decl);
16019 else if (cfun && in_cold_section_p)
16020 secname = crtl->subsections.cold_section_label;
16021 else
16022 secname = text_section_label;
16024 return secname;
16027 /* Return true when DECL_BY_REFERENCE is defined and set for DECL. */
16029 static bool
16030 decl_by_reference_p (tree decl)
16032 return ((TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL || TREE_CODE (decl) == RESULT_DECL
16033 || VAR_P (decl))
16034 && DECL_BY_REFERENCE (decl));
16037 /* Helper function for dw_loc_list. Compute proper Dwarf location descriptor
16038 for VARLOC. */
16040 static dw_loc_descr_ref
16041 dw_loc_list_1 (tree loc, rtx varloc, int want_address,
16042 enum var_init_status initialized)
16044 int have_address = 0;
16045 dw_loc_descr_ref descr;
16046 machine_mode mode;
16048 if (want_address != 2)
16050 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (varloc) == VAR_LOCATION);
16051 /* Single part. */
16052 if (GET_CODE (PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (varloc)) != PARALLEL)
16054 varloc = PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (varloc);
16055 if (GET_CODE (varloc) == EXPR_LIST)
16056 varloc = XEXP (varloc, 0);
16057 mode = GET_MODE (varloc);
16058 if (MEM_P (varloc))
16060 rtx addr = XEXP (varloc, 0);
16061 descr = mem_loc_descriptor (addr, get_address_mode (varloc),
16062 mode, initialized);
16063 if (descr)
16064 have_address = 1;
16065 else
16067 rtx x = avoid_constant_pool_reference (varloc);
16068 if (x != varloc)
16069 descr = mem_loc_descriptor (x, mode, VOIDmode,
16070 initialized);
16073 else
16074 descr = mem_loc_descriptor (varloc, mode, VOIDmode, initialized);
16076 else
16077 return 0;
16079 else
16081 if (GET_CODE (varloc) == VAR_LOCATION)
16082 mode = DECL_MODE (PAT_VAR_LOCATION_DECL (varloc));
16083 else
16084 mode = DECL_MODE (loc);
16085 descr = loc_descriptor (varloc, mode, initialized);
16086 have_address = 1;
16089 if (!descr)
16090 return 0;
16092 if (want_address == 2 && !have_address
16093 && (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
16095 if (int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc)) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
16097 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
16098 "DWARF address size mismatch");
16099 return 0;
16101 add_loc_descr (&descr, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
16102 have_address = 1;
16104 /* Show if we can't fill the request for an address. */
16105 if (want_address && !have_address)
16107 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
16108 "Want address and only have value");
16109 return 0;
16112 /* If we've got an address and don't want one, dereference. */
16113 if (!want_address && have_address)
16115 HOST_WIDE_INT size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc));
16116 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
16118 if (size > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE || size == -1)
16120 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
16121 "DWARF address size mismatch");
16122 return 0;
16124 else if (size == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
16125 op = DW_OP_deref;
16126 else
16127 op = DW_OP_deref_size;
16129 add_loc_descr (&descr, new_loc_descr (op, size, 0));
16132 return descr;
16135 /* Create a DW_OP_piece or DW_OP_bit_piece for bitsize, or return NULL
16136 if it is not possible. */
16138 static dw_loc_descr_ref
16139 new_loc_descr_op_bit_piece (HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
16141 if ((bitsize % BITS_PER_UNIT) == 0 && offset == 0)
16142 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_piece, bitsize / BITS_PER_UNIT, 0);
16143 else if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
16144 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bit_piece, bitsize, offset);
16145 else
16146 return NULL;
16149 /* Helper function for dw_loc_list. Compute proper Dwarf location descriptor
16150 for VAR_LOC_NOTE for variable DECL that has been optimized by SRA. */
16152 static dw_loc_descr_ref
16153 dw_sra_loc_expr (tree decl, rtx loc)
16155 rtx p;
16156 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT padsize = 0;
16157 dw_loc_descr_ref descr, *descr_tail;
16158 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT decl_size;
16159 rtx varloc;
16160 enum var_init_status initialized;
16162 if (DECL_SIZE (decl) == NULL
16163 || !tree_fits_uhwi_p (DECL_SIZE (decl)))
16164 return NULL;
16166 decl_size = tree_to_uhwi (DECL_SIZE (decl));
16167 descr = NULL;
16168 descr_tail = &descr;
16170 for (p = loc; p; p = XEXP (p, 1))
16172 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize = decl_piece_bitsize (p);
16173 rtx loc_note = *decl_piece_varloc_ptr (p);
16174 dw_loc_descr_ref cur_descr;
16175 dw_loc_descr_ref *tail, last = NULL;
16176 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT opsize = 0;
16178 if (loc_note == NULL_RTX
16179 || NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (loc_note) == NULL_RTX)
16181 padsize += bitsize;
16182 continue;
16184 initialized = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (loc_note);
16185 varloc = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (loc_note);
16186 cur_descr = dw_loc_list_1 (decl, varloc, 2, initialized);
16187 if (cur_descr == NULL)
16189 padsize += bitsize;
16190 continue;
16193 /* Check that cur_descr either doesn't use
16194 DW_OP_*piece operations, or their sum is equal
16195 to bitsize. Otherwise we can't embed it. */
16196 for (tail = &cur_descr; *tail != NULL;
16197 tail = &(*tail)->dw_loc_next)
16198 if ((*tail)->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_piece)
16200 opsize += (*tail)->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned
16201 * BITS_PER_UNIT;
16202 last = *tail;
16204 else if ((*tail)->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_bit_piece)
16206 opsize += (*tail)->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned;
16207 last = *tail;
16210 if (last != NULL && opsize != bitsize)
16212 padsize += bitsize;
16213 /* Discard the current piece of the descriptor and release any
16214 addr_table entries it uses. */
16215 remove_loc_list_addr_table_entries (cur_descr);
16216 continue;
16219 /* If there is a hole, add DW_OP_*piece after empty DWARF
16220 expression, which means that those bits are optimized out. */
16221 if (padsize)
16223 if (padsize > decl_size)
16225 remove_loc_list_addr_table_entries (cur_descr);
16226 goto discard_descr;
16228 decl_size -= padsize;
16229 *descr_tail = new_loc_descr_op_bit_piece (padsize, 0);
16230 if (*descr_tail == NULL)
16232 remove_loc_list_addr_table_entries (cur_descr);
16233 goto discard_descr;
16235 descr_tail = &(*descr_tail)->dw_loc_next;
16236 padsize = 0;
16238 *descr_tail = cur_descr;
16239 descr_tail = tail;
16240 if (bitsize > decl_size)
16241 goto discard_descr;
16242 decl_size -= bitsize;
16243 if (last == NULL)
16245 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
16246 if (GET_CODE (varloc) == VAR_LOCATION
16247 && GET_CODE (PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (varloc)) != PARALLEL)
16249 varloc = PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (varloc);
16250 if (GET_CODE (varloc) == EXPR_LIST)
16251 varloc = XEXP (varloc, 0);
16255 if (GET_CODE (varloc) == CONST
16256 || GET_CODE (varloc) == SIGN_EXTEND
16257 || GET_CODE (varloc) == ZERO_EXTEND)
16258 varloc = XEXP (varloc, 0);
16259 else if (GET_CODE (varloc) == SUBREG)
16260 varloc = SUBREG_REG (varloc);
16261 else
16262 break;
16264 while (1);
16265 /* DW_OP_bit_size offset should be zero for register
16266 or implicit location descriptions and empty location
16267 descriptions, but for memory addresses needs big endian
16268 adjustment. */
16269 if (MEM_P (varloc))
16271 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT memsize
16272 = MEM_SIZE (varloc) * BITS_PER_UNIT;
16273 if (memsize != bitsize)
16275 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN != WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
16276 && (memsize > BITS_PER_WORD || bitsize > BITS_PER_WORD))
16277 goto discard_descr;
16278 if (memsize < bitsize)
16279 goto discard_descr;
16280 if (BITS_BIG_ENDIAN)
16281 offset = memsize - bitsize;
16285 *descr_tail = new_loc_descr_op_bit_piece (bitsize, offset);
16286 if (*descr_tail == NULL)
16287 goto discard_descr;
16288 descr_tail = &(*descr_tail)->dw_loc_next;
16292 /* If there were any non-empty expressions, add padding till the end of
16293 the decl. */
16294 if (descr != NULL && decl_size != 0)
16296 *descr_tail = new_loc_descr_op_bit_piece (decl_size, 0);
16297 if (*descr_tail == NULL)
16298 goto discard_descr;
16300 return descr;
16302 discard_descr:
16303 /* Discard the descriptor and release any addr_table entries it uses. */
16304 remove_loc_list_addr_table_entries (descr);
16305 return NULL;
16308 /* Return the dwarf representation of the location list LOC_LIST of
16309 DECL. WANT_ADDRESS has the same meaning as in loc_list_from_tree
16310 function. */
16312 static dw_loc_list_ref
16313 dw_loc_list (var_loc_list *loc_list, tree decl, int want_address)
16315 const char *endname, *secname;
16316 rtx varloc;
16317 enum var_init_status initialized;
16318 struct var_loc_node *node;
16319 dw_loc_descr_ref descr;
16320 char label_id[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
16321 dw_loc_list_ref list = NULL;
16322 dw_loc_list_ref *listp = &list;
16324 /* Now that we know what section we are using for a base,
16325 actually construct the list of locations.
16326 The first location information is what is passed to the
16327 function that creates the location list, and the remaining
16328 locations just get added on to that list.
16329 Note that we only know the start address for a location
16330 (IE location changes), so to build the range, we use
16331 the range [current location start, next location start].
16332 This means we have to special case the last node, and generate
16333 a range of [last location start, end of function label]. */
16335 secname = secname_for_decl (decl);
16337 for (node = loc_list->first; node; node = node->next)
16338 if (GET_CODE (node->loc) == EXPR_LIST
16339 || NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (node->loc) != NULL_RTX)
16341 if (GET_CODE (node->loc) == EXPR_LIST)
16343 /* This requires DW_OP_{,bit_}piece, which is not usable
16344 inside DWARF expressions. */
16345 if (want_address != 2)
16346 continue;
16347 descr = dw_sra_loc_expr (decl, node->loc);
16348 if (descr == NULL)
16349 continue;
16351 else
16353 initialized = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (node->loc);
16354 varloc = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (node->loc);
16355 descr = dw_loc_list_1 (decl, varloc, want_address, initialized);
16357 if (descr)
16359 bool range_across_switch = false;
16360 /* If section switch happens in between node->label
16361 and node->next->label (or end of function) and
16362 we can't emit it as a single entry list,
16363 emit two ranges, first one ending at the end
16364 of first partition and second one starting at the
16365 beginning of second partition. */
16366 if (node == loc_list->last_before_switch
16367 && (node != loc_list->first || loc_list->first->next)
16368 && current_function_decl)
16370 endname = cfun->fde->dw_fde_end;
16371 range_across_switch = true;
16373 /* The variable has a location between NODE->LABEL and
16374 NODE->NEXT->LABEL. */
16375 else if (node->next)
16376 endname = node->next->label;
16377 /* If the variable has a location at the last label
16378 it keeps its location until the end of function. */
16379 else if (!current_function_decl)
16380 endname = text_end_label;
16381 else
16383 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label_id, FUNC_END_LABEL,
16384 current_function_funcdef_no);
16385 endname = ggc_strdup (label_id);
16388 *listp = new_loc_list (descr, node->label, endname, secname);
16389 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL
16390 && node == loc_list->first
16391 && NOTE_P (node->loc)
16392 && strcmp (node->label, endname) == 0)
16393 (*listp)->force = true;
16394 listp = &(*listp)->dw_loc_next;
16396 if (range_across_switch)
16398 if (GET_CODE (node->loc) == EXPR_LIST)
16399 descr = dw_sra_loc_expr (decl, node->loc);
16400 else
16402 initialized = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (node->loc);
16403 varloc = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (node->loc);
16404 descr = dw_loc_list_1 (decl, varloc, want_address,
16405 initialized);
16407 gcc_assert (descr);
16408 /* The variable has a location between NODE->LABEL and
16409 NODE->NEXT->LABEL. */
16410 if (node->next)
16411 endname = node->next->label;
16412 else
16413 endname = cfun->fde->dw_fde_second_end;
16414 *listp = new_loc_list (descr,
16415 cfun->fde->dw_fde_second_begin,
16416 endname, secname);
16417 listp = &(*listp)->dw_loc_next;
16422 /* Try to avoid the overhead of a location list emitting a location
16423 expression instead, but only if we didn't have more than one
16424 location entry in the first place. If some entries were not
16425 representable, we don't want to pretend a single entry that was
16426 applies to the entire scope in which the variable is
16427 available. */
16428 if (list && loc_list->first->next)
16429 gen_llsym (list);
16431 return list;
16434 /* Return if the loc_list has only single element and thus can be represented
16435 as location description. */
16437 static bool
16438 single_element_loc_list_p (dw_loc_list_ref list)
16440 gcc_assert (!list->dw_loc_next || list->ll_symbol);
16441 return !list->ll_symbol;
16444 /* Duplicate a single element of location list. */
16446 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref
16447 copy_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref ref)
16449 dw_loc_descr_ref copy = ggc_alloc<dw_loc_descr_node> ();
16450 memcpy (copy, ref, sizeof (dw_loc_descr_node));
16451 return copy;
16454 /* To each location in list LIST append loc descr REF. */
16456 static void
16457 add_loc_descr_to_each (dw_loc_list_ref list, dw_loc_descr_ref ref)
16459 dw_loc_descr_ref copy;
16460 add_loc_descr (&list->expr, ref);
16461 list = list->dw_loc_next;
16462 while (list)
16464 copy = copy_loc_descr (ref);
16465 add_loc_descr (&list->expr, copy);
16466 while (copy->dw_loc_next)
16467 copy = copy->dw_loc_next = copy_loc_descr (copy->dw_loc_next);
16468 list = list->dw_loc_next;
16472 /* To each location in list LIST prepend loc descr REF. */
16474 static void
16475 prepend_loc_descr_to_each (dw_loc_list_ref list, dw_loc_descr_ref ref)
16477 dw_loc_descr_ref copy;
16478 dw_loc_descr_ref ref_end = list->expr;
16479 add_loc_descr (&ref, list->expr);
16480 list->expr = ref;
16481 list = list->dw_loc_next;
16482 while (list)
16484 dw_loc_descr_ref end = list->expr;
16485 list->expr = copy = copy_loc_descr (ref);
16486 while (copy->dw_loc_next != ref_end)
16487 copy = copy->dw_loc_next = copy_loc_descr (copy->dw_loc_next);
16488 copy->dw_loc_next = end;
16489 list = list->dw_loc_next;
16493 /* Given two lists RET and LIST
16494 produce location list that is result of adding expression in LIST
16495 to expression in RET on each position in program.
16496 Might be destructive on both RET and LIST.
16498 TODO: We handle only simple cases of RET or LIST having at most one
16499 element. General case would involve sorting the lists in program order
16500 and merging them that will need some additional work.
16501 Adding that will improve quality of debug info especially for SRA-ed
16502 structures. */
16504 static void
16505 add_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref *ret, dw_loc_list_ref list)
16507 if (!list)
16508 return;
16509 if (!*ret)
16511 *ret = list;
16512 return;
16514 if (!list->dw_loc_next)
16516 add_loc_descr_to_each (*ret, list->expr);
16517 return;
16519 if (!(*ret)->dw_loc_next)
16521 prepend_loc_descr_to_each (list, (*ret)->expr);
16522 *ret = list;
16523 return;
16525 expansion_failed (NULL_TREE, NULL_RTX,
16526 "Don't know how to merge two non-trivial"
16527 " location lists.\n");
16528 *ret = NULL;
16529 return;
16532 /* LOC is constant expression. Try a luck, look it up in constant
16533 pool and return its loc_descr of its address. */
16535 static dw_loc_descr_ref
16536 cst_pool_loc_descr (tree loc)
16538 /* Get an RTL for this, if something has been emitted. */
16539 rtx rtl = lookup_constant_def (loc);
16541 if (!rtl || !MEM_P (rtl))
16543 gcc_assert (!rtl);
16544 return 0;
16546 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == SYMBOL_REF);
16548 /* TODO: We might get more coverage if we was actually delaying expansion
16549 of all expressions till end of compilation when constant pools are fully
16550 populated. */
16551 if (!TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (XEXP (rtl, 0))))
16553 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
16554 "CST value in contant pool but not marked.");
16555 return 0;
16557 return mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), get_address_mode (rtl),
16558 GET_MODE (rtl), VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
16561 /* Return dw_loc_list representing address of addr_expr LOC
16562 by looking for inner INDIRECT_REF expression and turning
16563 it into simple arithmetics.
16565 See loc_list_from_tree for the meaning of CONTEXT. */
16567 static dw_loc_list_ref
16568 loc_list_for_address_of_addr_expr_of_indirect_ref (tree loc, bool toplev,
16569 loc_descr_context *context)
16571 tree obj, offset;
16572 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, bitpos, bytepos;
16573 machine_mode mode;
16574 int unsignedp, reversep, volatilep = 0;
16575 dw_loc_list_ref list_ret = NULL, list_ret1 = NULL;
16577 obj = get_inner_reference (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0),
16578 &bitsize, &bitpos, &offset, &mode,
16579 &unsignedp, &reversep, &volatilep);
16580 STRIP_NOPS (obj);
16581 if (bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT)
16583 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "bitfield access");
16584 return 0;
16586 if (!INDIRECT_REF_P (obj))
16588 expansion_failed (obj,
16589 NULL_RTX, "no indirect ref in inner refrence");
16590 return 0;
16592 if (!offset && !bitpos)
16593 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (obj, 0), toplev ? 2 : 1,
16594 context);
16595 else if (toplev
16596 && int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc)) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
16597 && (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
16599 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (obj, 0), 0, context);
16600 if (!list_ret)
16601 return 0;
16602 if (offset)
16604 /* Variable offset. */
16605 list_ret1 = loc_list_from_tree (offset, 0, context);
16606 if (list_ret1 == 0)
16607 return 0;
16608 add_loc_list (&list_ret, list_ret1);
16609 if (!list_ret)
16610 return 0;
16611 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret,
16612 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
16614 bytepos = bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT;
16615 if (bytepos > 0)
16616 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret,
16617 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst,
16618 bytepos, 0));
16619 else if (bytepos < 0)
16620 loc_list_plus_const (list_ret, bytepos);
16621 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret,
16622 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
16624 return list_ret;
16627 /* Set LOC to the next operation that is not a DW_OP_nop operation. In the case
16628 all operations from LOC are nops, move to the last one. Insert in NOPS all
16629 operations that are skipped. */
16631 static void
16632 loc_descr_to_next_no_nop (dw_loc_descr_ref &loc,
16633 hash_set<dw_loc_descr_ref> &nops)
16635 while (loc->dw_loc_next != NULL && loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_nop)
16637 nops.add (loc);
16638 loc = loc->dw_loc_next;
16642 /* Helper for loc_descr_without_nops: free the location description operation
16643 P. */
16645 bool
16646 free_loc_descr (const dw_loc_descr_ref &loc, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
16648 ggc_free (loc);
16649 return true;
16652 /* Remove all DW_OP_nop operations from LOC except, if it exists, the one that
16653 finishes LOC. */
16655 static void
16656 loc_descr_without_nops (dw_loc_descr_ref &loc)
16658 if (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_nop && loc->dw_loc_next == NULL)
16659 return;
16661 /* Set of all DW_OP_nop operations we remove. */
16662 hash_set<dw_loc_descr_ref> nops;
16664 /* First, strip all prefix NOP operations in order to keep the head of the
16665 operations list. */
16666 loc_descr_to_next_no_nop (loc, nops);
16668 for (dw_loc_descr_ref cur = loc; cur != NULL;)
16670 /* For control flow operations: strip "prefix" nops in destination
16671 labels. */
16672 if (cur->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class == dw_val_class_loc)
16673 loc_descr_to_next_no_nop (cur->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc, nops);
16674 if (cur->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class == dw_val_class_loc)
16675 loc_descr_to_next_no_nop (cur->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_loc, nops);
16677 /* Do the same for the operations that follow, then move to the next
16678 iteration. */
16679 if (cur->dw_loc_next != NULL)
16680 loc_descr_to_next_no_nop (cur->dw_loc_next, nops);
16681 cur = cur->dw_loc_next;
16684 nops.traverse<void *, free_loc_descr> (NULL);
16688 struct dwarf_procedure_info;
16690 /* Helper structure for location descriptions generation. */
16691 struct loc_descr_context
16693 /* The type that is implicitly referenced by DW_OP_push_object_address, or
16694 NULL_TREE if DW_OP_push_object_address in invalid for this location
16695 description. This is used when processing PLACEHOLDER_EXPR nodes. */
16696 tree context_type;
16697 /* The ..._DECL node that should be translated as a
16698 DW_OP_push_object_address operation. */
16699 tree base_decl;
16700 /* Information about the DWARF procedure we are currently generating. NULL if
16701 we are not generating a DWARF procedure. */
16702 struct dwarf_procedure_info *dpi;
16703 /* True if integral PLACEHOLDER_EXPR stands for the first argument passed
16704 by consumer. Used for DW_TAG_generic_subrange attributes. */
16705 bool placeholder_arg;
16706 /* True if PLACEHOLDER_EXPR has been seen. */
16707 bool placeholder_seen;
16710 /* DWARF procedures generation
16712 DWARF expressions (aka. location descriptions) are used to encode variable
16713 things such as sizes or offsets. Such computations can have redundant parts
16714 that can be factorized in order to reduce the size of the output debug
16715 information. This is the whole point of DWARF procedures.
16717 Thanks to stor-layout.c, size and offset expressions in GENERIC trees are
16718 already factorized into functions ("size functions") in order to handle very
16719 big and complex types. Such functions are quite simple: they have integral
16720 arguments, they return an integral result and their body contains only a
16721 return statement with arithmetic expressions. This is the only kind of
16722 function we are interested in translating into DWARF procedures, here.
16724 DWARF expressions and DWARF procedure are executed using a stack, so we have
16725 to define some calling convention for them to interact. Let's say that:
16727 - Before calling a DWARF procedure, DWARF expressions must push on the stack
16728 all arguments in reverse order (right-to-left) so that when the DWARF
16729 procedure execution starts, the first argument is the top of the stack.
16731 - Then, when returning, the DWARF procedure must have consumed all arguments
16732 on the stack, must have pushed the result and touched nothing else.
16734 - Each integral argument and the result are integral types can be hold in a
16735 single stack slot.
16737 - We call "frame offset" the number of stack slots that are "under DWARF
16738 procedure control": it includes the arguments slots, the temporaries and
16739 the result slot. Thus, it is equal to the number of arguments when the
16740 procedure execution starts and must be equal to one (the result) when it
16741 returns. */
16743 /* Helper structure used when generating operations for a DWARF procedure. */
16744 struct dwarf_procedure_info
16746 /* The FUNCTION_DECL node corresponding to the DWARF procedure that is
16747 currently translated. */
16748 tree fndecl;
16749 /* The number of arguments FNDECL takes. */
16750 unsigned args_count;
16753 /* Return a pointer to a newly created DIE node for a DWARF procedure. Add
16754 LOCATION as its DW_AT_location attribute. If FNDECL is not NULL_TREE,
16755 equate it to this DIE. */
16757 static dw_die_ref
16758 new_dwarf_proc_die (dw_loc_descr_ref location, tree fndecl,
16759 dw_die_ref parent_die)
16761 dw_die_ref dwarf_proc_die;
16763 if ((dwarf_version < 3 && dwarf_strict)
16764 || location == NULL)
16765 return NULL;
16767 dwarf_proc_die = new_die (DW_TAG_dwarf_procedure, parent_die, fndecl);
16768 if (fndecl)
16769 equate_decl_number_to_die (fndecl, dwarf_proc_die);
16770 add_AT_loc (dwarf_proc_die, DW_AT_location, location);
16771 return dwarf_proc_die;
16774 /* Return whether TYPE is a supported type as a DWARF procedure argument
16775 type or return type (we handle only scalar types and pointer types that
16776 aren't wider than the DWARF expression evaluation stack. */
16778 static bool
16779 is_handled_procedure_type (tree type)
16781 return ((INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (type)
16782 || TREE_CODE (type) == OFFSET_TYPE
16783 || TREE_CODE (type) == POINTER_TYPE)
16784 && int_size_in_bytes (type) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
16787 /* Helper for resolve_args_picking: do the same but stop when coming across
16788 visited nodes. For each node we visit, register in FRAME_OFFSETS the frame
16789 offset *before* evaluating the corresponding operation. */
16791 static bool
16792 resolve_args_picking_1 (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, unsigned initial_frame_offset,
16793 struct dwarf_procedure_info *dpi,
16794 hash_map<dw_loc_descr_ref, unsigned> &frame_offsets)
16796 /* The "frame_offset" identifier is already used to name a macro... */
16797 unsigned frame_offset_ = initial_frame_offset;
16798 dw_loc_descr_ref l;
16800 for (l = loc; l != NULL;)
16802 bool existed;
16803 unsigned &l_frame_offset = frame_offsets.get_or_insert (l, &existed);
16805 /* If we already met this node, there is nothing to compute anymore. */
16806 if (existed)
16808 /* Make sure that the stack size is consistent wherever the execution
16809 flow comes from. */
16810 gcc_assert ((unsigned) l_frame_offset == frame_offset_);
16811 break;
16813 l_frame_offset = frame_offset_;
16815 /* If needed, relocate the picking offset with respect to the frame
16816 offset. */
16817 if (l->frame_offset_rel)
16819 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT off;
16820 switch (l->dw_loc_opc)
16822 case DW_OP_pick:
16823 off = l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned;
16824 break;
16825 case DW_OP_dup:
16826 off = 0;
16827 break;
16828 case DW_OP_over:
16829 off = 1;
16830 break;
16831 default:
16832 gcc_unreachable ();
16834 /* frame_offset_ is the size of the current stack frame, including
16835 incoming arguments. Besides, the arguments are pushed
16836 right-to-left. Thus, in order to access the Nth argument from
16837 this operation node, the picking has to skip temporaries *plus*
16838 one stack slot per argument (0 for the first one, 1 for the second
16839 one, etc.).
16841 The targetted argument number (N) is already set as the operand,
16842 and the number of temporaries can be computed with:
16843 frame_offsets_ - dpi->args_count */
16844 off += frame_offset_ - dpi->args_count;
16846 /* DW_OP_pick handles only offsets from 0 to 255 (inclusive)... */
16847 if (off > 255)
16848 return false;
16850 if (off == 0)
16852 l->dw_loc_opc = DW_OP_dup;
16853 l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned = 0;
16855 else if (off == 1)
16857 l->dw_loc_opc = DW_OP_over;
16858 l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned = 0;
16860 else
16862 l->dw_loc_opc = DW_OP_pick;
16863 l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned = off;
16867 /* Update frame_offset according to the effect the current operation has
16868 on the stack. */
16869 switch (l->dw_loc_opc)
16871 case DW_OP_deref:
16872 case DW_OP_swap:
16873 case DW_OP_rot:
16874 case DW_OP_abs:
16875 case DW_OP_neg:
16876 case DW_OP_not:
16877 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
16878 case DW_OP_skip:
16879 case DW_OP_reg0:
16880 case DW_OP_reg1:
16881 case DW_OP_reg2:
16882 case DW_OP_reg3:
16883 case DW_OP_reg4:
16884 case DW_OP_reg5:
16885 case DW_OP_reg6:
16886 case DW_OP_reg7:
16887 case DW_OP_reg8:
16888 case DW_OP_reg9:
16889 case DW_OP_reg10:
16890 case DW_OP_reg11:
16891 case DW_OP_reg12:
16892 case DW_OP_reg13:
16893 case DW_OP_reg14:
16894 case DW_OP_reg15:
16895 case DW_OP_reg16:
16896 case DW_OP_reg17:
16897 case DW_OP_reg18:
16898 case DW_OP_reg19:
16899 case DW_OP_reg20:
16900 case DW_OP_reg21:
16901 case DW_OP_reg22:
16902 case DW_OP_reg23:
16903 case DW_OP_reg24:
16904 case DW_OP_reg25:
16905 case DW_OP_reg26:
16906 case DW_OP_reg27:
16907 case DW_OP_reg28:
16908 case DW_OP_reg29:
16909 case DW_OP_reg30:
16910 case DW_OP_reg31:
16911 case DW_OP_bregx:
16912 case DW_OP_piece:
16913 case DW_OP_deref_size:
16914 case DW_OP_nop:
16915 case DW_OP_bit_piece:
16916 case DW_OP_implicit_value:
16917 case DW_OP_stack_value:
16918 break;
16920 case DW_OP_addr:
16921 case DW_OP_const1u:
16922 case DW_OP_const1s:
16923 case DW_OP_const2u:
16924 case DW_OP_const2s:
16925 case DW_OP_const4u:
16926 case DW_OP_const4s:
16927 case DW_OP_const8u:
16928 case DW_OP_const8s:
16929 case DW_OP_constu:
16930 case DW_OP_consts:
16931 case DW_OP_dup:
16932 case DW_OP_over:
16933 case DW_OP_pick:
16934 case DW_OP_lit0:
16935 case DW_OP_lit1:
16936 case DW_OP_lit2:
16937 case DW_OP_lit3:
16938 case DW_OP_lit4:
16939 case DW_OP_lit5:
16940 case DW_OP_lit6:
16941 case DW_OP_lit7:
16942 case DW_OP_lit8:
16943 case DW_OP_lit9:
16944 case DW_OP_lit10:
16945 case DW_OP_lit11:
16946 case DW_OP_lit12:
16947 case DW_OP_lit13:
16948 case DW_OP_lit14:
16949 case DW_OP_lit15:
16950 case DW_OP_lit16:
16951 case DW_OP_lit17:
16952 case DW_OP_lit18:
16953 case DW_OP_lit19:
16954 case DW_OP_lit20:
16955 case DW_OP_lit21:
16956 case DW_OP_lit22:
16957 case DW_OP_lit23:
16958 case DW_OP_lit24:
16959 case DW_OP_lit25:
16960 case DW_OP_lit26:
16961 case DW_OP_lit27:
16962 case DW_OP_lit28:
16963 case DW_OP_lit29:
16964 case DW_OP_lit30:
16965 case DW_OP_lit31:
16966 case DW_OP_breg0:
16967 case DW_OP_breg1:
16968 case DW_OP_breg2:
16969 case DW_OP_breg3:
16970 case DW_OP_breg4:
16971 case DW_OP_breg5:
16972 case DW_OP_breg6:
16973 case DW_OP_breg7:
16974 case DW_OP_breg8:
16975 case DW_OP_breg9:
16976 case DW_OP_breg10:
16977 case DW_OP_breg11:
16978 case DW_OP_breg12:
16979 case DW_OP_breg13:
16980 case DW_OP_breg14:
16981 case DW_OP_breg15:
16982 case DW_OP_breg16:
16983 case DW_OP_breg17:
16984 case DW_OP_breg18:
16985 case DW_OP_breg19:
16986 case DW_OP_breg20:
16987 case DW_OP_breg21:
16988 case DW_OP_breg22:
16989 case DW_OP_breg23:
16990 case DW_OP_breg24:
16991 case DW_OP_breg25:
16992 case DW_OP_breg26:
16993 case DW_OP_breg27:
16994 case DW_OP_breg28:
16995 case DW_OP_breg29:
16996 case DW_OP_breg30:
16997 case DW_OP_breg31:
16998 case DW_OP_fbreg:
16999 case DW_OP_push_object_address:
17000 case DW_OP_call_frame_cfa:
17001 case DW_OP_GNU_variable_value:
17002 ++frame_offset_;
17003 break;
17005 case DW_OP_drop:
17006 case DW_OP_xderef:
17007 case DW_OP_and:
17008 case DW_OP_div:
17009 case DW_OP_minus:
17010 case DW_OP_mod:
17011 case DW_OP_mul:
17012 case DW_OP_or:
17013 case DW_OP_plus:
17014 case DW_OP_shl:
17015 case DW_OP_shr:
17016 case DW_OP_shra:
17017 case DW_OP_xor:
17018 case DW_OP_bra:
17019 case DW_OP_eq:
17020 case DW_OP_ge:
17021 case DW_OP_gt:
17022 case DW_OP_le:
17023 case DW_OP_lt:
17024 case DW_OP_ne:
17025 case DW_OP_regx:
17026 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
17027 --frame_offset_;
17028 break;
17030 case DW_OP_call2:
17031 case DW_OP_call4:
17032 case DW_OP_call_ref:
17034 dw_die_ref dwarf_proc = l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die;
17035 int *stack_usage = dwarf_proc_stack_usage_map->get (dwarf_proc);
17037 if (stack_usage == NULL)
17038 return false;
17039 frame_offset_ += *stack_usage;
17040 break;
17043 case DW_OP_implicit_pointer:
17044 case DW_OP_entry_value:
17045 case DW_OP_const_type:
17046 case DW_OP_regval_type:
17047 case DW_OP_deref_type:
17048 case DW_OP_convert:
17049 case DW_OP_reinterpret:
17050 case DW_OP_form_tls_address:
17051 case DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address:
17052 case DW_OP_GNU_uninit:
17053 case DW_OP_GNU_encoded_addr:
17054 case DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer:
17055 case DW_OP_GNU_entry_value:
17056 case DW_OP_GNU_const_type:
17057 case DW_OP_GNU_regval_type:
17058 case DW_OP_GNU_deref_type:
17059 case DW_OP_GNU_convert:
17060 case DW_OP_GNU_reinterpret:
17061 case DW_OP_GNU_parameter_ref:
17062 /* loc_list_from_tree will probably not output these operations for
17063 size functions, so assume they will not appear here. */
17064 /* Fall through... */
17066 default:
17067 gcc_unreachable ();
17070 /* Now, follow the control flow (except subroutine calls). */
17071 switch (l->dw_loc_opc)
17073 case DW_OP_bra:
17074 if (!resolve_args_picking_1 (l->dw_loc_next, frame_offset_, dpi,
17075 frame_offsets))
17076 return false;
17077 /* Fall through. */
17079 case DW_OP_skip:
17080 l = l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc;
17081 break;
17083 case DW_OP_stack_value:
17084 return true;
17086 default:
17087 l = l->dw_loc_next;
17088 break;
17092 return true;
17095 /* Make a DFS over operations reachable through LOC (i.e. follow branch
17096 operations) in order to resolve the operand of DW_OP_pick operations that
17097 target DWARF procedure arguments (DPI). INITIAL_FRAME_OFFSET is the frame
17098 offset *before* LOC is executed. Return if all relocations were
17099 successful. */
17101 static bool
17102 resolve_args_picking (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, unsigned initial_frame_offset,
17103 struct dwarf_procedure_info *dpi)
17105 /* Associate to all visited operations the frame offset *before* evaluating
17106 this operation. */
17107 hash_map<dw_loc_descr_ref, unsigned> frame_offsets;
17109 return resolve_args_picking_1 (loc, initial_frame_offset, dpi,
17110 frame_offsets);
17113 /* Try to generate a DWARF procedure that computes the same result as FNDECL.
17114 Return NULL if it is not possible. */
17116 static dw_die_ref
17117 function_to_dwarf_procedure (tree fndecl)
17119 struct loc_descr_context ctx;
17120 struct dwarf_procedure_info dpi;
17121 dw_die_ref dwarf_proc_die;
17122 tree tree_body = DECL_SAVED_TREE (fndecl);
17123 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_body, epilogue;
17125 tree cursor;
17126 unsigned i;
17128 /* Do not generate multiple DWARF procedures for the same function
17129 declaration. */
17130 dwarf_proc_die = lookup_decl_die (fndecl);
17131 if (dwarf_proc_die != NULL)
17132 return dwarf_proc_die;
17134 /* DWARF procedures are available starting with the DWARFv3 standard. */
17135 if (dwarf_version < 3 && dwarf_strict)
17136 return NULL;
17138 /* We handle only functions for which we still have a body, that return a
17139 supported type and that takes arguments with supported types. Note that
17140 there is no point translating functions that return nothing. */
17141 if (tree_body == NULL_TREE
17142 || DECL_RESULT (fndecl) == NULL_TREE
17143 || !is_handled_procedure_type (TREE_TYPE (DECL_RESULT (fndecl))))
17144 return NULL;
17146 for (cursor = DECL_ARGUMENTS (fndecl);
17147 cursor != NULL_TREE;
17148 cursor = TREE_CHAIN (cursor))
17149 if (!is_handled_procedure_type (TREE_TYPE (cursor)))
17150 return NULL;
17152 /* Match only "expr" in: RETURN_EXPR (MODIFY_EXPR (RESULT_DECL, expr)). */
17153 if (TREE_CODE (tree_body) != RETURN_EXPR)
17154 return NULL;
17155 tree_body = TREE_OPERAND (tree_body, 0);
17156 if (TREE_CODE (tree_body) != MODIFY_EXPR
17157 || TREE_OPERAND (tree_body, 0) != DECL_RESULT (fndecl))
17158 return NULL;
17159 tree_body = TREE_OPERAND (tree_body, 1);
17161 /* Try to translate the body expression itself. Note that this will probably
17162 cause an infinite recursion if its call graph has a cycle. This is very
17163 unlikely for size functions, however, so don't bother with such things at
17164 the moment. */
17165 ctx.context_type = NULL_TREE;
17166 ctx.base_decl = NULL_TREE;
17167 ctx.dpi = &dpi;
17168 ctx.placeholder_arg = false;
17169 ctx.placeholder_seen = false;
17170 dpi.fndecl = fndecl;
17171 dpi.args_count = list_length (DECL_ARGUMENTS (fndecl));
17172 loc_body = loc_descriptor_from_tree (tree_body, 0, &ctx);
17173 if (!loc_body)
17174 return NULL;
17176 /* After evaluating all operands in "loc_body", we should still have on the
17177 stack all arguments plus the desired function result (top of the stack).
17178 Generate code in order to keep only the result in our stack frame. */
17179 epilogue = NULL;
17180 for (i = 0; i < dpi.args_count; ++i)
17182 dw_loc_descr_ref op_couple = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0);
17183 op_couple->dw_loc_next = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_drop, 0, 0);
17184 op_couple->dw_loc_next->dw_loc_next = epilogue;
17185 epilogue = op_couple;
17187 add_loc_descr (&loc_body, epilogue);
17188 if (!resolve_args_picking (loc_body, dpi.args_count, &dpi))
17189 return NULL;
17191 /* Trailing nops from loc_descriptor_from_tree (if any) cannot be removed
17192 because they are considered useful. Now there is an epilogue, they are
17193 not anymore, so give it another try. */
17194 loc_descr_without_nops (loc_body);
17196 /* fndecl may be used both as a regular DW_TAG_subprogram DIE and as
17197 a DW_TAG_dwarf_procedure, so we may have a conflict, here. It's unlikely,
17198 though, given that size functions do not come from source, so they should
17199 not have a dedicated DW_TAG_subprogram DIE. */
17200 dwarf_proc_die
17201 = new_dwarf_proc_die (loc_body, fndecl,
17202 get_context_die (DECL_CONTEXT (fndecl)));
17204 /* The called DWARF procedure consumes one stack slot per argument and
17205 returns one stack slot. */
17206 dwarf_proc_stack_usage_map->put (dwarf_proc_die, 1 - dpi.args_count);
17208 return dwarf_proc_die;
17212 /* Generate Dwarf location list representing LOC.
17213 If WANT_ADDRESS is false, expression computing LOC will be computed
17214 If WANT_ADDRESS is 1, expression computing address of LOC will be returned
17215 if WANT_ADDRESS is 2, expression computing address useable in location
17216 will be returned (i.e. DW_OP_reg can be used
17217 to refer to register values).
17219 CONTEXT provides information to customize the location descriptions
17220 generation. Its context_type field specifies what type is implicitly
17221 referenced by DW_OP_push_object_address. If it is NULL_TREE, this operation
17222 will not be generated.
17224 Its DPI field determines whether we are generating a DWARF expression for a
17225 DWARF procedure, so PARM_DECL references are processed specifically.
17227 If CONTEXT is NULL, the behavior is the same as if context_type, base_decl
17228 and dpi fields were null. */
17230 static dw_loc_list_ref
17231 loc_list_from_tree_1 (tree loc, int want_address,
17232 struct loc_descr_context *context)
17234 dw_loc_descr_ref ret = NULL, ret1 = NULL;
17235 dw_loc_list_ref list_ret = NULL, list_ret1 = NULL;
17236 int have_address = 0;
17237 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
17239 /* ??? Most of the time we do not take proper care for sign/zero
17240 extending the values properly. Hopefully this won't be a real
17241 problem... */
17243 if (context != NULL
17244 && context->base_decl == loc
17245 && want_address == 0)
17247 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
17248 return new_loc_list (new_loc_descr (DW_OP_push_object_address, 0, 0),
17249 NULL, NULL, NULL);
17250 else
17251 return NULL;
17254 switch (TREE_CODE (loc))
17256 case ERROR_MARK:
17257 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "ERROR_MARK");
17258 return 0;
17260 case PLACEHOLDER_EXPR:
17261 /* This case involves extracting fields from an object to determine the
17262 position of other fields. It is supposed to appear only as the first
17263 operand of COMPONENT_REF nodes and to reference precisely the type
17264 that the context allows. */
17265 if (context != NULL
17266 && TREE_TYPE (loc) == context->context_type
17267 && want_address >= 1)
17269 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
17271 ret = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_push_object_address, 0, 0);
17272 have_address = 1;
17273 break;
17275 else
17276 return NULL;
17278 /* For DW_TAG_generic_subrange attributes, PLACEHOLDER_EXPR stands for
17279 the single argument passed by consumer. */
17280 else if (context != NULL
17281 && context->placeholder_arg
17282 && INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (loc))
17283 && want_address == 0)
17285 ret = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_pick, 0, 0);
17286 ret->frame_offset_rel = 1;
17287 context->placeholder_seen = true;
17288 break;
17290 else
17291 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
17292 "PLACEHOLDER_EXPR for an unexpected type");
17293 break;
17295 case CALL_EXPR:
17297 const int nargs = call_expr_nargs (loc);
17298 tree callee = get_callee_fndecl (loc);
17299 int i;
17300 dw_die_ref dwarf_proc;
17302 if (callee == NULL_TREE)
17303 goto call_expansion_failed;
17305 /* We handle only functions that return an integer. */
17306 if (!is_handled_procedure_type (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (callee))))
17307 goto call_expansion_failed;
17309 dwarf_proc = function_to_dwarf_procedure (callee);
17310 if (dwarf_proc == NULL)
17311 goto call_expansion_failed;
17313 /* Evaluate arguments right-to-left so that the first argument will
17314 be the top-most one on the stack. */
17315 for (i = nargs - 1; i >= 0; --i)
17317 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descr
17318 = loc_descriptor_from_tree (CALL_EXPR_ARG (loc, i), 0,
17319 context);
17321 if (loc_descr == NULL)
17322 goto call_expansion_failed;
17324 add_loc_descr (&ret, loc_descr);
17327 ret1 = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_call4, 0, 0);
17328 ret1->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
17329 ret1->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = dwarf_proc;
17330 ret1->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
17331 add_loc_descr (&ret, ret1);
17332 break;
17334 call_expansion_failed:
17335 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "CALL_EXPR");
17336 /* There are no opcodes for these operations. */
17337 return 0;
17340 case PREINCREMENT_EXPR:
17341 case PREDECREMENT_EXPR:
17342 case POSTINCREMENT_EXPR:
17343 case POSTDECREMENT_EXPR:
17344 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "PRE/POST INDCREMENT/DECREMENT");
17345 /* There are no opcodes for these operations. */
17346 return 0;
17348 case ADDR_EXPR:
17349 /* If we already want an address, see if there is INDIRECT_REF inside
17350 e.g. for &this->field. */
17351 if (want_address)
17353 list_ret = loc_list_for_address_of_addr_expr_of_indirect_ref
17354 (loc, want_address == 2, context);
17355 if (list_ret)
17356 have_address = 1;
17357 else if (decl_address_ip_invariant_p (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))
17358 && (ret = cst_pool_loc_descr (loc)))
17359 have_address = 1;
17361 /* Otherwise, process the argument and look for the address. */
17362 if (!list_ret && !ret)
17363 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 1, context);
17364 else
17366 if (want_address)
17367 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "need address of ADDR_EXPR");
17368 return NULL;
17370 break;
17372 case VAR_DECL:
17373 if (DECL_THREAD_LOCAL_P (loc))
17375 rtx rtl;
17376 enum dwarf_location_atom tls_op;
17377 enum dtprel_bool dtprel = dtprel_false;
17379 if (targetm.have_tls)
17381 /* If this is not defined, we have no way to emit the
17382 data. */
17383 if (!targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel)
17384 return 0;
17386 /* The way DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address is specified, we
17387 can only look up addresses of objects in the current
17388 module. We used DW_OP_addr as first op, but that's
17389 wrong, because DW_OP_addr is relocated by the debug
17390 info consumer, while DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address
17391 operand shouldn't be. */
17392 if (DECL_EXTERNAL (loc) && !targetm.binds_local_p (loc))
17393 return 0;
17394 dtprel = dtprel_true;
17395 /* We check for DWARF 5 here because gdb did not implement
17396 DW_OP_form_tls_address until after 7.12. */
17397 tls_op = (dwarf_version >= 5 ? DW_OP_form_tls_address
17398 : DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address);
17400 else
17402 if (!targetm.emutls.debug_form_tls_address
17403 || !(dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict))
17404 return 0;
17405 /* We stuffed the control variable into the DECL_VALUE_EXPR
17406 to signal (via DECL_HAS_VALUE_EXPR_P) that the decl should
17407 no longer appear in gimple code. We used the control
17408 variable in specific so that we could pick it up here. */
17409 loc = DECL_VALUE_EXPR (loc);
17410 tls_op = DW_OP_form_tls_address;
17413 rtl = rtl_for_decl_location (loc);
17414 if (rtl == NULL_RTX)
17415 return 0;
17417 if (!MEM_P (rtl))
17418 return 0;
17419 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
17420 if (! CONSTANT_P (rtl))
17421 return 0;
17423 ret = new_addr_loc_descr (rtl, dtprel);
17424 ret1 = new_loc_descr (tls_op, 0, 0);
17425 add_loc_descr (&ret, ret1);
17427 have_address = 1;
17428 break;
17430 /* FALLTHRU */
17432 case PARM_DECL:
17433 if (context != NULL && context->dpi != NULL
17434 && DECL_CONTEXT (loc) == context->dpi->fndecl)
17436 /* We are generating code for a DWARF procedure and we want to access
17437 one of its arguments: find the appropriate argument offset and let
17438 the resolve_args_picking pass compute the offset that complies
17439 with the stack frame size. */
17440 unsigned i = 0;
17441 tree cursor;
17443 for (cursor = DECL_ARGUMENTS (context->dpi->fndecl);
17444 cursor != NULL_TREE && cursor != loc;
17445 cursor = TREE_CHAIN (cursor), ++i)
17447 /* If we are translating a DWARF procedure, all referenced parameters
17448 must belong to the current function. */
17449 gcc_assert (cursor != NULL_TREE);
17451 ret = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_pick, i, 0);
17452 ret->frame_offset_rel = 1;
17453 break;
17455 /* FALLTHRU */
17457 case RESULT_DECL:
17458 if (DECL_HAS_VALUE_EXPR_P (loc))
17459 return loc_list_from_tree_1 (DECL_VALUE_EXPR (loc),
17460 want_address, context);
17461 /* FALLTHRU */
17463 case FUNCTION_DECL:
17465 rtx rtl;
17466 var_loc_list *loc_list = lookup_decl_loc (loc);
17468 if (loc_list && loc_list->first)
17470 list_ret = dw_loc_list (loc_list, loc, want_address);
17471 have_address = want_address != 0;
17472 break;
17474 rtl = rtl_for_decl_location (loc);
17475 if (rtl == NULL_RTX)
17477 if (TREE_CODE (loc) != FUNCTION_DECL
17478 && early_dwarf
17479 && current_function_decl
17480 && want_address != 1
17481 && ! DECL_IGNORED_P (loc)
17482 && (INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (loc))
17483 || POINTER_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (loc)))
17484 && DECL_CONTEXT (loc) == current_function_decl
17485 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (loc)))
17486 <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE))
17488 dw_die_ref ref = lookup_decl_die (loc);
17489 ret = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_variable_value, 0, 0);
17490 if (ref)
17492 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
17493 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = ref;
17494 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
17496 else
17498 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_decl_ref;
17499 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_decl_ref = loc;
17501 break;
17503 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "DECL has no RTL");
17504 return 0;
17506 else if (CONST_INT_P (rtl))
17508 HOST_WIDE_INT val = INTVAL (rtl);
17509 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc)))
17510 val &= GET_MODE_MASK (DECL_MODE (loc));
17511 ret = int_loc_descriptor (val);
17513 else if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST_STRING)
17515 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "CONST_STRING");
17516 return 0;
17518 else if (CONSTANT_P (rtl) && const_ok_for_output (rtl))
17519 ret = new_addr_loc_descr (rtl, dtprel_false);
17520 else
17522 machine_mode mode, mem_mode;
17524 /* Certain constructs can only be represented at top-level. */
17525 if (want_address == 2)
17527 ret = loc_descriptor (rtl, VOIDmode,
17528 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
17529 have_address = 1;
17531 else
17533 mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
17534 mem_mode = VOIDmode;
17535 if (MEM_P (rtl))
17537 mem_mode = mode;
17538 mode = get_address_mode (rtl);
17539 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
17540 have_address = 1;
17542 ret = mem_loc_descriptor (rtl, mode, mem_mode,
17543 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
17545 if (!ret)
17546 expansion_failed (loc, rtl,
17547 "failed to produce loc descriptor for rtl");
17550 break;
17552 case MEM_REF:
17553 if (!integer_zerop (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1)))
17555 have_address = 1;
17556 goto do_plus;
17558 /* Fallthru. */
17559 case INDIRECT_REF:
17560 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0, context);
17561 have_address = 1;
17562 break;
17564 case TARGET_MEM_REF:
17565 case SSA_NAME:
17566 case DEBUG_EXPR_DECL:
17567 return NULL;
17569 case COMPOUND_EXPR:
17570 return loc_list_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), want_address,
17571 context);
17573 CASE_CONVERT:
17574 case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
17575 case SAVE_EXPR:
17576 case MODIFY_EXPR:
17577 case NON_LVALUE_EXPR:
17578 return loc_list_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), want_address,
17579 context);
17581 case COMPONENT_REF:
17582 case BIT_FIELD_REF:
17583 case ARRAY_REF:
17584 case ARRAY_RANGE_REF:
17585 case REALPART_EXPR:
17586 case IMAGPART_EXPR:
17588 tree obj, offset;
17589 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, bitpos, bytepos;
17590 machine_mode mode;
17591 int unsignedp, reversep, volatilep = 0;
17593 obj = get_inner_reference (loc, &bitsize, &bitpos, &offset, &mode,
17594 &unsignedp, &reversep, &volatilep);
17596 gcc_assert (obj != loc);
17598 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree_1 (obj,
17599 want_address == 2
17600 && !bitpos && !offset ? 2 : 1,
17601 context);
17602 /* TODO: We can extract value of the small expression via shifting even
17603 for nonzero bitpos. */
17604 if (list_ret == 0)
17605 return 0;
17606 if (bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT != 0 || bitsize % BITS_PER_UNIT != 0)
17608 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
17609 "bitfield access");
17610 return 0;
17613 if (offset != NULL_TREE)
17615 /* Variable offset. */
17616 list_ret1 = loc_list_from_tree_1 (offset, 0, context);
17617 if (list_ret1 == 0)
17618 return 0;
17619 add_loc_list (&list_ret, list_ret1);
17620 if (!list_ret)
17621 return 0;
17622 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
17625 bytepos = bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT;
17626 if (bytepos > 0)
17627 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, bytepos, 0));
17628 else if (bytepos < 0)
17629 loc_list_plus_const (list_ret, bytepos);
17631 have_address = 1;
17632 break;
17635 case INTEGER_CST:
17636 if ((want_address || !tree_fits_shwi_p (loc))
17637 && (ret = cst_pool_loc_descr (loc)))
17638 have_address = 1;
17639 else if (want_address == 2
17640 && tree_fits_shwi_p (loc)
17641 && (ret = address_of_int_loc_descriptor
17642 (int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc)),
17643 tree_to_shwi (loc))))
17644 have_address = 1;
17645 else if (tree_fits_shwi_p (loc))
17646 ret = int_loc_descriptor (tree_to_shwi (loc));
17647 else if (tree_fits_uhwi_p (loc))
17648 ret = uint_loc_descriptor (tree_to_uhwi (loc));
17649 else
17651 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
17652 "Integer operand is not host integer");
17653 return 0;
17655 break;
17657 case CONSTRUCTOR:
17658 case REAL_CST:
17659 case STRING_CST:
17660 case COMPLEX_CST:
17661 if ((ret = cst_pool_loc_descr (loc)))
17662 have_address = 1;
17663 else if (TREE_CODE (loc) == CONSTRUCTOR)
17665 tree type = TREE_TYPE (loc);
17666 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT size = int_size_in_bytes (type);
17667 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
17668 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT cnt;
17669 constructor_elt *ce;
17671 if (TREE_CODE (type) == RECORD_TYPE)
17673 /* This is very limited, but it's enough to output
17674 pointers to member functions, as long as the
17675 referenced function is defined in the current
17676 translation unit. */
17677 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (loc), cnt, ce)
17679 tree val = ce->value;
17681 tree field = ce->index;
17683 if (val)
17684 STRIP_NOPS (val);
17686 if (!field || DECL_BIT_FIELD (field))
17688 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
17689 "bitfield in record type constructor");
17690 size = offset = (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT)-1;
17691 ret = NULL;
17692 break;
17695 HOST_WIDE_INT fieldsize = tree_to_shwi (DECL_SIZE_UNIT (field));
17696 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT pos = int_byte_position (field);
17697 gcc_assert (pos + fieldsize <= size);
17698 if (pos < offset)
17700 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
17701 "out-of-order fields in record constructor");
17702 size = offset = (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT)-1;
17703 ret = NULL;
17704 break;
17706 if (pos > offset)
17708 ret1 = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_piece, pos - offset, 0);
17709 add_loc_descr (&ret, ret1);
17710 offset = pos;
17712 if (val && fieldsize != 0)
17714 ret1 = loc_descriptor_from_tree (val, want_address, context);
17715 if (!ret1)
17717 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
17718 "unsupported expression in field");
17719 size = offset = (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT)-1;
17720 ret = NULL;
17721 break;
17723 add_loc_descr (&ret, ret1);
17725 if (fieldsize)
17727 ret1 = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_piece, fieldsize, 0);
17728 add_loc_descr (&ret, ret1);
17729 offset = pos + fieldsize;
17733 if (offset != size)
17735 ret1 = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_piece, size - offset, 0);
17736 add_loc_descr (&ret, ret1);
17737 offset = size;
17740 have_address = !!want_address;
17742 else
17743 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
17744 "constructor of non-record type");
17746 else
17747 /* We can construct small constants here using int_loc_descriptor. */
17748 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
17749 "constructor or constant not in constant pool");
17750 break;
17752 case TRUTH_AND_EXPR:
17753 case TRUTH_ANDIF_EXPR:
17754 case BIT_AND_EXPR:
17755 op = DW_OP_and;
17756 goto do_binop;
17758 case TRUTH_XOR_EXPR:
17759 case BIT_XOR_EXPR:
17760 op = DW_OP_xor;
17761 goto do_binop;
17763 case TRUTH_OR_EXPR:
17764 case TRUTH_ORIF_EXPR:
17765 case BIT_IOR_EXPR:
17766 op = DW_OP_or;
17767 goto do_binop;
17769 case FLOOR_DIV_EXPR:
17770 case CEIL_DIV_EXPR:
17771 case ROUND_DIV_EXPR:
17772 case TRUNC_DIV_EXPR:
17773 case EXACT_DIV_EXPR:
17774 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc)))
17775 return 0;
17776 op = DW_OP_div;
17777 goto do_binop;
17779 case MINUS_EXPR:
17780 op = DW_OP_minus;
17781 goto do_binop;
17783 case FLOOR_MOD_EXPR:
17784 case CEIL_MOD_EXPR:
17785 case ROUND_MOD_EXPR:
17786 case TRUNC_MOD_EXPR:
17787 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc)))
17789 op = DW_OP_mod;
17790 goto do_binop;
17792 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0, context);
17793 list_ret1 = loc_list_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0, context);
17794 if (list_ret == 0 || list_ret1 == 0)
17795 return 0;
17797 add_loc_list (&list_ret, list_ret1);
17798 if (list_ret == 0)
17799 return 0;
17800 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_over, 0, 0));
17801 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_over, 0, 0));
17802 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_div, 0, 0));
17803 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_mul, 0, 0));
17804 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_minus, 0, 0));
17805 break;
17807 case MULT_EXPR:
17808 op = DW_OP_mul;
17809 goto do_binop;
17811 case LSHIFT_EXPR:
17812 op = DW_OP_shl;
17813 goto do_binop;
17815 case RSHIFT_EXPR:
17816 op = (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc)) ? DW_OP_shr : DW_OP_shra);
17817 goto do_binop;
17819 case POINTER_PLUS_EXPR:
17820 case PLUS_EXPR:
17821 do_plus:
17822 if (tree_fits_shwi_p (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1)))
17824 /* Big unsigned numbers can fit in HOST_WIDE_INT but it may be
17825 smarter to encode their opposite. The DW_OP_plus_uconst operation
17826 takes 1 + X bytes, X being the size of the ULEB128 addend. On the
17827 other hand, a "<push literal>; DW_OP_minus" pattern takes 1 + Y
17828 bytes, Y being the size of the operation that pushes the opposite
17829 of the addend. So let's choose the smallest representation. */
17830 const tree tree_addend = TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1);
17831 offset_int wi_addend;
17832 HOST_WIDE_INT shwi_addend;
17833 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_naddend;
17835 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0, context);
17836 if (list_ret == 0)
17837 return 0;
17839 /* Try to get the literal to push. It is the opposite of the addend,
17840 so as we rely on wrapping during DWARF evaluation, first decode
17841 the literal as a "DWARF-sized" signed number. */
17842 wi_addend = wi::to_offset (tree_addend);
17843 wi_addend = wi::sext (wi_addend, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * 8);
17844 shwi_addend = wi_addend.to_shwi ();
17845 loc_naddend = (shwi_addend != INTTYPE_MINIMUM (HOST_WIDE_INT))
17846 ? int_loc_descriptor (-shwi_addend)
17847 : NULL;
17849 if (loc_naddend != NULL
17850 && ((unsigned) size_of_uleb128 (shwi_addend)
17851 > size_of_loc_descr (loc_naddend)))
17853 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, loc_naddend);
17854 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret,
17855 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_minus, 0, 0));
17857 else
17859 for (dw_loc_descr_ref loc_cur = loc_naddend; loc_cur != NULL; )
17861 loc_naddend = loc_cur;
17862 loc_cur = loc_cur->dw_loc_next;
17863 ggc_free (loc_naddend);
17865 loc_list_plus_const (list_ret, wi_addend.to_shwi ());
17867 break;
17870 op = DW_OP_plus;
17871 goto do_binop;
17873 case LE_EXPR:
17874 op = DW_OP_le;
17875 goto do_comp_binop;
17877 case GE_EXPR:
17878 op = DW_OP_ge;
17879 goto do_comp_binop;
17881 case LT_EXPR:
17882 op = DW_OP_lt;
17883 goto do_comp_binop;
17885 case GT_EXPR:
17886 op = DW_OP_gt;
17887 goto do_comp_binop;
17889 do_comp_binop:
17890 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))))
17892 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0, context);
17893 list_ret1 = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0, context);
17894 list_ret = loc_list_from_uint_comparison (list_ret, list_ret1,
17895 TREE_CODE (loc));
17896 break;
17898 else
17899 goto do_binop;
17901 case EQ_EXPR:
17902 op = DW_OP_eq;
17903 goto do_binop;
17905 case NE_EXPR:
17906 op = DW_OP_ne;
17907 goto do_binop;
17909 do_binop:
17910 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0, context);
17911 list_ret1 = loc_list_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0, context);
17912 if (list_ret == 0 || list_ret1 == 0)
17913 return 0;
17915 add_loc_list (&list_ret, list_ret1);
17916 if (list_ret == 0)
17917 return 0;
17918 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
17919 break;
17921 case TRUTH_NOT_EXPR:
17922 case BIT_NOT_EXPR:
17923 op = DW_OP_not;
17924 goto do_unop;
17926 case ABS_EXPR:
17927 op = DW_OP_abs;
17928 goto do_unop;
17930 case NEGATE_EXPR:
17931 op = DW_OP_neg;
17932 goto do_unop;
17934 do_unop:
17935 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0, context);
17936 if (list_ret == 0)
17937 return 0;
17939 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
17940 break;
17942 case MIN_EXPR:
17943 case MAX_EXPR:
17945 const enum tree_code code =
17946 TREE_CODE (loc) == MIN_EXPR ? GT_EXPR : LT_EXPR;
17948 loc = build3 (COND_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (loc),
17949 build2 (code, integer_type_node,
17950 TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1)),
17951 TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0));
17954 /* fall through */
17956 case COND_EXPR:
17958 dw_loc_descr_ref lhs
17959 = loc_descriptor_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0, context);
17960 dw_loc_list_ref rhs
17961 = loc_list_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 2), 0, context);
17962 dw_loc_descr_ref bra_node, jump_node, tmp;
17964 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0, context);
17965 if (list_ret == 0 || lhs == 0 || rhs == 0)
17966 return 0;
17968 bra_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
17969 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, bra_node);
17971 add_loc_list (&list_ret, rhs);
17972 jump_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_skip, 0, 0);
17973 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, jump_node);
17975 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, lhs);
17976 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
17977 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = lhs;
17979 /* ??? Need a node to point the skip at. Use a nop. */
17980 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_nop, 0, 0);
17981 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, tmp);
17982 jump_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
17983 jump_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = tmp;
17985 break;
17987 case FIX_TRUNC_EXPR:
17988 return 0;
17990 default:
17991 /* Leave front-end specific codes as simply unknown. This comes
17992 up, for instance, with the C STMT_EXPR. */
17993 if ((unsigned int) TREE_CODE (loc)
17994 >= (unsigned int) LAST_AND_UNUSED_TREE_CODE)
17996 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
17997 "language specific tree node");
17998 return 0;
18001 /* Otherwise this is a generic code; we should just lists all of
18002 these explicitly. We forgot one. */
18003 if (flag_checking)
18004 gcc_unreachable ();
18006 /* In a release build, we want to degrade gracefully: better to
18007 generate incomplete debugging information than to crash. */
18008 return NULL;
18011 if (!ret && !list_ret)
18012 return 0;
18014 if (want_address == 2 && !have_address
18015 && (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
18017 if (int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc)) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
18019 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
18020 "DWARF address size mismatch");
18021 return 0;
18023 if (ret)
18024 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
18025 else
18026 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret,
18027 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
18028 have_address = 1;
18030 /* Show if we can't fill the request for an address. */
18031 if (want_address && !have_address)
18033 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
18034 "Want address and only have value");
18035 return 0;
18038 gcc_assert (!ret || !list_ret);
18040 /* If we've got an address and don't want one, dereference. */
18041 if (!want_address && have_address)
18043 HOST_WIDE_INT size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc));
18045 if (size > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE || size == -1)
18047 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
18048 "DWARF address size mismatch");
18049 return 0;
18051 else if (size == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
18052 op = DW_OP_deref;
18053 else
18054 op = DW_OP_deref_size;
18056 if (ret)
18057 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (op, size, 0));
18058 else
18059 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (op, size, 0));
18061 if (ret)
18062 list_ret = new_loc_list (ret, NULL, NULL, NULL);
18064 return list_ret;
18067 /* Likewise, but strip useless DW_OP_nop operations in the resulting
18068 expressions. */
18070 static dw_loc_list_ref
18071 loc_list_from_tree (tree loc, int want_address,
18072 struct loc_descr_context *context)
18074 dw_loc_list_ref result = loc_list_from_tree_1 (loc, want_address, context);
18076 for (dw_loc_list_ref loc_cur = result;
18077 loc_cur != NULL; loc_cur = loc_cur->dw_loc_next)
18078 loc_descr_without_nops (loc_cur->expr);
18079 return result;
18082 /* Same as above but return only single location expression. */
18083 static dw_loc_descr_ref
18084 loc_descriptor_from_tree (tree loc, int want_address,
18085 struct loc_descr_context *context)
18087 dw_loc_list_ref ret = loc_list_from_tree (loc, want_address, context);
18088 if (!ret)
18089 return NULL;
18090 if (ret->dw_loc_next)
18092 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
18093 "Location list where only loc descriptor needed");
18094 return NULL;
18096 return ret->expr;
18099 /* Given a value, round it up to the lowest multiple of `boundary'
18100 which is not less than the value itself. */
18102 static inline HOST_WIDE_INT
18103 ceiling (HOST_WIDE_INT value, unsigned int boundary)
18105 return (((value + boundary - 1) / boundary) * boundary);
18108 /* Given a pointer to what is assumed to be a FIELD_DECL node, return a
18109 pointer to the declared type for the relevant field variable, or return
18110 `integer_type_node' if the given node turns out to be an
18111 ERROR_MARK node. */
18113 static inline tree
18114 field_type (const_tree decl)
18116 tree type;
18118 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == ERROR_MARK)
18119 return integer_type_node;
18121 type = DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl);
18122 if (type == NULL_TREE)
18123 type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
18125 return type;
18128 /* Given a pointer to a tree node, return the alignment in bits for
18129 it, or else return BITS_PER_WORD if the node actually turns out to
18130 be an ERROR_MARK node. */
18132 static inline unsigned
18133 simple_type_align_in_bits (const_tree type)
18135 return (TREE_CODE (type) != ERROR_MARK) ? TYPE_ALIGN (type) : BITS_PER_WORD;
18138 static inline unsigned
18139 simple_decl_align_in_bits (const_tree decl)
18141 return (TREE_CODE (decl) != ERROR_MARK) ? DECL_ALIGN (decl) : BITS_PER_WORD;
18144 /* Return the result of rounding T up to ALIGN. */
18146 static inline offset_int
18147 round_up_to_align (const offset_int &t, unsigned int align)
18149 return wi::udiv_trunc (t + align - 1, align) * align;
18152 /* Compute the size of TYPE in bytes. If possible, return NULL and store the
18153 size as an integer constant in CST_SIZE. Otherwise, if possible, return a
18154 DWARF expression that computes the size. Return NULL and set CST_SIZE to -1
18155 if we fail to return the size in one of these two forms. */
18157 static dw_loc_descr_ref
18158 type_byte_size (const_tree type, HOST_WIDE_INT *cst_size)
18160 tree tree_size;
18161 struct loc_descr_context ctx;
18163 /* Return a constant integer in priority, if possible. */
18164 *cst_size = int_size_in_bytes (type);
18165 if (*cst_size != -1)
18166 return NULL;
18168 ctx.context_type = const_cast<tree> (type);
18169 ctx.base_decl = NULL_TREE;
18170 ctx.dpi = NULL;
18171 ctx.placeholder_arg = false;
18172 ctx.placeholder_seen = false;
18174 type = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type);
18175 tree_size = TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (type);
18176 return ((tree_size != NULL_TREE)
18177 ? loc_descriptor_from_tree (tree_size, 0, &ctx)
18178 : NULL);
18181 /* Helper structure for RECORD_TYPE processing. */
18182 struct vlr_context
18184 /* Root RECORD_TYPE. It is needed to generate data member location
18185 descriptions in variable-length records (VLR), but also to cope with
18186 variants, which are composed of nested structures multiplexed with
18187 QUAL_UNION_TYPE nodes. Each time such a structure is passed to a
18188 function processing a FIELD_DECL, it is required to be non null. */
18189 tree struct_type;
18190 /* When generating a variant part in a RECORD_TYPE (i.e. a nested
18191 QUAL_UNION_TYPE), this holds an expression that computes the offset for
18192 this variant part as part of the root record (in storage units). For
18193 regular records, it must be NULL_TREE. */
18194 tree variant_part_offset;
18197 /* Given a pointer to a FIELD_DECL, compute the byte offset of the lowest
18198 addressed byte of the "containing object" for the given FIELD_DECL. If
18199 possible, return a native constant through CST_OFFSET (in which case NULL is
18200 returned); otherwise return a DWARF expression that computes the offset.
18202 Set *CST_OFFSET to 0 and return NULL if we are unable to determine what
18203 that offset is, either because the argument turns out to be a pointer to an
18204 ERROR_MARK node, or because the offset expression is too complex for us.
18206 CTX is required: see the comment for VLR_CONTEXT. */
18208 static dw_loc_descr_ref
18209 field_byte_offset (const_tree decl, struct vlr_context *ctx,
18210 HOST_WIDE_INT *cst_offset)
18212 tree tree_result;
18213 dw_loc_list_ref loc_result;
18215 *cst_offset = 0;
18217 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == ERROR_MARK)
18218 return NULL;
18219 else
18220 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL);
18222 /* We cannot handle variable bit offsets at the moment, so abort if it's the
18223 case. */
18224 if (TREE_CODE (DECL_FIELD_BIT_OFFSET (decl)) != INTEGER_CST)
18225 return NULL;
18227 #ifdef PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS
18228 /* We used to handle only constant offsets in all cases. Now, we handle
18229 properly dynamic byte offsets only when PCC bitfield type doesn't
18230 matter. */
18231 if (PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS
18232 && TREE_CODE (DECL_FIELD_OFFSET (decl)) == INTEGER_CST)
18234 offset_int object_offset_in_bits;
18235 offset_int object_offset_in_bytes;
18236 offset_int bitpos_int;
18237 tree type;
18238 tree field_size_tree;
18239 offset_int deepest_bitpos;
18240 offset_int field_size_in_bits;
18241 unsigned int type_align_in_bits;
18242 unsigned int decl_align_in_bits;
18243 offset_int type_size_in_bits;
18245 bitpos_int = wi::to_offset (bit_position (decl));
18246 type = field_type (decl);
18247 type_size_in_bits = offset_int_type_size_in_bits (type);
18248 type_align_in_bits = simple_type_align_in_bits (type);
18250 field_size_tree = DECL_SIZE (decl);
18252 /* The size could be unspecified if there was an error, or for
18253 a flexible array member. */
18254 if (!field_size_tree)
18255 field_size_tree = bitsize_zero_node;
18257 /* If the size of the field is not constant, use the type size. */
18258 if (TREE_CODE (field_size_tree) == INTEGER_CST)
18259 field_size_in_bits = wi::to_offset (field_size_tree);
18260 else
18261 field_size_in_bits = type_size_in_bits;
18263 decl_align_in_bits = simple_decl_align_in_bits (decl);
18265 /* The GCC front-end doesn't make any attempt to keep track of the
18266 starting bit offset (relative to the start of the containing
18267 structure type) of the hypothetical "containing object" for a
18268 bit-field. Thus, when computing the byte offset value for the
18269 start of the "containing object" of a bit-field, we must deduce
18270 this information on our own. This can be rather tricky to do in
18271 some cases. For example, handling the following structure type
18272 definition when compiling for an i386/i486 target (which only
18273 aligns long long's to 32-bit boundaries) can be very tricky:
18275 struct S { int field1; long long field2:31; };
18277 Fortunately, there is a simple rule-of-thumb which can be used
18278 in such cases. When compiling for an i386/i486, GCC will
18279 allocate 8 bytes for the structure shown above. It decides to
18280 do this based upon one simple rule for bit-field allocation.
18281 GCC allocates each "containing object" for each bit-field at
18282 the first (i.e. lowest addressed) legitimate alignment boundary
18283 (based upon the required minimum alignment for the declared
18284 type of the field) which it can possibly use, subject to the
18285 condition that there is still enough available space remaining
18286 in the containing object (when allocated at the selected point)
18287 to fully accommodate all of the bits of the bit-field itself.
18289 This simple rule makes it obvious why GCC allocates 8 bytes for
18290 each object of the structure type shown above. When looking
18291 for a place to allocate the "containing object" for `field2',
18292 the compiler simply tries to allocate a 64-bit "containing
18293 object" at each successive 32-bit boundary (starting at zero)
18294 until it finds a place to allocate that 64- bit field such that
18295 at least 31 contiguous (and previously unallocated) bits remain
18296 within that selected 64 bit field. (As it turns out, for the
18297 example above, the compiler finds it is OK to allocate the
18298 "containing object" 64-bit field at bit-offset zero within the
18299 structure type.)
18301 Here we attempt to work backwards from the limited set of facts
18302 we're given, and we try to deduce from those facts, where GCC
18303 must have believed that the containing object started (within
18304 the structure type). The value we deduce is then used (by the
18305 callers of this routine) to generate DW_AT_location and
18306 DW_AT_bit_offset attributes for fields (both bit-fields and, in
18307 the case of DW_AT_location, regular fields as well). */
18309 /* Figure out the bit-distance from the start of the structure to
18310 the "deepest" bit of the bit-field. */
18311 deepest_bitpos = bitpos_int + field_size_in_bits;
18313 /* This is the tricky part. Use some fancy footwork to deduce
18314 where the lowest addressed bit of the containing object must
18315 be. */
18316 object_offset_in_bits = deepest_bitpos - type_size_in_bits;
18318 /* Round up to type_align by default. This works best for
18319 bitfields. */
18320 object_offset_in_bits
18321 = round_up_to_align (object_offset_in_bits, type_align_in_bits);
18323 if (wi::gtu_p (object_offset_in_bits, bitpos_int))
18325 object_offset_in_bits = deepest_bitpos - type_size_in_bits;
18327 /* Round up to decl_align instead. */
18328 object_offset_in_bits
18329 = round_up_to_align (object_offset_in_bits, decl_align_in_bits);
18332 object_offset_in_bytes
18333 = wi::lrshift (object_offset_in_bits, LOG2_BITS_PER_UNIT);
18334 if (ctx->variant_part_offset == NULL_TREE)
18336 *cst_offset = object_offset_in_bytes.to_shwi ();
18337 return NULL;
18339 tree_result = wide_int_to_tree (sizetype, object_offset_in_bytes);
18341 else
18342 #endif /* PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS */
18343 tree_result = byte_position (decl);
18345 if (ctx->variant_part_offset != NULL_TREE)
18346 tree_result = fold_build2 (PLUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (tree_result),
18347 ctx->variant_part_offset, tree_result);
18349 /* If the byte offset is a constant, it's simplier to handle a native
18350 constant rather than a DWARF expression. */
18351 if (TREE_CODE (tree_result) == INTEGER_CST)
18353 *cst_offset = wi::to_offset (tree_result).to_shwi ();
18354 return NULL;
18356 struct loc_descr_context loc_ctx = {
18357 ctx->struct_type, /* context_type */
18358 NULL_TREE, /* base_decl */
18359 NULL, /* dpi */
18360 false, /* placeholder_arg */
18361 false /* placeholder_seen */
18363 loc_result = loc_list_from_tree (tree_result, 0, &loc_ctx);
18365 /* We want a DWARF expression: abort if we only have a location list with
18366 multiple elements. */
18367 if (!loc_result || !single_element_loc_list_p (loc_result))
18368 return NULL;
18369 else
18370 return loc_result->expr;
18373 /* The following routines define various Dwarf attributes and any data
18374 associated with them. */
18376 /* Add a location description attribute value to a DIE.
18378 This emits location attributes suitable for whole variables and
18379 whole parameters. Note that the location attributes for struct fields are
18380 generated by the routine `data_member_location_attribute' below. */
18382 static inline void
18383 add_AT_location_description (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
18384 dw_loc_list_ref descr)
18386 if (descr == 0)
18387 return;
18388 if (single_element_loc_list_p (descr))
18389 add_AT_loc (die, attr_kind, descr->expr);
18390 else
18391 add_AT_loc_list (die, attr_kind, descr);
18394 /* Add DW_AT_accessibility attribute to DIE if needed. */
18396 static void
18397 add_accessibility_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
18399 /* In DWARF3+ the default is DW_ACCESS_private only in DW_TAG_class_type
18400 children, otherwise the default is DW_ACCESS_public. In DWARF2
18401 the default has always been DW_ACCESS_public. */
18402 if (TREE_PROTECTED (decl))
18403 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_protected);
18404 else if (TREE_PRIVATE (decl))
18406 if (dwarf_version == 2
18407 || die->die_parent == NULL
18408 || die->die_parent->die_tag != DW_TAG_class_type)
18409 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_private);
18411 else if (dwarf_version > 2
18412 && die->die_parent
18413 && die->die_parent->die_tag == DW_TAG_class_type)
18414 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_public);
18417 /* Attach the specialized form of location attribute used for data members of
18418 struct and union types. In the special case of a FIELD_DECL node which
18419 represents a bit-field, the "offset" part of this special location
18420 descriptor must indicate the distance in bytes from the lowest-addressed
18421 byte of the containing struct or union type to the lowest-addressed byte of
18422 the "containing object" for the bit-field. (See the `field_byte_offset'
18423 function above).
18425 For any given bit-field, the "containing object" is a hypothetical object
18426 (of some integral or enum type) within which the given bit-field lives. The
18427 type of this hypothetical "containing object" is always the same as the
18428 declared type of the individual bit-field itself (for GCC anyway... the
18429 DWARF spec doesn't actually mandate this). Note that it is the size (in
18430 bytes) of the hypothetical "containing object" which will be given in the
18431 DW_AT_byte_size attribute for this bit-field. (See the
18432 `byte_size_attribute' function below.) It is also used when calculating the
18433 value of the DW_AT_bit_offset attribute. (See the `bit_offset_attribute'
18434 function below.)
18436 CTX is required: see the comment for VLR_CONTEXT. */
18438 static void
18439 add_data_member_location_attribute (dw_die_ref die,
18440 tree decl,
18441 struct vlr_context *ctx)
18443 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
18444 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descr = 0;
18446 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == TREE_BINFO)
18448 /* We're working on the TAG_inheritance for a base class. */
18449 if (BINFO_VIRTUAL_P (decl) && is_cxx ())
18451 /* For C++ virtual bases we can't just use BINFO_OFFSET, as they
18452 aren't at a fixed offset from all (sub)objects of the same
18453 type. We need to extract the appropriate offset from our
18454 vtable. The following dwarf expression means
18456 BaseAddr = ObAddr + *((*ObAddr) - Offset)
18458 This is specific to the V3 ABI, of course. */
18460 dw_loc_descr_ref tmp;
18462 /* Make a copy of the object address. */
18463 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_dup, 0, 0);
18464 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
18466 /* Extract the vtable address. */
18467 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0);
18468 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
18470 /* Calculate the address of the offset. */
18471 offset = tree_to_shwi (BINFO_VPTR_FIELD (decl));
18472 gcc_assert (offset < 0);
18474 tmp = int_loc_descriptor (-offset);
18475 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
18476 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_minus, 0, 0);
18477 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
18479 /* Extract the offset. */
18480 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0);
18481 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
18483 /* Add it to the object address. */
18484 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0);
18485 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
18487 else
18488 offset = tree_to_shwi (BINFO_OFFSET (decl));
18490 else
18492 loc_descr = field_byte_offset (decl, ctx, &offset);
18494 /* If loc_descr is available then we know the field offset is dynamic.
18495 However, GDB does not handle dynamic field offsets very well at the
18496 moment. */
18497 if (loc_descr != NULL && gnat_encodings != DWARF_GNAT_ENCODINGS_MINIMAL)
18499 loc_descr = NULL;
18500 offset = 0;
18503 /* Data member location evalutation starts with the base address on the
18504 stack. Compute the field offset and add it to this base address. */
18505 else if (loc_descr != NULL)
18506 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
18509 if (! loc_descr)
18511 /* While DW_AT_data_bit_offset has been added already in DWARF4,
18512 e.g. GDB only added support to it in November 2016. For DWARF5
18513 we need newer debug info consumers anyway. We might change this
18514 to dwarf_version >= 4 once most consumers catched up. */
18515 if (dwarf_version >= 5
18516 && TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL
18517 && DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl))
18519 tree off = bit_position (decl);
18520 if (tree_fits_uhwi_p (off) && get_AT (die, DW_AT_bit_size))
18522 remove_AT (die, DW_AT_byte_size);
18523 remove_AT (die, DW_AT_bit_offset);
18524 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_data_bit_offset, tree_to_uhwi (off));
18525 return;
18528 if (dwarf_version > 2)
18530 /* Don't need to output a location expression, just the constant. */
18531 if (offset < 0)
18532 add_AT_int (die, DW_AT_data_member_location, offset);
18533 else
18534 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_data_member_location, offset);
18535 return;
18537 else
18539 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
18541 /* The DWARF2 standard says that we should assume that the structure
18542 address is already on the stack, so we can specify a structure
18543 field address by using DW_OP_plus_uconst. */
18544 op = DW_OP_plus_uconst;
18545 loc_descr = new_loc_descr (op, offset, 0);
18549 add_AT_loc (die, DW_AT_data_member_location, loc_descr);
18552 /* Writes integer values to dw_vec_const array. */
18554 static void
18555 insert_int (HOST_WIDE_INT val, unsigned int size, unsigned char *dest)
18557 while (size != 0)
18559 *dest++ = val & 0xff;
18560 val >>= 8;
18561 --size;
18565 /* Reads integers from dw_vec_const array. Inverse of insert_int. */
18567 static HOST_WIDE_INT
18568 extract_int (const unsigned char *src, unsigned int size)
18570 HOST_WIDE_INT val = 0;
18572 src += size;
18573 while (size != 0)
18575 val <<= 8;
18576 val |= *--src & 0xff;
18577 --size;
18579 return val;
18582 /* Writes wide_int values to dw_vec_const array. */
18584 static void
18585 insert_wide_int (const wide_int &val, unsigned char *dest, int elt_size)
18587 int i;
18589 if (elt_size <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT/BITS_PER_UNIT)
18591 insert_int ((HOST_WIDE_INT) val.elt (0), elt_size, dest);
18592 return;
18595 /* We'd have to extend this code to support odd sizes. */
18596 gcc_assert (elt_size % (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / BITS_PER_UNIT) == 0);
18598 int n = elt_size / (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / BITS_PER_UNIT);
18600 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
18601 for (i = n - 1; i >= 0; i--)
18603 insert_int ((HOST_WIDE_INT) val.elt (i), sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT), dest);
18604 dest += sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT);
18606 else
18607 for (i = 0; i < n; i++)
18609 insert_int ((HOST_WIDE_INT) val.elt (i), sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT), dest);
18610 dest += sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT);
18614 /* Writes floating point values to dw_vec_const array. */
18616 static void
18617 insert_float (const_rtx rtl, unsigned char *array)
18619 long val[4];
18620 int i;
18621 scalar_float_mode mode = as_a <scalar_float_mode> (GET_MODE (rtl));
18623 real_to_target (val, CONST_DOUBLE_REAL_VALUE (rtl), mode);
18625 /* real_to_target puts 32-bit pieces in each long. Pack them. */
18626 for (i = 0; i < GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) / 4; i++)
18628 insert_int (val[i], 4, array);
18629 array += 4;
18633 /* Attach a DW_AT_const_value attribute for a variable or a parameter which
18634 does not have a "location" either in memory or in a register. These
18635 things can arise in GNU C when a constant is passed as an actual parameter
18636 to an inlined function. They can also arise in C++ where declared
18637 constants do not necessarily get memory "homes". */
18639 static bool
18640 add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref die, rtx rtl)
18642 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
18644 case CONST_INT:
18646 HOST_WIDE_INT val = INTVAL (rtl);
18648 if (val < 0)
18649 add_AT_int (die, DW_AT_const_value, val);
18650 else
18651 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_const_value, (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) val);
18653 return true;
18655 case CONST_WIDE_INT:
18657 wide_int w1 = rtx_mode_t (rtl, MAX_MODE_INT);
18658 unsigned int prec = MIN (wi::min_precision (w1, UNSIGNED),
18659 (unsigned int)CONST_WIDE_INT_NUNITS (rtl) * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT);
18660 wide_int w = wi::zext (w1, prec);
18661 add_AT_wide (die, DW_AT_const_value, w);
18663 return true;
18665 case CONST_DOUBLE:
18666 /* Note that a CONST_DOUBLE rtx could represent either an integer or a
18667 floating-point constant. A CONST_DOUBLE is used whenever the
18668 constant requires more than one word in order to be adequately
18669 represented. */
18670 if (TARGET_SUPPORTS_WIDE_INT == 0
18671 && !SCALAR_FLOAT_MODE_P (GET_MODE (rtl)))
18672 add_AT_double (die, DW_AT_const_value,
18673 CONST_DOUBLE_HIGH (rtl), CONST_DOUBLE_LOW (rtl));
18674 else
18676 scalar_float_mode mode = as_a <scalar_float_mode> (GET_MODE (rtl));
18677 unsigned int length = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
18678 unsigned char *array = ggc_vec_alloc<unsigned char> (length);
18680 insert_float (rtl, array);
18681 add_AT_vec (die, DW_AT_const_value, length / 4, 4, array);
18683 return true;
18685 case CONST_VECTOR:
18687 machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
18688 unsigned int elt_size = GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (mode);
18689 unsigned int length = CONST_VECTOR_NUNITS (rtl);
18690 unsigned char *array
18691 = ggc_vec_alloc<unsigned char> (length * elt_size);
18692 unsigned int i;
18693 unsigned char *p;
18694 machine_mode imode = GET_MODE_INNER (mode);
18696 switch (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode))
18698 case MODE_VECTOR_INT:
18699 for (i = 0, p = array; i < length; i++, p += elt_size)
18701 rtx elt = CONST_VECTOR_ELT (rtl, i);
18702 insert_wide_int (rtx_mode_t (elt, imode), p, elt_size);
18704 break;
18706 case MODE_VECTOR_FLOAT:
18707 for (i = 0, p = array; i < length; i++, p += elt_size)
18709 rtx elt = CONST_VECTOR_ELT (rtl, i);
18710 insert_float (elt, p);
18712 break;
18714 default:
18715 gcc_unreachable ();
18718 add_AT_vec (die, DW_AT_const_value, length, elt_size, array);
18720 return true;
18722 case CONST_STRING:
18723 if (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict)
18725 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result;
18726 resolve_one_addr (&rtl);
18727 rtl_addr:
18728 loc_result = new_addr_loc_descr (rtl, dtprel_false);
18729 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
18730 add_AT_loc (die, DW_AT_location, loc_result);
18731 vec_safe_push (used_rtx_array, rtl);
18732 return true;
18734 return false;
18736 case CONST:
18737 if (CONSTANT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0)))
18738 return add_const_value_attribute (die, XEXP (rtl, 0));
18739 /* FALLTHROUGH */
18740 case SYMBOL_REF:
18741 if (!const_ok_for_output (rtl))
18742 return false;
18743 /* FALLTHROUGH */
18744 case LABEL_REF:
18745 if (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict)
18746 goto rtl_addr;
18747 return false;
18749 case PLUS:
18750 /* In cases where an inlined instance of an inline function is passed
18751 the address of an `auto' variable (which is local to the caller) we
18752 can get a situation where the DECL_RTL of the artificial local
18753 variable (for the inlining) which acts as a stand-in for the
18754 corresponding formal parameter (of the inline function) will look
18755 like (plus:SI (reg:SI FRAME_PTR) (const_int ...)). This is not
18756 exactly a compile-time constant expression, but it isn't the address
18757 of the (artificial) local variable either. Rather, it represents the
18758 *value* which the artificial local variable always has during its
18759 lifetime. We currently have no way to represent such quasi-constant
18760 values in Dwarf, so for now we just punt and generate nothing. */
18761 return false;
18763 case HIGH:
18764 case CONST_FIXED:
18765 return false;
18767 case MEM:
18768 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == CONST_STRING
18769 && MEM_READONLY_P (rtl)
18770 && GET_MODE (rtl) == BLKmode)
18772 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_const_value, XSTR (XEXP (rtl, 0), 0));
18773 return true;
18775 return false;
18777 default:
18778 /* No other kinds of rtx should be possible here. */
18779 gcc_unreachable ();
18781 return false;
18784 /* Determine whether the evaluation of EXPR references any variables
18785 or functions which aren't otherwise used (and therefore may not be
18786 output). */
18787 static tree
18788 reference_to_unused (tree * tp, int * walk_subtrees,
18789 void * data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
18791 if (! EXPR_P (*tp) && ! CONSTANT_CLASS_P (*tp))
18792 *walk_subtrees = 0;
18794 if (DECL_P (*tp) && ! TREE_PUBLIC (*tp) && ! TREE_USED (*tp)
18795 && ! TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (*tp))
18796 return *tp;
18797 /* ??? The C++ FE emits debug information for using decls, so
18798 putting gcc_unreachable here falls over. See PR31899. For now
18799 be conservative. */
18800 else if (!symtab->global_info_ready && VAR_OR_FUNCTION_DECL_P (*tp))
18801 return *tp;
18802 else if (VAR_P (*tp))
18804 varpool_node *node = varpool_node::get (*tp);
18805 if (!node || !node->definition)
18806 return *tp;
18808 else if (TREE_CODE (*tp) == FUNCTION_DECL
18809 && (!DECL_EXTERNAL (*tp) || DECL_DECLARED_INLINE_P (*tp)))
18811 /* The call graph machinery must have finished analyzing,
18812 optimizing and gimplifying the CU by now.
18813 So if *TP has no call graph node associated
18814 to it, it means *TP will not be emitted. */
18815 if (!cgraph_node::get (*tp))
18816 return *tp;
18818 else if (TREE_CODE (*tp) == STRING_CST && !TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (*tp))
18819 return *tp;
18821 return NULL_TREE;
18824 /* Generate an RTL constant from a decl initializer INIT with decl type TYPE,
18825 for use in a later add_const_value_attribute call. */
18827 static rtx
18828 rtl_for_decl_init (tree init, tree type)
18830 rtx rtl = NULL_RTX;
18832 STRIP_NOPS (init);
18834 /* If a variable is initialized with a string constant without embedded
18835 zeros, build CONST_STRING. */
18836 if (TREE_CODE (init) == STRING_CST && TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
18838 tree enttype = TREE_TYPE (type);
18839 tree domain = TYPE_DOMAIN (type);
18840 scalar_int_mode mode;
18842 if (is_int_mode (TYPE_MODE (enttype), &mode)
18843 && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) == 1
18844 && domain
18845 && integer_zerop (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain))
18846 && compare_tree_int (TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain),
18847 TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init) - 1) == 0
18848 && ((size_t) TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init)
18849 == strlen (TREE_STRING_POINTER (init)) + 1))
18851 rtl = gen_rtx_CONST_STRING (VOIDmode,
18852 ggc_strdup (TREE_STRING_POINTER (init)));
18853 rtl = gen_rtx_MEM (BLKmode, rtl);
18854 MEM_READONLY_P (rtl) = 1;
18857 /* Other aggregates, and complex values, could be represented using
18858 CONCAT: FIXME! */
18859 else if (AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (type)
18860 || (TREE_CODE (init) == VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR
18861 && AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (init, 0))))
18862 || TREE_CODE (type) == COMPLEX_TYPE)
18864 /* Vectors only work if their mode is supported by the target.
18865 FIXME: generic vectors ought to work too. */
18866 else if (TREE_CODE (type) == VECTOR_TYPE
18867 && !VECTOR_MODE_P (TYPE_MODE (type)))
18869 /* If the initializer is something that we know will expand into an
18870 immediate RTL constant, expand it now. We must be careful not to
18871 reference variables which won't be output. */
18872 else if (initializer_constant_valid_p (init, type)
18873 && ! walk_tree (&init, reference_to_unused, NULL, NULL))
18875 /* Convert vector CONSTRUCTOR initializers to VECTOR_CST if
18876 possible. */
18877 if (TREE_CODE (type) == VECTOR_TYPE)
18878 switch (TREE_CODE (init))
18880 case VECTOR_CST:
18881 break;
18882 case CONSTRUCTOR:
18883 if (TREE_CONSTANT (init))
18885 vec<constructor_elt, va_gc> *elts = CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (init);
18886 bool constant_p = true;
18887 tree value;
18888 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT ix;
18890 /* Even when ctor is constant, it might contain non-*_CST
18891 elements (e.g. { 1.0/0.0 - 1.0/0.0, 0.0 }) and those don't
18892 belong into VECTOR_CST nodes. */
18893 FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_VALUE (elts, ix, value)
18894 if (!CONSTANT_CLASS_P (value))
18896 constant_p = false;
18897 break;
18900 if (constant_p)
18902 init = build_vector_from_ctor (type, elts);
18903 break;
18906 /* FALLTHRU */
18908 default:
18909 return NULL;
18912 rtl = expand_expr (init, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, EXPAND_INITIALIZER);
18914 /* If expand_expr returns a MEM, it wasn't immediate. */
18915 gcc_assert (!rtl || !MEM_P (rtl));
18918 return rtl;
18921 /* Generate RTL for the variable DECL to represent its location. */
18923 static rtx
18924 rtl_for_decl_location (tree decl)
18926 rtx rtl;
18928 /* Here we have to decide where we are going to say the parameter "lives"
18929 (as far as the debugger is concerned). We only have a couple of
18930 choices. GCC provides us with DECL_RTL and with DECL_INCOMING_RTL.
18932 DECL_RTL normally indicates where the parameter lives during most of the
18933 activation of the function. If optimization is enabled however, this
18934 could be either NULL or else a pseudo-reg. Both of those cases indicate
18935 that the parameter doesn't really live anywhere (as far as the code
18936 generation parts of GCC are concerned) during most of the function's
18937 activation. That will happen (for example) if the parameter is never
18938 referenced within the function.
18940 We could just generate a location descriptor here for all non-NULL
18941 non-pseudo values of DECL_RTL and ignore all of the rest, but we can be
18942 a little nicer than that if we also consider DECL_INCOMING_RTL in cases
18943 where DECL_RTL is NULL or is a pseudo-reg.
18945 Note however that we can only get away with using DECL_INCOMING_RTL as
18946 a backup substitute for DECL_RTL in certain limited cases. In cases
18947 where DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) indicates the same type as TREE_TYPE (decl),
18948 we can be sure that the parameter was passed using the same type as it is
18949 declared to have within the function, and that its DECL_INCOMING_RTL
18950 points us to a place where a value of that type is passed.
18952 In cases where DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) and TREE_TYPE (decl) are different,
18953 we cannot (in general) use DECL_INCOMING_RTL as a substitute for DECL_RTL
18954 because in these cases DECL_INCOMING_RTL points us to a value of some
18955 type which is *different* from the type of the parameter itself. Thus,
18956 if we tried to use DECL_INCOMING_RTL to generate a location attribute in
18957 such cases, the debugger would end up (for example) trying to fetch a
18958 `float' from a place which actually contains the first part of a
18959 `double'. That would lead to really incorrect and confusing
18960 output at debug-time.
18962 So, in general, we *do not* use DECL_INCOMING_RTL as a backup for DECL_RTL
18963 in cases where DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) != TREE_TYPE (decl). There
18964 are a couple of exceptions however. On little-endian machines we can
18965 get away with using DECL_INCOMING_RTL even when DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) is
18966 not the same as TREE_TYPE (decl), but only when DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) is
18967 an integral type that is smaller than TREE_TYPE (decl). These cases arise
18968 when (on a little-endian machine) a non-prototyped function has a
18969 parameter declared to be of type `short' or `char'. In such cases,
18970 TREE_TYPE (decl) will be `short' or `char', DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) will
18971 be `int', and DECL_INCOMING_RTL will point to the lowest-order byte of the
18972 passed `int' value. If the debugger then uses that address to fetch
18973 a `short' or a `char' (on a little-endian machine) the result will be
18974 the correct data, so we allow for such exceptional cases below.
18976 Note that our goal here is to describe the place where the given formal
18977 parameter lives during most of the function's activation (i.e. between the
18978 end of the prologue and the start of the epilogue). We'll do that as best
18979 as we can. Note however that if the given formal parameter is modified
18980 sometime during the execution of the function, then a stack backtrace (at
18981 debug-time) will show the function as having been called with the *new*
18982 value rather than the value which was originally passed in. This happens
18983 rarely enough that it is not a major problem, but it *is* a problem, and
18984 I'd like to fix it.
18986 A future version of dwarf2out.c may generate two additional attributes for
18987 any given DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIE which will describe the "passed
18988 type" and the "passed location" for the given formal parameter in addition
18989 to the attributes we now generate to indicate the "declared type" and the
18990 "active location" for each parameter. This additional set of attributes
18991 could be used by debuggers for stack backtraces. Separately, note that
18992 sometimes DECL_RTL can be NULL and DECL_INCOMING_RTL can be NULL also.
18993 This happens (for example) for inlined-instances of inline function formal
18994 parameters which are never referenced. This really shouldn't be
18995 happening. All PARM_DECL nodes should get valid non-NULL
18996 DECL_INCOMING_RTL values. FIXME. */
18998 /* Use DECL_RTL as the "location" unless we find something better. */
18999 rtl = DECL_RTL_IF_SET (decl);
19001 /* When generating abstract instances, ignore everything except
19002 constants, symbols living in memory, and symbols living in
19003 fixed registers. */
19004 if (! reload_completed)
19006 if (rtl
19007 && (CONSTANT_P (rtl)
19008 || (MEM_P (rtl)
19009 && CONSTANT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0)))
19010 || (REG_P (rtl)
19011 && VAR_P (decl)
19012 && TREE_STATIC (decl))))
19014 rtl = targetm.delegitimize_address (rtl);
19015 return rtl;
19017 rtl = NULL_RTX;
19019 else if (TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL)
19021 if (rtl == NULL_RTX
19022 || is_pseudo_reg (rtl)
19023 || (MEM_P (rtl)
19024 && is_pseudo_reg (XEXP (rtl, 0))
19025 && DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl)
19026 && MEM_P (DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl))
19027 && GET_MODE (rtl) == GET_MODE (DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl))))
19029 tree declared_type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
19030 tree passed_type = DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl);
19031 machine_mode dmode = TYPE_MODE (declared_type);
19032 machine_mode pmode = TYPE_MODE (passed_type);
19034 /* This decl represents a formal parameter which was optimized out.
19035 Note that DECL_INCOMING_RTL may be NULL in here, but we handle
19036 all cases where (rtl == NULL_RTX) just below. */
19037 if (dmode == pmode)
19038 rtl = DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl);
19039 else if ((rtl == NULL_RTX || is_pseudo_reg (rtl))
19040 && SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (dmode)
19041 && GET_MODE_SIZE (dmode) <= GET_MODE_SIZE (pmode)
19042 && DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl))
19044 rtx inc = DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl);
19045 if (REG_P (inc))
19046 rtl = inc;
19047 else if (MEM_P (inc))
19049 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
19050 rtl = adjust_address_nv (inc, dmode,
19051 GET_MODE_SIZE (pmode)
19052 - GET_MODE_SIZE (dmode));
19053 else
19054 rtl = inc;
19059 /* If the parm was passed in registers, but lives on the stack, then
19060 make a big endian correction if the mode of the type of the
19061 parameter is not the same as the mode of the rtl. */
19062 /* ??? This is the same series of checks that are made in dbxout.c before
19063 we reach the big endian correction code there. It isn't clear if all
19064 of these checks are necessary here, but keeping them all is the safe
19065 thing to do. */
19066 else if (MEM_P (rtl)
19067 && XEXP (rtl, 0) != const0_rtx
19068 && ! CONSTANT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
19069 /* Not passed in memory. */
19070 && !MEM_P (DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl))
19071 /* Not passed by invisible reference. */
19072 && (!REG_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
19073 || REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
19074 || REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
19075 #if !HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_ARG_POINTER
19076 || REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
19077 #endif
19079 /* Big endian correction check. */
19080 && BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
19081 && TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) != GET_MODE (rtl)
19082 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)))
19083 < UNITS_PER_WORD))
19085 machine_mode addr_mode = get_address_mode (rtl);
19086 int offset = (UNITS_PER_WORD
19087 - GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl))));
19089 rtl = gen_rtx_MEM (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
19090 plus_constant (addr_mode, XEXP (rtl, 0), offset));
19093 else if (VAR_P (decl)
19094 && rtl
19095 && MEM_P (rtl)
19096 && GET_MODE (rtl) != TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)))
19098 machine_mode addr_mode = get_address_mode (rtl);
19099 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = byte_lowpart_offset (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
19100 GET_MODE (rtl));
19102 /* If a variable is declared "register" yet is smaller than
19103 a register, then if we store the variable to memory, it
19104 looks like we're storing a register-sized value, when in
19105 fact we are not. We need to adjust the offset of the
19106 storage location to reflect the actual value's bytes,
19107 else gdb will not be able to display it. */
19108 if (offset != 0)
19109 rtl = gen_rtx_MEM (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
19110 plus_constant (addr_mode, XEXP (rtl, 0), offset));
19113 /* A variable with no DECL_RTL but a DECL_INITIAL is a compile-time constant,
19114 and will have been substituted directly into all expressions that use it.
19115 C does not have such a concept, but C++ and other languages do. */
19116 if (!rtl && VAR_P (decl) && DECL_INITIAL (decl))
19117 rtl = rtl_for_decl_init (DECL_INITIAL (decl), TREE_TYPE (decl));
19119 if (rtl)
19120 rtl = targetm.delegitimize_address (rtl);
19122 /* If we don't look past the constant pool, we risk emitting a
19123 reference to a constant pool entry that isn't referenced from
19124 code, and thus is not emitted. */
19125 if (rtl)
19126 rtl = avoid_constant_pool_reference (rtl);
19128 /* Try harder to get a rtl. If this symbol ends up not being emitted
19129 in the current CU, resolve_addr will remove the expression referencing
19130 it. */
19131 if (rtl == NULL_RTX
19132 && VAR_P (decl)
19133 && !DECL_EXTERNAL (decl)
19134 && TREE_STATIC (decl)
19135 && DECL_NAME (decl)
19136 && !DECL_HARD_REGISTER (decl)
19137 && DECL_MODE (decl) != VOIDmode)
19139 rtl = make_decl_rtl_for_debug (decl);
19140 if (!MEM_P (rtl)
19141 || GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) != SYMBOL_REF
19142 || SYMBOL_REF_DECL (XEXP (rtl, 0)) != decl)
19143 rtl = NULL_RTX;
19146 return rtl;
19149 /* Check whether decl is a Fortran COMMON symbol. If not, NULL_TREE is
19150 returned. If so, the decl for the COMMON block is returned, and the
19151 value is the offset into the common block for the symbol. */
19153 static tree
19154 fortran_common (tree decl, HOST_WIDE_INT *value)
19156 tree val_expr, cvar;
19157 machine_mode mode;
19158 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, bitpos;
19159 tree offset;
19160 int unsignedp, reversep, volatilep = 0;
19162 /* If the decl isn't a VAR_DECL, or if it isn't static, or if
19163 it does not have a value (the offset into the common area), or if it
19164 is thread local (as opposed to global) then it isn't common, and shouldn't
19165 be handled as such. */
19166 if (!VAR_P (decl)
19167 || !TREE_STATIC (decl)
19168 || !DECL_HAS_VALUE_EXPR_P (decl)
19169 || !is_fortran ())
19170 return NULL_TREE;
19172 val_expr = DECL_VALUE_EXPR (decl);
19173 if (TREE_CODE (val_expr) != COMPONENT_REF)
19174 return NULL_TREE;
19176 cvar = get_inner_reference (val_expr, &bitsize, &bitpos, &offset, &mode,
19177 &unsignedp, &reversep, &volatilep);
19179 if (cvar == NULL_TREE
19180 || !VAR_P (cvar)
19181 || DECL_ARTIFICIAL (cvar)
19182 || !TREE_PUBLIC (cvar))
19183 return NULL_TREE;
19185 *value = 0;
19186 if (offset != NULL)
19188 if (!tree_fits_shwi_p (offset))
19189 return NULL_TREE;
19190 *value = tree_to_shwi (offset);
19192 if (bitpos != 0)
19193 *value += bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT;
19195 return cvar;
19198 /* Generate *either* a DW_AT_location attribute or else a DW_AT_const_value
19199 data attribute for a variable or a parameter. We generate the
19200 DW_AT_const_value attribute only in those cases where the given variable
19201 or parameter does not have a true "location" either in memory or in a
19202 register. This can happen (for example) when a constant is passed as an
19203 actual argument in a call to an inline function. (It's possible that
19204 these things can crop up in other ways also.) Note that one type of
19205 constant value which can be passed into an inlined function is a constant
19206 pointer. This can happen for example if an actual argument in an inlined
19207 function call evaluates to a compile-time constant address.
19209 CACHE_P is true if it is worth caching the location list for DECL,
19210 so that future calls can reuse it rather than regenerate it from scratch.
19211 This is true for BLOCK_NONLOCALIZED_VARS in inlined subroutines,
19212 since we will need to refer to them each time the function is inlined. */
19214 static bool
19215 add_location_or_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl, bool cache_p)
19217 rtx rtl;
19218 dw_loc_list_ref list;
19219 var_loc_list *loc_list;
19220 cached_dw_loc_list *cache;
19222 if (early_dwarf)
19223 return false;
19225 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == ERROR_MARK)
19226 return false;
19228 if (get_AT (die, DW_AT_location)
19229 || get_AT (die, DW_AT_const_value))
19230 return true;
19232 gcc_assert (VAR_P (decl) || TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL
19233 || TREE_CODE (decl) == RESULT_DECL);
19235 /* Try to get some constant RTL for this decl, and use that as the value of
19236 the location. */
19238 rtl = rtl_for_decl_location (decl);
19239 if (rtl && (CONSTANT_P (rtl) || GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST_STRING)
19240 && add_const_value_attribute (die, rtl))
19241 return true;
19243 /* See if we have single element location list that is equivalent to
19244 a constant value. That way we are better to use add_const_value_attribute
19245 rather than expanding constant value equivalent. */
19246 loc_list = lookup_decl_loc (decl);
19247 if (loc_list
19248 && loc_list->first
19249 && loc_list->first->next == NULL
19250 && NOTE_P (loc_list->first->loc)
19251 && NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (loc_list->first->loc)
19252 && NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (loc_list->first->loc))
19254 struct var_loc_node *node;
19256 node = loc_list->first;
19257 rtl = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (node->loc);
19258 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == EXPR_LIST)
19259 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
19260 if ((CONSTANT_P (rtl) || GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST_STRING)
19261 && add_const_value_attribute (die, rtl))
19262 return true;
19264 /* If this decl is from BLOCK_NONLOCALIZED_VARS, we might need its
19265 list several times. See if we've already cached the contents. */
19266 list = NULL;
19267 if (loc_list == NULL || cached_dw_loc_list_table == NULL)
19268 cache_p = false;
19269 if (cache_p)
19271 cache = cached_dw_loc_list_table->find_with_hash (decl, DECL_UID (decl));
19272 if (cache)
19273 list = cache->loc_list;
19275 if (list == NULL)
19277 list = loc_list_from_tree (decl, decl_by_reference_p (decl) ? 0 : 2,
19278 NULL);
19279 /* It is usually worth caching this result if the decl is from
19280 BLOCK_NONLOCALIZED_VARS and if the list has at least two elements. */
19281 if (cache_p && list && list->dw_loc_next)
19283 cached_dw_loc_list **slot
19284 = cached_dw_loc_list_table->find_slot_with_hash (decl,
19285 DECL_UID (decl),
19286 INSERT);
19287 cache = ggc_cleared_alloc<cached_dw_loc_list> ();
19288 cache->decl_id = DECL_UID (decl);
19289 cache->loc_list = list;
19290 *slot = cache;
19293 if (list)
19295 add_AT_location_description (die, DW_AT_location, list);
19296 return true;
19298 /* None of that worked, so it must not really have a location;
19299 try adding a constant value attribute from the DECL_INITIAL. */
19300 return tree_add_const_value_attribute_for_decl (die, decl);
19303 /* Helper function for tree_add_const_value_attribute. Natively encode
19304 initializer INIT into an array. Return true if successful. */
19306 static bool
19307 native_encode_initializer (tree init, unsigned char *array, int size)
19309 tree type;
19311 if (init == NULL_TREE)
19312 return false;
19314 STRIP_NOPS (init);
19315 switch (TREE_CODE (init))
19317 case STRING_CST:
19318 type = TREE_TYPE (init);
19319 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
19321 tree enttype = TREE_TYPE (type);
19322 scalar_int_mode mode;
19324 if (!is_int_mode (TYPE_MODE (enttype), &mode)
19325 || GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) != 1)
19326 return false;
19327 if (int_size_in_bytes (type) != size)
19328 return false;
19329 if (size > TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init))
19331 memcpy (array, TREE_STRING_POINTER (init),
19332 TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init));
19333 memset (array + TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init),
19334 '\0', size - TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init));
19336 else
19337 memcpy (array, TREE_STRING_POINTER (init), size);
19338 return true;
19340 return false;
19341 case CONSTRUCTOR:
19342 type = TREE_TYPE (init);
19343 if (int_size_in_bytes (type) != size)
19344 return false;
19345 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
19347 HOST_WIDE_INT min_index;
19348 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT cnt;
19349 int curpos = 0, fieldsize;
19350 constructor_elt *ce;
19352 if (TYPE_DOMAIN (type) == NULL_TREE
19353 || !tree_fits_shwi_p (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (type))))
19354 return false;
19356 fieldsize = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (type));
19357 if (fieldsize <= 0)
19358 return false;
19360 min_index = tree_to_shwi (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (type)));
19361 memset (array, '\0', size);
19362 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (init), cnt, ce)
19364 tree val = ce->value;
19365 tree index = ce->index;
19366 int pos = curpos;
19367 if (index && TREE_CODE (index) == RANGE_EXPR)
19368 pos = (tree_to_shwi (TREE_OPERAND (index, 0)) - min_index)
19369 * fieldsize;
19370 else if (index)
19371 pos = (tree_to_shwi (index) - min_index) * fieldsize;
19373 if (val)
19375 STRIP_NOPS (val);
19376 if (!native_encode_initializer (val, array + pos, fieldsize))
19377 return false;
19379 curpos = pos + fieldsize;
19380 if (index && TREE_CODE (index) == RANGE_EXPR)
19382 int count = tree_to_shwi (TREE_OPERAND (index, 1))
19383 - tree_to_shwi (TREE_OPERAND (index, 0));
19384 while (count-- > 0)
19386 if (val)
19387 memcpy (array + curpos, array + pos, fieldsize);
19388 curpos += fieldsize;
19391 gcc_assert (curpos <= size);
19393 return true;
19395 else if (TREE_CODE (type) == RECORD_TYPE
19396 || TREE_CODE (type) == UNION_TYPE)
19398 tree field = NULL_TREE;
19399 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT cnt;
19400 constructor_elt *ce;
19402 if (int_size_in_bytes (type) != size)
19403 return false;
19405 if (TREE_CODE (type) == RECORD_TYPE)
19406 field = TYPE_FIELDS (type);
19408 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (init), cnt, ce)
19410 tree val = ce->value;
19411 int pos, fieldsize;
19413 if (ce->index != 0)
19414 field = ce->index;
19416 if (val)
19417 STRIP_NOPS (val);
19419 if (field == NULL_TREE || DECL_BIT_FIELD (field))
19420 return false;
19422 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (field)) == ARRAY_TYPE
19423 && TYPE_DOMAIN (TREE_TYPE (field))
19424 && ! TYPE_MAX_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (TREE_TYPE (field))))
19425 return false;
19426 else if (DECL_SIZE_UNIT (field) == NULL_TREE
19427 || !tree_fits_shwi_p (DECL_SIZE_UNIT (field)))
19428 return false;
19429 fieldsize = tree_to_shwi (DECL_SIZE_UNIT (field));
19430 pos = int_byte_position (field);
19431 gcc_assert (pos + fieldsize <= size);
19432 if (val && fieldsize != 0
19433 && !native_encode_initializer (val, array + pos, fieldsize))
19434 return false;
19436 return true;
19438 return false;
19439 case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
19440 case NON_LVALUE_EXPR:
19441 return native_encode_initializer (TREE_OPERAND (init, 0), array, size);
19442 default:
19443 return native_encode_expr (init, array, size) == size;
19447 /* Attach a DW_AT_const_value attribute to DIE. The value of the
19448 attribute is the const value T. */
19450 static bool
19451 tree_add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree t)
19453 tree init;
19454 tree type = TREE_TYPE (t);
19455 rtx rtl;
19457 if (!t || !TREE_TYPE (t) || TREE_TYPE (t) == error_mark_node)
19458 return false;
19460 init = t;
19461 gcc_assert (!DECL_P (init));
19463 if (TREE_CODE (init) == INTEGER_CST)
19465 if (tree_fits_uhwi_p (init))
19467 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_const_value, tree_to_uhwi (init));
19468 return true;
19470 if (tree_fits_shwi_p (init))
19472 add_AT_int (die, DW_AT_const_value, tree_to_shwi (init));
19473 return true;
19476 if (! early_dwarf)
19478 rtl = rtl_for_decl_init (init, type);
19479 if (rtl)
19480 return add_const_value_attribute (die, rtl);
19482 /* If the host and target are sane, try harder. */
19483 if (CHAR_BIT == 8 && BITS_PER_UNIT == 8
19484 && initializer_constant_valid_p (init, type))
19486 HOST_WIDE_INT size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (init));
19487 if (size > 0 && (int) size == size)
19489 unsigned char *array = ggc_cleared_vec_alloc<unsigned char> (size);
19491 if (native_encode_initializer (init, array, size))
19493 add_AT_vec (die, DW_AT_const_value, size, 1, array);
19494 return true;
19496 ggc_free (array);
19499 return false;
19502 /* Attach a DW_AT_const_value attribute to VAR_DIE. The value of the
19503 attribute is the const value of T, where T is an integral constant
19504 variable with static storage duration
19505 (so it can't be a PARM_DECL or a RESULT_DECL). */
19507 static bool
19508 tree_add_const_value_attribute_for_decl (dw_die_ref var_die, tree decl)
19511 if (!decl
19512 || (!VAR_P (decl) && TREE_CODE (decl) != CONST_DECL)
19513 || (VAR_P (decl) && !TREE_STATIC (decl)))
19514 return false;
19516 if (TREE_READONLY (decl)
19517 && ! TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl)
19518 && DECL_INITIAL (decl))
19519 /* OK */;
19520 else
19521 return false;
19523 /* Don't add DW_AT_const_value if abstract origin already has one. */
19524 if (get_AT (var_die, DW_AT_const_value))
19525 return false;
19527 return tree_add_const_value_attribute (var_die, DECL_INITIAL (decl));
19530 /* Convert the CFI instructions for the current function into a
19531 location list. This is used for DW_AT_frame_base when we targeting
19532 a dwarf2 consumer that does not support the dwarf3
19533 DW_OP_call_frame_cfa. OFFSET is a constant to be added to all CFA
19534 expressions. */
19536 static dw_loc_list_ref
19537 convert_cfa_to_fb_loc_list (HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
19539 int ix;
19540 dw_fde_ref fde;
19541 dw_loc_list_ref list, *list_tail;
19542 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
19543 dw_cfa_location last_cfa, next_cfa;
19544 const char *start_label, *last_label, *section;
19545 dw_cfa_location remember;
19547 fde = cfun->fde;
19548 gcc_assert (fde != NULL);
19550 section = secname_for_decl (current_function_decl);
19551 list_tail = &list;
19552 list = NULL;
19554 memset (&next_cfa, 0, sizeof (next_cfa));
19555 next_cfa.reg = INVALID_REGNUM;
19556 remember = next_cfa;
19558 start_label = fde->dw_fde_begin;
19560 /* ??? Bald assumption that the CIE opcode list does not contain
19561 advance opcodes. */
19562 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*cie_cfi_vec, ix, cfi)
19563 lookup_cfa_1 (cfi, &next_cfa, &remember);
19565 last_cfa = next_cfa;
19566 last_label = start_label;
19568 if (fde->dw_fde_second_begin && fde->dw_fde_switch_cfi_index == 0)
19570 /* If the first partition contained no CFI adjustments, the
19571 CIE opcodes apply to the whole first partition. */
19572 *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&last_cfa, offset),
19573 fde->dw_fde_begin, fde->dw_fde_end, section);
19574 list_tail =&(*list_tail)->dw_loc_next;
19575 start_label = last_label = fde->dw_fde_second_begin;
19578 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (fde->dw_fde_cfi, ix, cfi)
19580 switch (cfi->dw_cfi_opc)
19582 case DW_CFA_set_loc:
19583 case DW_CFA_advance_loc1:
19584 case DW_CFA_advance_loc2:
19585 case DW_CFA_advance_loc4:
19586 if (!cfa_equal_p (&last_cfa, &next_cfa))
19588 *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&last_cfa, offset),
19589 start_label, last_label, section);
19591 list_tail = &(*list_tail)->dw_loc_next;
19592 last_cfa = next_cfa;
19593 start_label = last_label;
19595 last_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
19596 break;
19598 case DW_CFA_advance_loc:
19599 /* The encoding is complex enough that we should never emit this. */
19600 gcc_unreachable ();
19602 default:
19603 lookup_cfa_1 (cfi, &next_cfa, &remember);
19604 break;
19606 if (ix + 1 == fde->dw_fde_switch_cfi_index)
19608 if (!cfa_equal_p (&last_cfa, &next_cfa))
19610 *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&last_cfa, offset),
19611 start_label, last_label, section);
19613 list_tail = &(*list_tail)->dw_loc_next;
19614 last_cfa = next_cfa;
19615 start_label = last_label;
19617 *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&last_cfa, offset),
19618 start_label, fde->dw_fde_end, section);
19619 list_tail = &(*list_tail)->dw_loc_next;
19620 start_label = last_label = fde->dw_fde_second_begin;
19624 if (!cfa_equal_p (&last_cfa, &next_cfa))
19626 *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&last_cfa, offset),
19627 start_label, last_label, section);
19628 list_tail = &(*list_tail)->dw_loc_next;
19629 start_label = last_label;
19632 *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&next_cfa, offset),
19633 start_label,
19634 fde->dw_fde_second_begin
19635 ? fde->dw_fde_second_end : fde->dw_fde_end,
19636 section);
19638 if (list && list->dw_loc_next)
19639 gen_llsym (list);
19641 return list;
19644 /* Compute a displacement from the "steady-state frame pointer" to the
19645 frame base (often the same as the CFA), and store it in
19646 frame_pointer_fb_offset. OFFSET is added to the displacement
19647 before the latter is negated. */
19649 static void
19650 compute_frame_pointer_to_fb_displacement (HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
19652 rtx reg, elim;
19654 #ifdef FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET
19655 reg = frame_pointer_rtx;
19656 offset += FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (current_function_decl);
19657 #else
19658 reg = arg_pointer_rtx;
19659 offset += ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (current_function_decl);
19660 #endif
19662 elim = (ira_use_lra_p
19663 ? lra_eliminate_regs (reg, VOIDmode, NULL_RTX)
19664 : eliminate_regs (reg, VOIDmode, NULL_RTX));
19665 if (GET_CODE (elim) == PLUS)
19667 offset += INTVAL (XEXP (elim, 1));
19668 elim = XEXP (elim, 0);
19671 frame_pointer_fb_offset = -offset;
19673 /* ??? AVR doesn't set up valid eliminations when there is no stack frame
19674 in which to eliminate. This is because it's stack pointer isn't
19675 directly accessible as a register within the ISA. To work around
19676 this, assume that while we cannot provide a proper value for
19677 frame_pointer_fb_offset, we won't need one either. */
19678 frame_pointer_fb_offset_valid
19679 = ((SUPPORTS_STACK_ALIGNMENT
19680 && (elim == hard_frame_pointer_rtx
19681 || elim == stack_pointer_rtx))
19682 || elim == (frame_pointer_needed
19683 ? hard_frame_pointer_rtx
19684 : stack_pointer_rtx));
19687 /* Generate a DW_AT_name attribute given some string value to be included as
19688 the value of the attribute. */
19690 static void
19691 add_name_attribute (dw_die_ref die, const char *name_string)
19693 if (name_string != NULL && *name_string != 0)
19695 if (demangle_name_func)
19696 name_string = (*demangle_name_func) (name_string);
19698 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_name, name_string);
19702 /* Retrieve the descriptive type of TYPE, if any, make sure it has a
19703 DIE and attach a DW_AT_GNAT_descriptive_type attribute to the DIE
19704 of TYPE accordingly.
19706 ??? This is a temporary measure until after we're able to generate
19707 regular DWARF for the complex Ada type system. */
19709 static void
19710 add_gnat_descriptive_type_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree type,
19711 dw_die_ref context_die)
19713 tree dtype;
19714 dw_die_ref dtype_die;
19716 if (!lang_hooks.types.descriptive_type)
19717 return;
19719 dtype = lang_hooks.types.descriptive_type (type);
19720 if (!dtype)
19721 return;
19723 dtype_die = lookup_type_die (dtype);
19724 if (!dtype_die)
19726 gen_type_die (dtype, context_die);
19727 dtype_die = lookup_type_die (dtype);
19728 gcc_assert (dtype_die);
19731 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_GNAT_descriptive_type, dtype_die);
19734 /* Retrieve the comp_dir string suitable for use with DW_AT_comp_dir. */
19736 static const char *
19737 comp_dir_string (void)
19739 const char *wd;
19740 char *wd1;
19741 static const char *cached_wd = NULL;
19743 if (cached_wd != NULL)
19744 return cached_wd;
19746 wd = get_src_pwd ();
19747 if (wd == NULL)
19748 return NULL;
19750 if (DWARF2_DIR_SHOULD_END_WITH_SEPARATOR)
19752 int wdlen;
19754 wdlen = strlen (wd);
19755 wd1 = ggc_vec_alloc<char> (wdlen + 2);
19756 strcpy (wd1, wd);
19757 wd1 [wdlen] = DIR_SEPARATOR;
19758 wd1 [wdlen + 1] = 0;
19759 wd = wd1;
19762 cached_wd = remap_debug_filename (wd);
19763 return cached_wd;
19766 /* Generate a DW_AT_comp_dir attribute for DIE. */
19768 static void
19769 add_comp_dir_attribute (dw_die_ref die)
19771 const char * wd = comp_dir_string ();
19772 if (wd != NULL)
19773 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_comp_dir, wd);
19776 /* Given a tree node VALUE describing a scalar attribute ATTR (i.e. a bound, a
19777 pointer computation, ...), output a representation for that bound according
19778 to the accepted FORMS (see enum dw_scalar_form) and add it to DIE. See
19779 loc_list_from_tree for the meaning of CONTEXT. */
19781 static void
19782 add_scalar_info (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr, tree value,
19783 int forms, struct loc_descr_context *context)
19785 dw_die_ref context_die, decl_die;
19786 dw_loc_list_ref list;
19787 bool strip_conversions = true;
19788 bool placeholder_seen = false;
19790 while (strip_conversions)
19791 switch (TREE_CODE (value))
19793 case ERROR_MARK:
19794 case SAVE_EXPR:
19795 return;
19797 CASE_CONVERT:
19798 case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
19799 value = TREE_OPERAND (value, 0);
19800 break;
19802 default:
19803 strip_conversions = false;
19804 break;
19807 /* If possible and permitted, output the attribute as a constant. */
19808 if ((forms & dw_scalar_form_constant) != 0
19809 && TREE_CODE (value) == INTEGER_CST)
19811 unsigned int prec = simple_type_size_in_bits (TREE_TYPE (value));
19813 /* If HOST_WIDE_INT is big enough then represent the bound as
19814 a constant value. We need to choose a form based on
19815 whether the type is signed or unsigned. We cannot just
19816 call add_AT_unsigned if the value itself is positive
19817 (add_AT_unsigned might add the unsigned value encoded as
19818 DW_FORM_data[1248]). Some DWARF consumers will lookup the
19819 bounds type and then sign extend any unsigned values found
19820 for signed types. This is needed only for
19821 DW_AT_{lower,upper}_bound, since for most other attributes,
19822 consumers will treat DW_FORM_data[1248] as unsigned values,
19823 regardless of the underlying type. */
19824 if (prec <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
19825 || tree_fits_uhwi_p (value))
19827 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (value)))
19828 add_AT_unsigned (die, attr, TREE_INT_CST_LOW (value));
19829 else
19830 add_AT_int (die, attr, TREE_INT_CST_LOW (value));
19832 else
19833 /* Otherwise represent the bound as an unsigned value with
19834 the precision of its type. The precision and signedness
19835 of the type will be necessary to re-interpret it
19836 unambiguously. */
19837 add_AT_wide (die, attr, wi::to_wide (value));
19838 return;
19841 /* Otherwise, if it's possible and permitted too, output a reference to
19842 another DIE. */
19843 if ((forms & dw_scalar_form_reference) != 0)
19845 tree decl = NULL_TREE;
19847 /* Some type attributes reference an outer type. For instance, the upper
19848 bound of an array may reference an embedding record (this happens in
19849 Ada). */
19850 if (TREE_CODE (value) == COMPONENT_REF
19851 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (value, 0)) == PLACEHOLDER_EXPR
19852 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (value, 1)) == FIELD_DECL)
19853 decl = TREE_OPERAND (value, 1);
19855 else if (VAR_P (value)
19856 || TREE_CODE (value) == PARM_DECL
19857 || TREE_CODE (value) == RESULT_DECL)
19858 decl = value;
19860 if (decl != NULL_TREE)
19862 dw_die_ref decl_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
19864 /* ??? Can this happen, or should the variable have been bound
19865 first? Probably it can, since I imagine that we try to create
19866 the types of parameters in the order in which they exist in
19867 the list, and won't have created a forward reference to a
19868 later parameter. */
19869 if (decl_die != NULL)
19871 add_AT_die_ref (die, attr, decl_die);
19872 return;
19877 /* Last chance: try to create a stack operation procedure to evaluate the
19878 value. Do nothing if even that is not possible or permitted. */
19879 if ((forms & dw_scalar_form_exprloc) == 0)
19880 return;
19882 list = loc_list_from_tree (value, 2, context);
19883 if (context && context->placeholder_arg)
19885 placeholder_seen = context->placeholder_seen;
19886 context->placeholder_seen = false;
19888 if (list == NULL || single_element_loc_list_p (list))
19890 /* If this attribute is not a reference nor constant, it is
19891 a DWARF expression rather than location description. For that
19892 loc_list_from_tree (value, 0, &context) is needed. */
19893 dw_loc_list_ref list2 = loc_list_from_tree (value, 0, context);
19894 if (list2 && single_element_loc_list_p (list2))
19896 if (placeholder_seen)
19898 struct dwarf_procedure_info dpi;
19899 dpi.fndecl = NULL_TREE;
19900 dpi.args_count = 1;
19901 if (!resolve_args_picking (list2->expr, 1, &dpi))
19902 return;
19904 add_AT_loc (die, attr, list2->expr);
19905 return;
19909 /* If that failed to give a single element location list, fall back to
19910 outputting this as a reference... still if permitted. */
19911 if (list == NULL
19912 || (forms & dw_scalar_form_reference) == 0
19913 || placeholder_seen)
19914 return;
19916 if (current_function_decl == 0)
19917 context_die = comp_unit_die ();
19918 else
19919 context_die = lookup_decl_die (current_function_decl);
19921 decl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_variable, context_die, value);
19922 add_AT_flag (decl_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
19923 add_type_attribute (decl_die, TREE_TYPE (value), TYPE_QUAL_CONST, false,
19924 context_die);
19925 add_AT_location_description (decl_die, DW_AT_location, list);
19926 add_AT_die_ref (die, attr, decl_die);
19929 /* Return the default for DW_AT_lower_bound, or -1 if there is not any
19930 default. */
19932 static int
19933 lower_bound_default (void)
19935 switch (get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_language))
19937 case DW_LANG_C:
19938 case DW_LANG_C89:
19939 case DW_LANG_C99:
19940 case DW_LANG_C11:
19941 case DW_LANG_C_plus_plus:
19942 case DW_LANG_C_plus_plus_11:
19943 case DW_LANG_C_plus_plus_14:
19944 case DW_LANG_ObjC:
19945 case DW_LANG_ObjC_plus_plus:
19946 return 0;
19947 case DW_LANG_Fortran77:
19948 case DW_LANG_Fortran90:
19949 case DW_LANG_Fortran95:
19950 case DW_LANG_Fortran03:
19951 case DW_LANG_Fortran08:
19952 return 1;
19953 case DW_LANG_UPC:
19954 case DW_LANG_D:
19955 case DW_LANG_Python:
19956 return dwarf_version >= 4 ? 0 : -1;
19957 case DW_LANG_Ada95:
19958 case DW_LANG_Ada83:
19959 case DW_LANG_Cobol74:
19960 case DW_LANG_Cobol85:
19961 case DW_LANG_Modula2:
19962 case DW_LANG_PLI:
19963 return dwarf_version >= 4 ? 1 : -1;
19964 default:
19965 return -1;
19969 /* Given a tree node describing an array bound (either lower or upper) output
19970 a representation for that bound. */
19972 static void
19973 add_bound_info (dw_die_ref subrange_die, enum dwarf_attribute bound_attr,
19974 tree bound, struct loc_descr_context *context)
19976 int dflt;
19978 while (1)
19979 switch (TREE_CODE (bound))
19981 /* Strip all conversions. */
19982 CASE_CONVERT:
19983 case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
19984 bound = TREE_OPERAND (bound, 0);
19985 break;
19987 /* All fixed-bounds are represented by INTEGER_CST nodes. Lower bounds
19988 are even omitted when they are the default. */
19989 case INTEGER_CST:
19990 /* If the value for this bound is the default one, we can even omit the
19991 attribute. */
19992 if (bound_attr == DW_AT_lower_bound
19993 && tree_fits_shwi_p (bound)
19994 && (dflt = lower_bound_default ()) != -1
19995 && tree_to_shwi (bound) == dflt)
19996 return;
19998 /* FALLTHRU */
20000 default:
20001 /* Because of the complex interaction there can be with other GNAT
20002 encodings, GDB isn't ready yet to handle proper DWARF description
20003 for self-referencial subrange bounds: let GNAT encodings do the
20004 magic in such a case. */
20005 if (is_ada ()
20006 && gnat_encodings != DWARF_GNAT_ENCODINGS_MINIMAL
20007 && contains_placeholder_p (bound))
20008 return;
20010 add_scalar_info (subrange_die, bound_attr, bound,
20011 dw_scalar_form_constant
20012 | dw_scalar_form_exprloc
20013 | dw_scalar_form_reference,
20014 context);
20015 return;
20019 /* Add subscript info to TYPE_DIE, describing an array TYPE, collapsing
20020 possibly nested array subscripts in a flat sequence if COLLAPSE_P is true.
20021 Note that the block of subscript information for an array type also
20022 includes information about the element type of the given array type.
20024 This function reuses previously set type and bound information if
20025 available. */
20027 static void
20028 add_subscript_info (dw_die_ref type_die, tree type, bool collapse_p)
20030 unsigned dimension_number;
20031 tree lower, upper;
20032 dw_die_ref child = type_die->die_child;
20034 for (dimension_number = 0;
20035 TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE && (dimension_number == 0 || collapse_p);
20036 type = TREE_TYPE (type), dimension_number++)
20038 tree domain = TYPE_DOMAIN (type);
20040 if (TYPE_STRING_FLAG (type) && is_fortran () && dimension_number > 0)
20041 break;
20043 /* Arrays come in three flavors: Unspecified bounds, fixed bounds,
20044 and (in GNU C only) variable bounds. Handle all three forms
20045 here. */
20047 /* Find and reuse a previously generated DW_TAG_subrange_type if
20048 available.
20050 For multi-dimensional arrays, as we iterate through the
20051 various dimensions in the enclosing for loop above, we also
20052 iterate through the DIE children and pick at each
20053 DW_TAG_subrange_type previously generated (if available).
20054 Each child DW_TAG_subrange_type DIE describes the range of
20055 the current dimension. At this point we should have as many
20056 DW_TAG_subrange_type's as we have dimensions in the
20057 array. */
20058 dw_die_ref subrange_die = NULL;
20059 if (child)
20060 while (1)
20062 child = child->die_sib;
20063 if (child->die_tag == DW_TAG_subrange_type)
20064 subrange_die = child;
20065 if (child == type_die->die_child)
20067 /* If we wrapped around, stop looking next time. */
20068 child = NULL;
20069 break;
20071 if (child->die_tag == DW_TAG_subrange_type)
20072 break;
20074 if (!subrange_die)
20075 subrange_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subrange_type, type_die, NULL);
20077 if (domain)
20079 /* We have an array type with specified bounds. */
20080 lower = TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain);
20081 upper = TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain);
20083 /* Define the index type. */
20084 if (TREE_TYPE (domain)
20085 && !get_AT (subrange_die, DW_AT_type))
20087 /* ??? This is probably an Ada unnamed subrange type. Ignore the
20088 TREE_TYPE field. We can't emit debug info for this
20089 because it is an unnamed integral type. */
20090 if (TREE_CODE (domain) == INTEGER_TYPE
20091 && TYPE_NAME (domain) == NULL_TREE
20092 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (domain)) == INTEGER_TYPE
20093 && TYPE_NAME (TREE_TYPE (domain)) == NULL_TREE)
20095 else
20096 add_type_attribute (subrange_die, TREE_TYPE (domain),
20097 TYPE_UNQUALIFIED, false, type_die);
20100 /* ??? If upper is NULL, the array has unspecified length,
20101 but it does have a lower bound. This happens with Fortran
20102 dimension arr(N:*)
20103 Since the debugger is definitely going to need to know N
20104 to produce useful results, go ahead and output the lower
20105 bound solo, and hope the debugger can cope. */
20107 if (!get_AT (subrange_die, DW_AT_lower_bound))
20108 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_lower_bound, lower, NULL);
20109 if (upper && !get_AT (subrange_die, DW_AT_upper_bound))
20110 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_upper_bound, upper, NULL);
20113 /* Otherwise we have an array type with an unspecified length. The
20114 DWARF-2 spec does not say how to handle this; let's just leave out the
20115 bounds. */
20119 /* Add a DW_AT_byte_size attribute to DIE with TREE_NODE's size. */
20121 static void
20122 add_byte_size_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree tree_node)
20124 dw_die_ref decl_die;
20125 HOST_WIDE_INT size;
20126 dw_loc_descr_ref size_expr = NULL;
20128 switch (TREE_CODE (tree_node))
20130 case ERROR_MARK:
20131 size = 0;
20132 break;
20133 case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
20134 case RECORD_TYPE:
20135 case UNION_TYPE:
20136 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
20137 if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (tree_node)) == VAR_DECL
20138 && (decl_die = lookup_decl_die (TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (tree_node))))
20140 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_byte_size, decl_die);
20141 return;
20143 size_expr = type_byte_size (tree_node, &size);
20144 break;
20145 case FIELD_DECL:
20146 /* For a data member of a struct or union, the DW_AT_byte_size is
20147 generally given as the number of bytes normally allocated for an
20148 object of the *declared* type of the member itself. This is true
20149 even for bit-fields. */
20150 size = int_size_in_bytes (field_type (tree_node));
20151 break;
20152 default:
20153 gcc_unreachable ();
20156 /* Support for dynamically-sized objects was introduced by DWARFv3.
20157 At the moment, GDB does not handle variable byte sizes very well,
20158 though. */
20159 if ((dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
20160 && gnat_encodings == DWARF_GNAT_ENCODINGS_MINIMAL
20161 && size_expr != NULL)
20162 add_AT_loc (die, DW_AT_byte_size, size_expr);
20164 /* Note that `size' might be -1 when we get to this point. If it is, that
20165 indicates that the byte size of the entity in question is variable and
20166 that we could not generate a DWARF expression that computes it. */
20167 if (size >= 0)
20168 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_byte_size, size);
20171 /* Add a DW_AT_alignment attribute to DIE with TREE_NODE's non-default
20172 alignment. */
20174 static void
20175 add_alignment_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree tree_node)
20177 if (dwarf_version < 5 && dwarf_strict)
20178 return;
20180 unsigned align;
20182 if (DECL_P (tree_node))
20184 if (!DECL_USER_ALIGN (tree_node))
20185 return;
20187 align = DECL_ALIGN_UNIT (tree_node);
20189 else if (TYPE_P (tree_node))
20191 if (!TYPE_USER_ALIGN (tree_node))
20192 return;
20194 align = TYPE_ALIGN_UNIT (tree_node);
20196 else
20197 gcc_unreachable ();
20199 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_alignment, align);
20202 /* For a FIELD_DECL node which represents a bit-field, output an attribute
20203 which specifies the distance in bits from the highest order bit of the
20204 "containing object" for the bit-field to the highest order bit of the
20205 bit-field itself.
20207 For any given bit-field, the "containing object" is a hypothetical object
20208 (of some integral or enum type) within which the given bit-field lives. The
20209 type of this hypothetical "containing object" is always the same as the
20210 declared type of the individual bit-field itself. The determination of the
20211 exact location of the "containing object" for a bit-field is rather
20212 complicated. It's handled by the `field_byte_offset' function (above).
20214 CTX is required: see the comment for VLR_CONTEXT.
20216 Note that it is the size (in bytes) of the hypothetical "containing object"
20217 which will be given in the DW_AT_byte_size attribute for this bit-field.
20218 (See `byte_size_attribute' above). */
20220 static inline void
20221 add_bit_offset_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl, struct vlr_context *ctx)
20223 HOST_WIDE_INT object_offset_in_bytes;
20224 tree original_type = DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl);
20225 HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos_int;
20226 HOST_WIDE_INT highest_order_object_bit_offset;
20227 HOST_WIDE_INT highest_order_field_bit_offset;
20228 HOST_WIDE_INT bit_offset;
20230 field_byte_offset (decl, ctx, &object_offset_in_bytes);
20232 /* Must be a field and a bit field. */
20233 gcc_assert (original_type && TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL);
20235 /* We can't yet handle bit-fields whose offsets are variable, so if we
20236 encounter such things, just return without generating any attribute
20237 whatsoever. Likewise for variable or too large size. */
20238 if (! tree_fits_shwi_p (bit_position (decl))
20239 || ! tree_fits_uhwi_p (DECL_SIZE (decl)))
20240 return;
20242 bitpos_int = int_bit_position (decl);
20244 /* Note that the bit offset is always the distance (in bits) from the
20245 highest-order bit of the "containing object" to the highest-order bit of
20246 the bit-field itself. Since the "high-order end" of any object or field
20247 is different on big-endian and little-endian machines, the computation
20248 below must take account of these differences. */
20249 highest_order_object_bit_offset = object_offset_in_bytes * BITS_PER_UNIT;
20250 highest_order_field_bit_offset = bitpos_int;
20252 if (! BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
20254 highest_order_field_bit_offset += tree_to_shwi (DECL_SIZE (decl));
20255 highest_order_object_bit_offset +=
20256 simple_type_size_in_bits (original_type);
20259 bit_offset
20260 = (! BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
20261 ? highest_order_object_bit_offset - highest_order_field_bit_offset
20262 : highest_order_field_bit_offset - highest_order_object_bit_offset);
20264 if (bit_offset < 0)
20265 add_AT_int (die, DW_AT_bit_offset, bit_offset);
20266 else
20267 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_bit_offset, (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) bit_offset);
20270 /* For a FIELD_DECL node which represents a bit field, output an attribute
20271 which specifies the length in bits of the given field. */
20273 static inline void
20274 add_bit_size_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
20276 /* Must be a field and a bit field. */
20277 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL
20278 && DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl));
20280 if (tree_fits_uhwi_p (DECL_SIZE (decl)))
20281 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_bit_size, tree_to_uhwi (DECL_SIZE (decl)));
20284 /* If the compiled language is ANSI C, then add a 'prototyped'
20285 attribute, if arg types are given for the parameters of a function. */
20287 static inline void
20288 add_prototyped_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree func_type)
20290 switch (get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_language))
20292 case DW_LANG_C:
20293 case DW_LANG_C89:
20294 case DW_LANG_C99:
20295 case DW_LANG_C11:
20296 case DW_LANG_ObjC:
20297 if (prototype_p (func_type))
20298 add_AT_flag (die, DW_AT_prototyped, 1);
20299 break;
20300 default:
20301 break;
20305 /* Add an 'abstract_origin' attribute below a given DIE. The DIE is found
20306 by looking in the type declaration, the object declaration equate table or
20307 the block mapping. */
20309 static inline dw_die_ref
20310 add_abstract_origin_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree origin)
20312 dw_die_ref origin_die = NULL;
20314 if (DECL_P (origin))
20316 dw_die_ref c;
20317 origin_die = lookup_decl_die (origin);
20318 /* "Unwrap" the decls DIE which we put in the imported unit context.
20319 We are looking for the abstract copy here. */
20320 if (in_lto_p
20321 && origin_die
20322 && (c = get_AT_ref (origin_die, DW_AT_abstract_origin))
20323 /* ??? Identify this better. */
20324 && c->with_offset)
20325 origin_die = c;
20327 else if (TYPE_P (origin))
20328 origin_die = lookup_type_die (origin);
20329 else if (TREE_CODE (origin) == BLOCK)
20330 origin_die = BLOCK_DIE (origin);
20332 /* XXX: Functions that are never lowered don't always have correct block
20333 trees (in the case of java, they simply have no block tree, in some other
20334 languages). For these functions, there is nothing we can really do to
20335 output correct debug info for inlined functions in all cases. Rather
20336 than die, we'll just produce deficient debug info now, in that we will
20337 have variables without a proper abstract origin. In the future, when all
20338 functions are lowered, we should re-add a gcc_assert (origin_die)
20339 here. */
20341 if (origin_die)
20342 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin, origin_die);
20343 return origin_die;
20346 /* We do not currently support the pure_virtual attribute. */
20348 static inline void
20349 add_pure_or_virtual_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree func_decl)
20351 if (DECL_VINDEX (func_decl))
20353 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_virtuality, DW_VIRTUALITY_virtual);
20355 if (tree_fits_shwi_p (DECL_VINDEX (func_decl)))
20356 add_AT_loc (die, DW_AT_vtable_elem_location,
20357 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_constu,
20358 tree_to_shwi (DECL_VINDEX (func_decl)),
20359 0));
20361 /* GNU extension: Record what type this method came from originally. */
20362 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE
20363 && DECL_CONTEXT (func_decl))
20364 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_containing_type,
20365 lookup_type_die (DECL_CONTEXT (func_decl)));
20369 /* Add a DW_AT_linkage_name or DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name attribute for the
20370 given decl. This used to be a vendor extension until after DWARF 4
20371 standardized it. */
20373 static void
20374 add_linkage_attr (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
20376 const char *name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl));
20378 /* Mimic what assemble_name_raw does with a leading '*'. */
20379 if (name[0] == '*')
20380 name = &name[1];
20382 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
20383 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_linkage_name, name);
20384 else
20385 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name, name);
20388 /* Add source coordinate attributes for the given decl. */
20390 static void
20391 add_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
20393 expanded_location s;
20395 if (LOCATION_LOCUS (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl)) == UNKNOWN_LOCATION)
20396 return;
20397 s = expand_location (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl));
20398 add_AT_file (die, DW_AT_decl_file, lookup_filename (s.file));
20399 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_decl_line, s.line);
20400 if (debug_column_info && s.column)
20401 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_decl_column, s.column);
20404 /* Add DW_AT_{,MIPS_}linkage_name attribute for the given decl. */
20406 static void
20407 add_linkage_name_raw (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
20409 /* Defer until we have an assembler name set. */
20410 if (!DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME_SET_P (decl))
20412 limbo_die_node *asm_name;
20414 asm_name = ggc_cleared_alloc<limbo_die_node> ();
20415 asm_name->die = die;
20416 asm_name->created_for = decl;
20417 asm_name->next = deferred_asm_name;
20418 deferred_asm_name = asm_name;
20420 else if (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl) != DECL_NAME (decl))
20421 add_linkage_attr (die, decl);
20424 /* Add DW_AT_{,MIPS_}linkage_name attribute for the given decl if desired. */
20426 static void
20427 add_linkage_name (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
20429 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_NONE
20430 && VAR_OR_FUNCTION_DECL_P (decl)
20431 && TREE_PUBLIC (decl)
20432 && !(VAR_P (decl) && DECL_REGISTER (decl))
20433 && die->die_tag != DW_TAG_member)
20434 add_linkage_name_raw (die, decl);
20437 /* Add a DW_AT_name attribute and source coordinate attribute for the
20438 given decl, but only if it actually has a name. */
20440 static void
20441 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref die, tree decl,
20442 bool no_linkage_name)
20444 tree decl_name;
20446 decl_name = DECL_NAME (decl);
20447 if (decl_name != NULL && IDENTIFIER_POINTER (decl_name) != NULL)
20449 const char *name = dwarf2_name (decl, 0);
20450 if (name)
20451 add_name_attribute (die, name);
20452 if (! DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
20453 add_src_coords_attributes (die, decl);
20455 if (!no_linkage_name)
20456 add_linkage_name (die, decl);
20459 #ifdef VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
20460 /* Get the function's name, as described by its RTL. This may be different
20461 from the DECL_NAME name used in the source file. */
20462 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL && TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl))
20464 add_AT_addr (die, DW_AT_VMS_rtnbeg_pd_address,
20465 XEXP (DECL_RTL (decl), 0), false);
20466 vec_safe_push (used_rtx_array, XEXP (DECL_RTL (decl), 0));
20468 #endif /* VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO */
20471 /* Add VALUE as a DW_AT_discr_value attribute to DIE. */
20473 static void
20474 add_discr_value (dw_die_ref die, dw_discr_value *value)
20476 dw_attr_node attr;
20478 attr.dw_attr = DW_AT_discr_value;
20479 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_discr_value;
20480 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
20481 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_discr_value.pos = value->pos;
20482 if (value->pos)
20483 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_discr_value.v.uval = value->v.uval;
20484 else
20485 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_discr_value.v.sval = value->v.sval;
20486 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
20489 /* Add DISCR_LIST as a DW_AT_discr_list to DIE. */
20491 static void
20492 add_discr_list (dw_die_ref die, dw_discr_list_ref discr_list)
20494 dw_attr_node attr;
20496 attr.dw_attr = DW_AT_discr_list;
20497 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_discr_list;
20498 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
20499 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_discr_list = discr_list;
20500 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
20503 static inline dw_discr_list_ref
20504 AT_discr_list (dw_attr_node *attr)
20506 return attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_discr_list;
20509 #ifdef VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
20510 /* Output the debug main pointer die for VMS */
20512 void
20513 dwarf2out_vms_debug_main_pointer (void)
20515 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
20516 dw_die_ref die;
20518 /* Allocate the VMS debug main subprogram die. */
20519 die = new_die_raw (DW_TAG_subprogram);
20520 add_name_attribute (die, VMS_DEBUG_MAIN_POINTER);
20521 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, PROLOGUE_END_LABEL,
20522 current_function_funcdef_no);
20523 add_AT_lbl_id (die, DW_AT_entry_pc, label);
20525 /* Make it the first child of comp_unit_die (). */
20526 die->die_parent = comp_unit_die ();
20527 if (comp_unit_die ()->die_child)
20529 die->die_sib = comp_unit_die ()->die_child->die_sib;
20530 comp_unit_die ()->die_child->die_sib = die;
20532 else
20534 die->die_sib = die;
20535 comp_unit_die ()->die_child = die;
20538 #endif /* VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO */
20540 /* Push a new declaration scope. */
20542 static void
20543 push_decl_scope (tree scope)
20545 vec_safe_push (decl_scope_table, scope);
20548 /* Pop a declaration scope. */
20550 static inline void
20551 pop_decl_scope (void)
20553 decl_scope_table->pop ();
20556 /* walk_tree helper function for uses_local_type, below. */
20558 static tree
20559 uses_local_type_r (tree *tp, int *walk_subtrees, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
20561 if (!TYPE_P (*tp))
20562 *walk_subtrees = 0;
20563 else
20565 tree name = TYPE_NAME (*tp);
20566 if (name && DECL_P (name) && decl_function_context (name))
20567 return *tp;
20569 return NULL_TREE;
20572 /* If TYPE involves a function-local type (including a local typedef to a
20573 non-local type), returns that type; otherwise returns NULL_TREE. */
20575 static tree
20576 uses_local_type (tree type)
20578 tree used = walk_tree_without_duplicates (&type, uses_local_type_r, NULL);
20579 return used;
20582 /* Return the DIE for the scope that immediately contains this type.
20583 Non-named types that do not involve a function-local type get global
20584 scope. Named types nested in namespaces or other types get their
20585 containing scope. All other types (i.e. function-local named types) get
20586 the current active scope. */
20588 static dw_die_ref
20589 scope_die_for (tree t, dw_die_ref context_die)
20591 dw_die_ref scope_die = NULL;
20592 tree containing_scope;
20594 /* Non-types always go in the current scope. */
20595 gcc_assert (TYPE_P (t));
20597 /* Use the scope of the typedef, rather than the scope of the type
20598 it refers to. */
20599 if (TYPE_NAME (t) && DECL_P (TYPE_NAME (t)))
20600 containing_scope = DECL_CONTEXT (TYPE_NAME (t));
20601 else
20602 containing_scope = TYPE_CONTEXT (t);
20604 /* Use the containing namespace if there is one. */
20605 if (containing_scope && TREE_CODE (containing_scope) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
20607 if (context_die == lookup_decl_die (containing_scope))
20608 /* OK */;
20609 else if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
20610 context_die = get_context_die (containing_scope);
20611 else
20612 containing_scope = NULL_TREE;
20615 /* Ignore function type "scopes" from the C frontend. They mean that
20616 a tagged type is local to a parmlist of a function declarator, but
20617 that isn't useful to DWARF. */
20618 if (containing_scope && TREE_CODE (containing_scope) == FUNCTION_TYPE)
20619 containing_scope = NULL_TREE;
20621 if (SCOPE_FILE_SCOPE_P (containing_scope))
20623 /* If T uses a local type keep it local as well, to avoid references
20624 to function-local DIEs from outside the function. */
20625 if (current_function_decl && uses_local_type (t))
20626 scope_die = context_die;
20627 else
20628 scope_die = comp_unit_die ();
20630 else if (TYPE_P (containing_scope))
20632 /* For types, we can just look up the appropriate DIE. */
20633 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
20634 scope_die = get_context_die (containing_scope);
20635 else
20637 scope_die = lookup_type_die_strip_naming_typedef (containing_scope);
20638 if (scope_die == NULL)
20639 scope_die = comp_unit_die ();
20642 else
20643 scope_die = context_die;
20645 return scope_die;
20648 /* Returns nonzero if CONTEXT_DIE is internal to a function. */
20650 static inline int
20651 local_scope_p (dw_die_ref context_die)
20653 for (; context_die; context_die = context_die->die_parent)
20654 if (context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine
20655 || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram)
20656 return 1;
20658 return 0;
20661 /* Returns nonzero if CONTEXT_DIE is a class. */
20663 static inline int
20664 class_scope_p (dw_die_ref context_die)
20666 return (context_die
20667 && (context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_structure_type
20668 || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_class_type
20669 || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_interface_type
20670 || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_union_type));
20673 /* Returns nonzero if CONTEXT_DIE is a class or namespace, for deciding
20674 whether or not to treat a DIE in this context as a declaration. */
20676 static inline int
20677 class_or_namespace_scope_p (dw_die_ref context_die)
20679 return (class_scope_p (context_die)
20680 || (context_die && context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_namespace));
20683 /* Many forms of DIEs require a "type description" attribute. This
20684 routine locates the proper "type descriptor" die for the type given
20685 by 'type' plus any additional qualifiers given by 'cv_quals', and
20686 adds a DW_AT_type attribute below the given die. */
20688 static void
20689 add_type_attribute (dw_die_ref object_die, tree type, int cv_quals,
20690 bool reverse, dw_die_ref context_die)
20692 enum tree_code code = TREE_CODE (type);
20693 dw_die_ref type_die = NULL;
20695 /* ??? If this type is an unnamed subrange type of an integral, floating-point
20696 or fixed-point type, use the inner type. This is because we have no
20697 support for unnamed types in base_type_die. This can happen if this is
20698 an Ada subrange type. Correct solution is emit a subrange type die. */
20699 if ((code == INTEGER_TYPE || code == REAL_TYPE || code == FIXED_POINT_TYPE)
20700 && TREE_TYPE (type) != 0 && TYPE_NAME (type) == 0)
20701 type = TREE_TYPE (type), code = TREE_CODE (type);
20703 if (code == ERROR_MARK
20704 /* Handle a special case. For functions whose return type is void, we
20705 generate *no* type attribute. (Note that no object may have type
20706 `void', so this only applies to function return types). */
20707 || code == VOID_TYPE)
20708 return;
20710 type_die = modified_type_die (type,
20711 cv_quals | TYPE_QUALS_NO_ADDR_SPACE (type),
20712 reverse,
20713 context_die);
20715 if (type_die != NULL)
20716 add_AT_die_ref (object_die, DW_AT_type, type_die);
20719 /* Given an object die, add the calling convention attribute for the
20720 function call type. */
20721 static void
20722 add_calling_convention_attribute (dw_die_ref subr_die, tree decl)
20724 enum dwarf_calling_convention value = DW_CC_normal;
20726 value = ((enum dwarf_calling_convention)
20727 targetm.dwarf_calling_convention (TREE_TYPE (decl)));
20729 if (is_fortran ()
20730 && id_equal (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl), "MAIN__"))
20732 /* DWARF 2 doesn't provide a way to identify a program's source-level
20733 entry point. DW_AT_calling_convention attributes are only meant
20734 to describe functions' calling conventions. However, lacking a
20735 better way to signal the Fortran main program, we used this for
20736 a long time, following existing custom. Now, DWARF 4 has
20737 DW_AT_main_subprogram, which we add below, but some tools still
20738 rely on the old way, which we thus keep. */
20739 value = DW_CC_program;
20741 if (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict)
20742 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_main_subprogram, 1);
20745 /* Only add the attribute if the backend requests it, and
20746 is not DW_CC_normal. */
20747 if (value && (value != DW_CC_normal))
20748 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_calling_convention, value);
20751 /* Given a tree pointer to a struct, class, union, or enum type node, return
20752 a pointer to the (string) tag name for the given type, or zero if the type
20753 was declared without a tag. */
20755 static const char *
20756 type_tag (const_tree type)
20758 const char *name = 0;
20760 if (TYPE_NAME (type) != 0)
20762 tree t = 0;
20764 /* Find the IDENTIFIER_NODE for the type name. */
20765 if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (type)) == IDENTIFIER_NODE
20766 && !TYPE_NAMELESS (type))
20767 t = TYPE_NAME (type);
20769 /* The g++ front end makes the TYPE_NAME of *each* tagged type point to
20770 a TYPE_DECL node, regardless of whether or not a `typedef' was
20771 involved. */
20772 else if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (type)) == TYPE_DECL
20773 && ! DECL_IGNORED_P (TYPE_NAME (type)))
20775 /* We want to be extra verbose. Don't call dwarf_name if
20776 DECL_NAME isn't set. The default hook for decl_printable_name
20777 doesn't like that, and in this context it's correct to return
20778 0, instead of "<anonymous>" or the like. */
20779 if (DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (type))
20780 && !DECL_NAMELESS (TYPE_NAME (type)))
20781 name = lang_hooks.dwarf_name (TYPE_NAME (type), 2);
20784 /* Now get the name as a string, or invent one. */
20785 if (!name && t != 0)
20786 name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (t);
20789 return (name == 0 || *name == '\0') ? 0 : name;
20792 /* Return the type associated with a data member, make a special check
20793 for bit field types. */
20795 static inline tree
20796 member_declared_type (const_tree member)
20798 return (DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (member)
20799 ? DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (member) : TREE_TYPE (member));
20802 /* Get the decl's label, as described by its RTL. This may be different
20803 from the DECL_NAME name used in the source file. */
20805 #if 0
20806 static const char *
20807 decl_start_label (tree decl)
20809 rtx x;
20810 const char *fnname;
20812 x = DECL_RTL (decl);
20813 gcc_assert (MEM_P (x));
20815 x = XEXP (x, 0);
20816 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (x) == SYMBOL_REF);
20818 fnname = XSTR (x, 0);
20819 return fnname;
20821 #endif
20823 /* For variable-length arrays that have been previously generated, but
20824 may be incomplete due to missing subscript info, fill the subscript
20825 info. Return TRUE if this is one of those cases. */
20826 static bool
20827 fill_variable_array_bounds (tree type)
20829 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type)
20830 && TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE
20831 && variably_modified_type_p (type, NULL))
20833 dw_die_ref array_die = lookup_type_die (type);
20834 if (!array_die)
20835 return false;
20836 add_subscript_info (array_die, type, !is_ada ());
20837 return true;
20839 return false;
20842 /* These routines generate the internal representation of the DIE's for
20843 the compilation unit. Debugging information is collected by walking
20844 the declaration trees passed in from dwarf2out_decl(). */
20846 static void
20847 gen_array_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
20849 dw_die_ref array_die;
20851 /* GNU compilers represent multidimensional array types as sequences of one
20852 dimensional array types whose element types are themselves array types.
20853 We sometimes squish that down to a single array_type DIE with multiple
20854 subscripts in the Dwarf debugging info. The draft Dwarf specification
20855 say that we are allowed to do this kind of compression in C, because
20856 there is no difference between an array of arrays and a multidimensional
20857 array. We don't do this for Ada to remain as close as possible to the
20858 actual representation, which is especially important against the language
20859 flexibilty wrt arrays of variable size. */
20861 bool collapse_nested_arrays = !is_ada ();
20863 if (fill_variable_array_bounds (type))
20864 return;
20866 dw_die_ref scope_die = scope_die_for (type, context_die);
20867 tree element_type;
20869 /* Emit DW_TAG_string_type for Fortran character types (with kind 1 only, as
20870 DW_TAG_string_type doesn't have DW_AT_type attribute). */
20871 if (TYPE_STRING_FLAG (type)
20872 && TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE
20873 && is_fortran ()
20874 && TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (type)) == TYPE_MODE (char_type_node))
20876 HOST_WIDE_INT size;
20878 array_die = new_die (DW_TAG_string_type, scope_die, type);
20879 add_name_attribute (array_die, type_tag (type));
20880 equate_type_number_to_die (type, array_die);
20881 size = int_size_in_bytes (type);
20882 if (size >= 0)
20883 add_AT_unsigned (array_die, DW_AT_byte_size, size);
20884 /* ??? We can't annotate types late, but for LTO we may not
20885 generate a location early either (gfortran.dg/save_6.f90). */
20886 else if (! (early_dwarf && (flag_generate_lto || flag_generate_offload))
20887 && TYPE_DOMAIN (type) != NULL_TREE
20888 && TYPE_MAX_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (type)) != NULL_TREE)
20890 tree szdecl = TYPE_MAX_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (type));
20891 tree rszdecl = szdecl;
20893 size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (szdecl));
20894 if (!DECL_P (szdecl))
20896 if (TREE_CODE (szdecl) == INDIRECT_REF
20897 && DECL_P (TREE_OPERAND (szdecl, 0)))
20899 rszdecl = TREE_OPERAND (szdecl, 0);
20900 if (int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (rszdecl))
20901 != DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
20902 size = 0;
20904 else
20905 size = 0;
20907 if (size > 0)
20909 dw_loc_list_ref loc
20910 = loc_list_from_tree (rszdecl, szdecl == rszdecl ? 2 : 0,
20911 NULL);
20912 if (loc)
20914 add_AT_location_description (array_die, DW_AT_string_length,
20915 loc);
20916 if (size != DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
20917 add_AT_unsigned (array_die, dwarf_version >= 5
20918 ? DW_AT_string_length_byte_size
20919 : DW_AT_byte_size, size);
20923 return;
20926 array_die = new_die (DW_TAG_array_type, scope_die, type);
20927 add_name_attribute (array_die, type_tag (type));
20928 equate_type_number_to_die (type, array_die);
20930 if (TREE_CODE (type) == VECTOR_TYPE)
20931 add_AT_flag (array_die, DW_AT_GNU_vector, 1);
20933 /* For Fortran multidimensional arrays use DW_ORD_col_major ordering. */
20934 if (is_fortran ()
20935 && TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE
20936 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (type)) == ARRAY_TYPE
20937 && !TYPE_STRING_FLAG (TREE_TYPE (type)))
20938 add_AT_unsigned (array_die, DW_AT_ordering, DW_ORD_col_major);
20940 #if 0
20941 /* We default the array ordering. SDB will probably do
20942 the right things even if DW_AT_ordering is not present. It's not even
20943 an issue until we start to get into multidimensional arrays anyway. If
20944 SDB is ever caught doing the Wrong Thing for multi-dimensional arrays,
20945 then we'll have to put the DW_AT_ordering attribute back in. (But if
20946 and when we find out that we need to put these in, we will only do so
20947 for multidimensional arrays. */
20948 add_AT_unsigned (array_die, DW_AT_ordering, DW_ORD_row_major);
20949 #endif
20951 if (TREE_CODE (type) == VECTOR_TYPE)
20953 /* For VECTOR_TYPEs we use an array die with appropriate bounds. */
20954 dw_die_ref subrange_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subrange_type, array_die, NULL);
20955 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_lower_bound, size_zero_node, NULL);
20956 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_upper_bound,
20957 size_int (TYPE_VECTOR_SUBPARTS (type) - 1), NULL);
20959 else
20960 add_subscript_info (array_die, type, collapse_nested_arrays);
20962 /* Add representation of the type of the elements of this array type and
20963 emit the corresponding DIE if we haven't done it already. */
20964 element_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
20965 if (collapse_nested_arrays)
20966 while (TREE_CODE (element_type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
20968 if (TYPE_STRING_FLAG (element_type) && is_fortran ())
20969 break;
20970 element_type = TREE_TYPE (element_type);
20973 add_type_attribute (array_die, element_type, TYPE_UNQUALIFIED,
20974 TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE
20975 && TYPE_REVERSE_STORAGE_ORDER (type),
20976 context_die);
20978 add_gnat_descriptive_type_attribute (array_die, type, context_die);
20979 if (TYPE_ARTIFICIAL (type))
20980 add_AT_flag (array_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
20982 if (get_AT (array_die, DW_AT_name))
20983 add_pubtype (type, array_die);
20985 add_alignment_attribute (array_die, type);
20988 /* This routine generates DIE for array with hidden descriptor, details
20989 are filled into *info by a langhook. */
20991 static void
20992 gen_descr_array_type_die (tree type, struct array_descr_info *info,
20993 dw_die_ref context_die)
20995 const dw_die_ref scope_die = scope_die_for (type, context_die);
20996 const dw_die_ref array_die = new_die (DW_TAG_array_type, scope_die, type);
20997 struct loc_descr_context context = { type, info->base_decl, NULL,
20998 false, false };
20999 enum dwarf_tag subrange_tag = DW_TAG_subrange_type;
21000 int dim;
21002 add_name_attribute (array_die, type_tag (type));
21003 equate_type_number_to_die (type, array_die);
21005 if (info->ndimensions > 1)
21006 switch (info->ordering)
21008 case array_descr_ordering_row_major:
21009 add_AT_unsigned (array_die, DW_AT_ordering, DW_ORD_row_major);
21010 break;
21011 case array_descr_ordering_column_major:
21012 add_AT_unsigned (array_die, DW_AT_ordering, DW_ORD_col_major);
21013 break;
21014 default:
21015 break;
21018 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
21020 if (info->data_location)
21021 add_scalar_info (array_die, DW_AT_data_location, info->data_location,
21022 dw_scalar_form_exprloc, &context);
21023 if (info->associated)
21024 add_scalar_info (array_die, DW_AT_associated, info->associated,
21025 dw_scalar_form_constant
21026 | dw_scalar_form_exprloc
21027 | dw_scalar_form_reference, &context);
21028 if (info->allocated)
21029 add_scalar_info (array_die, DW_AT_allocated, info->allocated,
21030 dw_scalar_form_constant
21031 | dw_scalar_form_exprloc
21032 | dw_scalar_form_reference, &context);
21033 if (info->stride)
21035 const enum dwarf_attribute attr
21036 = (info->stride_in_bits) ? DW_AT_bit_stride : DW_AT_byte_stride;
21037 const int forms
21038 = (info->stride_in_bits)
21039 ? dw_scalar_form_constant
21040 : (dw_scalar_form_constant
21041 | dw_scalar_form_exprloc
21042 | dw_scalar_form_reference);
21044 add_scalar_info (array_die, attr, info->stride, forms, &context);
21047 if (dwarf_version >= 5)
21049 if (info->rank)
21051 add_scalar_info (array_die, DW_AT_rank, info->rank,
21052 dw_scalar_form_constant
21053 | dw_scalar_form_exprloc, &context);
21054 subrange_tag = DW_TAG_generic_subrange;
21055 context.placeholder_arg = true;
21059 add_gnat_descriptive_type_attribute (array_die, type, context_die);
21061 for (dim = 0; dim < info->ndimensions; dim++)
21063 dw_die_ref subrange_die = new_die (subrange_tag, array_die, NULL);
21065 if (info->dimen[dim].bounds_type)
21066 add_type_attribute (subrange_die,
21067 info->dimen[dim].bounds_type, TYPE_UNQUALIFIED,
21068 false, context_die);
21069 if (info->dimen[dim].lower_bound)
21070 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_lower_bound,
21071 info->dimen[dim].lower_bound, &context);
21072 if (info->dimen[dim].upper_bound)
21073 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_upper_bound,
21074 info->dimen[dim].upper_bound, &context);
21075 if ((dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict) && info->dimen[dim].stride)
21076 add_scalar_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_byte_stride,
21077 info->dimen[dim].stride,
21078 dw_scalar_form_constant
21079 | dw_scalar_form_exprloc
21080 | dw_scalar_form_reference,
21081 &context);
21084 gen_type_die (info->element_type, context_die);
21085 add_type_attribute (array_die, info->element_type, TYPE_UNQUALIFIED,
21086 TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE
21087 && TYPE_REVERSE_STORAGE_ORDER (type),
21088 context_die);
21090 if (get_AT (array_die, DW_AT_name))
21091 add_pubtype (type, array_die);
21093 add_alignment_attribute (array_die, type);
21096 #if 0
21097 static void
21098 gen_entry_point_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
21100 tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
21101 dw_die_ref decl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_entry_point, context_die, decl);
21103 if (origin != NULL)
21104 add_abstract_origin_attribute (decl_die, origin);
21105 else
21107 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (decl_die, decl);
21108 add_type_attribute (decl_die, TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
21109 TYPE_UNQUALIFIED, false, context_die);
21112 if (DECL_ABSTRACT_P (decl))
21113 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, decl_die);
21114 else
21115 add_AT_lbl_id (decl_die, DW_AT_low_pc, decl_start_label (decl));
21117 #endif
21119 /* Walk through the list of incomplete types again, trying once more to
21120 emit full debugging info for them. */
21122 static void
21123 retry_incomplete_types (void)
21125 set_early_dwarf s;
21126 int i;
21128 for (i = vec_safe_length (incomplete_types) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
21129 if (should_emit_struct_debug ((*incomplete_types)[i], DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE))
21130 gen_type_die ((*incomplete_types)[i], comp_unit_die ());
21131 vec_safe_truncate (incomplete_types, 0);
21134 /* Determine what tag to use for a record type. */
21136 static enum dwarf_tag
21137 record_type_tag (tree type)
21139 if (! lang_hooks.types.classify_record)
21140 return DW_TAG_structure_type;
21142 switch (lang_hooks.types.classify_record (type))
21144 case RECORD_IS_STRUCT:
21145 return DW_TAG_structure_type;
21147 case RECORD_IS_CLASS:
21148 return DW_TAG_class_type;
21150 case RECORD_IS_INTERFACE:
21151 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
21152 return DW_TAG_interface_type;
21153 return DW_TAG_structure_type;
21155 default:
21156 gcc_unreachable ();
21160 /* Generate a DIE to represent an enumeration type. Note that these DIEs
21161 include all of the information about the enumeration values also. Each
21162 enumerated type name/value is listed as a child of the enumerated type
21163 DIE. */
21165 static dw_die_ref
21166 gen_enumeration_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
21168 dw_die_ref type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
21170 if (type_die == NULL)
21172 type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_enumeration_type,
21173 scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
21174 equate_type_number_to_die (type, type_die);
21175 add_name_attribute (type_die, type_tag (type));
21176 if (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict)
21178 if (ENUM_IS_SCOPED (type))
21179 add_AT_flag (type_die, DW_AT_enum_class, 1);
21180 if (ENUM_IS_OPAQUE (type))
21181 add_AT_flag (type_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
21183 if (!dwarf_strict)
21184 add_AT_unsigned (type_die, DW_AT_encoding,
21185 TYPE_UNSIGNED (type)
21186 ? DW_ATE_unsigned
21187 : DW_ATE_signed);
21189 else if (! TYPE_SIZE (type))
21190 return type_die;
21191 else
21192 remove_AT (type_die, DW_AT_declaration);
21194 /* Handle a GNU C/C++ extension, i.e. incomplete enum types. If the
21195 given enum type is incomplete, do not generate the DW_AT_byte_size
21196 attribute or the DW_AT_element_list attribute. */
21197 if (TYPE_SIZE (type))
21199 tree link;
21201 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
21202 add_byte_size_attribute (type_die, type);
21203 add_alignment_attribute (type_die, type);
21204 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
21206 tree underlying = lang_hooks.types.enum_underlying_base_type (type);
21207 add_type_attribute (type_die, underlying, TYPE_UNQUALIFIED, false,
21208 context_die);
21210 if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type) != NULL_TREE)
21212 add_src_coords_attributes (type_die, TYPE_STUB_DECL (type));
21213 add_accessibility_attribute (type_die, TYPE_STUB_DECL (type));
21216 /* If the first reference to this type was as the return type of an
21217 inline function, then it may not have a parent. Fix this now. */
21218 if (type_die->die_parent == NULL)
21219 add_child_die (scope_die_for (type, context_die), type_die);
21221 for (link = TYPE_VALUES (type);
21222 link != NULL; link = TREE_CHAIN (link))
21224 dw_die_ref enum_die = new_die (DW_TAG_enumerator, type_die, link);
21225 tree value = TREE_VALUE (link);
21227 add_name_attribute (enum_die,
21228 IDENTIFIER_POINTER (TREE_PURPOSE (link)));
21230 if (TREE_CODE (value) == CONST_DECL)
21231 value = DECL_INITIAL (value);
21233 if (simple_type_size_in_bits (TREE_TYPE (value))
21234 <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT || tree_fits_shwi_p (value))
21236 /* For constant forms created by add_AT_unsigned DWARF
21237 consumers (GDB, elfutils, etc.) always zero extend
21238 the value. Only when the actual value is negative
21239 do we need to use add_AT_int to generate a constant
21240 form that can represent negative values. */
21241 HOST_WIDE_INT val = TREE_INT_CST_LOW (value);
21242 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (value)) || val >= 0)
21243 add_AT_unsigned (enum_die, DW_AT_const_value,
21244 (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) val);
21245 else
21246 add_AT_int (enum_die, DW_AT_const_value, val);
21248 else
21249 /* Enumeration constants may be wider than HOST_WIDE_INT. Handle
21250 that here. TODO: This should be re-worked to use correct
21251 signed/unsigned double tags for all cases. */
21252 add_AT_wide (enum_die, DW_AT_const_value, wi::to_wide (value));
21255 add_gnat_descriptive_type_attribute (type_die, type, context_die);
21256 if (TYPE_ARTIFICIAL (type))
21257 add_AT_flag (type_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
21259 else
21260 add_AT_flag (type_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
21262 add_pubtype (type, type_die);
21264 return type_die;
21267 /* Generate a DIE to represent either a real live formal parameter decl or to
21268 represent just the type of some formal parameter position in some function
21269 type.
21271 Note that this routine is a bit unusual because its argument may be a
21272 ..._DECL node (i.e. either a PARM_DECL or perhaps a VAR_DECL which
21273 represents an inlining of some PARM_DECL) or else some sort of a ..._TYPE
21274 node. If it's the former then this function is being called to output a
21275 DIE to represent a formal parameter object (or some inlining thereof). If
21276 it's the latter, then this function is only being called to output a
21277 DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIE to stand as a placeholder for some formal
21278 argument type of some subprogram type.
21279 If EMIT_NAME_P is true, name and source coordinate attributes
21280 are emitted. */
21282 static dw_die_ref
21283 gen_formal_parameter_die (tree node, tree origin, bool emit_name_p,
21284 dw_die_ref context_die)
21286 tree node_or_origin = node ? node : origin;
21287 tree ultimate_origin;
21288 dw_die_ref parm_die = NULL;
21290 if (DECL_P (node_or_origin))
21292 parm_die = lookup_decl_die (node);
21294 /* If the contexts differ, we may not be talking about the same
21295 thing.
21296 ??? When in LTO the DIE parent is the "abstract" copy and the
21297 context_die is the specification "copy". But this whole block
21298 should eventually be no longer needed. */
21299 if (parm_die && parm_die->die_parent != context_die && !in_lto_p)
21301 if (!DECL_ABSTRACT_P (node))
21303 /* This can happen when creating an inlined instance, in
21304 which case we need to create a new DIE that will get
21305 annotated with DW_AT_abstract_origin. */
21306 parm_die = NULL;
21308 else
21309 gcc_unreachable ();
21312 if (parm_die && parm_die->die_parent == NULL)
21314 /* Check that parm_die already has the right attributes that
21315 we would have added below. If any attributes are
21316 missing, fall through to add them. */
21317 if (! DECL_ABSTRACT_P (node_or_origin)
21318 && !get_AT (parm_die, DW_AT_location)
21319 && !get_AT (parm_die, DW_AT_const_value))
21320 /* We are missing location info, and are about to add it. */
21322 else
21324 add_child_die (context_die, parm_die);
21325 return parm_die;
21330 /* If we have a previously generated DIE, use it, unless this is an
21331 concrete instance (origin != NULL), in which case we need a new
21332 DIE with a corresponding DW_AT_abstract_origin. */
21333 bool reusing_die;
21334 if (parm_die && origin == NULL)
21335 reusing_die = true;
21336 else
21338 parm_die = new_die (DW_TAG_formal_parameter, context_die, node);
21339 reusing_die = false;
21342 switch (TREE_CODE_CLASS (TREE_CODE (node_or_origin)))
21344 case tcc_declaration:
21345 ultimate_origin = decl_ultimate_origin (node_or_origin);
21346 if (node || ultimate_origin)
21347 origin = ultimate_origin;
21349 if (reusing_die)
21350 goto add_location;
21352 if (origin != NULL)
21353 add_abstract_origin_attribute (parm_die, origin);
21354 else if (emit_name_p)
21355 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (parm_die, node);
21356 if (origin == NULL
21357 || (! DECL_ABSTRACT_P (node_or_origin)
21358 && variably_modified_type_p (TREE_TYPE (node_or_origin),
21359 decl_function_context
21360 (node_or_origin))))
21362 tree type = TREE_TYPE (node_or_origin);
21363 if (decl_by_reference_p (node_or_origin))
21364 add_type_attribute (parm_die, TREE_TYPE (type),
21365 TYPE_UNQUALIFIED,
21366 false, context_die);
21367 else
21368 add_type_attribute (parm_die, type,
21369 decl_quals (node_or_origin),
21370 false, context_die);
21372 if (origin == NULL && DECL_ARTIFICIAL (node))
21373 add_AT_flag (parm_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
21374 add_location:
21375 if (node && node != origin)
21376 equate_decl_number_to_die (node, parm_die);
21377 if (! DECL_ABSTRACT_P (node_or_origin))
21378 add_location_or_const_value_attribute (parm_die, node_or_origin,
21379 node == NULL);
21381 break;
21383 case tcc_type:
21384 /* We were called with some kind of a ..._TYPE node. */
21385 add_type_attribute (parm_die, node_or_origin, TYPE_UNQUALIFIED, false,
21386 context_die);
21387 break;
21389 default:
21390 gcc_unreachable ();
21393 return parm_die;
21396 /* Generate and return a DW_TAG_GNU_formal_parameter_pack. Also generate
21397 children DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIEs representing the arguments of the
21398 parameter pack.
21400 PARM_PACK must be a function parameter pack.
21401 PACK_ARG is the first argument of the parameter pack. Its TREE_CHAIN
21402 must point to the subsequent arguments of the function PACK_ARG belongs to.
21403 SUBR_DIE is the DIE of the function PACK_ARG belongs to.
21404 If NEXT_ARG is non NULL, *NEXT_ARG is set to the function argument
21405 following the last one for which a DIE was generated. */
21407 static dw_die_ref
21408 gen_formal_parameter_pack_die (tree parm_pack,
21409 tree pack_arg,
21410 dw_die_ref subr_die,
21411 tree *next_arg)
21413 tree arg;
21414 dw_die_ref parm_pack_die;
21416 gcc_assert (parm_pack
21417 && lang_hooks.function_parameter_pack_p (parm_pack)
21418 && subr_die);
21420 parm_pack_die = new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_formal_parameter_pack, subr_die, parm_pack);
21421 add_src_coords_attributes (parm_pack_die, parm_pack);
21423 for (arg = pack_arg; arg; arg = DECL_CHAIN (arg))
21425 if (! lang_hooks.decls.function_parm_expanded_from_pack_p (arg,
21426 parm_pack))
21427 break;
21428 gen_formal_parameter_die (arg, NULL,
21429 false /* Don't emit name attribute. */,
21430 parm_pack_die);
21432 if (next_arg)
21433 *next_arg = arg;
21434 return parm_pack_die;
21437 /* Generate a special type of DIE used as a stand-in for a trailing ellipsis
21438 at the end of an (ANSI prototyped) formal parameters list. */
21440 static void
21441 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (tree decl_or_type, dw_die_ref context_die)
21443 new_die (DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters, context_die, decl_or_type);
21446 /* Generate a list of nameless DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIEs (and perhaps a
21447 DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters DIE) to represent the types of the formal
21448 parameters as specified in some function type specification (except for
21449 those which appear as part of a function *definition*). */
21451 static void
21452 gen_formal_types_die (tree function_or_method_type, dw_die_ref context_die)
21454 tree link;
21455 tree formal_type = NULL;
21456 tree first_parm_type;
21457 tree arg;
21459 if (TREE_CODE (function_or_method_type) == FUNCTION_DECL)
21461 arg = DECL_ARGUMENTS (function_or_method_type);
21462 function_or_method_type = TREE_TYPE (function_or_method_type);
21464 else
21465 arg = NULL_TREE;
21467 first_parm_type = TYPE_ARG_TYPES (function_or_method_type);
21469 /* Make our first pass over the list of formal parameter types and output a
21470 DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIE for each one. */
21471 for (link = first_parm_type; link; )
21473 dw_die_ref parm_die;
21475 formal_type = TREE_VALUE (link);
21476 if (formal_type == void_type_node)
21477 break;
21479 /* Output a (nameless) DIE to represent the formal parameter itself. */
21480 if (!POINTER_BOUNDS_TYPE_P (formal_type))
21482 parm_die = gen_formal_parameter_die (formal_type, NULL,
21483 true /* Emit name attribute. */,
21484 context_die);
21485 if (TREE_CODE (function_or_method_type) == METHOD_TYPE
21486 && link == first_parm_type)
21488 add_AT_flag (parm_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
21489 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
21490 add_AT_die_ref (context_die, DW_AT_object_pointer, parm_die);
21492 else if (arg && DECL_ARTIFICIAL (arg))
21493 add_AT_flag (parm_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
21496 link = TREE_CHAIN (link);
21497 if (arg)
21498 arg = DECL_CHAIN (arg);
21501 /* If this function type has an ellipsis, add a
21502 DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters DIE to the end of the parameter list. */
21503 if (formal_type != void_type_node)
21504 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (function_or_method_type, context_die);
21506 /* Make our second (and final) pass over the list of formal parameter types
21507 and output DIEs to represent those types (as necessary). */
21508 for (link = TYPE_ARG_TYPES (function_or_method_type);
21509 link && TREE_VALUE (link);
21510 link = TREE_CHAIN (link))
21511 gen_type_die (TREE_VALUE (link), context_die);
21514 /* We want to generate the DIE for TYPE so that we can generate the
21515 die for MEMBER, which has been defined; we will need to refer back
21516 to the member declaration nested within TYPE. If we're trying to
21517 generate minimal debug info for TYPE, processing TYPE won't do the
21518 trick; we need to attach the member declaration by hand. */
21520 static void
21521 gen_type_die_for_member (tree type, tree member, dw_die_ref context_die)
21523 gen_type_die (type, context_die);
21525 /* If we're trying to avoid duplicate debug info, we may not have
21526 emitted the member decl for this function. Emit it now. */
21527 if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type)
21528 && TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type))
21529 && ! lookup_decl_die (member))
21531 dw_die_ref type_die;
21532 gcc_assert (!decl_ultimate_origin (member));
21534 push_decl_scope (type);
21535 type_die = lookup_type_die_strip_naming_typedef (type);
21536 if (TREE_CODE (member) == FUNCTION_DECL)
21537 gen_subprogram_die (member, type_die);
21538 else if (TREE_CODE (member) == FIELD_DECL)
21540 /* Ignore the nameless fields that are used to skip bits but handle
21541 C++ anonymous unions and structs. */
21542 if (DECL_NAME (member) != NULL_TREE
21543 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (member)) == UNION_TYPE
21544 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (member)) == RECORD_TYPE)
21546 struct vlr_context vlr_ctx = {
21547 DECL_CONTEXT (member), /* struct_type */
21548 NULL_TREE /* variant_part_offset */
21550 gen_type_die (member_declared_type (member), type_die);
21551 gen_field_die (member, &vlr_ctx, type_die);
21554 else
21555 gen_variable_die (member, NULL_TREE, type_die);
21557 pop_decl_scope ();
21561 /* Forward declare these functions, because they are mutually recursive
21562 with their set_block_* pairing functions. */
21563 static void set_decl_origin_self (tree);
21565 /* Given a pointer to some BLOCK node, if the BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for the
21566 given BLOCK node is NULL, set the BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for the node so
21567 that it points to the node itself, thus indicating that the node is its
21568 own (abstract) origin. Additionally, if the BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for
21569 the given node is NULL, recursively descend the decl/block tree which
21570 it is the root of, and for each other ..._DECL or BLOCK node contained
21571 therein whose DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGINs or BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGINs are also
21572 still NULL, set *their* DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN or BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN
21573 values to point to themselves. */
21575 static void
21576 set_block_origin_self (tree stmt)
21578 if (BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (stmt) == NULL_TREE)
21580 BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (stmt) = stmt;
21583 tree local_decl;
21585 for (local_decl = BLOCK_VARS (stmt);
21586 local_decl != NULL_TREE;
21587 local_decl = DECL_CHAIN (local_decl))
21588 /* Do not recurse on nested functions since the inlining status
21589 of parent and child can be different as per the DWARF spec. */
21590 if (TREE_CODE (local_decl) != FUNCTION_DECL
21591 && !DECL_EXTERNAL (local_decl))
21592 set_decl_origin_self (local_decl);
21596 tree subblock;
21598 for (subblock = BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (stmt);
21599 subblock != NULL_TREE;
21600 subblock = BLOCK_CHAIN (subblock))
21601 set_block_origin_self (subblock); /* Recurse. */
21606 /* Given a pointer to some ..._DECL node, if the DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for
21607 the given ..._DECL node is NULL, set the DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for the
21608 node to so that it points to the node itself, thus indicating that the
21609 node represents its own (abstract) origin. Additionally, if the
21610 DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for the given node is NULL, recursively descend
21611 the decl/block tree of which the given node is the root of, and for
21612 each other ..._DECL or BLOCK node contained therein whose
21613 DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGINs or BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGINs are also still NULL,
21614 set *their* DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN or BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN values to
21615 point to themselves. */
21617 static void
21618 set_decl_origin_self (tree decl)
21620 if (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) == NULL_TREE)
21622 DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) = decl;
21623 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL)
21625 tree arg;
21627 for (arg = DECL_ARGUMENTS (decl); arg; arg = DECL_CHAIN (arg))
21628 DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (arg) = arg;
21629 if (DECL_INITIAL (decl) != NULL_TREE
21630 && DECL_INITIAL (decl) != error_mark_node)
21631 set_block_origin_self (DECL_INITIAL (decl));
21636 /* Mark the early DIE for DECL as the abstract instance. */
21638 static void
21639 dwarf2out_abstract_function (tree decl)
21641 dw_die_ref old_die;
21643 /* Make sure we have the actual abstract inline, not a clone. */
21644 decl = DECL_ORIGIN (decl);
21646 if (DECL_IGNORED_P (decl))
21647 return;
21649 old_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
21650 /* With early debug we always have an old DIE unless we are in LTO
21651 and the user did not compile but only link with debug. */
21652 if (in_lto_p && ! old_die)
21653 return;
21654 gcc_assert (old_die != NULL);
21655 if (get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_inline)
21656 || get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_abstract_origin))
21657 /* We've already generated the abstract instance. */
21658 return;
21660 /* Go ahead and put DW_AT_inline on the DIE. */
21661 if (DECL_DECLARED_INLINE_P (decl))
21663 if (cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p (decl))
21664 add_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_declared_inlined);
21665 else
21666 add_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_declared_not_inlined);
21668 else
21670 if (cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p (decl))
21671 add_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_inlined);
21672 else
21673 add_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_not_inlined);
21676 if (DECL_DECLARED_INLINE_P (decl)
21677 && lookup_attribute ("artificial", DECL_ATTRIBUTES (decl)))
21678 add_AT_flag (old_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
21680 set_decl_origin_self (decl);
21683 /* Helper function of premark_used_types() which gets called through
21684 htab_traverse.
21686 Marks the DIE of a given type in *SLOT as perennial, so it never gets
21687 marked as unused by prune_unused_types. */
21689 bool
21690 premark_used_types_helper (tree const &type, void *)
21692 dw_die_ref die;
21694 die = lookup_type_die (type);
21695 if (die != NULL)
21696 die->die_perennial_p = 1;
21697 return true;
21700 /* Helper function of premark_types_used_by_global_vars which gets called
21701 through htab_traverse.
21703 Marks the DIE of a given type in *SLOT as perennial, so it never gets
21704 marked as unused by prune_unused_types. The DIE of the type is marked
21705 only if the global variable using the type will actually be emitted. */
21708 premark_types_used_by_global_vars_helper (types_used_by_vars_entry **slot,
21709 void *)
21711 struct types_used_by_vars_entry *entry;
21712 dw_die_ref die;
21714 entry = (struct types_used_by_vars_entry *) *slot;
21715 gcc_assert (entry->type != NULL
21716 && entry->var_decl != NULL);
21717 die = lookup_type_die (entry->type);
21718 if (die)
21720 /* Ask cgraph if the global variable really is to be emitted.
21721 If yes, then we'll keep the DIE of ENTRY->TYPE. */
21722 varpool_node *node = varpool_node::get (entry->var_decl);
21723 if (node && node->definition)
21725 die->die_perennial_p = 1;
21726 /* Keep the parent DIEs as well. */
21727 while ((die = die->die_parent) && die->die_perennial_p == 0)
21728 die->die_perennial_p = 1;
21731 return 1;
21734 /* Mark all members of used_types_hash as perennial. */
21736 static void
21737 premark_used_types (struct function *fun)
21739 if (fun && fun->used_types_hash)
21740 fun->used_types_hash->traverse<void *, premark_used_types_helper> (NULL);
21743 /* Mark all members of types_used_by_vars_entry as perennial. */
21745 static void
21746 premark_types_used_by_global_vars (void)
21748 if (types_used_by_vars_hash)
21749 types_used_by_vars_hash
21750 ->traverse<void *, premark_types_used_by_global_vars_helper> (NULL);
21753 /* Generate a DW_TAG_call_site DIE in function DECL under SUBR_DIE
21754 for CA_LOC call arg loc node. */
21756 static dw_die_ref
21757 gen_call_site_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref subr_die,
21758 struct call_arg_loc_node *ca_loc)
21760 dw_die_ref stmt_die = NULL, die;
21761 tree block = ca_loc->block;
21763 while (block
21764 && block != DECL_INITIAL (decl)
21765 && TREE_CODE (block) == BLOCK)
21767 stmt_die = BLOCK_DIE (block);
21768 if (stmt_die)
21769 break;
21770 block = BLOCK_SUPERCONTEXT (block);
21772 if (stmt_die == NULL)
21773 stmt_die = subr_die;
21774 die = new_die (dwarf_TAG (DW_TAG_call_site), stmt_die, NULL_TREE);
21775 add_AT_lbl_id (die, dwarf_AT (DW_AT_call_return_pc), ca_loc->label);
21776 if (ca_loc->tail_call_p)
21777 add_AT_flag (die, dwarf_AT (DW_AT_call_tail_call), 1);
21778 if (ca_loc->symbol_ref)
21780 dw_die_ref tdie = lookup_decl_die (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (ca_loc->symbol_ref));
21781 if (tdie)
21782 add_AT_die_ref (die, dwarf_AT (DW_AT_call_origin), tdie);
21783 else
21784 add_AT_addr (die, dwarf_AT (DW_AT_call_origin), ca_loc->symbol_ref,
21785 false);
21787 return die;
21790 /* Generate a DIE to represent a declared function (either file-scope or
21791 block-local). */
21793 static void
21794 gen_subprogram_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
21796 tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
21797 dw_die_ref subr_die;
21798 dw_die_ref old_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
21800 /* This function gets called multiple times for different stages of
21801 the debug process. For example, for func() in this code:
21803 namespace S
21805 void func() { ... }
21808 ...we get called 4 times. Twice in early debug and twice in
21809 late debug:
21811 Early debug
21812 -----------
21814 1. Once while generating func() within the namespace. This is
21815 the declaration. The declaration bit below is set, as the
21816 context is the namespace.
21818 A new DIE will be generated with DW_AT_declaration set.
21820 2. Once for func() itself. This is the specification. The
21821 declaration bit below is clear as the context is the CU.
21823 We will use the cached DIE from (1) to create a new DIE with
21824 DW_AT_specification pointing to the declaration in (1).
21826 Late debug via rest_of_handle_final()
21827 -------------------------------------
21829 3. Once generating func() within the namespace. This is also the
21830 declaration, as in (1), but this time we will early exit below
21831 as we have a cached DIE and a declaration needs no additional
21832 annotations (no locations), as the source declaration line
21833 info is enough.
21835 4. Once for func() itself. As in (2), this is the specification,
21836 but this time we will re-use the cached DIE, and just annotate
21837 it with the location information that should now be available.
21839 For something without namespaces, but with abstract instances, we
21840 are also called a multiple times:
21842 class Base
21844 public:
21845 Base (); // constructor declaration (1)
21848 Base::Base () { } // constructor specification (2)
21850 Early debug
21851 -----------
21853 1. Once for the Base() constructor by virtue of it being a
21854 member of the Base class. This is done via
21855 rest_of_type_compilation.
21857 This is a declaration, so a new DIE will be created with
21858 DW_AT_declaration.
21860 2. Once for the Base() constructor definition, but this time
21861 while generating the abstract instance of the base
21862 constructor (__base_ctor) which is being generated via early
21863 debug of reachable functions.
21865 Even though we have a cached version of the declaration (1),
21866 we will create a DW_AT_specification of the declaration DIE
21867 in (1).
21869 3. Once for the __base_ctor itself, but this time, we generate
21870 an DW_AT_abstract_origin version of the DW_AT_specification in
21871 (2).
21873 Late debug via rest_of_handle_final
21874 -----------------------------------
21876 4. One final time for the __base_ctor (which will have a cached
21877 DIE with DW_AT_abstract_origin created in (3). This time,
21878 we will just annotate the location information now
21879 available.
21881 int declaration = (current_function_decl != decl
21882 || class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die));
21884 /* Now that the C++ front end lazily declares artificial member fns, we
21885 might need to retrofit the declaration into its class. */
21886 if (!declaration && !origin && !old_die
21887 && DECL_CONTEXT (decl) && TYPE_P (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))
21888 && !class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die)
21889 && debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
21890 old_die = force_decl_die (decl);
21892 /* A concrete instance, tag a new DIE with DW_AT_abstract_origin. */
21893 if (origin != NULL)
21895 gcc_assert (!declaration || local_scope_p (context_die));
21897 /* Fixup die_parent for the abstract instance of a nested
21898 inline function. */
21899 if (old_die && old_die->die_parent == NULL)
21900 add_child_die (context_die, old_die);
21902 if (old_die && get_AT_ref (old_die, DW_AT_abstract_origin))
21904 /* If we have a DW_AT_abstract_origin we have a working
21905 cached version. */
21906 subr_die = old_die;
21908 else
21910 subr_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram, context_die, decl);
21911 add_abstract_origin_attribute (subr_die, origin);
21912 /* This is where the actual code for a cloned function is.
21913 Let's emit linkage name attribute for it. This helps
21914 debuggers to e.g, set breakpoints into
21915 constructors/destructors when the user asks "break
21916 K::K". */
21917 add_linkage_name (subr_die, decl);
21920 /* A cached copy, possibly from early dwarf generation. Reuse as
21921 much as possible. */
21922 else if (old_die)
21924 /* A declaration that has been previously dumped needs no
21925 additional information. */
21926 if (declaration)
21927 return;
21929 if (!get_AT_flag (old_die, DW_AT_declaration)
21930 /* We can have a normal definition following an inline one in the
21931 case of redefinition of GNU C extern inlines.
21932 It seems reasonable to use AT_specification in this case. */
21933 && !get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
21935 /* Detect and ignore this case, where we are trying to output
21936 something we have already output. */
21937 if (get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_low_pc)
21938 || get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_ranges))
21939 return;
21941 /* If we have no location information, this must be a
21942 partially generated DIE from early dwarf generation.
21943 Fall through and generate it. */
21946 /* If the definition comes from the same place as the declaration,
21947 maybe use the old DIE. We always want the DIE for this function
21948 that has the *_pc attributes to be under comp_unit_die so the
21949 debugger can find it. We also need to do this for abstract
21950 instances of inlines, since the spec requires the out-of-line copy
21951 to have the same parent. For local class methods, this doesn't
21952 apply; we just use the old DIE. */
21953 expanded_location s = expand_location (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl));
21954 struct dwarf_file_data * file_index = lookup_filename (s.file);
21955 if ((is_cu_die (old_die->die_parent)
21956 /* This condition fixes the inconsistency/ICE with the
21957 following Fortran test (or some derivative thereof) while
21958 building libgfortran:
21960 module some_m
21961 contains
21962 logical function funky (FLAG)
21963 funky = .true.
21964 end function
21965 end module
21967 || (old_die->die_parent
21968 && old_die->die_parent->die_tag == DW_TAG_module)
21969 || context_die == NULL)
21970 && (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl)
21971 /* The location attributes may be in the abstract origin
21972 which in the case of LTO might be not available to
21973 look at. */
21974 || get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_abstract_origin)
21975 || (get_AT_file (old_die, DW_AT_decl_file) == file_index
21976 && (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_line)
21977 == (unsigned) s.line)
21978 && (!debug_column_info
21979 || s.column == 0
21980 || (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_column)
21981 == (unsigned) s.column)))))
21983 subr_die = old_die;
21985 /* Clear out the declaration attribute, but leave the
21986 parameters so they can be augmented with location
21987 information later. Unless this was a declaration, in
21988 which case, wipe out the nameless parameters and recreate
21989 them further down. */
21990 if (remove_AT (subr_die, DW_AT_declaration))
21993 remove_AT (subr_die, DW_AT_object_pointer);
21994 remove_child_TAG (subr_die, DW_TAG_formal_parameter);
21997 /* Make a specification pointing to the previously built
21998 declaration. */
21999 else
22001 subr_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram, context_die, decl);
22002 add_AT_specification (subr_die, old_die);
22003 add_pubname (decl, subr_die);
22004 if (get_AT_file (old_die, DW_AT_decl_file) != file_index)
22005 add_AT_file (subr_die, DW_AT_decl_file, file_index);
22006 if (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_line) != (unsigned) s.line)
22007 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_decl_line, s.line);
22008 if (debug_column_info
22009 && s.column
22010 && (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_column)
22011 != (unsigned) s.column))
22012 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_decl_column, s.column);
22014 /* If the prototype had an 'auto' or 'decltype(auto)' return type,
22015 emit the real type on the definition die. */
22016 if (is_cxx () && debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
22018 dw_die_ref die = get_AT_ref (old_die, DW_AT_type);
22019 if (die == auto_die || die == decltype_auto_die)
22020 add_type_attribute (subr_die, TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
22021 TYPE_UNQUALIFIED, false, context_die);
22024 /* When we process the method declaration, we haven't seen
22025 the out-of-class defaulted definition yet, so we have to
22026 recheck now. */
22027 if ((dwarf_version >= 5 || ! dwarf_strict)
22028 && !get_AT (subr_die, DW_AT_defaulted))
22030 int defaulted
22031 = lang_hooks.decls.decl_dwarf_attribute (decl,
22032 DW_AT_defaulted);
22033 if (defaulted != -1)
22035 /* Other values must have been handled before. */
22036 gcc_assert (defaulted == DW_DEFAULTED_out_of_class);
22037 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_defaulted, defaulted);
22042 /* Create a fresh DIE for anything else. */
22043 else
22045 subr_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram, context_die, decl);
22047 if (TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
22048 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_external, 1);
22050 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (subr_die, decl);
22051 add_pubname (decl, subr_die);
22052 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
22054 add_prototyped_attribute (subr_die, TREE_TYPE (decl));
22055 add_type_attribute (subr_die, TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
22056 TYPE_UNQUALIFIED, false, context_die);
22059 add_pure_or_virtual_attribute (subr_die, decl);
22060 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
22061 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
22063 if (TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl) && (dwarf_version >= 5 || !dwarf_strict))
22064 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_noreturn, 1);
22066 add_alignment_attribute (subr_die, decl);
22068 add_accessibility_attribute (subr_die, decl);
22071 /* Unless we have an existing non-declaration DIE, equate the new
22072 DIE. */
22073 if (!old_die || is_declaration_die (old_die))
22074 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, subr_die);
22076 if (declaration)
22078 if (!old_die || !get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
22080 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
22082 /* If this is an explicit function declaration then generate
22083 a DW_AT_explicit attribute. */
22084 if ((dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
22085 && lang_hooks.decls.decl_dwarf_attribute (decl,
22086 DW_AT_explicit) == 1)
22087 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_explicit, 1);
22089 /* If this is a C++11 deleted special function member then generate
22090 a DW_AT_deleted attribute. */
22091 if ((dwarf_version >= 5 || !dwarf_strict)
22092 && lang_hooks.decls.decl_dwarf_attribute (decl,
22093 DW_AT_deleted) == 1)
22094 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_deleted, 1);
22096 /* If this is a C++11 defaulted special function member then
22097 generate a DW_AT_defaulted attribute. */
22098 if (dwarf_version >= 5 || !dwarf_strict)
22100 int defaulted
22101 = lang_hooks.decls.decl_dwarf_attribute (decl,
22102 DW_AT_defaulted);
22103 if (defaulted != -1)
22104 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_defaulted, defaulted);
22107 /* If this is a C++11 non-static member function with & ref-qualifier
22108 then generate a DW_AT_reference attribute. */
22109 if ((dwarf_version >= 5 || !dwarf_strict)
22110 && lang_hooks.decls.decl_dwarf_attribute (decl,
22111 DW_AT_reference) == 1)
22112 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_reference, 1);
22114 /* If this is a C++11 non-static member function with &&
22115 ref-qualifier then generate a DW_AT_reference attribute. */
22116 if ((dwarf_version >= 5 || !dwarf_strict)
22117 && lang_hooks.decls.decl_dwarf_attribute (decl,
22118 DW_AT_rvalue_reference)
22119 == 1)
22120 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_rvalue_reference, 1);
22123 /* For non DECL_EXTERNALs, if range information is available, fill
22124 the DIE with it. */
22125 else if (!DECL_EXTERNAL (decl) && !early_dwarf)
22127 HOST_WIDE_INT cfa_fb_offset;
22129 struct function *fun = DECL_STRUCT_FUNCTION (decl);
22131 if (!crtl->has_bb_partition)
22133 dw_fde_ref fde = fun->fde;
22134 if (fde->dw_fde_begin)
22136 /* We have already generated the labels. */
22137 add_AT_low_high_pc (subr_die, fde->dw_fde_begin,
22138 fde->dw_fde_end, false);
22140 else
22142 /* Create start/end labels and add the range. */
22143 char label_id_low[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
22144 char label_id_high[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
22145 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label_id_low, FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL,
22146 current_function_funcdef_no);
22147 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label_id_high, FUNC_END_LABEL,
22148 current_function_funcdef_no);
22149 add_AT_low_high_pc (subr_die, label_id_low, label_id_high,
22150 false);
22153 #if VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
22154 /* HP OpenVMS Industry Standard 64: DWARF Extensions
22155 Section 2.3 Prologue and Epilogue Attributes:
22156 When a breakpoint is set on entry to a function, it is generally
22157 desirable for execution to be suspended, not on the very first
22158 instruction of the function, but rather at a point after the
22159 function's frame has been set up, after any language defined local
22160 declaration processing has been completed, and before execution of
22161 the first statement of the function begins. Debuggers generally
22162 cannot properly determine where this point is. Similarly for a
22163 breakpoint set on exit from a function. The prologue and epilogue
22164 attributes allow a compiler to communicate the location(s) to use. */
22167 if (fde->dw_fde_vms_end_prologue)
22168 add_AT_vms_delta (subr_die, DW_AT_HP_prologue,
22169 fde->dw_fde_begin, fde->dw_fde_vms_end_prologue);
22171 if (fde->dw_fde_vms_begin_epilogue)
22172 add_AT_vms_delta (subr_die, DW_AT_HP_epilogue,
22173 fde->dw_fde_begin, fde->dw_fde_vms_begin_epilogue);
22175 #endif
22178 else
22180 /* Generate pubnames entries for the split function code ranges. */
22181 dw_fde_ref fde = fun->fde;
22183 if (fde->dw_fde_second_begin)
22185 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
22187 /* We should use ranges for non-contiguous code section
22188 addresses. Use the actual code range for the initial
22189 section, since the HOT/COLD labels might precede an
22190 alignment offset. */
22191 bool range_list_added = false;
22192 add_ranges_by_labels (subr_die, fde->dw_fde_begin,
22193 fde->dw_fde_end, &range_list_added,
22194 false);
22195 add_ranges_by_labels (subr_die, fde->dw_fde_second_begin,
22196 fde->dw_fde_second_end,
22197 &range_list_added, false);
22198 if (range_list_added)
22199 add_ranges (NULL);
22201 else
22203 /* There is no real support in DW2 for this .. so we make
22204 a work-around. First, emit the pub name for the segment
22205 containing the function label. Then make and emit a
22206 simplified subprogram DIE for the second segment with the
22207 name pre-fixed by __hot/cold_sect_of_. We use the same
22208 linkage name for the second die so that gdb will find both
22209 sections when given "b foo". */
22210 const char *name = NULL;
22211 tree decl_name = DECL_NAME (decl);
22212 dw_die_ref seg_die;
22214 /* Do the 'primary' section. */
22215 add_AT_low_high_pc (subr_die, fde->dw_fde_begin,
22216 fde->dw_fde_end, false);
22218 /* Build a minimal DIE for the secondary section. */
22219 seg_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram,
22220 subr_die->die_parent, decl);
22222 if (TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
22223 add_AT_flag (seg_die, DW_AT_external, 1);
22225 if (decl_name != NULL
22226 && IDENTIFIER_POINTER (decl_name) != NULL)
22228 name = dwarf2_name (decl, 1);
22229 if (! DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
22230 add_src_coords_attributes (seg_die, decl);
22232 add_linkage_name (seg_die, decl);
22234 gcc_assert (name != NULL);
22235 add_pure_or_virtual_attribute (seg_die, decl);
22236 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
22237 add_AT_flag (seg_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
22239 name = concat ("__second_sect_of_", name, NULL);
22240 add_AT_low_high_pc (seg_die, fde->dw_fde_second_begin,
22241 fde->dw_fde_second_end, false);
22242 add_name_attribute (seg_die, name);
22243 if (want_pubnames ())
22244 add_pubname_string (name, seg_die);
22247 else
22248 add_AT_low_high_pc (subr_die, fde->dw_fde_begin, fde->dw_fde_end,
22249 false);
22252 cfa_fb_offset = CFA_FRAME_BASE_OFFSET (decl);
22254 /* We define the "frame base" as the function's CFA. This is more
22255 convenient for several reasons: (1) It's stable across the prologue
22256 and epilogue, which makes it better than just a frame pointer,
22257 (2) With dwarf3, there exists a one-byte encoding that allows us
22258 to reference the .debug_frame data by proxy, but failing that,
22259 (3) We can at least reuse the code inspection and interpretation
22260 code that determines the CFA position at various points in the
22261 function. */
22262 if (dwarf_version >= 3 && targetm.debug_unwind_info () == UI_DWARF2)
22264 dw_loc_descr_ref op = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_call_frame_cfa, 0, 0);
22265 add_AT_loc (subr_die, DW_AT_frame_base, op);
22267 else
22269 dw_loc_list_ref list = convert_cfa_to_fb_loc_list (cfa_fb_offset);
22270 if (list->dw_loc_next)
22271 add_AT_loc_list (subr_die, DW_AT_frame_base, list);
22272 else
22273 add_AT_loc (subr_die, DW_AT_frame_base, list->expr);
22276 /* Compute a displacement from the "steady-state frame pointer" to
22277 the CFA. The former is what all stack slots and argument slots
22278 will reference in the rtl; the latter is what we've told the
22279 debugger about. We'll need to adjust all frame_base references
22280 by this displacement. */
22281 compute_frame_pointer_to_fb_displacement (cfa_fb_offset);
22283 if (fun->static_chain_decl)
22285 /* DWARF requires here a location expression that computes the
22286 address of the enclosing subprogram's frame base. The machinery
22287 in tree-nested.c is supposed to store this specific address in the
22288 last field of the FRAME record. */
22289 const tree frame_type
22290 = TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (fun->static_chain_decl));
22291 const tree fb_decl = tree_last (TYPE_FIELDS (frame_type));
22293 tree fb_expr
22294 = build1 (INDIRECT_REF, frame_type, fun->static_chain_decl);
22295 fb_expr = build3 (COMPONENT_REF, TREE_TYPE (fb_decl),
22296 fb_expr, fb_decl, NULL_TREE);
22298 add_AT_location_description (subr_die, DW_AT_static_link,
22299 loc_list_from_tree (fb_expr, 0, NULL));
22302 resolve_variable_values ();
22305 /* Generate child dies for template paramaters. */
22306 if (early_dwarf && debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
22307 gen_generic_params_dies (decl);
22309 /* Now output descriptions of the arguments for this function. This gets
22310 (unnecessarily?) complex because of the fact that the DECL_ARGUMENT list
22311 for a FUNCTION_DECL doesn't indicate cases where there was a trailing
22312 `...' at the end of the formal parameter list. In order to find out if
22313 there was a trailing ellipsis or not, we must instead look at the type
22314 associated with the FUNCTION_DECL. This will be a node of type
22315 FUNCTION_TYPE. If the chain of type nodes hanging off of this
22316 FUNCTION_TYPE node ends with a void_type_node then there should *not* be
22317 an ellipsis at the end. */
22319 /* In the case where we are describing a mere function declaration, all we
22320 need to do here (and all we *can* do here) is to describe the *types* of
22321 its formal parameters. */
22322 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
22324 else if (declaration)
22325 gen_formal_types_die (decl, subr_die);
22326 else
22328 /* Generate DIEs to represent all known formal parameters. */
22329 tree parm = DECL_ARGUMENTS (decl);
22330 tree generic_decl = early_dwarf
22331 ? lang_hooks.decls.get_generic_function_decl (decl) : NULL;
22332 tree generic_decl_parm = generic_decl
22333 ? DECL_ARGUMENTS (generic_decl)
22334 : NULL;
22336 /* Now we want to walk the list of parameters of the function and
22337 emit their relevant DIEs.
22339 We consider the case of DECL being an instance of a generic function
22340 as well as it being a normal function.
22342 If DECL is an instance of a generic function we walk the
22343 parameters of the generic function declaration _and_ the parameters of
22344 DECL itself. This is useful because we want to emit specific DIEs for
22345 function parameter packs and those are declared as part of the
22346 generic function declaration. In that particular case,
22347 the parameter pack yields a DW_TAG_GNU_formal_parameter_pack DIE.
22348 That DIE has children DIEs representing the set of arguments
22349 of the pack. Note that the set of pack arguments can be empty.
22350 In that case, the DW_TAG_GNU_formal_parameter_pack DIE will not have any
22351 children DIE.
22353 Otherwise, we just consider the parameters of DECL. */
22354 while (generic_decl_parm || parm)
22356 if (generic_decl_parm
22357 && lang_hooks.function_parameter_pack_p (generic_decl_parm))
22358 gen_formal_parameter_pack_die (generic_decl_parm,
22359 parm, subr_die,
22360 &parm);
22361 else if (parm && !POINTER_BOUNDS_P (parm))
22363 dw_die_ref parm_die = gen_decl_die (parm, NULL, NULL, subr_die);
22365 if (early_dwarf
22366 && parm == DECL_ARGUMENTS (decl)
22367 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == METHOD_TYPE
22368 && parm_die
22369 && (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict))
22370 add_AT_die_ref (subr_die, DW_AT_object_pointer, parm_die);
22372 parm = DECL_CHAIN (parm);
22374 else if (parm)
22375 parm = DECL_CHAIN (parm);
22377 if (generic_decl_parm)
22378 generic_decl_parm = DECL_CHAIN (generic_decl_parm);
22381 /* Decide whether we need an unspecified_parameters DIE at the end.
22382 There are 2 more cases to do this for: 1) the ansi ... declaration -
22383 this is detectable when the end of the arg list is not a
22384 void_type_node 2) an unprototyped function declaration (not a
22385 definition). This just means that we have no info about the
22386 parameters at all. */
22387 if (early_dwarf)
22389 if (prototype_p (TREE_TYPE (decl)))
22391 /* This is the prototyped case, check for.... */
22392 if (stdarg_p (TREE_TYPE (decl)))
22393 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (decl, subr_die);
22395 else if (DECL_INITIAL (decl) == NULL_TREE)
22396 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (decl, subr_die);
22400 if (subr_die != old_die)
22401 /* Add the calling convention attribute if requested. */
22402 add_calling_convention_attribute (subr_die, decl);
22404 /* Output Dwarf info for all of the stuff within the body of the function
22405 (if it has one - it may be just a declaration).
22407 OUTER_SCOPE is a pointer to the outermost BLOCK node created to represent
22408 a function. This BLOCK actually represents the outermost binding contour
22409 for the function, i.e. the contour in which the function's formal
22410 parameters and labels get declared. Curiously, it appears that the front
22411 end doesn't actually put the PARM_DECL nodes for the current function onto
22412 the BLOCK_VARS list for this outer scope, but are strung off of the
22413 DECL_ARGUMENTS list for the function instead.
22415 The BLOCK_VARS list for the `outer_scope' does provide us with a list of
22416 the LABEL_DECL nodes for the function however, and we output DWARF info
22417 for those in decls_for_scope. Just within the `outer_scope' there will be
22418 a BLOCK node representing the function's outermost pair of curly braces,
22419 and any blocks used for the base and member initializers of a C++
22420 constructor function. */
22421 tree outer_scope = DECL_INITIAL (decl);
22422 if (! declaration && outer_scope && TREE_CODE (outer_scope) != ERROR_MARK)
22424 int call_site_note_count = 0;
22425 int tail_call_site_note_count = 0;
22427 /* Emit a DW_TAG_variable DIE for a named return value. */
22428 if (DECL_NAME (DECL_RESULT (decl)))
22429 gen_decl_die (DECL_RESULT (decl), NULL, NULL, subr_die);
22431 /* The first time through decls_for_scope we will generate the
22432 DIEs for the locals. The second time, we fill in the
22433 location info. */
22434 decls_for_scope (outer_scope, subr_die);
22436 if (call_arg_locations && (!dwarf_strict || dwarf_version >= 5))
22438 struct call_arg_loc_node *ca_loc;
22439 for (ca_loc = call_arg_locations; ca_loc; ca_loc = ca_loc->next)
22441 dw_die_ref die = NULL;
22442 rtx tloc = NULL_RTX, tlocc = NULL_RTX;
22443 rtx arg, next_arg;
22445 for (arg = (ca_loc->call_arg_loc_note != NULL_RTX
22446 ? NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (ca_loc->call_arg_loc_note)
22447 : NULL_RTX);
22448 arg; arg = next_arg)
22450 dw_loc_descr_ref reg, val;
22451 machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 1));
22452 dw_die_ref cdie, tdie = NULL;
22454 next_arg = XEXP (arg, 1);
22455 if (REG_P (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0))
22456 && next_arg
22457 && MEM_P (XEXP (XEXP (next_arg, 0), 0))
22458 && REG_P (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (next_arg, 0), 0), 0))
22459 && REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0))
22460 == REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (next_arg, 0), 0), 0)))
22461 next_arg = XEXP (next_arg, 1);
22462 if (mode == VOIDmode)
22464 mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0));
22465 if (mode == VOIDmode)
22466 mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (arg, 0));
22468 if (mode == VOIDmode || mode == BLKmode)
22469 continue;
22470 /* Get dynamic information about call target only if we
22471 have no static information: we cannot generate both
22472 DW_AT_call_origin and DW_AT_call_target
22473 attributes. */
22474 if (ca_loc->symbol_ref == NULL_RTX)
22476 if (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0) == pc_rtx)
22478 tloc = XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 1);
22479 continue;
22481 else if (GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0)) == CLOBBER
22482 && XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0), 0) == pc_rtx)
22484 tlocc = XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 1);
22485 continue;
22488 reg = NULL;
22489 if (REG_P (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0)))
22490 reg = reg_loc_descriptor (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0),
22491 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
22492 else if (MEM_P (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0)))
22494 rtx mem = XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0);
22495 reg = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (mem, 0),
22496 get_address_mode (mem),
22497 GET_MODE (mem),
22498 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
22500 else if (GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0))
22501 == DEBUG_PARAMETER_REF)
22503 tree tdecl
22504 = DEBUG_PARAMETER_REF_DECL (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0));
22505 tdie = lookup_decl_die (tdecl);
22506 if (tdie == NULL)
22507 continue;
22509 else
22510 continue;
22511 if (reg == NULL
22512 && GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0))
22513 != DEBUG_PARAMETER_REF)
22514 continue;
22515 val = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 1), mode,
22516 VOIDmode,
22517 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
22518 if (val == NULL)
22519 continue;
22520 if (die == NULL)
22521 die = gen_call_site_die (decl, subr_die, ca_loc);
22522 cdie = new_die (dwarf_TAG (DW_TAG_call_site_parameter), die,
22523 NULL_TREE);
22524 if (reg != NULL)
22525 add_AT_loc (cdie, DW_AT_location, reg);
22526 else if (tdie != NULL)
22527 add_AT_die_ref (cdie, dwarf_AT (DW_AT_call_parameter),
22528 tdie);
22529 add_AT_loc (cdie, dwarf_AT (DW_AT_call_value), val);
22530 if (next_arg != XEXP (arg, 1))
22532 mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 1), 0), 1));
22533 if (mode == VOIDmode)
22534 mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 1), 0), 0));
22535 val = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 1),
22536 0), 1),
22537 mode, VOIDmode,
22538 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
22539 if (val != NULL)
22540 add_AT_loc (cdie, dwarf_AT (DW_AT_call_data_value),
22541 val);
22544 if (die == NULL
22545 && (ca_loc->symbol_ref || tloc))
22546 die = gen_call_site_die (decl, subr_die, ca_loc);
22547 if (die != NULL && (tloc != NULL_RTX || tlocc != NULL_RTX))
22549 dw_loc_descr_ref tval = NULL;
22551 if (tloc != NULL_RTX)
22552 tval = mem_loc_descriptor (tloc,
22553 GET_MODE (tloc) == VOIDmode
22554 ? Pmode : GET_MODE (tloc),
22555 VOIDmode,
22556 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
22557 if (tval)
22558 add_AT_loc (die, dwarf_AT (DW_AT_call_target), tval);
22559 else if (tlocc != NULL_RTX)
22561 tval = mem_loc_descriptor (tlocc,
22562 GET_MODE (tlocc) == VOIDmode
22563 ? Pmode : GET_MODE (tlocc),
22564 VOIDmode,
22565 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
22566 if (tval)
22567 add_AT_loc (die,
22568 dwarf_AT (DW_AT_call_target_clobbered),
22569 tval);
22572 if (die != NULL)
22574 call_site_note_count++;
22575 if (ca_loc->tail_call_p)
22576 tail_call_site_note_count++;
22580 call_arg_locations = NULL;
22581 call_arg_loc_last = NULL;
22582 if (tail_call_site_count >= 0
22583 && tail_call_site_count == tail_call_site_note_count
22584 && (!dwarf_strict || dwarf_version >= 5))
22586 if (call_site_count >= 0
22587 && call_site_count == call_site_note_count)
22588 add_AT_flag (subr_die, dwarf_AT (DW_AT_call_all_calls), 1);
22589 else
22590 add_AT_flag (subr_die, dwarf_AT (DW_AT_call_all_tail_calls), 1);
22592 call_site_count = -1;
22593 tail_call_site_count = -1;
22596 /* Mark used types after we have created DIEs for the functions scopes. */
22597 premark_used_types (DECL_STRUCT_FUNCTION (decl));
22600 /* Returns a hash value for X (which really is a die_struct). */
22602 hashval_t
22603 block_die_hasher::hash (die_struct *d)
22605 return (hashval_t) d->decl_id ^ htab_hash_pointer (d->die_parent);
22608 /* Return nonzero if decl_id and die_parent of die_struct X is the same
22609 as decl_id and die_parent of die_struct Y. */
22611 bool
22612 block_die_hasher::equal (die_struct *x, die_struct *y)
22614 return x->decl_id == y->decl_id && x->die_parent == y->die_parent;
22617 /* Return TRUE if DECL, which may have been previously generated as
22618 OLD_DIE, is a candidate for a DW_AT_specification. DECLARATION is
22619 true if decl (or its origin) is either an extern declaration or a
22620 class/namespace scoped declaration.
22622 The declare_in_namespace support causes us to get two DIEs for one
22623 variable, both of which are declarations. We want to avoid
22624 considering one to be a specification, so we must test for
22625 DECLARATION and DW_AT_declaration. */
22626 static inline bool
22627 decl_will_get_specification_p (dw_die_ref old_die, tree decl, bool declaration)
22629 return (old_die && TREE_STATIC (decl) && !declaration
22630 && get_AT_flag (old_die, DW_AT_declaration) == 1);
22633 /* Return true if DECL is a local static. */
22635 static inline bool
22636 local_function_static (tree decl)
22638 gcc_assert (VAR_P (decl));
22639 return TREE_STATIC (decl)
22640 && DECL_CONTEXT (decl)
22641 && TREE_CODE (DECL_CONTEXT (decl)) == FUNCTION_DECL;
22644 /* Generate a DIE to represent a declared data object.
22645 Either DECL or ORIGIN must be non-null. */
22647 static void
22648 gen_variable_die (tree decl, tree origin, dw_die_ref context_die)
22650 HOST_WIDE_INT off = 0;
22651 tree com_decl;
22652 tree decl_or_origin = decl ? decl : origin;
22653 tree ultimate_origin;
22654 dw_die_ref var_die;
22655 dw_die_ref old_die = decl ? lookup_decl_die (decl) : NULL;
22656 bool declaration = (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl_or_origin)
22657 || class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die));
22658 bool specialization_p = false;
22659 bool no_linkage_name = false;
22661 /* While C++ inline static data members have definitions inside of the
22662 class, force the first DIE to be a declaration, then let gen_member_die
22663 reparent it to the class context and call gen_variable_die again
22664 to create the outside of the class DIE for the definition. */
22665 if (!declaration
22666 && old_die == NULL
22667 && decl
22668 && DECL_CONTEXT (decl)
22669 && TYPE_P (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))
22670 && lang_hooks.decls.decl_dwarf_attribute (decl, DW_AT_inline) != -1)
22672 declaration = true;
22673 if (dwarf_version < 5)
22674 no_linkage_name = true;
22677 ultimate_origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl_or_origin);
22678 if (decl || ultimate_origin)
22679 origin = ultimate_origin;
22680 com_decl = fortran_common (decl_or_origin, &off);
22682 /* Symbol in common gets emitted as a child of the common block, in the form
22683 of a data member. */
22684 if (com_decl)
22686 dw_die_ref com_die;
22687 dw_loc_list_ref loc = NULL;
22688 die_node com_die_arg;
22690 var_die = lookup_decl_die (decl_or_origin);
22691 if (var_die)
22693 if (! early_dwarf && get_AT (var_die, DW_AT_location) == NULL)
22695 loc = loc_list_from_tree (com_decl, off ? 1 : 2, NULL);
22696 if (loc)
22698 if (off)
22700 /* Optimize the common case. */
22701 if (single_element_loc_list_p (loc)
22702 && loc->expr->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_addr
22703 && loc->expr->dw_loc_next == NULL
22704 && GET_CODE (loc->expr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr)
22705 == SYMBOL_REF)
22707 rtx x = loc->expr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr;
22708 loc->expr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr
22709 = plus_constant (GET_MODE (x), x , off);
22711 else
22712 loc_list_plus_const (loc, off);
22714 add_AT_location_description (var_die, DW_AT_location, loc);
22715 remove_AT (var_die, DW_AT_declaration);
22718 return;
22721 if (common_block_die_table == NULL)
22722 common_block_die_table = hash_table<block_die_hasher>::create_ggc (10);
22724 com_die_arg.decl_id = DECL_UID (com_decl);
22725 com_die_arg.die_parent = context_die;
22726 com_die = common_block_die_table->find (&com_die_arg);
22727 if (! early_dwarf)
22728 loc = loc_list_from_tree (com_decl, 2, NULL);
22729 if (com_die == NULL)
22731 const char *cnam
22732 = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (com_decl));
22733 die_node **slot;
22735 com_die = new_die (DW_TAG_common_block, context_die, decl);
22736 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (com_die, com_decl);
22737 if (loc)
22739 add_AT_location_description (com_die, DW_AT_location, loc);
22740 /* Avoid sharing the same loc descriptor between
22741 DW_TAG_common_block and DW_TAG_variable. */
22742 loc = loc_list_from_tree (com_decl, 2, NULL);
22744 else if (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl_or_origin))
22745 add_AT_flag (com_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
22746 if (want_pubnames ())
22747 add_pubname_string (cnam, com_die); /* ??? needed? */
22748 com_die->decl_id = DECL_UID (com_decl);
22749 slot = common_block_die_table->find_slot (com_die, INSERT);
22750 *slot = com_die;
22752 else if (get_AT (com_die, DW_AT_location) == NULL && loc)
22754 add_AT_location_description (com_die, DW_AT_location, loc);
22755 loc = loc_list_from_tree (com_decl, 2, NULL);
22756 remove_AT (com_die, DW_AT_declaration);
22758 var_die = new_die (DW_TAG_variable, com_die, decl);
22759 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (var_die, decl_or_origin);
22760 add_type_attribute (var_die, TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin),
22761 decl_quals (decl_or_origin), false,
22762 context_die);
22763 add_alignment_attribute (var_die, decl);
22764 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_external, 1);
22765 if (loc)
22767 if (off)
22769 /* Optimize the common case. */
22770 if (single_element_loc_list_p (loc)
22771 && loc->expr->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_addr
22772 && loc->expr->dw_loc_next == NULL
22773 && GET_CODE (loc->expr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr) == SYMBOL_REF)
22775 rtx x = loc->expr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr;
22776 loc->expr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr
22777 = plus_constant (GET_MODE (x), x, off);
22779 else
22780 loc_list_plus_const (loc, off);
22782 add_AT_location_description (var_die, DW_AT_location, loc);
22784 else if (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl_or_origin))
22785 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
22786 if (decl)
22787 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, var_die);
22788 return;
22791 if (old_die)
22793 if (declaration)
22795 /* A declaration that has been previously dumped, needs no
22796 further annotations, since it doesn't need location on
22797 the second pass. */
22798 return;
22800 else if (decl_will_get_specification_p (old_die, decl, declaration)
22801 && !get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_specification))
22803 /* Fall-thru so we can make a new variable die along with a
22804 DW_AT_specification. */
22806 else if (origin && old_die->die_parent != context_die)
22808 /* If we will be creating an inlined instance, we need a
22809 new DIE that will get annotated with
22810 DW_AT_abstract_origin. Clear things so we can get a
22811 new DIE. */
22812 gcc_assert (!DECL_ABSTRACT_P (decl));
22813 old_die = NULL;
22815 else
22817 /* If a DIE was dumped early, it still needs location info.
22818 Skip to where we fill the location bits. */
22819 var_die = old_die;
22821 /* ??? In LTRANS we cannot annotate early created variably
22822 modified type DIEs without copying them and adjusting all
22823 references to them. Thus we dumped them again, also add a
22824 reference to them. */
22825 tree type = TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin);
22826 if (in_lto_p
22827 && variably_modified_type_p
22828 (type, decl_function_context (decl_or_origin)))
22830 if (decl_by_reference_p (decl_or_origin))
22831 add_type_attribute (var_die, TREE_TYPE (type),
22832 TYPE_UNQUALIFIED, false, context_die);
22833 else
22834 add_type_attribute (var_die, type, decl_quals (decl_or_origin),
22835 false, context_die);
22838 goto gen_variable_die_location;
22842 /* For static data members, the declaration in the class is supposed
22843 to have DW_TAG_member tag in DWARF{3,4} and we emit it for compatibility
22844 also in DWARF2; the specification should still be DW_TAG_variable
22845 referencing the DW_TAG_member DIE. */
22846 if (declaration && class_scope_p (context_die) && dwarf_version < 5)
22847 var_die = new_die (DW_TAG_member, context_die, decl);
22848 else
22849 var_die = new_die (DW_TAG_variable, context_die, decl);
22851 if (origin != NULL)
22852 add_abstract_origin_attribute (var_die, origin);
22854 /* Loop unrolling can create multiple blocks that refer to the same
22855 static variable, so we must test for the DW_AT_declaration flag.
22857 ??? Loop unrolling/reorder_blocks should perhaps be rewritten to
22858 copy decls and set the DECL_ABSTRACT_P flag on them instead of
22859 sharing them.
22861 ??? Duplicated blocks have been rewritten to use .debug_ranges. */
22862 else if (decl_will_get_specification_p (old_die, decl, declaration))
22864 /* This is a definition of a C++ class level static. */
22865 add_AT_specification (var_die, old_die);
22866 specialization_p = true;
22867 if (DECL_NAME (decl))
22869 expanded_location s = expand_location (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl));
22870 struct dwarf_file_data * file_index = lookup_filename (s.file);
22872 if (get_AT_file (old_die, DW_AT_decl_file) != file_index)
22873 add_AT_file (var_die, DW_AT_decl_file, file_index);
22875 if (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_line) != (unsigned) s.line)
22876 add_AT_unsigned (var_die, DW_AT_decl_line, s.line);
22878 if (debug_column_info
22879 && s.column
22880 && (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_column)
22881 != (unsigned) s.column))
22882 add_AT_unsigned (var_die, DW_AT_decl_column, s.column);
22884 if (old_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_member)
22885 add_linkage_name (var_die, decl);
22888 else
22889 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (var_die, decl, no_linkage_name);
22891 if ((origin == NULL && !specialization_p)
22892 || (origin != NULL
22893 && !DECL_ABSTRACT_P (decl_or_origin)
22894 && variably_modified_type_p (TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin),
22895 decl_function_context
22896 (decl_or_origin))))
22898 tree type = TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin);
22900 if (decl_by_reference_p (decl_or_origin))
22901 add_type_attribute (var_die, TREE_TYPE (type), TYPE_UNQUALIFIED, false,
22902 context_die);
22903 else
22904 add_type_attribute (var_die, type, decl_quals (decl_or_origin), false,
22905 context_die);
22908 if (origin == NULL && !specialization_p)
22910 if (TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
22911 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_external, 1);
22913 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
22914 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
22916 add_alignment_attribute (var_die, decl);
22918 add_accessibility_attribute (var_die, decl);
22921 if (declaration)
22922 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
22924 if (decl && (DECL_ABSTRACT_P (decl)
22925 || !old_die || is_declaration_die (old_die)))
22926 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, var_die);
22928 gen_variable_die_location:
22929 if (! declaration
22930 && (! DECL_ABSTRACT_P (decl_or_origin)
22931 /* Local static vars are shared between all clones/inlines,
22932 so emit DW_AT_location on the abstract DIE if DECL_RTL is
22933 already set. */
22934 || (VAR_P (decl_or_origin)
22935 && TREE_STATIC (decl_or_origin)
22936 && DECL_RTL_SET_P (decl_or_origin))))
22938 if (early_dwarf)
22939 add_pubname (decl_or_origin, var_die);
22940 else
22941 add_location_or_const_value_attribute (var_die, decl_or_origin,
22942 decl == NULL);
22944 else
22945 tree_add_const_value_attribute_for_decl (var_die, decl_or_origin);
22947 if ((dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict)
22948 && lang_hooks.decls.decl_dwarf_attribute (decl_or_origin,
22949 DW_AT_const_expr) == 1
22950 && !get_AT (var_die, DW_AT_const_expr)
22951 && !specialization_p)
22952 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_const_expr, 1);
22954 if (!dwarf_strict)
22956 int inl = lang_hooks.decls.decl_dwarf_attribute (decl_or_origin,
22957 DW_AT_inline);
22958 if (inl != -1
22959 && !get_AT (var_die, DW_AT_inline)
22960 && !specialization_p)
22961 add_AT_unsigned (var_die, DW_AT_inline, inl);
22965 /* Generate a DIE to represent a named constant. */
22967 static void
22968 gen_const_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
22970 dw_die_ref const_die;
22971 tree type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
22973 const_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
22974 if (const_die)
22975 return;
22977 const_die = new_die (DW_TAG_constant, context_die, decl);
22978 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, const_die);
22979 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (const_die, decl);
22980 add_type_attribute (const_die, type, TYPE_QUAL_CONST, false, context_die);
22981 if (TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
22982 add_AT_flag (const_die, DW_AT_external, 1);
22983 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
22984 add_AT_flag (const_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
22985 tree_add_const_value_attribute_for_decl (const_die, decl);
22988 /* Generate a DIE to represent a label identifier. */
22990 static void
22991 gen_label_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
22993 tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
22994 dw_die_ref lbl_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
22995 rtx insn;
22996 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
22998 if (!lbl_die)
23000 lbl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_label, context_die, decl);
23001 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, lbl_die);
23003 if (origin != NULL)
23004 add_abstract_origin_attribute (lbl_die, origin);
23005 else
23006 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (lbl_die, decl);
23009 if (DECL_ABSTRACT_P (decl))
23010 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, lbl_die);
23011 else if (! early_dwarf)
23013 insn = DECL_RTL_IF_SET (decl);
23015 /* Deleted labels are programmer specified labels which have been
23016 eliminated because of various optimizations. We still emit them
23017 here so that it is possible to put breakpoints on them. */
23018 if (insn
23019 && (LABEL_P (insn)
23020 || ((NOTE_P (insn)
23021 && NOTE_KIND (insn) == NOTE_INSN_DELETED_LABEL))))
23023 /* When optimization is enabled (via -O) some parts of the compiler
23024 (e.g. jump.c and cse.c) may try to delete CODE_LABEL insns which
23025 represent source-level labels which were explicitly declared by
23026 the user. This really shouldn't be happening though, so catch
23027 it if it ever does happen. */
23028 gcc_assert (!as_a<rtx_insn *> (insn)->deleted ());
23030 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "L", CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (insn));
23031 add_AT_lbl_id (lbl_die, DW_AT_low_pc, label);
23033 else if (insn
23034 && NOTE_P (insn)
23035 && NOTE_KIND (insn) == NOTE_INSN_DELETED_DEBUG_LABEL
23036 && CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (insn) != -1)
23038 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "LDL", CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (insn));
23039 add_AT_lbl_id (lbl_die, DW_AT_low_pc, label);
23044 /* A helper function for gen_inlined_subroutine_die. Add source coordinate
23045 attributes to the DIE for a block STMT, to describe where the inlined
23046 function was called from. This is similar to add_src_coords_attributes. */
23048 static inline void
23049 add_call_src_coords_attributes (tree stmt, dw_die_ref die)
23051 expanded_location s = expand_location (BLOCK_SOURCE_LOCATION (stmt));
23053 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
23055 add_AT_file (die, DW_AT_call_file, lookup_filename (s.file));
23056 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_call_line, s.line);
23057 if (debug_column_info && s.column)
23058 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_call_column, s.column);
23063 /* A helper function for gen_lexical_block_die and gen_inlined_subroutine_die.
23064 Add low_pc and high_pc attributes to the DIE for a block STMT. */
23066 static inline void
23067 add_high_low_attributes (tree stmt, dw_die_ref die)
23069 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
23071 if (BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (stmt)
23072 && (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict))
23074 tree chain, superblock = NULL_TREE;
23075 dw_die_ref pdie;
23076 dw_attr_node *attr = NULL;
23078 if (inlined_function_outer_scope_p (stmt))
23080 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL,
23081 BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt));
23082 add_AT_lbl_id (die, DW_AT_entry_pc, label);
23085 /* Optimize duplicate .debug_ranges lists or even tails of
23086 lists. If this BLOCK has same ranges as its supercontext,
23087 lookup DW_AT_ranges attribute in the supercontext (and
23088 recursively so), verify that the ranges_table contains the
23089 right values and use it instead of adding a new .debug_range. */
23090 for (chain = stmt, pdie = die;
23091 BLOCK_SAME_RANGE (chain);
23092 chain = BLOCK_SUPERCONTEXT (chain))
23094 dw_attr_node *new_attr;
23096 pdie = pdie->die_parent;
23097 if (pdie == NULL)
23098 break;
23099 if (BLOCK_SUPERCONTEXT (chain) == NULL_TREE)
23100 break;
23101 new_attr = get_AT (pdie, DW_AT_ranges);
23102 if (new_attr == NULL
23103 || new_attr->dw_attr_val.val_class != dw_val_class_range_list)
23104 break;
23105 attr = new_attr;
23106 superblock = BLOCK_SUPERCONTEXT (chain);
23108 if (attr != NULL
23109 && ((*ranges_table)[attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset].num
23110 == BLOCK_NUMBER (superblock))
23111 && BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (superblock))
23113 unsigned long off = attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset;
23114 unsigned long supercnt = 0, thiscnt = 0;
23115 for (chain = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (superblock);
23116 chain; chain = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (chain))
23118 ++supercnt;
23119 gcc_checking_assert ((*ranges_table)[off + supercnt].num
23120 == BLOCK_NUMBER (chain));
23122 gcc_checking_assert ((*ranges_table)[off + supercnt + 1].num == 0);
23123 for (chain = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (stmt);
23124 chain; chain = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (chain))
23125 ++thiscnt;
23126 gcc_assert (supercnt >= thiscnt);
23127 add_AT_range_list (die, DW_AT_ranges, off + supercnt - thiscnt,
23128 false);
23129 note_rnglist_head (off + supercnt - thiscnt);
23130 return;
23133 unsigned int offset = add_ranges (stmt, true);
23134 add_AT_range_list (die, DW_AT_ranges, offset, false);
23135 note_rnglist_head (offset);
23137 bool prev_in_cold = BLOCK_IN_COLD_SECTION_P (stmt);
23138 chain = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (stmt);
23141 add_ranges (chain, prev_in_cold != BLOCK_IN_COLD_SECTION_P (chain));
23142 prev_in_cold = BLOCK_IN_COLD_SECTION_P (chain);
23143 chain = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (chain);
23145 while (chain);
23146 add_ranges (NULL);
23148 else
23150 char label_high[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
23151 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL,
23152 BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt));
23153 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label_high, BLOCK_END_LABEL,
23154 BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt));
23155 add_AT_low_high_pc (die, label, label_high, false);
23159 /* Generate a DIE for a lexical block. */
23161 static void
23162 gen_lexical_block_die (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die)
23164 dw_die_ref old_die = BLOCK_DIE (stmt);
23165 dw_die_ref stmt_die = NULL;
23166 if (!old_die)
23168 stmt_die = new_die (DW_TAG_lexical_block, context_die, stmt);
23169 BLOCK_DIE (stmt) = stmt_die;
23172 if (BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt))
23174 if (old_die)
23176 /* This must have been generated early and it won't even
23177 need location information since it's a DW_AT_inline
23178 function. */
23179 if (flag_checking)
23180 for (dw_die_ref c = context_die; c; c = c->die_parent)
23181 if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine
23182 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram)
23184 gcc_assert (get_AT (c, DW_AT_inline));
23185 break;
23187 return;
23190 else if (BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (stmt))
23192 /* If this is an inlined instance, create a new lexical die for
23193 anything below to attach DW_AT_abstract_origin to. */
23194 if (old_die)
23196 stmt_die = new_die (DW_TAG_lexical_block, context_die, stmt);
23197 BLOCK_DIE (stmt) = stmt_die;
23198 old_die = NULL;
23201 tree origin = block_ultimate_origin (stmt);
23202 if (origin != NULL_TREE && origin != stmt)
23203 add_abstract_origin_attribute (stmt_die, origin);
23206 if (old_die)
23207 stmt_die = old_die;
23209 /* A non abstract block whose blocks have already been reordered
23210 should have the instruction range for this block. If so, set the
23211 high/low attributes. */
23212 if (!early_dwarf && !BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt) && TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (stmt))
23214 gcc_assert (stmt_die);
23215 add_high_low_attributes (stmt, stmt_die);
23218 decls_for_scope (stmt, stmt_die);
23221 /* Generate a DIE for an inlined subprogram. */
23223 static void
23224 gen_inlined_subroutine_die (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die)
23226 tree decl;
23228 /* The instance of function that is effectively being inlined shall not
23229 be abstract. */
23230 gcc_assert (! BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt));
23232 decl = block_ultimate_origin (stmt);
23234 /* Make sure any inlined functions are known to be inlineable. */
23235 gcc_checking_assert (DECL_ABSTRACT_P (decl)
23236 || cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p (decl));
23238 if (! BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt))
23240 dw_die_ref subr_die
23241 = new_die (DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine, context_die, stmt);
23243 if (call_arg_locations)
23244 BLOCK_DIE (stmt) = subr_die;
23245 add_abstract_origin_attribute (subr_die, decl);
23246 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (stmt))
23247 add_high_low_attributes (stmt, subr_die);
23248 add_call_src_coords_attributes (stmt, subr_die);
23250 decls_for_scope (stmt, subr_die);
23254 /* Generate a DIE for a field in a record, or structure. CTX is required: see
23255 the comment for VLR_CONTEXT. */
23257 static void
23258 gen_field_die (tree decl, struct vlr_context *ctx, dw_die_ref context_die)
23260 dw_die_ref decl_die;
23262 if (TREE_TYPE (decl) == error_mark_node)
23263 return;
23265 decl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_member, context_die, decl);
23266 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (decl_die, decl);
23267 add_type_attribute (decl_die, member_declared_type (decl), decl_quals (decl),
23268 TYPE_REVERSE_STORAGE_ORDER (DECL_FIELD_CONTEXT (decl)),
23269 context_die);
23271 if (DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl))
23273 add_byte_size_attribute (decl_die, decl);
23274 add_bit_size_attribute (decl_die, decl);
23275 add_bit_offset_attribute (decl_die, decl, ctx);
23278 add_alignment_attribute (decl_die, decl);
23280 /* If we have a variant part offset, then we are supposed to process a member
23281 of a QUAL_UNION_TYPE, which is how we represent variant parts in
23282 trees. */
23283 gcc_assert (ctx->variant_part_offset == NULL_TREE
23284 || TREE_CODE (DECL_FIELD_CONTEXT (decl)) != QUAL_UNION_TYPE);
23285 if (TREE_CODE (DECL_FIELD_CONTEXT (decl)) != UNION_TYPE)
23286 add_data_member_location_attribute (decl_die, decl, ctx);
23288 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
23289 add_AT_flag (decl_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
23291 add_accessibility_attribute (decl_die, decl);
23293 /* Equate decl number to die, so that we can look up this decl later on. */
23294 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, decl_die);
23297 /* Generate a DIE for a pointer to a member type. TYPE can be an
23298 OFFSET_TYPE, for a pointer to data member, or a RECORD_TYPE, for a
23299 pointer to member function. */
23301 static void
23302 gen_ptr_to_mbr_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
23304 if (lookup_type_die (type))
23305 return;
23307 dw_die_ref ptr_die = new_die (DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type,
23308 scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
23310 equate_type_number_to_die (type, ptr_die);
23311 add_AT_die_ref (ptr_die, DW_AT_containing_type,
23312 lookup_type_die (TYPE_OFFSET_BASETYPE (type)));
23313 add_type_attribute (ptr_die, TREE_TYPE (type), TYPE_UNQUALIFIED, false,
23314 context_die);
23315 add_alignment_attribute (ptr_die, type);
23317 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (type)) != FUNCTION_TYPE
23318 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (type)) != METHOD_TYPE)
23320 dw_loc_descr_ref op = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0);
23321 add_AT_loc (ptr_die, DW_AT_use_location, op);
23325 static char *producer_string;
23327 /* Return a heap allocated producer string including command line options
23328 if -grecord-gcc-switches. */
23330 static char *
23331 gen_producer_string (void)
23333 size_t j;
23334 auto_vec<const char *> switches;
23335 const char *language_string = lang_hooks.name;
23336 char *producer, *tail;
23337 const char *p;
23338 size_t len = dwarf_record_gcc_switches ? 0 : 3;
23339 size_t plen = strlen (language_string) + 1 + strlen (version_string);
23341 for (j = 1; dwarf_record_gcc_switches && j < save_decoded_options_count; j++)
23342 switch (save_decoded_options[j].opt_index)
23344 case OPT_o:
23345 case OPT_d:
23346 case OPT_dumpbase:
23347 case OPT_dumpdir:
23348 case OPT_auxbase:
23349 case OPT_auxbase_strip:
23350 case OPT_quiet:
23351 case OPT_version:
23352 case OPT_v:
23353 case OPT_w:
23354 case OPT_L:
23355 case OPT_D:
23356 case OPT_I:
23357 case OPT_U:
23358 case OPT_SPECIAL_unknown:
23359 case OPT_SPECIAL_ignore:
23360 case OPT_SPECIAL_program_name:
23361 case OPT_SPECIAL_input_file:
23362 case OPT_grecord_gcc_switches:
23363 case OPT__output_pch_:
23364 case OPT_fdiagnostics_show_location_:
23365 case OPT_fdiagnostics_show_option:
23366 case OPT_fdiagnostics_show_caret:
23367 case OPT_fdiagnostics_color_:
23368 case OPT_fverbose_asm:
23369 case OPT____:
23370 case OPT__sysroot_:
23371 case OPT_nostdinc:
23372 case OPT_nostdinc__:
23373 case OPT_fpreprocessed:
23374 case OPT_fltrans_output_list_:
23375 case OPT_fresolution_:
23376 case OPT_fdebug_prefix_map_:
23377 /* Ignore these. */
23378 continue;
23379 default:
23380 if (cl_options[save_decoded_options[j].opt_index].flags
23381 & CL_NO_DWARF_RECORD)
23382 continue;
23383 gcc_checking_assert (save_decoded_options[j].canonical_option[0][0]
23384 == '-');
23385 switch (save_decoded_options[j].canonical_option[0][1])
23387 case 'M':
23388 case 'i':
23389 case 'W':
23390 continue;
23391 case 'f':
23392 if (strncmp (save_decoded_options[j].canonical_option[0] + 2,
23393 "dump", 4) == 0)
23394 continue;
23395 break;
23396 default:
23397 break;
23399 switches.safe_push (save_decoded_options[j].orig_option_with_args_text);
23400 len += strlen (save_decoded_options[j].orig_option_with_args_text) + 1;
23401 break;
23404 producer = XNEWVEC (char, plen + 1 + len + 1);
23405 tail = producer;
23406 sprintf (tail, "%s %s", language_string, version_string);
23407 tail += plen;
23409 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (switches, j, p)
23411 len = strlen (p);
23412 *tail = ' ';
23413 memcpy (tail + 1, p, len);
23414 tail += len + 1;
23417 *tail = '\0';
23418 return producer;
23421 /* Given a C and/or C++ language/version string return the "highest".
23422 C++ is assumed to be "higher" than C in this case. Used for merging
23423 LTO translation unit languages. */
23424 static const char *
23425 highest_c_language (const char *lang1, const char *lang2)
23427 if (strcmp ("GNU C++17", lang1) == 0 || strcmp ("GNU C++17", lang2) == 0)
23428 return "GNU C++17";
23429 if (strcmp ("GNU C++14", lang1) == 0 || strcmp ("GNU C++14", lang2) == 0)
23430 return "GNU C++14";
23431 if (strcmp ("GNU C++11", lang1) == 0 || strcmp ("GNU C++11", lang2) == 0)
23432 return "GNU C++11";
23433 if (strcmp ("GNU C++98", lang1) == 0 || strcmp ("GNU C++98", lang2) == 0)
23434 return "GNU C++98";
23436 if (strcmp ("GNU C11", lang1) == 0 || strcmp ("GNU C11", lang2) == 0)
23437 return "GNU C11";
23438 if (strcmp ("GNU C99", lang1) == 0 || strcmp ("GNU C99", lang2) == 0)
23439 return "GNU C99";
23440 if (strcmp ("GNU C89", lang1) == 0 || strcmp ("GNU C89", lang2) == 0)
23441 return "GNU C89";
23443 gcc_unreachable ();
23447 /* Generate the DIE for the compilation unit. */
23449 static dw_die_ref
23450 gen_compile_unit_die (const char *filename)
23452 dw_die_ref die;
23453 const char *language_string = lang_hooks.name;
23454 int language;
23456 die = new_die (DW_TAG_compile_unit, NULL, NULL);
23458 if (filename)
23460 add_name_attribute (die, filename);
23461 /* Don't add cwd for <built-in>. */
23462 if (filename[0] != '<')
23463 add_comp_dir_attribute (die);
23466 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_producer, producer_string ? producer_string : "");
23468 /* If our producer is LTO try to figure out a common language to use
23469 from the global list of translation units. */
23470 if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU GIMPLE") == 0)
23472 unsigned i;
23473 tree t;
23474 const char *common_lang = NULL;
23476 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (all_translation_units, i, t)
23478 if (!TRANSLATION_UNIT_LANGUAGE (t))
23479 continue;
23480 if (!common_lang)
23481 common_lang = TRANSLATION_UNIT_LANGUAGE (t);
23482 else if (strcmp (common_lang, TRANSLATION_UNIT_LANGUAGE (t)) == 0)
23484 else if (strncmp (common_lang, "GNU C", 5) == 0
23485 && strncmp (TRANSLATION_UNIT_LANGUAGE (t), "GNU C", 5) == 0)
23486 /* Mixing C and C++ is ok, use C++ in that case. */
23487 common_lang = highest_c_language (common_lang,
23488 TRANSLATION_UNIT_LANGUAGE (t));
23489 else
23491 /* Fall back to C. */
23492 common_lang = NULL;
23493 break;
23497 if (common_lang)
23498 language_string = common_lang;
23501 language = DW_LANG_C;
23502 if (strncmp (language_string, "GNU C", 5) == 0
23503 && ISDIGIT (language_string[5]))
23505 language = DW_LANG_C89;
23506 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
23508 if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU C89") != 0)
23509 language = DW_LANG_C99;
23511 if (dwarf_version >= 5 /* || !dwarf_strict */)
23512 if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU C11") == 0)
23513 language = DW_LANG_C11;
23516 else if (strncmp (language_string, "GNU C++", 7) == 0)
23518 language = DW_LANG_C_plus_plus;
23519 if (dwarf_version >= 5 /* || !dwarf_strict */)
23521 if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU C++11") == 0)
23522 language = DW_LANG_C_plus_plus_11;
23523 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU C++14") == 0)
23524 language = DW_LANG_C_plus_plus_14;
23525 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU C++17") == 0)
23526 /* For now. */
23527 language = DW_LANG_C_plus_plus_14;
23530 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU F77") == 0)
23531 language = DW_LANG_Fortran77;
23532 else if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
23534 if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Ada") == 0)
23535 language = DW_LANG_Ada95;
23536 else if (strncmp (language_string, "GNU Fortran", 11) == 0)
23538 language = DW_LANG_Fortran95;
23539 if (dwarf_version >= 5 /* || !dwarf_strict */)
23541 if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Fortran2003") == 0)
23542 language = DW_LANG_Fortran03;
23543 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Fortran2008") == 0)
23544 language = DW_LANG_Fortran08;
23547 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Objective-C") == 0)
23548 language = DW_LANG_ObjC;
23549 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Objective-C++") == 0)
23550 language = DW_LANG_ObjC_plus_plus;
23551 else if (dwarf_version >= 5 || !dwarf_strict)
23553 if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Go") == 0)
23554 language = DW_LANG_Go;
23557 /* Use a degraded Fortran setting in strict DWARF2 so is_fortran works. */
23558 else if (strncmp (language_string, "GNU Fortran", 11) == 0)
23559 language = DW_LANG_Fortran90;
23561 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_language, language);
23563 switch (language)
23565 case DW_LANG_Fortran77:
23566 case DW_LANG_Fortran90:
23567 case DW_LANG_Fortran95:
23568 case DW_LANG_Fortran03:
23569 case DW_LANG_Fortran08:
23570 /* Fortran has case insensitive identifiers and the front-end
23571 lowercases everything. */
23572 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_identifier_case, DW_ID_down_case);
23573 break;
23574 default:
23575 /* The default DW_ID_case_sensitive doesn't need to be specified. */
23576 break;
23578 return die;
23581 /* Generate the DIE for a base class. */
23583 static void
23584 gen_inheritance_die (tree binfo, tree access, tree type,
23585 dw_die_ref context_die)
23587 dw_die_ref die = new_die (DW_TAG_inheritance, context_die, binfo);
23588 struct vlr_context ctx = { type, NULL };
23590 add_type_attribute (die, BINFO_TYPE (binfo), TYPE_UNQUALIFIED, false,
23591 context_die);
23592 add_data_member_location_attribute (die, binfo, &ctx);
23594 if (BINFO_VIRTUAL_P (binfo))
23595 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_virtuality, DW_VIRTUALITY_virtual);
23597 /* In DWARF3+ the default is DW_ACCESS_private only in DW_TAG_class_type
23598 children, otherwise the default is DW_ACCESS_public. In DWARF2
23599 the default has always been DW_ACCESS_private. */
23600 if (access == access_public_node)
23602 if (dwarf_version == 2
23603 || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_class_type)
23604 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_public);
23606 else if (access == access_protected_node)
23607 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_protected);
23608 else if (dwarf_version > 2
23609 && context_die->die_tag != DW_TAG_class_type)
23610 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_private);
23613 /* Return whether DECL is a FIELD_DECL that represents the variant part of a
23614 structure. */
23615 static bool
23616 is_variant_part (tree decl)
23618 return (TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL
23619 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == QUAL_UNION_TYPE);
23622 /* Check that OPERAND is a reference to a field in STRUCT_TYPE. If it is,
23623 return the FIELD_DECL. Return NULL_TREE otherwise. */
23625 static tree
23626 analyze_discr_in_predicate (tree operand, tree struct_type)
23628 bool continue_stripping = true;
23629 while (continue_stripping)
23630 switch (TREE_CODE (operand))
23632 CASE_CONVERT:
23633 operand = TREE_OPERAND (operand, 0);
23634 break;
23635 default:
23636 continue_stripping = false;
23637 break;
23640 /* Match field access to members of struct_type only. */
23641 if (TREE_CODE (operand) == COMPONENT_REF
23642 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (operand, 0)) == PLACEHOLDER_EXPR
23643 && TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (operand, 0)) == struct_type
23644 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (operand, 1)) == FIELD_DECL)
23645 return TREE_OPERAND (operand, 1);
23646 else
23647 return NULL_TREE;
23650 /* Check that SRC is a constant integer that can be represented as a native
23651 integer constant (either signed or unsigned). If so, store it into DEST and
23652 return true. Return false otherwise. */
23654 static bool
23655 get_discr_value (tree src, dw_discr_value *dest)
23657 tree discr_type = TREE_TYPE (src);
23659 if (lang_hooks.types.get_debug_type)
23661 tree debug_type = lang_hooks.types.get_debug_type (discr_type);
23662 if (debug_type != NULL)
23663 discr_type = debug_type;
23666 if (TREE_CODE (src) != INTEGER_CST || !INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (discr_type))
23667 return false;
23669 /* Signedness can vary between the original type and the debug type. This
23670 can happen for character types in Ada for instance: the character type
23671 used for code generation can be signed, to be compatible with the C one,
23672 but from a debugger point of view, it must be unsigned. */
23673 bool is_orig_unsigned = TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (src));
23674 bool is_debug_unsigned = TYPE_UNSIGNED (discr_type);
23676 if (is_orig_unsigned != is_debug_unsigned)
23677 src = fold_convert (discr_type, src);
23679 if (!(is_debug_unsigned ? tree_fits_uhwi_p (src) : tree_fits_shwi_p (src)))
23680 return false;
23682 dest->pos = is_debug_unsigned;
23683 if (is_debug_unsigned)
23684 dest->v.uval = tree_to_uhwi (src);
23685 else
23686 dest->v.sval = tree_to_shwi (src);
23688 return true;
23691 /* Try to extract synthetic properties out of VARIANT_PART_DECL, which is a
23692 FIELD_DECL in STRUCT_TYPE that represents a variant part. If unsuccessful,
23693 store NULL_TREE in DISCR_DECL. Otherwise:
23695 - store the discriminant field in STRUCT_TYPE that controls the variant
23696 part to *DISCR_DECL
23698 - put in *DISCR_LISTS_P an array where for each variant, the item
23699 represents the corresponding matching list of discriminant values.
23701 - put in *DISCR_LISTS_LENGTH the number of variants, which is the size of
23702 the above array.
23704 Note that when the array is allocated (i.e. when the analysis is
23705 successful), it is up to the caller to free the array. */
23707 static void
23708 analyze_variants_discr (tree variant_part_decl,
23709 tree struct_type,
23710 tree *discr_decl,
23711 dw_discr_list_ref **discr_lists_p,
23712 unsigned *discr_lists_length)
23714 tree variant_part_type = TREE_TYPE (variant_part_decl);
23715 tree variant;
23716 dw_discr_list_ref *discr_lists;
23717 unsigned i;
23719 /* Compute how many variants there are in this variant part. */
23720 *discr_lists_length = 0;
23721 for (variant = TYPE_FIELDS (variant_part_type);
23722 variant != NULL_TREE;
23723 variant = DECL_CHAIN (variant))
23724 ++*discr_lists_length;
23726 *discr_decl = NULL_TREE;
23727 *discr_lists_p
23728 = (dw_discr_list_ref *) xcalloc (*discr_lists_length,
23729 sizeof (**discr_lists_p));
23730 discr_lists = *discr_lists_p;
23732 /* And then analyze all variants to extract discriminant information for all
23733 of them. This analysis is conservative: as soon as we detect something we
23734 do not support, abort everything and pretend we found nothing. */
23735 for (variant = TYPE_FIELDS (variant_part_type), i = 0;
23736 variant != NULL_TREE;
23737 variant = DECL_CHAIN (variant), ++i)
23739 tree match_expr = DECL_QUALIFIER (variant);
23741 /* Now, try to analyze the predicate and deduce a discriminant for
23742 it. */
23743 if (match_expr == boolean_true_node)
23744 /* Typically happens for the default variant: it matches all cases that
23745 previous variants rejected. Don't output any matching value for
23746 this one. */
23747 continue;
23749 /* The following loop tries to iterate over each discriminant
23750 possibility: single values or ranges. */
23751 while (match_expr != NULL_TREE)
23753 tree next_round_match_expr;
23754 tree candidate_discr = NULL_TREE;
23755 dw_discr_list_ref new_node = NULL;
23757 /* Possibilities are matched one after the other by nested
23758 TRUTH_ORIF_EXPR expressions. Process the current possibility and
23759 continue with the rest at next iteration. */
23760 if (TREE_CODE (match_expr) == TRUTH_ORIF_EXPR)
23762 next_round_match_expr = TREE_OPERAND (match_expr, 0);
23763 match_expr = TREE_OPERAND (match_expr, 1);
23765 else
23766 next_round_match_expr = NULL_TREE;
23768 if (match_expr == boolean_false_node)
23769 /* This sub-expression matches nothing: just wait for the next
23770 one. */
23773 else if (TREE_CODE (match_expr) == EQ_EXPR)
23775 /* We are matching: <discr_field> == <integer_cst>
23776 This sub-expression matches a single value. */
23777 tree integer_cst = TREE_OPERAND (match_expr, 1);
23779 candidate_discr
23780 = analyze_discr_in_predicate (TREE_OPERAND (match_expr, 0),
23781 struct_type);
23783 new_node = ggc_cleared_alloc<dw_discr_list_node> ();
23784 if (!get_discr_value (integer_cst,
23785 &new_node->dw_discr_lower_bound))
23786 goto abort;
23787 new_node->dw_discr_range = false;
23790 else if (TREE_CODE (match_expr) == TRUTH_ANDIF_EXPR)
23792 /* We are matching:
23793 <discr_field> > <integer_cst>
23794 && <discr_field> < <integer_cst>.
23795 This sub-expression matches the range of values between the
23796 two matched integer constants. Note that comparisons can be
23797 inclusive or exclusive. */
23798 tree candidate_discr_1, candidate_discr_2;
23799 tree lower_cst, upper_cst;
23800 bool lower_cst_included, upper_cst_included;
23801 tree lower_op = TREE_OPERAND (match_expr, 0);
23802 tree upper_op = TREE_OPERAND (match_expr, 1);
23804 /* When the comparison is exclusive, the integer constant is not
23805 the discriminant range bound we are looking for: we will have
23806 to increment or decrement it. */
23807 if (TREE_CODE (lower_op) == GE_EXPR)
23808 lower_cst_included = true;
23809 else if (TREE_CODE (lower_op) == GT_EXPR)
23810 lower_cst_included = false;
23811 else
23812 goto abort;
23814 if (TREE_CODE (upper_op) == LE_EXPR)
23815 upper_cst_included = true;
23816 else if (TREE_CODE (upper_op) == LT_EXPR)
23817 upper_cst_included = false;
23818 else
23819 goto abort;
23821 /* Extract the discriminant from the first operand and check it
23822 is consistant with the same analysis in the second
23823 operand. */
23824 candidate_discr_1
23825 = analyze_discr_in_predicate (TREE_OPERAND (lower_op, 0),
23826 struct_type);
23827 candidate_discr_2
23828 = analyze_discr_in_predicate (TREE_OPERAND (upper_op, 0),
23829 struct_type);
23830 if (candidate_discr_1 == candidate_discr_2)
23831 candidate_discr = candidate_discr_1;
23832 else
23833 goto abort;
23835 /* Extract bounds from both. */
23836 new_node = ggc_cleared_alloc<dw_discr_list_node> ();
23837 lower_cst = TREE_OPERAND (lower_op, 1);
23838 upper_cst = TREE_OPERAND (upper_op, 1);
23840 if (!lower_cst_included)
23841 lower_cst
23842 = fold_build2 (PLUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (lower_cst), lower_cst,
23843 build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (lower_cst), 1));
23844 if (!upper_cst_included)
23845 upper_cst
23846 = fold_build2 (MINUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (upper_cst), upper_cst,
23847 build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (upper_cst), 1));
23849 if (!get_discr_value (lower_cst,
23850 &new_node->dw_discr_lower_bound)
23851 || !get_discr_value (upper_cst,
23852 &new_node->dw_discr_upper_bound))
23853 goto abort;
23855 new_node->dw_discr_range = true;
23858 else
23859 /* Unsupported sub-expression: we cannot determine the set of
23860 matching discriminant values. Abort everything. */
23861 goto abort;
23863 /* If the discriminant info is not consistant with what we saw so
23864 far, consider the analysis failed and abort everything. */
23865 if (candidate_discr == NULL_TREE
23866 || (*discr_decl != NULL_TREE && candidate_discr != *discr_decl))
23867 goto abort;
23868 else
23869 *discr_decl = candidate_discr;
23871 if (new_node != NULL)
23873 new_node->dw_discr_next = discr_lists[i];
23874 discr_lists[i] = new_node;
23876 match_expr = next_round_match_expr;
23880 /* If we reach this point, we could match everything we were interested
23881 in. */
23882 return;
23884 abort:
23885 /* Clean all data structure and return no result. */
23886 free (*discr_lists_p);
23887 *discr_lists_p = NULL;
23888 *discr_decl = NULL_TREE;
23891 /* Generate a DIE to represent VARIANT_PART_DECL, a variant part that is part
23892 of STRUCT_TYPE, a record type. This new DIE is emitted as the next child
23893 under CONTEXT_DIE.
23895 Variant parts are supposed to be implemented as a FIELD_DECL whose type is a
23896 QUAL_UNION_TYPE: this is the VARIANT_PART_DECL parameter. The members for
23897 this type, which are record types, represent the available variants and each
23898 has a DECL_QUALIFIER attribute. The discriminant and the discriminant
23899 values are inferred from these attributes.
23901 In trees, the offsets for the fields inside these sub-records are relative
23902 to the variant part itself, whereas the corresponding DIEs should have
23903 offset attributes that are relative to the embedding record base address.
23904 This is why the caller must provide a VARIANT_PART_OFFSET expression: it
23905 must be an expression that computes the offset of the variant part to
23906 describe in DWARF. */
23908 static void
23909 gen_variant_part (tree variant_part_decl, struct vlr_context *vlr_ctx,
23910 dw_die_ref context_die)
23912 const tree variant_part_type = TREE_TYPE (variant_part_decl);
23913 tree variant_part_offset = vlr_ctx->variant_part_offset;
23914 struct loc_descr_context ctx = {
23915 vlr_ctx->struct_type, /* context_type */
23916 NULL_TREE, /* base_decl */
23917 NULL, /* dpi */
23918 false, /* placeholder_arg */
23919 false /* placeholder_seen */
23922 /* The FIELD_DECL node in STRUCT_TYPE that acts as the discriminant, or
23923 NULL_TREE if there is no such field. */
23924 tree discr_decl = NULL_TREE;
23925 dw_discr_list_ref *discr_lists;
23926 unsigned discr_lists_length = 0;
23927 unsigned i;
23929 dw_die_ref dwarf_proc_die = NULL;
23930 dw_die_ref variant_part_die
23931 = new_die (DW_TAG_variant_part, context_die, variant_part_type);
23933 equate_decl_number_to_die (variant_part_decl, variant_part_die);
23935 analyze_variants_discr (variant_part_decl, vlr_ctx->struct_type,
23936 &discr_decl, &discr_lists, &discr_lists_length);
23938 if (discr_decl != NULL_TREE)
23940 dw_die_ref discr_die = lookup_decl_die (discr_decl);
23942 if (discr_die)
23943 add_AT_die_ref (variant_part_die, DW_AT_discr, discr_die);
23944 else
23945 /* We have no DIE for the discriminant, so just discard all
23946 discrimimant information in the output. */
23947 discr_decl = NULL_TREE;
23950 /* If the offset for this variant part is more complex than a constant,
23951 create a DWARF procedure for it so that we will not have to generate DWARF
23952 expressions for it for each member. */
23953 if (TREE_CODE (variant_part_offset) != INTEGER_CST
23954 && (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict))
23956 const tree dwarf_proc_fndecl
23957 = build_decl (UNKNOWN_LOCATION, FUNCTION_DECL, NULL_TREE,
23958 build_function_type (TREE_TYPE (variant_part_offset),
23959 NULL_TREE));
23960 const tree dwarf_proc_call = build_call_expr (dwarf_proc_fndecl, 0);
23961 const dw_loc_descr_ref dwarf_proc_body
23962 = loc_descriptor_from_tree (variant_part_offset, 0, &ctx);
23964 dwarf_proc_die = new_dwarf_proc_die (dwarf_proc_body,
23965 dwarf_proc_fndecl, context_die);
23966 if (dwarf_proc_die != NULL)
23967 variant_part_offset = dwarf_proc_call;
23970 /* Output DIEs for all variants. */
23971 i = 0;
23972 for (tree variant = TYPE_FIELDS (variant_part_type);
23973 variant != NULL_TREE;
23974 variant = DECL_CHAIN (variant), ++i)
23976 tree variant_type = TREE_TYPE (variant);
23977 dw_die_ref variant_die;
23979 /* All variants (i.e. members of a variant part) are supposed to be
23980 encoded as structures. Sub-variant parts are QUAL_UNION_TYPE fields
23981 under these records. */
23982 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (variant_type) == RECORD_TYPE);
23984 variant_die = new_die (DW_TAG_variant, variant_part_die, variant_type);
23985 equate_decl_number_to_die (variant, variant_die);
23987 /* Output discriminant values this variant matches, if any. */
23988 if (discr_decl == NULL || discr_lists[i] == NULL)
23989 /* In the case we have discriminant information at all, this is
23990 probably the default variant: as the standard says, don't
23991 output any discriminant value/list attribute. */
23993 else if (discr_lists[i]->dw_discr_next == NULL
23994 && !discr_lists[i]->dw_discr_range)
23995 /* If there is only one accepted value, don't bother outputting a
23996 list. */
23997 add_discr_value (variant_die, &discr_lists[i]->dw_discr_lower_bound);
23998 else
23999 add_discr_list (variant_die, discr_lists[i]);
24001 for (tree member = TYPE_FIELDS (variant_type);
24002 member != NULL_TREE;
24003 member = DECL_CHAIN (member))
24005 struct vlr_context vlr_sub_ctx = {
24006 vlr_ctx->struct_type, /* struct_type */
24007 NULL /* variant_part_offset */
24009 if (is_variant_part (member))
24011 /* All offsets for fields inside variant parts are relative to
24012 the top-level embedding RECORD_TYPE's base address. On the
24013 other hand, offsets in GCC's types are relative to the
24014 nested-most variant part. So we have to sum offsets each time
24015 we recurse. */
24017 vlr_sub_ctx.variant_part_offset
24018 = fold_build2 (PLUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (variant_part_offset),
24019 variant_part_offset, byte_position (member));
24020 gen_variant_part (member, &vlr_sub_ctx, variant_die);
24022 else
24024 vlr_sub_ctx.variant_part_offset = variant_part_offset;
24025 gen_decl_die (member, NULL, &vlr_sub_ctx, variant_die);
24030 free (discr_lists);
24033 /* Generate a DIE for a class member. */
24035 static void
24036 gen_member_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
24038 tree member;
24039 tree binfo = TYPE_BINFO (type);
24041 gcc_assert (TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type) == type);
24043 /* If this is not an incomplete type, output descriptions of each of its
24044 members. Note that as we output the DIEs necessary to represent the
24045 members of this record or union type, we will also be trying to output
24046 DIEs to represent the *types* of those members. However the `type'
24047 function (above) will specifically avoid generating type DIEs for member
24048 types *within* the list of member DIEs for this (containing) type except
24049 for those types (of members) which are explicitly marked as also being
24050 members of this (containing) type themselves. The g++ front- end can
24051 force any given type to be treated as a member of some other (containing)
24052 type by setting the TYPE_CONTEXT of the given (member) type to point to
24053 the TREE node representing the appropriate (containing) type. */
24055 /* First output info about the base classes. */
24056 if (binfo)
24058 vec<tree, va_gc> *accesses = BINFO_BASE_ACCESSES (binfo);
24059 int i;
24060 tree base;
24062 for (i = 0; BINFO_BASE_ITERATE (binfo, i, base); i++)
24063 gen_inheritance_die (base,
24064 (accesses ? (*accesses)[i] : access_public_node),
24065 type,
24066 context_die);
24069 /* Now output info about the data members and type members. */
24070 for (member = TYPE_FIELDS (type); member; member = DECL_CHAIN (member))
24072 struct vlr_context vlr_ctx = { type, NULL_TREE };
24073 bool static_inline_p
24074 = (TREE_STATIC (member)
24075 && (lang_hooks.decls.decl_dwarf_attribute (member, DW_AT_inline)
24076 != -1));
24078 /* Ignore clones. */
24079 if (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (member))
24080 continue;
24082 /* If we thought we were generating minimal debug info for TYPE
24083 and then changed our minds, some of the member declarations
24084 may have already been defined. Don't define them again, but
24085 do put them in the right order. */
24087 if (dw_die_ref child = lookup_decl_die (member))
24089 /* Handle inline static data members, which only have in-class
24090 declarations. */
24091 dw_die_ref ref = NULL;
24092 if (child->die_tag == DW_TAG_variable
24093 && child->die_parent == comp_unit_die ())
24095 ref = get_AT_ref (child, DW_AT_specification);
24096 /* For C++17 inline static data members followed by redundant
24097 out of class redeclaration, we might get here with
24098 child being the DIE created for the out of class
24099 redeclaration and with its DW_AT_specification being
24100 the DIE created for in-class definition. We want to
24101 reparent the latter, and don't want to create another
24102 DIE with DW_AT_specification in that case, because
24103 we already have one. */
24104 if (ref
24105 && static_inline_p
24106 && ref->die_tag == DW_TAG_variable
24107 && ref->die_parent == comp_unit_die ()
24108 && get_AT (ref, DW_AT_specification) == NULL)
24110 child = ref;
24111 ref = NULL;
24112 static_inline_p = false;
24116 if (child->die_tag == DW_TAG_variable
24117 && child->die_parent == comp_unit_die ()
24118 && ref == NULL)
24120 reparent_child (child, context_die);
24121 if (dwarf_version < 5)
24122 child->die_tag = DW_TAG_member;
24124 else
24125 splice_child_die (context_die, child);
24128 /* Do not generate standard DWARF for variant parts if we are generating
24129 the corresponding GNAT encodings: DIEs generated for both would
24130 conflict in our mappings. */
24131 else if (is_variant_part (member)
24132 && gnat_encodings == DWARF_GNAT_ENCODINGS_MINIMAL)
24134 vlr_ctx.variant_part_offset = byte_position (member);
24135 gen_variant_part (member, &vlr_ctx, context_die);
24137 else
24139 vlr_ctx.variant_part_offset = NULL_TREE;
24140 gen_decl_die (member, NULL, &vlr_ctx, context_die);
24143 /* For C++ inline static data members emit immediately a DW_TAG_variable
24144 DIE that will refer to that DW_TAG_member/DW_TAG_variable through
24145 DW_AT_specification. */
24146 if (static_inline_p)
24148 int old_extern = DECL_EXTERNAL (member);
24149 DECL_EXTERNAL (member) = 0;
24150 gen_decl_die (member, NULL, NULL, comp_unit_die ());
24151 DECL_EXTERNAL (member) = old_extern;
24156 /* Generate a DIE for a structure or union type. If TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG
24157 is set, we pretend that the type was never defined, so we only get the
24158 member DIEs needed by later specification DIEs. */
24160 static void
24161 gen_struct_or_union_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die,
24162 enum debug_info_usage usage)
24164 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
24166 /* Fill in the bound of variable-length fields in late dwarf if
24167 still incomplete. */
24168 if (!early_dwarf && variably_modified_type_p (type, NULL))
24169 for (tree member = TYPE_FIELDS (type);
24170 member;
24171 member = DECL_CHAIN (member))
24172 fill_variable_array_bounds (TREE_TYPE (member));
24173 return;
24176 dw_die_ref type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
24177 dw_die_ref scope_die = 0;
24178 int nested = 0;
24179 int complete = (TYPE_SIZE (type)
24180 && (! TYPE_STUB_DECL (type)
24181 || ! TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type))));
24182 int ns_decl = (context_die && context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_namespace);
24183 complete = complete && should_emit_struct_debug (type, usage);
24185 if (type_die && ! complete)
24186 return;
24188 if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type) != NULL_TREE
24189 && (AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (TYPE_CONTEXT (type))
24190 || TREE_CODE (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)) == NAMESPACE_DECL))
24191 nested = 1;
24193 scope_die = scope_die_for (type, context_die);
24195 /* Generate child dies for template paramaters. */
24196 if (!type_die && debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
24197 schedule_generic_params_dies_gen (type);
24199 if (! type_die || (nested && is_cu_die (scope_die)))
24200 /* First occurrence of type or toplevel definition of nested class. */
24202 dw_die_ref old_die = type_die;
24204 type_die = new_die (TREE_CODE (type) == RECORD_TYPE
24205 ? record_type_tag (type) : DW_TAG_union_type,
24206 scope_die, type);
24207 equate_type_number_to_die (type, type_die);
24208 if (old_die)
24209 add_AT_specification (type_die, old_die);
24210 else
24211 add_name_attribute (type_die, type_tag (type));
24213 else
24214 remove_AT (type_die, DW_AT_declaration);
24216 /* If this type has been completed, then give it a byte_size attribute and
24217 then give a list of members. */
24218 if (complete && !ns_decl)
24220 /* Prevent infinite recursion in cases where the type of some member of
24221 this type is expressed in terms of this type itself. */
24222 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
24223 add_byte_size_attribute (type_die, type);
24224 add_alignment_attribute (type_die, type);
24225 if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type) != NULL_TREE)
24227 add_src_coords_attributes (type_die, TYPE_STUB_DECL (type));
24228 add_accessibility_attribute (type_die, TYPE_STUB_DECL (type));
24231 /* If the first reference to this type was as the return type of an
24232 inline function, then it may not have a parent. Fix this now. */
24233 if (type_die->die_parent == NULL)
24234 add_child_die (scope_die, type_die);
24236 push_decl_scope (type);
24237 gen_member_die (type, type_die);
24238 pop_decl_scope ();
24240 add_gnat_descriptive_type_attribute (type_die, type, context_die);
24241 if (TYPE_ARTIFICIAL (type))
24242 add_AT_flag (type_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
24244 /* GNU extension: Record what type our vtable lives in. */
24245 if (TYPE_VFIELD (type))
24247 tree vtype = DECL_FCONTEXT (TYPE_VFIELD (type));
24249 gen_type_die (vtype, context_die);
24250 add_AT_die_ref (type_die, DW_AT_containing_type,
24251 lookup_type_die (vtype));
24254 else
24256 add_AT_flag (type_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
24258 /* We don't need to do this for function-local types. */
24259 if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type)
24260 && ! decl_function_context (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type)))
24261 vec_safe_push (incomplete_types, type);
24264 if (get_AT (type_die, DW_AT_name))
24265 add_pubtype (type, type_die);
24268 /* Generate a DIE for a subroutine _type_. */
24270 static void
24271 gen_subroutine_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
24273 tree return_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
24274 dw_die_ref subr_die
24275 = new_die (DW_TAG_subroutine_type,
24276 scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
24278 equate_type_number_to_die (type, subr_die);
24279 add_prototyped_attribute (subr_die, type);
24280 add_type_attribute (subr_die, return_type, TYPE_UNQUALIFIED, false,
24281 context_die);
24282 add_alignment_attribute (subr_die, type);
24283 gen_formal_types_die (type, subr_die);
24285 if (get_AT (subr_die, DW_AT_name))
24286 add_pubtype (type, subr_die);
24287 if ((dwarf_version >= 5 || !dwarf_strict)
24288 && lang_hooks.types.type_dwarf_attribute (type, DW_AT_reference) != -1)
24289 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_reference, 1);
24290 if ((dwarf_version >= 5 || !dwarf_strict)
24291 && lang_hooks.types.type_dwarf_attribute (type,
24292 DW_AT_rvalue_reference) != -1)
24293 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_rvalue_reference, 1);
24296 /* Generate a DIE for a type definition. */
24298 static void
24299 gen_typedef_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
24301 dw_die_ref type_die;
24302 tree type;
24304 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl))
24306 if (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (decl))
24307 fill_variable_array_bounds (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (decl));
24308 return;
24311 /* As we avoid creating DIEs for local typedefs (see decl_ultimate_origin
24312 checks in process_scope_var and modified_type_die), this should be called
24313 only for original types. */
24314 gcc_assert (decl_ultimate_origin (decl) == NULL
24315 || decl_ultimate_origin (decl) == decl);
24317 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl) = 1;
24318 type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_typedef, context_die, decl);
24320 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (type_die, decl);
24321 if (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (decl))
24323 type = DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (decl);
24324 if (type == error_mark_node)
24325 return;
24327 gcc_assert (type != TREE_TYPE (decl));
24328 equate_type_number_to_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), type_die);
24330 else
24332 type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
24333 if (type == error_mark_node)
24334 return;
24336 if (is_naming_typedef_decl (TYPE_NAME (type)))
24338 /* Here, we are in the case of decl being a typedef naming
24339 an anonymous type, e.g:
24340 typedef struct {...} foo;
24341 In that case TREE_TYPE (decl) is not a typedef variant
24342 type and TYPE_NAME of the anonymous type is set to the
24343 TYPE_DECL of the typedef. This construct is emitted by
24344 the C++ FE.
24346 TYPE is the anonymous struct named by the typedef
24347 DECL. As we need the DW_AT_type attribute of the
24348 DW_TAG_typedef to point to the DIE of TYPE, let's
24349 generate that DIE right away. add_type_attribute
24350 called below will then pick (via lookup_type_die) that
24351 anonymous struct DIE. */
24352 if (!TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
24353 gen_tagged_type_die (type, context_die, DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE);
24355 /* This is a GNU Extension. We are adding a
24356 DW_AT_linkage_name attribute to the DIE of the
24357 anonymous struct TYPE. The value of that attribute
24358 is the name of the typedef decl naming the anonymous
24359 struct. This greatly eases the work of consumers of
24360 this debug info. */
24361 add_linkage_name_raw (lookup_type_die (type), decl);
24365 add_type_attribute (type_die, type, decl_quals (decl), false,
24366 context_die);
24368 if (is_naming_typedef_decl (decl))
24369 /* We want that all subsequent calls to lookup_type_die with
24370 TYPE in argument yield the DW_TAG_typedef we have just
24371 created. */
24372 equate_type_number_to_die (type, type_die);
24374 add_alignment_attribute (type_die, TREE_TYPE (decl));
24376 add_accessibility_attribute (type_die, decl);
24378 if (DECL_ABSTRACT_P (decl))
24379 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, type_die);
24381 if (get_AT (type_die, DW_AT_name))
24382 add_pubtype (decl, type_die);
24385 /* Generate a DIE for a struct, class, enum or union type. */
24387 static void
24388 gen_tagged_type_die (tree type,
24389 dw_die_ref context_die,
24390 enum debug_info_usage usage)
24392 int need_pop;
24394 if (type == NULL_TREE
24395 || !is_tagged_type (type))
24396 return;
24398 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
24399 need_pop = 0;
24400 /* If this is a nested type whose containing class hasn't been written
24401 out yet, writing it out will cover this one, too. This does not apply
24402 to instantiations of member class templates; they need to be added to
24403 the containing class as they are generated. FIXME: This hurts the
24404 idea of combining type decls from multiple TUs, since we can't predict
24405 what set of template instantiations we'll get. */
24406 else if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)
24407 && AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (TYPE_CONTEXT (type))
24408 && ! TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)))
24410 gen_type_die_with_usage (TYPE_CONTEXT (type), context_die, usage);
24412 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
24413 return;
24415 /* If that failed, attach ourselves to the stub. */
24416 push_decl_scope (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
24417 context_die = lookup_type_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
24418 need_pop = 1;
24420 else if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type) != NULL_TREE
24421 && (TREE_CODE (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)) == FUNCTION_DECL))
24423 /* If this type is local to a function that hasn't been written
24424 out yet, use a NULL context for now; it will be fixed up in
24425 decls_for_scope. */
24426 context_die = lookup_decl_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
24427 /* A declaration DIE doesn't count; nested types need to go in the
24428 specification. */
24429 if (context_die && is_declaration_die (context_die))
24430 context_die = NULL;
24431 need_pop = 0;
24433 else
24435 context_die = declare_in_namespace (type, context_die);
24436 need_pop = 0;
24439 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ENUMERAL_TYPE)
24441 /* This might have been written out by the call to
24442 declare_in_namespace. */
24443 if (!TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
24444 gen_enumeration_type_die (type, context_die);
24446 else
24447 gen_struct_or_union_type_die (type, context_die, usage);
24449 if (need_pop)
24450 pop_decl_scope ();
24452 /* Don't set TREE_ASM_WRITTEN on an incomplete struct; we want to fix
24453 it up if it is ever completed. gen_*_type_die will set it for us
24454 when appropriate. */
24457 /* Generate a type description DIE. */
24459 static void
24460 gen_type_die_with_usage (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die,
24461 enum debug_info_usage usage)
24463 struct array_descr_info info;
24465 if (type == NULL_TREE || type == error_mark_node)
24466 return;
24468 if (flag_checking && type)
24469 verify_type (type);
24471 if (TYPE_NAME (type) != NULL_TREE
24472 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (type)) == TYPE_DECL
24473 && is_redundant_typedef (TYPE_NAME (type))
24474 && DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (TYPE_NAME (type)))
24475 /* The DECL of this type is a typedef we don't want to emit debug
24476 info for but we want debug info for its underlying typedef.
24477 This can happen for e.g, the injected-class-name of a C++
24478 type. */
24479 type = DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (TYPE_NAME (type));
24481 /* If TYPE is a typedef type variant, let's generate debug info
24482 for the parent typedef which TYPE is a type of. */
24483 if (typedef_variant_p (type))
24485 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
24486 return;
24488 tree name = TYPE_NAME (type);
24489 tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (name);
24490 if (origin != NULL && origin != name)
24492 gen_decl_die (origin, NULL, NULL, context_die);
24493 return;
24496 /* Prevent broken recursion; we can't hand off to the same type. */
24497 gcc_assert (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (name) != type);
24499 /* Give typedefs the right scope. */
24500 context_die = scope_die_for (type, context_die);
24502 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
24504 gen_decl_die (name, NULL, NULL, context_die);
24505 return;
24508 /* If type is an anonymous tagged type named by a typedef, let's
24509 generate debug info for the typedef. */
24510 if (is_naming_typedef_decl (TYPE_NAME (type)))
24512 /* Use the DIE of the containing namespace as the parent DIE of
24513 the type description DIE we want to generate. */
24514 if (DECL_CONTEXT (TYPE_NAME (type))
24515 && TREE_CODE (DECL_CONTEXT (TYPE_NAME (type))) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
24516 context_die = get_context_die (DECL_CONTEXT (TYPE_NAME (type)));
24518 gen_decl_die (TYPE_NAME (type), NULL, NULL, context_die);
24519 return;
24522 if (lang_hooks.types.get_debug_type)
24524 tree debug_type = lang_hooks.types.get_debug_type (type);
24526 if (debug_type != NULL_TREE && debug_type != type)
24528 gen_type_die_with_usage (debug_type, context_die, usage);
24529 return;
24533 /* We are going to output a DIE to represent the unqualified version
24534 of this type (i.e. without any const or volatile qualifiers) so
24535 get the main variant (i.e. the unqualified version) of this type
24536 now. (Vectors and arrays are special because the debugging info is in the
24537 cloned type itself. Similarly function/method types can contain extra
24538 ref-qualification). */
24539 if (TREE_CODE (type) == FUNCTION_TYPE
24540 || TREE_CODE (type) == METHOD_TYPE)
24542 /* For function/method types, can't use type_main_variant here,
24543 because that can have different ref-qualifiers for C++,
24544 but try to canonicalize. */
24545 tree main = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type);
24546 for (tree t = main; t; t = TYPE_NEXT_VARIANT (t))
24547 if (TYPE_QUALS_NO_ADDR_SPACE (t) == 0
24548 && check_base_type (t, main)
24549 && check_lang_type (t, type))
24551 type = t;
24552 break;
24555 else if (TREE_CODE (type) != VECTOR_TYPE
24556 && TREE_CODE (type) != ARRAY_TYPE)
24557 type = type_main_variant (type);
24559 /* If this is an array type with hidden descriptor, handle it first. */
24560 if (!TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type)
24561 && lang_hooks.types.get_array_descr_info)
24563 memset (&info, 0, sizeof (info));
24564 if (lang_hooks.types.get_array_descr_info (type, &info))
24566 /* Fortran sometimes emits array types with no dimension. */
24567 gcc_assert (info.ndimensions >= 0
24568 && (info.ndimensions
24569 <= DWARF2OUT_ARRAY_DESCR_INFO_MAX_DIMEN));
24570 gen_descr_array_type_die (type, &info, context_die);
24571 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
24572 return;
24576 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
24578 /* Variable-length types may be incomplete even if
24579 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN. For such types, fall through to
24580 gen_array_type_die() and possibly fill in
24581 DW_AT_{upper,lower}_bound attributes. */
24582 if ((TREE_CODE (type) != ARRAY_TYPE
24583 && TREE_CODE (type) != RECORD_TYPE
24584 && TREE_CODE (type) != UNION_TYPE
24585 && TREE_CODE (type) != QUAL_UNION_TYPE)
24586 || !variably_modified_type_p (type, NULL))
24587 return;
24590 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
24592 case ERROR_MARK:
24593 break;
24595 case POINTER_TYPE:
24596 case REFERENCE_TYPE:
24597 /* We must set TREE_ASM_WRITTEN in case this is a recursive type. This
24598 ensures that the gen_type_die recursion will terminate even if the
24599 type is recursive. Recursive types are possible in Ada. */
24600 /* ??? We could perhaps do this for all types before the switch
24601 statement. */
24602 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
24604 /* For these types, all that is required is that we output a DIE (or a
24605 set of DIEs) to represent the "basis" type. */
24606 gen_type_die_with_usage (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die,
24607 DINFO_USAGE_IND_USE);
24608 break;
24610 case OFFSET_TYPE:
24611 /* This code is used for C++ pointer-to-data-member types.
24612 Output a description of the relevant class type. */
24613 gen_type_die_with_usage (TYPE_OFFSET_BASETYPE (type), context_die,
24614 DINFO_USAGE_IND_USE);
24616 /* Output a description of the type of the object pointed to. */
24617 gen_type_die_with_usage (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die,
24618 DINFO_USAGE_IND_USE);
24620 /* Now output a DIE to represent this pointer-to-data-member type
24621 itself. */
24622 gen_ptr_to_mbr_type_die (type, context_die);
24623 break;
24625 case FUNCTION_TYPE:
24626 /* Force out return type (in case it wasn't forced out already). */
24627 gen_type_die_with_usage (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die,
24628 DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE);
24629 gen_subroutine_type_die (type, context_die);
24630 break;
24632 case METHOD_TYPE:
24633 /* Force out return type (in case it wasn't forced out already). */
24634 gen_type_die_with_usage (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die,
24635 DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE);
24636 gen_subroutine_type_die (type, context_die);
24637 break;
24639 case ARRAY_TYPE:
24640 case VECTOR_TYPE:
24641 gen_array_type_die (type, context_die);
24642 break;
24644 case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
24645 case RECORD_TYPE:
24646 case UNION_TYPE:
24647 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
24648 gen_tagged_type_die (type, context_die, usage);
24649 return;
24651 case VOID_TYPE:
24652 case INTEGER_TYPE:
24653 case REAL_TYPE:
24654 case FIXED_POINT_TYPE:
24655 case COMPLEX_TYPE:
24656 case BOOLEAN_TYPE:
24657 case POINTER_BOUNDS_TYPE:
24658 /* No DIEs needed for fundamental types. */
24659 break;
24661 case NULLPTR_TYPE:
24662 case LANG_TYPE:
24663 /* Just use DW_TAG_unspecified_type. */
24665 dw_die_ref type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
24666 if (type_die == NULL)
24668 tree name = TYPE_IDENTIFIER (type);
24669 type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_unspecified_type, comp_unit_die (),
24670 type);
24671 add_name_attribute (type_die, IDENTIFIER_POINTER (name));
24672 equate_type_number_to_die (type, type_die);
24675 break;
24677 default:
24678 if (is_cxx_auto (type))
24680 tree name = TYPE_IDENTIFIER (type);
24681 dw_die_ref *die = (name == get_identifier ("auto")
24682 ? &auto_die : &decltype_auto_die);
24683 if (!*die)
24685 *die = new_die (DW_TAG_unspecified_type,
24686 comp_unit_die (), NULL_TREE);
24687 add_name_attribute (*die, IDENTIFIER_POINTER (name));
24689 equate_type_number_to_die (type, *die);
24690 break;
24692 gcc_unreachable ();
24695 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
24698 static void
24699 gen_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
24701 if (type != error_mark_node)
24703 gen_type_die_with_usage (type, context_die, DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE);
24704 if (flag_checking)
24706 dw_die_ref die = lookup_type_die (type);
24707 if (die)
24708 check_die (die);
24713 /* Generate a DW_TAG_lexical_block DIE followed by DIEs to represent all of the
24714 things which are local to the given block. */
24716 static void
24717 gen_block_die (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die)
24719 int must_output_die = 0;
24720 bool inlined_func;
24722 /* Ignore blocks that are NULL. */
24723 if (stmt == NULL_TREE)
24724 return;
24726 inlined_func = inlined_function_outer_scope_p (stmt);
24728 /* If the block is one fragment of a non-contiguous block, do not
24729 process the variables, since they will have been done by the
24730 origin block. Do process subblocks. */
24731 if (BLOCK_FRAGMENT_ORIGIN (stmt))
24733 tree sub;
24735 for (sub = BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (stmt); sub; sub = BLOCK_CHAIN (sub))
24736 gen_block_die (sub, context_die);
24738 return;
24741 /* Determine if we need to output any Dwarf DIEs at all to represent this
24742 block. */
24743 if (inlined_func)
24744 /* The outer scopes for inlinings *must* always be represented. We
24745 generate DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine DIEs for them. (See below.) */
24746 must_output_die = 1;
24747 else
24749 /* Determine if this block directly contains any "significant"
24750 local declarations which we will need to output DIEs for. */
24751 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
24752 /* We are not in terse mode so *any* local declaration counts
24753 as being a "significant" one. */
24754 must_output_die = ((BLOCK_VARS (stmt) != NULL
24755 || BLOCK_NUM_NONLOCALIZED_VARS (stmt))
24756 && (TREE_USED (stmt)
24757 || TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (stmt)
24758 || BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt)));
24759 else if ((TREE_USED (stmt)
24760 || TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (stmt)
24761 || BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt))
24762 && !dwarf2out_ignore_block (stmt))
24763 must_output_die = 1;
24766 /* It would be a waste of space to generate a Dwarf DW_TAG_lexical_block
24767 DIE for any block which contains no significant local declarations at
24768 all. Rather, in such cases we just call `decls_for_scope' so that any
24769 needed Dwarf info for any sub-blocks will get properly generated. Note
24770 that in terse mode, our definition of what constitutes a "significant"
24771 local declaration gets restricted to include only inlined function
24772 instances and local (nested) function definitions. */
24773 if (must_output_die)
24775 if (inlined_func)
24777 /* If STMT block is abstract, that means we have been called
24778 indirectly from dwarf2out_abstract_function.
24779 That function rightfully marks the descendent blocks (of
24780 the abstract function it is dealing with) as being abstract,
24781 precisely to prevent us from emitting any
24782 DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine DIE as a descendent
24783 of an abstract function instance. So in that case, we should
24784 not call gen_inlined_subroutine_die.
24786 Later though, when cgraph asks dwarf2out to emit info
24787 for the concrete instance of the function decl into which
24788 the concrete instance of STMT got inlined, the later will lead
24789 to the generation of a DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine DIE. */
24790 if (! BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt))
24791 gen_inlined_subroutine_die (stmt, context_die);
24793 else
24794 gen_lexical_block_die (stmt, context_die);
24796 else
24797 decls_for_scope (stmt, context_die);
24800 /* Process variable DECL (or variable with origin ORIGIN) within
24801 block STMT and add it to CONTEXT_DIE. */
24802 static void
24803 process_scope_var (tree stmt, tree decl, tree origin, dw_die_ref context_die)
24805 dw_die_ref die;
24806 tree decl_or_origin = decl ? decl : origin;
24808 if (TREE_CODE (decl_or_origin) == FUNCTION_DECL)
24809 die = lookup_decl_die (decl_or_origin);
24810 else if (TREE_CODE (decl_or_origin) == TYPE_DECL)
24812 if (TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl_or_origin))
24813 die = lookup_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin));
24814 else
24815 die = lookup_decl_die (decl_or_origin);
24816 /* Avoid re-creating the DIE late if it was optimized as unused early. */
24817 if (! die && ! early_dwarf)
24818 return;
24820 else
24821 die = NULL;
24823 /* Avoid creating DIEs for local typedefs and concrete static variables that
24824 will only be pruned later. */
24825 if ((origin || decl_ultimate_origin (decl))
24826 && (TREE_CODE (decl_or_origin) == TYPE_DECL
24827 || (VAR_P (decl_or_origin) && TREE_STATIC (decl_or_origin))))
24829 origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl_or_origin);
24830 if (decl && VAR_P (decl) && die != NULL)
24832 die = lookup_decl_die (origin);
24833 if (die != NULL)
24834 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, die);
24836 return;
24839 if (die != NULL && die->die_parent == NULL)
24840 add_child_die (context_die, die);
24841 else if (TREE_CODE (decl_or_origin) == IMPORTED_DECL)
24843 if (early_dwarf)
24844 dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl_1 (decl_or_origin, DECL_NAME (decl_or_origin),
24845 stmt, context_die);
24847 else
24849 if (decl && DECL_P (decl))
24851 die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
24853 /* Early created DIEs do not have a parent as the decls refer
24854 to the function as DECL_CONTEXT rather than the BLOCK. */
24855 if (die && die->die_parent == NULL)
24857 gcc_assert (in_lto_p);
24858 add_child_die (context_die, die);
24862 gen_decl_die (decl, origin, NULL, context_die);
24866 /* Generate all of the decls declared within a given scope and (recursively)
24867 all of its sub-blocks. */
24869 static void
24870 decls_for_scope (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die)
24872 tree decl;
24873 unsigned int i;
24874 tree subblocks;
24876 /* Ignore NULL blocks. */
24877 if (stmt == NULL_TREE)
24878 return;
24880 /* Output the DIEs to represent all of the data objects and typedefs
24881 declared directly within this block but not within any nested
24882 sub-blocks. Also, nested function and tag DIEs have been
24883 generated with a parent of NULL; fix that up now. We don't
24884 have to do this if we're at -g1. */
24885 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
24887 for (decl = BLOCK_VARS (stmt); decl != NULL; decl = DECL_CHAIN (decl))
24888 process_scope_var (stmt, decl, NULL_TREE, context_die);
24889 /* BLOCK_NONLOCALIZED_VARs simply generate DIE stubs with abstract
24890 origin - avoid doing this twice as we have no good way to see
24891 if we've done it once already. */
24892 if (! early_dwarf)
24893 for (i = 0; i < BLOCK_NUM_NONLOCALIZED_VARS (stmt); i++)
24895 decl = BLOCK_NONLOCALIZED_VAR (stmt, i);
24896 if (decl == current_function_decl)
24897 /* Ignore declarations of the current function, while they
24898 are declarations, gen_subprogram_die would treat them
24899 as definitions again, because they are equal to
24900 current_function_decl and endlessly recurse. */;
24901 else if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL)
24902 process_scope_var (stmt, decl, NULL_TREE, context_die);
24903 else
24904 process_scope_var (stmt, NULL_TREE, decl, context_die);
24908 /* Even if we're at -g1, we need to process the subblocks in order to get
24909 inlined call information. */
24911 /* Output the DIEs to represent all sub-blocks (and the items declared
24912 therein) of this block. */
24913 for (subblocks = BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (stmt);
24914 subblocks != NULL;
24915 subblocks = BLOCK_CHAIN (subblocks))
24916 gen_block_die (subblocks, context_die);
24919 /* Is this a typedef we can avoid emitting? */
24921 bool
24922 is_redundant_typedef (const_tree decl)
24924 if (TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl))
24925 return true;
24927 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl)
24928 && DECL_CONTEXT (decl)
24929 && is_tagged_type (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))
24930 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))) == TYPE_DECL
24931 && DECL_NAME (decl) == DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))))
24932 /* Also ignore the artificial member typedef for the class name. */
24933 return true;
24935 return false;
24938 /* Return TRUE if TYPE is a typedef that names a type for linkage
24939 purposes. This kind of typedefs is produced by the C++ FE for
24940 constructs like:
24942 typedef struct {...} foo;
24944 In that case, there is no typedef variant type produced for foo.
24945 Rather, the TREE_TYPE of the TYPE_DECL of foo is the anonymous
24946 struct type. */
24948 static bool
24949 is_naming_typedef_decl (const_tree decl)
24951 if (decl == NULL_TREE
24952 || TREE_CODE (decl) != TYPE_DECL
24953 || DECL_NAMELESS (decl)
24954 || !is_tagged_type (TREE_TYPE (decl))
24955 || DECL_IS_BUILTIN (decl)
24956 || is_redundant_typedef (decl)
24957 /* It looks like Ada produces TYPE_DECLs that are very similar
24958 to C++ naming typedefs but that have different
24959 semantics. Let's be specific to c++ for now. */
24960 || !is_cxx (decl))
24961 return FALSE;
24963 return (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (decl) == NULL_TREE
24964 && TYPE_NAME (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == decl
24965 && (TYPE_STUB_DECL (TREE_TYPE (decl))
24966 != TYPE_NAME (TREE_TYPE (decl))));
24969 /* Looks up the DIE for a context. */
24971 static inline dw_die_ref
24972 lookup_context_die (tree context)
24974 if (context)
24976 /* Find die that represents this context. */
24977 if (TYPE_P (context))
24979 context = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (context);
24980 dw_die_ref ctx = lookup_type_die (context);
24981 if (!ctx)
24982 return NULL;
24983 return strip_naming_typedef (context, ctx);
24985 else
24986 return lookup_decl_die (context);
24988 return comp_unit_die ();
24991 /* Returns the DIE for a context. */
24993 static inline dw_die_ref
24994 get_context_die (tree context)
24996 if (context)
24998 /* Find die that represents this context. */
24999 if (TYPE_P (context))
25001 context = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (context);
25002 return strip_naming_typedef (context, force_type_die (context));
25004 else
25005 return force_decl_die (context);
25007 return comp_unit_die ();
25010 /* Returns the DIE for decl. A DIE will always be returned. */
25012 static dw_die_ref
25013 force_decl_die (tree decl)
25015 dw_die_ref decl_die;
25016 unsigned saved_external_flag;
25017 tree save_fn = NULL_TREE;
25018 decl_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
25019 if (!decl_die)
25021 dw_die_ref context_die = get_context_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl));
25023 decl_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
25024 if (decl_die)
25025 return decl_die;
25027 switch (TREE_CODE (decl))
25029 case FUNCTION_DECL:
25030 /* Clear current_function_decl, so that gen_subprogram_die thinks
25031 that this is a declaration. At this point, we just want to force
25032 declaration die. */
25033 save_fn = current_function_decl;
25034 current_function_decl = NULL_TREE;
25035 gen_subprogram_die (decl, context_die);
25036 current_function_decl = save_fn;
25037 break;
25039 case VAR_DECL:
25040 /* Set external flag to force declaration die. Restore it after
25041 gen_decl_die() call. */
25042 saved_external_flag = DECL_EXTERNAL (decl);
25043 DECL_EXTERNAL (decl) = 1;
25044 gen_decl_die (decl, NULL, NULL, context_die);
25045 DECL_EXTERNAL (decl) = saved_external_flag;
25046 break;
25048 case NAMESPACE_DECL:
25049 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
25050 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
25051 else
25052 /* DWARF2 has neither DW_TAG_module, nor DW_TAG_namespace. */
25053 decl_die = comp_unit_die ();
25054 break;
25056 case TRANSLATION_UNIT_DECL:
25057 decl_die = comp_unit_die ();
25058 break;
25060 default:
25061 gcc_unreachable ();
25064 /* We should be able to find the DIE now. */
25065 if (!decl_die)
25066 decl_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
25067 gcc_assert (decl_die);
25070 return decl_die;
25073 /* Returns the DIE for TYPE, that must not be a base type. A DIE is
25074 always returned. */
25076 static dw_die_ref
25077 force_type_die (tree type)
25079 dw_die_ref type_die;
25081 type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
25082 if (!type_die)
25084 dw_die_ref context_die = get_context_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
25086 type_die = modified_type_die (type, TYPE_QUALS_NO_ADDR_SPACE (type),
25087 false, context_die);
25088 gcc_assert (type_die);
25090 return type_die;
25093 /* Force out any required namespaces to be able to output DECL,
25094 and return the new context_die for it, if it's changed. */
25096 static dw_die_ref
25097 setup_namespace_context (tree thing, dw_die_ref context_die)
25099 tree context = (DECL_P (thing)
25100 ? DECL_CONTEXT (thing) : TYPE_CONTEXT (thing));
25101 if (context && TREE_CODE (context) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
25102 /* Force out the namespace. */
25103 context_die = force_decl_die (context);
25105 return context_die;
25108 /* Emit a declaration DIE for THING (which is either a DECL or a tagged
25109 type) within its namespace, if appropriate.
25111 For compatibility with older debuggers, namespace DIEs only contain
25112 declarations; all definitions are emitted at CU scope, with
25113 DW_AT_specification pointing to the declaration (like with class
25114 members). */
25116 static dw_die_ref
25117 declare_in_namespace (tree thing, dw_die_ref context_die)
25119 dw_die_ref ns_context;
25121 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
25122 return context_die;
25124 /* External declarations in the local scope only need to be emitted
25125 once, not once in the namespace and once in the scope.
25127 This avoids declaring the `extern' below in the
25128 namespace DIE as well as in the innermost scope:
25130 namespace S
25132 int i=5;
25133 int foo()
25135 int i=8;
25136 extern int i;
25137 return i;
25141 if (DECL_P (thing) && DECL_EXTERNAL (thing) && local_scope_p (context_die))
25142 return context_die;
25144 /* If this decl is from an inlined function, then don't try to emit it in its
25145 namespace, as we will get confused. It would have already been emitted
25146 when the abstract instance of the inline function was emitted anyways. */
25147 if (DECL_P (thing) && DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (thing))
25148 return context_die;
25150 ns_context = setup_namespace_context (thing, context_die);
25152 if (ns_context != context_die)
25154 if (is_fortran ())
25155 return ns_context;
25156 if (DECL_P (thing))
25157 gen_decl_die (thing, NULL, NULL, ns_context);
25158 else
25159 gen_type_die (thing, ns_context);
25161 return context_die;
25164 /* Generate a DIE for a namespace or namespace alias. */
25166 static void
25167 gen_namespace_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
25169 dw_die_ref namespace_die;
25171 /* Namespace aliases have a DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN of the namespace
25172 they are an alias of. */
25173 if (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) == NULL)
25175 /* Output a real namespace or module. */
25176 context_die = setup_namespace_context (decl, comp_unit_die ());
25177 namespace_die = new_die (is_fortran ()
25178 ? DW_TAG_module : DW_TAG_namespace,
25179 context_die, decl);
25180 /* For Fortran modules defined in different CU don't add src coords. */
25181 if (namespace_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_module && DECL_EXTERNAL (decl))
25183 const char *name = dwarf2_name (decl, 0);
25184 if (name)
25185 add_name_attribute (namespace_die, name);
25187 else
25188 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (namespace_die, decl);
25189 if (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl))
25190 add_AT_flag (namespace_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
25191 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, namespace_die);
25193 else
25195 /* Output a namespace alias. */
25197 /* Force out the namespace we are an alias of, if necessary. */
25198 dw_die_ref origin_die
25199 = force_decl_die (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl));
25201 if (DECL_FILE_SCOPE_P (decl)
25202 || TREE_CODE (DECL_CONTEXT (decl)) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
25203 context_die = setup_namespace_context (decl, comp_unit_die ());
25204 /* Now create the namespace alias DIE. */
25205 namespace_die = new_die (DW_TAG_imported_declaration, context_die, decl);
25206 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (namespace_die, decl);
25207 add_AT_die_ref (namespace_die, DW_AT_import, origin_die);
25208 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, namespace_die);
25210 if ((dwarf_version >= 5 || !dwarf_strict)
25211 && lang_hooks.decls.decl_dwarf_attribute (decl,
25212 DW_AT_export_symbols) == 1)
25213 add_AT_flag (namespace_die, DW_AT_export_symbols, 1);
25215 /* Bypass dwarf2_name's check for DECL_NAMELESS. */
25216 if (want_pubnames ())
25217 add_pubname_string (lang_hooks.dwarf_name (decl, 1), namespace_die);
25220 /* Generate Dwarf debug information for a decl described by DECL.
25221 The return value is currently only meaningful for PARM_DECLs,
25222 for all other decls it returns NULL.
25224 If DECL is a FIELD_DECL, CTX is required: see the comment for VLR_CONTEXT.
25225 It can be NULL otherwise. */
25227 static dw_die_ref
25228 gen_decl_die (tree decl, tree origin, struct vlr_context *ctx,
25229 dw_die_ref context_die)
25231 tree decl_or_origin = decl ? decl : origin;
25232 tree class_origin = NULL, ultimate_origin;
25234 if (DECL_P (decl_or_origin) && DECL_IGNORED_P (decl_or_origin))
25235 return NULL;
25237 /* Ignore pointer bounds decls. */
25238 if (DECL_P (decl_or_origin)
25239 && TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin)
25240 && POINTER_BOUNDS_P (decl_or_origin))
25241 return NULL;
25243 switch (TREE_CODE (decl_or_origin))
25245 case ERROR_MARK:
25246 break;
25248 case CONST_DECL:
25249 if (!is_fortran () && !is_ada ())
25251 /* The individual enumerators of an enum type get output when we output
25252 the Dwarf representation of the relevant enum type itself. */
25253 break;
25256 /* Emit its type. */
25257 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), context_die);
25259 /* And its containing namespace. */
25260 context_die = declare_in_namespace (decl, context_die);
25262 gen_const_die (decl, context_die);
25263 break;
25265 case FUNCTION_DECL:
25266 #if 0
25267 /* FIXME */
25268 /* This doesn't work because the C frontend sets DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN
25269 on local redeclarations of global functions. That seems broken. */
25270 if (current_function_decl != decl)
25271 /* This is only a declaration. */;
25272 #endif
25274 /* We should have abstract copies already and should not generate
25275 stray type DIEs in late LTO dumping. */
25276 if (! early_dwarf)
25279 /* If we're emitting a clone, emit info for the abstract instance. */
25280 else if (origin || DECL_ORIGIN (decl) != decl)
25281 dwarf2out_abstract_function (origin
25282 ? DECL_ORIGIN (origin)
25283 : DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl));
25285 /* If we're emitting a possibly inlined function emit it as
25286 abstract instance. */
25287 else if (cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p (decl)
25288 && ! DECL_ABSTRACT_P (decl)
25289 && ! class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die)
25290 /* dwarf2out_abstract_function won't emit a die if this is just
25291 a declaration. We must avoid setting DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN in
25292 that case, because that works only if we have a die. */
25293 && DECL_INITIAL (decl) != NULL_TREE)
25294 dwarf2out_abstract_function (decl);
25296 /* Otherwise we're emitting the primary DIE for this decl. */
25297 else if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
25299 /* Before we describe the FUNCTION_DECL itself, make sure that we
25300 have its containing type. */
25301 if (!origin)
25302 origin = decl_class_context (decl);
25303 if (origin != NULL_TREE)
25304 gen_type_die (origin, context_die);
25306 /* And its return type. */
25307 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl)), context_die);
25309 /* And its virtual context. */
25310 if (DECL_VINDEX (decl) != NULL_TREE)
25311 gen_type_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl), context_die);
25313 /* Make sure we have a member DIE for decl. */
25314 if (origin != NULL_TREE)
25315 gen_type_die_for_member (origin, decl, context_die);
25317 /* And its containing namespace. */
25318 context_die = declare_in_namespace (decl, context_die);
25321 /* Now output a DIE to represent the function itself. */
25322 if (decl)
25323 gen_subprogram_die (decl, context_die);
25324 break;
25326 case TYPE_DECL:
25327 /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs to represent any
25328 actual typedefs. */
25329 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
25330 break;
25332 /* In the special case of a TYPE_DECL node representing the declaration
25333 of some type tag, if the given TYPE_DECL is marked as having been
25334 instantiated from some other (original) TYPE_DECL node (e.g. one which
25335 was generated within the original definition of an inline function) we
25336 used to generate a special (abbreviated) DW_TAG_structure_type,
25337 DW_TAG_union_type, or DW_TAG_enumeration_type DIE here. But nothing
25338 should be actually referencing those DIEs, as variable DIEs with that
25339 type would be emitted already in the abstract origin, so it was always
25340 removed during unused type prunning. Don't add anything in this
25341 case. */
25342 if (TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl) && decl_ultimate_origin (decl) != NULL_TREE)
25343 break;
25345 if (is_redundant_typedef (decl))
25346 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), context_die);
25347 else
25348 /* Output a DIE to represent the typedef itself. */
25349 gen_typedef_die (decl, context_die);
25350 break;
25352 case LABEL_DECL:
25353 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_NORMAL)
25354 gen_label_die (decl, context_die);
25355 break;
25357 case VAR_DECL:
25358 case RESULT_DECL:
25359 /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs to represent any
25360 variable declarations or definitions. */
25361 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
25362 break;
25364 /* Avoid generating stray type DIEs during late dwarf dumping.
25365 All types have been dumped early. */
25366 if (early_dwarf
25367 /* ??? But in LTRANS we cannot annotate early created variably
25368 modified type DIEs without copying them and adjusting all
25369 references to them. Dump them again as happens for inlining
25370 which copies both the decl and the types. */
25371 /* ??? And even non-LTO needs to re-visit type DIEs to fill
25372 in VLA bound information for example. */
25373 || (decl && variably_modified_type_p (TREE_TYPE (decl),
25374 current_function_decl)))
25376 /* Output any DIEs that are needed to specify the type of this data
25377 object. */
25378 if (decl_by_reference_p (decl_or_origin))
25379 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin)), context_die);
25380 else
25381 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin), context_die);
25384 if (early_dwarf)
25386 /* And its containing type. */
25387 class_origin = decl_class_context (decl_or_origin);
25388 if (class_origin != NULL_TREE)
25389 gen_type_die_for_member (class_origin, decl_or_origin, context_die);
25391 /* And its containing namespace. */
25392 context_die = declare_in_namespace (decl_or_origin, context_die);
25395 /* Now output the DIE to represent the data object itself. This gets
25396 complicated because of the possibility that the VAR_DECL really
25397 represents an inlined instance of a formal parameter for an inline
25398 function. */
25399 ultimate_origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl_or_origin);
25400 if (ultimate_origin != NULL_TREE
25401 && TREE_CODE (ultimate_origin) == PARM_DECL)
25402 gen_formal_parameter_die (decl, origin,
25403 true /* Emit name attribute. */,
25404 context_die);
25405 else
25406 gen_variable_die (decl, origin, context_die);
25407 break;
25409 case FIELD_DECL:
25410 gcc_assert (ctx != NULL && ctx->struct_type != NULL);
25411 /* Ignore the nameless fields that are used to skip bits but handle C++
25412 anonymous unions and structs. */
25413 if (DECL_NAME (decl) != NULL_TREE
25414 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == UNION_TYPE
25415 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == RECORD_TYPE)
25417 gen_type_die (member_declared_type (decl), context_die);
25418 gen_field_die (decl, ctx, context_die);
25420 break;
25422 case PARM_DECL:
25423 /* Avoid generating stray type DIEs during late dwarf dumping.
25424 All types have been dumped early. */
25425 if (early_dwarf
25426 /* ??? But in LTRANS we cannot annotate early created variably
25427 modified type DIEs without copying them and adjusting all
25428 references to them. Dump them again as happens for inlining
25429 which copies both the decl and the types. */
25430 /* ??? And even non-LTO needs to re-visit type DIEs to fill
25431 in VLA bound information for example. */
25432 || (decl && variably_modified_type_p (TREE_TYPE (decl),
25433 current_function_decl)))
25435 if (DECL_BY_REFERENCE (decl_or_origin))
25436 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin)), context_die);
25437 else
25438 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin), context_die);
25440 return gen_formal_parameter_die (decl, origin,
25441 true /* Emit name attribute. */,
25442 context_die);
25444 case NAMESPACE_DECL:
25445 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
25446 gen_namespace_die (decl, context_die);
25447 break;
25449 case IMPORTED_DECL:
25450 dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl_1 (decl, DECL_NAME (decl),
25451 DECL_CONTEXT (decl), context_die);
25452 break;
25454 case NAMELIST_DECL:
25455 gen_namelist_decl (DECL_NAME (decl), context_die,
25456 NAMELIST_DECL_ASSOCIATED_DECL (decl));
25457 break;
25459 default:
25460 /* Probably some frontend-internal decl. Assume we don't care. */
25461 gcc_assert ((int)TREE_CODE (decl) > NUM_TREE_CODES);
25462 break;
25465 return NULL;
25468 /* Output initial debug information for global DECL. Called at the
25469 end of the parsing process.
25471 This is the initial debug generation process. As such, the DIEs
25472 generated may be incomplete. A later debug generation pass
25473 (dwarf2out_late_global_decl) will augment the information generated
25474 in this pass (e.g., with complete location info). */
25476 static void
25477 dwarf2out_early_global_decl (tree decl)
25479 set_early_dwarf s;
25481 /* gen_decl_die() will set DECL_ABSTRACT because
25482 cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p() returns true. This is in
25483 turn will cause DW_AT_inline attributes to be set.
25485 This happens because at early dwarf generation, there is no
25486 cgraph information, causing cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p()
25487 to return true. Trick cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p()
25488 while we generate dwarf early. */
25489 bool save = symtab->global_info_ready;
25490 symtab->global_info_ready = true;
25492 /* We don't handle TYPE_DECLs. If required, they'll be reached via
25493 other DECLs and they can point to template types or other things
25494 that dwarf2out can't handle when done via dwarf2out_decl. */
25495 if (TREE_CODE (decl) != TYPE_DECL
25496 && TREE_CODE (decl) != PARM_DECL)
25498 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL)
25500 tree save_fndecl = current_function_decl;
25502 /* For nested functions, make sure we have DIEs for the parents first
25503 so that all nested DIEs are generated at the proper scope in the
25504 first shot. */
25505 tree context = decl_function_context (decl);
25506 if (context != NULL)
25508 dw_die_ref context_die = lookup_decl_die (context);
25509 current_function_decl = context;
25511 /* Avoid emitting DIEs multiple times, but still process CONTEXT
25512 enough so that it lands in its own context. This avoids type
25513 pruning issues later on. */
25514 if (context_die == NULL || is_declaration_die (context_die))
25515 dwarf2out_decl (context);
25518 /* Emit an abstract origin of a function first. This happens
25519 with C++ constructor clones for example and makes
25520 dwarf2out_abstract_function happy which requires the early
25521 DIE of the abstract instance to be present. */
25522 tree origin = DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl);
25523 dw_die_ref origin_die;
25524 if (origin != NULL
25525 /* Do not emit the DIE multiple times but make sure to
25526 process it fully here in case we just saw a declaration. */
25527 && ((origin_die = lookup_decl_die (origin)) == NULL
25528 || is_declaration_die (origin_die)))
25530 current_function_decl = origin;
25531 dwarf2out_decl (origin);
25534 /* Emit the DIE for decl but avoid doing that multiple times. */
25535 dw_die_ref old_die;
25536 if ((old_die = lookup_decl_die (decl)) == NULL
25537 || is_declaration_die (old_die))
25539 current_function_decl = decl;
25540 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
25543 current_function_decl = save_fndecl;
25545 else
25546 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
25548 symtab->global_info_ready = save;
25551 /* Output debug information for global decl DECL. Called from
25552 toplev.c after compilation proper has finished. */
25554 static void
25555 dwarf2out_late_global_decl (tree decl)
25557 /* Fill-in any location information we were unable to determine
25558 on the first pass. */
25559 if (VAR_P (decl) && !POINTER_BOUNDS_P (decl))
25561 dw_die_ref die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
25563 /* We may have to generate early debug late for LTO in case debug
25564 was not enabled at compile-time or the target doesn't support
25565 the LTO early debug scheme. */
25566 if (! die && in_lto_p)
25568 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
25569 die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
25572 if (die)
25574 /* We get called via the symtab code invoking late_global_decl
25575 for symbols that are optimized out. Do not add locations
25576 for those, except if they have a DECL_VALUE_EXPR, in which case
25577 they are relevant for debuggers. */
25578 varpool_node *node = varpool_node::get (decl);
25579 if ((! node || ! node->definition) && ! DECL_HAS_VALUE_EXPR_P (decl))
25580 tree_add_const_value_attribute_for_decl (die, decl);
25581 else
25582 add_location_or_const_value_attribute (die, decl, false);
25587 /* Output debug information for type decl DECL. Called from toplev.c
25588 and from language front ends (to record built-in types). */
25589 static void
25590 dwarf2out_type_decl (tree decl, int local)
25592 if (!local)
25594 set_early_dwarf s;
25595 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
25599 /* Output debug information for imported module or decl DECL.
25600 NAME is non-NULL name in the lexical block if the decl has been renamed.
25601 LEXICAL_BLOCK is the lexical block (which TREE_CODE is a BLOCK)
25602 that DECL belongs to.
25603 LEXICAL_BLOCK_DIE is the DIE of LEXICAL_BLOCK. */
25604 static void
25605 dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl_1 (tree decl,
25606 tree name,
25607 tree lexical_block,
25608 dw_die_ref lexical_block_die)
25610 expanded_location xloc;
25611 dw_die_ref imported_die = NULL;
25612 dw_die_ref at_import_die;
25614 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == IMPORTED_DECL)
25616 xloc = expand_location (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl));
25617 decl = IMPORTED_DECL_ASSOCIATED_DECL (decl);
25618 gcc_assert (decl);
25620 else
25621 xloc = expand_location (input_location);
25623 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL || TREE_CODE (decl) == CONST_DECL)
25625 at_import_die = force_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl));
25626 /* For namespace N { typedef void T; } using N::T; base_type_die
25627 returns NULL, but DW_TAG_imported_declaration requires
25628 the DW_AT_import tag. Force creation of DW_TAG_typedef. */
25629 if (!at_import_die)
25631 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL);
25632 gen_typedef_die (decl, get_context_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl)));
25633 at_import_die = lookup_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl));
25634 gcc_assert (at_import_die);
25637 else
25639 at_import_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
25640 if (!at_import_die)
25642 /* If we're trying to avoid duplicate debug info, we may not have
25643 emitted the member decl for this field. Emit it now. */
25644 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL)
25646 tree type = DECL_CONTEXT (decl);
25648 if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)
25649 && TYPE_P (TYPE_CONTEXT (type))
25650 && !should_emit_struct_debug (TYPE_CONTEXT (type),
25651 DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE))
25652 return;
25653 gen_type_die_for_member (type, decl,
25654 get_context_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)));
25656 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == NAMELIST_DECL)
25657 at_import_die = gen_namelist_decl (DECL_NAME (decl),
25658 get_context_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl)),
25659 NULL_TREE);
25660 else
25661 at_import_die = force_decl_die (decl);
25665 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
25667 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
25668 imported_die = new_die (DW_TAG_imported_module,
25669 lexical_block_die,
25670 lexical_block);
25671 else
25672 return;
25674 else
25675 imported_die = new_die (DW_TAG_imported_declaration,
25676 lexical_block_die,
25677 lexical_block);
25679 add_AT_file (imported_die, DW_AT_decl_file, lookup_filename (xloc.file));
25680 add_AT_unsigned (imported_die, DW_AT_decl_line, xloc.line);
25681 if (debug_column_info && xloc.column)
25682 add_AT_unsigned (imported_die, DW_AT_decl_column, xloc.column);
25683 if (name)
25684 add_AT_string (imported_die, DW_AT_name,
25685 IDENTIFIER_POINTER (name));
25686 add_AT_die_ref (imported_die, DW_AT_import, at_import_die);
25689 /* Output debug information for imported module or decl DECL.
25690 NAME is non-NULL name in context if the decl has been renamed.
25691 CHILD is true if decl is one of the renamed decls as part of
25692 importing whole module.
25693 IMPLICIT is set if this hook is called for an implicit import
25694 such as inline namespace. */
25696 static void
25697 dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl (tree decl, tree name, tree context,
25698 bool child, bool implicit)
25700 /* dw_die_ref at_import_die; */
25701 dw_die_ref scope_die;
25703 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
25704 return;
25706 gcc_assert (decl);
25708 /* For DWARF5, just DW_AT_export_symbols on the DW_TAG_namespace
25709 should be enough, for DWARF4 and older even if we emit as extension
25710 DW_AT_export_symbols add the implicit DW_TAG_imported_module anyway
25711 for the benefit of consumers unaware of DW_AT_export_symbols. */
25712 if (implicit
25713 && dwarf_version >= 5
25714 && lang_hooks.decls.decl_dwarf_attribute (decl,
25715 DW_AT_export_symbols) == 1)
25716 return;
25718 set_early_dwarf s;
25720 /* To emit DW_TAG_imported_module or DW_TAG_imported_decl, we need two DIEs.
25721 We need decl DIE for reference and scope die. First, get DIE for the decl
25722 itself. */
25724 /* Get the scope die for decl context. Use comp_unit_die for global module
25725 or decl. If die is not found for non globals, force new die. */
25726 if (context
25727 && TYPE_P (context)
25728 && !should_emit_struct_debug (context, DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE))
25729 return;
25731 scope_die = get_context_die (context);
25733 if (child)
25735 /* DW_TAG_imported_module was introduced in the DWARFv3 specification, so
25736 there is nothing we can do, here. */
25737 if (dwarf_version < 3 && dwarf_strict)
25738 return;
25740 gcc_assert (scope_die->die_child);
25741 gcc_assert (scope_die->die_child->die_tag == DW_TAG_imported_module);
25742 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) != NAMESPACE_DECL);
25743 scope_die = scope_die->die_child;
25746 /* OK, now we have DIEs for decl as well as scope. Emit imported die. */
25747 dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl_1 (decl, name, context, scope_die);
25750 /* Output debug information for namelists. */
25752 static dw_die_ref
25753 gen_namelist_decl (tree name, dw_die_ref scope_die, tree item_decls)
25755 dw_die_ref nml_die, nml_item_die, nml_item_ref_die;
25756 tree value;
25757 unsigned i;
25759 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
25760 return NULL;
25762 gcc_assert (scope_die != NULL);
25763 nml_die = new_die (DW_TAG_namelist, scope_die, NULL);
25764 add_AT_string (nml_die, DW_AT_name, IDENTIFIER_POINTER (name));
25766 /* If there are no item_decls, we have a nondefining namelist, e.g.
25767 with USE association; hence, set DW_AT_declaration. */
25768 if (item_decls == NULL_TREE)
25770 add_AT_flag (nml_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
25771 return nml_die;
25774 FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_VALUE (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (item_decls), i, value)
25776 nml_item_ref_die = lookup_decl_die (value);
25777 if (!nml_item_ref_die)
25778 nml_item_ref_die = force_decl_die (value);
25780 nml_item_die = new_die (DW_TAG_namelist_item, nml_die, NULL);
25781 add_AT_die_ref (nml_item_die, DW_AT_namelist_items, nml_item_ref_die);
25783 return nml_die;
25787 /* Write the debugging output for DECL and return the DIE. */
25789 static void
25790 dwarf2out_decl (tree decl)
25792 dw_die_ref context_die = comp_unit_die ();
25794 switch (TREE_CODE (decl))
25796 case ERROR_MARK:
25797 return;
25799 case FUNCTION_DECL:
25800 /* If we're a nested function, initially use a parent of NULL; if we're
25801 a plain function, this will be fixed up in decls_for_scope. If
25802 we're a method, it will be ignored, since we already have a DIE. */
25803 if (decl_function_context (decl)
25804 /* But if we're in terse mode, we don't care about scope. */
25805 && debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
25806 context_die = NULL;
25807 break;
25809 case VAR_DECL:
25810 /* For local statics lookup proper context die. */
25811 if (local_function_static (decl))
25812 context_die = lookup_decl_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl));
25814 /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs to represent any
25815 variable declarations or definitions. */
25816 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
25817 return;
25818 break;
25820 case CONST_DECL:
25821 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
25822 return;
25823 if (!is_fortran () && !is_ada ())
25824 return;
25825 if (TREE_STATIC (decl) && decl_function_context (decl))
25826 context_die = lookup_decl_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl));
25827 break;
25829 case NAMESPACE_DECL:
25830 case IMPORTED_DECL:
25831 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
25832 return;
25833 if (lookup_decl_die (decl) != NULL)
25834 return;
25835 break;
25837 case TYPE_DECL:
25838 /* Don't emit stubs for types unless they are needed by other DIEs. */
25839 if (TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG (decl))
25840 return;
25842 /* Don't bother trying to generate any DIEs to represent any of the
25843 normal built-in types for the language we are compiling. */
25844 if (DECL_IS_BUILTIN (decl))
25845 return;
25847 /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs for types. */
25848 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
25849 return;
25851 /* If we're a function-scope tag, initially use a parent of NULL;
25852 this will be fixed up in decls_for_scope. */
25853 if (decl_function_context (decl))
25854 context_die = NULL;
25856 break;
25858 case NAMELIST_DECL:
25859 break;
25861 default:
25862 return;
25865 gen_decl_die (decl, NULL, NULL, context_die);
25867 if (flag_checking)
25869 dw_die_ref die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
25870 if (die)
25871 check_die (die);
25875 /* Write the debugging output for DECL. */
25877 static void
25878 dwarf2out_function_decl (tree decl)
25880 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
25881 call_arg_locations = NULL;
25882 call_arg_loc_last = NULL;
25883 call_site_count = -1;
25884 tail_call_site_count = -1;
25885 decl_loc_table->empty ();
25886 cached_dw_loc_list_table->empty ();
25889 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the beginning of the generated code for
25890 a lexical block. */
25892 static void
25893 dwarf2out_begin_block (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
25894 unsigned int blocknum)
25896 switch_to_section (current_function_section ());
25897 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL, blocknum);
25900 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the end of the generated code for a
25901 lexical block. */
25903 static void
25904 dwarf2out_end_block (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, unsigned int blocknum)
25906 switch_to_section (current_function_section ());
25907 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, BLOCK_END_LABEL, blocknum);
25910 /* Returns nonzero if it is appropriate not to emit any debugging
25911 information for BLOCK, because it doesn't contain any instructions.
25913 Don't allow this for blocks with nested functions or local classes
25914 as we would end up with orphans, and in the presence of scheduling
25915 we may end up calling them anyway. */
25917 static bool
25918 dwarf2out_ignore_block (const_tree block)
25920 tree decl;
25921 unsigned int i;
25923 for (decl = BLOCK_VARS (block); decl; decl = DECL_CHAIN (decl))
25924 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL
25925 || (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL && TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl)))
25926 return 0;
25927 for (i = 0; i < BLOCK_NUM_NONLOCALIZED_VARS (block); i++)
25929 decl = BLOCK_NONLOCALIZED_VAR (block, i);
25930 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL
25931 || (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL && TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl)))
25932 return 0;
25935 return 1;
25938 /* Hash table routines for file_hash. */
25940 bool
25941 dwarf_file_hasher::equal (dwarf_file_data *p1, const char *p2)
25943 return filename_cmp (p1->filename, p2) == 0;
25946 hashval_t
25947 dwarf_file_hasher::hash (dwarf_file_data *p)
25949 return htab_hash_string (p->filename);
25952 /* Lookup FILE_NAME (in the list of filenames that we know about here in
25953 dwarf2out.c) and return its "index". The index of each (known) filename is
25954 just a unique number which is associated with only that one filename. We
25955 need such numbers for the sake of generating labels (in the .debug_sfnames
25956 section) and references to those files numbers (in the .debug_srcinfo
25957 and .debug_macinfo sections). If the filename given as an argument is not
25958 found in our current list, add it to the list and assign it the next
25959 available unique index number. */
25961 static struct dwarf_file_data *
25962 lookup_filename (const char *file_name)
25964 struct dwarf_file_data * created;
25966 if (!file_name)
25967 return NULL;
25969 dwarf_file_data **slot
25970 = file_table->find_slot_with_hash (file_name, htab_hash_string (file_name),
25971 INSERT);
25972 if (*slot)
25973 return *slot;
25975 created = ggc_alloc<dwarf_file_data> ();
25976 created->filename = file_name;
25977 created->emitted_number = 0;
25978 *slot = created;
25979 return created;
25982 /* If the assembler will construct the file table, then translate the compiler
25983 internal file table number into the assembler file table number, and emit
25984 a .file directive if we haven't already emitted one yet. The file table
25985 numbers are different because we prune debug info for unused variables and
25986 types, which may include filenames. */
25988 static int
25989 maybe_emit_file (struct dwarf_file_data * fd)
25991 if (! fd->emitted_number)
25993 if (last_emitted_file)
25994 fd->emitted_number = last_emitted_file->emitted_number + 1;
25995 else
25996 fd->emitted_number = 1;
25997 last_emitted_file = fd;
25999 if (DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
26001 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.file %u ", fd->emitted_number);
26002 output_quoted_string (asm_out_file,
26003 remap_debug_filename (fd->filename));
26004 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
26008 return fd->emitted_number;
26011 /* Schedule generation of a DW_AT_const_value attribute to DIE.
26012 That generation should happen after function debug info has been
26013 generated. The value of the attribute is the constant value of ARG. */
26015 static void
26016 append_entry_to_tmpl_value_parm_die_table (dw_die_ref die, tree arg)
26018 die_arg_entry entry;
26020 if (!die || !arg)
26021 return;
26023 gcc_assert (early_dwarf);
26025 if (!tmpl_value_parm_die_table)
26026 vec_alloc (tmpl_value_parm_die_table, 32);
26028 entry.die = die;
26029 entry.arg = arg;
26030 vec_safe_push (tmpl_value_parm_die_table, entry);
26033 /* Return TRUE if T is an instance of generic type, FALSE
26034 otherwise. */
26036 static bool
26037 generic_type_p (tree t)
26039 if (t == NULL_TREE || !TYPE_P (t))
26040 return false;
26041 return lang_hooks.get_innermost_generic_parms (t) != NULL_TREE;
26044 /* Schedule the generation of the generic parameter dies for the
26045 instance of generic type T. The proper generation itself is later
26046 done by gen_scheduled_generic_parms_dies. */
26048 static void
26049 schedule_generic_params_dies_gen (tree t)
26051 if (!generic_type_p (t))
26052 return;
26054 gcc_assert (early_dwarf);
26056 if (!generic_type_instances)
26057 vec_alloc (generic_type_instances, 256);
26059 vec_safe_push (generic_type_instances, t);
26062 /* Add a DW_AT_const_value attribute to DIEs that were scheduled
26063 by append_entry_to_tmpl_value_parm_die_table. This function must
26064 be called after function DIEs have been generated. */
26066 static void
26067 gen_remaining_tmpl_value_param_die_attribute (void)
26069 if (tmpl_value_parm_die_table)
26071 unsigned i, j;
26072 die_arg_entry *e;
26074 /* We do this in two phases - first get the cases we can
26075 handle during early-finish, preserving those we cannot
26076 (containing symbolic constants where we don't yet know
26077 whether we are going to output the referenced symbols).
26078 For those we try again at late-finish. */
26079 j = 0;
26080 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*tmpl_value_parm_die_table, i, e)
26082 if (!e->die->removed
26083 && !tree_add_const_value_attribute (e->die, e->arg))
26085 dw_loc_descr_ref loc = NULL;
26086 if (! early_dwarf
26087 && (dwarf_version >= 5 || !dwarf_strict))
26088 loc = loc_descriptor_from_tree (e->arg, 2, NULL);
26089 if (loc)
26090 add_AT_loc (e->die, DW_AT_location, loc);
26091 else
26092 (*tmpl_value_parm_die_table)[j++] = *e;
26095 tmpl_value_parm_die_table->truncate (j);
26099 /* Generate generic parameters DIEs for instances of generic types
26100 that have been previously scheduled by
26101 schedule_generic_params_dies_gen. This function must be called
26102 after all the types of the CU have been laid out. */
26104 static void
26105 gen_scheduled_generic_parms_dies (void)
26107 unsigned i;
26108 tree t;
26110 if (!generic_type_instances)
26111 return;
26113 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*generic_type_instances, i, t)
26114 if (COMPLETE_TYPE_P (t))
26115 gen_generic_params_dies (t);
26117 generic_type_instances = NULL;
26121 /* Replace DW_AT_name for the decl with name. */
26123 static void
26124 dwarf2out_set_name (tree decl, tree name)
26126 dw_die_ref die;
26127 dw_attr_node *attr;
26128 const char *dname;
26130 die = TYPE_SYMTAB_DIE (decl);
26131 if (!die)
26132 return;
26134 dname = dwarf2_name (name, 0);
26135 if (!dname)
26136 return;
26138 attr = get_AT (die, DW_AT_name);
26139 if (attr)
26141 struct indirect_string_node *node;
26143 node = find_AT_string (dname);
26144 /* replace the string. */
26145 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_str = node;
26148 else
26149 add_name_attribute (die, dname);
26152 /* True if before or during processing of the first function being emitted. */
26153 static bool in_first_function_p = true;
26154 /* True if loc_note during dwarf2out_var_location call might still be
26155 before first real instruction at address equal to .Ltext0. */
26156 static bool maybe_at_text_label_p = true;
26157 /* One above highest N where .LVLN label might be equal to .Ltext0 label. */
26158 static unsigned int first_loclabel_num_not_at_text_label;
26160 /* Called by the final INSN scan whenever we see a var location. We
26161 use it to drop labels in the right places, and throw the location in
26162 our lookup table. */
26164 static void
26165 dwarf2out_var_location (rtx_insn *loc_note)
26167 char loclabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES + 2];
26168 struct var_loc_node *newloc;
26169 rtx_insn *next_real, *next_note;
26170 rtx_insn *call_insn = NULL;
26171 static const char *last_label;
26172 static const char *last_postcall_label;
26173 static bool last_in_cold_section_p;
26174 static rtx_insn *expected_next_loc_note;
26175 tree decl;
26176 bool var_loc_p;
26178 if (!NOTE_P (loc_note))
26180 if (CALL_P (loc_note))
26182 call_site_count++;
26183 if (SIBLING_CALL_P (loc_note))
26184 tail_call_site_count++;
26185 if (optimize == 0 && !flag_var_tracking)
26187 /* When the var-tracking pass is not running, there is no note
26188 for indirect calls whose target is compile-time known. In this
26189 case, process such calls specifically so that we generate call
26190 sites for them anyway. */
26191 rtx x = PATTERN (loc_note);
26192 if (GET_CODE (x) == PARALLEL)
26193 x = XVECEXP (x, 0, 0);
26194 if (GET_CODE (x) == SET)
26195 x = SET_SRC (x);
26196 if (GET_CODE (x) == CALL)
26197 x = XEXP (x, 0);
26198 if (!MEM_P (x)
26199 || GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) != SYMBOL_REF
26200 || !SYMBOL_REF_DECL (XEXP (x, 0))
26201 || (TREE_CODE (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (XEXP (x, 0)))
26202 != FUNCTION_DECL))
26204 call_insn = loc_note;
26205 loc_note = NULL;
26206 var_loc_p = false;
26208 next_real = next_real_insn (call_insn);
26209 next_note = NULL;
26210 cached_next_real_insn = NULL;
26211 goto create_label;
26215 return;
26218 var_loc_p = NOTE_KIND (loc_note) == NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION;
26219 if (var_loc_p && !DECL_P (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_DECL (loc_note)))
26220 return;
26222 /* Optimize processing a large consecutive sequence of location
26223 notes so we don't spend too much time in next_real_insn. If the
26224 next insn is another location note, remember the next_real_insn
26225 calculation for next time. */
26226 next_real = cached_next_real_insn;
26227 if (next_real)
26229 if (expected_next_loc_note != loc_note)
26230 next_real = NULL;
26233 next_note = NEXT_INSN (loc_note);
26234 if (! next_note
26235 || next_note->deleted ()
26236 || ! NOTE_P (next_note)
26237 || (NOTE_KIND (next_note) != NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION
26238 && NOTE_KIND (next_note) != NOTE_INSN_CALL_ARG_LOCATION))
26239 next_note = NULL;
26241 if (! next_real)
26242 next_real = next_real_insn (loc_note);
26244 if (next_note)
26246 expected_next_loc_note = next_note;
26247 cached_next_real_insn = next_real;
26249 else
26250 cached_next_real_insn = NULL;
26252 /* If there are no instructions which would be affected by this note,
26253 don't do anything. */
26254 if (var_loc_p
26255 && next_real == NULL_RTX
26256 && !NOTE_DURING_CALL_P (loc_note))
26257 return;
26259 create_label:
26261 if (next_real == NULL_RTX)
26262 next_real = get_last_insn ();
26264 /* If there were any real insns between note we processed last time
26265 and this note (or if it is the first note), clear
26266 last_{,postcall_}label so that they are not reused this time. */
26267 if (last_var_location_insn == NULL_RTX
26268 || last_var_location_insn != next_real
26269 || last_in_cold_section_p != in_cold_section_p)
26271 last_label = NULL;
26272 last_postcall_label = NULL;
26275 if (var_loc_p)
26277 decl = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_DECL (loc_note);
26278 newloc = add_var_loc_to_decl (decl, loc_note,
26279 NOTE_DURING_CALL_P (loc_note)
26280 ? last_postcall_label : last_label);
26281 if (newloc == NULL)
26282 return;
26284 else
26286 decl = NULL_TREE;
26287 newloc = NULL;
26290 /* If there were no real insns between note we processed last time
26291 and this note, use the label we emitted last time. Otherwise
26292 create a new label and emit it. */
26293 if (last_label == NULL)
26295 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (loclabel, "LVL", loclabel_num);
26296 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, "LVL", loclabel_num);
26297 loclabel_num++;
26298 last_label = ggc_strdup (loclabel);
26299 /* See if loclabel might be equal to .Ltext0. If yes,
26300 bump first_loclabel_num_not_at_text_label. */
26301 if (!have_multiple_function_sections
26302 && in_first_function_p
26303 && maybe_at_text_label_p)
26305 static rtx_insn *last_start;
26306 rtx_insn *insn;
26307 for (insn = loc_note; insn; insn = previous_insn (insn))
26308 if (insn == last_start)
26309 break;
26310 else if (!NONDEBUG_INSN_P (insn))
26311 continue;
26312 else
26314 rtx body = PATTERN (insn);
26315 if (GET_CODE (body) == USE || GET_CODE (body) == CLOBBER)
26316 continue;
26317 /* Inline asm could occupy zero bytes. */
26318 else if (GET_CODE (body) == ASM_INPUT
26319 || asm_noperands (body) >= 0)
26320 continue;
26321 #ifdef HAVE_attr_length
26322 else if (get_attr_min_length (insn) == 0)
26323 continue;
26324 #endif
26325 else
26327 /* Assume insn has non-zero length. */
26328 maybe_at_text_label_p = false;
26329 break;
26332 if (maybe_at_text_label_p)
26334 last_start = loc_note;
26335 first_loclabel_num_not_at_text_label = loclabel_num;
26340 gcc_assert ((loc_note == NULL_RTX && call_insn != NULL_RTX)
26341 || (loc_note != NULL_RTX && call_insn == NULL_RTX));
26343 if (!var_loc_p)
26345 struct call_arg_loc_node *ca_loc
26346 = ggc_cleared_alloc<call_arg_loc_node> ();
26347 rtx_insn *prev
26348 = loc_note != NULL_RTX ? prev_real_insn (loc_note) : call_insn;
26350 ca_loc->call_arg_loc_note = loc_note;
26351 ca_loc->next = NULL;
26352 ca_loc->label = last_label;
26353 gcc_assert (prev
26354 && (CALL_P (prev)
26355 || (NONJUMP_INSN_P (prev)
26356 && GET_CODE (PATTERN (prev)) == SEQUENCE
26357 && CALL_P (XVECEXP (PATTERN (prev), 0, 0)))));
26358 if (!CALL_P (prev))
26359 prev = as_a <rtx_sequence *> (PATTERN (prev))->insn (0);
26360 ca_loc->tail_call_p = SIBLING_CALL_P (prev);
26362 /* Look for a SYMBOL_REF in the "prev" instruction. */
26363 rtx x = get_call_rtx_from (PATTERN (prev));
26364 if (x)
26366 /* Try to get the call symbol, if any. */
26367 if (MEM_P (XEXP (x, 0)))
26368 x = XEXP (x, 0);
26369 /* First, look for a memory access to a symbol_ref. */
26370 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == SYMBOL_REF
26371 && SYMBOL_REF_DECL (XEXP (x, 0))
26372 && TREE_CODE (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (XEXP (x, 0))) == FUNCTION_DECL)
26373 ca_loc->symbol_ref = XEXP (x, 0);
26374 /* Otherwise, look at a compile-time known user-level function
26375 declaration. */
26376 else if (MEM_P (x)
26377 && MEM_EXPR (x)
26378 && TREE_CODE (MEM_EXPR (x)) == FUNCTION_DECL)
26379 ca_loc->symbol_ref = XEXP (DECL_RTL (MEM_EXPR (x)), 0);
26382 ca_loc->block = insn_scope (prev);
26383 if (call_arg_locations)
26384 call_arg_loc_last->next = ca_loc;
26385 else
26386 call_arg_locations = ca_loc;
26387 call_arg_loc_last = ca_loc;
26389 else if (loc_note != NULL_RTX && !NOTE_DURING_CALL_P (loc_note))
26390 newloc->label = last_label;
26391 else
26393 if (!last_postcall_label)
26395 sprintf (loclabel, "%s-1", last_label);
26396 last_postcall_label = ggc_strdup (loclabel);
26398 newloc->label = last_postcall_label;
26401 last_var_location_insn = next_real;
26402 last_in_cold_section_p = in_cold_section_p;
26405 /* Called from finalize_size_functions for size functions so that their body
26406 can be encoded in the debug info to describe the layout of variable-length
26407 structures. */
26409 static void
26410 dwarf2out_size_function (tree decl)
26412 function_to_dwarf_procedure (decl);
26415 /* Note in one location list that text section has changed. */
26418 var_location_switch_text_section_1 (var_loc_list **slot, void *)
26420 var_loc_list *list = *slot;
26421 if (list->first)
26422 list->last_before_switch
26423 = list->last->next ? list->last->next : list->last;
26424 return 1;
26427 /* Note in all location lists that text section has changed. */
26429 static void
26430 var_location_switch_text_section (void)
26432 if (decl_loc_table == NULL)
26433 return;
26435 decl_loc_table->traverse<void *, var_location_switch_text_section_1> (NULL);
26438 /* Create a new line number table. */
26440 static dw_line_info_table *
26441 new_line_info_table (void)
26443 dw_line_info_table *table;
26445 table = ggc_cleared_alloc<dw_line_info_table> ();
26446 table->file_num = 1;
26447 table->line_num = 1;
26448 table->is_stmt = DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_IS_STMT_START;
26450 return table;
26453 /* Lookup the "current" table into which we emit line info, so
26454 that we don't have to do it for every source line. */
26456 static void
26457 set_cur_line_info_table (section *sec)
26459 dw_line_info_table *table;
26461 if (sec == text_section)
26462 table = text_section_line_info;
26463 else if (sec == cold_text_section)
26465 table = cold_text_section_line_info;
26466 if (!table)
26468 cold_text_section_line_info = table = new_line_info_table ();
26469 table->end_label = cold_end_label;
26472 else
26474 const char *end_label;
26476 if (crtl->has_bb_partition)
26478 if (in_cold_section_p)
26479 end_label = crtl->subsections.cold_section_end_label;
26480 else
26481 end_label = crtl->subsections.hot_section_end_label;
26483 else
26485 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
26486 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, FUNC_END_LABEL,
26487 current_function_funcdef_no);
26488 end_label = ggc_strdup (label);
26491 table = new_line_info_table ();
26492 table->end_label = end_label;
26494 vec_safe_push (separate_line_info, table);
26497 if (DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
26498 table->is_stmt = (cur_line_info_table
26499 ? cur_line_info_table->is_stmt
26500 : DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_IS_STMT_START);
26501 cur_line_info_table = table;
26505 /* We need to reset the locations at the beginning of each
26506 function. We can't do this in the end_function hook, because the
26507 declarations that use the locations won't have been output when
26508 that hook is called. Also compute have_multiple_function_sections here. */
26510 static void
26511 dwarf2out_begin_function (tree fun)
26513 section *sec = function_section (fun);
26515 if (sec != text_section)
26516 have_multiple_function_sections = true;
26518 if (crtl->has_bb_partition && !cold_text_section)
26520 gcc_assert (current_function_decl == fun);
26521 cold_text_section = unlikely_text_section ();
26522 switch_to_section (cold_text_section);
26523 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, cold_text_section_label);
26524 switch_to_section (sec);
26527 dwarf2out_note_section_used ();
26528 call_site_count = 0;
26529 tail_call_site_count = 0;
26531 set_cur_line_info_table (sec);
26534 /* Helper function of dwarf2out_end_function, called only after emitting
26535 the very first function into assembly. Check if some .debug_loc range
26536 might end with a .LVL* label that could be equal to .Ltext0.
26537 In that case we must force using absolute addresses in .debug_loc ranges,
26538 because this range could be .LVLN-.Ltext0 .. .LVLM-.Ltext0 for
26539 .LVLN == .LVLM == .Ltext0, thus 0 .. 0, which is a .debug_loc
26540 list terminator.
26541 Set have_multiple_function_sections to true in that case and
26542 terminate htab traversal. */
26545 find_empty_loc_ranges_at_text_label (var_loc_list **slot, int)
26547 var_loc_list *entry = *slot;
26548 struct var_loc_node *node;
26550 node = entry->first;
26551 if (node && node->next && node->next->label)
26553 unsigned int i;
26554 const char *label = node->next->label;
26555 char loclabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
26557 for (i = 0; i < first_loclabel_num_not_at_text_label; i++)
26559 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (loclabel, "LVL", i);
26560 if (strcmp (label, loclabel) == 0)
26562 have_multiple_function_sections = true;
26563 return 0;
26567 return 1;
26570 /* Hook called after emitting a function into assembly.
26571 This does something only for the very first function emitted. */
26573 static void
26574 dwarf2out_end_function (unsigned int)
26576 if (in_first_function_p
26577 && !have_multiple_function_sections
26578 && first_loclabel_num_not_at_text_label
26579 && decl_loc_table)
26580 decl_loc_table->traverse<int, find_empty_loc_ranges_at_text_label> (0);
26581 in_first_function_p = false;
26582 maybe_at_text_label_p = false;
26585 /* Temporary holder for dwarf2out_register_main_translation_unit. Used to let
26586 front-ends register a translation unit even before dwarf2out_init is
26587 called. */
26588 static tree main_translation_unit = NULL_TREE;
26590 /* Hook called by front-ends after they built their main translation unit.
26591 Associate comp_unit_die to UNIT. */
26593 static void
26594 dwarf2out_register_main_translation_unit (tree unit)
26596 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (unit) == TRANSLATION_UNIT_DECL
26597 && main_translation_unit == NULL_TREE);
26598 main_translation_unit = unit;
26599 /* If dwarf2out_init has not been called yet, it will perform the association
26600 itself looking at main_translation_unit. */
26601 if (decl_die_table != NULL)
26602 equate_decl_number_to_die (unit, comp_unit_die ());
26605 /* Add OPCODE+VAL as an entry at the end of the opcode array in TABLE. */
26607 static void
26608 push_dw_line_info_entry (dw_line_info_table *table,
26609 enum dw_line_info_opcode opcode, unsigned int val)
26611 dw_line_info_entry e;
26612 e.opcode = opcode;
26613 e.val = val;
26614 vec_safe_push (table->entries, e);
26617 /* Output a label to mark the beginning of a source code line entry
26618 and record information relating to this source line, in
26619 'line_info_table' for later output of the .debug_line section. */
26620 /* ??? The discriminator parameter ought to be unsigned. */
26622 static void
26623 dwarf2out_source_line (unsigned int line, unsigned int column,
26624 const char *filename,
26625 int discriminator, bool is_stmt)
26627 unsigned int file_num;
26628 dw_line_info_table *table;
26630 if (debug_info_level < DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE || line == 0)
26631 return;
26633 /* The discriminator column was added in dwarf4. Simplify the below
26634 by simply removing it if we're not supposed to output it. */
26635 if (dwarf_version < 4 && dwarf_strict)
26636 discriminator = 0;
26638 if (!debug_column_info)
26639 column = 0;
26641 table = cur_line_info_table;
26642 file_num = maybe_emit_file (lookup_filename (filename));
26644 /* ??? TODO: Elide duplicate line number entries. Traditionally,
26645 the debugger has used the second (possibly duplicate) line number
26646 at the beginning of the function to mark the end of the prologue.
26647 We could eliminate any other duplicates within the function. For
26648 Dwarf3, we ought to include the DW_LNS_set_prologue_end mark in
26649 that second line number entry. */
26650 /* Recall that this end-of-prologue indication is *not* the same thing
26651 as the end_prologue debug hook. The NOTE_INSN_PROLOGUE_END note,
26652 to which the hook corresponds, follows the last insn that was
26653 emitted by gen_prologue. What we need is to precede the first insn
26654 that had been emitted after NOTE_INSN_FUNCTION_BEG, i.e. the first
26655 insn that corresponds to something the user wrote. These may be
26656 very different locations once scheduling is enabled. */
26658 if (0 && file_num == table->file_num
26659 && line == table->line_num
26660 && column == table->column_num
26661 && discriminator == table->discrim_num
26662 && is_stmt == table->is_stmt)
26663 return;
26665 switch_to_section (current_function_section ());
26667 /* If requested, emit something human-readable. */
26668 if (flag_debug_asm)
26670 if (debug_column_info)
26671 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t%s %s:%d:%d\n", ASM_COMMENT_START,
26672 filename, line, column);
26673 else
26674 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t%s %s:%d\n", ASM_COMMENT_START,
26675 filename, line);
26678 if (DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
26680 /* Emit the .loc directive understood by GNU as. */
26681 /* "\t.loc %u %u 0 is_stmt %u discriminator %u",
26682 file_num, line, is_stmt, discriminator */
26683 fputs ("\t.loc ", asm_out_file);
26684 fprint_ul (asm_out_file, file_num);
26685 putc (' ', asm_out_file);
26686 fprint_ul (asm_out_file, line);
26687 putc (' ', asm_out_file);
26688 fprint_ul (asm_out_file, column);
26690 if (is_stmt != table->is_stmt)
26692 fputs (" is_stmt ", asm_out_file);
26693 putc (is_stmt ? '1' : '0', asm_out_file);
26695 if (SUPPORTS_DISCRIMINATOR && discriminator != 0)
26697 gcc_assert (discriminator > 0);
26698 fputs (" discriminator ", asm_out_file);
26699 fprint_ul (asm_out_file, (unsigned long) discriminator);
26701 putc ('\n', asm_out_file);
26703 else
26705 unsigned int label_num = ++line_info_label_num;
26707 targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, LINE_CODE_LABEL, label_num);
26709 push_dw_line_info_entry (table, LI_set_address, label_num);
26710 if (file_num != table->file_num)
26711 push_dw_line_info_entry (table, LI_set_file, file_num);
26712 if (discriminator != table->discrim_num)
26713 push_dw_line_info_entry (table, LI_set_discriminator, discriminator);
26714 if (is_stmt != table->is_stmt)
26715 push_dw_line_info_entry (table, LI_negate_stmt, 0);
26716 push_dw_line_info_entry (table, LI_set_line, line);
26717 if (debug_column_info)
26718 push_dw_line_info_entry (table, LI_set_column, column);
26721 table->file_num = file_num;
26722 table->line_num = line;
26723 table->column_num = column;
26724 table->discrim_num = discriminator;
26725 table->is_stmt = is_stmt;
26726 table->in_use = true;
26729 /* Record the beginning of a new source file. */
26731 static void
26732 dwarf2out_start_source_file (unsigned int lineno, const char *filename)
26734 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
26736 macinfo_entry e;
26737 e.code = DW_MACINFO_start_file;
26738 e.lineno = lineno;
26739 e.info = ggc_strdup (filename);
26740 vec_safe_push (macinfo_table, e);
26744 /* Record the end of a source file. */
26746 static void
26747 dwarf2out_end_source_file (unsigned int lineno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
26749 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
26751 macinfo_entry e;
26752 e.code = DW_MACINFO_end_file;
26753 e.lineno = lineno;
26754 e.info = NULL;
26755 vec_safe_push (macinfo_table, e);
26759 /* Called from debug_define in toplev.c. The `buffer' parameter contains
26760 the tail part of the directive line, i.e. the part which is past the
26761 initial whitespace, #, whitespace, directive-name, whitespace part. */
26763 static void
26764 dwarf2out_define (unsigned int lineno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
26765 const char *buffer ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
26767 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
26769 macinfo_entry e;
26770 /* Insert a dummy first entry to be able to optimize the whole
26771 predefined macro block using DW_MACRO_import. */
26772 if (macinfo_table->is_empty () && lineno <= 1)
26774 e.code = 0;
26775 e.lineno = 0;
26776 e.info = NULL;
26777 vec_safe_push (macinfo_table, e);
26779 e.code = DW_MACINFO_define;
26780 e.lineno = lineno;
26781 e.info = ggc_strdup (buffer);
26782 vec_safe_push (macinfo_table, e);
26786 /* Called from debug_undef in toplev.c. The `buffer' parameter contains
26787 the tail part of the directive line, i.e. the part which is past the
26788 initial whitespace, #, whitespace, directive-name, whitespace part. */
26790 static void
26791 dwarf2out_undef (unsigned int lineno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
26792 const char *buffer ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
26794 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
26796 macinfo_entry e;
26797 /* Insert a dummy first entry to be able to optimize the whole
26798 predefined macro block using DW_MACRO_import. */
26799 if (macinfo_table->is_empty () && lineno <= 1)
26801 e.code = 0;
26802 e.lineno = 0;
26803 e.info = NULL;
26804 vec_safe_push (macinfo_table, e);
26806 e.code = DW_MACINFO_undef;
26807 e.lineno = lineno;
26808 e.info = ggc_strdup (buffer);
26809 vec_safe_push (macinfo_table, e);
26813 /* Helpers to manipulate hash table of CUs. */
26815 struct macinfo_entry_hasher : nofree_ptr_hash <macinfo_entry>
26817 static inline hashval_t hash (const macinfo_entry *);
26818 static inline bool equal (const macinfo_entry *, const macinfo_entry *);
26821 inline hashval_t
26822 macinfo_entry_hasher::hash (const macinfo_entry *entry)
26824 return htab_hash_string (entry->info);
26827 inline bool
26828 macinfo_entry_hasher::equal (const macinfo_entry *entry1,
26829 const macinfo_entry *entry2)
26831 return !strcmp (entry1->info, entry2->info);
26834 typedef hash_table<macinfo_entry_hasher> macinfo_hash_type;
26836 /* Output a single .debug_macinfo entry. */
26838 static void
26839 output_macinfo_op (macinfo_entry *ref)
26841 int file_num;
26842 size_t len;
26843 struct indirect_string_node *node;
26844 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
26845 struct dwarf_file_data *fd;
26847 switch (ref->code)
26849 case DW_MACINFO_start_file:
26850 fd = lookup_filename (ref->info);
26851 file_num = maybe_emit_file (fd);
26852 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_start_file, "Start new file");
26853 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (ref->lineno,
26854 "Included from line number %lu",
26855 (unsigned long) ref->lineno);
26856 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (file_num, "file %s", ref->info);
26857 break;
26858 case DW_MACINFO_end_file:
26859 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_end_file, "End file");
26860 break;
26861 case DW_MACINFO_define:
26862 case DW_MACINFO_undef:
26863 len = strlen (ref->info) + 1;
26864 if (!dwarf_strict
26865 && len > DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE
26866 && !DWARF2_INDIRECT_STRING_SUPPORT_MISSING_ON_TARGET
26867 && (debug_str_section->common.flags & SECTION_MERGE) != 0)
26869 ref->code = ref->code == DW_MACINFO_define
26870 ? DW_MACRO_define_strp : DW_MACRO_undef_strp;
26871 output_macinfo_op (ref);
26872 return;
26874 dw2_asm_output_data (1, ref->code,
26875 ref->code == DW_MACINFO_define
26876 ? "Define macro" : "Undefine macro");
26877 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (ref->lineno, "At line number %lu",
26878 (unsigned long) ref->lineno);
26879 dw2_asm_output_nstring (ref->info, -1, "The macro");
26880 break;
26881 case DW_MACRO_define_strp:
26882 case DW_MACRO_undef_strp:
26883 node = find_AT_string (ref->info);
26884 gcc_assert (node
26885 && (node->form == DW_FORM_strp
26886 || node->form == DW_FORM_GNU_str_index));
26887 dw2_asm_output_data (1, ref->code,
26888 ref->code == DW_MACRO_define_strp
26889 ? "Define macro strp"
26890 : "Undefine macro strp");
26891 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (ref->lineno, "At line number %lu",
26892 (unsigned long) ref->lineno);
26893 if (node->form == DW_FORM_strp)
26894 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, node->label,
26895 debug_str_section, "The macro: \"%s\"",
26896 ref->info);
26897 else
26898 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (node->index, "The macro: \"%s\"",
26899 ref->info);
26900 break;
26901 case DW_MACRO_import:
26902 dw2_asm_output_data (1, ref->code, "Import");
26903 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label,
26904 DEBUG_MACRO_SECTION_LABEL,
26905 ref->lineno + macinfo_label_base);
26906 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, label, NULL, NULL);
26907 break;
26908 default:
26909 fprintf (asm_out_file, "%s unrecognized macinfo code %lu\n",
26910 ASM_COMMENT_START, (unsigned long) ref->code);
26911 break;
26915 /* Attempt to make a sequence of define/undef macinfo ops shareable with
26916 other compilation unit .debug_macinfo sections. IDX is the first
26917 index of a define/undef, return the number of ops that should be
26918 emitted in a comdat .debug_macinfo section and emit
26919 a DW_MACRO_import entry referencing it.
26920 If the define/undef entry should be emitted normally, return 0. */
26922 static unsigned
26923 optimize_macinfo_range (unsigned int idx, vec<macinfo_entry, va_gc> *files,
26924 macinfo_hash_type **macinfo_htab)
26926 macinfo_entry *first, *second, *cur, *inc;
26927 char linebuf[sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT) * 3 + 1];
26928 unsigned char checksum[16];
26929 struct md5_ctx ctx;
26930 char *grp_name, *tail;
26931 const char *base;
26932 unsigned int i, count, encoded_filename_len, linebuf_len;
26933 macinfo_entry **slot;
26935 first = &(*macinfo_table)[idx];
26936 second = &(*macinfo_table)[idx + 1];
26938 /* Optimize only if there are at least two consecutive define/undef ops,
26939 and either all of them are before first DW_MACINFO_start_file
26940 with lineno {0,1} (i.e. predefined macro block), or all of them are
26941 in some included header file. */
26942 if (second->code != DW_MACINFO_define && second->code != DW_MACINFO_undef)
26943 return 0;
26944 if (vec_safe_is_empty (files))
26946 if (first->lineno > 1 || second->lineno > 1)
26947 return 0;
26949 else if (first->lineno == 0)
26950 return 0;
26952 /* Find the last define/undef entry that can be grouped together
26953 with first and at the same time compute md5 checksum of their
26954 codes, linenumbers and strings. */
26955 md5_init_ctx (&ctx);
26956 for (i = idx; macinfo_table->iterate (i, &cur); i++)
26957 if (cur->code != DW_MACINFO_define && cur->code != DW_MACINFO_undef)
26958 break;
26959 else if (vec_safe_is_empty (files) && cur->lineno > 1)
26960 break;
26961 else
26963 unsigned char code = cur->code;
26964 md5_process_bytes (&code, 1, &ctx);
26965 checksum_uleb128 (cur->lineno, &ctx);
26966 md5_process_bytes (cur->info, strlen (cur->info) + 1, &ctx);
26968 md5_finish_ctx (&ctx, checksum);
26969 count = i - idx;
26971 /* From the containing include filename (if any) pick up just
26972 usable characters from its basename. */
26973 if (vec_safe_is_empty (files))
26974 base = "";
26975 else
26976 base = lbasename (files->last ().info);
26977 for (encoded_filename_len = 0, i = 0; base[i]; i++)
26978 if (ISIDNUM (base[i]) || base[i] == '.')
26979 encoded_filename_len++;
26980 /* Count . at the end. */
26981 if (encoded_filename_len)
26982 encoded_filename_len++;
26984 sprintf (linebuf, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_UNSIGNED, first->lineno);
26985 linebuf_len = strlen (linebuf);
26987 /* The group name format is: wmN.[<encoded filename>.]<lineno>.<md5sum> */
26988 grp_name = XALLOCAVEC (char, 4 + encoded_filename_len + linebuf_len + 1
26989 + 16 * 2 + 1);
26990 memcpy (grp_name, DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 ? "wm4." : "wm8.", 4);
26991 tail = grp_name + 4;
26992 if (encoded_filename_len)
26994 for (i = 0; base[i]; i++)
26995 if (ISIDNUM (base[i]) || base[i] == '.')
26996 *tail++ = base[i];
26997 *tail++ = '.';
26999 memcpy (tail, linebuf, linebuf_len);
27000 tail += linebuf_len;
27001 *tail++ = '.';
27002 for (i = 0; i < 16; i++)
27003 sprintf (tail + i * 2, "%02x", checksum[i] & 0xff);
27005 /* Construct a macinfo_entry for DW_MACRO_import
27006 in the empty vector entry before the first define/undef. */
27007 inc = &(*macinfo_table)[idx - 1];
27008 inc->code = DW_MACRO_import;
27009 inc->lineno = 0;
27010 inc->info = ggc_strdup (grp_name);
27011 if (!*macinfo_htab)
27012 *macinfo_htab = new macinfo_hash_type (10);
27013 /* Avoid emitting duplicates. */
27014 slot = (*macinfo_htab)->find_slot (inc, INSERT);
27015 if (*slot != NULL)
27017 inc->code = 0;
27018 inc->info = NULL;
27019 /* If such an entry has been used before, just emit
27020 a DW_MACRO_import op. */
27021 inc = *slot;
27022 output_macinfo_op (inc);
27023 /* And clear all macinfo_entry in the range to avoid emitting them
27024 in the second pass. */
27025 for (i = idx; macinfo_table->iterate (i, &cur) && i < idx + count; i++)
27027 cur->code = 0;
27028 cur->info = NULL;
27031 else
27033 *slot = inc;
27034 inc->lineno = (*macinfo_htab)->elements ();
27035 output_macinfo_op (inc);
27037 return count;
27040 /* Save any strings needed by the macinfo table in the debug str
27041 table. All strings must be collected into the table by the time
27042 index_string is called. */
27044 static void
27045 save_macinfo_strings (void)
27047 unsigned len;
27048 unsigned i;
27049 macinfo_entry *ref;
27051 for (i = 0; macinfo_table && macinfo_table->iterate (i, &ref); i++)
27053 switch (ref->code)
27055 /* Match the logic in output_macinfo_op to decide on
27056 indirect strings. */
27057 case DW_MACINFO_define:
27058 case DW_MACINFO_undef:
27059 len = strlen (ref->info) + 1;
27060 if (!dwarf_strict
27061 && len > DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE
27062 && !DWARF2_INDIRECT_STRING_SUPPORT_MISSING_ON_TARGET
27063 && (debug_str_section->common.flags & SECTION_MERGE) != 0)
27064 set_indirect_string (find_AT_string (ref->info));
27065 break;
27066 case DW_MACRO_define_strp:
27067 case DW_MACRO_undef_strp:
27068 set_indirect_string (find_AT_string (ref->info));
27069 break;
27070 default:
27071 break;
27076 /* Output macinfo section(s). */
27078 static void
27079 output_macinfo (const char *debug_line_label, bool early_lto_debug)
27081 unsigned i;
27082 unsigned long length = vec_safe_length (macinfo_table);
27083 macinfo_entry *ref;
27084 vec<macinfo_entry, va_gc> *files = NULL;
27085 macinfo_hash_type *macinfo_htab = NULL;
27086 char dl_section_ref[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
27088 if (! length)
27089 return;
27091 /* output_macinfo* uses these interchangeably. */
27092 gcc_assert ((int) DW_MACINFO_define == (int) DW_MACRO_define
27093 && (int) DW_MACINFO_undef == (int) DW_MACRO_undef
27094 && (int) DW_MACINFO_start_file == (int) DW_MACRO_start_file
27095 && (int) DW_MACINFO_end_file == (int) DW_MACRO_end_file);
27097 /* AIX Assembler inserts the length, so adjust the reference to match the
27098 offset expected by debuggers. */
27099 strcpy (dl_section_ref, debug_line_label);
27100 if (XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO)
27101 strcat (dl_section_ref, DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE_STR);
27103 /* For .debug_macro emit the section header. */
27104 if (!dwarf_strict || dwarf_version >= 5)
27106 dw2_asm_output_data (2, dwarf_version >= 5 ? 5 : 4,
27107 "DWARF macro version number");
27108 if (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 8)
27109 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 3, "Flags: 64-bit, lineptr present");
27110 else
27111 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 2, "Flags: 32-bit, lineptr present");
27112 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, debug_line_label,
27113 debug_line_section, NULL);
27116 /* In the first loop, it emits the primary .debug_macinfo section
27117 and after each emitted op the macinfo_entry is cleared.
27118 If a longer range of define/undef ops can be optimized using
27119 DW_MACRO_import, the DW_MACRO_import op is emitted and kept in
27120 the vector before the first define/undef in the range and the
27121 whole range of define/undef ops is not emitted and kept. */
27122 for (i = 0; macinfo_table->iterate (i, &ref); i++)
27124 switch (ref->code)
27126 case DW_MACINFO_start_file:
27127 vec_safe_push (files, *ref);
27128 break;
27129 case DW_MACINFO_end_file:
27130 if (!vec_safe_is_empty (files))
27131 files->pop ();
27132 break;
27133 case DW_MACINFO_define:
27134 case DW_MACINFO_undef:
27135 if ((!dwarf_strict || dwarf_version >= 5)
27136 && HAVE_COMDAT_GROUP
27137 && vec_safe_length (files) != 1
27138 && i > 0
27139 && i + 1 < length
27140 && (*macinfo_table)[i - 1].code == 0)
27142 unsigned count = optimize_macinfo_range (i, files, &macinfo_htab);
27143 if (count)
27145 i += count - 1;
27146 continue;
27149 break;
27150 case 0:
27151 /* A dummy entry may be inserted at the beginning to be able
27152 to optimize the whole block of predefined macros. */
27153 if (i == 0)
27154 continue;
27155 default:
27156 break;
27158 output_macinfo_op (ref);
27159 ref->info = NULL;
27160 ref->code = 0;
27163 if (!macinfo_htab)
27164 return;
27166 /* Save the number of transparent includes so we can adjust the
27167 label number for the fat LTO object DWARF. */
27168 unsigned macinfo_label_base_adj = macinfo_htab->elements ();
27170 delete macinfo_htab;
27171 macinfo_htab = NULL;
27173 /* If any DW_MACRO_import were used, on those DW_MACRO_import entries
27174 terminate the current chain and switch to a new comdat .debug_macinfo
27175 section and emit the define/undef entries within it. */
27176 for (i = 0; macinfo_table->iterate (i, &ref); i++)
27177 switch (ref->code)
27179 case 0:
27180 continue;
27181 case DW_MACRO_import:
27183 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
27184 tree comdat_key = get_identifier (ref->info);
27185 /* Terminate the previous .debug_macinfo section. */
27186 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End compilation unit");
27187 targetm.asm_out.named_section (debug_macinfo_section_name,
27188 SECTION_DEBUG
27189 | SECTION_LINKONCE
27190 | (early_lto_debug
27191 ? SECTION_EXCLUDE : 0),
27192 comdat_key);
27193 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label,
27194 DEBUG_MACRO_SECTION_LABEL,
27195 ref->lineno + macinfo_label_base);
27196 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, label);
27197 ref->code = 0;
27198 ref->info = NULL;
27199 dw2_asm_output_data (2, dwarf_version >= 5 ? 5 : 4,
27200 "DWARF macro version number");
27201 if (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 8)
27202 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 1, "Flags: 64-bit");
27203 else
27204 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "Flags: 32-bit");
27206 break;
27207 case DW_MACINFO_define:
27208 case DW_MACINFO_undef:
27209 output_macinfo_op (ref);
27210 ref->code = 0;
27211 ref->info = NULL;
27212 break;
27213 default:
27214 gcc_unreachable ();
27217 macinfo_label_base += macinfo_label_base_adj;
27220 /* Initialize the various sections and labels for dwarf output and prefix
27221 them with PREFIX if non-NULL. */
27223 static void
27224 init_sections_and_labels (bool early_lto_debug)
27226 /* As we may get called multiple times have a generation count for
27227 labels. */
27228 static unsigned generation = 0;
27230 if (early_lto_debug)
27232 if (!dwarf_split_debug_info)
27234 debug_info_section = get_section (DEBUG_LTO_INFO_SECTION,
27235 SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE,
27236 NULL);
27237 debug_abbrev_section = get_section (DEBUG_LTO_ABBREV_SECTION,
27238 SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE,
27239 NULL);
27240 debug_macinfo_section_name
27241 = ((dwarf_strict && dwarf_version < 5)
27242 ? DEBUG_LTO_MACINFO_SECTION : DEBUG_LTO_MACRO_SECTION);
27243 debug_macinfo_section = get_section (debug_macinfo_section_name,
27244 SECTION_DEBUG
27245 | SECTION_EXCLUDE, NULL);
27246 /* For macro info we have to refer to a debug_line section, so
27247 similar to split-dwarf emit a skeleton one for early debug. */
27248 debug_skeleton_line_section
27249 = get_section (DEBUG_LTO_LINE_SECTION,
27250 SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE, NULL);
27251 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_skeleton_line_section_label,
27252 DEBUG_SKELETON_LINE_SECTION_LABEL,
27253 generation);
27255 else
27257 /* ??? Which of the following do we need early? */
27258 debug_info_section = get_section (DEBUG_LTO_DWO_INFO_SECTION,
27259 SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE,
27260 NULL);
27261 debug_abbrev_section = get_section (DEBUG_LTO_DWO_ABBREV_SECTION,
27262 SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE,
27263 NULL);
27264 debug_skeleton_info_section = get_section (DEBUG_LTO_INFO_SECTION,
27265 SECTION_DEBUG
27266 | SECTION_EXCLUDE, NULL);
27267 debug_skeleton_abbrev_section
27268 = get_section (DEBUG_LTO_ABBREV_SECTION,
27269 SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE, NULL);
27270 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_skeleton_abbrev_section_label,
27271 DEBUG_SKELETON_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL,
27272 generation);
27274 /* Somewhat confusing detail: The skeleton_[abbrev|info] sections
27275 stay in the main .o, but the skeleton_line goes into the split
27276 off dwo. */
27277 debug_skeleton_line_section
27278 = get_section (DEBUG_LTO_LINE_SECTION,
27279 SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE, NULL);
27280 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_skeleton_line_section_label,
27281 DEBUG_SKELETON_LINE_SECTION_LABEL,
27282 generation);
27283 debug_str_offsets_section
27284 = get_section (DEBUG_LTO_DWO_STR_OFFSETS_SECTION,
27285 SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE,
27286 NULL);
27287 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_skeleton_info_section_label,
27288 DEBUG_SKELETON_INFO_SECTION_LABEL,
27289 generation);
27290 debug_str_dwo_section = get_section (DEBUG_LTO_STR_DWO_SECTION,
27291 DEBUG_STR_DWO_SECTION_FLAGS,
27292 NULL);
27293 debug_macinfo_section_name
27294 = ((dwarf_strict && dwarf_version < 5)
27295 ? DEBUG_LTO_DWO_MACINFO_SECTION : DEBUG_LTO_DWO_MACRO_SECTION);
27296 debug_macinfo_section = get_section (debug_macinfo_section_name,
27297 SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE,
27298 NULL);
27300 debug_str_section = get_section (DEBUG_LTO_STR_SECTION,
27301 DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS
27302 | SECTION_EXCLUDE, NULL);
27303 if (!dwarf_split_debug_info && !DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
27304 debug_line_str_section
27305 = get_section (DEBUG_LTO_LINE_STR_SECTION,
27306 DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS | SECTION_EXCLUDE, NULL);
27308 else
27310 if (!dwarf_split_debug_info)
27312 debug_info_section = get_section (DEBUG_INFO_SECTION,
27313 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
27314 debug_abbrev_section = get_section (DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION,
27315 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
27316 debug_loc_section = get_section (dwarf_version >= 5
27317 ? DEBUG_LOCLISTS_SECTION
27318 : DEBUG_LOC_SECTION,
27319 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
27320 debug_macinfo_section_name
27321 = ((dwarf_strict && dwarf_version < 5)
27322 ? DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION : DEBUG_MACRO_SECTION);
27323 debug_macinfo_section = get_section (debug_macinfo_section_name,
27324 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
27326 else
27328 debug_info_section = get_section (DEBUG_DWO_INFO_SECTION,
27329 SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE,
27330 NULL);
27331 debug_abbrev_section = get_section (DEBUG_DWO_ABBREV_SECTION,
27332 SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE,
27333 NULL);
27334 debug_addr_section = get_section (DEBUG_ADDR_SECTION,
27335 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
27336 debug_skeleton_info_section = get_section (DEBUG_INFO_SECTION,
27337 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
27338 debug_skeleton_abbrev_section = get_section (DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION,
27339 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
27340 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_skeleton_abbrev_section_label,
27341 DEBUG_SKELETON_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL,
27342 generation);
27344 /* Somewhat confusing detail: The skeleton_[abbrev|info] sections
27345 stay in the main .o, but the skeleton_line goes into the
27346 split off dwo. */
27347 debug_skeleton_line_section
27348 = get_section (DEBUG_DWO_LINE_SECTION,
27349 SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE, NULL);
27350 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_skeleton_line_section_label,
27351 DEBUG_SKELETON_LINE_SECTION_LABEL,
27352 generation);
27353 debug_str_offsets_section
27354 = get_section (DEBUG_DWO_STR_OFFSETS_SECTION,
27355 SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE, NULL);
27356 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_skeleton_info_section_label,
27357 DEBUG_SKELETON_INFO_SECTION_LABEL,
27358 generation);
27359 debug_loc_section = get_section (dwarf_version >= 5
27360 ? DEBUG_DWO_LOCLISTS_SECTION
27361 : DEBUG_DWO_LOC_SECTION,
27362 SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE,
27363 NULL);
27364 debug_str_dwo_section = get_section (DEBUG_STR_DWO_SECTION,
27365 DEBUG_STR_DWO_SECTION_FLAGS,
27366 NULL);
27367 debug_macinfo_section_name
27368 = ((dwarf_strict && dwarf_version < 5)
27369 ? DEBUG_DWO_MACINFO_SECTION : DEBUG_DWO_MACRO_SECTION);
27370 debug_macinfo_section = get_section (debug_macinfo_section_name,
27371 SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE,
27372 NULL);
27374 debug_aranges_section = get_section (DEBUG_ARANGES_SECTION,
27375 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
27376 debug_line_section = get_section (DEBUG_LINE_SECTION,
27377 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
27378 debug_pubnames_section = get_section (DEBUG_PUBNAMES_SECTION,
27379 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
27380 debug_pubtypes_section = get_section (DEBUG_PUBTYPES_SECTION,
27381 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
27382 debug_str_section = get_section (DEBUG_STR_SECTION,
27383 DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS, NULL);
27384 if (!dwarf_split_debug_info && !DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
27385 debug_line_str_section = get_section (DEBUG_LINE_STR_SECTION,
27386 DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS, NULL);
27387 debug_ranges_section = get_section (dwarf_version >= 5
27388 ? DEBUG_RNGLISTS_SECTION
27389 : DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION,
27390 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
27391 debug_frame_section = get_section (DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION,
27392 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
27395 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (abbrev_section_label,
27396 DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL, generation);
27397 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_info_section_label,
27398 DEBUG_INFO_SECTION_LABEL, generation);
27399 info_section_emitted = false;
27400 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_line_section_label,
27401 DEBUG_LINE_SECTION_LABEL, generation);
27402 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (ranges_section_label,
27403 DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL, generation);
27404 if (dwarf_version >= 5 && dwarf_split_debug_info)
27405 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (ranges_base_label,
27406 DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL, 2 + generation);
27407 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_addr_section_label,
27408 DEBUG_ADDR_SECTION_LABEL, generation);
27409 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (macinfo_section_label,
27410 (dwarf_strict && dwarf_version < 5)
27411 ? DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION_LABEL
27412 : DEBUG_MACRO_SECTION_LABEL, generation);
27413 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (loc_section_label, DEBUG_LOC_SECTION_LABEL,
27414 generation);
27416 ++generation;
27419 /* Set up for Dwarf output at the start of compilation. */
27421 static void
27422 dwarf2out_init (const char *filename ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
27424 /* Allocate the file_table. */
27425 file_table = hash_table<dwarf_file_hasher>::create_ggc (50);
27427 #ifndef DWARF2_LINENO_DEBUGGING_INFO
27428 /* Allocate the decl_die_table. */
27429 decl_die_table = hash_table<decl_die_hasher>::create_ggc (10);
27431 /* Allocate the decl_loc_table. */
27432 decl_loc_table = hash_table<decl_loc_hasher>::create_ggc (10);
27434 /* Allocate the cached_dw_loc_list_table. */
27435 cached_dw_loc_list_table = hash_table<dw_loc_list_hasher>::create_ggc (10);
27437 /* Allocate the initial hunk of the decl_scope_table. */
27438 vec_alloc (decl_scope_table, 256);
27440 /* Allocate the initial hunk of the abbrev_die_table. */
27441 vec_alloc (abbrev_die_table, 256);
27442 /* Zero-th entry is allocated, but unused. */
27443 abbrev_die_table->quick_push (NULL);
27445 /* Allocate the dwarf_proc_stack_usage_map. */
27446 dwarf_proc_stack_usage_map = new hash_map<dw_die_ref, int>;
27448 /* Allocate the pubtypes and pubnames vectors. */
27449 vec_alloc (pubname_table, 32);
27450 vec_alloc (pubtype_table, 32);
27452 vec_alloc (incomplete_types, 64);
27454 vec_alloc (used_rtx_array, 32);
27456 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
27457 vec_alloc (macinfo_table, 64);
27458 #endif
27460 /* If front-ends already registered a main translation unit but we were not
27461 ready to perform the association, do this now. */
27462 if (main_translation_unit != NULL_TREE)
27463 equate_decl_number_to_die (main_translation_unit, comp_unit_die ());
27466 /* Called before compile () starts outputtting functions, variables
27467 and toplevel asms into assembly. */
27469 static void
27470 dwarf2out_assembly_start (void)
27472 #ifndef DWARF2_LINENO_DEBUGGING_INFO
27473 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (text_section_label, TEXT_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
27474 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (text_end_label, TEXT_END_LABEL, 0);
27475 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (cold_text_section_label,
27476 COLD_TEXT_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
27477 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (cold_end_label, COLD_END_LABEL, 0);
27479 switch_to_section (text_section);
27480 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, text_section_label);
27481 #endif
27483 /* Make sure the line number table for .text always exists. */
27484 text_section_line_info = new_line_info_table ();
27485 text_section_line_info->end_label = text_end_label;
27487 #ifdef DWARF2_LINENO_DEBUGGING_INFO
27488 cur_line_info_table = text_section_line_info;
27489 #endif
27491 if (HAVE_GAS_CFI_SECTIONS_DIRECTIVE
27492 && dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm ()
27493 && (!(flag_unwind_tables || flag_exceptions)
27494 || targetm_common.except_unwind_info (&global_options) != UI_DWARF2))
27495 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_sections\t.debug_frame\n");
27498 /* A helper function for dwarf2out_finish called through
27499 htab_traverse. Assign a string its index. All strings must be
27500 collected into the table by the time index_string is called,
27501 because the indexing code relies on htab_traverse to traverse nodes
27502 in the same order for each run. */
27505 index_string (indirect_string_node **h, unsigned int *index)
27507 indirect_string_node *node = *h;
27509 find_string_form (node);
27510 if (node->form == DW_FORM_GNU_str_index && node->refcount > 0)
27512 gcc_assert (node->index == NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED);
27513 node->index = *index;
27514 *index += 1;
27516 return 1;
27519 /* A helper function for output_indirect_strings called through
27520 htab_traverse. Output the offset to a string and update the
27521 current offset. */
27524 output_index_string_offset (indirect_string_node **h, unsigned int *offset)
27526 indirect_string_node *node = *h;
27528 if (node->form == DW_FORM_GNU_str_index && node->refcount > 0)
27530 /* Assert that this node has been assigned an index. */
27531 gcc_assert (node->index != NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED
27532 && node->index != NOT_INDEXED);
27533 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, *offset,
27534 "indexed string 0x%x: %s", node->index, node->str);
27535 *offset += strlen (node->str) + 1;
27537 return 1;
27540 /* A helper function for dwarf2out_finish called through
27541 htab_traverse. Output the indexed string. */
27544 output_index_string (indirect_string_node **h, unsigned int *cur_idx)
27546 struct indirect_string_node *node = *h;
27548 if (node->form == DW_FORM_GNU_str_index && node->refcount > 0)
27550 /* Assert that the strings are output in the same order as their
27551 indexes were assigned. */
27552 gcc_assert (*cur_idx == node->index);
27553 assemble_string (node->str, strlen (node->str) + 1);
27554 *cur_idx += 1;
27556 return 1;
27559 /* A helper function for dwarf2out_finish called through
27560 htab_traverse. Emit one queued .debug_str string. */
27563 output_indirect_string (indirect_string_node **h, enum dwarf_form form)
27565 struct indirect_string_node *node = *h;
27567 node->form = find_string_form (node);
27568 if (node->form == form && node->refcount > 0)
27570 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, node->label);
27571 assemble_string (node->str, strlen (node->str) + 1);
27574 return 1;
27577 /* Output the indexed string table. */
27579 static void
27580 output_indirect_strings (void)
27582 switch_to_section (debug_str_section);
27583 if (!dwarf_split_debug_info)
27584 debug_str_hash->traverse<enum dwarf_form,
27585 output_indirect_string> (DW_FORM_strp);
27586 else
27588 unsigned int offset = 0;
27589 unsigned int cur_idx = 0;
27591 skeleton_debug_str_hash->traverse<enum dwarf_form,
27592 output_indirect_string> (DW_FORM_strp);
27594 switch_to_section (debug_str_offsets_section);
27595 debug_str_hash->traverse_noresize
27596 <unsigned int *, output_index_string_offset> (&offset);
27597 switch_to_section (debug_str_dwo_section);
27598 debug_str_hash->traverse_noresize<unsigned int *, output_index_string>
27599 (&cur_idx);
27603 /* Callback for htab_traverse to assign an index to an entry in the
27604 table, and to write that entry to the .debug_addr section. */
27607 output_addr_table_entry (addr_table_entry **slot, unsigned int *cur_index)
27609 addr_table_entry *entry = *slot;
27611 if (entry->refcount == 0)
27613 gcc_assert (entry->index == NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED
27614 || entry->index == NOT_INDEXED);
27615 return 1;
27618 gcc_assert (entry->index == *cur_index);
27619 (*cur_index)++;
27621 switch (entry->kind)
27623 case ate_kind_rtx:
27624 dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, entry->addr.rtl,
27625 "0x%x", entry->index);
27626 break;
27627 case ate_kind_rtx_dtprel:
27628 gcc_assert (targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel);
27629 targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel (asm_out_file,
27630 DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
27631 entry->addr.rtl);
27632 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
27633 break;
27634 case ate_kind_label:
27635 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, entry->addr.label,
27636 "0x%x", entry->index);
27637 break;
27638 default:
27639 gcc_unreachable ();
27641 return 1;
27644 /* Produce the .debug_addr section. */
27646 static void
27647 output_addr_table (void)
27649 unsigned int index = 0;
27650 if (addr_index_table == NULL || addr_index_table->size () == 0)
27651 return;
27653 switch_to_section (debug_addr_section);
27654 addr_index_table
27655 ->traverse_noresize<unsigned int *, output_addr_table_entry> (&index);
27658 #if ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING
27659 /* Verify that all marks are clear. */
27661 static void
27662 verify_marks_clear (dw_die_ref die)
27664 dw_die_ref c;
27666 gcc_assert (! die->die_mark);
27667 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, verify_marks_clear (c));
27669 #endif /* ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING */
27671 /* Clear the marks for a die and its children.
27672 Be cool if the mark isn't set. */
27674 static void
27675 prune_unmark_dies (dw_die_ref die)
27677 dw_die_ref c;
27679 if (die->die_mark)
27680 die->die_mark = 0;
27681 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unmark_dies (c));
27684 /* Given LOC that is referenced by a DIE we're marking as used, find all
27685 referenced DWARF procedures it references and mark them as used. */
27687 static void
27688 prune_unused_types_walk_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
27690 for (; loc != NULL; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
27691 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
27693 case DW_OP_implicit_pointer:
27694 case DW_OP_convert:
27695 case DW_OP_reinterpret:
27696 case DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer:
27697 case DW_OP_GNU_convert:
27698 case DW_OP_GNU_reinterpret:
27699 if (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class == dw_val_class_die_ref)
27700 prune_unused_types_mark (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die, 1);
27701 break;
27702 case DW_OP_GNU_variable_value:
27703 if (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class == dw_val_class_decl_ref)
27705 dw_die_ref ref
27706 = lookup_decl_die (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_decl_ref);
27707 if (ref == NULL)
27708 break;
27709 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
27710 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = ref;
27711 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
27713 /* FALLTHRU */
27714 case DW_OP_call2:
27715 case DW_OP_call4:
27716 case DW_OP_call_ref:
27717 case DW_OP_const_type:
27718 case DW_OP_GNU_const_type:
27719 case DW_OP_GNU_parameter_ref:
27720 gcc_assert (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class == dw_val_class_die_ref);
27721 prune_unused_types_mark (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die, 1);
27722 break;
27723 case DW_OP_regval_type:
27724 case DW_OP_deref_type:
27725 case DW_OP_GNU_regval_type:
27726 case DW_OP_GNU_deref_type:
27727 gcc_assert (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class == dw_val_class_die_ref);
27728 prune_unused_types_mark (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_die_ref.die, 1);
27729 break;
27730 case DW_OP_entry_value:
27731 case DW_OP_GNU_entry_value:
27732 gcc_assert (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class == dw_val_class_loc);
27733 prune_unused_types_walk_loc_descr (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc);
27734 break;
27735 default:
27736 break;
27740 /* Given DIE that we're marking as used, find any other dies
27741 it references as attributes and mark them as used. */
27743 static void
27744 prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (dw_die_ref die)
27746 dw_attr_node *a;
27747 unsigned ix;
27749 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
27751 switch (AT_class (a))
27753 /* Make sure DWARF procedures referenced by location descriptions will
27754 get emitted. */
27755 case dw_val_class_loc:
27756 prune_unused_types_walk_loc_descr (AT_loc (a));
27757 break;
27758 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
27759 for (dw_loc_list_ref list = AT_loc_list (a);
27760 list != NULL;
27761 list = list->dw_loc_next)
27762 prune_unused_types_walk_loc_descr (list->expr);
27763 break;
27765 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
27766 /* A reference to another DIE.
27767 Make sure that it will get emitted.
27768 If it was broken out into a comdat group, don't follow it. */
27769 if (! AT_ref (a)->comdat_type_p
27770 || a->dw_attr == DW_AT_specification)
27771 prune_unused_types_mark (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die, 1);
27772 break;
27774 case dw_val_class_str:
27775 /* Set the string's refcount to 0 so that prune_unused_types_mark
27776 accounts properly for it. */
27777 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->refcount = 0;
27778 break;
27780 default:
27781 break;
27786 /* Mark the generic parameters and arguments children DIEs of DIE. */
27788 static void
27789 prune_unused_types_mark_generic_parms_dies (dw_die_ref die)
27791 dw_die_ref c;
27793 if (die == NULL || die->die_child == NULL)
27794 return;
27795 c = die->die_child;
27798 if (is_template_parameter (c))
27799 prune_unused_types_mark (c, 1);
27800 c = c->die_sib;
27801 } while (c && c != die->die_child);
27804 /* Mark DIE as being used. If DOKIDS is true, then walk down
27805 to DIE's children. */
27807 static void
27808 prune_unused_types_mark (dw_die_ref die, int dokids)
27810 dw_die_ref c;
27812 if (die->die_mark == 0)
27814 /* We haven't done this node yet. Mark it as used. */
27815 die->die_mark = 1;
27816 /* If this is the DIE of a generic type instantiation,
27817 mark the children DIEs that describe its generic parms and
27818 args. */
27819 prune_unused_types_mark_generic_parms_dies (die);
27821 /* We also have to mark its parents as used.
27822 (But we don't want to mark our parent's kids due to this,
27823 unless it is a class.) */
27824 if (die->die_parent)
27825 prune_unused_types_mark (die->die_parent,
27826 class_scope_p (die->die_parent));
27828 /* Mark any referenced nodes. */
27829 prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (die);
27831 /* If this node is a specification,
27832 also mark the definition, if it exists. */
27833 if (get_AT_flag (die, DW_AT_declaration) && die->die_definition)
27834 prune_unused_types_mark (die->die_definition, 1);
27837 if (dokids && die->die_mark != 2)
27839 /* We need to walk the children, but haven't done so yet.
27840 Remember that we've walked the kids. */
27841 die->die_mark = 2;
27843 /* If this is an array type, we need to make sure our
27844 kids get marked, even if they're types. If we're
27845 breaking out types into comdat sections, do this
27846 for all type definitions. */
27847 if (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_array_type
27848 || (use_debug_types
27849 && is_type_die (die) && ! is_declaration_die (die)))
27850 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unused_types_mark (c, 1));
27851 else
27852 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unused_types_walk (c));
27856 /* For local classes, look if any static member functions were emitted
27857 and if so, mark them. */
27859 static void
27860 prune_unused_types_walk_local_classes (dw_die_ref die)
27862 dw_die_ref c;
27864 if (die->die_mark == 2)
27865 return;
27867 switch (die->die_tag)
27869 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
27870 case DW_TAG_union_type:
27871 case DW_TAG_class_type:
27872 break;
27874 case DW_TAG_subprogram:
27875 if (!get_AT_flag (die, DW_AT_declaration)
27876 || die->die_definition != NULL)
27877 prune_unused_types_mark (die, 1);
27878 return;
27880 default:
27881 return;
27884 /* Mark children. */
27885 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unused_types_walk_local_classes (c));
27888 /* Walk the tree DIE and mark types that we actually use. */
27890 static void
27891 prune_unused_types_walk (dw_die_ref die)
27893 dw_die_ref c;
27895 /* Don't do anything if this node is already marked and
27896 children have been marked as well. */
27897 if (die->die_mark == 2)
27898 return;
27900 switch (die->die_tag)
27902 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
27903 case DW_TAG_union_type:
27904 case DW_TAG_class_type:
27905 if (die->die_perennial_p)
27906 break;
27908 for (c = die->die_parent; c; c = c->die_parent)
27909 if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram)
27910 break;
27912 /* Finding used static member functions inside of classes
27913 is needed just for local classes, because for other classes
27914 static member function DIEs with DW_AT_specification
27915 are emitted outside of the DW_TAG_*_type. If we ever change
27916 it, we'd need to call this even for non-local classes. */
27917 if (c)
27918 prune_unused_types_walk_local_classes (die);
27920 /* It's a type node --- don't mark it. */
27921 return;
27923 case DW_TAG_const_type:
27924 case DW_TAG_packed_type:
27925 case DW_TAG_pointer_type:
27926 case DW_TAG_reference_type:
27927 case DW_TAG_rvalue_reference_type:
27928 case DW_TAG_volatile_type:
27929 case DW_TAG_typedef:
27930 case DW_TAG_array_type:
27931 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
27932 case DW_TAG_friend:
27933 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
27934 case DW_TAG_subroutine_type:
27935 case DW_TAG_string_type:
27936 case DW_TAG_set_type:
27937 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
27938 case DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type:
27939 case DW_TAG_file_type:
27940 /* Type nodes are useful only when other DIEs reference them --- don't
27941 mark them. */
27942 /* FALLTHROUGH */
27944 case DW_TAG_dwarf_procedure:
27945 /* Likewise for DWARF procedures. */
27947 if (die->die_perennial_p)
27948 break;
27950 return;
27952 default:
27953 /* Mark everything else. */
27954 break;
27957 if (die->die_mark == 0)
27959 die->die_mark = 1;
27961 /* Now, mark any dies referenced from here. */
27962 prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (die);
27965 die->die_mark = 2;
27967 /* Mark children. */
27968 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unused_types_walk (c));
27971 /* Increment the string counts on strings referred to from DIE's
27972 attributes. */
27974 static void
27975 prune_unused_types_update_strings (dw_die_ref die)
27977 dw_attr_node *a;
27978 unsigned ix;
27980 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
27981 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str)
27983 struct indirect_string_node *s = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str;
27984 s->refcount++;
27985 /* Avoid unnecessarily putting strings that are used less than
27986 twice in the hash table. */
27987 if (s->refcount
27988 == ((DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS & SECTION_MERGE) ? 1 : 2))
27990 indirect_string_node **slot
27991 = debug_str_hash->find_slot_with_hash (s->str,
27992 htab_hash_string (s->str),
27993 INSERT);
27994 gcc_assert (*slot == NULL);
27995 *slot = s;
28000 /* Mark DIE and its children as removed. */
28002 static void
28003 mark_removed (dw_die_ref die)
28005 dw_die_ref c;
28006 die->removed = true;
28007 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, mark_removed (c));
28010 /* Remove from the tree DIE any dies that aren't marked. */
28012 static void
28013 prune_unused_types_prune (dw_die_ref die)
28015 dw_die_ref c;
28017 gcc_assert (die->die_mark);
28018 prune_unused_types_update_strings (die);
28020 if (! die->die_child)
28021 return;
28023 c = die->die_child;
28024 do {
28025 dw_die_ref prev = c, next;
28026 for (c = c->die_sib; ! c->die_mark; c = next)
28027 if (c == die->die_child)
28029 /* No marked children between 'prev' and the end of the list. */
28030 if (prev == c)
28031 /* No marked children at all. */
28032 die->die_child = NULL;
28033 else
28035 prev->die_sib = c->die_sib;
28036 die->die_child = prev;
28038 c->die_sib = NULL;
28039 mark_removed (c);
28040 return;
28042 else
28044 next = c->die_sib;
28045 c->die_sib = NULL;
28046 mark_removed (c);
28049 if (c != prev->die_sib)
28050 prev->die_sib = c;
28051 prune_unused_types_prune (c);
28052 } while (c != die->die_child);
28055 /* Remove dies representing declarations that we never use. */
28057 static void
28058 prune_unused_types (void)
28060 unsigned int i;
28061 limbo_die_node *node;
28062 comdat_type_node *ctnode;
28063 pubname_entry *pub;
28064 dw_die_ref base_type;
28066 #if ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING
28067 /* All the marks should already be clear. */
28068 verify_marks_clear (comp_unit_die ());
28069 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
28070 verify_marks_clear (node->die);
28071 for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode; ctnode = ctnode->next)
28072 verify_marks_clear (ctnode->root_die);
28073 #endif /* ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING */
28075 /* Mark types that are used in global variables. */
28076 premark_types_used_by_global_vars ();
28078 /* Set the mark on nodes that are actually used. */
28079 prune_unused_types_walk (comp_unit_die ());
28080 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
28081 prune_unused_types_walk (node->die);
28082 for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode; ctnode = ctnode->next)
28084 prune_unused_types_walk (ctnode->root_die);
28085 prune_unused_types_mark (ctnode->type_die, 1);
28088 /* Also set the mark on nodes referenced from the pubname_table. Enumerators
28089 are unusual in that they are pubnames that are the children of pubtypes.
28090 They should only be marked via their parent DW_TAG_enumeration_type die,
28091 not as roots in themselves. */
28092 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*pubname_table, i, pub)
28093 if (pub->die->die_tag != DW_TAG_enumerator)
28094 prune_unused_types_mark (pub->die, 1);
28095 for (i = 0; base_types.iterate (i, &base_type); i++)
28096 prune_unused_types_mark (base_type, 1);
28098 /* For -fvar-tracking-assignments, also set the mark on nodes that could be
28099 referenced by DW_TAG_call_site DW_AT_call_origin (i.e. direct call
28100 callees). */
28101 cgraph_node *cnode;
28102 FOR_EACH_FUNCTION (cnode)
28103 if (cnode->referred_to_p (false))
28105 dw_die_ref die = lookup_decl_die (cnode->decl);
28106 if (die == NULL || die->die_mark)
28107 continue;
28108 for (cgraph_edge *e = cnode->callers; e; e = e->next_caller)
28109 if (e->caller != cnode
28110 && opt_for_fn (e->caller->decl, flag_var_tracking_assignments))
28112 prune_unused_types_mark (die, 1);
28113 break;
28117 if (debug_str_hash)
28118 debug_str_hash->empty ();
28119 if (skeleton_debug_str_hash)
28120 skeleton_debug_str_hash->empty ();
28121 prune_unused_types_prune (comp_unit_die ());
28122 for (limbo_die_node **pnode = &limbo_die_list; *pnode; )
28124 node = *pnode;
28125 if (!node->die->die_mark)
28126 *pnode = node->next;
28127 else
28129 prune_unused_types_prune (node->die);
28130 pnode = &node->next;
28133 for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode; ctnode = ctnode->next)
28134 prune_unused_types_prune (ctnode->root_die);
28136 /* Leave the marks clear. */
28137 prune_unmark_dies (comp_unit_die ());
28138 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
28139 prune_unmark_dies (node->die);
28140 for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode; ctnode = ctnode->next)
28141 prune_unmark_dies (ctnode->root_die);
28144 /* Helpers to manipulate hash table of comdat type units. */
28146 struct comdat_type_hasher : nofree_ptr_hash <comdat_type_node>
28148 static inline hashval_t hash (const comdat_type_node *);
28149 static inline bool equal (const comdat_type_node *, const comdat_type_node *);
28152 inline hashval_t
28153 comdat_type_hasher::hash (const comdat_type_node *type_node)
28155 hashval_t h;
28156 memcpy (&h, type_node->signature, sizeof (h));
28157 return h;
28160 inline bool
28161 comdat_type_hasher::equal (const comdat_type_node *type_node_1,
28162 const comdat_type_node *type_node_2)
28164 return (! memcmp (type_node_1->signature, type_node_2->signature,
28165 DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE));
28168 /* Move a DW_AT_{,MIPS_}linkage_name attribute just added to dw_die_ref
28169 to the location it would have been added, should we know its
28170 DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME when we added other attributes. This will
28171 probably improve compactness of debug info, removing equivalent
28172 abbrevs, and hide any differences caused by deferring the
28173 computation of the assembler name, triggered by e.g. PCH. */
28175 static inline void
28176 move_linkage_attr (dw_die_ref die)
28178 unsigned ix = vec_safe_length (die->die_attr);
28179 dw_attr_node linkage = (*die->die_attr)[ix - 1];
28181 gcc_assert (linkage.dw_attr == DW_AT_linkage_name
28182 || linkage.dw_attr == DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name);
28184 while (--ix > 0)
28186 dw_attr_node *prev = &(*die->die_attr)[ix - 1];
28188 if (prev->dw_attr == DW_AT_decl_line
28189 || prev->dw_attr == DW_AT_decl_column
28190 || prev->dw_attr == DW_AT_name)
28191 break;
28194 if (ix != vec_safe_length (die->die_attr) - 1)
28196 die->die_attr->pop ();
28197 die->die_attr->quick_insert (ix, linkage);
28201 /* Helper function for resolve_addr, mark DW_TAG_base_type nodes
28202 referenced from typed stack ops and count how often they are used. */
28204 static void
28205 mark_base_types (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
28207 dw_die_ref base_type = NULL;
28209 for (; loc; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
28211 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
28213 case DW_OP_regval_type:
28214 case DW_OP_deref_type:
28215 case DW_OP_GNU_regval_type:
28216 case DW_OP_GNU_deref_type:
28217 base_type = loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_die_ref.die;
28218 break;
28219 case DW_OP_convert:
28220 case DW_OP_reinterpret:
28221 case DW_OP_GNU_convert:
28222 case DW_OP_GNU_reinterpret:
28223 if (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class == dw_val_class_unsigned_const)
28224 continue;
28225 /* FALLTHRU */
28226 case DW_OP_const_type:
28227 case DW_OP_GNU_const_type:
28228 base_type = loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die;
28229 break;
28230 case DW_OP_entry_value:
28231 case DW_OP_GNU_entry_value:
28232 mark_base_types (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc);
28233 continue;
28234 default:
28235 continue;
28237 gcc_assert (base_type->die_parent == comp_unit_die ());
28238 if (base_type->die_mark)
28239 base_type->die_mark++;
28240 else
28242 base_types.safe_push (base_type);
28243 base_type->die_mark = 1;
28248 /* Comparison function for sorting marked base types. */
28250 static int
28251 base_type_cmp (const void *x, const void *y)
28253 dw_die_ref dx = *(const dw_die_ref *) x;
28254 dw_die_ref dy = *(const dw_die_ref *) y;
28255 unsigned int byte_size1, byte_size2;
28256 unsigned int encoding1, encoding2;
28257 unsigned int align1, align2;
28258 if (dx->die_mark > dy->die_mark)
28259 return -1;
28260 if (dx->die_mark < dy->die_mark)
28261 return 1;
28262 byte_size1 = get_AT_unsigned (dx, DW_AT_byte_size);
28263 byte_size2 = get_AT_unsigned (dy, DW_AT_byte_size);
28264 if (byte_size1 < byte_size2)
28265 return 1;
28266 if (byte_size1 > byte_size2)
28267 return -1;
28268 encoding1 = get_AT_unsigned (dx, DW_AT_encoding);
28269 encoding2 = get_AT_unsigned (dy, DW_AT_encoding);
28270 if (encoding1 < encoding2)
28271 return 1;
28272 if (encoding1 > encoding2)
28273 return -1;
28274 align1 = get_AT_unsigned (dx, DW_AT_alignment);
28275 align2 = get_AT_unsigned (dy, DW_AT_alignment);
28276 if (align1 < align2)
28277 return 1;
28278 if (align1 > align2)
28279 return -1;
28280 return 0;
28283 /* Move base types marked by mark_base_types as early as possible
28284 in the CU, sorted by decreasing usage count both to make the
28285 uleb128 references as small as possible and to make sure they
28286 will have die_offset already computed by calc_die_sizes when
28287 sizes of typed stack loc ops is computed. */
28289 static void
28290 move_marked_base_types (void)
28292 unsigned int i;
28293 dw_die_ref base_type, die, c;
28295 if (base_types.is_empty ())
28296 return;
28298 /* Sort by decreasing usage count, they will be added again in that
28299 order later on. */
28300 base_types.qsort (base_type_cmp);
28301 die = comp_unit_die ();
28302 c = die->die_child;
28305 dw_die_ref prev = c;
28306 c = c->die_sib;
28307 while (c->die_mark)
28309 remove_child_with_prev (c, prev);
28310 /* As base types got marked, there must be at least
28311 one node other than DW_TAG_base_type. */
28312 gcc_assert (die->die_child != NULL);
28313 c = prev->die_sib;
28316 while (c != die->die_child);
28317 gcc_assert (die->die_child);
28318 c = die->die_child;
28319 for (i = 0; base_types.iterate (i, &base_type); i++)
28321 base_type->die_mark = 0;
28322 base_type->die_sib = c->die_sib;
28323 c->die_sib = base_type;
28324 c = base_type;
28328 /* Helper function for resolve_addr, attempt to resolve
28329 one CONST_STRING, return true if successful. Similarly verify that
28330 SYMBOL_REFs refer to variables emitted in the current CU. */
28332 static bool
28333 resolve_one_addr (rtx *addr)
28335 rtx rtl = *addr;
28337 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST_STRING)
28339 size_t len = strlen (XSTR (rtl, 0)) + 1;
28340 tree t = build_string (len, XSTR (rtl, 0));
28341 tree tlen = size_int (len - 1);
28342 TREE_TYPE (t)
28343 = build_array_type (char_type_node, build_index_type (tlen));
28344 rtl = lookup_constant_def (t);
28345 if (!rtl || !MEM_P (rtl))
28346 return false;
28347 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
28348 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SYMBOL_REF
28349 && SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl)
28350 && !TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl)))
28351 return false;
28352 vec_safe_push (used_rtx_array, rtl);
28353 *addr = rtl;
28354 return true;
28357 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SYMBOL_REF
28358 && SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl))
28360 if (TREE_CONSTANT_POOL_ADDRESS_P (rtl))
28362 if (!TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (DECL_INITIAL (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl))))
28363 return false;
28365 else if (!TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl)))
28366 return false;
28369 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST)
28371 subrtx_ptr_iterator::array_type array;
28372 FOR_EACH_SUBRTX_PTR (iter, array, &XEXP (rtl, 0), ALL)
28373 if (!resolve_one_addr (*iter))
28374 return false;
28377 return true;
28380 /* For STRING_CST, return SYMBOL_REF of its constant pool entry,
28381 if possible, and create DW_TAG_dwarf_procedure that can be referenced
28382 from DW_OP_implicit_pointer if the string hasn't been seen yet. */
28384 static rtx
28385 string_cst_pool_decl (tree t)
28387 rtx rtl = output_constant_def (t, 1);
28388 unsigned char *array;
28389 dw_loc_descr_ref l;
28390 tree decl;
28391 size_t len;
28392 dw_die_ref ref;
28394 if (!rtl || !MEM_P (rtl))
28395 return NULL_RTX;
28396 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
28397 if (GET_CODE (rtl) != SYMBOL_REF
28398 || SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl) == NULL_TREE)
28399 return NULL_RTX;
28401 decl = SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl);
28402 if (!lookup_decl_die (decl))
28404 len = TREE_STRING_LENGTH (t);
28405 vec_safe_push (used_rtx_array, rtl);
28406 ref = new_die (DW_TAG_dwarf_procedure, comp_unit_die (), decl);
28407 array = ggc_vec_alloc<unsigned char> (len);
28408 memcpy (array, TREE_STRING_POINTER (t), len);
28409 l = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_implicit_value, len, 0);
28410 l->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_vec;
28411 l->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.length = len;
28412 l->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.elt_size = 1;
28413 l->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.array = array;
28414 add_AT_loc (ref, DW_AT_location, l);
28415 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, ref);
28417 return rtl;
28420 /* Helper function of resolve_addr_in_expr. LOC is
28421 a DW_OP_addr followed by DW_OP_stack_value, either at the start
28422 of exprloc or after DW_OP_{,bit_}piece, and val_addr can't be
28423 resolved. Replace it (both DW_OP_addr and DW_OP_stack_value)
28424 with DW_OP_implicit_pointer if possible
28425 and return true, if unsuccessful, return false. */
28427 static bool
28428 optimize_one_addr_into_implicit_ptr (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
28430 rtx rtl = loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr;
28431 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
28432 dw_die_ref ref = NULL;
28433 tree decl;
28435 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST
28436 && GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == PLUS
28437 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (XEXP (rtl, 0), 1)))
28439 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (rtl, 0), 1));
28440 rtl = XEXP (XEXP (rtl, 0), 0);
28442 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST_STRING)
28444 size_t len = strlen (XSTR (rtl, 0)) + 1;
28445 tree t = build_string (len, XSTR (rtl, 0));
28446 tree tlen = size_int (len - 1);
28448 TREE_TYPE (t)
28449 = build_array_type (char_type_node, build_index_type (tlen));
28450 rtl = string_cst_pool_decl (t);
28451 if (!rtl)
28452 return false;
28454 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SYMBOL_REF && SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl))
28456 decl = SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl);
28457 if (VAR_P (decl) && !DECL_EXTERNAL (decl))
28459 ref = lookup_decl_die (decl);
28460 if (ref && (get_AT (ref, DW_AT_location)
28461 || get_AT (ref, DW_AT_const_value)))
28463 loc->dw_loc_opc = dwarf_OP (DW_OP_implicit_pointer);
28464 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
28465 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry = NULL;
28466 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = ref;
28467 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
28468 loc->dw_loc_next = loc->dw_loc_next->dw_loc_next;
28469 loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_int = offset;
28470 return true;
28474 return false;
28477 /* Helper function for resolve_addr, handle one location
28478 expression, return false if at least one CONST_STRING or SYMBOL_REF in
28479 the location list couldn't be resolved. */
28481 static bool
28482 resolve_addr_in_expr (dw_attr_node *a, dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
28484 dw_loc_descr_ref keep = NULL;
28485 for (dw_loc_descr_ref prev = NULL; loc; prev = loc, loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
28486 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
28488 case DW_OP_addr:
28489 if (!resolve_one_addr (&loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr))
28491 if ((prev == NULL
28492 || prev->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_piece
28493 || prev->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_bit_piece)
28494 && loc->dw_loc_next
28495 && loc->dw_loc_next->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_stack_value
28496 && (!dwarf_strict || dwarf_version >= 5)
28497 && optimize_one_addr_into_implicit_ptr (loc))
28498 break;
28499 return false;
28501 break;
28502 case DW_OP_GNU_addr_index:
28503 case DW_OP_GNU_const_index:
28504 if (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_GNU_addr_index
28505 || (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_GNU_const_index && loc->dtprel))
28507 rtx rtl = loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry->addr.rtl;
28508 if (!resolve_one_addr (&rtl))
28509 return false;
28510 remove_addr_table_entry (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry);
28511 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry
28512 = add_addr_table_entry (rtl, ate_kind_rtx);
28514 break;
28515 case DW_OP_const4u:
28516 case DW_OP_const8u:
28517 if (loc->dtprel
28518 && !resolve_one_addr (&loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr))
28519 return false;
28520 break;
28521 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
28522 if (size_of_loc_descr (loc)
28523 > size_of_int_loc_descriptor (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned)
28525 && loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned > 0)
28527 dw_loc_descr_ref repl
28528 = int_loc_descriptor (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
28529 add_loc_descr (&repl, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
28530 add_loc_descr (&repl, loc->dw_loc_next);
28531 *loc = *repl;
28533 break;
28534 case DW_OP_implicit_value:
28535 if (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class == dw_val_class_addr
28536 && !resolve_one_addr (&loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_addr))
28537 return false;
28538 break;
28539 case DW_OP_implicit_pointer:
28540 case DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer:
28541 case DW_OP_GNU_parameter_ref:
28542 case DW_OP_GNU_variable_value:
28543 if (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class == dw_val_class_decl_ref)
28545 dw_die_ref ref
28546 = lookup_decl_die (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_decl_ref);
28547 if (ref == NULL)
28548 return false;
28549 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
28550 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = ref;
28551 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
28553 if (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_GNU_variable_value)
28555 if (prev == NULL
28556 && loc->dw_loc_next == NULL
28557 && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc)
28558 switch (a->dw_attr)
28560 /* Following attributes allow both exprloc and reference,
28561 so if the whole expression is DW_OP_GNU_variable_value
28562 alone we could transform it into reference. */
28563 case DW_AT_byte_size:
28564 case DW_AT_bit_size:
28565 case DW_AT_lower_bound:
28566 case DW_AT_upper_bound:
28567 case DW_AT_bit_stride:
28568 case DW_AT_count:
28569 case DW_AT_allocated:
28570 case DW_AT_associated:
28571 case DW_AT_byte_stride:
28572 a->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
28573 a->dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
28574 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die
28575 = loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die;
28576 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
28577 return true;
28578 default:
28579 break;
28581 if (dwarf_strict)
28582 return false;
28584 break;
28585 case DW_OP_const_type:
28586 case DW_OP_regval_type:
28587 case DW_OP_deref_type:
28588 case DW_OP_convert:
28589 case DW_OP_reinterpret:
28590 case DW_OP_GNU_const_type:
28591 case DW_OP_GNU_regval_type:
28592 case DW_OP_GNU_deref_type:
28593 case DW_OP_GNU_convert:
28594 case DW_OP_GNU_reinterpret:
28595 while (loc->dw_loc_next
28596 && (loc->dw_loc_next->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_convert
28597 || loc->dw_loc_next->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_GNU_convert))
28599 dw_die_ref base1, base2;
28600 unsigned enc1, enc2, size1, size2;
28601 if (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_regval_type
28602 || loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_deref_type
28603 || loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_GNU_regval_type
28604 || loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_GNU_deref_type)
28605 base1 = loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_die_ref.die;
28606 else if (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class
28607 == dw_val_class_unsigned_const)
28608 break;
28609 else
28610 base1 = loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die;
28611 if (loc->dw_loc_next->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class
28612 == dw_val_class_unsigned_const)
28613 break;
28614 base2 = loc->dw_loc_next->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die;
28615 gcc_assert (base1->die_tag == DW_TAG_base_type
28616 && base2->die_tag == DW_TAG_base_type);
28617 enc1 = get_AT_unsigned (base1, DW_AT_encoding);
28618 enc2 = get_AT_unsigned (base2, DW_AT_encoding);
28619 size1 = get_AT_unsigned (base1, DW_AT_byte_size);
28620 size2 = get_AT_unsigned (base2, DW_AT_byte_size);
28621 if (size1 == size2
28622 && (((enc1 == DW_ATE_unsigned || enc1 == DW_ATE_signed)
28623 && (enc2 == DW_ATE_unsigned || enc2 == DW_ATE_signed)
28624 && loc != keep)
28625 || enc1 == enc2))
28627 /* Optimize away next DW_OP_convert after
28628 adjusting LOC's base type die reference. */
28629 if (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_regval_type
28630 || loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_deref_type
28631 || loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_GNU_regval_type
28632 || loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_GNU_deref_type)
28633 loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_die_ref.die = base2;
28634 else
28635 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = base2;
28636 loc->dw_loc_next = loc->dw_loc_next->dw_loc_next;
28637 continue;
28639 /* Don't change integer DW_OP_convert after e.g. floating
28640 point typed stack entry. */
28641 else if (enc1 != DW_ATE_unsigned && enc1 != DW_ATE_signed)
28642 keep = loc->dw_loc_next;
28643 break;
28645 break;
28646 default:
28647 break;
28649 return true;
28652 /* Helper function of resolve_addr. DIE had DW_AT_location of
28653 DW_OP_addr alone, which referred to DECL in DW_OP_addr's operand
28654 and DW_OP_addr couldn't be resolved. resolve_addr has already
28655 removed the DW_AT_location attribute. This function attempts to
28656 add a new DW_AT_location attribute with DW_OP_implicit_pointer
28657 to it or DW_AT_const_value attribute, if possible. */
28659 static void
28660 optimize_location_into_implicit_ptr (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
28662 if (!VAR_P (decl)
28663 || lookup_decl_die (decl) != die
28664 || DECL_EXTERNAL (decl)
28665 || !TREE_STATIC (decl)
28666 || DECL_INITIAL (decl) == NULL_TREE
28667 || DECL_P (DECL_INITIAL (decl))
28668 || get_AT (die, DW_AT_const_value))
28669 return;
28671 tree init = DECL_INITIAL (decl);
28672 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
28673 /* For variables that have been optimized away and thus
28674 don't have a memory location, see if we can emit
28675 DW_AT_const_value instead. */
28676 if (tree_add_const_value_attribute (die, init))
28677 return;
28678 if (dwarf_strict && dwarf_version < 5)
28679 return;
28680 /* If init is ADDR_EXPR or POINTER_PLUS_EXPR of ADDR_EXPR,
28681 and ADDR_EXPR refers to a decl that has DW_AT_location or
28682 DW_AT_const_value (but isn't addressable, otherwise
28683 resolving the original DW_OP_addr wouldn't fail), see if
28684 we can add DW_OP_implicit_pointer. */
28685 STRIP_NOPS (init);
28686 if (TREE_CODE (init) == POINTER_PLUS_EXPR
28687 && tree_fits_shwi_p (TREE_OPERAND (init, 1)))
28689 offset = tree_to_shwi (TREE_OPERAND (init, 1));
28690 init = TREE_OPERAND (init, 0);
28691 STRIP_NOPS (init);
28693 if (TREE_CODE (init) != ADDR_EXPR)
28694 return;
28695 if ((TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (init, 0)) == STRING_CST
28696 && !TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (TREE_OPERAND (init, 0)))
28697 || (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (init, 0)) == VAR_DECL
28698 && !DECL_EXTERNAL (TREE_OPERAND (init, 0))
28699 && TREE_OPERAND (init, 0) != decl))
28701 dw_die_ref ref;
28702 dw_loc_descr_ref l;
28704 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (init, 0)) == STRING_CST)
28706 rtx rtl = string_cst_pool_decl (TREE_OPERAND (init, 0));
28707 if (!rtl)
28708 return;
28709 decl = SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl);
28711 else
28712 decl = TREE_OPERAND (init, 0);
28713 ref = lookup_decl_die (decl);
28714 if (ref == NULL
28715 || (!get_AT (ref, DW_AT_location)
28716 && !get_AT (ref, DW_AT_const_value)))
28717 return;
28718 l = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_implicit_pointer), 0, offset);
28719 l->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
28720 l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = ref;
28721 l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
28722 add_AT_loc (die, DW_AT_location, l);
28726 /* Return NULL if l is a DWARF expression, or first op that is not
28727 valid DWARF expression. */
28729 static dw_loc_descr_ref
28730 non_dwarf_expression (dw_loc_descr_ref l)
28732 while (l)
28734 if (l->dw_loc_opc >= DW_OP_reg0 && l->dw_loc_opc <= DW_OP_reg31)
28735 return l;
28736 switch (l->dw_loc_opc)
28738 case DW_OP_regx:
28739 case DW_OP_implicit_value:
28740 case DW_OP_stack_value:
28741 case DW_OP_implicit_pointer:
28742 case DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer:
28743 case DW_OP_GNU_parameter_ref:
28744 case DW_OP_piece:
28745 case DW_OP_bit_piece:
28746 return l;
28747 default:
28748 break;
28750 l = l->dw_loc_next;
28752 return NULL;
28755 /* Return adjusted copy of EXPR:
28756 If it is empty DWARF expression, return it.
28757 If it is valid non-empty DWARF expression,
28758 return copy of EXPR with DW_OP_deref appended to it.
28759 If it is DWARF expression followed by DW_OP_reg{N,x}, return
28760 copy of the DWARF expression with DW_OP_breg{N,x} <0> appended.
28761 If it is DWARF expression followed by DW_OP_stack_value, return
28762 copy of the DWARF expression without anything appended.
28763 Otherwise, return NULL. */
28765 static dw_loc_descr_ref
28766 copy_deref_exprloc (dw_loc_descr_ref expr)
28768 dw_loc_descr_ref tail = NULL;
28770 if (expr == NULL)
28771 return NULL;
28773 dw_loc_descr_ref l = non_dwarf_expression (expr);
28774 if (l && l->dw_loc_next)
28775 return NULL;
28777 if (l)
28779 if (l->dw_loc_opc >= DW_OP_reg0 && l->dw_loc_opc <= DW_OP_reg31)
28780 tail = new_loc_descr ((enum dwarf_location_atom)
28781 (DW_OP_breg0 + (l->dw_loc_opc - DW_OP_reg0)),
28782 0, 0);
28783 else
28784 switch (l->dw_loc_opc)
28786 case DW_OP_regx:
28787 tail = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bregx,
28788 l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned, 0);
28789 break;
28790 case DW_OP_stack_value:
28791 break;
28792 default:
28793 return NULL;
28796 else
28797 tail = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0);
28799 dw_loc_descr_ref ret = NULL, *p = &ret;
28800 while (expr != l)
28802 *p = new_loc_descr (expr->dw_loc_opc, 0, 0);
28803 (*p)->dw_loc_oprnd1 = expr->dw_loc_oprnd1;
28804 (*p)->dw_loc_oprnd2 = expr->dw_loc_oprnd2;
28805 p = &(*p)->dw_loc_next;
28806 expr = expr->dw_loc_next;
28808 *p = tail;
28809 return ret;
28812 /* For DW_AT_string_length attribute with DW_OP_GNU_variable_value
28813 reference to a variable or argument, adjust it if needed and return:
28814 -1 if the DW_AT_string_length attribute and DW_AT_{string_length_,}byte_size
28815 attribute if present should be removed
28816 0 keep the attribute perhaps with minor modifications, no need to rescan
28817 1 if the attribute has been successfully adjusted. */
28819 static int
28820 optimize_string_length (dw_attr_node *a)
28822 dw_loc_descr_ref l = AT_loc (a), lv;
28823 dw_die_ref die;
28824 if (l->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class == dw_val_class_decl_ref)
28826 tree decl = l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_decl_ref;
28827 die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
28828 if (die)
28830 l->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
28831 l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = die;
28832 l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
28834 else
28835 return -1;
28837 else
28838 die = l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die;
28840 /* DWARF5 allows reference class, so we can then reference the DIE.
28841 Only do this for DW_OP_GNU_variable_value DW_OP_stack_value. */
28842 if (l->dw_loc_next != NULL && dwarf_version >= 5)
28844 a->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
28845 a->dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
28846 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die = die;
28847 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
28848 return 0;
28851 dw_attr_node *av = get_AT (die, DW_AT_location);
28852 dw_loc_list_ref d;
28853 bool non_dwarf_expr = false;
28855 if (av == NULL)
28856 return dwarf_strict ? -1 : 0;
28857 switch (AT_class (av))
28859 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
28860 for (d = AT_loc_list (av); d != NULL; d = d->dw_loc_next)
28861 if (d->expr && non_dwarf_expression (d->expr))
28862 non_dwarf_expr = true;
28863 break;
28864 case dw_val_class_loc:
28865 lv = AT_loc (av);
28866 if (lv == NULL)
28867 return dwarf_strict ? -1 : 0;
28868 if (non_dwarf_expression (lv))
28869 non_dwarf_expr = true;
28870 break;
28871 default:
28872 return dwarf_strict ? -1 : 0;
28875 /* If it is safe to transform DW_OP_GNU_variable_value DW_OP_stack_value
28876 into DW_OP_call4 or DW_OP_GNU_variable_value into
28877 DW_OP_call4 DW_OP_deref, do so. */
28878 if (!non_dwarf_expr
28879 && (l->dw_loc_next != NULL || AT_class (av) == dw_val_class_loc))
28881 l->dw_loc_opc = DW_OP_call4;
28882 if (l->dw_loc_next)
28883 l->dw_loc_next = NULL;
28884 else
28885 l->dw_loc_next = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0);
28886 return 0;
28889 /* For DW_OP_GNU_variable_value DW_OP_stack_value, we can just
28890 copy over the DW_AT_location attribute from die to a. */
28891 if (l->dw_loc_next != NULL)
28893 a->dw_attr_val = av->dw_attr_val;
28894 return 1;
28897 dw_loc_list_ref list, *p;
28898 switch (AT_class (av))
28900 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
28901 p = &list;
28902 list = NULL;
28903 for (d = AT_loc_list (av); d != NULL; d = d->dw_loc_next)
28905 lv = copy_deref_exprloc (d->expr);
28906 if (lv)
28908 *p = new_loc_list (lv, d->begin, d->end, d->section);
28909 p = &(*p)->dw_loc_next;
28911 else if (!dwarf_strict && d->expr)
28912 return 0;
28914 if (list == NULL)
28915 return dwarf_strict ? -1 : 0;
28916 a->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_loc_list;
28917 gen_llsym (list);
28918 *AT_loc_list_ptr (a) = list;
28919 return 1;
28920 case dw_val_class_loc:
28921 lv = copy_deref_exprloc (AT_loc (av));
28922 if (lv == NULL)
28923 return dwarf_strict ? -1 : 0;
28924 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc = lv;
28925 return 1;
28926 default:
28927 gcc_unreachable ();
28931 /* Resolve DW_OP_addr and DW_AT_const_value CONST_STRING arguments to
28932 an address in .rodata section if the string literal is emitted there,
28933 or remove the containing location list or replace DW_AT_const_value
28934 with DW_AT_location and empty location expression, if it isn't found
28935 in .rodata. Similarly for SYMBOL_REFs, keep only those that refer
28936 to something that has been emitted in the current CU. */
28938 static void
28939 resolve_addr (dw_die_ref die)
28941 dw_die_ref c;
28942 dw_attr_node *a;
28943 dw_loc_list_ref *curr, *start, loc;
28944 unsigned ix;
28945 bool remove_AT_byte_size = false;
28947 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
28948 switch (AT_class (a))
28950 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
28951 start = curr = AT_loc_list_ptr (a);
28952 loc = *curr;
28953 gcc_assert (loc);
28954 /* The same list can be referenced more than once. See if we have
28955 already recorded the result from a previous pass. */
28956 if (loc->replaced)
28957 *curr = loc->dw_loc_next;
28958 else if (!loc->resolved_addr)
28960 /* As things stand, we do not expect or allow one die to
28961 reference a suffix of another die's location list chain.
28962 References must be identical or completely separate.
28963 There is therefore no need to cache the result of this
28964 pass on any list other than the first; doing so
28965 would lead to unnecessary writes. */
28966 while (*curr)
28968 gcc_assert (!(*curr)->replaced && !(*curr)->resolved_addr);
28969 if (!resolve_addr_in_expr (a, (*curr)->expr))
28971 dw_loc_list_ref next = (*curr)->dw_loc_next;
28972 dw_loc_descr_ref l = (*curr)->expr;
28974 if (next && (*curr)->ll_symbol)
28976 gcc_assert (!next->ll_symbol);
28977 next->ll_symbol = (*curr)->ll_symbol;
28979 if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
28980 remove_loc_list_addr_table_entries (l);
28981 *curr = next;
28983 else
28985 mark_base_types ((*curr)->expr);
28986 curr = &(*curr)->dw_loc_next;
28989 if (loc == *start)
28990 loc->resolved_addr = 1;
28991 else
28993 loc->replaced = 1;
28994 loc->dw_loc_next = *start;
28997 if (!*start)
28999 remove_AT (die, a->dw_attr);
29000 ix--;
29002 break;
29003 case dw_val_class_loc:
29005 dw_loc_descr_ref l = AT_loc (a);
29006 /* DW_OP_GNU_variable_value DW_OP_stack_value or
29007 DW_OP_GNU_variable_value in DW_AT_string_length can be converted
29008 into DW_OP_call4 or DW_OP_call4 DW_OP_deref, which is standard
29009 DWARF4 unlike DW_OP_GNU_variable_value. Or for DWARF5
29010 DW_OP_GNU_variable_value DW_OP_stack_value can be replaced
29011 with DW_FORM_ref referencing the same DIE as
29012 DW_OP_GNU_variable_value used to reference. */
29013 if (a->dw_attr == DW_AT_string_length
29014 && l
29015 && l->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_GNU_variable_value
29016 && (l->dw_loc_next == NULL
29017 || (l->dw_loc_next->dw_loc_next == NULL
29018 && l->dw_loc_next->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_stack_value)))
29020 switch (optimize_string_length (a))
29022 case -1:
29023 remove_AT (die, a->dw_attr);
29024 ix--;
29025 /* If we drop DW_AT_string_length, we need to drop also
29026 DW_AT_{string_length_,}byte_size. */
29027 remove_AT_byte_size = true;
29028 continue;
29029 default:
29030 break;
29031 case 1:
29032 /* Even if we keep the optimized DW_AT_string_length,
29033 it might have changed AT_class, so process it again. */
29034 ix--;
29035 continue;
29038 /* For -gdwarf-2 don't attempt to optimize
29039 DW_AT_data_member_location containing
29040 DW_OP_plus_uconst - older consumers might
29041 rely on it being that op instead of a more complex,
29042 but shorter, location description. */
29043 if ((dwarf_version > 2
29044 || a->dw_attr != DW_AT_data_member_location
29045 || l == NULL
29046 || l->dw_loc_opc != DW_OP_plus_uconst
29047 || l->dw_loc_next != NULL)
29048 && !resolve_addr_in_expr (a, l))
29050 if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
29051 remove_loc_list_addr_table_entries (l);
29052 if (l != NULL
29053 && l->dw_loc_next == NULL
29054 && l->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_addr
29055 && GET_CODE (l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr) == SYMBOL_REF
29056 && SYMBOL_REF_DECL (l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr)
29057 && a->dw_attr == DW_AT_location)
29059 tree decl = SYMBOL_REF_DECL (l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr);
29060 remove_AT (die, a->dw_attr);
29061 ix--;
29062 optimize_location_into_implicit_ptr (die, decl);
29063 break;
29065 if (a->dw_attr == DW_AT_string_length)
29066 /* If we drop DW_AT_string_length, we need to drop also
29067 DW_AT_{string_length_,}byte_size. */
29068 remove_AT_byte_size = true;
29069 remove_AT (die, a->dw_attr);
29070 ix--;
29072 else
29073 mark_base_types (l);
29075 break;
29076 case dw_val_class_addr:
29077 if (a->dw_attr == DW_AT_const_value
29078 && !resolve_one_addr (&a->dw_attr_val.v.val_addr))
29080 if (AT_index (a) != NOT_INDEXED)
29081 remove_addr_table_entry (a->dw_attr_val.val_entry);
29082 remove_AT (die, a->dw_attr);
29083 ix--;
29085 if ((die->die_tag == DW_TAG_call_site
29086 && a->dw_attr == DW_AT_call_origin)
29087 || (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_call_site
29088 && a->dw_attr == DW_AT_abstract_origin))
29090 tree tdecl = SYMBOL_REF_DECL (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_addr);
29091 dw_die_ref tdie = lookup_decl_die (tdecl);
29092 dw_die_ref cdie;
29093 if (tdie == NULL
29094 && DECL_EXTERNAL (tdecl)
29095 && DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (tdecl) == NULL_TREE
29096 && (cdie = lookup_context_die (DECL_CONTEXT (tdecl))))
29098 dw_die_ref pdie = cdie;
29099 /* Make sure we don't add these DIEs into type units.
29100 We could emit skeleton DIEs for context (namespaces,
29101 outer structs/classes) and a skeleton DIE for the
29102 innermost context with DW_AT_signature pointing to the
29103 type unit. See PR78835. */
29104 while (pdie && pdie->die_tag != DW_TAG_type_unit)
29105 pdie = pdie->die_parent;
29106 if (pdie == NULL)
29108 /* Creating a full DIE for tdecl is overly expensive and
29109 at this point even wrong when in the LTO phase
29110 as it can end up generating new type DIEs we didn't
29111 output and thus optimize_external_refs will crash. */
29112 tdie = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram, cdie, NULL_TREE);
29113 add_AT_flag (tdie, DW_AT_external, 1);
29114 add_AT_flag (tdie, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
29115 add_linkage_attr (tdie, tdecl);
29116 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (tdie, tdecl, true);
29117 equate_decl_number_to_die (tdecl, tdie);
29120 if (tdie)
29122 a->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
29123 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die = tdie;
29124 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
29126 else
29128 if (AT_index (a) != NOT_INDEXED)
29129 remove_addr_table_entry (a->dw_attr_val.val_entry);
29130 remove_AT (die, a->dw_attr);
29131 ix--;
29134 break;
29135 default:
29136 break;
29139 if (remove_AT_byte_size)
29140 remove_AT (die, dwarf_version >= 5
29141 ? DW_AT_string_length_byte_size
29142 : DW_AT_byte_size);
29144 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, resolve_addr (c));
29147 /* Helper routines for optimize_location_lists.
29148 This pass tries to share identical local lists in .debug_loc
29149 section. */
29151 /* Iteratively hash operands of LOC opcode into HSTATE. */
29153 static void
29154 hash_loc_operands (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, inchash::hash &hstate)
29156 dw_val_ref val1 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd1;
29157 dw_val_ref val2 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd2;
29159 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
29161 case DW_OP_const4u:
29162 case DW_OP_const8u:
29163 if (loc->dtprel)
29164 goto hash_addr;
29165 /* FALLTHRU */
29166 case DW_OP_const1u:
29167 case DW_OP_const1s:
29168 case DW_OP_const2u:
29169 case DW_OP_const2s:
29170 case DW_OP_const4s:
29171 case DW_OP_const8s:
29172 case DW_OP_constu:
29173 case DW_OP_consts:
29174 case DW_OP_pick:
29175 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
29176 case DW_OP_breg0:
29177 case DW_OP_breg1:
29178 case DW_OP_breg2:
29179 case DW_OP_breg3:
29180 case DW_OP_breg4:
29181 case DW_OP_breg5:
29182 case DW_OP_breg6:
29183 case DW_OP_breg7:
29184 case DW_OP_breg8:
29185 case DW_OP_breg9:
29186 case DW_OP_breg10:
29187 case DW_OP_breg11:
29188 case DW_OP_breg12:
29189 case DW_OP_breg13:
29190 case DW_OP_breg14:
29191 case DW_OP_breg15:
29192 case DW_OP_breg16:
29193 case DW_OP_breg17:
29194 case DW_OP_breg18:
29195 case DW_OP_breg19:
29196 case DW_OP_breg20:
29197 case DW_OP_breg21:
29198 case DW_OP_breg22:
29199 case DW_OP_breg23:
29200 case DW_OP_breg24:
29201 case DW_OP_breg25:
29202 case DW_OP_breg26:
29203 case DW_OP_breg27:
29204 case DW_OP_breg28:
29205 case DW_OP_breg29:
29206 case DW_OP_breg30:
29207 case DW_OP_breg31:
29208 case DW_OP_regx:
29209 case DW_OP_fbreg:
29210 case DW_OP_piece:
29211 case DW_OP_deref_size:
29212 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
29213 hstate.add_object (val1->v.val_int);
29214 break;
29215 case DW_OP_skip:
29216 case DW_OP_bra:
29218 int offset;
29220 gcc_assert (val1->val_class == dw_val_class_loc);
29221 offset = val1->v.val_loc->dw_loc_addr - (loc->dw_loc_addr + 3);
29222 hstate.add_object (offset);
29224 break;
29225 case DW_OP_implicit_value:
29226 hstate.add_object (val1->v.val_unsigned);
29227 switch (val2->val_class)
29229 case dw_val_class_const:
29230 hstate.add_object (val2->v.val_int);
29231 break;
29232 case dw_val_class_vec:
29234 unsigned int elt_size = val2->v.val_vec.elt_size;
29235 unsigned int len = val2->v.val_vec.length;
29237 hstate.add_int (elt_size);
29238 hstate.add_int (len);
29239 hstate.add (val2->v.val_vec.array, len * elt_size);
29241 break;
29242 case dw_val_class_const_double:
29243 hstate.add_object (val2->v.val_double.low);
29244 hstate.add_object (val2->v.val_double.high);
29245 break;
29246 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
29247 hstate.add (val2->v.val_wide->get_val (),
29248 get_full_len (*val2->v.val_wide)
29249 * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR);
29250 break;
29251 case dw_val_class_addr:
29252 inchash::add_rtx (val2->v.val_addr, hstate);
29253 break;
29254 default:
29255 gcc_unreachable ();
29257 break;
29258 case DW_OP_bregx:
29259 case DW_OP_bit_piece:
29260 hstate.add_object (val1->v.val_int);
29261 hstate.add_object (val2->v.val_int);
29262 break;
29263 case DW_OP_addr:
29264 hash_addr:
29265 if (loc->dtprel)
29267 unsigned char dtprel = 0xd1;
29268 hstate.add_object (dtprel);
29270 inchash::add_rtx (val1->v.val_addr, hstate);
29271 break;
29272 case DW_OP_GNU_addr_index:
29273 case DW_OP_GNU_const_index:
29275 if (loc->dtprel)
29277 unsigned char dtprel = 0xd1;
29278 hstate.add_object (dtprel);
29280 inchash::add_rtx (val1->val_entry->addr.rtl, hstate);
29282 break;
29283 case DW_OP_implicit_pointer:
29284 case DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer:
29285 hstate.add_int (val2->v.val_int);
29286 break;
29287 case DW_OP_entry_value:
29288 case DW_OP_GNU_entry_value:
29289 hstate.add_object (val1->v.val_loc);
29290 break;
29291 case DW_OP_regval_type:
29292 case DW_OP_deref_type:
29293 case DW_OP_GNU_regval_type:
29294 case DW_OP_GNU_deref_type:
29296 unsigned int byte_size
29297 = get_AT_unsigned (val2->v.val_die_ref.die, DW_AT_byte_size);
29298 unsigned int encoding
29299 = get_AT_unsigned (val2->v.val_die_ref.die, DW_AT_encoding);
29300 hstate.add_object (val1->v.val_int);
29301 hstate.add_object (byte_size);
29302 hstate.add_object (encoding);
29304 break;
29305 case DW_OP_convert:
29306 case DW_OP_reinterpret:
29307 case DW_OP_GNU_convert:
29308 case DW_OP_GNU_reinterpret:
29309 if (val1->val_class == dw_val_class_unsigned_const)
29311 hstate.add_object (val1->v.val_unsigned);
29312 break;
29314 /* FALLTHRU */
29315 case DW_OP_const_type:
29316 case DW_OP_GNU_const_type:
29318 unsigned int byte_size
29319 = get_AT_unsigned (val1->v.val_die_ref.die, DW_AT_byte_size);
29320 unsigned int encoding
29321 = get_AT_unsigned (val1->v.val_die_ref.die, DW_AT_encoding);
29322 hstate.add_object (byte_size);
29323 hstate.add_object (encoding);
29324 if (loc->dw_loc_opc != DW_OP_const_type
29325 && loc->dw_loc_opc != DW_OP_GNU_const_type)
29326 break;
29327 hstate.add_object (val2->val_class);
29328 switch (val2->val_class)
29330 case dw_val_class_const:
29331 hstate.add_object (val2->v.val_int);
29332 break;
29333 case dw_val_class_vec:
29335 unsigned int elt_size = val2->v.val_vec.elt_size;
29336 unsigned int len = val2->v.val_vec.length;
29338 hstate.add_object (elt_size);
29339 hstate.add_object (len);
29340 hstate.add (val2->v.val_vec.array, len * elt_size);
29342 break;
29343 case dw_val_class_const_double:
29344 hstate.add_object (val2->v.val_double.low);
29345 hstate.add_object (val2->v.val_double.high);
29346 break;
29347 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
29348 hstate.add (val2->v.val_wide->get_val (),
29349 get_full_len (*val2->v.val_wide)
29350 * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR);
29351 break;
29352 default:
29353 gcc_unreachable ();
29356 break;
29358 default:
29359 /* Other codes have no operands. */
29360 break;
29364 /* Iteratively hash the whole DWARF location expression LOC into HSTATE. */
29366 static inline void
29367 hash_locs (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, inchash::hash &hstate)
29369 dw_loc_descr_ref l;
29370 bool sizes_computed = false;
29371 /* Compute sizes, so that DW_OP_skip/DW_OP_bra can be checksummed. */
29372 size_of_locs (loc);
29374 for (l = loc; l != NULL; l = l->dw_loc_next)
29376 enum dwarf_location_atom opc = l->dw_loc_opc;
29377 hstate.add_object (opc);
29378 if ((opc == DW_OP_skip || opc == DW_OP_bra) && !sizes_computed)
29380 size_of_locs (loc);
29381 sizes_computed = true;
29383 hash_loc_operands (l, hstate);
29387 /* Compute hash of the whole location list LIST_HEAD. */
29389 static inline void
29390 hash_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref list_head)
29392 dw_loc_list_ref curr = list_head;
29393 inchash::hash hstate;
29395 for (curr = list_head; curr != NULL; curr = curr->dw_loc_next)
29397 hstate.add (curr->begin, strlen (curr->begin) + 1);
29398 hstate.add (curr->end, strlen (curr->end) + 1);
29399 if (curr->section)
29400 hstate.add (curr->section, strlen (curr->section) + 1);
29401 hash_locs (curr->expr, hstate);
29403 list_head->hash = hstate.end ();
29406 /* Return true if X and Y opcodes have the same operands. */
29408 static inline bool
29409 compare_loc_operands (dw_loc_descr_ref x, dw_loc_descr_ref y)
29411 dw_val_ref valx1 = &x->dw_loc_oprnd1;
29412 dw_val_ref valx2 = &x->dw_loc_oprnd2;
29413 dw_val_ref valy1 = &y->dw_loc_oprnd1;
29414 dw_val_ref valy2 = &y->dw_loc_oprnd2;
29416 switch (x->dw_loc_opc)
29418 case DW_OP_const4u:
29419 case DW_OP_const8u:
29420 if (x->dtprel)
29421 goto hash_addr;
29422 /* FALLTHRU */
29423 case DW_OP_const1u:
29424 case DW_OP_const1s:
29425 case DW_OP_const2u:
29426 case DW_OP_const2s:
29427 case DW_OP_const4s:
29428 case DW_OP_const8s:
29429 case DW_OP_constu:
29430 case DW_OP_consts:
29431 case DW_OP_pick:
29432 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
29433 case DW_OP_breg0:
29434 case DW_OP_breg1:
29435 case DW_OP_breg2:
29436 case DW_OP_breg3:
29437 case DW_OP_breg4:
29438 case DW_OP_breg5:
29439 case DW_OP_breg6:
29440 case DW_OP_breg7:
29441 case DW_OP_breg8:
29442 case DW_OP_breg9:
29443 case DW_OP_breg10:
29444 case DW_OP_breg11:
29445 case DW_OP_breg12:
29446 case DW_OP_breg13:
29447 case DW_OP_breg14:
29448 case DW_OP_breg15:
29449 case DW_OP_breg16:
29450 case DW_OP_breg17:
29451 case DW_OP_breg18:
29452 case DW_OP_breg19:
29453 case DW_OP_breg20:
29454 case DW_OP_breg21:
29455 case DW_OP_breg22:
29456 case DW_OP_breg23:
29457 case DW_OP_breg24:
29458 case DW_OP_breg25:
29459 case DW_OP_breg26:
29460 case DW_OP_breg27:
29461 case DW_OP_breg28:
29462 case DW_OP_breg29:
29463 case DW_OP_breg30:
29464 case DW_OP_breg31:
29465 case DW_OP_regx:
29466 case DW_OP_fbreg:
29467 case DW_OP_piece:
29468 case DW_OP_deref_size:
29469 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
29470 return valx1->v.val_int == valy1->v.val_int;
29471 case DW_OP_skip:
29472 case DW_OP_bra:
29473 /* If splitting debug info, the use of DW_OP_GNU_addr_index
29474 can cause irrelevant differences in dw_loc_addr. */
29475 gcc_assert (valx1->val_class == dw_val_class_loc
29476 && valy1->val_class == dw_val_class_loc
29477 && (dwarf_split_debug_info
29478 || x->dw_loc_addr == y->dw_loc_addr));
29479 return valx1->v.val_loc->dw_loc_addr == valy1->v.val_loc->dw_loc_addr;
29480 case DW_OP_implicit_value:
29481 if (valx1->v.val_unsigned != valy1->v.val_unsigned
29482 || valx2->val_class != valy2->val_class)
29483 return false;
29484 switch (valx2->val_class)
29486 case dw_val_class_const:
29487 return valx2->v.val_int == valy2->v.val_int;
29488 case dw_val_class_vec:
29489 return valx2->v.val_vec.elt_size == valy2->v.val_vec.elt_size
29490 && valx2->v.val_vec.length == valy2->v.val_vec.length
29491 && memcmp (valx2->v.val_vec.array, valy2->v.val_vec.array,
29492 valx2->v.val_vec.elt_size
29493 * valx2->v.val_vec.length) == 0;
29494 case dw_val_class_const_double:
29495 return valx2->v.val_double.low == valy2->v.val_double.low
29496 && valx2->v.val_double.high == valy2->v.val_double.high;
29497 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
29498 return *valx2->v.val_wide == *valy2->v.val_wide;
29499 case dw_val_class_addr:
29500 return rtx_equal_p (valx2->v.val_addr, valy2->v.val_addr);
29501 default:
29502 gcc_unreachable ();
29504 case DW_OP_bregx:
29505 case DW_OP_bit_piece:
29506 return valx1->v.val_int == valy1->v.val_int
29507 && valx2->v.val_int == valy2->v.val_int;
29508 case DW_OP_addr:
29509 hash_addr:
29510 return rtx_equal_p (valx1->v.val_addr, valy1->v.val_addr);
29511 case DW_OP_GNU_addr_index:
29512 case DW_OP_GNU_const_index:
29514 rtx ax1 = valx1->val_entry->addr.rtl;
29515 rtx ay1 = valy1->val_entry->addr.rtl;
29516 return rtx_equal_p (ax1, ay1);
29518 case DW_OP_implicit_pointer:
29519 case DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer:
29520 return valx1->val_class == dw_val_class_die_ref
29521 && valx1->val_class == valy1->val_class
29522 && valx1->v.val_die_ref.die == valy1->v.val_die_ref.die
29523 && valx2->v.val_int == valy2->v.val_int;
29524 case DW_OP_entry_value:
29525 case DW_OP_GNU_entry_value:
29526 return compare_loc_operands (valx1->v.val_loc, valy1->v.val_loc);
29527 case DW_OP_const_type:
29528 case DW_OP_GNU_const_type:
29529 if (valx1->v.val_die_ref.die != valy1->v.val_die_ref.die
29530 || valx2->val_class != valy2->val_class)
29531 return false;
29532 switch (valx2->val_class)
29534 case dw_val_class_const:
29535 return valx2->v.val_int == valy2->v.val_int;
29536 case dw_val_class_vec:
29537 return valx2->v.val_vec.elt_size == valy2->v.val_vec.elt_size
29538 && valx2->v.val_vec.length == valy2->v.val_vec.length
29539 && memcmp (valx2->v.val_vec.array, valy2->v.val_vec.array,
29540 valx2->v.val_vec.elt_size
29541 * valx2->v.val_vec.length) == 0;
29542 case dw_val_class_const_double:
29543 return valx2->v.val_double.low == valy2->v.val_double.low
29544 && valx2->v.val_double.high == valy2->v.val_double.high;
29545 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
29546 return *valx2->v.val_wide == *valy2->v.val_wide;
29547 default:
29548 gcc_unreachable ();
29550 case DW_OP_regval_type:
29551 case DW_OP_deref_type:
29552 case DW_OP_GNU_regval_type:
29553 case DW_OP_GNU_deref_type:
29554 return valx1->v.val_int == valy1->v.val_int
29555 && valx2->v.val_die_ref.die == valy2->v.val_die_ref.die;
29556 case DW_OP_convert:
29557 case DW_OP_reinterpret:
29558 case DW_OP_GNU_convert:
29559 case DW_OP_GNU_reinterpret:
29560 if (valx1->val_class != valy1->val_class)
29561 return false;
29562 if (valx1->val_class == dw_val_class_unsigned_const)
29563 return valx1->v.val_unsigned == valy1->v.val_unsigned;
29564 return valx1->v.val_die_ref.die == valy1->v.val_die_ref.die;
29565 case DW_OP_GNU_parameter_ref:
29566 return valx1->val_class == dw_val_class_die_ref
29567 && valx1->val_class == valy1->val_class
29568 && valx1->v.val_die_ref.die == valy1->v.val_die_ref.die;
29569 default:
29570 /* Other codes have no operands. */
29571 return true;
29575 /* Return true if DWARF location expressions X and Y are the same. */
29577 static inline bool
29578 compare_locs (dw_loc_descr_ref x, dw_loc_descr_ref y)
29580 for (; x != NULL && y != NULL; x = x->dw_loc_next, y = y->dw_loc_next)
29581 if (x->dw_loc_opc != y->dw_loc_opc
29582 || x->dtprel != y->dtprel
29583 || !compare_loc_operands (x, y))
29584 break;
29585 return x == NULL && y == NULL;
29588 /* Hashtable helpers. */
29590 struct loc_list_hasher : nofree_ptr_hash <dw_loc_list_struct>
29592 static inline hashval_t hash (const dw_loc_list_struct *);
29593 static inline bool equal (const dw_loc_list_struct *,
29594 const dw_loc_list_struct *);
29597 /* Return precomputed hash of location list X. */
29599 inline hashval_t
29600 loc_list_hasher::hash (const dw_loc_list_struct *x)
29602 return x->hash;
29605 /* Return true if location lists A and B are the same. */
29607 inline bool
29608 loc_list_hasher::equal (const dw_loc_list_struct *a,
29609 const dw_loc_list_struct *b)
29611 if (a == b)
29612 return 1;
29613 if (a->hash != b->hash)
29614 return 0;
29615 for (; a != NULL && b != NULL; a = a->dw_loc_next, b = b->dw_loc_next)
29616 if (strcmp (a->begin, b->begin) != 0
29617 || strcmp (a->end, b->end) != 0
29618 || (a->section == NULL) != (b->section == NULL)
29619 || (a->section && strcmp (a->section, b->section) != 0)
29620 || !compare_locs (a->expr, b->expr))
29621 break;
29622 return a == NULL && b == NULL;
29625 typedef hash_table<loc_list_hasher> loc_list_hash_type;
29628 /* Recursively optimize location lists referenced from DIE
29629 children and share them whenever possible. */
29631 static void
29632 optimize_location_lists_1 (dw_die_ref die, loc_list_hash_type *htab)
29634 dw_die_ref c;
29635 dw_attr_node *a;
29636 unsigned ix;
29637 dw_loc_list_struct **slot;
29639 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
29640 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc_list)
29642 dw_loc_list_ref list = AT_loc_list (a);
29643 /* TODO: perform some optimizations here, before hashing
29644 it and storing into the hash table. */
29645 hash_loc_list (list);
29646 slot = htab->find_slot_with_hash (list, list->hash, INSERT);
29647 if (*slot == NULL)
29648 *slot = list;
29649 else
29650 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc_list = *slot;
29653 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, optimize_location_lists_1 (c, htab));
29657 /* Recursively assign each location list a unique index into the debug_addr
29658 section. */
29660 static void
29661 index_location_lists (dw_die_ref die)
29663 dw_die_ref c;
29664 dw_attr_node *a;
29665 unsigned ix;
29667 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
29668 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc_list)
29670 dw_loc_list_ref list = AT_loc_list (a);
29671 dw_loc_list_ref curr;
29672 for (curr = list; curr != NULL; curr = curr->dw_loc_next)
29674 /* Don't index an entry that has already been indexed
29675 or won't be output. */
29676 if (curr->begin_entry != NULL
29677 || (strcmp (curr->begin, curr->end) == 0 && !curr->force))
29678 continue;
29680 curr->begin_entry
29681 = add_addr_table_entry (xstrdup (curr->begin), ate_kind_label);
29685 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, index_location_lists (c));
29688 /* Optimize location lists referenced from DIE
29689 children and share them whenever possible. */
29691 static void
29692 optimize_location_lists (dw_die_ref die)
29694 loc_list_hash_type htab (500);
29695 optimize_location_lists_1 (die, &htab);
29698 /* Traverse the limbo die list, and add parent/child links. The only
29699 dies without parents that should be here are concrete instances of
29700 inline functions, and the comp_unit_die. We can ignore the comp_unit_die.
29701 For concrete instances, we can get the parent die from the abstract
29702 instance. */
29704 static void
29705 flush_limbo_die_list (void)
29707 limbo_die_node *node;
29709 /* get_context_die calls force_decl_die, which can put new DIEs on the
29710 limbo list in LTO mode when nested functions are put in a different
29711 partition than that of their parent function. */
29712 while ((node = limbo_die_list))
29714 dw_die_ref die = node->die;
29715 limbo_die_list = node->next;
29717 if (die->die_parent == NULL)
29719 dw_die_ref origin = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin);
29721 if (origin && origin->die_parent)
29722 add_child_die (origin->die_parent, die);
29723 else if (is_cu_die (die))
29725 else if (seen_error ())
29726 /* It's OK to be confused by errors in the input. */
29727 add_child_die (comp_unit_die (), die);
29728 else
29730 /* In certain situations, the lexical block containing a
29731 nested function can be optimized away, which results
29732 in the nested function die being orphaned. Likewise
29733 with the return type of that nested function. Force
29734 this to be a child of the containing function.
29736 It may happen that even the containing function got fully
29737 inlined and optimized out. In that case we are lost and
29738 assign the empty child. This should not be big issue as
29739 the function is likely unreachable too. */
29740 gcc_assert (node->created_for);
29742 if (DECL_P (node->created_for))
29743 origin = get_context_die (DECL_CONTEXT (node->created_for));
29744 else if (TYPE_P (node->created_for))
29745 origin = scope_die_for (node->created_for, comp_unit_die ());
29746 else
29747 origin = comp_unit_die ();
29749 add_child_die (origin, die);
29755 /* Reset DIEs so we can output them again. */
29757 static void
29758 reset_dies (dw_die_ref die)
29760 dw_die_ref c;
29762 /* Remove stuff we re-generate. */
29763 die->die_mark = 0;
29764 die->die_offset = 0;
29765 die->die_abbrev = 0;
29766 remove_AT (die, DW_AT_sibling);
29768 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, reset_dies (c));
29771 /* Output stuff that dwarf requires at the end of every file,
29772 and generate the DWARF-2 debugging info. */
29774 static void
29775 dwarf2out_finish (const char *)
29777 comdat_type_node *ctnode;
29778 dw_die_ref main_comp_unit_die;
29779 unsigned char checksum[16];
29780 char dl_section_ref[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
29782 /* Flush out any latecomers to the limbo party. */
29783 flush_limbo_die_list ();
29785 if (flag_checking)
29787 verify_die (comp_unit_die ());
29788 for (limbo_die_node *node = cu_die_list; node; node = node->next)
29789 verify_die (node->die);
29792 /* We shouldn't have any symbols with delayed asm names for
29793 DIEs generated after early finish. */
29794 gcc_assert (deferred_asm_name == NULL);
29796 gen_remaining_tmpl_value_param_die_attribute ();
29798 if (flag_generate_lto || flag_generate_offload)
29800 gcc_assert (flag_fat_lto_objects || flag_generate_offload);
29802 /* Prune stuff so that dwarf2out_finish runs successfully
29803 for the fat part of the object. */
29804 reset_dies (comp_unit_die ());
29805 for (limbo_die_node *node = cu_die_list; node; node = node->next)
29806 reset_dies (node->die);
29808 hash_table<comdat_type_hasher> comdat_type_table (100);
29809 for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode != NULL; ctnode = ctnode->next)
29811 comdat_type_node **slot
29812 = comdat_type_table.find_slot (ctnode, INSERT);
29814 /* Don't reset types twice. */
29815 if (*slot != HTAB_EMPTY_ENTRY)
29816 continue;
29818 /* Add a pointer to the line table for the main compilation unit
29819 so that the debugger can make sense of DW_AT_decl_file
29820 attributes. */
29821 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
29822 reset_dies (ctnode->root_die);
29824 *slot = ctnode;
29827 /* Reset die CU symbol so we don't output it twice. */
29828 comp_unit_die ()->die_id.die_symbol = NULL;
29830 /* Remove DW_AT_macro from the early output. */
29831 if (have_macinfo)
29832 remove_AT (comp_unit_die (), DEBUG_MACRO_ATTRIBUTE);
29834 /* Remove indirect string decisions. */
29835 debug_str_hash->traverse<void *, reset_indirect_string> (NULL);
29838 #if ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING
29840 dw_die_ref die = comp_unit_die (), c;
29841 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, gcc_assert (! c->die_mark));
29843 #endif
29844 resolve_addr (comp_unit_die ());
29845 move_marked_base_types ();
29847 /* Initialize sections and labels used for actual assembler output. */
29848 init_sections_and_labels (false);
29850 /* Traverse the DIE's and add sibling attributes to those DIE's that
29851 have children. */
29852 add_sibling_attributes (comp_unit_die ());
29853 limbo_die_node *node;
29854 for (node = cu_die_list; node; node = node->next)
29855 add_sibling_attributes (node->die);
29856 for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode != NULL; ctnode = ctnode->next)
29857 add_sibling_attributes (ctnode->root_die);
29859 /* When splitting DWARF info, we put some attributes in the
29860 skeleton compile_unit DIE that remains in the .o, while
29861 most attributes go in the DWO compile_unit_die. */
29862 if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
29864 limbo_die_node *cu;
29865 main_comp_unit_die = gen_compile_unit_die (NULL);
29866 if (dwarf_version >= 5)
29867 main_comp_unit_die->die_tag = DW_TAG_skeleton_unit;
29868 cu = limbo_die_list;
29869 gcc_assert (cu->die == main_comp_unit_die);
29870 limbo_die_list = limbo_die_list->next;
29871 cu->next = cu_die_list;
29872 cu_die_list = cu;
29874 else
29875 main_comp_unit_die = comp_unit_die ();
29877 /* Output a terminator label for the .text section. */
29878 switch_to_section (text_section);
29879 targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, TEXT_END_LABEL, 0);
29880 if (cold_text_section)
29882 switch_to_section (cold_text_section);
29883 targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, COLD_END_LABEL, 0);
29886 /* We can only use the low/high_pc attributes if all of the code was
29887 in .text. */
29888 if (!have_multiple_function_sections
29889 || (dwarf_version < 3 && dwarf_strict))
29891 /* Don't add if the CU has no associated code. */
29892 if (text_section_used)
29893 add_AT_low_high_pc (main_comp_unit_die, text_section_label,
29894 text_end_label, true);
29896 else
29898 unsigned fde_idx;
29899 dw_fde_ref fde;
29900 bool range_list_added = false;
29902 if (text_section_used)
29903 add_ranges_by_labels (main_comp_unit_die, text_section_label,
29904 text_end_label, &range_list_added, true);
29905 if (cold_text_section_used)
29906 add_ranges_by_labels (main_comp_unit_die, cold_text_section_label,
29907 cold_end_label, &range_list_added, true);
29909 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*fde_vec, fde_idx, fde)
29911 if (DECL_IGNORED_P (fde->decl))
29912 continue;
29913 if (!fde->in_std_section)
29914 add_ranges_by_labels (main_comp_unit_die, fde->dw_fde_begin,
29915 fde->dw_fde_end, &range_list_added,
29916 true);
29917 if (fde->dw_fde_second_begin && !fde->second_in_std_section)
29918 add_ranges_by_labels (main_comp_unit_die, fde->dw_fde_second_begin,
29919 fde->dw_fde_second_end, &range_list_added,
29920 true);
29923 if (range_list_added)
29925 /* We need to give .debug_loc and .debug_ranges an appropriate
29926 "base address". Use zero so that these addresses become
29927 absolute. Historically, we've emitted the unexpected
29928 DW_AT_entry_pc instead of DW_AT_low_pc for this purpose.
29929 Emit both to give time for other tools to adapt. */
29930 add_AT_addr (main_comp_unit_die, DW_AT_low_pc, const0_rtx, true);
29931 if (! dwarf_strict && dwarf_version < 4)
29932 add_AT_addr (main_comp_unit_die, DW_AT_entry_pc, const0_rtx, true);
29934 add_ranges (NULL);
29938 /* AIX Assembler inserts the length, so adjust the reference to match the
29939 offset expected by debuggers. */
29940 strcpy (dl_section_ref, debug_line_section_label);
29941 if (XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO)
29942 strcat (dl_section_ref, DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE_STR);
29944 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
29945 add_AT_lineptr (main_comp_unit_die, DW_AT_stmt_list,
29946 dl_section_ref);
29948 if (have_macinfo)
29949 add_AT_macptr (comp_unit_die (), DEBUG_MACRO_ATTRIBUTE,
29950 macinfo_section_label);
29952 if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
29954 if (have_location_lists)
29956 if (dwarf_version >= 5)
29957 add_AT_loclistsptr (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_loclists_base,
29958 loc_section_label);
29959 /* optimize_location_lists calculates the size of the lists,
29960 so index them first, and assign indices to the entries.
29961 Although optimize_location_lists will remove entries from
29962 the table, it only does so for duplicates, and therefore
29963 only reduces ref_counts to 1. */
29964 index_location_lists (comp_unit_die ());
29967 if (addr_index_table != NULL)
29969 unsigned int index = 0;
29970 addr_index_table
29971 ->traverse_noresize<unsigned int *, index_addr_table_entry>
29972 (&index);
29976 loc_list_idx = 0;
29977 if (have_location_lists)
29979 optimize_location_lists (comp_unit_die ());
29980 /* And finally assign indexes to the entries for -gsplit-dwarf. */
29981 if (dwarf_version >= 5 && dwarf_split_debug_info)
29982 assign_location_list_indexes (comp_unit_die ());
29985 save_macinfo_strings ();
29987 if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
29989 unsigned int index = 0;
29991 /* Add attributes common to skeleton compile_units and
29992 type_units. Because these attributes include strings, it
29993 must be done before freezing the string table. Top-level
29994 skeleton die attrs are added when the skeleton type unit is
29995 created, so ensure it is created by this point. */
29996 add_top_level_skeleton_die_attrs (main_comp_unit_die);
29997 debug_str_hash->traverse_noresize<unsigned int *, index_string> (&index);
30000 /* Output all of the compilation units. We put the main one last so that
30001 the offsets are available to output_pubnames. */
30002 for (node = cu_die_list; node; node = node->next)
30003 output_comp_unit (node->die, 0, NULL);
30005 hash_table<comdat_type_hasher> comdat_type_table (100);
30006 for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode != NULL; ctnode = ctnode->next)
30008 comdat_type_node **slot = comdat_type_table.find_slot (ctnode, INSERT);
30010 /* Don't output duplicate types. */
30011 if (*slot != HTAB_EMPTY_ENTRY)
30012 continue;
30014 /* Add a pointer to the line table for the main compilation unit
30015 so that the debugger can make sense of DW_AT_decl_file
30016 attributes. */
30017 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
30018 add_AT_lineptr (ctnode->root_die, DW_AT_stmt_list,
30019 (!dwarf_split_debug_info
30020 ? dl_section_ref
30021 : debug_skeleton_line_section_label));
30023 output_comdat_type_unit (ctnode);
30024 *slot = ctnode;
30027 if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
30029 int mark;
30030 struct md5_ctx ctx;
30032 if (dwarf_version >= 5 && !vec_safe_is_empty (ranges_table))
30033 index_rnglists ();
30035 /* Compute a checksum of the comp_unit to use as the dwo_id. */
30036 md5_init_ctx (&ctx);
30037 mark = 0;
30038 die_checksum (comp_unit_die (), &ctx, &mark);
30039 unmark_all_dies (comp_unit_die ());
30040 md5_finish_ctx (&ctx, checksum);
30042 if (dwarf_version < 5)
30044 /* Use the first 8 bytes of the checksum as the dwo_id,
30045 and add it to both comp-unit DIEs. */
30046 add_AT_data8 (main_comp_unit_die, DW_AT_GNU_dwo_id, checksum);
30047 add_AT_data8 (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_GNU_dwo_id, checksum);
30050 /* Add the base offset of the ranges table to the skeleton
30051 comp-unit DIE. */
30052 if (!vec_safe_is_empty (ranges_table))
30054 if (dwarf_version >= 5)
30055 add_AT_lineptr (main_comp_unit_die, DW_AT_rnglists_base,
30056 ranges_base_label);
30057 else
30058 add_AT_lineptr (main_comp_unit_die, DW_AT_GNU_ranges_base,
30059 ranges_section_label);
30062 switch_to_section (debug_addr_section);
30063 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, debug_addr_section_label);
30064 output_addr_table ();
30067 /* Output the main compilation unit if non-empty or if .debug_macinfo
30068 or .debug_macro will be emitted. */
30069 output_comp_unit (comp_unit_die (), have_macinfo,
30070 dwarf_split_debug_info ? checksum : NULL);
30072 if (dwarf_split_debug_info && info_section_emitted)
30073 output_skeleton_debug_sections (main_comp_unit_die, checksum);
30075 /* Output the abbreviation table. */
30076 if (vec_safe_length (abbrev_die_table) != 1)
30078 switch_to_section (debug_abbrev_section);
30079 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, abbrev_section_label);
30080 output_abbrev_section ();
30083 /* Output location list section if necessary. */
30084 if (have_location_lists)
30086 char l1[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
30087 char l2[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
30088 /* Output the location lists info. */
30089 switch_to_section (debug_loc_section);
30090 if (dwarf_version >= 5)
30092 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, DEBUG_LOC_SECTION_LABEL, 1);
30093 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l2, DEBUG_LOC_SECTION_LABEL, 2);
30094 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
30095 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
30096 "Initial length escape value indicating "
30097 "64-bit DWARF extension");
30098 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l2, l1,
30099 "Length of Location Lists");
30100 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l1);
30101 dw2_asm_output_data (2, dwarf_version, "DWARF Version");
30102 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Address Size");
30103 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "Segment Size");
30104 dw2_asm_output_data (4, dwarf_split_debug_info ? loc_list_idx : 0,
30105 "Offset Entry Count");
30107 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, loc_section_label);
30108 if (dwarf_version >= 5 && dwarf_split_debug_info)
30110 unsigned int save_loc_list_idx = loc_list_idx;
30111 loc_list_idx = 0;
30112 output_loclists_offsets (comp_unit_die ());
30113 gcc_assert (save_loc_list_idx == loc_list_idx);
30115 output_location_lists (comp_unit_die ());
30116 if (dwarf_version >= 5)
30117 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
30120 output_pubtables ();
30122 /* Output the address range information if a CU (.debug_info section)
30123 was emitted. We output an empty table even if we had no functions
30124 to put in it. This because the consumer has no way to tell the
30125 difference between an empty table that we omitted and failure to
30126 generate a table that would have contained data. */
30127 if (info_section_emitted)
30129 switch_to_section (debug_aranges_section);
30130 output_aranges ();
30133 /* Output ranges section if necessary. */
30134 if (!vec_safe_is_empty (ranges_table))
30136 if (dwarf_version >= 5)
30137 output_rnglists ();
30138 else
30139 output_ranges ();
30142 /* Have to end the macro section. */
30143 if (have_macinfo)
30145 switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section);
30146 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, macinfo_section_label);
30147 output_macinfo (!dwarf_split_debug_info ? debug_line_section_label
30148 : debug_skeleton_line_section_label, false);
30149 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End compilation unit");
30152 /* Output the source line correspondence table. We must do this
30153 even if there is no line information. Otherwise, on an empty
30154 translation unit, we will generate a present, but empty,
30155 .debug_info section. IRIX 6.5 `nm' will then complain when
30156 examining the file. This is done late so that any filenames
30157 used by the debug_info section are marked as 'used'. */
30158 switch_to_section (debug_line_section);
30159 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, debug_line_section_label);
30160 if (! DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
30161 output_line_info (false);
30163 if (dwarf_split_debug_info && info_section_emitted)
30165 switch_to_section (debug_skeleton_line_section);
30166 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, debug_skeleton_line_section_label);
30167 output_line_info (true);
30170 /* If we emitted any indirect strings, output the string table too. */
30171 if (debug_str_hash || skeleton_debug_str_hash)
30172 output_indirect_strings ();
30173 if (debug_line_str_hash)
30175 switch_to_section (debug_line_str_section);
30176 const enum dwarf_form form = DW_FORM_line_strp;
30177 debug_line_str_hash->traverse<enum dwarf_form,
30178 output_indirect_string> (form);
30182 /* Returns a hash value for X (which really is a variable_value_struct). */
30184 inline hashval_t
30185 variable_value_hasher::hash (variable_value_struct *x)
30187 return (hashval_t) x->decl_id;
30190 /* Return nonzero if decl_id of variable_value_struct X is the same as
30191 UID of decl Y. */
30193 inline bool
30194 variable_value_hasher::equal (variable_value_struct *x, tree y)
30196 return x->decl_id == DECL_UID (y);
30199 /* Helper function for resolve_variable_value, handle
30200 DW_OP_GNU_variable_value in one location expression.
30201 Return true if exprloc has been changed into loclist. */
30203 static bool
30204 resolve_variable_value_in_expr (dw_attr_node *a, dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
30206 dw_loc_descr_ref next;
30207 for (dw_loc_descr_ref prev = NULL; loc; prev = loc, loc = next)
30209 next = loc->dw_loc_next;
30210 if (loc->dw_loc_opc != DW_OP_GNU_variable_value
30211 || loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class != dw_val_class_decl_ref)
30212 continue;
30214 tree decl = loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_decl_ref;
30215 if (DECL_CONTEXT (decl) != current_function_decl)
30216 continue;
30218 dw_die_ref ref = lookup_decl_die (decl);
30219 if (ref)
30221 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
30222 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = ref;
30223 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
30224 continue;
30226 dw_loc_list_ref l = loc_list_from_tree (decl, 0, NULL);
30227 if (l == NULL)
30228 continue;
30229 if (l->dw_loc_next)
30231 if (AT_class (a) != dw_val_class_loc)
30232 continue;
30233 switch (a->dw_attr)
30235 /* Following attributes allow both exprloc and loclist
30236 classes, so we can change them into a loclist. */
30237 case DW_AT_location:
30238 case DW_AT_string_length:
30239 case DW_AT_return_addr:
30240 case DW_AT_data_member_location:
30241 case DW_AT_frame_base:
30242 case DW_AT_segment:
30243 case DW_AT_static_link:
30244 case DW_AT_use_location:
30245 case DW_AT_vtable_elem_location:
30246 if (prev)
30248 prev->dw_loc_next = NULL;
30249 prepend_loc_descr_to_each (l, AT_loc (a));
30251 if (next)
30252 add_loc_descr_to_each (l, next);
30253 a->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_loc_list;
30254 a->dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
30255 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc_list = l;
30256 have_location_lists = true;
30257 return true;
30258 /* Following attributes allow both exprloc and reference,
30259 so if the whole expression is DW_OP_GNU_variable_value alone
30260 we could transform it into reference. */
30261 case DW_AT_byte_size:
30262 case DW_AT_bit_size:
30263 case DW_AT_lower_bound:
30264 case DW_AT_upper_bound:
30265 case DW_AT_bit_stride:
30266 case DW_AT_count:
30267 case DW_AT_allocated:
30268 case DW_AT_associated:
30269 case DW_AT_byte_stride:
30270 if (prev == NULL && next == NULL)
30271 break;
30272 /* FALLTHRU */
30273 default:
30274 if (dwarf_strict)
30275 continue;
30276 break;
30278 /* Create DW_TAG_variable that we can refer to. */
30279 gen_decl_die (decl, NULL_TREE, NULL,
30280 lookup_decl_die (current_function_decl));
30281 ref = lookup_decl_die (decl);
30282 if (ref)
30284 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
30285 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = ref;
30286 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
30288 continue;
30290 if (prev)
30292 prev->dw_loc_next = l->expr;
30293 add_loc_descr (&prev->dw_loc_next, next);
30294 free_loc_descr (loc, NULL);
30295 next = prev->dw_loc_next;
30297 else
30299 memcpy (loc, l->expr, sizeof (dw_loc_descr_node));
30300 add_loc_descr (&loc, next);
30301 next = loc;
30303 loc = prev;
30305 return false;
30308 /* Attempt to resolve DW_OP_GNU_variable_value using loc_list_from_tree. */
30310 static void
30311 resolve_variable_value (dw_die_ref die)
30313 dw_attr_node *a;
30314 dw_loc_list_ref loc;
30315 unsigned ix;
30317 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
30318 switch (AT_class (a))
30320 case dw_val_class_loc:
30321 if (!resolve_variable_value_in_expr (a, AT_loc (a)))
30322 break;
30323 /* FALLTHRU */
30324 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
30325 loc = AT_loc_list (a);
30326 gcc_assert (loc);
30327 for (; loc; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
30328 resolve_variable_value_in_expr (a, loc->expr);
30329 break;
30330 default:
30331 break;
30335 /* Attempt to optimize DW_OP_GNU_variable_value refering to
30336 temporaries in the current function. */
30338 static void
30339 resolve_variable_values (void)
30341 if (!variable_value_hash || !current_function_decl)
30342 return;
30344 struct variable_value_struct *node
30345 = variable_value_hash->find_with_hash (current_function_decl,
30346 DECL_UID (current_function_decl));
30348 if (node == NULL)
30349 return;
30351 unsigned int i;
30352 dw_die_ref die;
30353 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (node->dies, i, die)
30354 resolve_variable_value (die);
30357 /* Helper function for note_variable_value, handle one location
30358 expression. */
30360 static void
30361 note_variable_value_in_expr (dw_die_ref die, dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
30363 for (; loc; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
30364 if (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_GNU_variable_value
30365 && loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class == dw_val_class_decl_ref)
30367 tree decl = loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_decl_ref;
30368 dw_die_ref ref = lookup_decl_die (decl);
30369 if (! ref && (flag_generate_lto || flag_generate_offload))
30371 /* ??? This is somewhat a hack because we do not create DIEs
30372 for variables not in BLOCK trees early but when generating
30373 early LTO output we need the dw_val_class_decl_ref to be
30374 fully resolved. For fat LTO objects we'd also like to
30375 undo this after LTO dwarf output. */
30376 gcc_assert (DECL_CONTEXT (decl));
30377 dw_die_ref ctx = lookup_decl_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl));
30378 gcc_assert (ctx != NULL);
30379 gen_decl_die (decl, NULL_TREE, NULL, ctx);
30380 ref = lookup_decl_die (decl);
30381 gcc_assert (ref != NULL);
30383 if (ref)
30385 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
30386 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = ref;
30387 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
30388 continue;
30390 if (VAR_P (decl)
30391 && DECL_CONTEXT (decl)
30392 && TREE_CODE (DECL_CONTEXT (decl)) == FUNCTION_DECL
30393 && lookup_decl_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl)))
30395 if (!variable_value_hash)
30396 variable_value_hash
30397 = hash_table<variable_value_hasher>::create_ggc (10);
30399 tree fndecl = DECL_CONTEXT (decl);
30400 struct variable_value_struct *node;
30401 struct variable_value_struct **slot
30402 = variable_value_hash->find_slot_with_hash (fndecl,
30403 DECL_UID (fndecl),
30404 INSERT);
30405 if (*slot == NULL)
30407 node = ggc_cleared_alloc<variable_value_struct> ();
30408 node->decl_id = DECL_UID (fndecl);
30409 *slot = node;
30411 else
30412 node = *slot;
30414 vec_safe_push (node->dies, die);
30419 /* Walk the tree DIE and note DIEs with DW_OP_GNU_variable_value still
30420 with dw_val_class_decl_ref operand. */
30422 static void
30423 note_variable_value (dw_die_ref die)
30425 dw_die_ref c;
30426 dw_attr_node *a;
30427 dw_loc_list_ref loc;
30428 unsigned ix;
30430 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
30431 switch (AT_class (a))
30433 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
30434 loc = AT_loc_list (a);
30435 gcc_assert (loc);
30436 if (!loc->noted_variable_value)
30438 loc->noted_variable_value = 1;
30439 for (; loc; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
30440 note_variable_value_in_expr (die, loc->expr);
30442 break;
30443 case dw_val_class_loc:
30444 note_variable_value_in_expr (die, AT_loc (a));
30445 break;
30446 default:
30447 break;
30450 /* Mark children. */
30451 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, note_variable_value (c));
30454 /* Perform any cleanups needed after the early debug generation pass
30455 has run. */
30457 static void
30458 dwarf2out_early_finish (const char *filename)
30460 set_early_dwarf s;
30462 /* PCH might result in DW_AT_producer string being restored from the
30463 header compilation, so always fill it with empty string initially
30464 and overwrite only here. */
30465 dw_attr_node *producer = get_AT (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_producer);
30466 producer_string = gen_producer_string ();
30467 producer->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->refcount--;
30468 producer->dw_attr_val.v.val_str = find_AT_string (producer_string);
30470 /* Add the name for the main input file now. We delayed this from
30471 dwarf2out_init to avoid complications with PCH. */
30472 add_name_attribute (comp_unit_die (), remap_debug_filename (filename));
30473 add_comp_dir_attribute (comp_unit_die ());
30475 /* When emitting DWARF5 .debug_line_str, move DW_AT_name and
30476 DW_AT_comp_dir into .debug_line_str section. */
30477 if (!DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
30478 && dwarf_version >= 5
30479 && DWARF5_USE_DEBUG_LINE_STR)
30481 for (int i = 0; i < 2; i++)
30483 dw_attr_node *a = get_AT (comp_unit_die (),
30484 i ? DW_AT_comp_dir : DW_AT_name);
30485 if (a == NULL
30486 || AT_class (a) != dw_val_class_str
30487 || strlen (AT_string (a)) + 1 <= DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE)
30488 continue;
30490 if (! debug_line_str_hash)
30491 debug_line_str_hash
30492 = hash_table<indirect_string_hasher>::create_ggc (10);
30494 struct indirect_string_node *node
30495 = find_AT_string_in_table (AT_string (a), debug_line_str_hash);
30496 set_indirect_string (node);
30497 node->form = DW_FORM_line_strp;
30498 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->refcount--;
30499 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str = node;
30503 /* With LTO early dwarf was really finished at compile-time, so make
30504 sure to adjust the phase after annotating the LTRANS CU DIE. */
30505 if (in_lto_p)
30507 early_dwarf_finished = true;
30508 return;
30511 /* Walk through the list of incomplete types again, trying once more to
30512 emit full debugging info for them. */
30513 retry_incomplete_types ();
30515 /* The point here is to flush out the limbo list so that it is empty
30516 and we don't need to stream it for LTO. */
30517 flush_limbo_die_list ();
30519 gen_scheduled_generic_parms_dies ();
30520 gen_remaining_tmpl_value_param_die_attribute ();
30522 /* Add DW_AT_linkage_name for all deferred DIEs. */
30523 for (limbo_die_node *node = deferred_asm_name; node; node = node->next)
30525 tree decl = node->created_for;
30526 if (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl) != DECL_NAME (decl)
30527 /* A missing DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME can be a constant DIE that
30528 ended up in deferred_asm_name before we knew it was
30529 constant and never written to disk. */
30530 && DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl))
30532 add_linkage_attr (node->die, decl);
30533 move_linkage_attr (node->die);
30536 deferred_asm_name = NULL;
30538 if (flag_eliminate_unused_debug_types)
30539 prune_unused_types ();
30541 /* Generate separate COMDAT sections for type DIEs. */
30542 if (use_debug_types)
30544 break_out_comdat_types (comp_unit_die ());
30546 /* Each new type_unit DIE was added to the limbo die list when created.
30547 Since these have all been added to comdat_type_list, clear the
30548 limbo die list. */
30549 limbo_die_list = NULL;
30551 /* For each new comdat type unit, copy declarations for incomplete
30552 types to make the new unit self-contained (i.e., no direct
30553 references to the main compile unit). */
30554 for (comdat_type_node *ctnode = comdat_type_list;
30555 ctnode != NULL; ctnode = ctnode->next)
30556 copy_decls_for_unworthy_types (ctnode->root_die);
30557 copy_decls_for_unworthy_types (comp_unit_die ());
30559 /* In the process of copying declarations from one unit to another,
30560 we may have left some declarations behind that are no longer
30561 referenced. Prune them. */
30562 prune_unused_types ();
30565 /* Traverse the DIE's and note DIEs with DW_OP_GNU_variable_value still
30566 with dw_val_class_decl_ref operand. */
30567 note_variable_value (comp_unit_die ());
30568 for (limbo_die_node *node = cu_die_list; node; node = node->next)
30569 note_variable_value (node->die);
30570 for (comdat_type_node *ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode != NULL;
30571 ctnode = ctnode->next)
30572 note_variable_value (ctnode->root_die);
30573 for (limbo_die_node *node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
30574 note_variable_value (node->die);
30576 /* The AT_pubnames attribute needs to go in all skeleton dies, including
30577 both the main_cu and all skeleton TUs. Making this call unconditional
30578 would end up either adding a second copy of the AT_pubnames attribute, or
30579 requiring a special case in add_top_level_skeleton_die_attrs. */
30580 if (!dwarf_split_debug_info)
30581 add_AT_pubnames (comp_unit_die ());
30583 /* The early debug phase is now finished. */
30584 early_dwarf_finished = true;
30586 /* Do not generate DWARF assembler now when not producing LTO bytecode. */
30587 if (!flag_generate_lto && !flag_generate_offload)
30588 return;
30590 /* Now as we are going to output for LTO initialize sections and labels
30591 to the LTO variants. We don't need a random-seed postfix as other
30592 LTO sections as linking the LTO debug sections into one in a partial
30593 link is fine. */
30594 init_sections_and_labels (true);
30596 /* The output below is modeled after dwarf2out_finish with all
30597 location related output removed and some LTO specific changes.
30598 Some refactoring might make both smaller and easier to match up. */
30600 /* Traverse the DIE's and add add sibling attributes to those DIE's
30601 that have children. */
30602 add_sibling_attributes (comp_unit_die ());
30603 for (limbo_die_node *node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
30604 add_sibling_attributes (node->die);
30605 for (comdat_type_node *ctnode = comdat_type_list;
30606 ctnode != NULL; ctnode = ctnode->next)
30607 add_sibling_attributes (ctnode->root_die);
30609 if (have_macinfo)
30610 add_AT_macptr (comp_unit_die (), DEBUG_MACRO_ATTRIBUTE,
30611 macinfo_section_label);
30613 save_macinfo_strings ();
30615 /* Output all of the compilation units. We put the main one last so that
30616 the offsets are available to output_pubnames. */
30617 for (limbo_die_node *node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
30618 output_comp_unit (node->die, 0, NULL);
30620 hash_table<comdat_type_hasher> comdat_type_table (100);
30621 for (comdat_type_node *ctnode = comdat_type_list;
30622 ctnode != NULL; ctnode = ctnode->next)
30624 comdat_type_node **slot = comdat_type_table.find_slot (ctnode, INSERT);
30626 /* Don't output duplicate types. */
30627 if (*slot != HTAB_EMPTY_ENTRY)
30628 continue;
30630 /* Add a pointer to the line table for the main compilation unit
30631 so that the debugger can make sense of DW_AT_decl_file
30632 attributes. */
30633 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
30634 add_AT_lineptr (ctnode->root_die, DW_AT_stmt_list,
30635 (!dwarf_split_debug_info
30636 ? debug_line_section_label
30637 : debug_skeleton_line_section_label));
30639 output_comdat_type_unit (ctnode);
30640 *slot = ctnode;
30643 /* Stick a unique symbol to the main debuginfo section. */
30644 compute_comp_unit_symbol (comp_unit_die ());
30646 /* Output the main compilation unit. We always need it if only for
30647 the CU symbol. */
30648 output_comp_unit (comp_unit_die (), true, NULL);
30650 /* Output the abbreviation table. */
30651 if (vec_safe_length (abbrev_die_table) != 1)
30653 switch_to_section (debug_abbrev_section);
30654 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, abbrev_section_label);
30655 output_abbrev_section ();
30658 /* Have to end the macro section. */
30659 if (have_macinfo)
30661 /* We have to save macinfo state if we need to output it again
30662 for the FAT part of the object. */
30663 vec<macinfo_entry, va_gc> *saved_macinfo_table = macinfo_table;
30664 if (flag_fat_lto_objects)
30665 macinfo_table = macinfo_table->copy ();
30667 switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section);
30668 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, macinfo_section_label);
30669 output_macinfo (debug_skeleton_line_section_label, true);
30670 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End compilation unit");
30672 /* Emit a skeleton debug_line section. */
30673 switch_to_section (debug_skeleton_line_section);
30674 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, debug_skeleton_line_section_label);
30675 output_line_info (true);
30677 if (flag_fat_lto_objects)
30679 vec_free (macinfo_table);
30680 macinfo_table = saved_macinfo_table;
30685 /* If we emitted any indirect strings, output the string table too. */
30686 if (debug_str_hash || skeleton_debug_str_hash)
30687 output_indirect_strings ();
30689 /* Switch back to the text section. */
30690 switch_to_section (text_section);
30693 /* Reset all state within dwarf2out.c so that we can rerun the compiler
30694 within the same process. For use by toplev::finalize. */
30696 void
30697 dwarf2out_c_finalize (void)
30699 last_var_location_insn = NULL;
30700 cached_next_real_insn = NULL;
30701 used_rtx_array = NULL;
30702 incomplete_types = NULL;
30703 decl_scope_table = NULL;
30704 debug_info_section = NULL;
30705 debug_skeleton_info_section = NULL;
30706 debug_abbrev_section = NULL;
30707 debug_skeleton_abbrev_section = NULL;
30708 debug_aranges_section = NULL;
30709 debug_addr_section = NULL;
30710 debug_macinfo_section = NULL;
30711 debug_line_section = NULL;
30712 debug_skeleton_line_section = NULL;
30713 debug_loc_section = NULL;
30714 debug_pubnames_section = NULL;
30715 debug_pubtypes_section = NULL;
30716 debug_str_section = NULL;
30717 debug_line_str_section = NULL;
30718 debug_str_dwo_section = NULL;
30719 debug_str_offsets_section = NULL;
30720 debug_ranges_section = NULL;
30721 debug_frame_section = NULL;
30722 fde_vec = NULL;
30723 debug_str_hash = NULL;
30724 debug_line_str_hash = NULL;
30725 skeleton_debug_str_hash = NULL;
30726 dw2_string_counter = 0;
30727 have_multiple_function_sections = false;
30728 text_section_used = false;
30729 cold_text_section_used = false;
30730 cold_text_section = NULL;
30731 current_unit_personality = NULL;
30733 early_dwarf = false;
30734 early_dwarf_finished = false;
30736 next_die_offset = 0;
30737 single_comp_unit_die = NULL;
30738 comdat_type_list = NULL;
30739 limbo_die_list = NULL;
30740 file_table = NULL;
30741 decl_die_table = NULL;
30742 common_block_die_table = NULL;
30743 decl_loc_table = NULL;
30744 call_arg_locations = NULL;
30745 call_arg_loc_last = NULL;
30746 call_site_count = -1;
30747 tail_call_site_count = -1;
30748 cached_dw_loc_list_table = NULL;
30749 abbrev_die_table = NULL;
30750 delete dwarf_proc_stack_usage_map;
30751 dwarf_proc_stack_usage_map = NULL;
30752 line_info_label_num = 0;
30753 cur_line_info_table = NULL;
30754 text_section_line_info = NULL;
30755 cold_text_section_line_info = NULL;
30756 separate_line_info = NULL;
30757 info_section_emitted = false;
30758 pubname_table = NULL;
30759 pubtype_table = NULL;
30760 macinfo_table = NULL;
30761 ranges_table = NULL;
30762 ranges_by_label = NULL;
30763 rnglist_idx = 0;
30764 have_location_lists = false;
30765 loclabel_num = 0;
30766 poc_label_num = 0;
30767 last_emitted_file = NULL;
30768 label_num = 0;
30769 tmpl_value_parm_die_table = NULL;
30770 generic_type_instances = NULL;
30771 frame_pointer_fb_offset = 0;
30772 frame_pointer_fb_offset_valid = false;
30773 base_types.release ();
30774 XDELETEVEC (producer_string);
30775 producer_string = NULL;
30778 #include "gt-dwarf2out.h"